German All-in-One For Dummies - Wiley [PDF] | Online Book Share (2024)

723 Pages • 199,265 Words • PDF • 16.6 MB

+ German+ Wiley+ Dummies

Uploaded at 2021-07-06 00:22

Report DMCA

PREVIEW PDF

German ALL-IN-ONE

by Wendy Foster with Paulina Christensen, PhD, and Anne Fox

German All-in-One For Dummies® Published by John Wiley & Sons, Inc. 111 River St. Hoboken, NJ 07030-5774 www.wiley.com

Copyright © 2013 by John Wiley & Sons, Inc., Hoboken, New Jersey Published simultaneously in Canada No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or transmitted in any form orby any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, scanning or otherwise, except as permitted under Sections 107 or 108 of the 1976 United States Copyright Act, without the prior written permission of the Publisher. Requests to the Publisher for permission should be addressed to the Permissions Department, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 111 River Street, Hoboken, NJ 07030, (201) 748-6011, fax(201) 748-6008, or online at http://www.wiley.com/go/permissions. Trademarks: Wiley, the Wiley logo, For Dummies, the Dummies Man logo, A Reference for the Rest of Us!, The Dummies Way, Dummies Daily, The Fun and Easy Way, Dummies.com, Making Everything Easier, and related trade dress are trademarks or registered trademarks of John Wiley & Sons, Inc., and/or its affiliates in the United States and other countries, and may not be used without written permission. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. John Wiley & Sons, Inc., is not associated with any product or vendor mentioned in this book. LIMIT OF LIABILITY/DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY: THE PUBLISHER AND THE AUTHOR MAKE NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES WITH RESPECT TO THE ACCURACY OR COMPLETENESS OF THE CONTENTS OF THIS WORK AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION WARRANTIES OF FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. NO WARRANTY MAY BE CREATED OR EXTENDED BY SALES OR PROMOTIONAL MATERIALS. THE ADVICE AND STRATEGIES CONTAINED HEREIN MAY NOT BE SUITABLE FOR EVERY SITUATION. THIS WORK IS SOLD WITH THE UNDERSTANDING THAT THE PUBLISHER IS NOT ENGAGED IN RENDERING LEGAL, ACCOUNTING, OR OTHER PROFESSIONAL SERVICES. IF PROFESSIONAL ASSISTANCE IS REQUIRED, THE SERVICES OF A COMPETENT PROFESSIONAL PERSON SHOULD BE SOUGHT. NEITHER THE PUBLISHER NOR THE AUTHOR SHALL BE LIABLE FOR DAMAGES ARISING HEREFROM. THE FACT THAT AN ORGANIZATION OR WEBSITE IS REFERRED TO IN THIS WORK AS A CITATION AND/OR A POTENTIAL SOURCE OF FURTHER INFORMATION DOES NOT MEAN THAT THE AUTHOR OR THE PUBLISHER ENDORSES THE INFORMATION THE ORGANIZATION OR WEBSITE MAY PROVIDE OR RECOMMENDATIONS IT MAY MAKE. FURTHER, READERS SHOULD BE AWARE THAT INTERNET WEBSITES LISTED IN THIS WORK MAY HAVE CHANGED OR DISAPPEARED BETWEEN WHEN THIS WORK WAS WRITTEN AND WHEN IT IS READ. For general information on our other products and services, please contact our Customer Care Department within the U.S. at 877-762-2974, outside the U.S. at 317-572-3993, or fax 317-572-4002. For technical support, please visit www.wiley.com/techsupport. Wiley publishes in a variety of print and electronic formats and by print-on-demand. Some material included with standard print versions of this book may not be included in e-books or in print-on-demand. If this book refers to media such as a CD or DVD that is not included in the version you purchased, you may download this material at http://booksupport.wiley.com. For more information about Wiley products, visit www.wiley.com. Library of Congress Control Number: 2013935672 ISBN 978-1-118-49140-9 (pbk); ISBN 978-1-118-61260-6 (ebk); ISBN 978-1-118-61270-5 (ebk); ISBN 978-1-118-61271-2 (ebk) Manufactured in the United States of America 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

About the Authors Wendy Foster was born in Connecticut and grew up in Scituate, Massachusetts. While studying in France, she traveled around Europe and became curious about the German language and culture. After graduating with a teaching certificate and a degree in French, she decided to return to Europe to study German. Her love of the Alps inspired her to live in Munich, where she spent 30 years. During that time, she completed her German studies at the Sprachen-und-Dolmetscher-Institut in Munich and later her MA in French at Middlebury College in Paris. Her professional experience includes teaching Business English, German, French, and intercultural communication skills. She also does editing for online German education programs. A few years ago, she returned to her New England roots. When she’s not teaching ESL or German at the Boston Language Institute, she works from her home overlooking a spectacular salt marsh that constantly beckons her to go kayaking, exploring, and swimming. Paulina Christensen has been working as a writer, editor, and translator for almost ten years. She holds a degree in English and German literature and has developed, written, and edited numerous German-language textbooks and teachers’ handbooks for Berlitz International. Her work as a translator ranges from new media art to science fiction (Starlog magazine). She occasionally works as a court interpreter and does consulting and interpreting at educational conferences, as well as voice-overs for educational videos and CDs. Dr. Christensen received her MA and PhD from Düsseldorf University, Germany, and has taught at Berlitz Language Schools, New York University, and Fordham University. Anne Fox has been working as a translator, editor, and writer for the past 12 years. She studied at Interpreters’ School, Zurich, Switzerland, and holds a degree in translation. Her various assignments have taken her to outer space, hyperspace, and around the world. She has also taught at Berlitz Language Schools and worked as a legal and technical proofreader in the editorial departments of several law firms. Most recently she has been developing, writing, and editing student textbooks and teacher handbooks for Berlitz.

Dedication This book is dedicated to all those who enjoy speaking German and appreciate the rich cultural heritage of German-speaking people. I also dedicate this work to Phil Kehoe, whose unflagging support of my endeavors serves as a constant inspiration to me. — Wendy Foster

Author’s Acknowledgments I would like to express my deep appreciation to the editorial staff at Wiley for their insight, patience, and expertise, especially my project editor Vicki Adang, copy editor Amanda Langferman, acquisitions editor Michael Lewis, and technical editors Candis Carey and Susan Reinhardt. The careful guidance provided by these professionals has greatly enhanced the quality of this book. My sincere thanks to all of you. — Wendy Foster

Publisher’s Acknowledgments We’re proud of this book; please send us your comments at http://dummies.custhelp.com. For other comments, please contact our Customer Care Department within the U.S. at 877-762-2974, outside the U.S. at 317-572-3993, or fax 317-572-4002. Some of the people who helped bring this book to market include the following: Acquisitions, Editorial, and VerticalWebsites

Composition Services

Senior Project Editor: Victoria M. Adang

Project Coordinator: Patrick Redmond

Acquisitions Editor: Michael Lewis

Layout and Graphics: Carrie A. Cesavice, Jennifer Creasey

Copy Editor: Amanda M. Langferman

Proofreaders: John Greenough, Tricia Liebig

Assistant Editor: David Lutton

Indexer: Potomac Indexing, LLC

Editorial Program Coordinator: Joe Niesen Technical Editors: Candis Carey, Susan Reinhardt Vertical Websites: Melanie Orr, Josh Frank, Doug Kuhn Editorial Manager: Michelle Hacker Editorial Assistants: Rachelle Amick, Alexa Koschier Cover Photo: © iStockphoto.com / Nikada Publishing and Editorial for Consumer Dummies Kathleen Nebenhaus, Vice President and Executive Publisher David Palmer, Associate Publisher Kristin Ferguson-Wagstaffe, Product Development Director Publishing for Technology Dummies Andy Cummings, Vice President and Publisher Composition Services Debbie Stailey, Director of Composition Services

Contents at a Glance Introduction................................................................. 1 Book I: Getting Started with German............................. 7 Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics...................................................................... 9 Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements............................. 31 Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag!............................................................... 53 Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life................................ 77 Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events.................. 97 Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified..................................................................................... 119 Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit!........................................... 137

Book II: Speaking German on the Go.......................... 165 Chapter 1: Locating Places............................................................................................ 167 Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town............................................................................... 185 Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!....................................................... 203 Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht!.......................................................... 227 Chapter 5: Getting Around............................................................................................ 243 Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe!...................................................................... 263

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication.......................................................281 Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences................................................ 283 Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case.......................................................... 307 Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense............................... 331 Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions ............................................................. 353 Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs...................... 379 Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries........................... 411 Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood............................. 429 Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs............................. 445

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication............................................. 463 Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns......... 465 Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions............................................. 479 Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations...................................... 493 Chapter 4: Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect....... 507 Chapter 5: Narrating the (Simple) Past: Fact and Fiction.......................................... 525 Chapter 6: Looking to the Future (And Avoiding It)................................................... 537 Chapter 7: Describing Your Mood: Summing Up the Subjunctive............................ 549

Book V: The Appendixes............................................ 563 Appendix A: Verb Tables and Case Charts................................................................. 565 Appendix B: German-English Mini-Dictionary............................................................. 587 Appendix C: English-German Mini-Dictionary............................................................. 599 Appendix D: Fun & Games............................................................................................. 611 Appendix E: About the CD............................................................................................. 655

Index....................................................................... 659

Table of Contents Introduction.................................................................. 1 About This Book............................................................................................... 1 Conventions Used in This Book...................................................................... 2 Foolish Assumptions........................................................................................ 3 How This Book Is Organized........................................................................... 4 Book I: Getting Started with German.................................................... 4 Book II: Speaking German on the Go.................................................... 4 Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations forCommunication............................................................................. 5 Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication...... 5 Book V: The Appendixes........................................................................ 5 Icons Used in This Book.................................................................................. 6 Where to Go from Here.................................................................................... 6

Book I: Getting Started with German.............................. 7 Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Starting with What You Already Know.......................................................... 9 Friendly allies: Kindergarten and more (perfect cognates).............. 9 Kissing cousins (near cognates)......................................................... 11 False friends.......................................................................................... 13 Lenders and borrowers........................................................................ 16 Using Popular Expressions............................................................................ 19 Handling Basic Pronunciation....................................................................... 21 Understanding stress in German........................................................ 21 Constructing the alphabet blocks...................................................... 21 Pronouncing vowels............................................................................. 23 Pronouncing ä, ö, and ü....................................................................... 24 Pronouncing diphthongs..................................................................... 25 Pronouncing consonants..................................................................... 25 Pronouncing consonant combinations.............................................. 28

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements . . . 31 Doing the Numbers......................................................................................... 32 Counting off with cardinal numbers................................................... 32 Getting in line with ordinal numbers................................................. 36 Telling Time..................................................................................................... 38 Using the 12-hour clock........................................................................ 38 Using the 24-hour system.................................................................... 40 Describing times of the day................................................................. 40

x

German All-in-One For Dummies Expressing Dates............................................................................................ 41 Recounting the days............................................................................. 41 Knowing the names of the months and seasons.............................. 42 Writing dates the European way......................................................... 44 Referring to specific dates................................................................... 45 Naming specific times in the months................................................. 46 Celebrating holidays............................................................................. 47 Measurements, Quantities, and Weights..................................................... 49

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Getting Formal or Informal............................................................................ 53 Saying “Hello,” “Goodbye,” and “How Are You?”....................................... 54 Saying “Guten Tag” and “Auf Wiedersehen”..................................... 54 Asking “Wie geht es Ihnen?”................................................................ 56 Giving a response to “Wie geht es Ihnen?”........................................ 57 Introducing Yourself and Your Friends....................................................... 59 Introducing your friends...................................................................... 59 Making introductions for special occasions..................................... 59 Introducing yourself............................................................................. 61 Talking about Yourself................................................................................... 62 Describing your work........................................................................... 63 Providing names and numbers........................................................... 64 Discussing Cities, Countries, and Nationalities.......................................... 67 Saying where you come from.............................................................. 67 Asking people where they come from................................................ 68 Discovering nationalities..................................................................... 70 Chatting about languages you speak.................................................. 71 Making Small Talk about the Weather......................................................... 73 Noting what it’s like out there............................................................. 73 Discussing the temperature................................................................ 74 Describing the day’s weather.............................................................. 75

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life . . . . 77 Describing Where You Live........................................................................... 77 Looking at your living quarters: Mein Haus...................................... 78 Naming furnishings and appliances................................................... 79 Talking about Family...................................................................................... 83 Naming your relatives.......................................................................... 83 Family pets............................................................................................. 86 Discussing Friends, Acquaintances, and Neighbors.................................. 87 Spending Time at Your Home or Someone Else’s...................................... 88 Daily routine.......................................................................................... 88 Das Wochenende: The weekend......................................................... 90 Doing and saying the right thing......................................................... 91 Playing Sports................................................................................................. 93 Playing around with the verb “spielen”............................................. 93 Verbalizing sports you enjoy.............................................................. 93 Inviting someone to play...................................................................... 94

Table of Contents Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Making a Phone Call....................................................................................... 97 Asking for your party........................................................................... 98 Making the connection......................................................................... 99 Making appointments......................................................................... 102 Leaving messages............................................................................... 103 Writing Your Message.................................................................................. 105 Beginning and ending a letter........................................................... 105 Sending mail the old-fashioned way................................................. 106 E-mailing and faxing............................................................................ 109 Settling In at the Office................................................................................. 109 Organizing your desk and supplies.................................................. 110 Interacting with coworkers............................................................... 111 Doing business in German................................................................. 112 Tuning In to Current Events........................................................................ 115 Newspapers and magazines.............................................................. 115 Television, radio, and the web.......................................................... 117

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Getting Familiar with the German Shopping Experience........................ 119 Identifying types of shops................................................................. 120 Determining a store’s hours.............................................................. 120 Finding your way around a department store................................ 121 Browsing and responding to “Kann ich Ihnen helfen?”................. 123 Getting assistance............................................................................... 123 Shopping for Clothes.................................................................................... 124 Characterizing various clothing items............................................. 124 Knowing your size.............................................................................. 128 Trying on clothes................................................................................ 130 Making Your Purchase................................................................................. 133 Preparing to pay for your items........................................................ 133 Getting a tax refund on your purchases.......................................... 135

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! . . . . . . . . . . 137 Talking about Eating and Drinking............................................................. 138 Saying you’re hungry and thirsty: Hast du Hunger? Hast du Durst?................................................................................. 138 Talking about meals: Guten Appetit!................................................ 139 Setting the table.................................................................................. 140 Going to a Restaurant: Das Restaurant...................................................... 141 Deciding where to eat........................................................................ 141 Making reservations........................................................................... 143 Arriving and being seated.................................................................. 146 Checking Out the Menu: Die Speisekarte.................................................. 147 Looking at breakfast, lunch, and dinner items................................ 147 Understanding cooking terms........................................................... 150 Quenching your thirst........................................................................ 151

xi

xii

German All-in-One For Dummies Placing Your Order....................................................................................... 152 Ordering politely................................................................................. 153 Asking for assistance.......................................................................... 154 Ordering something special.............................................................. 155 Finishing Your Meal and Getting the Check.............................................. 156 Replying to “How did you like the food?” “Hat es Ihnen geschmeckt?”.......................................................... 156 Asking for the check........................................................................... 156 Shopping for Food........................................................................................ 159 Knowing where to shop..................................................................... 159 Finding what you need....................................................................... 160

Book II: Speaking German on the Go........................... 165 Chapter 1: Locating Places . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Getting Yourself Oriented............................................................................ 167 Finding out where something is........................................................ 168 Asking how far something is: Ist es weit von hier?......................... 170 Getting more specific directions....................................................... 170 Asking How to Get from One Place to Another......................................... 171 Asking how to get to a location......................................................... 172 Asking how to get to a city or country............................................. 173 Asking how to get to a specific building.......................................... 173 Describing Where Something Is Located................................................... 174 Locating one place in relation to another....................................... 175 Going left, right, straight ahead: Links, rechts, geradeaus............ 177 Using compass points........................................................................ 178 Understanding Where to Go........................................................................ 179 Pointing out the first, second, or third street ................................ 179 Following directions: Take this street.............................................. 180 Traveling by Car — das Auto — or Other Vehicle................................... 183

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Taking in the Sights...................................................................................... 185 Deciding what to see.......................................................................... 186 Taking a sightseeing tour................................................................... 187 Making plans........................................................................................ 188 Heading to the Movies................................................................................. 189 Going to the show............................................................................... 189 Buying tickets...................................................................................... 190 Going to the Museum................................................................................... 193 Discovering different types of museums......................................... 193 Talking about museums..................................................................... 193 Attending Cultural Performances............................................................... 195 Deciding where to go.......................................................................... 195 Going to a concert.............................................................................. 197

Table of Contents How Was It? Talking about Entertainment................................................ 198 Asking about the entertainment....................................................... 198 Telling people what you think........................................................... 199 Going to a Party............................................................................................ 200 Getting an invitation........................................................................... 201 Talking about the party...................................................................... 202

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Getting Ready for Your Trip........................................................................ 203 Finding travel information online..................................................... 204 Getting help from a travel agent....................................................... 206 Packing your bags............................................................................... 208 Exploring the Outdoors............................................................................... 209 Getting out and going......................................................................... 209 Things to see along the way.............................................................. 210 Going to the mountains...................................................................... 212 Going to the country.......................................................................... 214 Going to the sea.................................................................................. 215 Dealing with Passports and Visas.............................................................. 217 Keeping tabs on your passport......................................................... 217 Inquiring about visas.......................................................................... 218 Handling Money............................................................................................ 219 Changing currency: Geldwechsel..................................................... 220 Understanding the euro and other currencies............................... 223 Heading to the ATM............................................................................ 223

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 Finding Accommodations............................................................................ 227 Making a Reservation................................................................................... 228 Saying when and how long you want to stay.................................. 229 Specifying the kind of room you want.............................................. 229 Asking about the price....................................................................... 230 Finalizing the reservation.................................................................. 231 Checking In.................................................................................................... 233 Stating how long you’re staying........................................................ 233 Filling out the registration form........................................................ 233 Getting keyed in.................................................................................. 234 Asking about amenities and essentials............................................ 235 Making the Most of Your Stay..................................................................... 238 Making special requests.................................................................... 238 Pointing out problems........................................................................ 239 Checking Out and Paying the Bill............................................................... 240 Asking for the bill................................................................................ 240 Asking small favors............................................................................. 241

xiii

xiv

German All-in-One For Dummies Chapter 5: Getting Around . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Going through the Airport........................................................................... 243 Getting your ticket and checking in................................................. 243 Going through passport control....................................................... 247 Going through customs...................................................................... 248 Traveling by Car........................................................................................... 249 Renting a car........................................................................................ 249 Making sense of road maps............................................................... 251 Understanding and observing road signs........................................ 252 Identifying parts of a car.................................................................... 253 Taking the Train............................................................................................ 255 Interpreting train schedules.............................................................. 255 Getting more information.................................................................. 256 Buying train tickets............................................................................. 257 Navigating Buses, Subways, Streetcars, and Taxis.................................. 259 Purchasing a ticket............................................................................. 259 Boarding the bus, subway, or streetcar........................................... 260 Getting a taxi....................................................................................... 262

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Requesting Help............................................................................................ 263 Shouting for help................................................................................ 263 Reporting a problem.......................................................................... 264 Asking for English-speaking help...................................................... 265 Handling Health Issues................................................................................ 265 Describing what ails you.................................................................... 266 Talking about any special conditions.............................................. 267 Getting an examination...................................................................... 267 Specifying parts of the body.............................................................. 269 Understanding the diagnosis............................................................ 270 Getting treatment................................................................................ 272 Going to a pharmacy.......................................................................... 273 Handling Police Matters............................................................................... 276 Describing what was stolen............................................................... 276 Giving a description of the thief....................................................... 277 Getting legal help................................................................................ 278

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations  for Communication........................................................281 Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 Identifying the Parts of Speech................................................................... 284 Nouns................................................................................................... 285 Pronouns.............................................................................................. 287 Articles................................................................................................. 288

Table of Contents Adjectives............................................................................................ 289 Verbs.................................................................................................... 290 Adverbs................................................................................................ 290 Conjunctions....................................................................................... 291 Prepositions........................................................................................ 292 Understanding Grammar Terms................................................................. 292 Conjugating verbs and understanding tenses................................. 292 Familiarizing yourself with gender, number, and case.................. 294 Grammar terms that describe words, parts of words, and word groupings........................................................................ 294 Understanding Word Order........................................................................ 295 Arranging words in the right order.................................................. 295 Putting the verb in second place...................................................... 296 Pushing the verb to the end.............................................................. 297 Forming questions.............................................................................. 297 Checking Out the Tenses: Present, Past, and Future.....................................298 Looking at the present....................................................................... 298 Talking about the past....................................................................... 299 Writing about the past....................................................................... 301 Talking about the future.................................................................... 302 Finding Meaning through Context.............................................................. 302 Using a Bilingual Dictionary........................................................................ 303 Making the right choice..................................................................... 303 Performing a word search................................................................. 305

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Classifying Nouns and Pronouns with Gender......................................... 308 Identifying German genders and figuring out which one to use.... 308 Eyeing nouns with more than one gender and meaning............... 310 Pinning Down Plurals................................................................................... 311 Knowing the five plural forms........................................................... 312 Taking note of nouns that are only singular or plural................... 314 Mastering the Art of Articles....................................................................... 315 Identifying singular nouns with indefinite articles......................... 316 Knowing when not to use articles.................................................... 316 Calling All Cases: The Roles Nouns and Pronouns Play.......................... 317 Identifying the four cases.................................................................. 318 Eyeing the similarities and differences............................................ 319 Understanding nouns with case endings......................................... 321 Putting Pronouns in Place........................................................................... 322 Getting personal with personal pronouns....................................... 322 Relating to relative pronouns............................................................ 324 Demonstrating demonstrative pronouns........................................ 325 Discovering Dative Verbs............................................................................ 327 Considering How Case Affects Adjectives................................................. 328 How possessives change................................................................... 328 How adjective endings change.......................................................... 329

xv

xvi

German All-in-One For Dummies Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense . . . 331 Grasping the Specifics of Subject Pronouns............................................. 332 Assigning person and number to subject pronouns...................... 332 Distinguishing among the three forms of “you”.............................. 333 Distinguishing among “she,” “they,” and the formal “you”........... 335 Getting Your Verbs in Shape....................................................................... 336 Agreeing with the regulars................................................................ 336 Conjugating verbs with spelling changes........................................ 339 Conjugating the irregulars haben and sein: To have and to be.... 342 Using the Very Versatile Present Tense.................................................... 346 Stating Information with the Passive......................................................... 348 Forming the passive........................................................................... 348 Using the passive................................................................................ 350 Recognizing the impersonal passive................................................ 351

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353 Knowing How to Formulate Questions...................................................... 353 Inverting word order for yes/no questions..................................... 354 Gathering information with question words: Who, what, why, and more............................................................ 354 Forming indirect questions............................................................... 357 Checking information: Tag! You’re it, aren’t you?.......................... 358 Making choices: Asking what kind of. . . ?........................................ 359 Answering with Yes...................................................................................... 361 Variations on yes................................................................................ 361 Emphasizing yes................................................................................. 363 Responding with No: The Difference between Kein and Nicht............... 364 Negating with nicht............................................................................. 364 Negating with kein.............................................................................. 366 Avoiding blunt negative replies........................................................ 368 Asking and Answering Questions with Wo- and DaCompound Words..................................................................................... 370 Combining question words: Compounds with wo-........................ 371 Explaining yes and no answers by using da- compounds............. 373 Sounding Diplomatic: Using Maybe, Suggesting, and Refusing Politely................................................................................ 376

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379 Organizing Adjectives: Opposites, Cognates, and Collocations............. 380 Letting opposites attract................................................................... 380 A family resemblance: Describing with cognates........................... 382 Putting collocations and word partnerships into action............... 384

Table of Contents Helping Adjectives Meet a Satisfying End................................................. 385 Forming endings on adjectives not preceded by der- or ein- words............................................................................ 386 Adding endings for preceded adjectives......................................... 388 Using the right endings with possessive adjectives....................... 389 Understanding Types of Adverbs............................................................... 391 Describing time with adverbs........................................................... 391 Using adverbs to indicate place........................................................ 392 Looking at adverbs of manner and degree...................................... 393 Eyeing adverbs that describe cause................................................. 394 Putting Adverbs and Adverbial Expressions in Their Proper Place...... 395 Comparing with Regular Adjectives and Adverbs: Fast, Faster, Fastest.................................................................................. 397 Comparing two things........................................................................ 398 Absolutely the most! Discussing superlatives................................ 399 Considering common comparisons.................................................. 400 Adding the umlaut in regular comparisons..................................... 402 Using Irregular Comparison Forms............................................................ 403 Comparing Equals and Nonequals............................................................. 404 Identifying Unique Adjective and Adverb Groups.................................... 406 Adjectives that act as nouns............................................................. 407 Participles that function as adjectives or adverbs......................... 407 Adverbs that modify adjectives........................................................ 409

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries . . 411 Grasping the Basics of Modal Verbs.......................................................... 412 Identifying modals: Assistants with attitude................................... 412 Understanding word order and modals........................................... 413 May I? Dürfen, the Permission Verb........................................................... 414 Forming dürfen.................................................................................... 414 Using dürfen........................................................................................ 414 You Can Do It! Können, the Ability Verb................................................... 416 Forming können.................................................................................. 417 Using können....................................................................................... 417 I Like That: Mögen, the Likeable Verb....................................................... 419 Forming mögen................................................................................... 420 Using mögen........................................................................................ 420 What Would You Like? Möchten, the Preference Verb........................... 421 Forming möchten................................................................................ 421 Using möchten.................................................................................... 422 Do I Have To? Müssen, the Verb of Necessity.......................................... 423 Forming müssen.................................................................................. 423 Using müssen...................................................................................... 424

xvii

xviii

German All-in-One For Dummies Should I or Shouldn’t I? Sollen, the Duty Verb.......................................... 425 Forming sollen..................................................................................... 425 Using sollen......................................................................................... 426 I Want to Be Famous: Wollen, the Intention Verb.................................... 426 Forming wollen.................................................................................... 427 Using wollen........................................................................................ 427

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood . . . 429 Getting into the Imperative Mood.............................................................. 430 Grasping the three imperative forms............................................... 430 Punctuating commands..................................................................... 431 Commanding with regular verbs...................................................... 432 Commanding with irregular verbs.................................................... 433 Grasping Formal Commands....................................................................... 434 Using the formal “you” form: Sie....................................................... 434 Obeying orders................................................................................... 435 Understanding signs........................................................................... 437 Reading instructions.......................................................................... 439 Giving Informal Directives........................................................................... 440 Using the singular “you” form: du.................................................... 440 Using the plural informal “you” form: ihr........................................ 441 Giving Directives Politely and Making Suggestions................................. 441

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs . . . 445 Looking at the Prefix.................................................................................... 445 Parting Ways: Simplifying Separable-Prefix Verbs................................... 446 Getting the hang of separable prefixes............................................ 447 Using separable-prefix verbs in the present tense......................... 451 Together Forever: Investigating Inseparable-Prefix Verbs...................... 453 Understanding inseparable-prefix combinations........................... 454 Putting inseparable-prefix verbs into the present tense............... 457 Double-Crossers: Dealing with Dual-Prefix Verbs.................................... 458 Grasping dual-prefix verb distinctions............................................. 458 Looking at dual-prefix verbs in the present tense.......................... 460

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication.............................................. 463 Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 465 Conjunctions and Clauses: Reviewing the Terminology......................... 466 Connecting with Coordinating Conjunctions............................................ 468 Using coordinating conjunctions...................................................... 469 Working on word order...................................................................... 470

Table of Contents Getting Support from Subordinating Conjunctions................................. 471 Using subordinating conjunctions.................................................... 473 Putting words in the proper order................................................... 474 Joining with Relative Pronouns.................................................................. 476 Knowing how to make the connection with relative pronouns.... 476 Forming sentences with relative clauses......................................... 477

Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions . . . . . . . . . . 479 Prepping for Prepositions with a Few Basic Guidelines.......................... 480 Grasping the importance of case...................................................... 480 Understanding where meaning fits in.............................................. 481 Accusative, Dative, and Genitive Cases: How the Rest of the Phrase Shapes Up.................................................... 482 No finger pointing: Accusative prepositions................................... 482 Dative prepositions............................................................................ 484 Genitive prepositions......................................................................... 487 Tackling Two-Way Prepositions: Accusative/Dative............................... 488 Understanding Quirky Combinations........................................................ 491

Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations . . . . . . . 493 Identifying Types of Idiomatic Verb Expressions..................................... 494 In the Looking Glass: Reflecting on Reflexive Verbs................................ 495 Self-ish concerns: Meeting the reflexive pronouns........................ 495 Identifying which verbs need to be reflexive.................................. 497 Combining Verbs with Prepositions.......................................................... 501 Seeing how prepositions transform verbs...................................... 501 Knowing common combos in the accusative case......................... 503 Eyeing common combos in the dative case.................................... 504

Chapter 4: Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 507 Forming the Present Perfect with Haben.................................................. 508 Forming the present perfect with regular weak verbs................... 508 Forming the present perfect with irregular weak verbs................ 510 Forming the present perfect with strong verbs.............................. 511 Forming the present perfect with verbs ending in -ieren.............. 512 Forming the Present Perfect with Sein...................................................... 513 Eyeing the Present Perfect: German versus English................................ 515 One for all: Representing three English tenses............................... 515 Opting for the German present......................................................... 516 Using Modal Auxiliary Verbs in Present Perfect....................................... 516 Forming modal verbs in present perfect......................................... 517 Understanding word order with modal verbs................................ 517 Using Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs in Present Perfect........ 519 Separable-prefix verbs....................................................................... 519 Inseparable-prefix verbs.................................................................... 521 Describing with Past Perfect....................................................................... 522

xix

xx

German All-in-One For Dummies Chapter 5: Narrating the (Simple) Past: Fact and Fiction . . . . . . . . . . 525 Conjugating the Simple Past....................................................................... 525 Forming regular (weak) verbs in simple past................................. 527 Forming irregular (strong) verbs in simple past............................ 528 Forming haben and sein in simple past........................................... 531 Forming modals in simple past......................................................... 532 Contrasting Tenses....................................................................................... 534

Chapter 6: Looking to the Future (And Avoiding It) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537 The Future Is Now: Using the Present Tense Instead.............................. 538 Seeing when German present works perfectly............................... 538 Saying when: Using future time expressions with the present tense.................................................................... 539 Peering into the Future with Werden......................................................... 541 Forming the future: Werden + infinitive verb.................................. 541 Using the future: Assuming, hoping, and emphasizing intentions........................................................... 543 Using the future to express probability........................................... 544 Talking about What Will Have Happened: The Future Perfect............... 545 Forming the future perfect................................................................ 545 Using the future perfect..................................................................... 546

Chapter 7: Describing Your Mood: Summing Up the Subjunctive . . 549 Terms and Conditions: Unraveling Subjunctive Terminology................ 549 Getting in the mood............................................................................ 550 Comparing subjunctive types and the conditional........................ 550 The Present Subjunctive II: Knowing How and When to Use It.............. 551 Creating the present Subjunctive II with würde............................. 552 Forming the Subjunctive II of haben, sein, and modal verbs........ 553 Using the present Subjunctive II....................................................... 555 Forming and Using the Past Subjunctive II................................................ 557 Forming the past Subjunctive II........................................................ 557 Using the past Subjunctive II............................................................. 558 Two-timing the past subjunctive: Using double infinitives........... 559 Subjunctive I: Using It in Indirect Discourse............................................. 560 Recognizing the present Subjunctive I............................................. 560 Recognizing the past Subjunctive I................................................... 561

Book V: The Appendixes............................................. 563 Appendix A: Verb Tables and Case Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 565 Verb Conjugation Basics.............................................................................. 565 Present and simple past tenses........................................................ 565 Present perfect tense......................................................................... 566 Future tense......................................................................................... 567 Subjunctive mood............................................................................... 567

Table of Contents Conjugations of Weak Verbs....................................................................... 567 Regular verbs (no stem change in the simple past)....................... 567 Regular verbs (with stem ending in -d, -t, -fn, or -gn)..................... 568 Irregular weak verbs (stem change in the simple past)................ 568 Conjugations of Strong Verbs..................................................................... 569 Verbs with auxiliary haben................................................................ 569 Verbs with auxiliary sein................................................................... 569 Verbs with present-tense vowel change in second- and third-person singular............................................ 569 Conjugations of Separable-Prefix Verbs.................................................... 570 Conjugations of Inseparable-Prefix Verbs................................................. 570 Verbs with a past participle ending in -t.......................................... 570 Verbs with a past participle ending in -en....................................... 571 Conjugations of Auxiliary Verbs Haben, Sein, and Werden.................... 571 Conjugations of Modal Auxiliary Verbs..................................................... 572 Principal Parts of Strong and Irregular Weak Verbs................................ 574 Case Charts................................................................................................... 577 Articles................................................................................................. 577 Pronouns.............................................................................................. 579 Adjectives............................................................................................ 581 Prepositions........................................................................................ 583

Appendix B: German-English Mini-Dictionary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587 Appendix C: English-German Mini-Dictionary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 599 Appendix D: Fun & Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 611 Appendix E: About the CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 655 How to Use the CD........................................................................................ 655 Track Listing.................................................................................................. 656 Customer Care.............................................................................................. 658

Index........................................................................ 659

xxi

xxii

German All-in-One For Dummies

Introduction

S

tarting out on the journey of speaking another language and discovering a foreign culture is like opening a window to the world. By learning to speak German, you’re preparing yourself to communicate in the most widely spoken language of the European Union. Perhaps you’re getting ready for a business or pleasure trip to Europe, perhaps you’re studying German in school, or maybe you’re simply curious about exploring Germany and its culture, including its language. As you consider the plethora of language learning options out there, you’ll find methods that promise you’ll succeed in just a few easy steps, or better yet, while you’re sleeping. Other programs take a significant chunk out of your budget and your spare time yet still don’t deliver on their promises. This book lets you delve into the language at your own pace, and you can study the chapters in any order you want. Ample cross-referencing allows you to easily find any supporting information you need. Whatever your reasons for wanting to acquire some German, choosing German All-in-One For Dummies offers you a great opportunity to reach your goals.

About This Book With German All-in-One For Dummies, you find a wealth of resources in one volume. You get straightforward information on the nuts and bolts of understanding and using the language as it’s spoken today in German-speaking countries. You can go through the chapters in this book in any order you choose, zeroing in on your priorities. You can skim or, better yet, skip over the lessons you don’t need. Use the book to find answers to specific questions you may have on a topic that comes up while you’re learning to use the language. Without even realizing it, your German vocabulary expands as you cruise through the book. This book is chock-full of everyday phrases and words with pronunciation guidelines so you can practice the language right away. You find in-depth grammar explanations that answer your questions about how to build sentences in German. Throughout the book, you also get plenty of words, dialogues, and phrases related to specific situations you may come across in different settings. The appendixes offer more support in understanding grammar points, and the mini-dictionaries give you the translations of important words that appear in the book. The audio CD inside the back cover

2

German All-in-One For Dummies provides audio tracks of the German alphabet and listening practice for various dialogues in the book. (If you’re reading a digital version of this book, go to http://booksupport.wiley.com for the audio tracks.) Most importantly, as you go through this book, Viel Spaß! (feel shpahs!) (Have a lot of fun!)

Conventions Used in This Book To make your progress go as smoothly as possible, we use the following conventions in this book. They can help you spot essential elements in the text. ✓ We use boldface to highlight German words, example sentences, and the essential elements in verb tables, which may be information like verb endings or irregular conjugations. ✓ We italicize English translations that accompany German words and sentences. You’ll find them set in parentheses following the pronunciation of German terms or sentences. Within the German pronunciations, we italicize the syllables that are stressed in words with two or more syllables. Finally, we italicize English terms that we define. ✓ In some cases, German speakers use the same pronunciation as English speakers for words, many of which are borrowed from English or other languages. When such words are pronounced the same way in German as in English, you see the English word in the pronunciation followed by the notation “as in English” rather than the usual phonetic pronunciation. Of course, if the pronunciation differs between the English and the German, we include the German pronunciation as usual. ✓ Verb conjugations (lists that show you the forms of a verb) are given in tables in this order:

• The “I” form

• The “you” (singular, informal [or sing. inf.]) form

• The “you” (singular, formal [or sing. form.]) form

• The “he, she, it” form

• The “we” form

• The “you” (plural, informal [or pl. inf.]) form

• The “you” (plural, formal [or pl. form.]) form

• The “they” form

For example, here’s what the present-tense conjugation of the verb sein (to be) looks like:

Introduction sein (to be) ich bin

wir sind

du bist

ihr seid

er/sie/es ist

sie sind Sie sind

Sind Sie Herr Schumpich? (Are you Mr. Schumpich?) To help you make fast progress in German, this book includes a few elements to help you along: ✓ Talkin’ the Talk dialogues: The best way to learn a language is to see and hear how it’s used in conversation, so we include dialogues throughout Books I and II. The dialogues come under the heading “Talkin’ the Talk” and show you the German words, their pronunciations, and the English translations. For your listening and learning pleasure, we also include a number of these dialogues on the CD tucked into the back cover of your book. If you’re reading a digital version of this book, you can find the audio tracks at http://booksupport.wiley.com. ✓ Words to Know blackboards: Acquiring key words and phrases is also important in language learning, so we collect these important words in sections that resemble chalkboards, with the heading “Words to Know.” Note: In the pronunciations given in these sections, the stressed syllables are underlined rather than italicized. ✓ Fun & Games activities: If you want to flex your new language muscles, you can use the Fun & Games activities in Appendix D to reinforce what you learn. These activities are fun ways to check your progress. Also note that, because each language has its own ways of expressing ideas, the English translations that we provide for the German terms may not be exactly literal. We want you to know the essence of what’s being said, not just the meanings of single words. For example, the phrase Es geht (ês geyt) can be translated literally as It goes, but the phrase is actually the equivalent of So, so, or Okay, which is what you see as the translation.

Foolish Assumptions In writing German All-in-One For Dummies, we made the following assumptions about you, dear reader:

3

4

German All-in-One For Dummies ✓ You’re a German student looking for an in-depth, easy-to-use reference. ✓ You know very little or no German — or if you took German back in school, you remember very little of it. ✓ Your goal is to expand your knowledge of German. You don’t want to be burdened by long-winded explanations of unnecessary grammatical terms, nor do you care to hold a scholarly discussion in German about Goethe’s Faust. You just want to express yourself in clear and reasonably accurate German. ✓ You’re enthusiastic about having some fun while honing your German skills. If any or all of these statements describe you, then you’re ready to get started using this book. Willkommen! (vil-kom-en!) (Welcome!)

How This Book Is Organized This book is actually five books in one, each of which tackles a different aspect of German language acquisition. The following sections provide a brief description of what types of information you can find in each book.

Book I: Getting Started with German In this book, you acquaint yourself with the world of popular German phrases and pronunciations. You get a broad base in the language of meeting and greeting people and talking about yourself and others. One chapter deals with everyday topics such as talking about the weather. Another contains practical vocabulary and expressions you need for speaking in business situations and using telecommunications. In Book I, you also gain insight into the world of German news media. You get practice in the language you need for buying clothes and food, as well as the ins and outs of having a pleasant dining experience.

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Book II gets you up to speed on finding your way around in a German-speaking environment. You get practice in asking how to get somewhere and in understanding directions. You find useful input on the language you need for making reservations at a hotel, booking a trip, and going through airports. Book II also offers essential language for dealing with money matters like exchanging money

Introduction and going to an ATM. And just in case, this book rounds out with a primer on going to the doctor and handling emergencies.

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication In this book, you move onto the basics of grammar. You see the mysteries of gender and case unveiled, and you get an up-close look at the intricacies of combining nouns and pronouns with verbs. Here, you also find out how to construct sentences in the present tense, how to ask and answer questions, and how to agree and disagree. Book III delves into the finer points of expressing yourself using adjectives and adverbs. It shows you the six modal verbs that help you be polite, ask for help, and talk about what you can do, want to do, should do, or must do. Finally, you get the lowdown on how to make commands and how to use tricky two-part verbs.

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication This book helps you become acquainted with past and future verb tenses. You get a handle on the difference between the conversational past and the simple (narrative) past, and you see how to choose the correct verb form to express yourself in the future. Here, you find out how to express yourself using reflexive verbs and how to connect shorter ideas with conjunctions to build more complex sentences. You find out the intricacies of using prepositions in German. Finally, you discover how to express certainty and uncertainty and how to make wishes and requests using subjunctive verbs.

Book V: The Appendixes The five appendixes in this book provide an assortment of references to help you in expressing yourself confidently in German. The first appendix includes verb tables for conjugating verbs, as well as case-ending tables to help you use nouns, pronouns, and adjectives correctly. Appendixes B and C are two mini-dictionaries that allow you to find the meaning of a German word you don’t understand or the German equivalent of an English word. Appendix D is the Fun & Games activities section. The last appendix, E, is devoted to the CD element of this book. It contains the listing of audio tracks that appear as dialogues throughout the book.

5

6

German All-in-One For Dummies

Icons Used in This Book The following icons help you make the most of your journey through this book. You find them in the left-hand margin next to key points you don’t want to miss. Here’s what each icon means:

The Tip icon highlights helpful hints that’ll make it a whole lot easier for you to feel comfortable using German, whether you’re traveling abroad or just using it at home or in the workplace.

This icon alerts you to key information that’s worth revisiting. You want to stash this info in your mind because you’ll end up using it again and again. If you’re looking for information and advice about culture and travel, look for this icon. It draws your attention to interesting tidbits about the countries in which German is spoken. The audio CD that comes with this book gives you the opportunity to listen to real German speakers so you can get a better understanding of what German sounds like. This icon marks the Talkin’ the Talk dialogues in Books I and II that you can listen to on the CD. If you’re using a digital version of this book, go to http://booksupport.wiley.com to download the audio tracks. You can also access the audio tracks at www.dummies.com/go/germanaio.

Where to Go from Here For starters, try scanning the table of contents. Select a chapter that piques your interest and take it from there. Read the section in the chapter that presents a conversation in an everyday situation, a point of grammar, or some other information you want to know more about. Study the example dialogues and the details on forming useful language. You’ll soon discover what you know or don’t know, and when your curiosity is satisfied, flip back to the table of contents and find another chapter you’re ready to tackle. Whenever you feel like you’re losing steam, mach eine Pause (mâH ayn-e pou-ze) (take a break), close your eyes, and dream about die Romantische Straße (dee ro-mân-tish-e shtrah-se) (the Romantic Road — an enchanting route through some of the most picturesque parts of southern Germany). Before you know it, you’ll be dreaming of storybook castles and court jesters auf Deutsch (ouf doych) (in German)!

Book I

Getting Started with German

Visit www.dummies.com for free access to great Dummies content online.

Contents at a Glance Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Starting with What You Already Know...............................................................................9 Using Popular Expressions................................................................................................19 Handling Basic Pronunciation...........................................................................................21

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements . . . 31 Doing the Numbers..............................................................................................................32 Telling Time...........................................................................................................................38 Expressing Dates.................................................................................................................41 Measurements, Quantities, and Weights........................................................................49

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Getting Formal or Informal.................................................................................................53 Saying “Hello,” “Goodbye,” and “How Are You?”.........................................................54 Introducing Yourself and Your Friends.............................................................................59 Talking about Yourself........................................................................................................62 Discussing Cities, Countries, and Nationalities..............................................................67 Making Small Talk about the Weather.............................................................................73

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life . . . . 77 Describing Where You Live................................................................................................77 Talking about Family............................................................................................................83 Discussing Friends, Acquaintances, and Neighbors.....................................................87 Spending Time at Your Home or Someone Else’s..........................................................88 Playing Sports......................................................................................................................93

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Making a Phone Call...........................................................................................................97 Writing Your Message......................................................................................................105 Settling In at the Office.....................................................................................................109 Tuning In to Current Events..............................................................................................115

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Getting Familiar with the German Shopping Experience............................................119 Shopping for Clothes.........................................................................................................124 Making Your Purchase.....................................................................................................133

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! . . . . . . . . . . 137 Talking about Eating and Drinking..................................................................................138 Going to a Restaurant: Das Restaurant..........................................................................141 Checking Out the Menu: Die Speisekarte......................................................................147 Placing Your Order............................................................................................................152 Finishing Your Meal and Getting the Check..................................................................156 Shopping for Food..............................................................................................................159

Chapter 1

Warming Up to German Basics In This Chapter ▶ Recognizing the German you already know ▶ Spotting words that aren’t what they seem ▶ Understanding German pronunciation

T

he best way to learn a new language is to jump right in — no tiptoeing around. In this chapter, you get a head start in German by seeing bits of the language you’re already familiar with. You find out some popular German expressions, and you get the hang of why you need to be careful with words known as “false friends,” that is, words that seem to be the same in both languages but actually have different meanings. In the section on pronunciation, you familiarize yourself with the German alphabet and find out how to pronounce words so you can start to sound just like a native.

Starting with What You Already Know Because German and English are both Germanic languages, quite a few words are either identical or similar in the two languages. Words that share a common source are called cognates. Another group of words common to German and English stem from Latin-based words that English speakers are familiar with. Many of these words have direct equivalents in German (for example, nouns that end in -tion).

Friendly allies: Kindergarten and more (perfect cognates) The following words are spelled the same way and have the same meaning in German and in English. The only difference is the pronunciation, as shown in parentheses; in a few instances, the German and English pronunciation for the word is the same, so you see the English word in the pronunciation (followed by the notation “as in English”). The other quirk you may notice is that

10

Book I: Getting Started with German in German, nouns are always capitalized. In addition, German nouns have one of three genders, as noted in this list by the words der (masculine), die (feminine), and das (neuter) in front of each noun. See Chapter 2 in Book III for details on what gender is all about. ✓ der Arm (dêr ârm)

✓ liberal (lee-bêr-ahl)

✓ der Bandit (dêr bân-deet)

✓ der Mast (dêr mast)

✓ die Bank (dee bânk)

✓ die Mine (dee meen-e)

✓ die Basis (dee bah-zis)

✓ modern (moh-dêrn)

✓ blind (blint)

✓ der Moment (dêr moh-mênt)

✓ die Butter (dee boot-er) ✓ digital (di-gi-tâl) ✓ elegant (êl-ê-gânt) ✓ die Emotion (dee ê-mohtsee-ohn) ✓ emotional (ê-moh-tseeoh-nahl) ✓ der Export (dêr ex-port) ✓ der Finger (dêr fing-er) ✓ die Hand (dee hânt) ✓ das Hotel (dâs hotel [as in English]) ✓ die Immigration (dee im-i-grâ-tsee-ohn) ✓ der Import (dêr im-port) ✓ die Inflation (dee in-flâtsee-ohn) ✓ die Information (dee infor-mâ-tsee-ohn) ✓ die Inspiration (dee in-spi-râ-tsee-ohn) ✓ das Instrument (dâs in-stroo-mênt) ✓ international (in-ter-nâtsee-oh-nahl) ✓ irrational (ir-râ-tseeoh-nahl) ✓ legal (ley-gahl)

✓ die Motivation (dee moh-ti-vâ-tsee-ohn) ✓ das Museum (dâs mooh-zey-oohm) ✓ der Name (dêr nah-me) ✓ die Nation (dee nâ-t see-ohn) ✓ normal (nor-mahl) ✓ die Olive (dee oh-lee-ve) ✓ parallel (pâr-â-leyl) ✓ der Pilot (dêr pee-loht) ✓ der Professor (dêr professor [as in English]) ✓ das Radio (dâs rah-dee-oh) ✓ die Religion (dee rey-li-gee-ohn) ✓ das Restaurant (dâs rês-tuh-ron) ✓ die Rose (dee roh-ze) ✓ der Service (dêr ser-vis) ✓ das Signal (dâs zig-nahl) ✓ der Sport (dêr shport) ✓ die Statue (dee shtah-tooh-e) ✓ der Stress (dêr shtrês)

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics ✓ das System (dâs zers-teym)

✓ die Tradition (dee trâ-di-tsee-ohn)

✓ das Taxi (dâs tâx-ee)

✓ der Tunnel (dêr toohn-el)

✓ der Tiger (dêr tee-ger)

✓ wild (vilt)

✓ tolerant (to-lêr-ânt)

✓ der Wind (dêr vint)

Kissing cousins (near cognates) Many words, like the ones shown in Table 1-1, are spelled almost the same in German as in English and have the same meaning. Table 1-1 also shows you a few common German spelling conventions: ✓ The English c is a k in most German words. ✓ The ou in English words like house or mouse is often equivalent to au in German words. ✓ Many English adjectives ending in -ic or -ical have an -isch ending in German. ✓ Some English adjectives ending in -y are spelled with -ig in German. ✓ Some English nouns ending in -y have an -ie ending in German. ✓ Some English nouns ending in -ly have a -lich ending in German.

Table 1-1

Words Similar in Meaning but Slightly Different in Spelling

German

English

die Adresse (dee ah-drês-e)

address

der Aspekt (dêr âs-pêkt)

aspect

der Bär (dêr bear [as in English])

bear

blond (blont)

blond(e)

die Bluse (dee blooh-ze)

blouse

braun (brown [as in English])

brown

die Demokratie (dee dê-moh-krâ-tee)

democracy

direkt (di-rêkt)

direct

der Doktor (dêr dok-tohr)

doctor

exakt (êx-âkt)

exact (continued)

11 Book I Getting Started with German

12

Book I: Getting Started with German Table 1-1 (continued) German

English

exzellent (êx-tsel-ênt)

excellent

fantastisch (fân-tâs-tish)

fantastic

der Fisch (dêr fish)

fish

das Glas (dâs glahs)

glass

das Haus (dâs hous)

house

hungrig (hoong-riH)

hungry

indirekt (in-di-rêkt)

indirect

die Industrie (dee in-dooh-stree)

industry

die Infektion (dee in-fêk-tsee-ohn)

infection

das Insekt (dâs in-zêkt)

insect

der Kaffee (dêr kâf-ey)

coffee

das Knie (dâs knee)

knee

die Komödie (dee koh-mer-dee-e)

comedy

die Kondition (dee kon-di-tsee-ohn)

condition

konservativ (kon-sêr-vâ-teef)

conservative

der Kontinent (dêr kon-ti-nênt)

continent

das Konzert (dâs kon-tsêrt)

concert

die Kultur (dee kool-toohr)

culture

logisch (loh-gish)

logical

das Mandat (dâs mân-daht)

mandate

der Mann (dêr mân)

man

die Maschine (dee mâ-sheen-e)

machine

die Maus (dee mouse [as in English])

mouse

die Methode (dee mê-toh-de)

method

die Mobilität (dee moh-bi-li-tait)

mobility

die Musik (dee mooh-zeek)

music

die Nationalität (dee nât-see-oh-nahl-i-tait)

nationality

die Natur (dee nâ-toohr)

nature

offiziell (oh-fits-ee-êl)

official (adjective)

der Ozean (dêr oh-tsê-ân)

ocean

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics

13

German

English

Book I

das Papier (dâs pâ-peer)

paper

das Parlament (dâs pâr-lâ-mênt)

parliament

perfekt (pêr-fêkt)

perfect

Getting Started with German

politisch (poh-li-tish)

political

potenziell (po-tên-tsee-êl)

potential (adjective)

praktisch (prâk-tish)

practical

das Programm (dâs proh-grâm)

program

das Salz (dâs zâlts)

salt

der Scheck (dêr shêk)

check (bank or traveler’s)

sonnig (zon-iH)

sunny

der Supermarkt (dêr zooh-pêr-mârkt)

supermarket

das Telefon (dâs tê-le-fohn)

telephone

die Theorie (dee tey-ohr-ee)

theory

die Tragödie (dee trâ-ger-dee-e)

tragedy

die Walnuss (dee vahl-noohs)

walnut

False friends Like every language, German contains some false friends — words that look very similar to English but have a completely different meaning. As you read the following list, you can see why you have to treat any new German word with kid gloves, especially if it looks like an English word, until you find out for sure what it means in English: ✓ After (ahf-ter): If you want to avoid embarrassment, remember the meaning of this word. Its German meaning is anus, not after. The German word for after is nach (nahH) or nachdem (nahH-deym). ✓ aktuell (âk-tooh-êl): This word means up-to-date and current, not actual. The German translation for actual is tatsächlich (tât-sêH-liH). ✓ also (âl-zoh): This one means so, therefore, or thus, not also. The German word for also is auch (ouH). ✓ bald (bâlt): This word means soon. It isn’t a description for someone with little or no hair. The German word for bald is kahl (kahl) or glatzköpfig (glâts-kerpf-iH).

14

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ bekommen (be-kom-en): This verb is an important one to remember. It means to get, not to become. The German word for to become is werden (vêr-den). ✓ Boot (boht): This is a boat and not a boot, which is Stiefel (shteef-el) in German. A sailboat is called a Segelboot (zey-gêl-boht). ✓ brav (brahf): This word means well-behaved, not brave. The German word for brave is tapfer (tâp-fer). ✓ Brief (breef): This is a noun that means letter, not brief. The German translation for the English adjective brief is kurz (koorts), and for the English noun, Auftrag (ouf-trahk) or Unterlagen (oon-ter-lah-gen). ✓ Chef (shêf): This is the German word for a person you take orders from (in other words, your boss or supervisor), not someone who’s in charge of the cooking. The German word for chef is Küchenchef (kueH-ên-shêf) or Chefkoch (shêf-koH). Otherwise, a plain cook is called a Koch (koH) in German. ✓ eventuell (ey-vên-tooh-êl): This one means possible or possibly, not eventual or eventually, both of which would be schließlich (shlees-liH) in German. ✓ fast (fâst): This is an adjective that means almost — not the speeds at which Formula One drivers race. The German word for fast is schnell (shnêl) or rasch (râsh). ✓ genial (gê-nee-ahl): This adjective describes an idea or person of genius and has nothing to do with genial. The German word for genial is heiter (hay-ter). ✓ Gift (gift [as in English]): The German meaning is poison, so when you’re giving your German-speaking host a present, you should say you have a Geschenk (gê-shênk), that is, unless you really are giving something like weed killer or a green mamba. ✓ Handy (hân-dee): This is the German word for cellphone. The German equivalent of handy is praktisch (prâk-tish), geschickt (ge-shikt), or handlich (hânt-liH). ✓ Hut (hoot): This word means hat. The German word for hut is Hütte (hueH-tê). ✓ Kind (kint): This is the German word for child. It has nothing to do with the English kind, which is nett (nêt), lieb (leep), or liebenswürdig (leebens-vuerd-iH) in German. ✓ Komfort (kom-fohr): This word means amenity, for example, the amenities you expect in a five-star hotel, not comfort. The German verb meaning to comfort [someone] is trösten (trers-ten).

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics ✓ Kost (kost): This is the German word for food or fare. For example, the term Feinkost (fayn-kost) refers to gourmet food or a delicatessen where you can buy fine food products. The German word meaning to cost is kosten (kos-ten). ✓ kurios (koohr-ee-ohs): This word means strange, not curious. The German word for curious is neugierig (noy-geer-iH). ✓ Mist (mist [as in English]): Be careful not to misuse this word that actually means manure in German! It doesn’t describe heavy moisture resembling a fine rain, which is called Nebel (ney-bel) or Dunst (doonst). ✓ Mobbing (mobbing [as in English]): The meaning of this word is bullying or harassing. The German word for a mob is Pöbel (per-bel) or Rotte (rot-e), and the verb to mob (someone) is anpöbeln (ân-per-beln). ✓ Most (most): This is the German word for unfermented fruit juice, and in southern German-speaking regions, a young fruit wine. The German word for the English most is das meiste (dâs mays-te); for example, die meisten Leute (die mays-ten loy-te) (most people). ✓ Oldtimer (oldtimer [as in English]): Germans use this word to refer to a vintage car. An old man, like the kind you see in a rocking chair smoking a pipe is an alter Hase (âlt-er hâz-e), which actually means old rabbit. ✓ ordinär (or-di-nair): This word means vulgar rather than ordinary. The German word for ordinary is normal (nor-mahl) or gewöhnlich (ge-vern-liH). ✓ pathetisch (pâ-tey-tish): This one means overly emotional, not pathetic, which, in German, is jämmerlich (yêm-er-liH) or armselig (ârm-zey-liH). ✓ plump (ploomp): The German meaning is clumsy or tactless, not roundish, which in German is rundlich (roont-liH). ✓ Präservativ (prê-zêr-vah-teef): You can avoid another embarrassing moment when you remember that this word means condom in German. The German equivalent of preservative is Konservierungsmittel (kon-sêryeer-oongs-mit-el). ✓ Provision (proh-vi-zee-ohn): The meaning of this word is commission, not provision. The German word for provision is Vorsorge (fohr-zor-ge) or Versorgung (fêr-zohrg-oong). ✓ Rat (rât): This word means advice or counsel. In German, Ratte (rah-te) is the word for rat. ✓ Rock (rok): The meaning of this word is skirt. The German word for rock is Fels (fels). Germans do, however, use the word Rockmusik (rok moozeek) to refer to rock music.

15 Book I Getting Started with German

16

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ See (zey): This word means lake (der See) (deyr zey) or sea (die See, das Meer) (dee zey, dâs mêr). In German, the verb to see is sehen (zey-en). ✓ sensibel (zen-zee-bel): The meaning of this word is sensitive rather than sensible, which translates as vernünftig (fêr-nuenf-tiH). ✓ Smoking (smoking [as in English]): In German, this word means tuxedo or dinner jacket. The verb to smoke is rauchen (rouH-en). ✓ spenden (shpen-den): The German meaning is to donate, not to spend, which in German is ausgeben [money] (ous-gey-ben). ✓ sympathisch (zerm-pah-tish): This word means likeable or congenial, not sympathetic. The German word for sympathetic is mitfühlend (mit-fuelent) or verständnisvoll (fêr-shtênd-nis-fol). ✓ Taste (tahs-te): The meaning of this word is key, like the key of a musical instrument or a button on a computer or a machine. The German word for taste is Geschmack (ge-shmâk). The word for the item you use to lock or unlock a door is Schlüssel (shlues-el).

Lenders and borrowers A few German words have been adopted by the English language and have retained their meaning, such as Kindergarten (kin-der-gâr-ten), Angst (ânkst), kaputt (kâ-poot), Ersatz (êr-zats), Sauerkraut (zou-er-krout), Zeitgeist (tsayt-gayst), and Wanderlust (vân-der-loost). However, the number of these German words is minimal compared to the number of English words that have made their way into the German language. At times, the combination of English and German makes for somewhat curious linguistic oddities. For example, you may hear das ist total in/out (dâs ist toh-tahl in/out [as in English]) (that’s totally in/out) or Sie können den File downloaden (zee kern-en deyn file [as in English] doun-lohd-en) (You can download the file). The following is a list of German words that have been borrowed from the English language. Note that they all retain their English pronunciations, with one slight exception: The borrowed verbs are “Germanified,” which simply means they combine the English verb, such as kill or jog, with -en, the German suffix that creates the infinitive form (to kill and to jog). Go to Chapter 1 of Book III for more on German verbs and infinitive forms.

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics

17

✓ das Baby

✓ klicken (to click)

Book I

✓ der Boss

✓ managen (to manage)

Getting Started with German

✓ das Business ✓ das Catering ✓ die City (downtown) ✓ der Computer ✓ cool ✓ das Design ✓ das Event ✓ Fashion (used without article) ✓ das Fast Food ✓ das Feeling ✓ flirten (to flirt) ✓ der Headhunter ✓ Hi ✓ hip ✓ der Hit ✓ das Hotel ✓ das Internet ✓ das Interview ✓ der Jetlag ✓ der Job ✓ joggen (to jog) ✓ killen (to kill)

✓ der Manager ✓ das Marketing ✓ das Meeting ✓ Okay ✓ online ✓ outsourcen (to outsource) ✓ die Party ✓ pink ✓ das Shopping ✓ die Shorts ✓ die Show/Talkshow ✓ das Steak ✓ stoppen (to stop) ✓ surfen (to surf waves or the Internet) ✓ das Team ✓ der Thriller ✓ der Tourist ✓ der Trainer ✓ das T-Shirt ✓ der Workshop ✓ Wow

18

Book I: Getting Started with German

Talkin’ the Talk Read the following conversation with a grain of salt — and a smile. It gives you an idea of how many English words have slid into German. However, you’re not likely to overhear this many examples of mixed language in a single conversation. In this scenario, two friends, Claudia and Jana, meet on the street. Notice how some terms have a slightly different meaning in German. Claudia: Jana: Claudia:

Hi Jana, wie geht’s? Wie ist der neue Job? Hi [as in English] yâ-nâ, vee geyts? vee ist dêr noy-e job [as in English]? Hi Jana, how are you? How’s the new job? Super! Heute war meine erste Presentation vor meinem big Boss, und er war total cool. super [as in English]! hoy-te vahr mayn-e êrs-te prezen-tât-see-ohn fohr mayn-êm big boss [as in English], oont êr vahr toh-tahl cool [as in English]. Super! Today was my first presentation in front of my big boss, and he was totally cool. Wow! In meinem Office gibt es nur Stress. Mein Boss kann nichts managen. Mein Kollege checkt nichts, und denkt, er ist ein Sonnyboy, und alle anderen spinnen. wow [as in English]! in mayn-êm office [as in English] gipt ês noohr shtrês. mayn boss kân niHts mân-â-jen. mayn kol-ey-ge checkt niHts, oont dênkt, êr ist ayn sonny boy [as in English], oont âl-e ân-der-en spin-en. Wow! In my office there’s nothing but stress. My boss can’t manage anything. My colleague isn’t “with it,” and thinks he’s a hot shot, and all the others are crazy.

Ich gehe shoppen. Kommst du mit? Jana: iH gey-e shop-en. Komst dooh mit? I’m going shopping. Do you want to come along? Claudia:

Nein, danke. Gestern war ich in einem Outlet und habe ein T-Shirt in pink und eine Jeans im BoyfriendLook gekauft. Ich gehe jetzt joggen. Bye-bye!

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics nayn, dân-ke. gês-têrn vahr iH in ayn-em outlet [as in English] oont hah-be ayn T-shirt [as in English] in pink [as in English] oont ayn-e jeans [as in English] im boyfriend-look [as in English] ge-kouft. iH gey-e yêtst jog-en [jog as in English]. bye-bye [as in English]! No, thanks. Yesterday I went to an outlet and bought a pink T-shirt and a pair of jeans in boyfriend look. I’m going jogging now. Bye! Jana:

Schade. Bye-bye! shah-de. bye-bye! Too bad. Bye!

Using Popular Expressions Just like English, German has many idioms, or expressions typical of a language and culture. When you translate these idioms word for word, they may sound obscure, silly, or just plain meaningless, so to use them appropriately, you need to find out what they really mean. Some expressions have an English equivalent that’s recognizable, so using them correctly isn’t too hard. For example, the German idiom ein Fisch auf dem Trockenen (ayn fish ouf deym trok-ên-en) literally translates into a fish on the dry, which somewhat resembles the English a fish out of water. Other German expressions are a little harder to figure out. For instance, if you were to take apart the German expression Da liegt der Hund begraben (da leekt dêr hoont be-grah-ben) word for word, you’d probably feel sorry for the poor dog, because in essence, it means something like That’s where the dog is buried. However, the English equivalent is That’s the heart of the matter. A few other typical German idioms are Die Daumen drücken. (dee doum-en druek-en.) (Press the thumbs.) The English meaning is Keep your fingers crossed. Wo sich Fuchs und Hase gute Nacht sagen (voh ziH fooks oont hah-ze gooh-te nâHt zah-gen) (where fox and hare say good night to one another), which means in the middle of nowhere or in the sticks. Ich bin fix und fertig. (iH bin fix oont fêr-tiH.) (I’m quick and ready.) This means I’m wiped out or I’m exhausted. Du nimmst mich auf den Arm! (dooh nimst miH ouf deyn ârm!) (You’re taking me on your arm!) In English, this means You’re pulling my leg!

19 Book I Getting Started with German

20

Book I: Getting Started with German Das ist ein Katzensprung. (dâs ist ayn kâts-en-shproong.) (That’s a cat’s jump.) The English meaning is It’s a stone’s throw away. Schlafen wie ein Murmeltier. (shlâf-en vee ayn moor-mel-teer.) (Sleep like a woodchuck [marmot].) In English, you say Sleep like a log. Apart from such idioms, many handy and frequently used German expressions are easy to learn. Here are some of the most common ones: Prima!/Klasse!/Toll! (pree-mah!/klâs-e!/tôl!) (Great!) Fertig. (fêrt-iH.) (Ready./Finished.) This can be either a question or a statement. Genau. (ge-nou.) (Exactly./Precisely.) This can be used to tell someone that you really agree. Es tut mir leid. (ês toot mir layd.) (I’m sorry.) Use this when you apologize for something. Aber . . . (ah-ber) (But . . . ) Quatsch! (qvâch!) (Nonsense!/How silly of me!) Einverstanden. (ayn-fêr-shtând-en.) (Agreed./Okay.) Vielleicht. (fee-layHt.) (Maybe./Perhaps.) Eventuell. (ê-ven-too-êl.) (Maybe./Possibly.) You can use this alone or in a statement. Mach’s gut. (vîrt ge-mâHt.) (Take it easy.) This is a casual way of saying goodbye. Wie, bitte? (vee, bi-te?) ([I beg your] pardon?/What did you say?) Das macht nichts. (dâs mâHt niHts.) (Never mind./That’s okay.) Nicht der Rede wert. (niHt dêr rey-de vêrt.) (Don’t mention it.) Schade! (shah-de!) (Too bad!/What a pity!) So ein Pech! (zoh ayn pêH!) (Bad luck!) Viel Glück! (feel gluek!) (Good luck!) Oder?/Nicht? (oh-der?) (Isn’t that true?/Don’t you think so?) Bis dann! (bis dân!) (See you then!) Bis bald! (bis bâlt!) (See you soon!)

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics

Handling Basic Pronunciation Speaking a foreign language correctly is all about mastering the basics of pronunciation. The key to mastering pronunciation is to start small by figuring out how the individual letters sound. Then you can expand to syllables, words, and finally, sentences. The rest is practice, practice, practice.

Understanding stress in German This type of stress doesn’t have anything to do with meeting deadlines or having a BMW tailgate you at 110 miles per hour on the Autobahn. Instead, it’s about knowing which syllables to stress in German words. In the pronunciation key that you see in parentheses following each word, the syllables you should stress are in italics.

Constructing the alphabet blocks The German alphabet has all the letters that English does — 26 of ’em — plus four special letters: ä, ö, ü, and ß. The good news is that German words are generally pronounced just as they’re spelled, so things aren’t as confusing as they are in English with the likes of bow (tie), (take a) bow, and (tree) bough. The bad news is that many of the familiar letters are pronounced differently from their English counterparts. Table 1-2 shows you the sound of each letter of the alphabet when it’s pronounced alone. Knowing how to say each individual letter comes in handy, for example, when you need to spell your name to make a table reservation at a German restaurant, book a room with a hotel receptionist, or compete in a German spelling bee with a grand prize of 500,000 euros.

Track 1 gives you the sounds of the letters in the German alphabet as shown in Table 1-2. Note that the German pronunciation of a single letter may be different from the way you pronounce it within a German word.

21 Book I Getting Started with German

22

Book I: Getting Started with German Table 1-2

Pronouncing the German Alphabet

Letter

German Pronunciation

German Word

a

ah

Ahnen (ahn-en) (ancestors)

b

bey

Bild (bilt) (image, picture)

c

tsey

Café (kâ-fey) (café)

d

dey

durstig (doohrs-tiH) (thirsty)

e

ey

Ehe (ey-e) (marriage)

f

êf

Feuer (foy-er) (fire)

g

gey

geben (gey-ben) (give)

h

hah

Haus (house [as in English]) (house)

i

ee

ihn (een) (him)

j

yot

Januar (yahn-oo-âr) (January)

k

kah

Kilometer (ki-loh-mey-ter) (kilometer)

l

êl

Liebe (lee-be) (love)

m

êm

Manager (manager [as in English]) (manager)

n

ên

Name (nah-me) (name)

o

oh

ohne (oh-ne) (without)

p

pey

Pause (pou-ze) (break, intermission)

q

kooh

Quatsch (kvâch) (nonsense)

r

êr

rot (roht) (red)

s

ês

S-Bahn (es-bahn) (suburban train)

t

tey

Taxi (tâx-ee) (taxi)

u

ooh

U-Boot (ooh-boht) (submarine)

v

fou

Vogel (foh-gel) (bird)

w

veh

Wald (vâlt) (forest)

x

iks

Fax (fâx) (fax)

y

uep-si-lon

System (zers-teym) (system)

z

tset

Zeit (tsayt) (time)

ä

ah-oom-lout (Umlaut)

Bäcker (bêk-er) (baker)

ö

oh-oom-lout (Umlaut)

schön (shern) (beautiful)

ü

ooh-oom-lout (Umlaut)

Tür (tuer) (system)

ß

ês-tsêt

Straße (strah-se) (street)

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics

Pronouncing vowels

Book I

In German, vowels (a, e, i, o, and u) can generally be pronounced in two ways — as short or long vowel sounds. The short vowel sounds are “clipped,” meaning they’re pronounced shorter than their English equivalents. Long vowel sounds are “steady-state” or “pure,” meaning the sound quality doesn’t change even though it’s a long sound. Here are the basic rules: ✓ A vowel is long when it’s followed by the letter h, as in Stahl (shtahl) (steel) or ihn (een) (him). ✓ A vowel is generally long when it’s followed by a single consonant, as in Tag (tahk) (day). ✓ A vowel is long when it’s doubled, as in Teer (teyr) (tar) or Aal (ahl) (eel). ✓ The vowels a, e, and i sound long before a single consonant, as in beten (bey-ten) (to pray). ✓ In general, a vowel is short when followed by two or more consonants, as in Tanne (tân-e) (fir tree).

Table 1-3 shows you how to pronounce German vowels by providing some examples and the letter combinations that serve as the English equivalent of the German letter’s pronunciation (called the phonetic script). In this book’s phonetic script, two short vowel sounds have a little “hat” over the letter, so they look like this: â and ê. (Note that the phonetic spelling of ê in Table 1-3 is the same as that of the German short umlaut sound ä in Table 1-4.) Listen to Track 2 to hear how to pronounce these German vowels.

Table 1-3

23

Pronouncing German Vowels

German Letter

Phonetic Symbol

As in English

German Example

a (long)

ah

father

Bahnhof (bahn-hohf) (station)

a (short)

â

adore (clipped “a”)

Banner (bân-er) (banner)

e (long)

ey

vein

Leben (ley-ben) (life)

e (short/ stressed)

ê

bet (clipped “e”)

Bett (bêt) (bed)

e (short/ unstressed)

e

pocket

Lachen (lâH-en) (laughter) (continued)

Getting Started with German

24

Book I: Getting Started with German Table 1-3 (continued) German Letter

Phonetic Symbol

As in English

German Example

i (long)

ee

see

isoliert (eez-o-leert) (isolated)

i (short)

i

winter

Mitte (mit-e) (middle)

o (long)

oh

mope

Lob (lohp) (praise)

o (short)

o

gonna

Sonne (zon-e) (sun)

u (long)

ooh

moon

Grube (grooh-be) (pit)

u (short)

oo

push (clipped “u”)

muss (moos) (have to/must)

Pronouncing ä, ö, and ü

German has three extra vowels: ä, ö, and ü. The German word for those curious double dots over the vowels is Umlaut (oom-lout) (umlaut). Umlauts slightly alter the sound of the vowels a, o, and u, as outlined in Table 1-4. These sounds have no equivalent in English, so listen to them on Track 3 to find out how to pronounce them.

Table 1-4

Pronouncing Vowels with Umlauts

German Letter

Phonetic Symbol

As in English

German Example

ä (long)

ai

say (“ay” in “say” with spread lips)

nächste (naiH-ste) (next)

ä (short)

ê

bet (clipped “e”)

fällen (fêl-en) (to fell [a tree])

ö

er

her (without the “r” sound)

schön (shern) (pretty) (remember: no “r” sound)

ü

ue

lure (“ooh” with pursed lips)

Tür (tuer) (door)

To make your German vowels ä, ö, and ü sound a bit more authentic, try progressing through the ä, ö, and ü sounds, pronouncing the vowels as though you’re getting ready to kiss someone — in other words, round your lips and pucker up, baby! The ü sound is pronounced with very pursed lips.

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics

Pronouncing diphthongs

Diphthongs, which you can hear on Track 4, are combinations of two vowels in one syllable (as in the English “lie”). Table 1-5 lists the German diphthongs and shows you how to pronounce them.

Table 1-5

Pronouncing German Diphthongs

German Diphthong

Phonetic Symbol

As in English

German Example

ai/ei/ay

ay

cry

Mais (mays) (corn)/ein (ayn) (a)/Bayern (bay-ern) (Bavaria)

au

ou

loud

laut (lout) (noisy)

äu/eu

oy

boy

Häuser (hoy-zer) (houses)/Leute (loy-te) (people)

ie

ee

see

Miete (meet-e) (rent)

Both the long German vowel i and the German vowel combination ie are pronounced like the English letter e in see, but the German ei, ai, and ay are pronounced like the English letter y in cry.

Pronouncing consonants Ahh, relief! The sounds of German consonants are easier to master than the German vowel sounds. In fact, they’re pronounced either almost the same as their English equivalents or like other English consonants. Of course, you’ll find a couple of oddities and exceptions, but don’t worry. The following sections explain what you need to know.

Pronouncing f, h, k, m, n, p, t, x, and ß As part of a word, the letters f, h, k, m, n, p, t, and x are pronounced the same in German as they are in English. The letter ß, on the other hand, doesn’t exist in English. It’s kind of cool looking, though, don’t you think? But even if you don’t care about looks, you’ll be glad to know that you pronounce it just like ss or s. As far as the written language goes, whether a given German word is spelled with ss or ß depends on a couple of rules. Here’s the scoop: ✓ After a long vowel or a diphthong, the s sound is spelled ß — for example, Fuß (foohs) (foot). ✓ After a short vowel, the s sound is spelled ss — for example, Fass (fâs) (barrel).

25 Book I Getting Started with German

26

Book I: Getting Started with German Note: In Switzerland, the ß isn’t used at all. Instead, the Swiss always spell words with the double ss.

Table 1-6 tells you how to pronounce the rest of the German consonants by providing you with examples and a phonetic script. To hear them all, listen to Track 5.

Table 1-6

Pronouncing Selected German Consonants

German Letter

Phonetic Symbol

As in English

German Example

b* (end of a word or syllable or before voiceless consonants)

p

up

Abfahrt (âp-fahrt) (departure)

b

b

bright

Bild (bilt) (image, picture)

c (beginning of a word)

k

cat

Café (kâ-fey) (café)

c (mostly words of foreign origin)

ts

tsar

Celsius (tsêl-zee-oos) (Celsius)

c (mostly words of foreign origin)

ch

cello

Cello (chêl-oh) (cello)

d* (end of a word or syllable or before voiceless consonants)

t

moot

blind (blint) (blind)

d

d

do

Dunst (doonst) (mist, haze)

g

g

go

geben (gey-ben) (give)

g* (end of a word or syllable or before voiceless consonants)

k

lag

Tag (tahk) (day)

j

y

yes

ja (yah) (yes)

qu

kv

kv (pronounced together)

Quatsch (kvâch) (nonsense)

s (beginning of a word)

z

zoo

sieben (zee-ben) (seven)

s (middle/end of a word)

s

sit

Haus (house [as in English]) (house)

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics German Letter

Phonetic Symbol

As in English

German Example

Book I

v

f

fire

Vogel (foh-gel) (bird)

v (words of foreign origin)

v

velvet

Vase (vah-ze) (vase)

Getting Started with German

w

v

vice

Wald (vâlt) (forest)

y (mostly words of foreign origin)

y

yes

Yoga (yoh-gâ) (yoga)

y (mostly middle a of word)

er

her (without the “r” sound)

System (zers-teym) (system)

z

ts

ts as in tsunami

Zahl (tsahl) (number)

ß

s

guess

Straße (shtrah-se) (street)

*Note: When the letters b, d, and g are at the end of a word or syllable or before voiceless consonants like s or t, they change sounds. The b changes to a p sound, dchanges to t, and g changes to k.

Pronouncing the German r and l You pronounce the letters r and l differently in German than you do in English: ✓ To replicate the “gargled” pronunciation of the German r, try making a gargling sound before saying aahh, so you’re saying ra. Also, don’t roll the tip of your tongue or use it to pronounce the German r. ✓ To correctly pronounce the German letter l, you have to position your tongue differently than you do when you pronounce the English letter l. In English, you pronounce the l with your tongue in a spoon shape, hollowed out in the middle. To make the German l, you press the tip of your tongue against your gum ridge (just as you do in English), but you keep it flat instead of spoon-shaped. The German l sound is clipped, not drawled.

27

Listen to Track 6 to hear how to pronounce these letters. Here are some sample words:

✓ l as in Bild (bilt) (picture) ✓ r as in richtig (riH-tiH) (correct)

28

Book I: Getting Started with German

Pronouncing consonant combinations The German language has a few consonant sounds that are either different or don’t occur in English. Fortunately, most of them are easy to pronounce. The German letter combination ch is the trickiest one for English speakers to pronounce. There’s absolutely no equivalent for it in English (that’s why it’s represented by a capital H in this book’s phonetic script), and you actually have to learn a new sound — a kind of gentle “dry” gargling sound — in order to say it. The sound is a bit like trying to pronounce hch and not a k sound. The sound is similar to the guttural ch in Scottish, like in Loch Ness. The good news is that in a few words, the ch + s combo is simply pronounced as an x sound, for example in Wachs (vâks) (wax) or Fuchs (fooks) (fox). In a few other words (generally French foreign words), the ch is pronounced like the sound sh in English, for example in Champignon (shâm-peen-yon) (mushroom) or Champagner (shâm-pân-yer) (champagne).

Table 1-7 shows you how to pronounce the common consonant combinations of ch, ck, sch, sp, st, and tsch. Listen to Track 7 to hear how to pronounce these combinations.

Table 1-7

Pronouncing ch, ck, sch, sp, st, and tsch

German Letter

Phonetic Symbol

As in English

German Example

ch

H

Loch (Ness)

mich (miH) (me)

ck

k

check

Dreck (drêk) (dirt)

sch

sh

shut

Tisch (tish) (table)

sp (beginning of a word or a syllable)

shp

sh as in shut, p as in people

spät (shpait) (late)

st (beginning of a word or a syllable)

sht

sh as in shut, t as in table

Stadt (shtât) (city)

st (middle/end of a word)

st

stable

fast (fâst) (almost, nearly)

tsch

ch

switch

Deutsch (doych) (German)

Chapter 1: Warming Up to German Basics

The English th sound doesn’t exist in the German language. The th combination is pronounced one of two ways in German: ✓ The h is silent, as in the words Theorie (tey-oh-ree) (theory) and Theologie (tey-oh-loh-gee) (theology).

✓ The t and h are pronounced separately because they actually belong to different components of a compound noun, as in the words Gasthaus (gâst-hous) (inn), which is a combination of the German words for guest and house, or Basthut (bâst-hooht) (straw hat), a combo of the German words for raffia and hat.

29 Book I Getting Started with German

30

Book I: Getting Started with German

Chapter 2

Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements In This Chapter ▶ Naming numbers and counting ▶ Tackling time and the days of the week ▶ Managing months and calendars ▶ Getting familiar with metric measurements

I

n German-speaking countries, the servers in street cafés often walk around with a bulging black leather change purse either tucked in the back of the pants (the male version) or attached at the waist in front, neatly camouflaged under a starched white apron (the female version). When you say die Rechnung, bitte (dee rêH-noong bi-te), or its more informal version, Zahlen, bitte (tsahl-en bi-te) (the check, please), they have a crafty way of whipping the change purse out of hiding and opening it wide, ready for action. The next part is the best: watching the seasoned waiter take a quick look, add up the tab without pen and paper, and blurt out, “Das macht siebenundzwanzig Euro.” (dâs mâHt zee-ben-oont-tsvân-tsiH oy-roh.) (That’ll be twenty-seven euros.) That’s the moment of reckoning: How good are you at understanding numbers in German? In this chapter, you work with basic building blocks: numbers, dates, times, and measurements. If you feel confident that you can use these elements without any hesitation, you’re ready to feed the waiter’s portable cash wallet. You can also understand which Bahnsteig (bahn-shtayg) (track) the train is leaving from (and at what time) and jump on the correct train when there’s been a last-minute track change.

32

Book I: Getting Started with German

Doing the Numbers Chances are you’ll encounter German numbers in all kinds of situations: when you’re trying to decipher prices, for example, or street numbers, departure times, exchange rates, and so on. Knowing German numbers makes counting anything easy. (For money matters, such as changing currency and accessing funds, see Book II, Chapter 3.)

Counting off with cardinal numbers Cardinal numbers have nothing to do with religious numbers colored red or a songbird that can sing numbers. These numbers are just plain, unadulterated numbers like 25, 654, or 300,000. In this section, you get a list of cardinal numbers and details on the differences between German and English numbers.

It’s always good to start at the very beginning (as Julie Andrews pointed out in The Sound of Music), so here are the basic numbers and their German pronunciations. Listen to Track 8 to hear how to pronounce them:

✓ 0: null (nool) ✓ 1: eins (ayns) ✓ 2: zwei (tsvay) ✓ 3: drei (dray) ✓ 4: vier (feer) ✓ 5: fünf (fuenf) ✓ 6: sechs (zêks) ✓ 7: sieben (zee-ben) ✓ 8: acht (âHt) ✓ 9: neun (noyn) ✓ 10: zehn (tseyn) ✓ 11: elf (êlf) ✓ 12: zwölf (tsverlf) ✓ 13: dreizehn (dray-tseyn) ✓ 14: vierzehn (feer-tseyn) ✓ 15: fünfzehn (fuenf-tseyn)

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements

33

✓ 16: sechzehn (zêH-tseyn)

Book I

✓ 17: siebzehn (zeep-tseyn)

Getting Started with German

✓ 18: achtzehn (âHt-tseyn) ✓ 19: neunzehn (noyn-tseyn) ✓ 20: zwanzig (tsvân-tsiH) ✓ 21: einundzwanzig (ayn-oont-tsvân-tsiH) ✓ 22: zweiundzwanzig (tsvay-oont-tsvân-tsiH) ✓ 23: dreiundzwanzig (dray-oont-tsvân-tsiH) ✓ 24: vierundzwanzig (feer-oont-tsvân-tsiH) ✓ 25: fünfundzwanzig (fuenf-oont-tsvân-tsiH) ✓ 30: dreißig (dray-siH) ✓ 40: vierzig (feer-tsiH) ✓ 50: fünfzig (fuenf-tsiH) ✓ 60: sechzig (zêH-tsiH) ✓ 70: siebzig (zeep-tsiH) ✓ 80: achtzig (âHt-tsiH) ✓ 90: neunzig (noyn-tsiH) ✓ 100: hundert (hoon-dert) ✓ 101: hunderteins (hoon-dert-ayns) ✓ 102: hundertzwei (hoon-dert-tsvay) ✓ 103: hundertdrei (hoon-dert-dray) ✓ 104: hundertvier (hoon-dert-feer) ✓ 111: hundertelf (hoon-dert-êlf) ✓ 112: hundertzwölf (hoon-dert-tsverlf) ✓ 113: hundertdreizehn (hoon-dert-dray-tseyn) ✓ 114: hundertvierzehn (hoon-dert-feer-tseyn) ✓ 200: zweihundert (tsvay-hoon-dert) ✓ 300: dreihundert (dray-hoon-dert) ✓ 400: vierhundert (feer-hoon-dert) ✓ 500: fünfhundert (fuenf-hoon-dert)

34

Book I: Getting Started with German Notice that, as words, the numbers between 21 and 25 in the preceding list appear to be backward. Take the number 21, einundzwanzig, for example. In German, you actually say, “One and twenty.” Just remember to stick to this pattern for all the double-digit numbers, except for numbers in multiples of ten, like 30, 40, 50, and so on. Pay close attention to the number 30. Unlike the other multiples of ten (40, 50, and so on), 30 is spelled slightly differently. Dreißig has no z in its ending, whereas the other double-digits do (vierzig, fünfzig, and so on). When dealing with numbers made up of three digits, keep in mind that the last two digits in a three-digit sequence are spoken “backward.” So for a number like 679, you say “six hundred nine and seventy.” Check out the following examples of triple-digit numbers: ✓ 223 zweihundertdreiundzwanzig (tsvay-hoon-dert-dray-oont-tsvân-tsiH) (two hundred three and twenty) ✓ 548 fünfhundertachtundvierzig (fuenf-hoon-dert-âHt-oont-feer-tsiH) (five hundred eight and forty) ✓ 752 siebenhundertzweiundfünfzig (zee-ben-hoon-dert-tsvay-oontfuenf-tsiH) (seven hundred two and fifty)

Watching out for spelling and pronunciation changes Not surprisingly, German numbers have a few of their own oddities that keep native English speakers on their toes. Here are some of the most common spelling and pronunciation changes related to numbers that you need to be familiar with: ✓ When you use the number eins to describe one thing in a sentence, it changes spelling because, in these situations, eins is working as an adjective, and it’s the equivalent of using a or an. In German, adjectives go through all kinds of spelling changes in a sentence. (See Chapter 5 in Book III for more info on adjectives.) Consider this example: Er hat einen großen Hund. (êr hât ayn-en grohs-en hoont.) (He has a large dog.) ✓ In spoken German, people commonly pronounce the digit 2 as zwo (tsvoh) instead of zwei (tsvay). Doing so helps avoid the confusion — acoustically speaking — with drei (dray) (three). To double-check that you heard zwei and not drei in credit card numbers, prices, telephone numbers, room numbers, and so on, simply ask, or repeat the number(s) using zwo. Say, for example, Ich wiederhole vier-zwo-acht. (iH vee-derhoh-le feer-tsvoh-âHt.) (I’ll repeat four-two-eight.)

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements ✓ Especially in spoken German, you can use einhundert (ayn hoon-dert) (one hundred) in place of hundert (hoon-dert) (hundred). This change makes the number clearer to the listener. ✓ When referring to currency, you change the numerical value of the bill to a noun to talk about the bill itself. Imagine you’re cashing €400 in traveler’s checks and you want three €100 bills and five €20 bills. You say Ich möchte drei Hunderter und fünf Zwanziger. (iH merH-te dray hoondert-er oont fuenf tsvân-tsiH-er.) (I’d like three hundreds [euro bills] and five twenties.) The numbers Hunderter and Zwanziger are nouns, and you form them like this: Take the number, for example hundert, and add -er to the end of the number: hundert + -er = Hunderter.

✓ Germans often “spell” their phone numbers in pairs of numbers. If, for example, your number is 23 86 50, you say dreiundzwanzig sechsundachtzig fünfzig (dray-oont-tsvân-tsiH zêks-oont-âH-tsiH fuenf-tsiH). If you read the numbers one by one, you may say the number 2, or zwei (tsvay), pronounced as zwo (tsvoh), making 23 86 50 sound like zwo drei acht sechs fünf null (tsvoh dray âHt zeks fuenf nool). Numbers in groups of three, such as area codes, are usually read one by one. For example, the area code for München is 089, so you would say null acht neun (nool âHt noyn).

Thinking grand with large numbers and punctuating properly For numbers higher than 999, look at the following list. Notice that the decimal point in German numbers represents the comma in English: ✓ 1.000: tausend (tou-zent) or ein tausend (ayn tou-zent) (1,000) ✓ 1.000.000: Million (mee-lee-ohn) or eine Milllion (ayn-e mee-lee-ohn) (1,000,000) ✓ 1.650.000: eine Million sechshundertfünzigtausend (ayn-e mee-lee-ohn zêks hoon-dert fuenf-tsiH tou-zent) (1,650,000) ✓ 2.000.000: zwei Millionen (tsvay mee-lee-ohn-en) (2,000,000) ✓ 1.000.000.000: eine Milliarde (ayn-e mee-lee-ahr-de) (1,000,000,000; one billion) ✓ 2.000.000.000: zwei Milliarden (tsvay mee-lee-ahr-den) (2,000,000,000; two billion) ✓ 1.000.000.000.000: eine Billion (ayn-e bil-ee-ohn) (1,000,000,000,000; one trillion) In English, you use a comma to indicate thousands and a period to show decimals. German (and many other languages) does the reverse: It uses a period (Punkt) (poonkt) to indicate thousands and the comma (Komma) (ko-mâ) to work as a decimal point. Consider these examples:

35 Book I Getting Started with German

36

Book I: Getting Started with German 1 Zoll (ayn tsol) (one inch) = 2,54 Zentimeter (tsvay ko-mâ foonf feer tsen-ti-mey-ter) (two comma five four centimeters) 1 Zentimeter (ayn tsen-ti-mey-ter) (one centimeter) = 0,39 Zoll (noohl ko-mâ dray noyn tsol) (zero comma three nine inches) Mount Everest ist 8.848 Meter hoch. (mount everest [as in English] ist âHt-tou-zent âHt hoon-dert âHt-oont-feer-tsiH mey-ter hohH.) (Mount Everest is eight thousand eight hundred forty-eight meters high.) And this is how you say one of these numbers: 20,75 = zwanzig Komma sieben fünf (tsvân-tsiH ko-mâ zee-ben fuenf). The English equivalent has a decimal point in place of the comma in German, so you’d say the number as twenty point seven five.

Getting in line with ordinal numbers Ordinal numbers are the kinds of numbers that show what order things come in. You need ordinal numbers when you’re talking about das Datum (dâs dah-toom) (the date), die Feiertage (dee fay-er-tah-ge) (the holidays), die Stockwerke in einem Hotel (dee shtok-ver-ke in ayn-em hoh-tel) (the floors in a hotel), and stuff like that. Ordinal numbers function as adjectives, so they have the adjective endings you normally use in a sentence. (Go to Chapter 5 in Book III for specifics on adjectives.) The general rule for forming ordinal numbers is to add -te to the numbers 1 through 19 and then -ste to the numbers 20 and higher. For example, Nach der achten Tasse Kaffee, ist er am Schreibtisch eingeschlafen. (naH dêr âHt-en tah-se kâ-fey ist êr âm shrayp-tish ayn-ge-shlâf-en.) (After the eighth cup of coffee, he fell asleep on the desk.) This rule has four exceptions: ✓ erste (êrs-te) (first) ✓ dritte (dri-te) (third) ✓ siebte (zeep-te) (seventh) ✓ achte (âHt-e) (eighth) For example, Reinhold Messner war der erste Mensch, der Mount Everest ohne Sauerstoffmaske bestieg. (rayn-hold mês-ner vahr dêr êrs-te mênsh, dêr mount everest [as in English] oh-ne zou-er-shtof-mahs-ke be-shteeg.) (Reinhold Messner was the first person to climb Mt. Everest without an oxygen mask.)

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements Here are two other adjectives you need to know when putting things in order: letzte (lets-te) (last) and nächste (naiH-ste) (next). You can use them to refer to any sequence of numbers, people, or things. To write dates as numerals, write the digit followed by a period: Der 1. Mai ist ein Feiertag in Deutschland. (dêr êrs-te may ist ayn fay-er-tâg in doychlânt.) (May 1st is a holiday in Germany.) In case you’re wondering, the same sentence with a spelled-out date looks like this: Der erste Mai ist ein Feiertag in Deutschland. Look at the examples of ordinal numbers in Table 2-1. The first column shows the ordinal numbers as numerals, or digits, the second column shows the same ordinal numbers as words, and the third column shows how to say on the . . . fifth floor, sixth of December, and so on.

Table 2-1

Ordinal Numbers

Ordinals as Numerals

Ordinals as Words

On the . . .

1st

der erste (dêr êrs-te) (the first)

am ersten (âm êrs-ten) (on the first)

2nd

der zweite (dêr tsvay-te) (the second)

am zweiten (âm tsvay-ten) (on the second)

3rd

der dritte (dêr dri-te) (the third)

am dritten (âm dri-ten) (on the third)

4th

der vierte (dêr feer-te) (the fourth)

am vierten (âm feer-ten) (on the fourth)

5th

der fünfte (dêr fuenf-te) (the fifth)

am fünften (âm fuenf-ten) (on the fifth)

6th

der sechste (dêr zêks-te) (the sixth)

am sechsten (âm zêks-ten) (on the sixth)

7th

der siebte (dêr zeep-te) (the seventh)

am siebten (âm zeep-ten) (on the seventh)

18th

der achtzehnte (dêr âHt- tseyn -te) (the eighteenth)

am achtzehnten (âm âHttseyn-ten) (on the eighteenth)

22nd

der zweiundzwanzigste (dêr tsvay-oont-tsvân-tsiH-ste) (the twenty-second)

am zweiundzwanzigsten (âm tsvay-oont-tsvân-tsiHsten) (on the twenty-second)

37 Book I Getting Started with German

38

Book I: Getting Started with German Note: In Table 2-1, you see how to formulate the expression on the (first). It’s am (âm) + ordinal number + en (en). Am is the contraction of an (ân) (on) + dem (deym) (the); you form it by taking the preposition an, which uses the dative case here, plus dem, the masculine dative of der (dêr) (the). You need to show dative case agreement with the adjective erste (first), so you add -n: erste + n = ersten. (See Chapter 2 in Book IV for more on prepositions.)

Telling Time You’re in Interlaken, in der Schweiz (in-têr-lâ-ken in dêr shvayts) (Interlaken, in Switzerland) and you want to know what time it is. You have four choices: Look at your own watch; look at the nearest clock tower (most are absolutely stunning) and find out just how accurate the Swiss are in keeping time (very!); buy a Rolex for 1,399 Swiss francs (no euros in Switzerland); or practice understanding German clock time by asking someone on the street, Wie viel Uhr ist es? (vee feel oohr ist ês?) (What time is it?) You’re just about guaranteed whomever you ask will tell you the precise time. German speakers have two systems for telling time: one using the numbers 1–12 on a standard clock and one using a 24-hour format. They use the 12-hour system in casual conversation and the 24-hour system when they want to avoid any chance of misunderstanding. Unlike in the United States, Germans don’t use the a.m./p.m. system. When you need to ask someone for the time, you can use either one of the following two phrases: Wie viel Uhr ist es? (vee feel oohr ist ês?) (What time is it?) Wie spät ist es? (vee shpait ist ês?) (What time is it?)

To make your request for the time a little more polite, simply add the phrase Entschuldigen Sie, bitte (ênt-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te) (Excuse me, please) to the beginning of your question.

Using the 12-hour clock Many German speakers use the 12-hour clock format when talking casually. This system is one you’re already familiar with: You use the numbers 1 through 12 on a standard clock. However, German doesn’t have the expressions a.m. and p.m., so German speakers revert to the 24-hour format to avoid potential misunderstandings, for example, when discussing schedules and the like. (For more about the 24-hour system, head to the upcoming section.)

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements

39

On the hour

Book I

At the top of the hour, telling time is very easy. You just say

Getting Started with German

Es ist . . . Uhr. (ês ist . . . oohr.) (It’s . . . o’clock.) Of course, you include the number of the appropriate hour before the word Uhr. Note: You say Es ist ein Uhr (ês ist ayn oohr) (It’s one o’clock), not eins Uhr (ayns oohr). However, you can also say Es ist eins (ês ist ayns) (It’s one) and leave out the word Uhr (oohr) (o’clock).

Before and after the hour Indicating times like quarter past three, ten to eight, or half past eleven is a little more complicated, but you still need to know only three key expressions. To use the German word for quarter, you include Viertel (feer-tel) (quarter) plus the word nach (nâH) (past/after) or vor (fohr) (to/before) followed by the appropriate hour, as shown in these examples: Es ist Viertel nach. . . . (ês ist feer-tel nâH. . . .) (It’s quarter past. . . .) Es ist Viertel vor. . . . (ês ist feer-tel fohr. . . .) (It’s quarter to. . . .) Expressing the half hour isn’t quite as straightforward. In German, the word halb (hâlp) (half) indicates half of the hour to come rather than the past hour. You use the phrase Es ist halb. . . . (ês ist hâlp. . . .) (It’s half an hour before. . . .) followed by the appropriate hour. For example, when it’s 4:30, you say this: Es ist halb fünf. (ês ist hâlp fuenf.) (It’s half an hour before 5:00.)

A few minutes before or after When you need to break down the time in terms of minutes before or after the hour, you use nach (nâH) (past/after) and vor (fohr) (to/before), like this: Es ist fünf Minuten vor zwölf. (ês ist fuenf mi-nooh-ten fohr tsverlf.) (It’s five minutes to twelve.) Es ist zwanzig Minuten nach sechs. (ês ist tsvân-tsiH mi-nooh-ten nâH zêks.) (It’s twenty minutes past six.) If you’re looking for a shortcut, you can leave out the word Minuten. For example, you can say either Es ist fünf vor zwölf or Es ist fünf Minuten vor zwölf. Both phrases mean the same thing: It’s five [minutes] to twelve. The same goes for talking about the full hour. You don’t need to use the word Uhr. You can say either Es ist acht or Es ist acht Uhr. Both phrases mean It’s eight [o’clock.].

40

Book I: Getting Started with German

Using the 24-hour system Like the a.m./p.m. system, the 24-hour system prevents misunderstanding, which is why all kinds of German businesses — banks, stores, airlines, theaters, museums, cinemas, and so forth — use it to tell time. Here’s how the 24-hour system works: After you reach 12, you keep adding hours (13, 14, 15, and so on) until you get to 24 or Mitternacht (mit-er-nâHt) (midnight), which is also called null Uhr (nool oohr) (literally: zero hour).

Time tables are published using the 24-hour system, so it’s a good idea to become familiar with this format before heading off to Europe. In this system of telling time, you don’t use phrases like “half past” or “a quarter to” (the hour). Those expressions are only used for 12-hour time. With 24-hour time, everything is expressed in terms of minutes after the hour. Note in the following examples how the hour comes first, followed by the minutes: Es ist fünfzehn Uhr dreißig. (ês ist fuenf-tseyn oohr dray-siH.) (It’s fifteen hours and thirty.) This corresponds to 3:30 p.m. Es ist einundzwanzig Uhr fünfzehn. (ês ist ayn-oont-tsvân-tsiH oohr fuenf-tseyn.) (It’s twenty-one hours and fifteen.) That’s 9:15 p.m. Es ist zweiundzwanzig Uhr vierundvierzig. (ês ist tsvay-oont-tsvân-tsiH oohr feer-oont-feer-tsiH.) (It’s twenty-two hours and forty-four.) You got it — 10:44 p.m. Es ist null Uhr siebenundreißig. (ês ist nool oohr zee-ben-oont-dray-siH.) (It’s zero hours and thirty-seven.) That’s the early, early morning — 12:37 a.m.!

When writing the time numerically, German traditionally uses a period where English uses a colon. Note that when you read the time, you say Uhr (o’clock) where the period appears. Alternatively, you can leave out the Uhr, just as you can leave out the o’clock in English. For example, Um wie viel Uhr kommst du? Um sechs oder um sieben? (oom vee feel oohr komst dooh? oom zêks oh-der oom zee-ben?) (What time are you coming? At six or at seven?) Note also that the word Uhr in the question means the word time in English. You can also say Die Bank öffnet um 8.30 Uhr. (dee bank erf-net oom âHt oohr dray-siH.) (The bank opens at 8:30 a.m.)

Describing times of the day When you want to talk about a slice of the day, such as morning or afternoon, you have several options in German. However, take the following time periods

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements with a grain of salt; they’re meant as guidelines. After all, night owls and early morning joggers have different ideas about when one part of the day starts and another ends. ✓ der Morgen (dêr mor-gen) (morning; 4:00 a.m. to noon) ✓ der Vormittag (dêr fohr-mi-tahk) (morning; 9:00 a.m. to noon) ✓ der Mittag (dêr mi-tahk) (noon; 12 noon to 2:00 p.m.) ✓ der Nachmitag (dêr nâH-mi-tahk) (afternoon; 2:00 p.m. to 6:00 p.m.) ✓ der Abend (dêr ah-bent) (evening; 6:00 p.m. to 12:00 a.m.) ✓ die Nacht (dee nâHt) (night; 12:00 a.m. to 4:00 a.m.)

Expressing Dates To express dates correctly, you first need to know how to use die Tage der Woche (dee tah-ge dêr voH-e) (the days of the week), die Jahreszeiten (dee yahr-es-tsay-ten) (the seasons), and die Monate (dee moh-nâ-te) (the months) in your writing and speech. That way, you can clearly and correctly ask and answer Was ist das Datum? (vâs ist dâs dah-toom?) (What is the date?)

Recounting the days Looking at a German calendar, you find that the week, die Woche (dee woH-e), starts on a Monday. In addition, the days of the week are all the same gender — masculine (dêr) — but they’re generally used without an article. For example, if you want to say that today is Monday, you say Heute ist Montag. (hoy-te ist mohn-tahk.) Here are the days of the week followed by the abbreviations you often see on schedules: ✓ Montag (mohn-tahk) (Mo) (Monday)

✓ Dienstag (deens-tahk) (Di) (Tuesday)

✓ Mittwoch (mit-voH) (Mi) (Wednesday) ✓ Donnerstag (don-ers-tahk) (Do) (Thursday) ✓ Freitag (fray-tâk) (Fr) (Friday) ✓ Samstag/Sonnabend (zâms-tahk/zon-ah-bênt) (Sa) (Saturday) ✓ Sonntag (zon-tahk) (So) (Sunday)

41 Book I Getting Started with German

42

Book I: Getting Started with German

In northern Germany, Saturday is called Sonnabend, while people living in southern Germany, Austria, and German-speaking Switzerland use the term Samstag. To indicate that something always happens on a particular day of the week, you add an s to the word and lowercase it. For example, you may get to a museum or a restaurant on a Monday and find it closed, in which case you’re likely to see a sign on the door that says montags geschlossen (mohn-tahks ge-shlos-en) (closed on Mondays). Sometimes you want to be more casual in your references to days and use words like tomorrow or yesterday rather than the specific name of the day. Say it’s Tuesday and you want to confirm that you’ve planned to meet someone the next day. You can ask whether you’re meeting on Wednesday, or you can ask whether the meeting is tomorrow. The following list helps you refer to specific days without saying them by name:

✓ heute (hoy-te) (today) ✓ gestern (gês-tern) (yesterday) ✓ vorgestern (fohr-gês-tern) (the day before yesterday) ✓ morgen (mor-gen) (tomorrow) ✓ übermorgen (ue-ber-mor-gen) (the day after tomorrow) To speak precisely about a particular time on a specific day, you can combine the preceding words with the times of day discussed in the earlier section “Describing times of the day.” Try the following examples on for size: heute Morgen (hoy-te mor-gen) (this morning) heute Vormittag (hoy-te fohr-mi-tahk) (this morning) gestern Abend (gês-tern ah-bent) (yesterday evening/last night) The word morgen (mor-gen) shows up in two different versions. Written with a lowercase m, morgen means tomorrow. The noun der Morgen, written with an uppercase m, means morning. Theoretically, morgen Morgen should mean tomorrow morning, but German speakers don’t say that. Instead, they say morgen früh (mor-gen frue) (early tomorrow).

Knowing the names of the months and seasons When writing and speaking German, you need to have a firm grasp of the seasons and months because they’re part of dates, too. (The last thing you

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements want to do is invite someone to your July barbeque and tell him it’s in the winter.) The good news is that some of the months of the calendar year in German are quite similar to their English counterparts. The only caveat is that the pronunciation of the German months is a bit different from English. The following list shows you the names of the months. Although you don’t use an article when speaking generally about a particular month, all the months’ names are masculine, meaning that their article is der: ✓ Januar (yâ-noo-ahr) (January) or Jänner (yên-er) (January), which is often used in Austria ✓ Februar (fey-broo-ahr) (February) ✓ März (mêrts) (March) ✓ April (ah-pril) (April) ✓ Mai (may) (May) ✓ Juni (yooh-nee) (June) ✓ Juli (yooh-lee) (July) ✓ August (ou-goost) (August) ✓ September (zêp-têm-ber) (September) ✓ Oktober (ok-toh-ber) (October) ✓ November (no-vêm-ber) (November) ✓ Dezember (dey-tsêm-ber) (December)

Instead of saying Juni (yooh-nee) (June), some German speakers say Juno (yooh-noh) (June) to distinguish it, acoustically speaking, from Juli (yooh-lee) (July). The following sentences explain the basic calendar, der Kalender (der kâlên-der), in German: Ein Jahr hat 12 Monate. (ayn yahr hât tsverlf moh-nâ-te.) (A year has 12 months.) Ein Monat hat 30 oder 31 Tage. (ayn moh-nât hât dray-siH oh-der aynoont-dray-siH tah-ge.) (A month has 30 or 31 days.) Der Februar hat 28 oder 29 Tage. (dêr fey-broo-ahr hât âHt-oont-tsvântsiH oh-der noyn-oont-tsvân-tsiH tah-ge.) (February has 28 or 29 days.) Eine Woche hat 7 Tage. (ayn-e voH-e hât zee-ben tah-ge.) (A week has seven days.)

43 Book I Getting Started with German

44

Book I: Getting Started with German Here’s a look at the seasons, die Jahreszeiten (dee yahr-es-tsayt-en), in German: ✓ der Frühling (dêr frue-leeng) (the spring) or das Frühjahr (dâs frue-yahr) (the spring); these terms are interchangeable in German-speaking regions ✓ der Sommer (dêr zom-er) (the summer) ✓ der Herbst (dêr hêrpst) (the autumn) ✓ der Winter (dêr vin-ter) (the winter)

Writing dates the European way In German (and other European languages), you write dates in the order of day-month-year, such as in this sentence: Die Berliner Mauer ist am 09.11.1989 gefallen. (dee bêr-leen-er mou-er ist âm noyn-ten êlf-ten noyntseyn-hoon-dert-noyn-oont-âHt-tsiH ge-fâl-en.) (The Berlin Wall fell on 11/09/1989 or The Berlin Wall fell on November 9, 1989.) You need the periods in dates in German, just as you need to write the date in English with a slash between the month, day, and year. To write out the date with the words for the ordinal numbers, you’d write Die Berliner Mauer ist am neunten elften neunzehnhundertneunundachtzig gefallen. (dee bêr-leen-er mou-er ist âm noyn-ten-êlf-ten-noyn-tseyn-hoondert-noyn-oont-âHt-tsiH ge-fâl-en.) (The Berlin Wall fell on November 9, 1989.) Alternatively, you could say am neunten November (âm noyn-ten no-vêm-ber) (on the ninth of November). Those are the long versions. You often see or hear a shorter version. For example, you would write 14.10.2014, and you would say vierzehnter zehnter zweitausend vierzehn (feer-tseyn-ter tseyn-ter tsvay-tou-zênt feertseyn) ([the] 14th of October, 2014). Note the periods after the numerals (both the day and month are ordinals). If you want to find out what today’s date is, simply ask Welches Datum ist heute? (vêlH-es dah-toom ist hoy-te?) (What’s today’s date?) The answer will be one of the following: Heute ist der (achte April). (hoy-te ist dêr [aH-te ah-pril].) (Today is the [eighth of April].) Heute haben wir den (achten April). (hoy-te hah-ben veer deyn [aH-ten ah-pril].) (Today we have the [eighth of April].)

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements

45 Book I

Words to Know das Jahr

dâs yahr

year

der Monat

dêr moh-nât

month

die Woche

dee voH-e

week

der Tag

dêr tahk

day

das Datum

dâs dah-toom

date

der Kalender

dêr kâ-lên-der

calendar

You may hear the name of a year integrated into a sentence in one of two ways. The first, longer way uses the preposition im to create the phrase im Jahr . . . (im yahr) (in the year). The second, more common, and shorter way omits this phrase. The following sentences show you examples of both ways of talking about the year: Im Jahr 2010 arbeitete Herr Diebold in den USA. (im yahr tsvay-touzênt-tseyn âr-bay-te-te hêr dee-bolt in deyn ooh-ês-ah.) (In the year 2010, Mr. Diebold worked in the United States.) 2008 war er in Kanada. (tsvay-tou-zênt-âHt vâr êr in kâ-nâ-dâ.) (In 2008, he was in Canada.)

Referring to specific dates When you refer to the days of the week, seasons, and months, keep in mind the following rules: ✓ They’re all masculine, except for das Frühjahr (dâs frue-yahr) (the spring). ✓ When speaking or writing days of the week and months, you generally leave out the article der. However, some combinations with the dative prepositions an (on) and in (in) do include der in the dative form (see Book IV, Chapter 2 for more on prepositions). ✓ Seasons use the definite article.

Getting Started with German

46

Book I: Getting Started with German Take a look at the following examples, two of which include an and in with the article der: Gestern war Dienstag, heute ist Mittwoch, und morgen ist Donnerstag. (gês-tern vahr deens-tahk, hoy-te ist mit-voH, oont mor-gen ist don-ers-tahk.) (Yesterday was Tuesday, today is Wednesday, and tomorrow is Thursday.) The article der isn’t used; you’re referring to the name of the day of the week. Am kommenden Freitag fahre ich nach Flensburg. (âm kom-en-den fray-tahk fahr-e iH naH flêns-boorg.) (I’m driving to Flensburg this coming Friday.) An + dem = am; an is a dative preposition, and dem is the dative masculine article derived from der. The phrase am kommenden Freitag describes the specific Friday; it literally means on this coming Friday. Im Frühling gibt es viele Feiertage in Deutschland. (im frue-leeng gipt ês fee-le fay-er-tah-ge in doych-lânt.) (In [the] spring there are a lot of holidays in Germany.) In + dem = im; in is a dative preposition, and dem is the dative masculine article. You combine the name of the season or month with the preposition im (im) (in) when something takes place during a particular time. Warum trägst du Sommerkleidung bei herbstlichen Temperaturen? (vah-roohm trêgst dooh zom-er-klai-doong bay hêrpst-leeH-en têmp-er-âtoohr-en?) (Why are you wearing summer clothes during fall-like temperatures?) Bei is a dative preposition, so to form the dative plural ending with the adjective herbstlich (hêrpst-leeH) (fall-like), you add -en. Note: Sommerkleidung (zom-er-klai-doong) (summer clothes) is a combination of two nouns. Because the last word of any noun combination determines the gender, you have der Sommer + die Kleidung = die Sommerkleidung (dêr zom-er + dee klai-doong = dee zom-er-klai-doong). In the prepositional phrase bei herbstlichen Temperaturen (during fall-like temperatures), the preposition bei (bay) (during) takes the dative case, so the adjective herbstlichen (hêrpst-leeH-en) (fall-like) is in the dative plural.

Naming specific times in the months If you need to be more specific about a particular time of the month, the following phrases help narrow down the field: Anfang Januar (ân-fâng yân-oo-ahr) (in the beginning of January) Mitte Februar (mit-e fey-broo-ahr) (in the middle of February) Ende März (ên-de mêrts) (at the end of March)

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements Of course, you can substitute the name of any month after Anfang, Mitte, and Ende: Anfang April fliegen wir nach Berlin. (ân-fâng â-pril fleeg-en veer nahH bêr-leen.) (In the beginning of April, we’re flying to Berlin.) Ich werde Ende Mai verreisen. (iH vêr-de ên-de may fêr-ray-zen.) (I’ll go traveling at the end of May.) Herr Behr wird Mitte Februar in den Skiurlaub fahren. (hêr beyr virt mit-e fey-broo-ahr in deyn shee-oor-loup fahr-en.) (Mr. Behr is going on a skiing trip in the middle of February.)

Celebrating holidays People in German-speaking countries have a rich tradition of holidays that they celebrate throughout the year. In addition to the six weeks of paid vacation that most Germans enjoy, the country celebrates a number of Festtage (fêst-tah-ge) (festive days) and Feiertage (fay-er-tah-ge) (legal holidays) when people have the day off work. Some parts of Germany, Austria, and Switzerland have more legal holidays than others, but everyone has ample occasions to get together with family and friends to celebrate. Here are a few of the holidays that various German-speaking regions of Europe celebrate: ✓ Silvester (sil-vês-ter) (New Years Eve) and Neujahr (noy-yahr) (New Year’s Day) are celebrated mostly the same in German-speaking Europe as in other parts of the world. On Silvester, people join together for an elegant festive dinner or go to parties and spend the night dancing. To ring in the New Year, plenty of fireworks light up the sky. ✓ Carnival (kâr-ni-vâl) (carnival) or Mardi Gras (mardi gras [same as English]) (Mardi gras) season is one of the most popular celebrations that takes place in Germany, Austria, and German-speaking Switzerland. It has different names in different regions: Karneval (kâr-nê-vâl) in the German Rhineland, Fasching (fâsh-eeng) in Bavaria and Austria, and Fastnacht (fâst-nâHt) or Fastnet (fâst-nêt) in southwestern Germany and Switzerland. They all mean the same thing — a period of merrymaking, costume balls, parades, and generally crazy-fun days that precede the Lent period, which is when Catholics traditionally fast in preparation for Easter. Depending on the region, the festivities last anywhere from a few days up to several months. For the people of the Rhineland, Fastnacht begins each year on the 11th day of the 11th month at 11:11. The carnival season is jokingly referred to as die fünfte Jahreszeit (dee fuenf-te yahr-ês-tsayt) (the fifth season).

47 Book I Getting Started with German

48

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ Tag der Arbeit (tahk dêr âr-bayt) (Labor Day) takes place on the first of May in European countries. In ancient times, people held festivities to celebrate the beginning of spring on May 1. Nowadays, trade unions hold large public rallies to generate support for social reform. ✓ Jahrmarkt (yahr-mârkt) is one of several terms for a local annual fair held throughout German-speaking regions in late spring and summer. Depending on the region, other names for this type of fair are Kirmes (kêr-mês), Kerb (kêrb), and Dult (doolt). These annual fairs feature all kinds of regional food and drink specialties, rides, contests, booths, and live entertainment. Another general term for any kind of large celebration of this type is Volksfest (folks-fêst). In some areas, the annual celebration focuses on the founding of the local church and is called Kirchweih (kirH-vay), which means blessing of the church. ✓ Oktoberfest (ok-toh-ber-fêst) (Octoberfest) takes place in Munich, Germany, and is the largest Volksfest of its kind in the world. It’s 16 days of beer drinking accompanied by oompah music in enormous specially erected Bierzelte (beer-zêlt-e) (beer tents), each of which features one locally brewed beer. On a sunny weekend day, Oktoberfest-goers consume more than 1 million Maß Bier (mahs beer) (liter mugs of beer) and thousands of servings of Schweinshaxe (shvayns-hâx-e) (pork knuckle) and grilled Hähnchen (hain-Hen) (chicken). Other attractions at the Oktoberfest include enormous roller coasters, a traditional merry-goround, a hall of mirrors, and a real flea circus. ✓ Weihnachtsmarkt (vay-nâHts-mârkt) (Christmas market) is a four-weeklong market that many cities hold in their center, where people set up booths to sell Christmas ornaments, gift items, and seasonal specialties like Lebkuchen (leyb-koohH-en) (gingerbread) and Glühwein (glue-vayn) (hot mulled wine). ✓ Weihnachten (vay-nâHt-en) (Christmas) is one celebration that happens quietly at home. Many families carry on the tradition of lighting the Christmas tree with real candles on Allerheiligen (âl-er-hay-leegen) (Christmas Eve). Christmas Day, December 25, is an official holiday. Families serve a traditional, festive meal that, depending on the region, may include Gans (gâns) (goose), Karpfen (kârp-fen) (carp), or Würstchen mit Kartoffelsalat (wuerst-Hen mit kâr-tof-el-zâ-laht) (sausage with potato salad). The day after Christmas is also an official holiday. Germany, Austria, and Switzerland also have a few Nationalfeiertage (nâ-tseeoh-nahl-fay-er-tah-ge) (national days) with unique historical backgrounds: ✓ Der 3. Oktober (dêr drit-te ok-toh-ber) (October 3): Germany’s national day is officially called Tag der Deutschen Einheit (tahk dêr doych-en ayn-hayt) (Day of German Unity). It marks the day in 1990 when the German Democratic Republic ceased to exist and was officially united with the Federal Republic of Germany.

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements ✓ Der 26. Oktober (dêr zeHs-oont-tsvân-tsig-ste ok-toh-ber) (October 26): Austria’s national holiday commemorates the day in 1955 when Austria declared permanent neutrality after World War II and regained its status as an independent and sovereign nation. ✓ Der 1. August (dêr êrs-te ou-goost) (August 1): The national day of Switzerland dates back to 1291 when three cantons formed an historic alliance and the Swiss Confederation was founded.

Measurements, Quantities, and Weights You use the metric system in German-speaking countries, as well as most other countries around the globe. The various metric units crop up in all sorts of everyday situations, so familiarizing yourself with the various equivalents for units of length, weight, and capacity is definitely worth your time. Here are a few examples to get you in the metric mood: ✓ You buy milk by the Liter (lee-ter) (liter) rather than the quart. ✓ Speed limits are in Kilometer (kee-lo-mey-ter) (kilometers) per hour (1kilometer = 0.6 mile) rather than miles. ✓ A 2.2-pound sack of potatoes sells as a unit of 1 Kilo(gramm) (kee-loh[gram]) (kilo[gram]). Note: German speakers refer to 1,000 grams as either Kilo or Kilogramm, and neither one has an s in the plural form. If you want to buy some amount of something at a tantalizing open-air market, all you have to say is Ich hätte gern. . . . (iH hêt-e gêrn. . . .) (I would like to have. . . .) At the end of the phrase, simply say how much you want, which could include any of the following weights and measurements. Note that the plural forms for most of these measurements are the same as the singular form. ein/zwei Kilo (ayn/tsvay kee-loh) (1 kilogram/2 kilograms) (1 kilogram = 2.2 pounds) ein/zwei Pfund (ayn/tsvay pfoont) (1 pound/2 pounds) (1 metric pound = 500 grams) (In the U.S., a pound is 454 grams.) ein/einhundert Gramm (ayn/ayn-hoon-dêrt grâm) (1 gram/100 grams) ein/zwei Stück (ayn/tsvay shtuek) (one piece/two pieces) eine Scheibe/zwei Scheiben (ayn-e shay-be/tsvay shay-ben) (one slice/ two slices)

49 Book I Getting Started with German

50

Book I: Getting Started with German

Words to Know das Kilo

dâs kee-loh

kilogram

das Pfund

dâs pfoont

pound

das Gramm

dâs grâm

gram

wie viel

vee feel

how much

wie viele

vee fee-le

how many

Das wär’s.

dâs vêrs.

That’s it.

Was darf es sein?

vâs dârf ês zayn?

W hat would you like?

Sonst noch etwas?

zonst noH êt-vâs?

Anything else?

To specify exactly what you want, simply add the appropriate word to the end of the whole phrase. For example, if you want one Kilo of apples, you say Ich hätte gern ein Kilo Äpfel. (iH hêt-e gêrn ayn kee-loh êp-fel.) (I’d like to have one kilogram of apples.)

Talkin’ the Talk Frau Bauer buys all her produce at the open-air market. Today she needs apples and tomatoes. Looking at the various stands, she approaches one where she’s bought produce before and speaks to the Verkäuferin (saleswoman). (Track 9) Verkäuferin: Guten Tag. Was darf es sein? gooh-ten tahk. vâs dârf ês zayn? Hello. What would you like? Frau Bauer: Zwei Kilo Äpfel und ein Pfund Tomaten, bitte. tsvay kee-loh êp-fel oont ayn pfoont toh-mah-ten, bi-te. Two kilograms of apples and one pound of tomatoes, please.

Chapter 2: Handling Numbers, Times, Dates, and Measurements Verkäuferin: Sonst noch etwas? zonst noH êt-vâs? Anything else? Frau Bauer: Danke, das ist alles. dân-ke, dâs ist âl-ês. Thank you, that’s all. Next, Frau Bauer goes to a stand that sells dairy products. Frau Bauer: Ich hätte gern etwas von dem Gouda. iH hêt-e gêrn êt-vâs fon deym gou-dâ. I’d like to have some Gouda. Verkäuferin: Wie viel hätten Sie denn gern? vee-feel hêt-en zee dên gêrn? How much would you like? Frau Bauer: Zweihundert Gramm, bitte. tsvay-hoon-dert grâm, bi-te. Two hundred grams, please. Verkäuferin: Sonst noch etwas? zonst noH êt-vâs? Anything else? Frau Bauer: Nein, danke. Das wär’s. nayn, dân-ke. dâs vêrs. No, thank you. That’s it.

51 Book I Getting Started with German

52

Book I: Getting Started with German

Chapter 3

Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag! In This Chapter ▶ Addressing people formally or informally ▶ Greeting others and saying goodbye ▶ Talking about yourself and saying where you’re from ▶ Discussing the weather

G

reetings and introductions are your crucial first steps in establishing contact with other people and making a positive first impression. To that end, this chapter helps you determine whether to use formal or informal language in various situations. It also introduces the basic expressions of polite conversation: how to say hello and goodbye, how to ask and answer the universal question “How are you?,” and how to make introductions.

Engaging in small talk is one way to develop contacts and improve your German at the same time. Lucky for you, starting up a light and casual conversation isn’t too difficult. Whether you’re meeting somebody at a party or you want to talk to the person sitting next to you on the train, plane, or bus, you have several topics you can use as openers: yourself, your job, where you’re from, and of course, the weather. Throughout this chapter, you become familiar with discussing these topics.

Getting Formal or Informal German speakers generally place great value on showing respect toward each other and strangers. The language itself allows the speaker to make a clear distinction between formal and informal ways of saying you. (Once upon a time, English did this, too, but English speakers dropped the thee and thou forms long ago.) In German, you use either the formal Sie (zee) (you) or one of the two informal forms: du (dooh) (you), if you’re talking to one person, or ihr (eer) (you, you guys, you all), if you’re addressing two or more people.

54

Book I: Getting Started with German Making the distinction between the informal and formal you forms is important. Why? Because people are likely to consider you impolite and disrespectful if you use the informal way of addressing them in a situation that calls for more formality. In general, you use the formal Sie for everyday communication with people outside your circle of family and friends. Even among people who are in regular contact with one another (neighbors or coworkers, for example), Sie is often used as a means of showing respect. As you get to know somebody better, you may switch to du. However, no hard and fast rules apply when it comes to using du or Sie. In fact, many exceptions exist. For example, suppose a German friend takes you to a party. Even though you and the other guests are complete strangers, the other guests may just address you with du — especially if they’re easygoing — so you may address them with du as well. For more details on deciding when to use Sie, du, or ihr, go to Book III, Chapter 3.

If you’re the least bit unsure of whether to use du or Sie, use Sie until the person you’re addressing asks you to use du or addresses you with du.

Saying “Hello,” “Goodbye,” and “How Are You?” Getting your hellos and goodbyes straight in German is a matter of keeping in mind how well you know someone. If you’re on formal terms — in other words, if you’re addressing one or more people with Sie (zee) (you, formal) — then you have one set of expressions. When you’re on du (dooh) (you, informal) terms of address, you go with the more informal expressions.

Saying “Guten Tag” and “Auf Wiedersehen” The first part of your greeting is a basic hello. How you say hello depends on what time of day it is. The following list includes both the standard, formal expressions for saying hello and the more casual, informal expressions: Guten Morgen! (gooh-ten mor-gen!) (Good morning!) This is the standard, formal greeting you use in the morning (until about noon).

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag! Guten Tag! (gooh-ten tahk!) (Hello!) This is the most common formal greeting you use, except early in the morning and late in the day. Guten Abend! (gooh-ten ah-bent!) (Good evening!) Obviously, this is the formal greeting of choice in the evening. Hallo! (hâ-loh!) (Hello!) You should be pretty comfortable with this informal greeting because it’s very similar to English’s hello. When the time comes to part, you can say: Auf Wiedersehen! (ouf vee-der-zey-en!) (Goodbye!) This is the standard, formal goodbye. Gute Nacht! (gooh-te nâHt!) (Good night!) You use this standard, formal farewell when you say goodbye late at night. War nett, Sie kennenzulernen. (vahr nêt, zee kên-en-tsoo-lêrn-en.) (It was nice meeting you.) You use this formal phrase to tell people that you enjoyed meeting them for the first time. Tschüs! (chues!) (Bye!) This is the informal way of saying goodbye. People in Southern Germany, Austria, and German-speaking Switzerland certainly understand you when you wish them Guten Morgen/Guten Tag/Guten Abend (depending on the time of day). However, people in these regions also use some other greetings: ✓ In Switzerland, you hear Grüezi (grue-e-tsee) (hello) most often, and people who know each other well use salut (sâ-lue) to say both hi and bye. ✓ In Southern Germany and Austria, you say hello with Grüß Gott (grues got) or its informal version, Grüß dich (grues diH). Good friends express both hi and bye with the casual Servus (sêr-voohs). Especially among younger German speakers, you hear the informal goodbye, Ciao (chou), or the German-spelled version Tschau (chou), which has made its way north across the Alps from Italy.

Talkin’ the Talk In the next two conversations, people on a train are saying goodbye as the train comes into a station. In the first dialogue, Frau Stein is getting ready to exit the train. (Track 10) Frau Stein:

Das ist meine Station. War nett, Sie kennenzulernen, Frau Boch. dâs ist mayn-e shtâts-ee-ohn. vahr nêt, zee kên-en-tsoo-lêrn-en, frou boH. This is my stop. It was nice to meet you, Ms. Boch.

55 Book I Getting Started with German

56

Book I: Getting Started with German Ganz meinerseits. Auf Wiedersehen, Frau Stein. gânts mayn-er-zayts. ouf vee-der-zey-en, frou shtayn. And nice to meet you. Goodbye, Ms. Stein. Frau Boch:

Frau Stein: Auf Wiedersehen. ouf vee-der-zey-en. Goodbye. In this conversation, Hubert and Isgard are getting off the train as well, but before they do, they say goodbye to another passenger they met during their trip. Hubert und Isgard: Tschüs Ludwig. chues lood-vig Bye, Ludwig. Ludwig: Tschüs Isgard, tschüs Hubert. Schöne Ferien! chues is-gârd, chues hooh-bert. shern-e fê-ree-en! Bye Isgard, bye Hubert. Have a nice vacation!

Asking “Wie geht es Ihnen?” The next step after greeting someone in German is asking the question How are you? Whether you use the formal or the informal version of the question depends on whom you’re talking to. Sound complicated? Well, figuring out which form to use is easier than you may think. The following three versions of How are you? use three dative-case pronouns that represent you. Ihnen (een-en) is the dative equivalent of Sie, dir (deer) represents du, and euch (oyH) stands in for ihr. (See Book III, Chapter 2 for more information on personal pronouns in the dative case.) Here’s a breakdown of what to use when: Wie geht es Ihnen? (vee geyt ês een-en?) (How are you?) This is the formal version. Wie geht es dir? (vee geyt ês deer?) (How are you?) This is the informal, singular version.

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag! Wie geht’s? (vee geyts?) (How’s it going?) When you know someone really well, you can use this casual question. Wie geht es euch? (vee geyt ês oyH?) (How are you?) Use this when talking to several people informally. Greetings and introductions are often accompanied by some form of bodily contact. In Germany, Austria, and Switzerland, hand-shaking is the most common form of bodily contact during greetings and introductions. Female friends may kiss each other on the cheek or give each other a hug. Men usually don’t kiss or hug each other, although they may greet a woman friend with a hug (and a kiss). You may notice that people in Europe often stand closer to you than you’re used to, for example, in stores, on the bus or subway, or during conversations with you.

Giving a response to “Wie geht es Ihnen?” In English, the question How are you? is often just a way of saying hello, and no one raises an eyebrow if you don’t answer. In German, however, a reply is customary. Germans expect a reply because for the German speaker, asking “Wie geht es Ihnen?” isn’t the same as a casual hello but rather is a means of showing genuine interest in someone. The following are acceptable answers to the question Wie geht es Ihnen? (How are you?): Danke, gut. (dân-ke, gooht.) (Thanks, I’m fine.) or Gut, danke. (gooht, dân-ke.) (Fine, thanks.) Sehr gut. (zeyr gooht.) (Very good.) Ganz gut. (gânts gooht.) (Really good.) Es geht. (ês geyt.) (So, so.) This German expression actually means it goes. Nicht so gut. (niHt zoh gooht.) (Not so good.) As in English, you would usually accompany your reply with the question And (how are) you? Here’s the formal version: Und Ihnen? (oont een-en?) (And you?) Here’s how to pose the question informally: Und dir? (oont deer?) (And you?) (singular, informal you) Und euch? (oont oyH?) (And you?) (plural, informal you)

57 Book I Getting Started with German

58

Book I: Getting Started with German

Talkin’ the Talk In the following dialogue, you find some phrases that German speakers commonly use for greetings in a more formal setting. (Track 11) Herr Schulte: Guten Tag, Frau Berger! gooh-ten tahk, frou bêr-ger! Hello, Ms. Berger! Frau Berger: Herr Schulte, guten Tag! Wie geht es Ihnen? hêr shool-te, gooh-ten tahk! vee geyt ês een-en? Mr. Schulte, hello! How are you? Herr Schulte: Danke, gut! Und Ihnen? dân-ke, gooht! oont een-en? Thanks, I’m fine! And how are you? Frau Berger: Danke, gut. dân-ke, gooht. Thanks, I’m fine.

Talkin’ the Talk

Check out this dialogue between Mike and Christa, two old friends who run into each other on the street. (Track 12) Mike:

Hallo Christa! hâ-loh christa [as in English]! Hello Christa!

Christa:

Mike, hallo! Wie geht’s? mike [as in English], hâ-loh! vee geyts? Mike, hello! How’s it going?

Mike:

Danke, mir geht’s gut! Und selbst? dân-ke, meer geyts gooht! oont zêlpst? Thanks, I’m fine! And yourself?

Christa:

Auch gut. ouH gooht. I’m fine, too.

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag!

Introducing Yourself and Your Friends Meeting and greeting often require introductions. Your friends may want you to meet someone they know, or you may have to introduce your significant other to your colleague at a formal occasion. This section gives you the lowdown on how to do so.

Introducing your friends Commonplace, everyday introductions are easy to make. You start with Das ist . . . (dâs ist . . .) (This is . . .) Then you simply add the name of the person. Or if you’re introducing a friend, begin with Das ist eine Freundin von mir (female)/ein Freund von mir (male) . . . (dâs ist ayn-e froyn-din fon mir/ayn froynt fon mir . . .) (This is a friend of mine . . .) If you’re introduced to someone, you may want to indicate that you’re pleased to meet that person. In German, the casual way of responding to someone you’ve just met is to simply say Hallo (hâ-loh) (hello) or Guten Tag (gooh-ten tahk) (hello). If the introductions have been more formal, you express Nice to meet you by saying Freut mich. (froyt miH.) (Nice to meet you.) The person you have been introduced to may then reply by saying Mich auch. (miH ouH.) (Pleased to meet you, too.)

Making introductions for special occasions If you were to find yourself in a situation that calls for a high level of formality, you’d need to know the following introductory phrases: ✓ Darf ich Ihnen . . . vorstellen? (dârf iH een-en . . . fohr-shtêl-len?) (May I introduce you to. . . ?)

59 Book I Getting Started with German

60

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ Freut mich, Sie kennenzulernen. (froyt miH, zee kên-en-tsoo-lêrn-en.) (I’m pleased to meet you.) ✓ Meinerseits. (mayn-er-zayts.)/Ganz meinerseits. (gânts mayn-er-zayts.) (The pleasure is all mine. Literally: Mine or All mine.) Sometimes you need to use formal titles in your introduction. Herr (hêr) is the German word for Mr., and Frau (frou) expresses Mrs. The same word, die Frau (dee frou), also means woman, as well as wife, as in meine Frau (mayn-e frou) (my wife). No German equivalent for the English Ms. exists, so you need to use Frau. German also has the word Fräulein (froy-layn), which used to be the German version of Miss and was the proper way to address an unmarried woman. However, those days are long gone. So address a woman as Frau, regardless of her marital status. Or when in doubt, leave it out.

Talkin’ the Talk In this dialogue between the directors of two companies, listen to Herr Kramer and Herr Huber. They meet at an official function, and Herr Huber introduces his wife. Herr Kramer: Guten Abend, Herr Huber. gooh-ten ah-bent, hêr hooh-ber. Good evening, Mr. Huber. Herr Huber: Guten Abend, Herr Kramer. Darf ich Ihnen meine Frau vorstellen? gooh-ten ah-bent, hêr krah-mer. dârf iH een-en mayn-e frou fohr-shtêl-len? Good evening, Mr. Kramer. May I introduce my wife to you? Herr Kramer: Guten Abend, Frau Huber. Freut mich sehr, Sie kennenzulernen. gooh-ten ah-bent, frou hooh-ber. froyt miH zeyr, zee kên-en-tsoo-lêrn-en. Good evening, Mrs. Huber. Very nice to meet you. Frau Huber: Ganz meinerseits, Herr Kramer. gânts mayn-er-zayts, hêr krah-mer. And nice to meet you, Mr. Kramer.

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag!

61 Book I

Words to Know auch

ouH

also

gut

gooht

good

sehr

zeyr

very

freuen

froy-en

to be glad/pleased

kennenlernen

kên-en-lêrn-en

t o become acquainted with/to get to know

vorstellen

fohr-shtêl-len

to introduce

der Freund (m)

der froynt

friend

die Freundin (f)

dee froyn-din

friend

Introducing yourself You can’t always rely on someone else to introduce you. In such situations, you simply introduce yourself. Even in more formal settings, you can often introduce yourself simply by stating your name: Mein Name ist. . . . (mayn nah-me ist. . . .) (My name is. . . .) Or use the verb that expresses the same idea, heißen (hay-sen) (to be called): Ich heiße. . . . (iH hay-se. . . .) (My name is. . . .)

Talkin’ the Talk In the following conversation, Herr Hauser arrives at a meeting with several people he hasn’t been introduced to yet. He’s looking for a seat at the conference table. Herr Hauser: Guten Tag. Ist dieser Platz noch frei? gooh-ten tahk. îst dee-zer plâts noH fray? Hello. Is this seat still free?

Getting Started with German

62

Book I: Getting Started with German Frau Berger: Ja. Nehmen Sie doch bitte Platz. yah. ney-men zee doH bi-te plâts. Yes, it is. Do sit down. Herr Hauser: Vielen Dank. Mein Name ist Max Hauser. fee-len dânk. mayn nah-me ist mâx houz-er. Thank you very much. My name is Max Hauser. Frau Berger: Freut mich. Ich heiße Karin Berger. froyt miH. iH hay-se kah-rin bêr-ger. Pleased to meet you. I’m Karin Berger. The preceding conversation would sound very different among younger people meeting in an informal setting, like a party. They’d probably introduce each other like this: Martin:

Hallo, wie heißt du? hâ-loh, vee hayst dooh? Hello, what’s your name?

Susanne: Ich heiße Susanne. Und du? iH hay-se zooh-zân-e. oont dooh? My name is Susanne. And you? Martin:

Ich bin der Martin. Und wer ist das? iH bin dêr mâr-tin. oont vêr ist dâs? I’m Martin. And who is that?

Susanne:

Das ist meine Freundin Anne. dâs ist mayn-e froyn-din ân-e. This is my friend Anne.

Talking about Yourself When you talk about yourself to a new acquaintance, you often answer many of the same key questions: What kind of job do you do? Where do you work? Are you self-employed? Are you a student? Where do you live? Later on in a conversation, your acquaintance may ask for your address and phone number. Because you’ll encounter these topics often, you need to be prepared. The following sections provide you with the information you need.

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag!

Describing your work Say you start chatting with a guy you meet at a friend’s party. He may ask you what you do for a living. For example, he may ask any of the following: Bei welcher Firma arbeiten Sie? (bay vêlH-er fir-mâ âr-bay-ten zee?) (What company are you working for?) Was machen Sie beruflich? (vâs mâH-en zee be-roohf-liH?) (What kind of work do you do?) Sind Sie berufstätig? (zint zee be-roohfs-tê-tiH?) (Are you employed?) A few simple words and expressions help you describe your job and company. In most cases, you can describe what kind of work you do by connecting Ich bin . . . (iH bin . . .) (I am . . .) with the name of your occupation, without using any article. Most names for jobs exist in a female and male form. The male form frequently ends with -er; the female form usually ends with -in. Here are some examples: Ich bin Handelsvertreter (m)/Handelsvertreterin (f). (iH bin hân-delsfêr-trey-ter/hân-dels-fêr-trey-ter-in.) (I am a sales representative.) Ich bin Student (m)/Studentin (f). (iH bin shtoo-dênt/shtoo-dên-tin.) (I am a student.) If you’re a student, you may want to say what you’re studying. You do this with the phrase Ich studiere . . . (iH shtoo-dee-re . . .) (I am studying . . .). At the end of the sentence, you add the name of your field (without any article). Some fields you may use include the following: ✓ Architektur (âr-Hi-têk-toohr) (architecture) ✓ Betriebswirtschaft (be-treeps-virt-shâft) (business administration) ✓ Softwaretechnik (soft-wair-têH-nik) (software engineering) ✓ Kunst (koonst) (art) ✓ Literaturwissenschaft (li-te-rah-toohr-vis-en-shâft) (literature) ✓ Biochemie (bee-oh-Hey-mee) (biochemistry) You also can describe what you do with the phrase Ich bin . . . (iH bin . . .) (I am . . .). You end the phrase with an appropriate adjective. For example, you may say any of the following: Ich bin berufstätig/nicht berufstätig. (iH bin be-roohfs-tê-tiH/niHt be-roohfstê-tiH.) (I am employed/not employed.)

63 Book I Getting Started with German

64

Book I: Getting Started with German Ich bin pensioniert. (iH bin pân-zee-o-neert.) (I am retired.) Ich bin oft geschäftlich unterwegs. (iH bin oft ge-shêft-liH oon-ter-veyks.) (I often travel on business.) Ich bin selbständig. (iH bin zelpst-shtênd-iH.) (I am self-employed.) Your company name, place of work, or line of work may be almost as important as the actual work you do. The phrase Ich arbeite bei . . ./in . . . (iH ârbay-te bay . . ./in . . .) (I work at . . ./in . . .) tells someone, in a nutshell, where you earn your money. Consider these examples: Ich arbeite bei der Firma. . . . (iH âr-bay-te bay dêr fir-mâ. . . .) (I work at the company. . . .) After the word Firma, you simply insert the name of the company you work for. Ich arbeite in einem Krankenhaus. (iH âr-bay-te in ayn-em krânk-enhous.) (I work in a hospital.) Ich arbeite in der Gentechnik/in der Umweltforschung. (iH âr-bay-te in dêr geyn-teH-nik/in dêr oom-velt-fohrsh-oong. ) (I work in genetic engineering/in environmental research.) Ich arbeite in einem Architekturbüro/in einem Forschungslabor. (iH âr-bay-te in ayn-em âr-Hi-têk-toohr-bue-roh/in ayn-em forsh-oongs-lah-bor.) (Iwork at an architecture office/in a research lab.)

Providing names and numbers Telling people where you live and how they can reach you is the key to growing your social and business relationships. The following sections give you everything you need to know to offer your personal information to others.

A business card is worth a thousand words, especially if your German is a little shaky. So if someone asks you about your personal info and you have your business card with you, why not save yourself the struggle of saying your vital statistics and present your card instead? Just hand it over and say Hier ist meine Visitenkarte. (heer ist mayn-e vi-zeet-en-kâr-te.) (Here is my business card.) For detailed information on personal pronouns like mein (mayn) (my) and Ihr (eer) (your), go to Book III, Chapter 2.

Telling someone where you live When someone asks you Wo wohnen Sie? (voh vohn-en zee?) (Where do you live?), you can respond with any of the following:

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag! Ich wohne in Berlin/in einem Vorort von Berlin. (iH vohn-e in bêr-leen/ in ayn-em fohr-ort von bêr-leen.) (I live in Berlin/in a suburb of Berlin.) Simply insert the name of your city in this expression. Ich wohne in einer Kleinstadt/auf dem Land. (iH vohn-e in ayn-er klaynshtât/ouf deym lânt.) (I live in a small town/in the country.) Ich habe ein Haus/eine Wohnung. (iH hah-be ayn hous/ayn-e vohnoong.) (I have a house/an apartment.) Depending on the circumstances, someone may ask you Wie ist Ihre Adresse? (vee ist eer-e â-drês-e?) (What is your address?) When you want to get down to specifics on where you live, use the following words: ✓ die Adresse (dee â-drês-e) (address) ✓ die Straße (dee shtrah-se) (street) ✓ die Hausnummer (dee hous-noom-er) (house/building number) ✓ die Postleitzahl (dee post-layt-tsahl) (zip code) When you tell someone your address, substitute the appropriate word into the following sentence: Die Adresse/Straße/Hausnummer/Postleitzahl ist. . . . (dee â-drês-e/shtrah-se/hous-noom-er/post-layt-tsahl ist. . . .) (The address/ street/house number/zip code is. . . .)

German addresses place the house number after the street, and the zip code before the city, such as this address: Herr Peter Schmidt, Schulstraße 22, 07749 Jena, Deutschland.

Handing out your phone number and e-mail address If a new acquaintance asks you for your phone number and e-mail address, don’t worry. You can easily provide your contact information. Here’s what you say: Die Telefonnummer/die Handynummer/die Vorwahl/die Nebenstelle ist. . . . (dee tê-le-fohn-noom-er/dee hân-dee-noom-er/dee fohr-vahl/dee ney-ben-shtêl-e ist. . . .) (The telephone number/the cellphone number/the area code/the extension is. . . .) Meine E-mail Adresse ist . . . @ . . . dot com/net. (mayn-e e-mail [as in English] a-drês-e ist . . . at . . . dot com/net [as in English].) (My e-mail address is . . . at . . . dot com/net.)

65 Book I Getting Started with German

66

Book I: Getting Started with German

Talkin’ the Talk Kurt Hanser is on the plane from München to Frankfurt. His seat is next to Frau Schneider, a businesswoman. After the two have intro duced themselves, they talk about their jobs. (Track 13) Herr Hanser: Was machen Sie beruflich, wenn ich fragen darf? vâs mâH-en zee be-roohf-liH, vên iH frah-gen dârf? What kind of work do you do, if I may ask? Ich arbeite als Biochemikerin bei der Firma Agrolab. iH âr-bay-te âls bee-oh-Hê-mee-ker-in bay dêr fir-mâ â-groh-lâb. I work as a biochemist at a company called Agrolab. Frau Schneider:

Herr Hanser:

Das ist ja interessant. Haben Sie eine Visitenkarte? dâs ist yah in-te-re-sânt. hah-ben zee ayn-e vi-zeet-en-kâr-te? That’s interesting. Do you have a business card?

Frau Schneider: Ja, hier bitte. Und was machen Sie beruflich? yah, heer bi-te. oont vâs mâH-en zee be-roohf-liH? Yes, here it is. And what kind of work do you do? Ich arbeite in einem Architekturbüro. Leider habe ich meine Visitenkarte nicht dabei. iH âr-bay-te in ayn-em âr-Hi-têk-toohr-bue-roh. lay-der hah-be iH mayn-e vi-zeet-en-kâr-te niHt dâ-bay. I work at an architecture office. Unfortunately, Idon’t have my business card with me. Herr Hanser:

Frau Schneider: Ist Ihre Firma in Frankfurt? ist eer-e fir-mâ in frânk-foort? Is your company in Frankfurt? Ja, unser Büro ist in der Bockenheimer Straße 27. yah, oon-zer bue-roh ist in deyr bok-en-haym-er shtrah-se zee-ben-oont-tsvân-tsiH. Yes, our office is at Bockenheimer Street 27. Herr Hanser:

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag!

67 Book I

Words to Know fragen

frah-gen

to ask

geben

gey-ben

to give

dabei haben

dâ-bay hah-ben

to have on/with oneself

leider

lay-der

unfortunately

Discussing Cities, Countries, and Nationalities When you’re getting to know someone, at some point, the conversation will probably turn to familial origins. Using the handful of vocabulary words from this section, you can describe where you come from with confidence. You can also ask people where they come from and what languages they speak.

Saying where you come from Saying where you’re from in German is fairly easy. The magic words are Ich komme aus . . . (iH kom-e ous . . .) (I come from . . .) Ich bin aus . . . (iH bin ous . . .) (I am from . . .) These few words go a long way. They work for countries, states, and cities. Take a look at these examples: Ich komme aus Amerika. (iH kom-e ous â-mey-ree-kâ.) (I come from America.) Ich bin aus Pennsylvania. (iH bin ous pennsylvania [as in English].) (I am from Pennsylvania.) Ich komme aus Zürich. (iH kom-e ous tsue-riH.) (I come from Zurich.) Ich bin aus Wien. (iH bin ous veen.) (I am from Vienna.)

Getting Started with German

68

Book I: Getting Started with German The German language can be a bit challenging at times, so watch your step when discussing your origins. Here are a few specifics to be aware of: ✓ Some countries’ and regions’ names are considered plural. In this case, they use the plural definite article, die (dee) (the). The United States of America (USA) is one such country. In German, it’s referred to as die USA (dee ooh-ês-ah) or die Vereinigten Staaten (dee fer-ay-nikten shtah-ten). Saying Ich bin aus Amerika (iH bin ous â-mey-ree-kâ) (I’m from America) is easy; however, technically, you could be referring to one of two American continents. So to be a little more specific, you may say Ich bin aus den USA. (iH bin ous deyn ooh-ês-ah.) (I’m from the USA.) Or you may want to challenge yourself with Ich bin aus den Vereinigten Staaten. (iH bin ous deyn fer-ay-nik-ten shtah-ten.) (I’m from the United States.) ✓ Some countries’ names are considered female. Switzerland, for example, is die Schweiz (dee shvayts) in German. Ms. Egli, whom you meet later in this chapter in a Talkin’ the Talk dialogue, is Swiss. So to say where Ms. Egli is from, you say Frau Egli ist aus der Schweiz. (frou ey-glee ist ous dêr shvayts.) (Ms. Egli is from Switzerland.) The article die changes to the dative case — der — when it’s combined with the preposition aus (ous) (from). (See Book III, Chapter 2 for more info on the dative case.)

Asking people where they come from To ask people where they’re from, you first need to decide whether to use the formal term of address Sie or one of the two informal terms, du (for one person) or ihr (for several people). (For more information on when to use Sie, du, or ihr, turn to the section “Getting Formal or Informal.”) Then you choose one of these three versions of the question: Woher kommen Sie? (voh-hêr kom-en zee?) (Where are you from?) Woher kommst du? (voh-hêr komst doo?) (Where are you from?) Woher kommt ihr? (voh-hêr komt eer?) (Where are you [all] from?)

Talkin’ the Talk Frau Egli and Frau Myers are on a train. During their trip, they strike up a conversation. They have just introduced themselves and are curious to learn a little more about each other. Frau Egli:

Und woher kommen Sie, Frau Myers? oont voh-hêr kom-en zee, frou myers [as in English]? And where do you come from, Ms. Myers?

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag! Frau Myers: Ich komme aus den USA, aus Pennsylvania. IH kom-e ous deyn ooh-ês-ah, ous pennsylvania [as in English]. I come from the USA, from Pennsylvania. Frau Egli:

Aus den USA, wie interessant. Kommen Sie aus einer Großstadt? ous deyn ooh-ês-ah, vee in-te-re-sânt. kom-en zee ous ayn-er grohs-shtât? From the USA, how interesting. Do you come from a large city?

Frau Myers: Nein, ich komme aus Doylestown, eine Kleinstadt, aber es ist sehr schön. Und Sie, Frau Egli, woher kommen Sie? nayn, iH kom-e ous Doylestown [as in English], ayn-e klayn-shtat, ah-ber ês ist zeyr shern. oont zee, frou ey-glee, voh-hêr kom-ên zee? No, I come from Doylestown, a small town, but it’s very pretty. And you, Ms. Egli, where do you come from? Ich komme aus der Schweiz, aus Zürich. Frau Egli: iH kom-e ous dêr shvayts, ous tsue-riH. I’m from Switzerland, from Zurich. In the next compartment, Claire and Michelle, two young backpackers, are getting to know Mark, another backpacker. Being easygoing teenagers, they use the informal address du and ihr right from the start. Claire:

Kommst du aus Deutschland? komst dooh ous doych-lânt? Are you from Germany?

Mark:

Nein, ich komme aus Österreich, aus Wien. Und ihr, woher kommt ihr? nayn, iH kom-e ous er-ste-rayH, ous veen. oont eer, voh-hêr komt eer? No, I’m from Austria, from Vienna. And you, where do you come from?

Wir kommen aus Frankreich. Meine Freundin Claire kommt aus Lyon, und ich komme aus Avignon. veer kom-en ous frânk-rayH. mayn-e froyn-din claire [as in English] komt ous lee-on, oont iH kom-e ous ah-vee-nyon. We’re from France. My friend Claire comes from Lyon, and I come from Avignon. Michelle:

69 Book I Getting Started with German

70

Book I: Getting Started with German

Discovering nationalities Unlike English, which describes nationality by using the adjective of a country’s name (such as She is French), German indicates nationality with a noun. As you probably already know, genders are important in German, so it’s no surprise that these nationality nouns have genders, too. Consider these examples: ein Amerikaner (ayn â-mey-ree-kah-ner) (American man or boy) eine Amerikanerin (ayn-e â-mey-ree-kah-ner-in) (American woman or girl) You find more specifics on nouns and gender in Book III, Chapter 2. Table 3-1 lists the names of a few countries along with the corresponding nationality (a noun) and adjective.

Table 3-1

Country Names, Nouns, and Adjectives

Country in English

Country in German

Nationality (Noun)

Adjective

Belgium

Belgien (bêl-gee-ên)

Belgier(-in) (bêlgee-êr[-in])

belgisch (bêl-gish)

Germany

Deutschland (doych-lânt)

Deutsche(r) (doych-e[r])

deutsch (doych)

England

England (êng-lânt)

Engländer(in) (êng-lain-der[-in])

englisch (êng-lish)

France

Frankreich (frânk-rayH)

Franzose/ Französin (frântsoh-ze/frân-tserzin)

französisch (frân-tser-zish)

Italy

Italien (i-tah-lee-ên)

Italiener(in) (i-tahlee-eyn-er[-in])

italienisch (i-tahlee-eyn-ish)

Austria

Österreich (er-ste-rayH)

Österreicher(in) (er-ste-rayH-er[in])

österreichisch (er-ste-rayH-ish)

Switzerland

die Schweiz (dee shvayts)

Schweizer(in) (shvayts-er[-in])

schweizerisch (shvayts-er-ish)

USA

die USA (dee oohês-ah)

Amerikaner(in) (â-mey-ree-kahner[-in])

amerikanisch (â-mey-reekah-nish)

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag! Here are a few examples of how you may use these words in sentences: Herr Marsh ist Engländer. (hêr marsh [as in English] ist êng-lain-der.) (Mr. Marsh is English.) Maria ist Italienerin. (mah-ree-ah ist i-tah-lee-eyn-er-in.) (Maria is Italian.) Ich bin Schweizerin. (iH bin shvayts-er-in.) (I am Swiss.) In this example, a girl or a woman is speaking. Ich bin Österreicher. (iH bin er-ste-rayH-er.) (I am Austrian.) In this sentence, a boy or a man is speaking.

Chatting about languages you speak To tell people what language you speak, you use the verb sprechen (shprêH-en) (to speak) and combine it with the language’s name. If you want to ask somebody whether he speaks English, for example, the question is (informally): Sprichst du Englisch? (shpriHst dooh êng-lish?) (Do you speak English?) Here’s the formal version: Sprechen Sie Englisch? (shprêH-en zee êng-lish?) (Do you speak English?)

Talkin’ the Talk Claire, Michelle, and Mark are talking about languages they speak. Claire:

Sprichst du Französisch? shpriHst dooh frân-tser-zish? Do you speak French?

Mark:

Nein, überhaupt nicht. Aber ich spreche Englisch. Und ihr? nayn, ue-ber-houpt niHt. ah-ber iH shprêH-e êng-lish. oont eer? No, not at all. But I speak English. How about you?

Ich spreche ein bisschen Englisch, und ich spreche auch Spanisch. iH shprêH-e ayn bis-Hen êng-lish, oont iH shprêH-e ouH shpah-nish. I speak a little English, and I speak Spanish, too.

Michelle:

71 Book I Getting Started with German

72

Book I: Getting Started with German Claire:

Spanisch spreche ich nicht, aber ich spreche Englisch sehr gut. Englisch finde ich leicht. shpah-nish shprêH-e iH niHt, ah-ber iH shprêH-e ênglish zeyr gooht. êng-lish fin-de iH layHt. I don’t speak Spanish, but I speak English very well. Ithink English is easy.

Mark:

Deutsch ist auch leicht, oder? doych ist ouH layHt, oh-der? German is easy, too, isn’t it?

Claire:

Für mich nicht. Deutsch kann ich überhaupt nicht aussprechen! fuer miH niHt. doych kân iH ue-ber-houpt niHt ous-sprê-Hen! Not for me. I can’t pronounce German at all!

Words to Know leicht

layHt

easy/simple

groß

grohs

large/big

interessant

in-te-re-sânt

interesting

klein

klayn

small

schön

shern

pretty

aber

ah-ber

but

ein bisschen

ayn bis-Hen

a little (bit)

überhaupt nicht

ue-ber-houpt niHt

not at all

sein

zayn

to be

sprechen

shprêH-en

to speak

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag!

Making Small Talk about the Weather People everywhere love to talk about das Wetter (dâs vêt-er) (the weather). After all, it affects major aspects of life — your commute to work, your plans for outdoor activities, and sometimes even your mood. Plus, it’s always a safe topic of conversation that you can rant or rave about! You can ask about the weather with the question Wie ist das Wetter? (vee ist dâs vêt-er?) (What’s the weather like?) In the following sections, you get comfortable making small talk about the goings-on outside.

Noting what it’s like out there The phrase Es ist . . . (ês ist . . .) (It is . . .) helps you describe the weather no matter what the forecast looks like. You simply supply the appropriate adjective at the end of the sentence. Check out these examples: Es ist kalt. (ês ist kâlt.) (It is cold.) Es ist heiß. (ês ist hays.) (It is hot.) Es ist schön. (ês ist shern.) (It is beautiful.) The following vocabulary allows you to describe almost any kind of weather: ✓ bewölkt (be-verlkt) (cloudy) ✓ eiskalt (ays-kâlt) (freezing) ✓ feucht (foyHt) (humid) ✓ kühl (kuehl) (cool) ✓ neblig (neyb-liH) (foggy) ✓ regnerisch (reyk-ner-ish) (rainy) ✓ schwül (shvuel) (muggy) ✓ sonnig (son-iH) (sunny) ✓ warm (vârm) (warm) ✓ windig (vin-diH) (windy)

73 Book I Getting Started with German

74

Book I: Getting Started with German You can also use the following phrases to give your personal weather report: Die Sonne scheint. (dee son-e shaynt.) (The sun is shining.) Es regnet/schneit. (ês reyk-nêt/shnayt.) (It is raining/snowing.) Es gibt ein Unwetter. Es blitzt und donnert. (ês gipt ayn oon-vêt-er. ês blitst oont don-ert.) (There’s a storm. There’s lightning and thunder.) Es wird hell/dunkel. (ês virt hêl/doon-kel.) (It is getting light/dark.)

Discussing the temperature In the old country, 30-degree weather means you can break out your swimming gear, not your skis! In Europe (and most everywhere else in the world), the temperature is measured in degrees Celsius (tsêl-zee-oos) (also called Centigrade), not degrees Fahrenheit (as it is in the United States). If you want to convert Celsius to Fahrenheit or the other way around, just use these formulas: ✓ Celsius to Fahrenheit: Multiply the Celsius temperature by 1.8 and then add 32. ✓ Fahrenheit to Celsius: Subtract 32 from the Fahrenheit temperature and multiply the result by 0.5.

You may want to take note of the following conversions:

✓ 0 degrees Celsius = 32 degrees Fahrenheit ✓ 10 degrees Celsius = 50 degrees Fahrenheit ✓ 20 degrees Celsius = 68 degrees Fahrenheit ✓ 30 degrees Celsius = 86 degrees Fahrenheit When the temperature is the topic of conversation, the following phrases are sure to come up: Es ist zehn Grad. (ês ist tseyn graht.) (It’s ten degrees.) Of course, you substitute the appropriate number before the word Grad. (See Book I, Chapter 2 for more information on numbers.) Es ist minus zehn Grad. (ês ist mee-noos tseyn graht.) (It is minus ten degrees.) Again, substitute the proper number before Grad. Es ist zehn Grad unter Null. (ês ist tseyn graht oon-ter nool.) (It is ten degrees below zero.) Die Temperatur fällt/steigt. (dee têm-pê-rah-toohr fêlt/shtaykt.) (The temperature is falling/is rising.)

Chapter 3: Meeting and Greeting: Guten Tag!

Describing the day’s weather Any of the following phrases can get the ball rolling on a discussion of the weather: Was für ein herrliches/prächtiges Wetter! (vâs fuer ayn hêr-liH-ês/ praiH-tig-es vêt-er!) (What wonderful/glorious weather!) Was für ein schreckliches/schlechtes Wetter! (vâs fuer ayn shrêk-liH-ês/ shlêHt-ês vêt-er!) (What horrible/bad weather!) Was für ein schöner/herrlicher Tag! (vâs fuer ayn shern-er/hêr-liH-er tahk!) (What a beautiful/lovely day!)

Talkin’ the Talk Anita and Rolf live across the hall from each other in the same apartment building. They have been planning to go to the park this Sunday afternoon. On Sunday morning, Rolf knocks on Anita’s door to discuss their plans. (Go to www.dummies.com/go/ germanaio to listen to this bonus track.) Was machen wir jetzt? Bei so einem Wetter können wir nicht in den Park gehen. Es ist regnerisch und windig. vâs mâH-en veer yêtst? bay zoh ayn-em vêt-er kern-nen veer niHt in deyn pârk gey-en. ês ist reyk-ner-ish oont vin-diH. What do we do now? We can’t go to the park in this weather. It’s rainy and windy. Rolf:

Anita:

Ja, ja, ich weiß. Aber gegen Mittag soll es aufhören zu regnen. yah, yah, iH vays. ah-ber gey-gen mi-tahk zoll ês oufherr-en tsooh reyk-nen. Yeah, yeah, I know. But around noon it’s supposed to stop raining.

Rolf:

Wirklich? Ich sehe nur Wolken am Himmel . . . virk-liH? iH zey-he noohr vol-ken âm him-el . . . Really? I only see clouds in the sky . . .

Anita:

Keine Panik! Heute Mittag scheint bestimmt wieder die Sonne. kayn-e pah-nik! hoy-te mi-tahk shaynt be-stimmt veeder dee zon-e. Don’t panic! Surely the sun will shine again around noon today.

75 Book I Getting Started with German

76

Book I: Getting Started with German

Na gut. Vielleicht hast du recht. Ich kann bis Mittag warten. nâ gooht. vee-layHt hâst dooh rêHt. iH kân bis mi-tahk vâr-ten. Okay. Perhaps you’re right. I can wait until noon.

Anita:

Okay, bis später! Tschüs! okay [as in English], bis shpai-ter! chues! Okay, see you later! Bye!

Rolf:

Words to Know machen

mâH-en

to do

sehen

zey-hen

to see

wissen

vis-en

to know

recht haben

rêHt hah-ben

to be right

vielleicht

vee-layHt

perhaps

wirklich

virk-liH

really

bis später

bis shpai-ter

til later

Chapter 4

Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life In This Chapter ▶ Describing your home and everything in it ▶ Sharing info about your family and friends ▶ Talking about your daily routine and discussing your interest in sports

T

alking about where you live and describing your family are great ways to open the lines of communication to a new acquaintance. In this chapter, you go on a tour of the rooms in the home and discover useful information on German domestic lifestyles. You identify names of family members, including pets, and find out how to talk about them. Finally, you build your vocabulary with words that describe your daily routine at home as well as sports.

Describing Where You Live A far greater number of Germans live in apartments, either rented or owned, than do North Americans, and great value is placed on being able to own a single-family dwelling. Land and construction materials are very costly, so German living quarters tend to be smaller and more energy efficient than their North American counterparts. Typical homes in German-speaking regions are solidly built using materials such as bricks or concrete with stucco-coated walls and slate or clay tile roofs. More traditional homes are half-timbered, and some have thatched roofs. Homes often include a full basement that many Germans use for storage or as a work room. Windows in homes and apartments often have shutters that unroll vertically over the windows, shutting out all daylight when closed. Windows can be opened fully inward or tipped open a bit for air, and screens are rare. Air-conditioning and clothes dryers are quite uncommon. Smaller kitchens mean smaller appliances, so you’re unlikely to encounter massive, American-sized fridges.

78

Book I: Getting Started with German The following sections help you talk about your own living quarters — from what type of building you live in to the type of furniture and accessories you have in your living room.

Looking at your living quarters: Mein Haus Here’s some basic vocabulary you need to know to describe rooms in a home, along with a few other residence-related details: ✓ das Apartment (dâs â-pârt-ment) (studio, efficiency apartment)

✓ das Arbeitszimmer (dâs âr-bayts-tsi-mer) (workroom/study)

✓ das Bad/das Badezimmer (dâs baht/dâs bah-de-tsi-mer) (bathroom) ✓ der Balkon (dêr bâl-kon) (balcony) ✓ der Boden (dêr boh-den) (floor) ✓ der Dachboden (dêr dâH-boh-den) (attic) ✓ die Decke (dee dêk-e) (ceiling) ✓ die Eigentumswohnung (dee ay-gên-tooms-vohn-oong) (condominium) ✓ das Einfamilienhaus (dâs ayn-fâ-mi-lee-en-hous) (single-family home) ✓ das Esszimmer (dâs ês-tsi-mer) (dining room) ✓ das Fenster (dâs fêns-ter) (window) ✓ der Gang (dêr gâng) (hallway) ✓ die Garage (dee gâ-rah-je) (garage) ✓ der Garten (dêr gâr-ten) (yard/garden) ✓ der Keller (dêr kêl-er) (basement) ✓ die Küche (dee kueH-e) (kitchen) ✓ die Mietwohnung (dee meet-vohn-oong) (rented apartment) ✓ das Reihenhaus (dâs ray-ên-hous) (townhouse) ✓ das Schlafzimmer (dâs shlahf-tsi-mer) (bedroom) ✓ das Studentenwohnheim (dâs shtoo-dênt-en-vohn-haym) (student residence hall) ✓ das Studio (dâs shtooh-dee-oh) (studio/studio apartment) ✓ die Terrasse (dee têr-âs-e) (terrace)

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life

79

✓ die Treppe (dee trêp-e) (stairs)

Book I

✓ die Tür (dee tuer) (door)

Getting Started with German

✓ die Wand (dee vând) (wall) ✓ die Wohnung (dee vohn-oong) (apartment) ✓ das Wohnzimmer (dâs vohn-tsi-mer) (living room) ✓ das Zimmer (dâs tsi-mer) (room) When you want to tell people what type of place you live in, use the verb wohnen (vohn-en) (to live). Consider the following examples: Ich wohne in einer Eigentumswohnung. (iH vohn-e in ayn-er ayg-entooms-vohn-oong.) (I live in a condominium.) Wir wohnen in einem Einfamilienhaus. (veer vohn-en in ayn-em ayn-fâmee-lee-en-hous.) (We live in a single-family home.) Ich wohne mit meiner Frau in einem Reihenhaus. (iH vohn-e mit mayner frou in ayn-em ray-en-hous.) (I live with my wife in a townhouse.) Here are some ways you can describe your home: Wir haben einen großen Garten. (veer hah-ben ayn-en grohs-en gâr-ten.) (We have a large garden.) Das Haus hat drei Schlafzimmer. (dâs hous hât dray shlahf-tsi-mer.) (The house has three bedrooms.) Das Wohnzimmer ist sehr bequem. (dâs vohn-tsi-mer ist zeyr be-kveym.) (The living room is very comfortable.) Unsere Wohnung hat einen schönen Balkon. (oon-ser-e vohn-oong hât ayn-en shern-en bâl-kon.) (Our apartment has a nice balcony.)

Naming furnishings and appliances When you furnish your home, your personal style influences what you choose to include in each room. Germans take great pride in having a home that’s gemütlich (ge-muet-liH), a quintessential word that embodies the feeling of a place that’s cozy, comfortable, and homey. The following sections give you the basic vocabulary for home furnishings and other accessories you may find in the living room, bedroom, kitchen, and bathroom.

80

Book I: Getting Started with German Das Wohnzimmer: The living room The German-style Wohnzimmer (vohn-tsi-mer) (living room) is similar to what you’re familiar with in North America, although German living spaces tend to be smaller. So you’re unlikely to encounter mammoth sectional furniture and massive flat screen TVs. Instead, you often find a large wall unit, die Schrankwand (dee shrânk-vând), in the living room, which doubles as storage space and a place to display decorative or practical items. Here’s a list of other furnishings you typically find in a living room: ✓ die Couch (dee couch [as in English]) (couch) ✓ der Couchtisch/der Kaffeetisch (dêr kouch-tish/dêr kâf-e-tish) (coffee table) ✓ der Fernseher (dêr fêrn-zey-er) (TV) ✓ die Gardinen/die Vorhänge (dee gâr-deen-en/dee for-hêng-e) (curtains) ✓ die Lampe (dee lâm-pe) (lamp) ✓ der Sessel (dêr zês-el) (armchair) ✓ das Sofa (dâs sofa [as in English]) (sofa) ✓ die Stehlampe (dee shtey-lâm-pe) (floor lamp) ✓ die Stereoanlage (dee shtêr-ee-oh-ân-lâ-ge) (stereo) ✓ der Teppich (dêr têp-iH) (carpet/rug) ✓ der Teppichboden (dêr têp-iH-boh-den) (wall-to-wall carpet) Using these words, you can talk about your living room, as in these examples: In meinem Wohnzimmer gibt es zwei Sofas und einen Sessel. (in maynem vohn-tsi-mer gipt ês tsvay soh-fas oont ayn-en zês-el.) (In my living room there are two sofas and an armchair.) Unsere Familie sieht dort fern, besonders am Abend. (oon-zer-e fâ-meelee-e zeet dort fêrn, be-zon-dêrs âm ah-bent.) (Our family watches TV there, especially in the evening.) Die Couch ist sehr groß. (dee kouch ist zeyr grohs.) (The couch is very large.)

Das Schlafzimmer: The bedroom When you need a bit of privacy or you want to sleep, das Schlafzimmer (dâs shlahf-tsi-mer) (bedroom) is where you go. Germans are great fans of fresh air, and even in winter, they like to sleep with the window open and the bedroom door closed. If you’re wondering how they stay warm in a cold bedroom, well, the secret is a Federbett (fey-der-bêt) (down-filled comforter), which keeps them toasty warm, even when snow’s blowing in the window.

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life Here are some of the other furnishings you find in a Schlafzimmer: ✓ das Bett (dâs bêt) (bed) ✓ das Bettlaken (dâs bêt-lâk-en) (sheet)

✓ die Decke (dee dêk-e) (blanket)

✓ der Kleiderschrank (dêr klay-dêr-shrânk) ([clothes] closet) ✓ die Kommode (dee ko-moh-de) (dresser) ✓ das Kopfkissen (dâs kopf-kis-en) (pillow) ✓ der Nachttisch (dêr nâHt-tish) (nightstand) ✓ der Schrank (dêr shrânk) (closet) ✓ der Wecker (dêr vêk-er) (alarm clock)

Die Küche: The kitchen The heart of many homes is die Küche (dee kueH-e) (kitchen), where family and friends congregate while home-cooked meals are prepared. Here’s a list of what you may find in a typical Küche: ✓ der Backofen (dêr bâk-oh-fen) (oven) ✓ die Geschirrspülmaschine (dee ge-shir-shpuel-mâ-sheen-e) (dishwasher) ✓ der Herd (dêr hêrd) (stove) ✓ der Kühlschrank (dêr kuel-shrânk) (refrigerator) ✓ der Mikrowellenherd (dêr meek-roh-vêl-en-hêrd) (microwave oven) ✓ der Mülleimer (dêr muel-aym-er) (garbage can) ✓ das Regal (dâs rey-gahl) (shelf) ✓ der Schrank (dêr shrânk) (cabinet/cupboard) ✓ das Spülbecken (dâs shpuel-bêk-en) (sink) ✓ der Stuhl (dêr shtoohl) (chair) ✓ die Theke (dee tey-ke) (counter) ✓ das Tiefkühlfach (dâs teef-kuel-fâH) (freezer) ✓ der Tisch (dêr tish) (table) ✓ der Wasserhahn (dêr vâs-er-hahn) (faucet) German homes may or may not have a dining room, depending on how they’re designed. In cities where living space is at a premium, smaller apartments don’t have a dining room, so people eat in the kitchen, or even in the living room, where you may find der Esstisch (dêr ês-tish) (dining table). Another alternative to eating at a regular dining table in the dining room is die

81 Book I Getting Started with German

82

Book I: Getting Started with German Eckbank (dee êk-bânk) (corner bench). This neat, space-saving seating arrangement found in the kitchens of farmhouses and city apartments alike consists of a corner bench and a table that can accommodate four or more people in a relatively small space. The bench seats may even flip up, offering plenty of storage below the seat for kitchen items.

Das Badezimmer: The bathroom You may find yourself in an uncomfortable situation if you ask to use the Badezimmer (bad-e-tsi-mer) (bathroom), when what you’re probably looking for, believe it or not, is die Toilette (dee toy-lêt-e) (the toilet). What constitutes a “bathroom” in German homes differs from the definition you may be accustomed to. In Germany, the bathroom is a room where you can take a bath or shower, but it may or may not have a toilet. The toilet may be located in a separate room, euphemistically described in real-estate lingo as a halfbath. So to avoid any confusion, whatever the plumbing situation may be, here’s what you ask when you have to go: Darf ich ihre Toilette benutzen? (dârf iH eer-e toy-lêt-e be-noots-en?) (May I use the bathroom? Literally: May I use the toilet?) Here are some things you commonly find in a Badezimmer: ✓ die Badewanne (dee bahd-e-vân-e) (bathtub) ✓ die Dusche (dee dooh-she) (shower) ✓ die Haarbürste (dee hahr-buers-te) (hairbrush) ✓ der Kamm (dêr kâm) (comb) ✓ der Rasierapparat (dêr râ-zeer-âp-âr-aht) (razor) ✓ die Seife (dee zay-fe) (soap) ✓ der Spiegel (dêr spee-gel) (faucet) ✓ das Tuch (dâs toohH) (towel) ✓ das Waschbecken (dâs vâsh-bêk-en) (bathroom sink) ✓ die Zahnbürste (dee tsahn-buers-te) (toothbrush) ✓ die Zahnpaste (dee tsahn-pâs-te) (toothpaste) If you’re missing an item in the bathroom, either at somebody’s house or in a hotel room, use the following question starters to find it: Wo ist. . . ? (voh ist. . . ?) (Where is. . . ?) For example, Wo ist das Badetuch? (voh ist dâs bahd-e-toohH?) (Where is the bathtowel?) Haben Sie. . . ? (hah-ben zee. . . ?) (Do you have. . . ?) For example, Haben Sie Seife? (hah-ben zee zay-fe?) (Do you have soap?)

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life

Talking about Family In the United States, discussing family, die Familie (dee fâ-mee-lee-e), is a great way to get to know someone. Some people may even show off their photos of family members. However, talking at great length about little Gretchen and Hansi, Jr. is a far less popular pastime in Germany, perhaps because Germans place a lot of value on privacy. Even so, you need to know how to talk about family, just in case the topic ever comes up.

Naming your relatives The following list includes most, if not all, of the members of your family tree. Even if you don’t have kids or in-laws, get familiar with these words so you can recognize them when discussing someone else’s family (see Figure 4-1): ✓ der Bruder (dêr brooh-der) (brother) ✓ der Cousin (dêr kooh-zen) (male cousin) ✓ die Cousine (dee kooh-zeen-e) (female cousin) ✓ die Eltern (dee êl-tern) (parents) ✓ die Frau (dee frou) (woman/wife) ✓ die Geschwister (dee ge-shvis-ter) (siblings) ✓ die Großeltern (dee grohs-êl-tern) (grandparents) ✓ die Großmutter (dee grohs-moot-er) (grandmother) ✓ der Großvater (dêr grohs-fah-ter) (grandfather) ✓ der Junge (dêr yoong-e) (boy) ✓ die Kinder (dee kin-der) (children, kids) ✓ das Mädchen (dâs maid-Hên) (girl) ✓ der Mann (dêr mân) (man/husband) ✓ die Mutter (dee moot-er) (mother) ✓ der Onkel (dêr on-kel) (uncle) ✓ die Schwester (dee shvês-ter) (sister) ✓ der Sohn (dêr zohn) (son) ✓ die Tante (dee tân-te) (aunt) ✓ die Tochter (dee toH-ter) (daughter) ✓ der Vater (dêr fah-ter) (father)

83 Book I Getting Started with German

84

Book I: Getting Started with German

Figure 4-1: Who’s who in the family.

Illustration by Elizabeth Kurtzman

Use the following words for the in-laws: ✓ der Schwager (dêr shvah-ger) (brother-in-law) ✓ die Schwägerin (dee shvai-ger-in) (sister-in-law) ✓ die Schwiegereltern (dee shvee-ger-êl-tern) (parents-in-law) ✓ die Schwiegermutter (dee shvee-ger-moot-er) (mother-in-law) ✓ der Schwiegersohn (dêr shvee-ger-zohn) (son-in-law) ✓ die Schwiegertochter (dee shvee-ger-toH-ter) (daughter-in-law) ✓ der Schwiegervater (dêr shvee-ger-fah-ter) (father-in-law) To express the term step-, you use the prefix Stief- with the name of the relative, like in this example: Stiefbruder (steef-brooh-der) (step-brother). The term for a half relative uses the prefix Halb-, so half-sister looks like this: Halbschwester (hâlp-shvês-ter). German-speaking children use the following terms to talk about their parents and grandparents: ✓ die Mama (dee mâ-mâ) (mom) ✓ die Mutti (dee moot-ee) (mommy)

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life

85

✓ die Oma (dee oh-mâ) (grandma)

Book I

✓ der Opa (der oh-pâ) (grandpa)

Getting Started with German

✓ der Papa (dêr pâ-pâ) (dad) ✓ der Vati (dêr fâ-tee) (daddy) When directly addressing their elders, children leave out the articles dee (dee) (the) and der (dêr) (the). For example, Mama! Komm her! (mâ-mâ!! kom hêr!) (Mom! Come here!) To say that you have a certain type of relative, simply use the following phrase: Ich habe einen + masculine noun/eine + feminine noun/ein + neuter noun/(nothing before plurals). . . . (îH hah-be ayn-en/ayn-e/ayn. . . .) (I have a. . . .) The correct form of the indefinite article einen (masculine)/eine (feminine)/ ein (neuter) (ayn-en/ayn-e/ayn) (a) depends on both gender and case. In the preceding phrase, you’re using the accusative (direct object) case. The feminine and the neuter indefinite articles happen to be the same in the nominative (subject) case and the accusative (direct object) case, so their spelling doesn’t change. The masculine indefinite article, however, takes a different form in the accusative. (Flip to Book III, Chapter 2 for more details on articles, gender, and case.) So what do you do if you want to express that you don’t have any siblings, a dog, a house, or whatever it may be? In English, you would say, “I don’t have any siblings/a dog/a house.” In German, you just use the negative, accusative form of the indefinite article einen/eine/ein, which you form by adding the letter k to the beginning of the word: keinen/keine/kein (kayn-en/kayn-e/ kayn) (no). Look at the negative, accusative forms in the following sentences for some examples: ✓ Masculine nouns: Masculine nouns, such as der Schwiegervater, use keinen: Ich habe keinen Schwiegervater. (iH hah-be kayn-en shveeger-fah-ter.) (I don’t have a father-in-law.) ✓ Feminine nouns: Feminine nouns, such as die Familie, use keine: Ich habe keine große Familie. (iH hah-be kayn-e groh-se fâ-mi-lee-e.) (I don’t have a large family.) ✓ Neuter nouns: Neuter nouns, such as das Haus, use kein: Ich habe kein Haus. (iH hah-be kayn house.) (I don’t have a house.) ✓ Plural nouns: Nouns in their plural form or those that are always plural, like die Geschwister, use keine: Ich habe keine Geschwister. (iH hah-be kayn-e ge-shvis-ter.) (I don’t have any siblings.)

86

Book I: Getting Started with German

Family pets Some families have other members besides the two-legged variety. In fact, Haustiere (hous-teer-e) (house pets) play an important role in many households. The following list includes the typical animals that Germans have as pets: ✓ der Fisch (dêr fish) (fish) ✓ der Goldfisch (dêr goldfish [as in English]) (goldfish) ✓ der Hund (dêr hoont) (dog) ✓ das Kaninchen (dâs kân-een-Hen) (rabbit) ✓ die Katze (dee kâts-e) (cat) ✓ das Meerschweinchen (dâs meyr-shvayn-Hen) (guinea pig)

✓ der Vogel (dêr foh-gel) (bird)

✓ der Wellensittich (dêr vêl-en-zit-iH) (parakeet) Here’s a list of some activities you may do with your pet: ✓ den Hund spazieren führen (deyn hoont shpâts-eer-en fuer-en) (to take the dog for a walk) ✓ den Hund anleinen (deyn hoont ân-layn-en) (to put a leash on the dog) ✓ mit dem Hund spielen (mit deym hoont spee-len) (to play with the dog) ✓ die Katze futtern (dee kât-se foot-ern) (to feed the cat) In Germany, Hunde (hoon-de) (dogs) are such beloved family members that, in some restaurants, they’re allowed to sit under their master’s table, provided they stay there.

Talkin’ the Talk Herr Hanser and Frau Schneider have just met at a symposium in Frankfurt. They’re talking about their families during a coffee break. (Track 14) Herr Hanser:

Wohnen Sie in Frankfurt? vohn-en zee in frânk-foort? Do you live in Frankfurt?

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life Nicht direkt. Mein Mann und ich haben ein Reihenhaus in Mühlheim. Und Sie? niHt dee-rêkt. mayn mahn oont iH hah-ben ayn ray-ên-hous in muel-haym. oont zee? Not exactly. My husband and I have a townhouse in Mühlheim. And you? Frau Schneider:

Wir haben eine Wohnung in der Innenstadt, aber unser Sohn wohnt in München. Haben Sie Kinder? veer hah-ben ayn-e vohn-oong in dêr in-enshtât, ah-ber oon-zer zohn vohnt in muen-Hen. hah-ben zee kin-der? We have an apartment in the center of the city, but our son lives in Munich. Do you have any kids? Herr Hanser:

Ja, zwei Kinder. Mein Sohn Andreas arbeitet bei Siemens, und meine Tochter Claudia wohnt mit ihrem Mann in Italien. yah, tsvay kin-der. mayn zohn ân-drey-âs âr-baytet bay zee-mens, oont mayn-e toH-ter klou-deeâ vohnt mit eer-em mân in i-tah-lee-en. Yes, two children. My son Andreas works at Siemens, and my daughter Claudia lives with her husband in Italy. Frau Schneider:

Ach, meine Frau kommt aus Italien, aber ihre Eltern und ihre vier Geschwister wohnen alle in Deutschland. âH, mayn-e frou komt ous i-tah-lee-en, ah-ber eer-e êl-tern oont eer-e feer ge-shvis-ter vohn-en âl-e în doych-lânt. Oh, my wife is from Italy, but her parents and her four siblings all live in Germany. Herr Hanser:

Discussing Friends, Acquaintances, and Neighbors You may find yourself describing people you know as your friends, even if you aren’t in close contact with them. In the German-speaking world, people have more distinct boundaries between those they consider as Freunde (froyn-de) (friends) and those they describe as Bekannte (bê-kân-te) (acquaintances).

87 Book I Getting Started with German

88

Book I: Getting Started with German For many Germans, Freunde are part of a smaller, tighter knit circle than those you may include in your group of friends. Aside from family and friends, other people you may know are Nachbarn (nâH-bârn) (neighbors) or Arbeitskollegen (âr-bayts-koh-ley-gen) (coworkers). Here are some example sentences you may use to describe your friends, acquaintances, and neighbors: Ich habe einen sehr guten Freund, der in New York lebt. (iH hah-be ayn-en zeyr gooh-ten froynd, dêr in new york [as in English] lêpt.) (I have a very good [male] friend who lives in New York.) Ich habe eine sehr gute Freundin, die in New York lebt. (iH hah-be ayn-e zeyr gooh-te froyn-din, dee in new york [as in English] lêpt.) (I have a very good [female] friend who lives in New York.) Er ist ein Bekannter von mir. (êr ist ayn bê-kân-ter fon meer.) (He’s an acquaintance of mine.) Sie ist eine Bekannte von mir. (zee ist ayn-e bê-kân-te fon meer.) (She’s an acquaintance of mine.) Ich kenne meine Nachbarn nicht sehr gut. (iH kên-e mayn-e nahH-bârn niHt zeyr gooht.) (I don’t know my neighbors very well.) Note: In the previous example sentences, the German nouns for friend and acquaintance have different spellings, depending on whether you’re talking about a male or a female. Some German nouns have this type of spelling change. For more on figuring out how to use such German nouns, see Book III, Chapter 2.

Spending Time at Your Home or Someone Else’s The time you spend at home is an important part of your life that defines who you are. It’s where you prepare meals, relax, entertain friends, do work, and much more. This section provides you with useful vocabulary so you can describe the activities you do at home both during the week and on the weekends. It also explains what you need to know about being a guest at someone else’s home.

Daily routine Everyone has some sort of daily routine, starting with getting up in the morning and followed by a number of steps, like taking a shower, getting dressed, and

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life having a bite to eat. The evening routine probably includes some of the same steps, only in reverse order. This section gets you up to speed on describing what you do on a daily basis. Some German verbs that you use to describe your daily actions have an unusual construction. They’re the equivalent of reflexive verbs in English. Verbs in this group use a reflexive pronoun like myself or ourselves to emphasize the information about who is carrying out the action of the verb. When you say, “Cats wash themselves very thoroughly,” you’re using the reflexive pronoun themselves together with the verb wash to talk about what cats do. For more information on reflexive verbs, go to Book IV, Chapter 3. Another set of verbs you use to describe your daily routine includes separableprefix verbs and inseparable-prefix verbs. These verbs are similar to English verbs that have two parts, such as look at or get up. To find out more about using separable- and inseparable-prefix verbs, see Book III, Chapter 8. Here’s a list of typical daily routine activities. Some of the verbs in the list are regular, some are reflexive, and some are separable prefix. For the reflexive and separable-prefix verbs, you see a note after the English meaning of the word: ✓ aufstehen (ouf-shtey-en) (to get up) (separable prefix) ✓ sich duschen (zeeH doohsh-en) (to take a shower) (reflexive) ✓ sich anziehen (zeeH ân-tsee-en) (to get dressed) (reflexive/separable prefix) ✓ frühstücken (frue-shtuek-en) (to eat breakfast) ✓ in die/zur Arbeit gehen (in dee/tsoor âr-bayt gey-en) (to go into/to work) ✓ zu Mittag essen (tsooh mit-âk ês-en) (to have lunch) ✓ nach Hause kommen (nâH-houz-e kom-en) (to come home) ✓ zu Abend essen (tsooh ah-bent ês-en) (to have dinner) ✓ fernsehen (fêrn-zey-en) (to watch TV) (separable prefix) ✓ den Wecker stellen (deyn vêk-er shtêl-en) (to set the alarm clock) ✓ sich ausziehen (zeeH ous-tsee-en) (to get undressed) (reflexive/separable prefix) ✓ ins Bett gehen (ins bêt gey-en) (to go to bed) Use the following sentences to describe your daily routine or someone else’s: Ich stehe um (7) Uhr auf. (iH shtey-e oom [zee-ben] oohr ouf.) (I get up at [seven] o’clock.) Ich ziehe mich an. (iH tsee-e meeH ân.) (I get dressed.) Wir kommen spät nach Hause. (veer kom-en shpait nâH houz-e.) (We’re coming home late.)

89 Book I Getting Started with German

90

Book I: Getting Started with German Abends sehe ich oft fern. (ah-bents zey-e iH oft fêrn.) (I often watch TV in the evening.) Sie geht um zehn Uhr ins Bett. (zee geyt oom tseyn oohr ins bêt.) (She goes to bed at ten o’clock.)

Das Wochenende: The weekend Das Wochenende (dâs voH-en-ên-de) (the weekend) is the time to relax, or, expressed in German, sich entspannen (zeeH ênt-shpân-en) (to relax), especially for anyone who has a typical Monday through Friday work routine. On the weekend, you may have a number of chores to catch up on, but you may also get up a little later and have a relaxing breakfast first. The following is a list of some typical weekend chores and activities. For verbs that are separable-prefix verbs, you see a note in parentheses after the English translation. For details on using separable-prefix verbs, see Book III, Chapter 8. ✓ abwaschen (âp-vâsh-en) (to do the dishes) (separable prefix) ✓ das Auto waschen (dâs ou-toh vâsh-en) (to wash the car) ✓ einkaufen (ayn-kouf-en) (to shop) (separable prefix) ✓ faulenzen (foul-ênts-en) (to lounge around) ✓ Freunde einladen (froyn-de ayn-lâd-en) (to invite friends over) (separable prefix) ✓ die Hausarbeit machen (dee hous-âr-bayt mâH-en) (to do the housework) ✓ im Internet surfen (im Internet [as in English] soorf-en) (to surf the Internet) ✓ kochen (koH-en) (to cook) ✓ Musik hören (moo-zeek her-en) (to listen to music) ✓ saubermachen (zou-ber-mâH-en) (to clean up) (separable prefix) ✓ spät aufstehen (shpait ouf-shtey-en) (to get up late) (separable prefix) ✓ staubsaugen (shtoup-zoug-en) (to vacuum) (separable prefix) ✓ die Wäsche waschen (dee vaish-e vâsh-en) (to do the laundry) Here are some sentences you can use to talk about what you or other people do on weekends: Ich lade Freunde ein. (iH lâ-de froyn-de ayn.) (I’m inviting friends over.) Ich mache die Hausarbeit gern. (iH mâH-e dee hous-âr-bayt gêrn) (I like to do the housework.)

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life Er macht heute Nachmittag sauber. (êr mâHt hoy-te nâH-mi-tahk zou-ber.) (He’s cleaning up this afternoon.) Steht sie Sonntags spät auf? (shteyt zee zon-tahks spait ouf?) (Does she get up late on Sundays?) Until a few years ago, strict laws in Germany, Austria, and Switzerland regulated when stores were allowed to be open, particularly on weekends. On Saturday mornings, people rushed to shop for food because supermarkets closed in the early afternoon, and no stores of any kind were open on Sundays. Although the regulations for opening and closing hours have been relaxed, people still like to get out early on Saturday to buy fresh Brötchen (brert-Hen) (rolls) from the local bakery. After doing some shopping and a number of household chores on Saturday morning, Germans enjoy taking a long Spaziergang (shpâts-eer-gâng) (walk), Fahrradfahren (fahr-râd-fahr-en) (bicycling), or doing any number of outdoor recreation activities. Sunday is traditionally a day of rest and a time for families to enjoy a homecooked meal together at midday, followed by a leisurely stroll. At around 4 p.m., many families share Kaffee und Kuchen (kah-fey oont koohH-en) (coffee and cake) or, for the indulgent, a big dollop of unsweetened Schlagsahne (shlâgzahn-e) (whipped cream) on top of a slice of homemade Apfelstrudel (âp-fêlshtrooh-del) (apple strudel). Mmm! All day on Sundays and on weekdays usually between 1 p.m. and 3 p.m. and after 10 p.m., certain loud activities, such as mowing the lawn, playing loud music, and doing laundry, are prohibited in accordance with the “quiet time”law.

Doing and saying the right thing Knowing what to do when you’re a guest in someone’s home is a simple matter of being aware of the differences in the conventions of others and then observing them. This section outlines some of the things you need to know before visiting someone’s home in a German-speaking country.

Living behind closed doors Privacy plays an important role in German-speaking countries, so in general, people close doors between rooms in homes and office buildings. As an added benefit to maintaining privacy, closed doors keep noise levels down and may conserve energy. When you’re in doubt about whether it’s okay to enter a room with a closed door, simply knock and say, Darf ich? (dârf iH?) (May I?)

91 Book I Getting Started with German

92

Book I: Getting Started with German Helping yourself When you’re at home, you think nothing of going to the fridge to help yourself to something to drink. Your friends may do the same in your home. Germans tend to be more formal about opening up the fridge door in someone else’s home without asking. If you’re thirsty and you want something to drink, you can say, Könnte ich etwas zu trinken haben? (kern-te iH êt-vâs tsooh trin-ken hah-ben?) (Could I have something to drink?)

Behaving politely at the dinner table Table etiquette in German-speaking countries involves a couple of polite phrases at the start of the meal, as well as appropriate eating customs. Before beginning a meal, Germans often say Guten Appetit (gooh-ten âp-eteet) (enjoy your meal) or its more informal version, Mahlzeit (mâl-tsayt) (enjoy your meal). You may also hear Mahlzeit used as a means of greeting colleagues at the workplace around lunchtime. People gathered around a dinner table use the phrase zum Wohl (tsoom vohl) (cheers) as they raise their glasses before taking the first sip of something like wine. Prost (prohst) (cheers) is an alternative, informal expression more typically associated with drinking only. Table manners in the German-speaking world deem it polite to have both hands on the table but not the elbows. In fact, your fellow diners would consider you strange if you kept your hands hidden in your lap during a meal. (No funny business under the table, please!) By the same token, eating with your fork while holding your knife in the other hand is acceptable. During meal preparation, if you’d like to offer your help, by all means do so. You may use either the formal or informal version of you. Here’s the formal you formulation: Kann ich Ihnen helfen? (kân iH een-en hêlf-en?) (Can I help you?) The informal you version looks like this: Kann ich dir helfen? (kân iH deer hêlf-en?) (Can I help you?) In another situation, you may be offered something (more) to eat or drink. Check out the question and some replies: Darf/Kann ich Ihnen . . . anbieten? (dârf/kân iH een-en . . . ân-beet-en?) (May/Can I offer you. . . ?) Ja, bitte. Ich möchte. . . . (yah, bi-te. iH merH-te. . . .) (Yes, please. I’d like. . . .) Danke, nein. (dân-ke, nayn.) (No, thank you.)

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life

Playing Sports Europeans, like Americans and people all over the world, enjoy participating in and watching a wide variety of indoor and outdoor sports. By far the most popular Sport (shport) (sport) is soccer, known to Germans as Fußball (foohs-bâl). It’s not to be confused with Football (football [as in English]) (American football), which isn’t played much in Europe. Other traditional German favorites include volleyball, bicycling, skiing, and hiking. Some relative newcomers are tennis, golf, and windsurfing. By using the words and phrases in this section, you can share your interest in sports with other people auf Deutsch (ouf doych) (in German)!

Playing around with the verb “spielen” You can talk about playing many sports by using the verb spielen (shpeel-en) (to play) and the noun that describes the sport in the following phrase: Ich spiele gern. . . . (iH shpeel-e gêrn. . . .) (I like to play. . . .) Just insert the names of the following sports at the end of the sentence and let the games begin! ✓ Basketball (basketball [as in English]) (basketball) ✓ Fußball (foohs-bâl) (soccer) ✓ Golf (golf [as in English]) (golf) ✓ Tennis (tennis [as in English]) (tennis) ✓ Volleyball (volleyball [as in English]) (volleyball)

Verbalizing sports you enjoy Some sports you express as verbs, so you don’t use the verb spielen to talk about them. Instead, you use the following expression: Ich möchte gern. . . . (iH merH-te gêrn. . . .) (I would like to. . . .) To complete the sentence, you simply tack on the verb that expresses the sport — no conjugating necessary — at the end of the expression. For example: Ich möchte gern segeln. (iH merH-te gêrn zey-geln.) (I would like to sail.)

93 Book I Getting Started with German

94

Book I: Getting Started with German Here are a few other verbs that describe sports: ✓ (Fahr)rad fahren ([fahr]-rât fahr-en) (to ride a bike) ✓ joggen (jog-en) (to jog) ✓ schwimmen (shvim-en) (to swim) ✓ Ski fahren (shee fahr-en) (to ski) (Note: Pronunciation is “shee,” not “skee.”) ✓ windsurfen (vint-soorf-en) (to windsurf) The following construction provides another way to discuss your favorite activities: Ich . . . gern. (iH . . . gêrn.) (I like to. . . .) Here you need to remember to conjugate the verb (drop the -n for the ich forms, keep the -n for the wir, sie/Sie [we, they/you formal]) that you put in the blank. Check out these examples: Ich schwimme gern. (iH shvim-e gêrn.) (I like to swim.) Ich fahre gern Fahrrad. (iH fahr-e gêrn fahr-rât.) (I like to bike.)

Inviting someone to play To ask someone to join you in an activity, use one of the following expressions and add either the verb (in infinitive form) that expresses the sport or the noun that expresses the sport plus the verb spielen: Lass uns . . . gehen! (lâs oons . . . gey-en!) (Let’s go. . . !) Möchtest du. . . ? (merH-test dooh. . . ) (Would you like to. . . ?) Take a look at these two examples: Lass uns windsurfen gehen! (lâs oons vint-soorf-en gey-en!) (Let’s go windsurfing!) Möchtest du Volleyball spielen? (merH-test dooh volleyball speel-en?) (Would you like to play volleyball?)

Chapter 4: Talking about Home, Family, Friends, and Daily Life

95 Book I

Words to Know etwas vorhaben

êt-wâs for-hah-ben

to have some plans

mitkommen

mit-kom-en

to come along

ja, sicher

jâh, zeeH-er

yes, sure

wohin

voh-hin

where to

abgemacht

ahp-ge-mâHt

that’s a deal

bis morgen

bis mor-gen

until tomorrow

Talkin’ the Talk

It’s Friday afternoon, and Michael spots his friend Ingo on the subway. (Track 15) Michael:

Grüß dich Ingo. Was machst du morgen? grues dîH een-goh. Vâs mâHst dooh mor-gên? Hi Ingo. What are you doing tomorrow?

Ingo:

Nichts Besonderes. Joggen oder schwimmen. Was hast du vor? niHts be-zon-der-es. jog-en oh-der shvim-en. vâs hâst du for? Nothing special. Jogging or swimming. What are your plans?

Michael: Ich möchte gern Fahrrad fahren. Kommst du mit? iH merH-te gêrn fahr-rât fahr-en. Komst du mit? I’d really like to take a bike ride. Want to come along? Ingo: Ja, sicher. Wohin fahren wir? yâh, zeeH-er. voh-hin fahr-en veer? Yes, sure. Where shall we go?

Getting Started with German

96

Book I: Getting Started with German Michael: Ingo:

Lass uns zum Starnberger See fahren. Wir können dort in den Biergarten gehen. lâs oons tsoom shtahrn-bêr-ger zey fahr-en. veer kern-en dort in deyn beer-gâr-ten gey-en. Let’s ride to Starnberger Lake. We can go to the beergarden there. Abgemacht! Bis morgen! ahp-ge-mâHt. bis mor-gen! That’s a deal! Until tomorrow!

Chapter 5

Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events In This Chapter ▶ Placing phone calls ▶ Sending letters, faxes, and e-mails ▶ Becoming familiar with business terminology ▶ Understanding media and current events

T

elecommunications increasingly drive daily interaction with others, from ordering pizza to conducting business between continents. The first step is deciding which interface you want to use to convey your message — phone, e-mail, fax, or a good old-fashioned letter. This chapter delves into each of these media. It also offers a brief primer in office terminology and some tips on conducting business. Finally, it includes a quick overview of the news media so you can keep up with current events.

Making a Phone Call When German speakers pick up das Telefon (dâs tê-le-fohn) (the telephone), they usually answer the call by stating their last name — particularly when they’re at the office. If you call somebody at home, you sometimes may hear a simple Hallo? (hâ-loh?) (Hello?). If you want to express that you’re going to call somebody or that you want somebody to call you, use the verb anrufen (ân-roohf-en) (to call). It’s a separable verb, so the prefix an (ân) (to) gets separated from the stem rufen (roohf-en) (call) when you conjugate it, as you can see here:

98

Book I: Getting Started with German anrufen (to call ) ich rufe an

wir rufen an

du rufst an

ihr ruft an

er/sie/es ruft an

sie rufen an Sie rufen an

Ich rufe später noch einmal an. (I’ll call again later.) For more info on separable verbs, see Book III, Chapter 8.

Asking for your party If the person you want to speak to doesn’t pick up the phone, you need to ask for your party. As in English, you have several options to express that you want to speak with somebody: Ich möchte gern Herrn/Frau . . . sprechen. (îH merH-te gêrn hêrn/frou . . . shprêH-en.) (I would like to talk to Mr./Mrs. . . .) Ist Herr/Frau . . . zu sprechen? (ist hêr/frou . . . tsooh shprêH-en?) (Is Mr./ Mrs. . . . available?) Kann ich bitte mit Herrn/Frau . . . , sprechen? (kân îH bi-te mit hêrn/frou . . . , shprêH-en?) (Can I speak to Mr./Mrs. . . . , please?) Herrn/Frau . . . , bitte. (hêrn/frou . . . , bi-te.) (Mr./Mrs. . . . , please.) If you find that somebody on the other end of the line talks too fast for you to understand, try using these questions to slow down the conversation: Können Sie bitte langsamer sprechen? (kern-en zee bi-te lâng-zahm-er sprêH-en?) (Could you please talk more slowly?) Können Sie das bitte wiederholen? (kern-en zee dâs bi-te vee-der-hohlen?) (Could you repeat that, please?) And if the person on the other end starts speaking English in response to your question, don’t consider it a failure on your part. The other person probably just wants to practice his or her English!

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events

99 Book I

Using the phone while visiting Germany If you’d like the convenience of using a cellphone while you’re in Germany, or almost anywhere in Europe for that matter, shop around before you leave for your destination. You may want a prepaid SIM card for your cellphone, but you need to ask your provider beforehand whether it works in Europe. Your other options are to get a prepaid cellphone or to use a rental cellphone. If you want to make a call from a public phone — die Telefonzelle (dee tê-le-fohn-tsêl-e) (the

phone booth) — in Germany, be prepared to do some sleuthing to find one. When you do, you’ll need to figure out how it works, and you’ll probably need to purchase a telephone card — Telefonkarte (tê-le-fohnkâr-te) — elsewhere beforehand. You may find telephone cards for sale at tobacco shops. However, it may be easier to get your own cellphone — das Handy (dâs hên-dee) — at a telephone shop in Germany.

Making the connection After you ask to speak to a specific person, you may hear any number of responses depending on whom you’re calling and where that person is when you call: Am Apparat. (âm â-pâ-raht.) (Speaking. [Literally: On the phone.]) Einen Moment bitte, ich verbinde. (ayn-en moh-mênt bi-te, îH fêr-bin-de.) (One moment please, I’ll put you through.) Er/sie telefoniert gerade. (êr/zee tê-le-fohn-eert ge-rah-de.) (He/she is on the telephone right now.) Bitte, bleiben Sie am Apparat. (bi-te blay-ben zee âm â-pâ-raht.) (Please hold.) Die Leitung ist besetzt. (dee lay-toong ist be-zêtst.) (The line is busy.) Können Sie später noch einmal anrufen? (kern-en zee shpai-ter noH ayn-mahl ân-roohf-en?) (Could you call again later?) Kann er/sie Sie zurückrufen? (kân êr/zee zee tsoo-ruek-roohf-en?) (Can he/she call you back?) Hat er/sie Ihre Telefonnummer? (hât êr/zee eer-e tê-le-fohn-noom-er?) (Does he/she have your phone number?)

Getting Started with German

100

Book I: Getting Started with German Here are some expressions that may be helpful if something goes wrong with your connection: Es tut mir leid. Ich habe mich verwählt. (ês tooht meer layt. iH hah-be miH fer-vailt.) (I’m sorry. I have dialed the wrong number.) Die Verbindung ist schlecht. (dee fêr-bin-doong ist shlêHt.) (It’s a bad connection.) Er/sie hebt nicht ab. (êr/zee hêpt niHt âp.) (He/she doesn’t answer the phone.) Ich werde später noch einmal versuchen. (iH vêr-de shpait-er noH aynmâl vêr-zoohH-en.) (I’ll try again later.) You may hear the following expressions when you’re in the process of making your connection and you reach someone’s answering machine: Hier ist der Anrufbeantworter von. . . . (heer ist dêr ân-roohf-be-ânt-forter fon. . . .) (This is the answering machine of. . . .) Sie können eine Nachricht hinterlassen. (zee kern-en ayn-e nâH-reeHt hin-ter-lâs-en.) (You can leave a message.) Sprechen Sie bitte nach dem Piepton. (sprêH-en zee bi-te nâH deym peep-tohn.) (Please speak after the beep.)

Talkin’ the Talk The following is a conversation between Frau Bauer, the personal assistant of Herr Huber, and Herr Meißner, a client of the company. (Track 16) Firma TransEuropa, Bauer. Guten Morgen! Frau Bauer: fir-mâ trâns-oy-roh-pâ, bou-er. gooh-ten mor-gen! TransEuropa company, (Mrs.) Bauer speaking. Good morning! Guten Morgen! Herrn Huber, bitte. Herr Meißner: gooh-ten mor-gen! hêrn hooh-ber, bi-te. Good morning! Mr. Huber, please. Frau Bauer:

Wie ist Ihr Name, bitte? vee ist eer nah-me, bi-te? What is your name, please?

Herr Meißner:

Meißner. Ich bin von der Firma Schlecker. mays-ner. iH bin fon dêr fir-mâ shlêk-er. (This is Mr.) Meißner. I’m from the Schlecker company.

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events Ich verbinde . . . Tut mir leid. Herr Huber ist in einer Besprechung. Kann er Sie zurückrufen? iH fêr-bin-de . . . tooht meer layt. hêr hooh-ber ist in ayn-er be-shprêH-oong. kân êr zee tsoo-ruek-roohf-en? I’ll connect you . . . I’m sorry. Mr. Huber is in a meeting. Can he call you back?

Frau Bauer:

Selbstverständlich. Er hat meine Telefonnummer. zêlpst-fêr-shtant-liH. êr hât mayn-e tê-le-fohn-noom-er. Of course. He has my telephone number. Herr Meißner:

Frau Bauer:

Gut, Herr Meißner. Auf Wiederhören! gooht, hêr mays-ner. ouf vee-der-herr-en! Good, Mr. Meißner. Goodbye!

Herr Meißner:

Vielen Dank. Auf Wiederhören! fee-len dânk. ouf vee-der-herr-en! Thanks a lot. Goodbye!

Words to Know das Telefon

dâs tê-le-fohn

phone

das Handy

dâs hên-dee

cellphone

anrufen

ân-roohf-en

to call

zurückrufen

tsoo-ruek-roohf-en

to call back

auf Wiederhören!

ouf vee-der-herr-en

G oodbye! (on the phone)

das Telefonbuch

dâs tê-le-fohn-boohH

phone book

das Telefongespräch

dâs tê-le-fohn-ge-shpraiH

phone call

die Telefonnummer

dee tê-le-fohn- noom-er

phone number

der Anrufbeantworter

dêr ân-roohf-beânt-for-ter

a nswering machine

101 Book I Getting Started with German

102

Book I: Getting Started with German

Saying goodbye on the phone Does auf Wiederhören! (ouf vee-der-herr-en!) sound somewhat familiar? It’s the phone equivalent to auf Wiedersehen (ouf vee-der-zey-en), the expression you use if you say goodbye to somebody you’ve just seen in person. Auf

Wiedersehen combines wieder (vee-der) (again) with the verb sehen (zey-en) (to see), whereas auf Wiederhören uses the verb hören (herr-en) (to hear), so it literally means “hear you again.” Makes sense, doesn’t it?

Making appointments You may need to make an appointment to see someone. Here are some expressions that can help you get past the gatekeepers: Ich möchte gern einen Termin machen. (iH merH-te gêrn ayn-en têrmeen mâH-en.) (I would like to make an appointment.) Kann ich meinen Termin verschieben? (kân iH mayn-en têr-meen fêrshee-ben?) (Can I change my appointment?) Here are some of the responses you may hear: Wann passt es Ihnen? (vân pâst ês een-en?) (What time suits you?) Wie wäre es mit. . . ? (vee vai-re ês mit. . . ?) (How about. . . ?) Heute ist leider kein Termin mehr frei. (hoy-te ist lay-der kayn têr-meen meyr fray.) (Unfortunately, there is no appointment available today.)

Talkin’ the Talk Frau Bauer has to make an appointment at the doctor’s office. She is talking to the doctor’s assistant, Liza. Liza:

Praxis Dr. Eggert. prâx-is dok-tor êg-ert. Dr. Eggert’s office.

Frau Bauer: Guten Tag, Anita Bauer. Ich möchte einen Termin für nächste Woche machen. gooh-ten tahk, â-nee-tâ bou-er. iH merH-te ayn-en têr-meen fuer naiH-ste voH-e mâH-en. Hello. (This is) Anita Bauer. I would like to make an appointment for next week.

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events Liza:

Wann passt es Ihnen? vân pâst ês een-en? What time suits you?

Frau Bauer: Mittwoch wäre gut. mit-vôH vai-re gooht. Wednesday would be good. Liza:

Mittwoch ist leider kein Termin mehr frei. Wie wäre es mit Donnerstag? mit-voH îst lay-der kayn têr-meen meyr fray. vee vai-re ês mit don-ers-tahk? Unfortunately, there is no appointment available on Wednesday. How about Thursday?

Frau Bauer: Donnerstag ist auch gut. Geht fünfzehn Uhr? don-ers-tahk ist ouH gooht. geyt fuenf-tseyn oohr? Thursday is good, too. Does 3:00 p.m. work? Liza:

Kein Problem. Dann bis Donnerstag. kayn proh-bleym. dân bis don-ers-tahk. No problem. Until Thursday.

Frau Bauer: Danke schön. Auf Wiederhören. dân-ke shern. ouf vee-der-herr-en. Thank you very much. Goodbye.

Leaving messages Unfortunately, you often don’t get through to the person you’re trying to reach, and you have to leave a message. In that case, some of the following expressions may come in handy: Kann ich ihm/ihr eine Nachricht hinterlassen? (kân îH eem/eer ayn-e nahH-riHt hin-ter-lâs-en?) (Can I leave him/her a message?) Kann ich ihm/ihr etwas ausrichten? (kân iH eem/eer êt-vâs ous-rîH-ten?) (Can I give him/her a message?) Möchten Sie eine Nachricht hinterlassen? (merH-ten zee ayn-e naH-riHt hin-ter-lâs-en?) (Would you like to leave a message?) Ich bin unter der Nummer . . . zu erreichen. (iH bin oon-ter dêr noom-er . . . tsooh êr-ayH-en.) (I can be reached at the number. . . .)

103 Book I Getting Started with German

104

Book I: Getting Started with German

Talkin’ the Talk Frau Bauer, an assistant at the company TransEuropa, answers a phone call from Hans Seibold, who is an old friend of her boss, Herr Huber. Frau Bauer: Firma TransEuropa, guten Tag! fir-mâ trâns-oy-roh-pâ, gooh-ten tahk! TransEuropa company, hello! Herr Seibold: Guten Tag, Seibold hier. Kann ich bitte mit Herrn Huber, sprechen? gooh-ten tahk, zay-bolt heer. kân iH bi-te mit hêrn hooh-ber, shprêH-en? Hello, (this is Mr.) Seibold. Can I speak to Mr. Huber, please? Frau Bauer: Guten Tag, Herr Seibold. Einen Moment bitte, ich verbinde. gooh-ten tahk hêr zay-bolt. ayn-en moh-mênt bi-te, iH fêr-bin-de. Hello, Mr. Seibold. One moment, please. I’ll connect you. (After a short moment) Frau Bauer: Herr Seibold? Herr Huber spricht gerade auf der anderen Leitung. Möchten Sie ihm eine Nachricht hinterlassen? hêr zay-bolt? hêr hooh-ber shpriHt ge-rah-de ouf dêr ân-de-ren lay-toong. merH-ten zee eem ayn-e nahHriHt hin-ter-lâs-en? Mr. Seibold? Mr. Huber is on the other line. Would you like to leave him a message? Herr Seibold: Ja bitte. Ich bin unter der Nummer 089 57 36 488 zu erreichen. yah, bi-te. iH bin oon-têr dêr noom-er nool âHt noyn fuenf zee-ben dray zeks feer âHt âHt tsooh êr-rayH-en. Yes, please. I can be reached at the number 089 57 36 488. Frau Bauer: Ich werde es ausrichten! iH vêr-de ês ous-riH-ten! I’ll forward the message! Herr Seibold: Vielen Dank! Auf Wiederhören! fee-len dânk! ouf vee-der-herr-en! Thanks a lot! Goodbye!

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events

Writing Your Message Considering all the tasks you can accomplish with a (cell)phone, you may ask yourself why anyone would bother with the hassle of putting pen to paper, or fingers to keyboard, for that matter. Yet people still like, and need, to send written correspondence from time to time. Entire books have been written about the art of writing letters in German; this section gives you just enough information to write and send a letter or e-mail.

Beginning and ending a letter You use certain conventions in German, just as you do in English, to write letters. The form of address varies, depending on whether you know the name of the person you’re writing to. The greeting in the letter is followed by a comma. Contrary to English convention, the first letter of the first word in the opening sentence of a German letter isn’t capitalized, unless it’s a noun. The following sections provide more details on how to start and finish a letter in German.

Formal style In formal German, when you know the name of the person you’re writing to, the phrase you begin with is Sehr geehrte Frau/Sehr geehrter Herr . . . (zeyr ge-eyr-te frou/zeyr ge-eyr-ter hêr) (Dear Mrs./Dear Mr. . . .). You add the person’s last name after the form of address of Frau or Herr. The term Fräulein (froy-layn) (Miss) is no longer used. Here’s an example of a formal style opening salutation: Sehr geehrter Herr Schneider, (zeyr ge-eyr-ter hêr schnayd-er,) (Dear Mr. Schneider,) When you don’t know the name of the person or people you’re writing to, you write Sehr geehrte Damen und Herren, (zeyr ge-eyr-te dâm-en oont hêr-en,) (Dear ladies and gentlemen,).

When the person you’re writing to has a title, be sure to include that in the salutation. The following list shows some commonly used titles, their abbreviated forms, and an example of how to use the title in the salutation of a letter:

✓ Professor (pro-fês-or) (Professor) (male)/Professorin (pro-fês-or-in) (Professor) (female): Prof. is the abbreviated form. You write the full title Professor or Professorin in the salutation of a letter like this: Sehr geehrter Herr Professor Schlagbaum, (zeyr ge-eyr-ter hêr proh-fês-or shlahk-boum,) (Dear Professor Schlagbaum,)

105 Book I Getting Started with German

106

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ Doktor (dok-tor) (Doctor) (male and female): Dr. is the abbreviation. In the German-speaking world, you use the title Doktor to address both people who are medical doctors as well as those with doctorate degrees. Write the abbreviated form in salutations like this: Sehr geehrte Frau Dr. Prediger, (zeyr ge-eyr-te frou dok-tor preydee-ger,) (Dear Doctor Preydiger,) ✓ Diplom-Ingenieur (di-plohm-in-gen-er) (graduate engineer): Dipl.-Ing. is the abbreviation. You use this title for people with advanced engineering degrees. Write the abbreviated form in salutations like this: Sehr geehrter Herr Dipl.-Ing. Morgenstern, (zeyr ge-eyr-ter hêr di-plohm-in-gen-er mor-gen-shtêrn,) (Dear Mr. Morgenstern,) The phrase most often used to sign off a letter is Mit freundlichen Grüßen (mit froynt-liH-en grues-en) (Sincerely). Unlike the closing greeting in English, you don’t follow this expression with a comma. Your signature goes below the closing, and you add your full name and contact information below the signature, as you do in English.

Informal style When you know people well enough to be on a first-name basis, you use the informal du (dooh) (informal you) when you’re speaking to them and the informal style of opening and closing a letter when writing to them. If you’re not sure whether to address someone formally or informally, err on the side of caution and stick with formal usage. But when you’re writing to people you know well, use the informal letter style for salutations and closings. Use Liebe (leeb-e) (Dear) to address a female and Lieber (leeb-er) (Dear) to address a male. Follow the greeting with the person’s first name. For example: Liebe Heidi, (leeb-e hay-dee,) (Dear Heidi,) The informal closing to a letter looks like this: Herzliche Grüße (hertz-leeH-e grues-e) (kind regards)

Sending mail the old-fashioned way When you’re ready to send someone der Brief (dêr breef) (letter), die Postkarte (dee post-kâr-te) (postcard), die Ansichtskarte (dee ahn-zîHts-kâr-te) (picture postcard), or das Paket (dâs pâ-keyt) (package), you need to be prepared with some simple phrases that get you in and out of das Postamt (dâs post-âmt) (post office) as quickly and hassle-free as possible.

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events

107

Buying stamps

Book I

In Germany, you usually buy Briefmarken (breef-mâr-ken) (stamps) — or, if you need only one, die Briefmarke (dee breef-mâr-ke) (stamp) — at the post office. To get your stamps, say the following to the postal worker:

Getting Started with German

Ich möchte gern Briefmarken kaufen. (iH merH-te gern breef-mâr-ken kouf-en.) (I would like to buy stamps.) To specify how many stamps and what values you want, state your request like this: 5-mal 50 Cent und 10-mal 20 Cent. (fuenf-mahl fuenf-tsiH sent oont tseynmahl tsvân-tsiH sent.) (5 times 50 cents and 10 times 20 cents.) If you want to know the postage for an item you’re sending to the U.S. — for example, a letter or a postcard — ask the following as you hand your correspondence over the counter: Wie viel kostet es, diesen Brief/diese Ansichtskarte nach Amerika zu schicken? (vee feel kos-tet ês, deez-en breef/deez-e ahn-ziHts-kâr-te nahH â-mey-ree-kah tsooh shik-en?) (How much does it cost to send this letter/ picture postcard to the U.S.?)

Putting your mail in the mailbox As in the U.S., you can give your mail to a postal worker, drop it into one of the receptacles at the post office (those slits in the wall), or put it into a Briefkasten (breef-kâst-en) (mailbox) found on street corners or in front of post offices (in Germany, mailboxes are yellow, not blue). Sometimes separate mailboxes are available: one for the city you’re in and the surrounding area, and another one for other places. So the mailboxes may have signs saying, for example, Köln und Umgebung (kerln oont oom-gey-boong) (Cologne and surrounding area) and andere Orte (ân-de-re or-te) (other places). In Germany, you can’t put items to mail in your mailbox to be picked up.

Asking for special services If you want to send an express letter, airmail, certified mail, or a package, you need to be familiar with these words: ✓ der Eilbrief (dêr ayl-breef) (express letter) ✓ das Einschreiben (dâs ayn-shrayb-en) (registered letter/certified mail) ✓ die Luftpost (dee looft-post) (airmail) ✓ das Paket (dâs pâ-keyt) (package)

108

Book I: Getting Started with German To get these special pieces of mail on their way, use one of these expressions: Ich möchte diesen Brief per Eilzustellung/per Luftpost/per Einschreiben schicken. (îH merH-te deez-en breef pêr ayl-tsooh-shtêloong/pêr looft-post/pêr ayn-shrayb-en shik-en.) (I would like to send this letter express/by air mail/by registered mail.) Ich möchte dieses Paket absenden. (iH merH-te deez-es pâ-keyt âp-zênden.) (I would like to send this package.) The following words come in handy when you’re sending mail (and you find them on the form you have to fill out to send certified mail):

✓ der Absender (dêr âp-zên-der) (sender)

✓ der Empfänger (dêr êm-pfêng-er) (addressee) ✓ das Porto (dâs por-toh) (postage)

Talkin’ the Talk Frau Bauer’s workday is almost over, and she has to mail a package at the post office. Listen in on her conversation with der Postangestellte (dêr post-ân-ge-shtêl-te) (post office worker). Frau Bauer:

Guten Tag. Ich möchte ein Paket absenden. gooh-ten tahk. iH merH-te ayn pâ-keyt ouf-gey-ben. Hello. I would like to send a package.

Der Postangestellte: Jawohl. Füllen Sie bitte dieses Formular aus. yah-vohl. fuel-en zee bi-te deez-es fohr-moolahr ous. Certainly. Please fill out this form. Frau Bauer:

Was für ein Formular ist das? vâs fuer ayn fohr-moo-lahr ist dâs? What kind of a form is that?

Der Postangestellte: Es ist eine Zollerklärung. ês ist ayn-e tsol-êr-klair-oong. It’s a customs declaration. Frau Bauer fills out the form and hands it back. Frau Bauer:

Bitte. bi-te Here you are.

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events Der Postangestellte: Also, das macht 12,60 Euro. âl-zoh, dâs maHt tsverlf oy-roh sêH-tsiH. So, that’ll be 12 euros 60.

E-mailing and faxing If you want to catch up on your e-mail while in Germany, your hotel will probably have Wi-Fi Internet access. Otherwise, head for a cybercafé or ask whether a (free) Wi-Fi hotspot is nearby. The great thing about e-mail and the Internet is that they involve an international language — the language of computers, which is, for the most part, English. However, being aware of the German equivalents for a few words connected with e-mailing is still a good idea: ✓ der Computer (dêr computer [as in English]) (computer) ✓ die E-mail (dee e-mail [as in English]) (e-mail) ✓ die E-Mail Adresse (dee e-mail ah-drês-e) (e-mail address) ✓ e-mailen (e-mail-en) (to e-mail) ✓ der Hotspot (der hot-spot [as in English]) (hot spot) ✓ das Internet (dâs Internet [as in English]) (Internet) If you can’t conveniently use somebody’s Faxgerät (fâx-ge-rêt) (fax machine), you should be able to send a Fax (fâx) (fax) from most cybercafés, hotels, and some copy shops. Just walk up to the counter and say the following: Ich möchte etwas faxen. (iH merH-te êt-vâs fâx-en.) (I would like to fax something.) After you find a place that can send your fax, the person operating the machine will ask you for die Faxnummer (dee fâx-noom-er) (the fax number).

Settling In at the Office When it comes to the workplace, Germans have a reputation for being straightforward, productive, and efficient, but statistically speaking, they don’t work as many hours as Americans do. Not that people don’t work late, but Germans enjoy much more generous vacation time. Many companies also close early on Fridays.

109 Book I Getting Started with German

110

Book I: Getting Started with German When you’re working in a German-speaking Büro (bue-roh) (office), you’re assigned various tasks, or Büroarbeit (bue-roh-âr-bayt) (office work). What do you call all that paraphernalia on your desk or all the stuff in the supply closet? Read on. After you have these terms down, you need to know how to describe what to do with them. Time to get to work!

Organizing your desk and supplies Typically, you may find — or hope to find — the following items on or around your Schreibtisch (shrayp-tish) (desk): ✓ der Brief (dêr breef) (letter) ✓ der Bürostuhl (dêr bue-roh-shtool) (office chair) ✓ der Computer (dêr computer [as in English]) (computer) ✓ der Drucker (dêr drook-er) (printer) ✓ das Faxgerät (dâs fâx-gê-reyt) (fax machine) ✓ der Fotokopierer (dêr foh-toh-ko-peer-er) (copy machine) ✓ die Lampe (dee lâm-pe) (lamp) ✓ die Maus (dee mouse [as in English]) (mouse) ✓ die Tastatur (dee tâs-tâ-toohr) (keyboard) ✓ das Telefon (dâs tê-le-fohn) (telephone) ✓ die Unterlagen (dee oon-ter-lah-gen) (documents, files) Sooner or later, you’re likely to need one of the following supplies: ✓ der Bleistift (dêr blay-shtift) (pencil) ✓ der Kugelschreiber/der Kuli (dêr kooh-gel-schrayb-er/dêr kooh-lee) (pen) (Note: People use the term der Kuli in spoken German.) ✓ das Papier (dâs pâ-peer) (paper) ✓ der Umschlag (dêr oom-shlahk) (envelope) When you need some of these supplies and you can’t find them on your own after rummaging around, ask a colleague to help you find them by saying one of the following: Haben Sie einen Kuli/einen Umschlag für mich? (hah-ben zee ayn-en kooh-lee/ayn-en oom-shlahk fuer miH?) (Could you give me a pen/ envelope? Literally: Do you have a pen/envelope for me?) Können Sie mir sagen, wo ich Umschläge/Bleistifte/Papier finde? (kernen zee meer zah-gen, voh iH oom-shlê-ge/blay-shtift-e/pâ-peer fin-de?) (Could you tell me where I would find envelopes/pencils/paper?)

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events

Interacting with coworkers Comprehensive job training plays an important role in forming Germany’s hardworking, qualified working population. To learn traditional trades such as Bäcker (bêk-er) (baker) or Zimmerman (tsim-er-mân) (carpenter) that don’t require a university degree, as well as for positions in offices and the service sector, young people start out in their job field as a Lehrling (lêhr-leeng) (apprentice) and go through a three-year Lehrzeit (lêhr-tsayt) (apprenticeship). When they complete the training, they’re well-qualified to enter the workforce in their job field. The atmosphere between coworkers tends to be quite formal, so when you address people in the workplace, use the formal Sie (zee) (formal you).

Naming jobs and occupations Many German job titles have two versions to show whether a man or a woman is doing that job. Often, the title for men ends in –er, and the counterpart title for women ends in an additional -in, as in the case of the term for a male manager, der Manager (dêr manager [as in English]), and the term for a female manager, die Managerin (dee manager-in). In the following list of common office jobs, those that follow a different pattern for male and female jobs are indicated with both terms: ✓ der Angestellte/die Angestellte (dêr ân-gê-shtêl-te/dee ân-gê-shtêl-te) (clerk, employee) ✓ der Arbeitskollege/die Arbeitskollegin (dêr âr-bayts-koh-leyg-e/dee ârbayts-koh-leyg-in) (coworker) ✓ der Assistent/die Assistentin (dêr âs-is-tênt/dee âs-is-tênt-in) (assistant) ✓ der Chef/die Chefin (dêr shêf/die shêf-în) (boss) ✓ der Direktor/die Direktorin (dêr di-rêk-tohr/dee di-rêk-tohr-in) (director) ✓ der Firmenchef/die Firmenchefin (dêr firm-en-shêf/die firm-en-shêf-în) (president [of a company]) ✓ der Geschäftsführer (dêr gê-shâfts-fuer-er) (business manager/CEO) ✓ der Geschäftsman/die Geschäftsfrau (dêr gê-shâfts-mân/dee gê-shâftsfrou) (businessman/businesswoman) ✓ der Leiter (dêr layt-er) (director) ✓ der Mitarbeiter (dêr mit-âr-bay-ter) (associate, colleague, staff member)

✓ der Sekretär/die Sekretärin (dêr zê-krê-têr/dee zê-krê-têr-in) (secretary)

111 Book I Getting Started with German

112

Book I: Getting Started with German Talking about common duties Here are a few expressions that come into play in everyday office situations; they also come in handy when you need help with a task: Wo finde ich den Fotokopierer/das Faxgerät? (voh fin-de iH deyn fohtoh-ko-peer-er/dâs fâx-gê-reyt?) (Where can I find the copy machine/fax machine?) Können Sie mir bitte zeigen, wie das funktioniert? (kern-en zee meer bi-te tsay-gen, vee dâs foonk-tsee-oh-neert?) (Could you please show me how that works?) Würden Sie bitte diesen Brief für mich übersetzen? (vuer-den zee bi-te deez-en breef fuer miH ue-ber-zêts-en?) (Would you translate this letter for me, please?)

Doing business in German Just like everywhere else, German-speaking countries have their own business world with their own culture and specialized language. To be successful at doing business in German, non-native speakers study for many years, taking special courses on holding meetings, negotiating, telephoning, and giving speeches. This chapter (or book, for that matter) doesn’t have the space to provide all the details you need to communicate at the business level — and you probably don’t have the time it would take to learn everything you’d need to know. But you may find yourself in a situation where a few business terms — and a little advice on how to proceed — can come in handy. Here are a few common office terms: ✓ anrufen (ân-roohf-en) (to phone) ✓ der Arbeitsplatz (dêr âr-bayts-plâts) (workplace) ✓ die Besprechung (dee be-shprêH-oong) (informal meeting) ✓ der Besprechungsraum (dêr be-shprêH-oongs-roum) (meeting room) ✓ das Büro (dâs buer-oh) (office) ✓ das Großraumbüro (dâs grohs-roum-buer-oh) (open-plan office) ✓ das Meeting (dâs meeting [as in English]) (formal meeting) ✓ die Telefonkonferenz (dee tê-le-fohn-kon-fêr-ênts) (conference call) ✓ der Termin (dêr têr-meen) (appointment) ✓ die Videokonferenz (dee vid-ee-oh-kon-fêr-ênts) (video conference) ✓ die Visitenkarte (dee vi-zeet-en-kâr-te) (business card)

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events

If you plan to perform business with German speakers, you may want to call ahead and ask whether the services of der Dolmetscher (dêr dol-mêch-er) (interpreter) or der Übersetzer (dêr ue-ber-zêts-êr) (translator) can be made available to you. Also find out whether the translator will take die Notizen (dee noh-tits-en) (notes) in English during the meeting so you have a written record of the goings-on. Don’t feel the slightest bit shy about asking for an interpreter or a translator. Business people all over the world respect someone who knows when it’s time to delegate. Following are a few more steps to take before you start doing business auf Deutsch (ouf doych) (in German):

✓ Study up on the formal introductions in Book I, Chapter 3. Nailing the introductions shows your interest in the proceedings, even if you don’t understand much more of what’s being said. ✓ Read the section “Talking about Yourself” in Book I, Chapter 3. It arms you with a few words you need to make small talk about your job. ✓ Before you start doing business, make sure you have plenty of business cards to hand out. Germans get far more vacation time than Americans: 30 workdays of vacation plus paid holidays (and some states of Germany have as many as 12 legal holidays). However, Germans typically have trouble finding the time to actually take vacations. Thus, vacation time is sometimes carried over into the next year.

Talkin’ the Talk Listen in on the following conversation between Frau Seifert and her assistant, Frau Remmert. Frau Seifert has come to the office early because she has an important meeting. Frau Seifert:

Guten Morgen, Frau Remmert. gooh-ten mor-gen, frou rêm-ert. Good morning, Ms. Remmert.

Frau Remmert:

Guten Morgen, Frau Seifert. gooh-ten mor-gen, frou zayf-êrt. Good morning, Ms. Seifert.

Frau Seifert:

Wissen Sie, ob Herr Krause heute im Hause ist? vis-en zee, op hêr krouz-e hoy-te im houz-e ist? Do you know if Mr. Krause is in the office today?

113 Book I Getting Started with German

114

Book I: Getting Started with German Frau Remmert: Ich glaube ja. iH glou-be yah. I think so. Ich muss dringend mit ihm sprechen. iH moos dring-end mit eem shprêH-en. I have to speak to him urgently.

Frau Seifert:

Frau Remmert: In Ordnung. Ach ja, Frau Hoffmann von der Firma Solag hat angerufen. in ord-noong. ahH yah, frou hof-mân fon dêr fir-mâ soh-lahk hât ân-gê-roohf-en. Okay. Oh yes, Ms. Hoffman from (the company) Solag called. Gut, ich rufe sie gleich an. Und würden Sie bitte diesen Brief für mich übersetzen? gooht, iH roohf-e zee glayH ân. oont vuer-den zee bi-te deez-en breef fuer miH ue-ber-zêts-en? Good, I’ll call her right away. And would you translate this letter for me, please?

Frau Seifert: Frau Remmert:

Wird gemacht, Frau Seifert. virt gê-mâHt frou zayf-êrt I’ll do that, Ms. Seifert.

Words to Know gleich

glayH

right away

dringend

drîng-end

urgently

im Hause/ Büro sein

im houz-e/ buer-oh zayn

to be in the building/ office

in Ordnung

in ord-noong

okay

Wird gemacht

virt ge-mâHt

I’ll do that. (Literally: It will be done.)

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events

Tuning In to Current Events Germans are known to be avid readers of newspapers and magazines that cover international current events. Both Germany and Austria have far higher per capita newspaper circulation rates than the United States, so you shouldn’t be surprised to find out that many Europeans are just as informed about events in the U.S. as Americans themselves. German-speaking television channels devote a great deal of time to both international and local news, and the Internet provides online access to international newspapers, magazines, TV stations, and radio programs.

Newspapers and magazines Several major German daily Zeitungen (tsayt-oong-en) (newspapers) offer in-depth coverage of international, national, and local news, and almost all German newspapers offer comprehensive online versions. In addition, some broadsheets offer special sections in English. The following sections and headings generally appear in large German daily papers: ✓ Börse (ber-ze) (stock market) ✓ Kultur (kool-toohr) (culture) ✓ Politik (pol-i-teek) (politics) ✓ Sport (shport) (sports) ✓ Wetter (vêt-er) (weather) ✓ Wirtschaft (virt-shâft) (economy) The following sections, topics, and columns may appear daily or on certain days of the week, depending on the newspaper: ✓ Bildung (bild-oong) (education) ✓ Briefe (breef-e) (letters) ✓ Gesellschaft (gê-zêl-shâft) (society) ✓ Gesundheit (gê-zoond-hayt) (health) ✓ Immobilienmarkt (im-oh-bee-lee-en-mârkt) (real estate market) ✓ Karriere (kâr-ee-êr-e) (careers) ✓ Kinoprogramm (kee-noh-proh-grâm) (movie program) ✓ Medien (mey-dee-en) (media)

115 Book I Getting Started with German

116

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ Meinung (mayn-oong) (opinion) ✓ Multimedia (moohl-tee-mey-dee-â) (multimedia) ✓ Spiele (shpee-le) (games) ✓ Stellenmarkt (shtêl-en-mârkt) (job market) ✓ Trends (trends [as in English]) (trends) ✓ TV-Programm (tee-fou-proh-grâm) (TV program) ✓ Umwelt (oohm-vêlt) (environment) ✓ Unterhaltung (oon-ter-hâlt-oong) (entertainment) ✓ Wissenschaft (vis-en-shâft) (science) Table 5-1 lists the largest newspapers in Germany and one in Switzerland.

Table 5-1

Largest Newspapers in Germany

Newspaper

Description

Website

Bild (bilt)

Known for its focus on sensational news; high ratio of photos to text (Bild means picture)

www.bild.de

Frankfurter Allgemeine Zeitung (frank-foort-er âl-ge-mayn-e tsayt-oong) (abbreviation: FAZ) (êfah-tset)

One of the most widely read quality newspapers among German readers inside and outside of Europe

www.faz.net

Handelsblatt (hân-dêls-blât)

Strong focus on the world of business and finance

www.handels blatt.com

Die Neue Zürcher Zeitung (dee noy-e tsuerH-er tsaytoong) (abbreviation: NZZ) (ên-tset-tset)

Swiss daily newspaper based in Zurich

www.nzz.ch

Die Süddeutsche Zeitung (dee sued-doych-e tsaytoong) (abbreviation: SZ) (ês-tset)

Internationally recognized newspaper that has earned a reputation for solid journalism

www.sued deutsche.de

Die Welt (dee vêlt)

Focuses on world news, as well as local news in Germany; has a Sunday publication called Die Welt am Sonntag (dee vêlt am zon-tahk)

www.welt.de

Chapter 5: Talking Telecommunications, Business, and Current Events The largest weekly magazines are Bunte (boon-te), Focus (fohk-oos), Der Spiegel (der speeg-el), and Stern (shtêrn). Die Zeit (dee tsayt) is a weekly newspaper that covers international and national news.

Television, radio, and the web The government-funded German television stations ARD and ZDF are terrific ways to get excellent quality news in German. Simply go to their websites — www.ard.de and www.zdf.de — and choose the type of information you’re interested in: politics, culture, sports, or of course, Nachrichten (nâH-reeH-ten) (news). At ARD, you can watch a classic weekly TV series, Tatort (taht-ort) (Crime Scene), a murder mystery/thriller. You may also want to try Deutsche Welle (doy-che vêl-e) (German radio) (www.dw-world.de), which broadcasts both radio and TV programs in many languages, including German and English, or radioWissen (rah-dee-oh vis-en) (radio knowledge), which offers quality radio broadcasts in German (www.br-online.de/bayern2/radiowissen).

Looking for something else in German? Just type the topic into a major search engine, plus the international code: .de for Germany, .at for Austria, and .ch for Switzerland. For a directory of German news online, go to: http:// www.onlinenewspapers.com/germany.htm. Another great resource is http://www.goethe.de/enindex.htm.

117 Book I Getting Started with German

118

Book I: Getting Started with German

Chapter 6

Shopping Simplified In This Chapter ▶ Deciding where and when to shop ▶ Finding items, browsing, and asking for help ▶ Focusing on clothes as you shop ▶ Making purchases after you find what you need

S

hopping in another country can be a fun way to dive into the culture and rub elbows with the locals. In many large European cities, you can either hunt for unique items in small shops and boutiques or, if you’re in the mood for one-stop shopping, head for the major department stores. When you’re traveling, whether for business or pleasure, you probably want to bring back one or two Andenken (ân-dênk-en) (souvenirs) to remind you of the time you spent abroad. Whether you choose to buy an article of clothing, a knife set, or a beer mug, picking just the right item is part of the fun of going on a trip. In this chapter, you become familiar with the terms and phrases you would use during a shopping trip — from browsing and asking for help to trying on and purchasing your finds.

Getting Familiar with the German Shopping Experience City centers often have large pedestrian zones featuring all kinds of stores and restaurants, making them ideal settings for leisurely strolls and window shopping, which is called Schaufensterbummel (shou-fêns-ter-boom-el). When you’re tired of shopping, you can sit down at a café in the pedestrian zone and watch the passers-by before doing some more shopping.

120

Book I: Getting Started with German

Identifying types of shops Like the U.S., Germany offers plenty of shopping opportunities in places like the following: ✓ die Apotheke (dee ah-poh-tey-ke) (pharmacy) ✓ das Blumengeschäft (dâs blooh-men-ge-shêft) (flower shop) ✓ die Boutique (dee boutique [as in English]) (boutique) ✓ die Buchhandlung (dee boohH-hând-loong) (bookstore) ✓ der Computerladen (dêr computer [as in English] lah-den) (computer store) ✓ die Drogerie (dee drohg-êr-ee) (drug store) (Note: This is a store that sells toiletry items and over-the-counter medicines. For prescription drugs, go to die Apotheke.) ✓ das Einkaufszentrum (dâs ayn-koufs-tsên-troom) (shopping center) ✓ das Fachgeschäft (dâs fâH-ge-shêft) (store specializing in a line of products) ✓ der Flohmarkt (dêr floh-mârkt) (flea market) ✓ die Fußgängerzone (dee foohs-gêng-er-tsoh-ne) (pedestrian zone) ✓ das Geschäft (dâs ge-shêft) (business, store) ✓ das Juweliergeschäft (dâs yoo-ve-leer-ge-shêft) (jewelry store) ✓ das Kaufhaus (dâs kouf-hous) (department store) ✓ der Kiosk (dêr kee-osk) (newsstand) ✓ der Laden (dêr lah-den) (store, shop) ✓ das Schreibwarengeschäft (dâs shrayb-vâr-en-ge-shêft) (stationery store) ✓ das Schuhgeschäft (dâs shooh-ge-shêft) (shoe store) ✓ der Souvenirladen, der Andenkenladen (dêr zoo-ven-eer-lah-den, dêr ân-dênk-en-lah-den) (souvenir shop) ✓ das Spielwarengeschäft (dâs speel-vâr-en-ge-shêft) (toy store) ✓ das Sportgeschäft (dâs shport-ge-shêft) (sporting goods store)

Determining a store’s hours Shopping hours in Germany aren’t what you’re used to in the U.S. because German law regulates when stores can be open. For the most part, stores open at 6 a.m. and close by 8 p.m. Monday through Saturday, although Saturday hours may vary. In small towns, some stores close between noon and 2 p.m. for lunch. Most banks are open only until 4 p.m.; however, you may find some

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified banks that stay open until 6 p.m. on Thursdays. Most businesses are closed Sundays. Bakeries, which sell fresh rolls, or Brötchen (brert-Hen), are an exception to the rule that businesses are closed on Sundays, and some stores may be open in popular resort towns. If you’re looking for a place to buy sandwich fixings on a Sunday afternoon, search for 24/7 gas stations that sell a wide variety of grocery items. Or check out the shops at train stations in larger cities. To find out a store’s open hours, ask the following questions: ✓ Wann öffnen Sie? (vân erf-nen zee?) (When do you open?) ✓ Wann schließen Sie? (vân shlees-en zee?) (When do you close?)

✓ Haben Sie mittags geöffnet? (hah-ben zee mi-tahks ge-erf-net?) (Are you open during lunch?)

Finding your way around a department store If you need help finding a certain item or section in a department store, you can consult the information desk — die Auskunft (dee ous-koonft) or die Information (dee in-for-mâ-tsee-ohn). The people there should have all the answers you need. Plus, talking to the folks at the information desk provides you with a terrific opportunity to practice your questioning skills. If you’re searching for a certain item, you can ask for it by name with either of these phrases (at the end of the phrase, just fill in the plural form of the item you’re looking for): ✓ Wo bekomme ich. . . ? (voh be-kom-e iH. . . ?) (Where do I get. . . ?) ✓ Wo finde ich. . . ? (voh fin-de iH. . . ?) (Where do I find. . . ?) If you want to sound particularly nice as you ask for help, use the polite phrase Entschuldigen Sie, bitte. (ent-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te.) (Excuse me, please.) Consider, for example, the following polite question (turn to Chapter 3 in Book I for more details on polite expressions): Entschuldigen Sie, bitte, wo ist die Rolltreppe? (ent-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te, voh ist dee rol-trêp-e?) (Excuse me, please, where is the escalator?)

121 Book I Getting Started with German

122

Book I: Getting Started with German When you question the people at the information desk, they may say . . . führen wir nicht (. . . fuer-en veer niHt) (We don’t carry . . .). Or they may direct you to the appropriate section of the store, using one of the following phrases: ✓ Im Erdgeschoss/Parterre. (im êrt-ge-shos/pâr-têr.) (On the ground floor.) ✓ Im Untergeschoss. (im oon-ter-ge-shos.) (In the basement.) ✓ In der . . . Etage. (in dêr . . . ê-tah-zhe.) (On the . . . floor.) ✓ Im . . . Stock. (im . . . shtok.) (On the . . . floor.) ✓ Eine Etage höher. (ayn-e ê-tah-zhe her-her.) (One floor above.) ✓ Eine Etage tiefer. (ayn-e ê-tah-zhe teef-er.) (One floor below.) Germans (and other Europeans) look at buildings differently than Americans do. They don’t count the ground floor, das Erdgeschoss/das Parterre, as the first floor. They start numbering with the floor above the ground floor. That system makes the American second floor the German first floor, and so on, all the way to the top. If you’d like to browse through a section of the store or you’re looking for a special feature of the store, you can use the phrase Wo finde ich. . . ? (voh fin-de iH. . . ?) (Where do I find. . . ?), ending the phrase with one of the following expressions: ✓ den Aufzug/den Fahrstuhl (deyn ouf-tsook/deyn fâr-shtoohl) (elevator) ✓ die Damenabteilung (dee dah-mên-âp-tay-loong) (ladies’ department) ✓ die Herrenabteilung (dee hêr-en-âp-tay-loong) (men’s department) ✓ die Kasse (dee kâs-e) (checkout counter) ✓ die Kinderabteilung (dee kin-der-âp-tay-loong) (children’s department) ✓ die Rolltreppe (dee rol-trêp-e) (escalator) ✓ die Schmuckabteilung (dee shmook-âp-tay-loong) (jewelry department) ✓ die Schuhabteilung (dee shooh-âp-tay-loong) (shoe department) ✓ die Toiletten (dee toy-lêt-en) (restrooms) ✓ die Umkleidekabinen (dee oom-klayd-e-kâ-been-en) (fitting rooms)

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified

Browsing and responding to “Kann ich Ihnen helfen?” Sometimes you just want to check out the merchandise in the store on your own without anybody breathing down your neck. However, store assistants may offer their help by saying something like the following: Kann ich Ihnen helfen? (kân iH een-en hêlf-en?) (Can I help you?) Kann ich Ihnen behilflich sein? (kân iH een-en be-hilf-liH zayn?) (Can I help you?) Suchen Sie etwas Bestimmtes? (zoohH-en zee êt-vâs be-shtim-tes?) (Are you looking for something in particular?) When all you want to do is browse, use this phrase to politely turn down help: Ich möchte mich nur umsehen. (iH merH-te miH noohr oom-zey-en.) (I just want to look around.) The store assistant will probably tell you it’s okay to keep browsing by saying either of the following: Aber natürlich. Sagen Sie Bescheid, wenn Sie eine Frage haben. (ahber nâ-tuer-liH. zah-gen zee be-shayt, vên zee ayn-e frah-ge hah-ben.) (Of course. Just let me know if you need help.) Rufen Sie mich, wenn Sie eine Frage haben. (rooh-fen zee miH, vên zee ayn-e frah-ge hah-ben.) (Call me if you have a question.)

Getting assistance In some situations, you may want or need assistance while you’re shopping. Here are some useful phrases you can use to get the help you need: Würden Sie mir bitte helfen? Ich suche. . . . (vuer-den zee meer bi-te hêlfen. iH zoohH-e. . . .) (Would you help me, please? I’m looking for. . . .) Aber gern, hier entlang bitte. (ah-ber gêrn, heer ênt-lâng bi-te.) (Certainly. This way please.) Welche Größe suchen Sie? (vêl-He grer-se zoohH-en zee?) (What size are you looking for?)

123 Book I Getting Started with German

124

Book I: Getting Started with German Haben Sie so etwas in Größe/in rot, blau. . . ? (hah-ben zee zoh êt-vâs in grer-se/in roht, blou. . . ?) (Do you have something like this in size/in red, blue. . . ?) Wie gefällt Ihnen diese Farbe? (vee ge-fêlt een-en deez-e fâr-be?) (How do you like this color?) Thanks to the education system, most sales people in Austrian, German, and Swiss stores are competent and knowledgeable. As is the case in most trades, salespeople generally complete a comprehensive three-year apprenticeship that combines on-the-job training with trade school instruction.

Shopping for Clothes When you’re shopping for clothes, you have to decide what you want in terms of item, color, size, fabric, style, and, so on. This section breaks down these criteria to help make your shopping experience go as smoothly as possible. Notice that some terms for clothing are the same in English and others that appear to be English words have different meanings in German.

Characterizing various clothing items Some clothing items are unisex, while others are typical for either men or women. In this section, you get to know all the different types of clothes you may see in a German store, including casual and formal attire, outerwear, and accessories. You also find out how to describe fabrics, styles, and colors. Some terms that apply to female clothes include the following: ✓ der Badeanzug (dêr bah-de-ân-tsook) (bathing suit) ✓ die Bluse (dee blooh-ze) (blouse) ✓ der Hosenanzug (dêr hoh-zen-ân-tsook) (pantsuit) ✓ das Kleid (dâs klayt) (dress) ✓ das Kostüm (dâs kos-tuem) (suit, fancy dress) ✓ der Rock (dêr rok) (skirt) ✓ die Strumpfhose (dee shtroompf-hoh-ze) (panty hose)

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified The following words usually apply to clothing for men: ✓ der Anzug (dêr ân-tsook) (suit) ✓ die Badehose (dee bah-de-hoh-ze) (swimming trunks) ✓ die Krawatte (dee krâ-vât-e) (tie) Generally speaking, both men and women wear the following items:

✓ der Blazer (dêr bley-zer) (blazer)

✓ das Hemd (dâs hêmt) (shirt) ✓ die Hose (dee hoh-ze) (pants) ✓ das Jackett/die Jacke (dâs jhâ-kêt/dee yâ-ke) (jacket) ✓ die Jeans (dee jeans [as in English]) (jeans) ✓ der Mantel (dêr mân-tel) (coat) ✓ der Pullover/der Pulli (dêr pool-oh-ver/dêr poo-lee) (sweater) ✓ der Pullunder (dêr poo-loon-der) (tank top) ✓ der Pyjama (dêr pêr-jah-mâ) (pajamas) ✓ der Regenmantel (dêr rey-gen-mân-tel) (raincoat) ✓ die Sandalen (dee zân-dahl-en) (sandals) ✓ die Schuhe (dee shooh-e) (shoes) ✓ die Shorts/die kurze Hose (dee shorts [as in English]/dee koorts-ehoh-ze) (shorts) ✓ die Socken/die Strümpfe (dee zok-en/dee shtruempf-e) (socks) ✓ die Stiefel (dee shteef-el) (boots) ✓ die Strickjacke (dee shtrik-yâ-ke) (cardigan) ✓ das Sweatshirt (dâs sweatshirt [as in English]) (sweatshirt) ✓ das T-Shirt (dâs T-shirt [as in English]) (T-shirt) ✓ die Unterwäsche (dee oon-ter-vêsh-e) (underwear) ✓ die Volkstracht (dee folks-trâHt) (folk costume) ✓ die Weste (dee vês-te) (vest)

125 Book I Getting Started with German

126

Book I: Getting Started with German You may find the following items listed in a store directory as das Zubehör (dâs tsooh-bê-herr) (accessories): ✓ der Gürtel (dêr guer-tel) (belt) ✓ die Handschuhe (dee hând-shooh-e) (gloves) ✓ die Handtasche (dee hând-tâsh-e) (purse, handbag) ✓ der Hut (dêr hooht) (hat) ✓ die Mütze (dee muets-e) (cap) ✓ der Schal (dêr shâl) (scarf) ✓ der Schmuck (dêr shmook) (jewelry) ✓ die Sonnenbrille (dee zon-en-bril-e) (sunglasses) Clothing and accessory items such as the ones in the preceding lists can come in any number of fabrics, including the following: ✓ die Baumwolle (dee boum-vol-e) (cotton) ✓ der Flanell (dêr flan-êl) (flannel) ✓ das Fleece (dâs fleece [as in English]) (fleece) ✓ der Kord (dêr kord) (corduroy) ✓ die Kunstfaser (dee koonst-fâz-er) (synthetic material) ✓ das Leder (dâs ley-der) (leather) ✓ das Leinen (dâs layn-en) (linen) ✓ das Nylon (dâs ner-lon) (nylon) ✓ der Polyester (dêr po-lee-êst-er) (polyester) ✓ der Samt (dêr zâmt) (velvet) ✓ die Seide (dee zay-de) (silk) ✓ der Wildleder (dêr vilt-ley-der) (suede) ✓ die Wolle (dee vol-e) (wool) Clothing items can also come in any number of styles, including the following: ✓ bunt (boont) (multicolored) ✓ einfarbig (ayn-fâr-biH) (solid color) ✓ elegant (ê-le-gânt) (elegant)

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified

127

✓ gepunktet (ge-poonk-tet) (with dots)

Book I

✓ gestreift (ge-shtrayft) (striped)

Getting Started with German

✓ kariert (kâr-eert) (checkered) ✓ lässig (lês-iH) (casual) ✓ modisch (moh-dish) (fashionable) ✓ sportlich (shport-liH) (sporty) Figure 6-1 shows a variety of clothing items with their German names. Whether you’re looking for a new dress, a belt, or a pair of pants, you probably have a particular color in mind (or a color that you absolutely will not wear!). The basic Farben (fâr-ben) (colors) are ✓ beige (beige [as in English]) (beige) ✓ blau (blou) (blue) ✓ braun (brown [as in English]) (brown)

Figure 6-1: Common clothing items.

Illustration by Elizabeth Kurtzman

128

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ gelb (gêlp) (yellow) ✓ gold (golt) (gold) ✓ grau (grou) (gray) ✓ grün (gruen) (green) ✓ lila (lee-lâ) (purple) ✓ orange (o-rânch) (orange) ✓ rosa (roh-za) (pink) ✓ rot (roht) (red) ✓ schwarz (shvârts) (black) ✓ silber (zil-ber) (silver) ✓ türkis (tuer-kees) (turquoise) ✓ violett (vee-oh-lêt) (violet) ✓ weiß (vays) (white) To describe dark and light shades of colors, use the following terms: ✓ dunkel (doon-kel) (dark) ✓ hell (hêl) (light) Combine dunkel or hell with a color like this: ✓ dunkelblau (doon-kel blou) (dark blue) ✓ hellgrün (hêl gruen) (light green) All these color words are adjectives. To find out how to fit them into phrases and sentences, check out Chapter 5 in Book III.

Knowing your size Finding the right size clothing can be a pain in the neck in any shopping situation. When shopping in German-speaking countries, though, you get a double whammy: Clothes sizes aren’t the same as they are in the U.S. The charts in this section provide useful guidelines to help you crack the code. Here are the approximate equivalents for sizes of women’s clothes. You simply add 30 to the American size to get the German size.

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified American German

4 34

6 36

8 38

10 40

12 42

14 44

16 46

18 48

20 50

Book I

For men’s jacket and suit sizes, use the following approximate conversions. You just add 10 to the American size to get the German size. American German

34 44

36 46

38 48

40 50

42 52

44 54

46 56

48 58

50 60

For men’s shirts, keep in mind these approximate neck size conversions: American German

14 36

14.5 37

15 38

15.5 39

16 40

16.5 41

17 42

17.5 43

18 44

The following chart shows approximate equivalents for women’s shoe sizes: American German American German

5 51⁄2 6 35–36 36 36–37 11 10 101⁄2 40–41 41 41–42

61⁄2 37

7 37–38

71⁄2 38

8 38–39

81⁄2 39

91⁄2 39–40

91⁄2 40

For men’s shoe sizes, refer to the following approximate equivalents: American German American German

61⁄2 39 11 44

7 71⁄2 40 40–41 12 111⁄2 44–45 45

8 41 13 46

81⁄2 41–42

9 42

91⁄2 42–43

10 43

101⁄2 43–44

Talkin’ the Talk Frau Schulte is in the ladies’ section of a department store. She wants to buy a blouse and is getting assistance from a Verkäuferin (saleswoman). (Track 17) Verkäuferin: Kann ich Ihnen behilflich sein? kân iH een-en be-hilf-liH zayn? Can I help you? Frau Schulte: Ja bitte. Ich suche eine Bluse. yah bi-te. iH zoohH-e ayn-e blooh-ze. Yes, please. I’m looking for a blouse.

129 Getting Started with German

130

Book I: Getting Started with German Verkäuferin: Hier entlang, bitte. Welche Farbe soll es denn sein? heer ênt-lang, bi-te. vêlH-e fâr-be zol ês dên zayn? Please come this way. What color do you want? Frau Schulte: Weiß. Vays. White. Verkäuferin: Suchen Sie etwas Lässiges? zoohH-en zee êt-vâs lês-ee-ges? Are you looking for something casual? Frau Schulte: Nein, eher etwas Elegantes. nayn, ê-her êt-vâs ey-le-gân-tes. No, rather something elegant. Verkäuferin: Gut. Welche Größe haben Sie? gooht. vêlH-e grer-se hah-ben zee? Good. What is your size? Frau Schulte: Größe 38. grer-se âHt-toon-dray-siH. Size 38. Verkäuferin: Wie gefällt Ihnen dieses Modell? vee ge-fêlt een-en deez-es mo-dêl? How do you like this style? Frau Schulte: Sehr gut. zeyr gooht. Very much.

Trying on clothes When you find an article of clothing that looks promising, you may want to try it on. In that case, you can ask the sales assistant the following question, inserting the name of the article you want to try on: Kann ich . . . anprobieren? (kân iH . . . ân-pro-bee-ren?) (Can I try . . . on?) Or a sales assistant may anticipate your question and ask this question: Möchten Sie . . . anprobieren? (merH-ten zee . . . ân-pro-bee-ren?) (Would you like to try . . . on?)

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified

131 Book I

Words to Know (zu) eng

(tsooh) êng

(too) tight

weit

vayt

loose

lang

lâng

long

kurz

koorts

short

groß

grohs

big

klein

klayn

small

die Abteilung

dee âb-tay-loong

department

die Größe

dee grer-se

size

die Farbe

dee fâr-be

color

das Modell, der Stil

dâs mo-dêl, der shtil

style

anprobieren

ân-pro-bee-ren

to try on

bringen

bring-en

to bring

passen

pâs-en

to fit

stehen

stey-en

to suit

gefallen

ge-fâl-en

to like

gefällt mir

ge-fêlt meer

I like

hier entlang

heer ênt-lâng

this way

die Umkleidekabine

dee oom-klay-dekâ-been-e

fitting room

kaufen

kouf-en

to buy

In either case, the next step is going to the dressing rooms, which you can ask about by saying: Wo sind die Umkleidekabinen? (voh zint dee oom-klay-de-kâ-been-en?) (Where are the fitting rooms?)

Getting Started with German

132

Book I: Getting Started with German After you try on your item, the sales assistant may ask you one of the following questions to find out what you think of it: Passt. . . ? (pâst. . . ?) (Does . . . fit?) Wie passt Ihnen. . . ? (wie pâst een-en. . . ?) (How does . . . fit you?) Gefällt Ihnen. . . ? (ge-fêlt een-en. . . ?) (Do you like. . . ?) You can answer with any of the following, depending on how things went when you tried on your item: Nein, . . . ist zu lang/kurz/eng/weit/groß/klein. (nayn, . . . ist tsooh lâng/ koorts/êng/vayt/grohs/klayn.) (No, . . . is too long/short/tight/loose/big/ small.) Können Sie mir eine andere Größe bringen? (kern-en zee meer ayn-e ânde-re grer-se bring-en?) (Can you get me another size?) . . . passt sehr gut. (. . . pâst zeyr gooht.) (. . . fits very well.) . . . steht mir. (. . . shteyt meer.) (. . . suits me.) . . . gefällt mir. (. . . ge-fêlt meer.) (I like . . .) Ich nehme. . . . (IH ney-me. . . . ) (I’ll take. . . .)

Talkin’ the Talk

Frau Schulte likes the blouse the saleswoman has shown her and wants to try it on. Here’s a look at their conversation. (Track 18) Frau Schulte: Ich möchte diese Bluse anprobieren. Wo sind die Umkleidekabinen, bitte? iH merH-te deez-e blooh-ze ân-pro-bee-ren. voh zint dee oom-klay-de-kâ-been-en, bi-te? I would like to try on this blouse. Where are the fitting rooms, please? Verkäuferin: Ja, natürlich. Da drüben sind die Umkleidekabinen. yah, nâ-tuer-liH. dâ drue-ben zint dee oom-klay-de-kâ-been-en. Of course. The fitting rooms are over there. (A few minutes later Frau Schulte returns.)

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified Verkäuferin: Passt die Bluse? pâst dee blooh-ze? Does the blouse fit? Frau Schulte: Ja. Ich nehme die Bluse. yah. iH ney-me dee blooh-ze. Yes. I’ll take the blouse.

Making Your Purchase After selecting one or more items that you really like, you’re ready to make your purchase. You’re standing, sweater in hand, at the Kasse (kâs-e) (checkout counter, cash register), and the moment of reckoning comes when you have to pay.

Preparing to pay for your items Stores in Europe generally accept most major credit cards, although some small shops and places like flea markets take only cash. Even at stores that take credit cards, however, you may prefer to withdraw money at an ATM before you shop and then use cash to pay for whatever you buy. At any rate, before you leave the U.S., find out about any fees your credit card company may charge you for using your card outside the U.S. Here are some terms you may find useful to know when you’re getting ready to make your purchases: ✓ der Beleg (dêr be-leyk) (receipt, slip) ✓ der Bruttobetrag (dêr broot-oh-be-trâk) (total amount) ✓ die Kasse (dee kâs-e) (checkout counter, cash register) ✓ der Nettobetrag (dêr nêt-oh-be-trâk) (net amount) ✓ die Mehrwertsteuer (dee meyr-vêrt-shtoy-er) (sales tax) ✓ der Preis (dêr prays) (price) ✓ die Quittung (dee kvit-oong) (receipt) ✓ die Waren (dee vahr-en) (goods, merchandise)

133 Book I Getting Started with German

134

Book I: Getting Started with German Occasionally, you may find yourself in a situation where you need to ask about the price (der Preis) of an item. Price tags, being the devious little critters that they are, have a way of falling off or being indecipherable, especially when handwritten. Consider this case in point: The German number 1 can look a lot like the American number 7 when scrawled by hand. But not to worry. The following simple phrases take care of the price question should you need to ask it: Was kostet. . . ? (vâs kos-tet. . . ?) (What does . . . cost?) Wie viel kostet. . . ? (vee feel kos-tet. . . ?) (How much does . . . cost?) After you decide to purchase something, the following questions may help you as you proceed to the cash register: Wo ist die Kasse? (voh ist dee kâs-e?) (Where is the checkout counter?) Kann ich mit Kreditkarte bezahlen? (kân iH mit krê-dit-kâr-te be-tsahlen?) (Can I pay with a credit card?) You may hear the salesperson say one of the following in response: Ja, sicher. (Ya, zeeH-er.) (Yes, certainly.) Ja, selbstverständlich. (Ya, zêlpst-fêr-shtênt-liH.) (Yes, of course.) Aber, natürlich. (ah-ber nâ-tuer-liH.) (But, of course.) Es tut mir leid. Wir nehmen nur Bargeld. (ês toot mir layd. veer ney-men noor bâr-gêlt.) (I’m sorry. We only accept cash.)

Talkin’ the Talk Frau Schulte heads to the cash register to pay for her purchase. Consider how her conversation with the Kassiererin (cashier) goes. Kassiererin: Das macht 49 Euro. dâs mâHt noyn-oont-feer-tsiH oy-roh. That’s 49 euros, please. Frau Schulte: Nehmen Sie Kreditkarten? ney-men see krey-dit-kâr-ten? Can I pay by credit card?

Chapter 6: Shopping Simplified Kassiererin: Kein Problem. kayn pro-bleym. No problem. Frau Schulte: Hier bitte. heer bi-te. Here you are. Kassiererin: Danke. Würden Sie bitte unterschreiben? Und hier ist Ihre Quittung. dân-ke. wuer-den zee bi-te un-ter-schray-ben? oont heer ist eer-e kvit-oong. Thanks. Would you please sign here? And here is your receipt. Frau Schulte: Danke! dân-ke! Thanks!

Getting a tax refund on your purchases Most of the time, when you go shopping, every piece of merchandise has a tag that tells you exactly how much it costs. The price you see on a price tag is what you pay for the item at the cash register, including sales tax, called the VAT (or value added tax). The German word for VAT is die Mehrwertsteuer (MwSt) (dee mêr-vêrt-shtoy-er). In Germany, most items, including clothing, are taxed at 19 percent, although some select goods are taxed at 7 percent. The good news is, you may be able to get a tax refund on items of value.

If you don’t reside in a country of the European Union (EU), you usually can get a refund for the VAT tax when you leave the EU. The VAT refund is referred to as — take a deep breath — die Mehrwertsteuerrückerstattung (dee mêr-vêrt-shtoy-er-ruek-êr-shtât-oong). Although the German word for the VAT refund looks a bit daunting, the process for getting it back is usually simple. Just ask for a VAT refund form when you pay at the register. Collect all the receipts and forms for merchandise you’re taking out of the EU, and then you can have a customs agent at the airport approve everything before you leave the EU to return home. (Because you must show the items, don’t pack them with your checked luggage!)

135 Book I Getting Started with German

136

Book I: Getting Started with German

Words to Know kosten

kos-ten

to cost

der Preis

dêr prays

price

d ie Mehrwertsteuer (MwSt)

dee mêr-vêrt-shtoy-er

tax (VAT)

d ie Mehrwertsteuer rückerstattung

d ee mêr-vêrt-shtoy-erruek-êr-shtât-oong

VAT refund

Chapter 7

Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! In This Chapter ▶ Talking about hunger, thirst, and meals ▶ Eating out at a restaurant or other eatery ▶ Buying food at a grocery store or outdoor market

E

xploring the food and eating habits of people in another country is one of the most interesting — and tasty — ways to learn about their culture. One of the first differences you may notice when dining in Europe is the slower pace, which allows you time to linger after eating your food, even in simpler locales. You don’t feel pressured by the service personnel to finish up, pay, and vacate the table for the next patrons. The epitome of life in the slow lane can still be experienced at traditional cafés, the most famous of which are in Vienna. You grab a newspaper conveniently attached to a stick with a handle, order a cup of coffee served with a glass of water on a small silver tray, and read to your heart’s content. When eating out in German-speaking Europe, one thing that isn’t much different from what you’re probably used to is the way the food is prepared. A traditional German meal consists of meat, potatoes, and vegetables or a salad. However, local cuisines vary from region to region, and we heartily suggest you try them whenever you can. Whether you’re interested in having a business lunch or enjoying a casual dinner, this chapter helps you find your way around food. You get the hang of deciphering a menu, ordering in a restaurant, and buying food items at an open air market. You get the lowdown on the standard practice of seating yourself in many restaurants. You discover how to get the server’s attention, and you find out about tipping. In short, this chapter gets you ready to eat and drink your way through Germany, Austria, and Switzerland.

138

Book I: Getting Started with German

Talking about Eating and Drinking The geographical features of German-speaking regions play a role in the types of food found on menus and in food markets. For instance, in the north of Germany, you find fresh fish from the North Sea. Traveling south, you come across some well-known foods, like Schweinebraten (shvayn-e-brât-en) (roast pork), as well as some surprises, like weißer Spargel (vays-er shpâr-gel) (white asparagus), a delicacy only available for a short period of time in the spring. Switzerland produces some world-famous alpine cheeses like Emmentaler (êmen-tâl-er) (emmentaler) and Appenzeller (âp-en-tsêl-er) (appenzeller). A pleasant surprise in the form of a spreadable fresh cheese is Quark (kvârk) (quark), a common dairy product hardly known in North America. You find Quark in cheesecake, dips, and spreads. Potatoes and cabbage are grown in many regions, as well as a number of lesser known vegetables like Kohlrabi (kohlrâ-bee) (kohlrabi), Lauch (louH) (leeks), and Sellerie (zêl-êr-ee) (celeriac). You find these ingredients in hearty meat and vegetable stews. Germans also have some great snacks you may like to try. Often, the best Bratwurst (brât-voorst) (bratwurst) are served at unassuming fast-food stands. Three of the most popular snacks you can enjoy in a Bavarian Biergarten (beer-gâr-ten) (beer garden) are mammoth-sized, freshly baked Brezen (breyttsen) (pretzels), often eaten together with Obatzter (oh-bats-ter) (a spreadable blend of camembert cheese, Quark [kvârk] [quark], and diced onions), Steckerlfisch (shtêk-erl-fish) (fish on a stick), and a long piece of artfully sliced giant white radish called Radi (râ-dee) that looks like a curlicue streamer. Germany, Austria, and Switzerland each have variations in their cooking styles and tastes, yet German-speaking regions and their cuisines extend beyond these three countries. In the region of Elsaß (êl-zâs) (Alsace) in eastern France, people still speak a dialect of German, and their cuisine reflects a remarkable blend of French and German cuisine. The northern part of Italy known as Südtirol (zued-tir-ol) (south Tyrol) is partly German speaking, so you may find menus that reflect a blend of Italian and German cuisine. Want to know more about German food? Read on. Whatever meal you decide to enjoy, remember to say Guten Appetit (gooh-ten âp-e-teet) (enjoy your meal) as the Germans do with each other before they start to eat!

Saying you’re hungry and thirsty: Hast du Hunger? Hast du Durst? When it comes to food, expressing your hunger and thirst are important. Otherwise, you have no cure for your grumbling stomach and parched throat. Here’s how you talk about being hungry or thirsty in German:

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! Ich habe Hunger/Durst. (iH hah-be hoong-er/doorst.) (I am hungry/thirsty. Literally: I have hunger/thirst.) Ich bin hungrig/durstig. (iH bin hoong-riH/door-stiH.) (I am hungry/thirsty.) To satisfy your hunger or thirst, you have to eat — essen (ês-en) — and you have to drink — trinken (trin-ken). Here are the conjugations for essen, which is an irregular verb, and trinken (see Book III, Chapter 3 for more information on conjugating verbs in the present tense): essen (to eat) ich esse

wir essen

du isst

ihr esst

er/sie/es isst

sie essen Sie essen

Wir essen gern Fisch. (We like to eat fish.)

trinken (to drink) ich trinke

wir trinken

du trinkst

ihr trinkt

er/sie/es trinkt

sie trinken Sie trinken

Trinkst du Bier? (Do you drink beer?)

Talking about meals: Guten Appetit! German meals and meal times don’t differ too much from their American counterparts. The three Mahlzeiten (mahl-tsayt-en) (meals) of the day are ✓ das Frühstück (dâs frue-shtuek) (breakfast) ✓ das Mittagessen (dâs mi-tahk-ês-en) (lunch) ✓ das Abendessen (dâs ah-bent-ês-en) (dinner) In most cafés and hotels, breakfast is served from 7 a.m. to 10 a.m., and it’s often more substantial than the typical continental breakfast served in North America. In lodgings such as hostels and bed-and-breakfasts, breakfast may end at 9 a.m., so it’s a good idea to check first before turning in for the night. In smaller eateries, a hot lunch is usually served only between 11:30 a.m. and 2:00 p.m. For some Germans, lunch is the main meal of the day; for others,

139 Book I Getting Started with German

140

Book I: Getting Started with German the main meal comes at dinnertime. In restaurants, a full menu is generally available between 6:30 p.m. and 9:00 p.m. In larger cities, restaurants may offer a full menu until 11 p.m. In addition, fast-food places abound, including several well-known American hamburger restaurant chains, where, interestingly enough, you can order beer. The traditional cold evening meal in German homes consists of bread with cold meats, cheeses, salad, and other cold dishes. This same fare is what families and friends in southern Germany have at the local Biergarten (dêr beer-gâr-ten) (beer garden), where they spread their food out on a picnic table and enjoy warm summer evenings with eine Maß Bier (ayn-e mahs beer [as in English]) (a liter of beer). You may occasionally hear people say Mahlzeit! (mahl-tsayt) as a greeting at lunchtime. Roughly translated, the word means mealtime in English. This greeting is especially common among colleagues at the workplace. If someone says this to you, just say the same — Mahlzeit! — and smile.

Setting the table The German table features all the same items that you find on your table at home, including the following: ✓ der Becher (dêr bêH-er) (mug) ✓ das Besteck (dâs be-shtêk) (a set of a knife, fork, and spoon) ✓ die Gabel (dee gah-bel) (fork) ✓ das Glas (dâs glahs) (glass) ✓ der Kaffeelöffel/der Teelöffel (kâf-ey-ler-fel/tey-ler-fel) (teaspoon) ✓ der Löffel (dêr ler-fel) (spoon) ✓ das Messer (dâs mês-er) (knife) ✓ die Serviette (dee sêr-vee-êt-e) (napkin) ✓ der Suppenlöffel/der Esslöffel (dêr zoop-enler-fel/dêr ês-ler-fel) (soup spoon) ✓ der Suppenteller (dêr zoop-en-têl-er) (soup bowl) ✓ die Tasse (dee tâs-e) (cup) ✓ der Teller (dêr têl-er) (plate) ✓ die Tischdecke (dee tish-dêk-e) (tablecloth) ✓ der Unterteller (dêr oon-ter-têl-er) (saucer)

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! If you’re in a restaurant and need an item not found on the table (for example, a spoon, fork, or knife), call the waiter over by saying the following: Entschuldigen Sie, bitte! (ênt-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te!) (Excuse me, please!) After you get the waiter’s attention, ask for what you need: Kann ich bitte einen Löffel/eine Gabel/ein Messer haben? (kân iH bi-te ayn-en ler-fel/ayn-e gah-bel/ayn mês-er hah-ben?) (Can I please have a spoon/a fork/a knife?)

Going to a Restaurant: Das Restaurant Eating out is quite popular in Germany, and you’ll find a couple of differences between going to a restaurant in Germany and going to one in the U.S. For instance, in many German restaurants, you don’t have to wait to be seated as you do in the U.S. However, in more upscale places, the server usually does take you to your table. Also, doggie bags aren’t common practice in Germany. But, surprisingly, dogs are generally welcome in many restaurants if they sit under the table.

Europeans in general place great value on the dining experience. Overall, you can expect a more leisurely pace while enjoying your meal in Europe. In fact, don’t expect your server to bring the check after you’ve finished your meal — until you ask for it. In the following sections, you become acquainted with dining out in Germany so you can get the most from your experience.

Deciding where to eat Most German eateries post a menu (see Figure 7-1) at their entrances, so you can easily tell what kind of dining experience you would have there. This display is helpful when you’re looking for a place to eat. However, if you want to ask someone about a particular kind of eatery, you need to know what kinds are available. Here are the most common ones: ✓ der Biergarten (dêr beer-gâr-ten) (beer garden): This outdoor Bavarian institution is a casual family place that serves snacks and beer in 1-liter mugs. At a traditional Biergarten, you sit at picnic tables under the shade of chestnut trees, and you may bring your own food and a tablecloth.

141 Book I Getting Started with German

142

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ die Bierhalle (dee beer-hâl-e)/die Bierstube (dee beer-shtooh-be) (beer hall): Beer halls, of course, specialize in beer served from huge barrels. But besides beer, you can also order hot dishes (usually deciding among a few dishes of the day), salads, and pretzels. The best-known beer halls are in Munich, Bavaria, where the Oktoberfest (ok-toh-ber-fêst) takes place for two weeks beginning in late September. At this event, each Munich brewery sets up a massive Bierzelt (beer-tsêlt) (beer tent). ✓ das Café (dâs café [as in English]) (café): Cafés may range from places to have Kaffee und Kuchen (kâf-ey oont koohH-en) (coffee and cake) to upscale establishments with full menus. Vienna’s café tradition is famous. In these cafés, you can sit down for a leisurely cup of fine coffee and read the newspaper. ✓ das Gasthaus (dâs gâst-hous)/der Gasthof (dêr gâst-hohf) (inn): You usually find these inns in the country. They often offer home cooking, and the atmosphere may be rather folksy. In rural areas, some offer lodging. ✓ die Gaststätte (dee gâst-shtêt-e) (local type of restaurant): This restaurant is a simpler type where you’re likely to find local specialties. ✓ der Heuriger (dêr hoy-ree-ger) (wine tavern): Located in the wineproducing regions of eastern Austria, these tradition-bound taverns are open for only a few weeks each year, at which time they may serve their own most recently produced wine of that year, together with a selection of locally made cold foods. ✓ die Kneipe (dee knayp-e) (bar-restaurant): This type of bar-restaurant combination is similar to what you may find in the U.S. You usually find a casual atmosphere here where the locals hang out. ✓ die Raststätte (dee râst-shtêt-e) (roadside restaurant): These restaurants usually are found on the Autobahn. They provide service station facilities and sometimes even lodging. Note: In Austria, these restaurants are called der Rasthof (dêr râst-hohf). ✓ der Ratskeller (dêr rahts-kêl-er): This type of restaurant is named after an eatery in the Keller (kêl-er) (cellar) of the Rathaus (raht-hous) (town hall). You often find these in historic buildings. ✓ das Restaurant (dâs rês-tuh-ron) (restaurant): You find a similar variety of restaurants in Germany that you find in the U.S., ranging from simple to fancy establishments with corresponding menus and prices. ✓ der (Schnell)imbiss (dêr [shnêl-]im-bis) or der (Steh)imbiss (dêr [shteyl-] im-bis) (snack bar, fast-food restaurant): Here, you can get food like Wurst (woorst) (sausage) and Pommes frites (pom frit) (french fries). ✓ die Weinstube (dee vayn-shtooh-be) (wine bar): At this cozy restaurant, often found in wine-producing areas, you can sample wine with bar food and snacks.

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit!

143 Book I

Gasthaus zum Löwen

Gasthaus zum Löwen

Speisekarte

Menu

Vorspeisen

(fohr-shpayz-en)

Gemischter Salat

(ge-mish-ter zâ-laht)

4,00 €

Mixed salad

4,00 €

Grüner Salat

(gruen-er zâ-laht)

3,50 €

Green salad

3,50 €

Melone mit Schinken

(mê-loh-ne mit shin-ken)

5,20 €

Melon with ham

5,20 €

6,50 €

Seafood salad with toast

6,50 €

Meeresfrüchtesalat mit Toast (mey-res-frueH-te-zâ-laht mit tohst)

Figure 7-1: German restaurants typically post a menu near the door.

Getting Started with German

Appetizers

Suppen

(zoop-en)

Tomatensuppe

(toh-mah-ten-zoop-e)

3,00 €

Tomato soup

3,00 €

Kartoffelcremesuppe

(kâr-to-fel-kreym-zoop-e)

3,80 €

Cream of potato soup

3,80 €

Gulaschsuppe

(gooh-lash-zoop-e)

6,20 €

Hearty beef/pork soup

6,20 €

Französische Zwiebelsuppe

(frân-tser-zi-she tsvee-bel-zoop-e)

5,50 €

French onion soup

5,50 €

Hauptspeisen

(houpt-shpayz-en)

Gefüllte Hühnerbrust mit Kartoffelpüree

(ge-fuel-te huen-er-broost mit kâr-to-fel-puer-ey)

Frischer Spargel mit Räucherschinken

(fri-sher shpâr-gel mit royH-er-shin-ken)

Rumpsteak mit Pommes Frites (roomp-steak mit pom frit und gemischtem Salat oont ge-mish-tem zâ-laht)

Soups

Main Dishes 9,50 €

Stuffed chicken breast with mashed potatoes

9,50 €

12,90 €

Fresh asparagus with smoked ham

12,90 €

14,50 €

Rump steak with french fries and mixed salad

14,50 €

Illustration by Elizabeth Kurtzman

Making reservations Making reservations isn’t always necessary in Germany. In fact, during the week you may be able to get a table without a reservation — unless you’re going to a particularly trendy place or one with limited seating. You usually don’t make reservations at a Kneipe or Gaststätte; you get a table on a firstcome, first-served basis. However, if you want to be on the safe side, call ahead to make a reservation. When making a reservation, consider using the following expressions: Ich möchte gern einen Tisch reservieren/bestellen. (iH merH-te gêrn ayn-en tish rê-zêr-vee-ren/be-shtêl-en.) (I would like to reserve a table.) Haben Sie um . . . Uhr einen Tisch frei? (hah-ben zee oom . . . oohr ayn-en tish fray?) (Do you have a table free at . . . o’clock?) Ich möchte gern einen Tisch für . . . Personen um . . . Uhr. (iH merH-te gêrn ayn-en tish fuer . . . pêr-zohn-en oom . . . oohr.) (I would like a table for . . . people at . . . o’clock.)

144

Book I: Getting Started with German

To get more specific about when you want the reservation, you can add the specific day of the week or one of the following appropriate phrases to your request: ✓ am Freitag Abend (âm fray-tahk ah-bent) (on Friday evening)

✓ heute Abend (hoy-te ah-bent) (this evening) ✓ morgen Abend (mor-gen ah-bent) (tomorrow evening) ✓ heute Mittag (hoy-te mi-tahk) (today at lunchtime) ✓ morgen Mittag (mor-gen mi-tahk) (tomorrow at lunchtime) Here’s what you may say: Ich möchte gern für heute Abend einen Tisch reservieren. (iH merH-te gêrn fuer hoy-te ah-bent ayn-en tish rê-zêr-vee-ren.) (I would like to reserve a table for this evening.) Haben Sie am Sonntag Abend um . . . Uhr einen Tisch frei? (hah-ben zee âm zon-tahk ah-bent oom . . . oohr ayn-en tish fray?) (Do you have a table free on Sunday evening at . . . o’clock?)

Talkin’ the Talk Mike and his friend Ute want to check out the trendy new Restaurant Galleria. Mike calls the restaurant to make a reservation. Restaurant: Restaurant Galleria. rês-tuh-ron gâ-le-ree-â. Restaurant Galleria. Mike:

Guten Tag. Ich möchte gern einen Tisch für heute Abend bestellen. gooh-ten tahk. iH merH-te gêrn ayn-en tish fuer hoy-te ah-bent be-shtêl-en. Hello. I would like to reserve a table for this evening.

Restaurant: Für wie viele Personen? fuer vee fee-le pêr-zohn-en? For how many people? Mike:

Zwei Personen, bitte. Haben Sie um acht Uhr einen Tisch frei? tsvay pêr-zohn-en, bi-te. hah-ben zee oom âHt oohr ayn-en tish fray?

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit!

Two people, please. Do you have a table free at eight o’clock?

Restaurant: Tut mir leid. Um acht Uhr ist alles ausgebucht. Sie können aber um acht Uhr dreißig einen Tisch haben. tooht meer layt. oom âHt oohr ist âl-ês ous-geboohHt. zee kern-en ah-bêr oom âHt oohr dray-siH ayn-en tish hah-ben. I’m sorry. At 8:00 everything’s booked. But you could have a table at 8:30. Mike:

Acht Uhr dreißig wäre auch gut. âHt oohr dray-siH vai-re ouH gooht. 8:30 would be good, too.

Restaurant: Und Ihr Name, bitte? oont eer nah-me, bi-te? And your name, please? Mike:

Evans. evans [as in English]. Evans.

Restaurant: Geht in Ordnung, ich habe den Tisch für Sie reserviert. geyt in ort-noong, iH hah-be deyn tish fuer zee rê-zêr-veert. That’s all set. I have reserved the table for you. Mike:

Vielen Dank. Bis heute Abend. fee-lên dânk. bis hoy-te ah-bent. Thank you very much. Until this evening.

Occasionally, you may call for a reservation and discover that no tables are available. In those instances, you may hear the following: Es tut mir leid. Wir sind völlig ausgebucht. (ês tooht meer layt. veer zint fer-liH ous-ge-boohHt.) (I’m sorry. We are totally booked.) If you show up at a busy restaurant without making a reservation, expect to hear one of the following: In . . . Minuten wird ein Tisch frei. (in . . . mi-nooh-ten virt ayn tish fray.) (In . . . minutes a table will be free.) Können Sie in . . . Minuten wiederkommen? (kern-en zee in . . . mi-noohten vee-der-kom-en?) (Could you come back in . . . minutes?)

145 Book I Getting Started with German

146

Book I: Getting Started with German

Arriving and being seated When you arrive at a restaurant, you want to take your seat, Platz nehmen (plâts neym-en), and get your Speisekarte (shpayz-e-kâr-tê) (menu). In casual restaurants, you seat yourself. In upscale restaurants, a waiter, der Kellner (dêr kêl-ner), or a waitress, die Kellnerin (dee kêl-ner-in), directs you to your table. With the exception of upscale restaurants, sharing a table with strangers isn’t unusual. Sharing is especially common in places that tend to be crowded and in places with large tables. If seats are still available at the table where you’re sitting, someone may ask you Ist hier noch frei? (ist heer noH fray?) (Is this place still available?) or Können wir uns dazu setzen? (kern-en veer oons dâtsooh zêts-en?) (May we sit down with you?) It’s a very casual arrangement, and you don’t have to start up a conversation with the party who’s sharing the table with you. Some people may find the lack of privacy a little irritating, but it’s also a good opportunity to meet the locals.

Talkin’ the Talk Mike and Ute have been looking forward to eating at Restaurant Galleria since Mike made the reservation. They arrive at the restau rant and are seated. (Go to www.dummies.com/go/germanaio to listen to this bonus track.) Mike:

Guten Abend. Mein Name ist Evans. Wir haben einen Tisch für zwei Personen bestellt. gooh-ten ah-bent. mayn nah-me ist evans [as in English]. veer hah-ben ayn-en tish fuer tsvay pêr-zohn-en be-shtêlt. Good evening. My name is Evans. We reserved a table for two people.

Kellner:

Guten Abend. Bitte, nehmen Sie hier vorne Platz. gooh-ten ah-bent. bi-te, neym-en zee heer forn-e plâts. Good evening. Please take a seat over here.

Ute:

Könnten wir vielleicht den Tisch dort drüben am Fenster haben? kern-ten veer fee-layHt deyn tish dort drue-ben âm ­fên-ster hah-ben? Could we perhaps have the table over there by the window?

Kellner:

Aber sicher, kein Problem. Setzen Sie sich. Ich bringe Ihnen sofort die Speisekarte. ah-ber ziH-er, kayn pro-bleym. zêts-en zee ziH. iH bring-e een-en zo-fort dee shpayz-e-kâr-te. But of course, no problem. Have a seat. I’ll bring you the menu right away.

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit!

147 Book I

Words to Know bringen

bring-en

to bring

vielleicht

fee-layHt

perhaps

hier vorne

heer forn-e

over here

dort drüben

dort drue-ben

over there

Setzen Sie sich.

zêts-en zee ziH.

Have a seat.

Tut mir leid!

tooht meer layt!

I’m sorry!

Geht in Ordnung!

geyt in ort-noong!

That’s all set.

Checking Out the Menu: Die Speisekarte After you decide where to eat and then get a reservation and table, you’re ready for the fun part — deciding what to eat! Of course, what’s on die Speisekarte (dee spayz-e-kâr-te) (the menu) depends entirely on what kind of place you choose. Unlike in the U.S., the prices shown on a German menu normally include taxes and service.

If you go to a French, Spanish, or Chinese restaurant, the menu may be in the language of the respective country, with a German translation below the original name of the dish. In popular tourist areas, you may even find an English translation.

Looking at breakfast, lunch, and dinner items The following sections tell you about foods you may find in European restaurants. Keep in mind, however, that these sections don’t tell you about local cuisine, which differs substantially from region to region. For example, you commonly find certain regional dishes on the menu in Bavaria or southern Germany but never in Hamburg or the northern parts of the country. Austria and Switzerland also have their own regional specialties.

Breakfast The following items may be offered zum Frühstück (tsoom frue-shtuek) (for breakfast) in a German-speaking country:

Getting Started with German

148

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ der Aufschnitt (dêr ouf-shnit) (cold meats and cheese) ✓ das Brot (dâs broht) (bread) ✓ das Brötchen (dâs brert-Hên) (roll) ✓ die Butter (dee boot-er) (butter) ✓ die Cornflakes (dee cornflakes [as in English]) (cornflakes) ✓ das Ei (dâs ay) (egg) ✓ die Haferflocken (dee hahf-er-flok-en) (oatmeal) ✓ die Margarine (dee mâr-gâr-een-e) (margarine) ✓ die Marmelade (dee mâr-me-lah-de) (marmelade, jam) ✓ die Milch (dee milH) (milk) ✓ das Müsli (dâs mues-lee) (muesli) ✓ die Rühreier (dee ruehr-ay-er) (scrambled eggs) ✓ der Saft (dêr zâft) (juice) ✓ der Schinken (dêr shin-ken) (ham) ✓ das Spiegelei (dâs shpee-gêl-ay) (fried egg, sunny side up) ✓ der Toast (dêr tohst) (toast) ✓ die Wurst (dee voorst) (sausage) In Germany, Brötchen are popular for breakfast; however, you also may get all kinds of bread or croissants. Eating cold cuts for breakfast is also common in Germany. If you order an egg without specifying that you want it scrambled or sunny side up, you’ll get it soft-boiled, or weichgekocht (vayHge-koHt), served in an egg cup.

Appetizers For Vorspeisen (fohr-shpayz-en) (appetizers), you may see the following German favorites: ✓ Gemischter Salat (ge-mish-ter zâ-laht) (mixed salad) ✓ Grüner Salat (gruen-er zâ-laht) (green salad) ✓ Meeresfrüchtesalat mit Toast (meyr-es-frueH-te-zâ-laht mit tohst) (seafood salad with toast) ✓ Melone mit Schinken (mê-loh-ne mit shin-ken) (melon with ham)

Soups You may see the following Suppen (zoop-en) (soups) on a German menu: ✓ Französische Zwiebelsuppe (frân-tser-zi-she tsvee-bel-zoop-e) (French onion soup)

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit!

149

✓ Gulaschsuppe (gooh-lash-zoop-e) (hearty beef and occasionally pork soup)

Book I

✓ Kartoffelcremesuppe (kâr-tof-el-kreym-zoop-e) (cream of potato soup)

Getting Started with German

✓ Tomatensuppe (to-mah-ten-zoop-e) (tomato soup)

Main dishes Hauptspeisen (houpt-shpayz-en) (main dishes) are as diverse in Germany as they are in any culture; here are some you may find on a German menu: ✓ Fisch des Tages (fish dês tah-ges) (fish of the day) ✓ Frischer Spargel mit Räucherschinken (frish-er shpâr-gel mit royH-ershin-ken) (fresh white asparagus with smoked ham) ✓ gefüllte Hühnerbrust mit Kartoffelpüree (ge-fuel-te huen-er-broost mit kâr-tof-el-puer-ey) (stuffed chicken breast with mashed potatoes) ✓ Kalbsschnitzel nach Art des Hauses (kâlps-shnits-el nahH ârt dês houz-es) (chef’s style veal cutlet). This dish is often referred to as Wienerschnitzel (veen-er-shnits-el). ✓ Lachs an Safransoße mit Spinat und Salzkartoffeln (lâks ân zâf-rahnzohs-e mit shpi-naht oont zâlts-kâr-tof-eln) (salmon in saffron sauce with spinach and boiled potatoes) ✓ Lammfrikassee mit Reis (lâm-frik-â-sey mit rays) (lamb fricassee with rice). With chicken, it’s called Hühnerfrikassee (huen-er-frik-â-sey) (chicken fricassee). ✓ Rumpsteak mit Pommes Frites und gemischtem Salat (roomp-steak mit pom frit oont ge-mish-tem zâ-laht) (rump steak with french fries and mixed salad)

Side dishes You can sometimes order Beilagen (bay-lah-gen) (side dishes) separately from your main course. Consider the following popular items: ✓ Butterbohnen (boot-er-bohn-en) (buttered beans) ✓ Gurkensalat (goork-en-zâ-laht) (cucumber salad) ✓ Kartoffelkroketten (kâr-tof-el-kroh-ket-en) (potato croquettes)

Dessert German restaurants commonly offer many fine dishes zum Nachtisch (tsoom naH-tish) (for dessert), including the following: ✓ Apfelstrudel (âp-fel-shtrooh-del) (apple strudel) ✓ Frischer Obstsalat (frish-er ohpst-zâ-laht) (fresh fruit salad)

150

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ Gemischtes Eis mit Sahne (ge-mish-tes ays mit zahn-e) (mixed ice cream with whipped cream) ✓ Rote Grütze mit Vanillesoße (roh-te grue-tse mit vâ-ni-le-zohs-e) (red berry compote with vanilla sauce)

Understanding cooking terms When you’re reading a menu in German, you can understand a great deal of the dishes when you’re familiar with the various terms that describe methods of preparation such as frying or broiling. Here are some cooking terms you may see on a German menu, with examples of food prepared using such cooking methods: ✓ eingelegt, mariniert (ayn-ge-leygt, mâr-i-neert) (pickled, marinated): eingelegter Hering (ayn-ge-leygt-er hêr-ing) (pickled herring) ✓ frittiert (fri-teert) (deep-fat fried): frittierte Zwiebelringe (fri-teer-te tsveebel-ring-e) (fried onion rings) ✓ gebacken (ge-bâk-en) (baked): gebackene Kartoffel (ge-bâk-en-e kâr-tof-el) (baked potatoes) ✓ gebraten (ge-brât-en) (roasted): gebratenes Hãhnchen (ge-brât-en-es hain-Hen) (roasted chicken) ✓ gedampft (ge-dâmpft) (steamed): gedampftes Gemüse (ge-dâmpf-tes ge-muez-e) (steamed vegetables) ✓ gefüllt (ge-fuelt) (stuffed/filled): gefüllte Hühnerbrust (ge-fuel-te huen-erbroost) (stuffed chicken breast) ✓ gekocht (ge-koHt) (boiled/cooked): ein weichgekochtes Ei (ayn vayH-gekoHt-es ay) (a soft-boiled egg) ✓ geräuchert (ge-royH-êrt) (smoked): geräucherte Forelle (ge-royH-êrt-e for-êl-e) (smoked trout) ✓ heiß (hays) (hot [as in temperature]): eine Tasse heisse Schokolade (ayn-e tâs-e hays-e shok-oh-lah-de) (a cup of hot chocolate) ✓ kalt (kâlt) (cold): eine kalte Suppe (ayn-e kal-te zoop-e) (a cold soup) ✓ roh (roh) (raw): rohe Austern (roh-e ous-têrn) (raw oysters) ✓ sauer (sou-er) (sour): Sauerkirschen (sou-er-keersch-en) (sour cherries) ✓ scharf (shârf) (hot [as in spicy]): eine scharfe Soße (ayn-e shârf-e zohs-e) (a spicy sauce) ✓ süß (sues) (sweet): Süßkirschen (sues-keersch-en) (sweet cherries) ✓ überbacken (ue-ber-bâk-en) (scalloped/au gratin): überbackene Aubergine (ue-ber-bâk-en-e oh-bêr-jeen-e) (eggplant Parmesan)

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! Menus may also include some of the ingredients used in preparing a particular dish. Knowing some of the basics can help you better understand what you’re ordering. The following is a list of condiments and ingredients commonly used in German-style cooking: ✓ der Essig (dêr ês-iH) (vinegar) ✓ die Gewürze (dee ge-vuerts-e) (spices) ✓ der Honig (dêr hohn-iH) (honey) ✓ der Ketchup (dêr ketchup [as in English]) (ketchup) ✓ die Kräuter (dee kroyt-er) (herbs) ✓ der Meerrettich (dêr meyr-rêt-iH) (horseradish) ✓ das Öl (dâs erl) (oil) ✓ der Pfeffer (dêr pfêf-er) (pepper) ✓ die Sahne (dee zah-ne) (cream) ✓ die Salatsoße (dee zâ-laht-zohs-e) (dressing) ✓ das Salz (dâs zâlts) (salt) ✓ der Senf (dêr zênf) (mustard) ✓ die Soße (dee zohs-e) (sauce) ✓ der Zucker (dêr tsook-er) (sugar)

Quenching your thirst If you want to order Wasser (vâs-er) (water) at a German restaurant, you have the choice between the carbonated or noncarbonated kind — ein Wasser mit Kohlensäure (ayn vâs-er mit koh-len-zoy-re) (carbonated water) or ein Wasser ohne Kohlensäure (ayn vâs-er oh-ne koh-len-zoy-re) (noncarbonated water). If you ask the server for ein Mineralwasser (ayn min-êr-ahl-vâs-êr) (mineral water), you get carbonated water. Germans usually don’t drink Leitungswasser (lay-toongs-vâs-er) (tap water). However, if you’d like a glass of tap water, you can say this: Ein Glas Leitungswasser, bitte. (ayn glahs lay-toongs-vâs-er, bi-te.) (Aglass of tap water, please.) You can order Wein (vayn) (wine) by the bottle — die Flasche (dee flâsh-e) — or by the glass — das Glas (dâs glahs). Occasionally, you also can get a carafe of wine, which is die Karaffe (dee kah-râf-e).

151 Book I Getting Started with German

152

Book I: Getting Started with German In the following list, you find some common beverages, Getränke (gê-train-ke), that you may see on a German menu: ✓ Bier (beer [as in English]) (beer) ✓ das Bier vom Fass (dâs beer fom fâs) (draft beer) ✓ das Export (dâs export [as in English]) (smooth lager beer) ✓ helles/dunkles Bier (hel-es/dunk-les beer) (light/dark beer) (Helles refers to the beer’s light color, not its alcoholic content.) ✓ der Kaffee (dêr kâf-ê) (coffee) ✓ das Pils/Pilsner (dâs pils/pilsner [as in English]) (pale lager beer) ✓ der Rotwein (dêr roht-vayn) (red wine) ✓ der Tafelwein (dêr tahf-el-vayn) (table wine, lowest quality) ✓ der Tee (dêr tey) (tea) ✓ Wein (vayn) (wine) ✓ der Weißwein (dêr vays-vayn) (white wine)

Placing Your Order As in English, you use a variety of common expressions, including the following, to order your food in German. Luckily, they aren’t too complicated, and you can use them for ordering anything from food to drinks and for buying food at a store. Ich hätte gern . . . (iH hêt-e gêrn . . .) (I would like to have . . .) Für mich bitte . . . (fuer miH bi-te . . .) (For me . . . please) Ich möchte (gern) . . . (iH merH-te [gêrn] . . .) (I would like to have . . .) When ordering, you may decide to be adventurous and ask the server to suggest something for you. Here’s how: Könnten Sie etwas empfehlen? (kern-ten zee êt-vâs êm-pfey-len?) (Could you recommend something?)

Be prepared for your server to rattle off names of dishes you may be unfamiliar with. To avoid any confusion, try holding out your menu so the server can point at specific dishes when responding.

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit!

Ordering politely Take a closer look at the verb forms hätte, könnten, and möchte in the preceding section. These verbs are in the subjunctive. The subjunctive has a number of uses in German, such as describing a wish or condition or expressing your opinion. For more information on the subjunctive, go to Book IV, Chapter 7. In the examples in this section, you use the subjunctive for making polite requests. Basically, the subjunctive acts like the English would. Ich hätte . . . (iH hêt-e . . .) (I would have . . .) comes from haben (hah-ben) (to have). The big difference between the German and the English usage is that in German you can combine would and have into one word: hätte. Add gern (gêrn) (gladly, willingly) to hätte and presto! You have the form for ordering: Ich hätte gern . . . (iH hêt-e gêrn) (I would like to have . . .) You also have Ich möchte . . . (iH merH-te . . .) (I would like . . .), which comes from mögen (mer-gen) (to like). Möchte basically corresponds to the English would like. You use it in a similar way when ordering. Consider the following example: Ich möchte gern ein Glas Mineralwasser. (iH merH-te gêrn ayn glahs min-êr-ahl-vâs-er.) (I would like a glass of mineral water.) Note: Both hätte and möchte are commonly used without the infinitive of a verb. The phrase Ich könnte . . . (iH kern-te . . .) (I could . . .) comes from the verb können (kern-en) (to be able to or can). Könnte combines with the infinitive of a verb to make the following request: Könnten Sie uns helfen? (kern-ten zee oons helf-en?) (Could you help us?)

Talkin’ the Talk

Mike and Ute have had a chance to look at the menu. The waiter returns to take their orders. (Track 19) Kellner:

Darf ich Ihnen etwas zu trinken bringen? dârf iH een-en êt-vâs tsooh trin-ken bring-en? May I bring you something to drink?

Mike:

Ja, ich möchte gern ein Bier. yah, iH merH-te gêrn ayn beer. Yes, I’d like a beer.

153 Book I Getting Started with German

154

Book I: Getting Started with German Kellner: Pils oder Export? pils oh-der export? A pilsner or an export? Mike: Export, bitte. export, bi-te. Export, please. Kellner:

Ein Export. Und was darf es für Sie sein? ayn export. oont vâs dârf ês fuer zee zayn? One export. And what would you like?

Ute:

Mmm . . . Soll ich den Sylvaner oder den Riesling bestellen? Mmm . . . zol iH deyn Sylvaner [as in English] oh-der deyn Riesling [as in English] be-shtêl-en? Mmm. Should I order the Sylvaner or the Riesling?

Kellner:

Ich kann Ihnen beide Weißweine empfehlen. iH kahn een-en bay-de vays-vayn-e êm-pfey-len. I can recommend both white wines.

Ute:

Gut. Ich hätte gern ein Glas Sylvaner. gooht. iH hêt-e gêrn ayn glahs Sylvaner. Good. I would like to have a glass of Sylvaner.

Asking for assistance When you’re asking someone for help, you want to be polite, so you formulate a question or make a statement using the verbs darf, soll, and kann: ✓ Ich darf . . . (iH dârf . . .) (I may/I’m allowed to . . .) comes from the verb dürfen (duerf-en) (may/to be allowed to). ✓ Ich soll . . . (iH zol . . .) (I should . . .) comes from the verb sollen (zol-en) (should). ✓ Ich kann . . . (iH kân . . .) (I can . . .) comes from the verb können (kern-en) (can). These verbs help you further determine or modify the action expressed by another verb (that’s why they’re called modal auxiliaries), and they work in a similar way as their English equivalents may, should, and can. Möchte, which we discuss in the preceding section, does double duty as a modal auxiliary and as a subjunctive verb. For more information on modal auxiliaries, check out Book III, Chapter 6.

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! Here are some example sentences to familiarize you with darf, soll, and kann: Darf ich die Speisekarte haben? (dârf iH dee shpayz-e-kâr-te hah-ben?) (May I have the menu, please?) Dürfen wir dort drüben sitzen? (duerf-en veer dort drueb-en zits-en?) (May we sit over there?) Sie sollten den Apfelstrudel bestellen. (zee zol-ten den âp-fel-shtrooh-del be-shtêl-en.) (You should order the apple strudel.) Soll ich Ihnen zwei Löffel bringen? (zol iH een-en tsvay ler-fel bring-en?) (Shall I bring you two spoons?) Kann ich bitte eine Serviette haben? (kân iH bi-te ayn-e sêr-vee-êt-e hah-ben?) (Can I have a napkin, please?) Können Sie uns bitte noch zwei Bier bringen? (kern-en zee oons bi-te noH tsvay beer bring-en?) (Can you bring us two more beers, please?)

Ordering something special People all over the world are now more conscientious than ever about what they’re eating, whether due to health or ethical concerns. So you may need the following phrases to order something a little out of the ordinary: Haben Sie vegetarische Gerichte? (hah-ben zee vey-gê-tahr-ish-e ge-riH-te?) (Do you have vegetarian dishes?) Ich kann nichts essen, was . . . enthält (iH kân niHts ês-en, vâs . . . ênt-hailt) (I can’t eat anything that contains . . .) Haben Sie Gerichte für Diabetiker? (hah-ben zee ge-riH-te fuer dee-âbey-ti-ker?) (Do you have dishes for diabetics?) Haben Sie Kinderportionen? (hah-ben zee kin-der-por-tsee-ohn-en?) (Do you have children’s portions?) If you order meat — steak, for example — the server may ask you Wie hätten Sie das Steak gern? (vee hêt-en zee dâs steak gêrn?) (How would you like your steak?) You can respond with any of the following, depending on your tastes: ✓ englisch (êng-lish) (rare) ✓ medium (mey-dee-oom) (medium) ✓ durchgebraten (doorH-ge-braht-en) (well-done)

155 Book I Getting Started with German

156

Book I: Getting Started with German

Finishing Your Meal and Getting the Check When you’re nearing the end of your meal, you may be thinking about having a cup of coffee or ordering some dessert, or you may just want the check. If the server doesn’t stop by to ask you how you’re doing, you have to take the initiative. To get your server’s attention, try politely raising your hand. You can also say Entschuldigen Sie, bitte! (ênt-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te!) (Excuse me, please!)

Replying to “How did you like the food?” “Hat es Ihnen geschmeckt?” After a meal, the server typically asks you whether you liked the food. The following is the question you hear: Hat es Ihnen geschmeckt? (hât ês een-en ge-shmêkt?) (Did you enjoy the food?) Hopefully, you enjoyed your meal and can honestly answer the question with one of the following: ✓ Danke, gut. (dân-ke, gooht.) (Thanks, good.) ✓ Sehr gut. (zeyr gooht.) (Very good.) ✓ Ausgezeichnet. (ous-ge-tsayH-net.) (Excellent.) After your server asks you how you liked the food, she may ask you the following as a way to bring your meal to a close and to find out whether you’re ready for the check: Sonst noch etwas? (zonst noH êt-vâs?) (Anything else?) Unless you’d like to order something else, it’s time to pay die Rechnung (dee rêH-noong) (bill).

Asking for the check In German-speaking regions, you have to ask for the check when you want to pay. Otherwise, your server will let you sit at your table indefinitely. After all,

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! he would be considered pushy and impolite if he were to put the check on your table before you requested it. So when you’re ready to pay, ask for the bill in one of the following ways: Ich möchte bezahlen. (iH merH-te be-tsahl-en.) (I would like to pay.) Die Rechnung, bitte. (dee rêH-noong, bi-te.) (The check, please.) If you want to, you can pay together with the other people you’re dining with. In that case, use this phrase: Alles zusammen, bitte. (âl-es tsoo-zâm-en, bi-te.) (Everything together, please.). Or you can ask to pay separately with Wir möchten getrennt bezahlen. (veer merH-ten ge-trênt be-tsahl-en.) (We would like to pay separately.)

Some German restaurants, especially upscale establishments, allow you to pay with a credit card — die Kreditkarte (dee krê-dit-kâr-te). These restaurants have signs in the window or at the door, indicating which cards they take (just as American restaurants do). If you must pay with a credit card, simply look for these signs. If you need a Quittung (kvit-oong) (receipt), ask the server for one after you’ve asked for the check: Und eine Quittung, bitte. (oont ayn-e kvit-oong, bi-te.) (And a receipt, please.) In more casual establishments, such as a Kneipe, you may simply tell the server that you want to pay and then make the payment directly at the table, usually with cash.

Don’t feel like you have to tip as much as you do in North America. The servers receive a salary, and they don’t live off their tips. If you’re paying cash for the check at your table, just round up the bill by 5 percent. Consider using the phrase Stimmt so. (shtimt zoh.) (Keep the change.) It tells the server that the sum added on to the bill is the tip and that you don’t need any change back. You need to hand the tip to the server, as leaving money on the table is not customary in Europe. Alternatively, if the check is 36€ and you only have a 50€ bill, you can say Machen Sie es 38€ (mâH-en zee ês âHt-oont-dray-siH oy-roh.) (Make that 38€.) The server will hand you back 12€. In high-end restaurants with great service, you may want to leave a somewhat larger tip, and conversely, if you’re in a simple establishment with minimal service, you may simply round off the amount to the next euro if the check is small.

157 Book I Getting Started with German

158

Book I: Getting Started with German

Talkin’ the Talk

Mike and Ute have enjoyed a great meal. They ask for the check, pay, and then tip the waiter. (Track 20) Die Rechnung, bitte. Mike: dee rêH-noong, bi-te. The check, please. Sofort. Das macht 45 Euro 80. Kellner: zoh-fort. dâs mâHt fuenf-oont-feer-tsiH oy-roh âHt-tsiH. Coming right up. That would be 45 euros 80 cents. Mike puts 50 euros on the table. Mike:

Stimmt so. shtimt zoh. Keep the change.

Kellner:

Vielen Dank. fee-len dânk. Thank you very much.

Mike:

Bitte. bi-te. You’re welcome.

Words to Know bezahlen

be-tsahl-en

to pay

die Kreditkarte

dee krê-dit-kâr-te

credit card

die Quittung

dee kvit-oong

receipt

in bar bezahlen

in bâr be-tsahl-en

to pay cash

die Rechnung

dee rêH-noong

bill

Stimmt so.

shtimt zoh.

Keep the change.

Bitte.

bi-te.

Y ou’re welcome./Please.

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit!

Shopping for Food Sometimes you may not feel like eating out. You may prefer to buy food for a picnic or to do the cooking yourself. If you want to shop for food, you need to know where to go and what to buy. The following sections provide you with words for types of stores and food. To find out about how to order specific quantities of food, check out the section in Book I, Chapter 2 on weights and measurements.

Knowing where to shop Although supermarkets are an obvious place to pick up the makings of a meal, you may not find one nearby. The local neighborhood grocery store, butcher shop, or bakery may be more convenient, and don’t forget that in such stores you have the opportunity to interact in German. Other shopping options include the open-air food stands and markets common in Germany, Austria, and Switzerland. Some are open on a regular basis, others are open only once a week, and a few may be seasonal, but all of them sell quality produce and food items that are fresh and tasty. Whether you want to buy something for a snack or a whole week’s worth of groceries, you can stock up at the local market and practice your German at the same time. The food is often artfully displayed, tempting you to reach for that delicious-looking piece of fruit. However, restrain yourself and wait to be served. Outdoor-market etiquette is different from supermarket-style, self-serve shopping. You’re better off resisting temptation to help yourself, lest you hear the words of warning: Nicht anfassen! (niHt ân-fâs-en!) (Don’t touch!) Here are just some of the stores and shops you can visit if you want to buy food: ✓ die Bäckerei (dee bêk-e-ray) (bakery) ✓ der Bioladen, das Reformhaus (dêr bee-oh-lah-den, dâs rê-form-hous) (organic food store, health-food store) ✓ das Feinkostgeschäft (dâs fayn-kost-ge-shêft) (delicatessen) ✓ der Getränkemarkt (dêr ge-trênk-e-markt) (store selling alcoholic and nonalcoholic beverages) ✓ die Konditorei (dee kon-dee-to-ray) (cake and pastry shop) ✓ das Lebensmittelgeschäft (dâs ley-benz-mit-el-ge-shêft) (grocery store) ✓ der Markt (dêr mârkt) (market, usually outdoors) ✓ die Markthalle (dee mârkt-hâl-e) (covered market, often with stands selling fresh food items)

159 Book I Getting Started with German

160

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ der Marktplatz (dêr mârkt-plâts) (outdoor market place, often in the center of town near the town hall) ✓ die Metzgerei, die Fleischerei (dee mêts-ge-ray, dee flaysh-er-ay) (butcher shop) ✓ der Supermarkt (dêr zooh-pêr-mârkt) (supermarket) ✓ die Weinhandlung (dee vayn-hând-loong) (wine store) You may purchase beer, wine, and other alcoholic beverages in German supermarkets, grocery stores, discount stores, and even some gas stations. Large train stations may also have stores that sell food and alcoholic beverages, and some of the larger department stores have a full-fledged supermarket located in the basement.

Finding what you need After you decide where you want to shop, you have to decide what you want to buy. Often making that decision requires talking to the shopkeeper or market seller. For instance, some shopkeepers pride themselves on their fine cheeses, olives, or other deli items and may be willing to let you try something before you decide to buy. All you have to do is ask. The following expressions may come in handy when you’re interacting with a shopkeeper: Ich hätte gern . . . (iH hêt-e gêrn . . .) (I’d like . . .) Was ist das? (vâs ist dâs?) (What is that?) Könnte ich das probieren? (kern-te iH dâs proh-beer-en?) (Could I try that?) Das schmeckt sehr gut. (dâs shmêkt zeyr goot.) (That tastes really good.) Ein Stück, bitte. (ayn shtueck, bi-te.) (One piece, please.) 300 Gramm, bitte. (dray hoon-dêrt grâm, bi-te.) (Three hundred grams, please.) Das wär’s/Das war’s. (dâs vêrs/dâs vârs.) (That’s all.) You may hear the shopkeeper ask you the following: Kann ich Ihnen behilflich sein/helfen? (kân iH eehn-en be-hilf-liH zany/ hêlf-en?) (Can I help you?) Was darf es sein? (vâs dârf es zayn?) (What would you like?) Am Stück oder geschnitten? (âm shtuek oh-der ge-shnit-en?) (A piece or sliced?) Sonst noch etwas? (zonst noH êt-vâs?) (Anything else?)

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit! Here are the main types of foods you may find in the shops and markets listed in the preceding section: ✓ die Backwaren (dee bâk-vâr-en) (bakery goods) ✓ das Gebäck (dâs ge-bêk) (cookies, pastries) ✓ das Gemüse (dâs ge-mue-ze) (vegetables) ✓ der Fisch (dêr fish) (fish) ✓ das Fleisch (dâs flaysh) (meat) ✓ das Obst (dâs ohpst) (fruit) Some common grain and dairy items you may be interested in purchasing include ✓ das Brot (dâs broht) (bread) ✓ das Brötchen (dâs brert-Hen) (roll) ✓ die Butter (dee boot-er) (butter) ✓ der Käse (dêr kai-ze) (cheese) ✓ der Kuchen (dêr koohH-en) (cake) ✓ die Milch (dee milH) (milk) ✓ der Reis (dêr rays) (rice) ✓ das Roggenbrot (dâs rog-en-broht) (rye bread) ✓ die Sahne (dee zahn-e) (cream) ✓ das Schwarzbrot (dâs shvârts-broht) (brown bread) ✓ die Torte (dee tor-te) (cake, often multilayered) You may be interested in buying the following types of Fisch (fish) (fish) and Meeresfrüchte (meyr-es-frueH-te) (seafood): ✓ die Austern (dee ous-têrn) (oysters) ✓ die Flunder (dee floon-der) (flounder) ✓ die Forelle (dee fohr-e-le) (trout) ✓ der Heilbutt (dêr hayl-boot) (halibut) ✓ der Hering (dêr hêr-ing) (herring) ✓ der Kabeljau (dêr kah-bel-you) (cod) ✓ die Krabben (dee krâb-en) (shrimp) ✓ der Krebs (dêr kreyps) (crab)

161 Book I Getting Started with German

162

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ der Lachs (dêr lâx) (salmon) ✓ die Muscheln (dee moosh-eln) (mussels) ✓ der Schellfisch (dêr shêl-fish) (haddock) ✓ die Seezunge (dee zey-tsoong-e) (sole) ✓ der Thunfisch (dêr toohn-fish) (tuna) Here are some types of Fleisch (flaysh) (meat) you may want to buy: ✓ die Bratwurst (dee braht-voorst) (fried sausage) ✓ die Ente (dee ên-te) (duck) ✓ der Fasan (dêr fâ-zân) (pheasant) ✓ die Gans (dee gâns) (goose) ✓ das Geflügel (dâs ge-flueg-el) (poultry) ✓ das Hackfleisch (dâs hâk-flaysh) (hamburger meat) ✓ das Hähnchen (dâs hain-Hen) (chicken) ✓ das Kalbfleisch (dâs kâlp-flaysh) (veal) ✓ das Kanninchen (dâs kân-een-Hen) (rabbit) ✓ das Lammfleisch (dâs lâm-flaysh) (lamb) ✓ das Rehfleisch (dâs rey-flaysh) (venison) ✓ das Rindfleisch (dâs rint-flaysh) (beef) ✓ der Schinken (dêr shin-ken) (ham) ✓ das Schweinefleisch (dâs shvayn-e-flaysh) (pork) ✓ der Speck (dêr shpêk) (bacon) ✓ der Truthahn, die Pute (dêr trooht-hahn, dee pooh-te) (turkey) ✓ das Wild (dâs vilt) (game) ✓ die Wurst (dee voorst) (sausage) Here are some types of Obst (opst) (fruit) and Gemüse (ge-mue-ze) (vegetables) you may want to purchase: ✓ die Ananas (dee ân-ân-âs) (pineapple) ✓ der Apfel (dêr âp-fel) (apple) ✓ die Aubergine (dee oh-bêr-jeen-e) (eggplant) ✓ die Banane (dee bâ-nah-ne) (banana)

Chapter 7: Dining Out and Buying Food: Guten Appetit!

163

✓ die Birne (dee birn-e) (pear)

Book I

✓ die Blaubeere/Heidelbeere (dee blou-beyr-e/hay-del-beyr-e) (blueberry)

Getting Started with German

✓ der Blumenkohl (dêr bloom-en-kohl) (cauliflower) ✓ die Bohne (dee bohn-e) (bean) ✓ der Brokkoli (dêr broh-ko-lee) (broccoli) ✓ der Champignon (dêr shâm-peen-yon) (mushroom) ✓ die Erbse (dee êrp-se) (pea) ✓ die Erdbeere (dee eyrt-beyr-e) (strawberry) ✓ der Grünkohl (dêr gruen-kohl) (kale) ✓ die Gurke (dee goork-e) (cucumber) ✓ die Himbeere (dee him-beyr-e) (raspberry) ✓ die Karotte/Möhre (dee kâ-rot-e/mer-e) (carrot) ✓ die Kartoffel (dee kâr-tof-el) (potato) ✓ die Kirsche (dee kirsh-e) (cherry) ✓ die Kiwi (dee kee-vee) (kiwi) ✓ der Knoblauch (dêr knoh-blouH) (garlic) ✓ der Kohl (dêr kohl) (cabbage) ✓ der Kohlrabi (dêr kohl-râ-bee) (kohlrabi) ✓ der Kopfsalat (dêr kopf-zâ-laht) (lettuce) ✓ der Kürbis (dêr kuer-bis) (pumpkin) ✓ der Lauch (dêr lauH) (leek) ✓ die Olive (dee oh-leev-e) (olive) ✓ die Orange (dee oh-ron-ge [g as in the word genre]) (orange) ✓ der Paprika (dêr pâp-ree-kah) (bell pepper) ✓ der Pfirsich (dêr pfir-siH) (peach) ✓ die Pflaume (dee pflau-me) (plum) ✓ der Pilz (dêr pilts) (mushroom) (often: wild mushroom) ✓ die Preiselbeere (dee pray-zêl-beyr-e) (cranberry) ✓ der Rotkohl (dêr roht-kohl) (red cabbage) ✓ der Salat (dêr zâ-laht) (salad) ✓ das Sauerkraut (dâs zou-er-krout) (sauerkraut)

164

Book I: Getting Started with German ✓ die saure Gurke (dee zou-re goork-e) (sour pickle) ✓ der Sellerie (dêr zêl-êr-ee) (celeriac) ✓ der Spargel (dêr shpâr-gêl) (asparagus) ✓ der Spinat (dêr shpi-naht) (spinach) ✓ die Tomate (dee to-mah-te) (tomato) ✓ die Zitrone (dee tsi-trohn-e) (lemon) ✓ die Zucchini (dee tsoo-kee-ni) (zucchini) ✓ die Zwiebel (dee tsvee-bel) (onion) If you go shopping at a supermarket in Germany, you’ll quickly notice that shoppers don’t get free plastic or paper bags to put their groceries in. You either have to bring your own bag or pay a small amount for a plastic bag at the checkout. So why not go with the flow and purchase a few cloth bags that you can reuse? Oh, and keep in mind that bagging your own groceries is customary.

Book II

Speaking German on the Go

Get your day off to a good start when you’re living or traveling in Germany by enjoying a traditional German breakfast. To find out what foods may be served, check out the free article at www.dummies.com/extras/germanaio.

Contents at a Glance Chapter 1: Locating Places . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Getting Yourself Oriented.................................................................................................167 Asking How to Get from One Place to Another............................................................171 Describing Where Something Is Located......................................................................174 Understanding Where to Go............................................................................................179 Traveling by Car — das Auto — or Other Vehicle.......................................................183

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Taking in the Sights...........................................................................................................185 Heading to the Movies......................................................................................................189 Going to the Museum........................................................................................................193 Attending Cultural Performances...................................................................................195 How Was It? Talking about Entertainment....................................................................198 Going to a Party..................................................................................................................200

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Getting Ready for Your Trip..............................................................................................203 Exploring the Outdoors.....................................................................................................209 Dealing with Passports and Visas..................................................................................217 Handling Money.................................................................................................................219

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 Finding Accommodations.................................................................................................227 Making a Reservation.......................................................................................................228 Checking In.........................................................................................................................233 Making the Most of Your Stay.........................................................................................238 Checking Out and Paying the Bill....................................................................................240

Chapter 5: Getting Around . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Going through the Airport.................................................................................................243 Traveling by Car.................................................................................................................249 Taking the Train.................................................................................................................255 Navigating Buses, Subways, Streetcars, and Taxis....................................................259

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Requesting Help.................................................................................................................263 Handling Health Issues.....................................................................................................265 Handling Police Matters...................................................................................................276

Chapter 1

Locating Places In This Chapter ▶ Asking about the places you want to go ▶ Getting your directions straight ▶ Going by car or other vehicle

T

he key to getting around is knowing how to get where you’re going. Before you hop on that bus or train, or set out on your journey by car or on foot, you naturally want to plan your trip. Being able to ask about the location of a train station, open-air market, or museum is a good start. Of course, you also want to understand the directions someone gives you to your destination. For example, someone may say that the market is across from the subway station, behind the hotel, or next to the post office. Or they may tell you to take the second street on the left, turn right at the third traffic light, and so on. If you don’t relish the thought of getting lost, read on.

Getting Yourself Oriented You emerge from the subway station in the middle of a large city square and don’t see any street signs near you, so you rotate your map, trying to make sense of the buildings around you. Finding your way at this point may be a bit confusing, so unless you have a reliable GPS with you, the next step is to ask someone for help locating your destination. This section points you in the right direction.

168

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Finding out where something is Where am I? Where do we go from here? Where would you be without the word where? Probably lost. Luckily, asking where something is in German is pretty easy. You start with the word wo (voh) (where) and frame your question like this: Wo ist. . . ? (voh ist. . . ?) (Where is. . . ?) Whenever you ask a stranger a question, you sound more polite (and therefore are more likely to get more or better assistance) if you preface the question with the following: Entschuldigen Sie, bitte . . . (ênt-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te . . .) (Excuse me, please . . .) After you flag down a stranger and start your question with Entschuldigen Sie, bitte, wo ist . . ., finish the question by supplying the name of the location you’re looking for, which may include one of the following: ✓ der Bahnhof (dêr bahn-hohf) (train station) ✓ die U-Bahnstation (dee ooh-bahn-shtât-see-ohn) (subway station) ✓ die Bank (dee bânk) (bank)

✓ die Bushaltestelle/die Straßenbahnhaltestelle (dee boos-hâl-te-shtêl-e/ dee shtrah-sen-bahn-hâl-te-shtêl-e) (bus stop/streetcar or tram stop)

✓ das Café (dâs kâf-ey) (café) ✓ der Dom (dêr dohm) (cathedral) ✓ der Flughafen (dêr floohk-hah-fen) (airport) ✓ der Hafen (dêr hah-fen) (harbor) ✓ das Hotel (dâs hotel [as in English]) (hotel) ✓ das Kino (dâs kee-noh) (movie theater) ✓ die Kirche (dee kirH-e) (church)

✓ der Markt (dêr mârkt) (market)

✓ das Museum (dâs moo-zey-oom) (museum) ✓ der Park (dêr pârk) (park) ✓ der Platz (dêr plâtz) ([town] square) ✓ die Post (dee post) (post office) ✓ das Restaurant (dâs rês-tuh-ron) (restaurant) ✓ der Taxistand (dêr tâx-ee-shtânt) (taxi stand) ✓ das Theater (dâs tey-ah-ter) (theater)

Chapter 1: Locating Places

169

Of course, if you’re in a town of any size at all, a general question like “Where is the bus stop?” or “Where is the bank?” may be met with a quizzical look. After all, multiple bus stops and banks may be in close proximity. To make your questions as specific as possible, include the proper name of the bus stop, theater, church, or other location in your question. Here are some examples: Wo ist die Bushaltestelle Karlsplatz? (voh ist dee boos-hâl-te-shtêl-e kârlz-plâts?) (Where is the bus stop Karlsplatz?) Wo ist das Staatstheater? (voh ist dâs shtâts-tey-ah-ter?) (Where is the Staatstheater?) Wo ist der Marktplatz? (voh ist dêr mârkt-plâts?) (Where is the open-air market?) If you don’t know the proper name of your destination, you can ask for directions to the nearest of whatever you’re looking for. You simply insert the word nächste (naiH-ste) (nearest) after the article of the location in question. Check out the following questions that use nächste: Wo ist der nächste Park? (voh ist dêr naiH-ste pârk?) (Where is the nearest park?) Wo ist die nächste Bank? (voh ist dee naiH-ste bânk?) (Where is the nearest bank?) Wo ist das nächste Hotel? (voh ist dâs naiH-ste hotel?) (Where is the nearest hotel?)

When it comes to getting around and asking for directions, the following expressions help you to say that you don’t know your way around: Ich bin Tourist. (iH bin toor-ist.) (I’m a tourist.) Ich bin nicht von hier. (iH bin niHt fon heer.) (I’m not from here.) With the following helpful verb, you can indicate that you don’t know your way around a place: auskennen (ous-kên-en) (to know one’s way around). Here’s an expression using this verb that you may want to memorize: Ich kenne mich hier nicht aus. (iH kên-e miH heer niHt ous.) (I don’t know my way around here.) The verb auskennen belongs to a group of verbs called separable verbs. They all have a prefix that separates from the main part of the verb and gets shoved to the end of the sentence. The prefix of the verb auskennen is aus-. Notice how this prefix appears at the very end of the sentence in the preceding example. For more information on separable verbs, turn to Book III, Chapter 8.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

170

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Asking how far something is: Ist es weit von hier? Before you decide whether you want to walk to your destination or take public transportation, you need to find out how far away your destination is. You have a few ways to discover how distant a location is, and the key word to know is weit (vayt) (far): Ist . . . weit entfernt/weit von hier? (ist . . . vayt ênt-fêrnt/vayt fon heer?) (Is . . . far away/far from here?) Just fill in the name of the location you’re asking about. So, for example, if you’re headed to the art museum, you may ask someone one of the following: Ist das Kunstmuseum weit entfernt? (ist dâs koonst-moo-zey-oom vayt ênt-fêrnt?) (Is the art museum far [away]?) Ist das Kunstmuseum weit von hier? (ist dâs koonst-moo-zey-oom vayt fon heer?) (Is the art museum far from here?) Hopefully, you get the answer Nein, das Kunstmuseum ist nicht weit von hier. (nayn, dâs koonst-moozey-oom ist niHt vayt fon heer.) (No, the art museum isn’t far from here.) If you want to know specifically how far away a location is, you can use this question: Wie weit ist . . . von hier? (vee vayt ist . . . fon heer?) (How far is . . . from here?) You may also approach the issue the other way around and find out how close something is by using the word nah (nah) (near). You usually find the word nah in the following combination: in der Nähe (in dêr nai-he) (nearby). You can ask the question Ist . . . in der Nähe? (ist . . . in dêr nai-he?) (Is . . . nearby?)

Getting more specific directions The words hier (heer) (here) and dort (dort) (there) may be small words, but they play an important part in communicating directions. How? Well, like their English equivalents, they make directions just a little more concrete.

Chapter 1: Locating Places

171

Look at the following sample sentences to see how hier and dort work in explaining directions: Das Museum ist nicht weit von hier. (dâs moo-zey-oom ist niHt vayt fon heer.) (The museum isn’t far from here.) Das Hotel ist dort, neben dem Café. (dâs hotel [as in English] ist dort, ney-ben deym café [as in English].) (The hotel is there, next to the café.)

Some key words that answer the question “where?” more specifically are easier to remember when you recognize them in commonly used word combinations. Try these combos on for size:

✓ hier vorne (heer forn-e) (here in front)

✓ dort drüben (dort drue-ben) (over there)

✓ ziemlich weit/sehr weit (tseem-leeH vayt/zeyr vayt) (quite far/very far) ✓ gleich um die Ecke (glayH oom dee êk-e) (just around the corner) ✓ direkt gegenüber (di-rêkt gey-gen-ue-ber) (directly opposite) Check out the following sentences that use some of the preceding expressions: Der Hauptbahnhof ist gleich um die Ecke. (dêr houpt-bahn-hohf ist glayH oom dee êk-e.) (The main train station is just around the corner.) Die U-Bahnstation ist dort drüben. (dee ooh-bahn-shtât-see-ohn ist dort drue-ben.) (The subway station is over there.)

Asking How to Get from One Place to Another When you want to ask “How do I get there?” you use the verb kommen (kom-en), which means both “to come” and, when used with a preposition, “to get to.” Refer to Book I, Chapter 3 for the conjugation of kommen. The basic form of the question “How do I get there?” is Wie komme ich. . . ? (vee kom-e iH. . . ?) (How do I get. . . ?) To finish the rest of the sentence, you need to use a preposition to help you say “to the train station” or “to the city center.” At this point, you need to shift into high gear — that is, high grammar gear.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

172

Book II: Speaking German on the Go In German, you don’t just deal with one preposition as you do in English, in which you would simply use to (How do I get to. . . ?). In fact, you may need to use any of a number of prepositions, all of which can mean “to.” The most commonly used “to” prepositions in German are the following: ✓ in (in) ✓ nach (nahH) ✓ zu (tsooh) The following sections discuss each of these prepositions and explain how to use them.

Asking how to get to a location You use the preposition in (in) when you want to get to or into a certain location, such as the city center, the zoo, or the mountains. For example: Wie komme ich in die Innenstadt? (vee kom-e iH in dee in-ên-shtât?) (How do I get to the center of the city?) When you use the preposition in this way, the article that comes after it goes into the accusative case, meaning that some of the articles change form slightly. Book IV, Chapter 2 has a complete explanation of the accusative case, but here’s a quick reminder of how the articles change (or don’t change): ✓ der (dêr) becomes den (deyn) (masculine) ✓ die (dee) stays die (feminine) ✓ das (dâs) stays das (neuter) ✓ die (dee) stays die (plural) For example, the article of a feminine noun like die City (dee si-tee) (city center) stays the same: Wie komme ich in die City? (vee kom-e iH in dee si-tee?) (How do I get to the city center?) The article of a masculine noun like der Zoo (dêr tsoh) (zoo) changes like this: Wie kommen wir zum Zoo? (vee kom-en veer tsoohm tsoh?) (How do we get to the zoo?)

Chapter 1: Locating Places

173

The article of a plural noun like die Berge (dee bêr-ge) (mountains) stays the same: Wie komme ich in die Berge? (vee kom-e iH in dee bêr-ge?) (How do I get to the mountains?) The article of a neuter noun like das Zentrum (dâs tsên-troom) (center) stays the same, but when the preposition in is used with neuter nouns in the accusative case, the preposition and article contract to form the word ins (ins): in + das = ins This contraction is almost always used, giving you phrases like Wie komme ich ins Zentrum/ins Museum/ins Cafe? (vee kom-e iH ins tsên-troom/ins mooh-zey-oom/ins kâf-ey?) (How do I get to the city center/ museum/café?)

Asking how to get to a city or country Luckily, the preposition nach (nahH) comes into play only in one specific context — when you want to get to a city or country: Wie komme ich nach Köln? (vee kom-e iH nahH kerln?) (How do I get to Cologne?) You have no troublesome articles to bother with when using nach because city names and most country names don’t need articles.

Asking how to get to a specific building If you’re asking how to get to a place such as a train station or a museum, the preposition zu (tsooh) is a pretty safe bet. However, it may go through a slight spelling change when used in a sentence. For example: Wie kommen wir zum Flughafen/zum Theater/zum Restaurant/zum Café? (vee kom-en veer tsoom floohk-hâ-fen/tsoom tey-ah-ter/tsoom rês-tuh-ron/tsoom kâf-ey?) (How do we get to the airport/theater/ restaurant/café?) Wie komme ich zur Deutschen Bank/zur Apotheke? (vee kom-e iH tsoor doych-en bânk/tsoor âp-oh-teyk-e?) (How do I get to the German bank/ pharmacy?)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

174

Book II: Speaking German on the Go The preposition zu requires the dative case. (See Book IV, Chapter 2 for a complete explanation of the dative case.) As a result, the articles used right after zu change in the following ways:

✓ der (dêr) becomes dem (deym) (masculine)

✓ die (dee) becomes der (dêr) (feminine) ✓ das (dâs) becomes dem (deym) (neuter) ✓ die (dee) becomes den (deyn) (plural) When zu is used with masculine nouns, like der Bahnhof, and neuter nouns, like das Hotel, the preposition and article contract to form the word zum. In other words, zu + dem = zum. The following two examples both use zum: Wie komme ich zum Bahnhof? (vee kom-e iH tsoom bahn-hohf?) (How do I get to the train station?) Wie komme ich zum Hotel Kempinski? (vee kom-e iH tsoom hotel kêmpin-skee?) (How do I get to Hotel Kempinski?) Similarly, take a look at how zu combines with a feminine noun like die Post (dee post) (post office) in its dative form, der Post: zu + der = zur. Here’s an example: Wie komme ich zur Post/zur Bäckerei/zur Kirche? (vee kom-e iH tsoor post/tsoor bêk-er-ay/tsoor kirH-e?) (How do I get to the post office/bakery/ church?) To use plural nouns like die Souvenirläden (dee zoo-ven-eer-lê-den) (souvenir shops) together with zu, you simply change the article to den, like this: Wie kommen wir zu den Souvenirläden/zu den Restaurants/zu den Cafés? (vee kom-en veer tsooh deyn zoo-ven-eer-lê-den/tsooh deyn rêstoh-rons/kâf-eyz?) (How do we get to the souvenir shops/restaurants/ cafés?)

Describing Where Something Is Located After you ask for directions, you have to be ready to understand the answers you may receive. After all, if you don’t understand how a language describes how to get from one place to another, you’ll have a hard time following directions. In this section, you can put an end to your helplessness by mastering

Chapter 1: Locating Places

175

the few simple words you need to understand (and ask about) the various directions in German. You also get up to speed on common prepositions used to describe locations, and you get a handle on how to follow instructions on turning left or right and how to understand compass points.

Locating one place in relation to another People commonly express the location of a place in relation to a well-known landmark or location. You can use quite a few prepositions to describe locations in this way. Luckily, all the prepositions used in this context use the dative case, so any articles after the preposition behave just as they do when used with zu, as described in the preceding section. In addition, the preposition bei (bay) (near/next to) and the article dem almost always contract like this: bei + dem = beim (baym). Table 1-1 shows you some common prepositions that are used to express the location of one thing in relation to another.

Table 1-1

Prepositions That Express Locations

Preposition

Pronunciation

Meaning

Example

an

ân

at

an der Ecke (ân dêr êk-e) (at the corner)

auf

ouf

on

auf der Museumsinsel (ouf dêr moo-zey-ooms-in-sel) (on the Museum Island)

bei

bay

near/next to

beim Bahnhof (baym bahn-hohf) (near the train station)

hinter

hin-ter

behind

hinter der Kirche (hin-ter dêr kirH-e) (behind the church)

neben

ney-ben

next to

neben der Bank (ney-ben dêr bânk) (next to the bank)

vor

fohr

in front of

vor der Post (fohr dêr post) (in front of the post office)

zwischen

tsvi-shen

between

zwischen dem Theater und der Bank (tsvish-en deym tey-ah-ter oont dêr bânk) (between the theater and the bank)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

176

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Talkin’ the Talk Mike is on a business trip to München (muen-Hen) (Munich), a city he hasn’t visited before. He wants to take a cab to get to a friend’s house, but he needs some help finding the nearest taxi stand. So he approaches a woman on the street. (Track 21) Entschuldigen Sie, bitte, wo ist der nächste Taxistand? ênt-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te, voh ist dêr naiH-ste tâx-ee-shtant? Excuse me, where is the nearest taxi stand? Mike:

Frau:

In der Sonnenstraße. in dêr zon-en-shtrah-se. On Sonnen Street.

Ich kenne mich in München leider nicht aus. Wie komme ich zur Sonnenstraße? iH kên-e miH in muen-Hen lay-der niHt ous. vee kom-e iH tsoor zon-en-shtrah-se? Unfortunately, I don’t know my way around Munich. How do I get to Sonnen Street? Mike:

Frau:

Mike:

Sehen Sie die Kirche dort drüben? Hinter der Kirche ist der Sendlinger-Tor-Platz und direkt gegenüber ist der Taxistand. zey-en zee dee kirH-e dort drue-ben? hin-ter dêr kirH-e ist dêr zênd-leeng-er-tohr-plâts oont di-rêkt gey-gen-ue-ber ist dêr tâx-ee-shtânt. Do you see the church over there? Behind the church is Sendlinger-Tor Square and directly opposite is the taxi stand. Vielen Dank! fee-len dânk! Thank you very much!

Chapter 1: Locating Places

177

Words to Know Wo ist. . . ?

voh ist. . . ?

Where is. . . ?

nächste

naiH-ste

nearest

sich auskennen

ziH ous-kên-en

to know one’s way around

weit

vayt

far

in der Nähe

in dêr nai-he

nearby

hinter

hin-ter

behind

vor

fohr

in front of

neben

ney-ben

next to

an

ân

at

Going left, right, straight ahead: Links, rechts, geradeaus Unless you tackle the words for the various directions such as left, right, or straight ahead, you may find yourself trying to find the town hall by tugging at some stranger’s sleeve and chanting Rathaus (rât-hous) over and over, hoping he’ll lead you to the right building. To avoid that embarrassing situation, commit the following directional words to memory: ✓ links (links) (left) ✓ rechts (rêHts) (right) ✓ geradeaus (ge-rah-de-ous) (straight ahead)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

178

Book II: Speaking German on the Go If you want to express that something is located to the left or right of something else, you add the preposition von (fon) (of), making the following: ✓ links von (links fon) (to the left of) ✓ rechts von (rêHts fon) (to the right of) Check out these examples that use von and a defining position: Der Markt ist links von der Kirche. (dêr mârkt ist links fon dêr kirH-e.) (The market is to the left of the church.) Die U-Bahnstation ist rechts vom Theater. (dee ooh-bahn-shtât-see-ohn ist rêHts fom tey-ah-ter.) (The subway station is to the right of the theater.) When the preposition von combines with dem (deym), it usually contracts like this: von + dem = vom (fom). (Dem is the dative form of the masculine definite article der and the neuter definite article das. Book IV, Chapter 2 gives you more info on the dative case.) You also may hear the word for side, die Seite (dee zay-te), in connection with directions. Seite can help directions be more specific. For example: Das Museum ist auf der linken Seite. (dâs moo-zey-oom ist ouf dêr linken zay-te.) (The museum is on the left side.) Die Bank ist auf der rechten Seite. (dee bânk ist ouf dêr rêHt-en zay-te.) (The bank is on the right side.)

Using compass points Instead of using left, right, or straight ahead, some folks give directions by using the points of the compass (also called cardinal points). These points are ✓ der Norden (dêr nor-den) (the north) ✓ der Süden (dêr zue-den) (the south) ✓ der Osten (dêr os-ten) (the east) ✓ der Westen (dêr wês-ten) (the west) If someone uses cardinal points to tell you the specific location of a place, you may hear something like Der Hafen liegt im Norden/Süden/Osten/Westen. (dêr hah-fen leekt im nor-den/zue-den/os-ten/vês-ten.) (The harbor lies [is] in the north/south/ east/west.)

Chapter 1: Locating Places

179

To describe a location, for example, in the north, you use the preposition in with a definite article in the dative case. When the definite article is masculine (der) or neuter (das), it changes to dem (deym), and the preposition in usually contracts to im like this: in + dem = im (im).

Understanding Where to Go You ask where something is located, and a kind stranger rattles off some details that include landmarks and street names you’re unfamiliar with. One way to make sure you understand is to repeat what you’ve heard, especially the information about when to turn left or right and when to go straight ahead. If that doesn’t work, you can always approach another person and ask where to go.

Pointing out the first, second, or third street When you ask for directions, you may get the answer that you should take a specific street — the second street on the left or the first street on the right, for example. One, two, three, four, and similar numbers are referred to as cardinal numbers, while numbers like first, second, third, and fourth are called ordinal numbers. Ordinal numbers indicate the specific order of something. For example, to answer the question “Which house?” you use an ordinal number to say, “The fifth house on the left.” In German, you form ordinal numbers by adding the suffix -te to the cardinal numbers for numbers between 1 and 19 — with the following exceptions: ✓ eins (ayns) (one)/erste (êrs-te) (first) ✓ drei (dray) (three)/dritte (drit-e) (third) ✓ sieben (zee-ben) (seven)/siebte (zeep-te) (seventh) ✓ acht (âHt) (eight)/achte (âHt-e) (eighth) Ordinals 20 and above all add the suffix -ste to the cardinal number. Table 1-2 shows how to form the ordinal numbers 1 through 10, including one example of an ordinal number formed with a “-teen” number and another example for an ordinal above 20.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

180

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Table 1-2

Sample Cardinal and Ordinal Numbers

Cardinal Number

Ordinal Number

eins (ayns) (one)

der/die/das erste (êrs-te) (first)

zwei (tsvay) (two)

zweite (tsvay-te) (second)

drei (dray) (three)

dritte (drit-e) (third)

vier (feer) (four)

vierte (feer-te) (fourth)

fünf (fuenf) (five)

fünfte (fuenf-te) (fifth)

sechs (zêks) (six)

sechste (zêks-te) (sixth)

sieben (zeeb-en) (seven)

siebte (zeep-te) (seventh)

acht (âHt) (eight)

achte (âHt-e) (eighth)

neun (noyn) (nine)

neunte (noyn-te) (ninth)

zehn (tseyn) (ten)

zehnte (tseyn-te) (tenth)

siebzehn (zeep-tseyn) (seventeen)

siebzehnte (zeep-tseyn-te) (seventeenth)

vierzig (fir-tsiH) (forty)

vierzigste (fir-tsiH-ste) (fortieth)

See Book I, Chapter 2 for more information about cardinal and ordinal numbers. Because they’re used like adjectives, the ordinal numbers take the gender and case of the noun they refer to. Table 1-3 shows you how the adjective erste and the article that comes before it changes in each case.

Table 1-3

Breaking Down an Ordinal Number by Case and Gender: Erste (êrs-te) (first)

Noun’s Gender

Nominative

Genitive

Dative

Accusative

Masculine (der)

der erste

des ersten

dem ersten

den ersten

Feminine (die)

die erste

der ersten

der ersten

die erste

Neuter (das)

das erste

des ersten

dem ersten

das erste

Plural (die)

die ersten

der ersten

den ersten

die ersten

Following directions: Take this street When you give or receive directions, you need to be familiar with the verbs gehen (gey-en) (to go) and nehmen (ney-men) (to take) in the imperative. (For the moment, just focus on the word order. You find out more about

Chapter 1: Locating Places

181

imperative sentences — those that give commands — in Book III, Chapter 7.) With the imperative, the verb goes at the beginning of the sentence. For example: Nehmen Sie die zweite Straße links. (ney-men zee dee tsvay-te shtrah-se links.) (Take the second street on the left.) Gehen Sie die erste Straße rechts. (gey-en zee dee êrs-te shtrah-se rêHts.) (Go down the first street on the right.) If you simply have to go straight ahead, you may hear these instructions: Gehen Sie immer geradeaus. (gey-en zee im-er ge-rah-de-ous.) (Go straight ahead.) If you’re looking for a specific building, you may hear something like this: Es ist das dritte Haus auf der linken Seite. (ês ist dâs drit-e house [as in English] ouf dêr lin-ken zay-te.) (It is the third house on the left side.)

Talkin’ the Talk Erika is in town on business and wants to meet an old friend who also happens to be in town on business. She has the address of the hotel where her friend is staying, but she isn’t sure where the street is located, so she asks for help. (Track 22) Erika: Entschuldigung? ênt-shool-di-goong? Excuse me? Mann: Ja, bitte? yah, bi-te? Yes, please? Erika : Wie komme ich zur Beethovenstraße? vee kom-e iH tsoor bey-toh-fên-shtrah-se? How do I get to Beethoven Street? Mann:

Nehmen Sie die U-Bahn am Opernplatz. ney-men zee dee ooh-bahn âm oh-pêrn-plâts. You have to take the subway at Opera Square.

Erika:

Und wo ist der Opernplatz? oont voh ist dêr oh-pêrn-plâts? And where is Opera Square?

Book II Speaking German on the Go

182

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Mann:

Gehen Sie die Wodanstraße geradeaus. Dann gehen Sie links in die Reuterstraße. Rechts liegt die Post und direkt gegenüber ist der Opernplatz. gey-en zee dee voh-dahn-shtrah-se ge-rah-de-ous. dân gey-en zee links in dee roy-ter-shtrah-se. rêHts leekt dee post oont dee-rêkt gey-gen-ue-ber ist dêr oh-pêrn-plâts. Go straight down Wodan Street. Then go left onto Reuter Street. On the right you see the post office and directly opposite is Opera Square.

Und welche U-Bahn nehme ich? Erika: oont vêlH-e ooh-bahn ney-me iH? And which subway do I take?

Die U5 bis zur Station Beethovenstraße. dee ooh fuenf bis tsoor shtat-tsee-ohn bey-toh-fên-shtrah-se. Take the subway 5 to the stop Beethoven Street.

Erika:

Vielen Dank! fee-len dânk! Thank you very much!

Mann:

Words to Know links

links

left

rechts

rêHts

right

Wo ist. . . ?

voh ist. . . ?

Where is. . . ?

Nehmen Sie . . .

ney-men zee . . .

Take . . .

Gehen Sie . . .

gey-en zee . . .

Go . . .

die U-Bahn

dee ooh-bahn

subway

Chapter 1: Locating Places

183

Traveling by Car — das Auto — or Other Vehicle In English, whether you’re going by car or on foot doesn’t make much difference; distance aside, you’re still going somewhere. However, the German verb gehen (gey-en) (to go) isn’t that flexible. You may “go” on foot, which would require zu Fuß gehen (tsooh foohs gey-en). But if you take the car, the bus, a bicycle, or another form of transportation, you’re “driving,” which takes fahren (fahr-en) — not gehen — even if you aren’t behind the wheel. When using fahren in a sentence, you need three things: the word for the type of vehicle in which you’re traveling, the preposition mit (mit) (with), and the dative version of the vehicle’s article. Here’s an example of how you use the verb fahren in a sentence to say that you’re taking a specific type of transportation: Ich fahre mit dem Auto/mit dem Bus/mit dem Rad. (iH fahr-e mit deym ou-toh/mit deym boos/mit deym râd.) (I’m going by car/by bus/by bicycle. Literally: I’m driving with the car/with the bus/with the bicycle.) You use the verb fahren whether you’re describing turns you or someone else makes on a bike, in a pair of inline skates, or on a snowboard. You simply say Fahren Sie links/rechts. (fahr-en zee links/rêHts.) (Go left/right. Literally: Drive left/right.) If you get lost driving around, always remember to pull this expression from your memory: Ich habe mich verfahren. Ich suche . . . (iH hah-be miH fêr-fahr-en. iH zoohH-e . . .) (I’ve lost my way. I’m looking for . . .) See Book II, Chapter 5 for more information on words you need for getting around in a car or other vehicle.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

184

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Talkin’ the Talk Paula has rented a car to go to Frankfurt for a day trip. She’s on her way to Bockenheim, a district of Frankfurt, and she stops at a gas station to ask the pump attendant (Tankwart) for directions. Paula: Entschuldigen Sie, wie komme ich nach Bockenheim? ênt-shool-di-gên zee, vee kom-e iH nahH bok-en-haym? Excuse me, how do I get to Bockenheim? Tankwart: Paula:

Nehmen Sie die Ausfahrt Frankfurt-Messe. Das sind ungefähr vier Kilometer von hier. ney-men zee dee ous-fahrt frânk-foort mês-e. Dâs zint oon-ge-fair feer ki-lo-mey-ter fon heer. Take the exit Frankfurt-Messe. That is approximately 4 kilometers from here. Alles klar! Danke. âl-es klahr! dân-ke. Okay! Thank you.

Paula makes it to Bockenheim but then seems to have lost her way. She stops her car and asks a policeman (Polizei) for directions. Entschuldigen Sie, ich habe mich verfahren. Ich suche den Hessenplatz. ênt-shool-di-gên zee, iH hah-be miH fêr-fahr-en. iH zoohH-e deyn hês-ên-plâts. Excuse me, I’ve lost my way. I’m looking for Hessen Square.

Paula:

Polizei:

Paula:

An der nächsten Kreuzung fahren Sie rechts. Dann fahren Sie geradeaus, ungefähr einen Kilometer. Der Hessenplatz liegt auf der linken Seite. ân dêr naiH-sten kroy-tsoong fahr-en zee rêHts. dân fahr-en zee ge-rah-de-ous, oon-ge-fair ayn-en ki-lomey-ter. dêr hês-en-plâts leekt ouf dêr lin-ken zay-te. Go left at the next intersection. Then go straight on, approximately one kilometer. Hessen Square is on the left side. Vielen Dank! fee-len dânk! Thank you very much!

Chapter 2

Going Out on the Town In This Chapter ▶ Doing some sightseeing ▶ Going to the movies, the museum, a concert, or a party ▶ Talking about an event you attend

Y

ou find a surprisingly large number of cultural venues in Germany and most of the rest of Europe. Not only do the arts receive state and federal funds to support their efforts, but Europeans also have a long-standing appreciation of their cultural assets. So if you’re interested in visiting a museum and you happen to be in Berlin, you have more than 170 to choose from! Das Pergamonmuseum (dâs pêr-gâ-mon-moo-sey-oom) (Pergamon Museum) is a great place to start, with its priceless world treasures that include ancient Greek, Roman, and Etruscan artifacts.

To get a taste of German culture, check the media to find out what’s going on. Along with local websites, the local newspapers and other media offer weekly guides of local events by publishing a Veranstaltungskalender (fêr-ân-shtâltoongs-kâ-len-der) (calendar of events). However you decide to spend your time, you’re sure to enjoy it more when you make some careful plans beforehand. This chapter helps you decide what you want to see and do when you’re visiting a new place and how to do it.

Taking in the Sights When you’re deciding what you want to do and see, you may want to take in the sights and activities that are unique to that place. Europe is steeped in a rich culture and lifestyle that ranges from cafés to classical music, from museums to mountain climbing, and most everything in between. When

186

Book II: Speaking German on the Go you’re planning your day, you may find it best to begin with the most ambitious activities, such as hiking around the ramparts of a Burg (boork) (castle) perched atop the city of Salzburg, and allow for some down time in the afternoon before attending a Konzert (kon-tsêrt) (concert) in the evening. In case you’re not the planning type, you can take a Stadtrundfahrt (shtâtroond-fahrt) (city tour) and let the experts show you the highlights of the city. Many of the same organizations that offer city tours can help you book an interesting Tagesausflug (dêr tahg-es-ous-floohk) (day trip) to any number of outlying areas around the city you’re visiting. This section gives you useful terms and expressions for talking about various sightseeing options. You may want to join a guided tour through a castle or go on a city bicycle tour with a small group or set out on your own to explore the sights.

Deciding what to see When you travel, you first have to figure out what sorts of places to see and then decide how to get to them in the amount of time you have. If you’re doing a lot of traveling, you may consider mixing a morning Stadtrundfahrt (shtât-roond-fahrt) (city tour) with some other type of afternoon activity, such as Menschen beobachten (mên-shên be-oh-bâHt-en) (people watching) from the vantage point of a Café (kâf-ey) (café), or taking a Spaziergang (shpâts-eer-gâng) (walk/stroll) through a city park to see how the natives spend their free time. Some of the sights you find in and around cities include the following: ✓ der botanische Garten (dêr boh-tân-ish-e gâr-ten) (botanical garden) ✓ die Burg (dee boork) (castle) (usually on a hill) ✓ das Denkmal (dâs dênk-mâl) (monument) ✓ die Galerie (dee gâl-êr-ee) (gallery) ✓ die Kirche (dee kirH-e) (church) ✓ der Markt (dêr mârkt) (market) ✓ das Monument (dâs mon-oo-mênt) (monument) ✓ das Museum (dâs moo-sey-oom) (museum) ✓ der Palast (dêr pâ-lâst) (palace) ✓ der Park (dêr park [as in English]) (park)

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town

187

✓ der Platz (dêr plâts) (square) ✓ das Rathaus (dâs rât-hous) (town hall) ✓ das Schloss (dâs shlos) (castle) ✓ das Stadion (dâs shtah-dee-on) (stadium) ✓ die Statue (dee shtât-oo-e) (statue) ✓ das Theater (dâs tey-ah-ter) (theater) ✓ der Tierpark (dêr teer-park [as in English]) (zoo) When you’re deciding what to see and do, you may notice that place names may or may not have the identifying word for that particular sight. It’s easy to decipher what sort of place the Olympiastadion (oh-lerm-pee-â-shtah-deeon) (Olympic stadium) is when you break down the two words. Other places may not be so obvious because they don’t contain a word that describes what that place is. Take, for example, der Friedensengel (dêr freed-enz-êng-el) (angel of peace), which is found in both Berlin and Munich. The term is a combination of the two words, Frieden (freed-en) (peace/freedom) and Engel (êng-el) (angel), and it describes a monument with a golden angel mounted on a pedestal. When you’re on the street asking someone where to find such a location, the natives are much more likely to understand you when you use the German term for that place, even if your pronunciation isn’t perfect. Try asking about places like this: Entschuldigen Sie, bitte. Wo ist der Friedensengel? (ent-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te. voh ist dêr freed-enz-êng-el?) (Excuse me, please. Where is the angel of peace?) Entschuldigen Sie, bitte. Ist das der Reichstag? (ent-shool-di-gen zee, bi-te. ist dâs dêr reyHs-tahk?) (Excuse me, please. Is that the German parliament building?)

Taking a sightseeing tour German-speaking cities offer guided tours of all kinds, and you can often choose a tour in English if you don’t feel confident listening to German for several hours. You may also be interested in getting outside of the bustling city atmosphere by booking a day excursion to an outlying tourist destination like the castle Neuschwanstein (noy-shvân-shtayn), which inspired Disneyland’s fantasy castle. Your choices are practically boundless, so you only have to decide what suits you. If you don’t like being in a group, ask about hiring a private guide.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

188

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Here are some terms for sightseeing tours you may encounter: ✓ die City-Sightseeing (dee city sightseeing [as in English]) (city sightseeing) ✓ die Fahrradtour (dee fahr-râd-toor) (bicycle tour) ✓ die Gruppenführung (dee groop-en-fuer-oong) (group tour) ✓ die Hafenrundfahrt (dee hah-fên-roond-fahrt) (harbor boat tour) ✓ die Schiffsrundfahrt (dee shifs-roond-fahrt) (boat tour) ✓ die Stadtführung (dee shtât-fuer-oong) (city tour) ✓ die Stadtrundfahrt (dee shtât-roond-fahrt) (city tour) ✓ die Stadttour (dee shtât-tour) (city tour) ✓ der Tagesausflug (dêr tahg-es-ous-floohk) (day trip) ✓ Hamburg by Night (Hamburg by Night [as in English]) (Hamburg by night; a tour of some of the popular night spots in the lively St. Pauli quarter of Hamburg; other cities offer the same) When you’re trying to decide what sort of sightseeing tour to take, you may want to know some specific information about the tour. Here are some questions you may find useful: Wie lange dauert die Führung? (vee lâng-e dou-êrt dee fuer-oong?) (How long does the tour last?) Wo ist der Treffpunkt? (voh ist dêr trêf-poonkt?) (Where is the meeting point?) Ist das Mittagessen im Preis enthalten? (ist dâs mi-tahk-ês-en im prays ênt-hâlt-en?) (Is lunch included in the price?) Gibt es eine Tour auf Englisch? (gipt ês ayn-e tour [as in English] ouf êng-lish?) (Is there a tour in English?)

Making plans Sometimes you may want to go out by yourself, and other times you may want company. If you’re in the mood for companionship and want to toss around ideas with someone about what to do, you can ask Was wollen wir unternehmen? (vâs vol-en veer oon-ter-ney-men?) (What do we want to do?)

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town

189

Use the following phrases if you want to find out about somebody’s plans or if you want to know whether somebody is available: Haben Sie (heute Abend) etwas vor? (hah-ben zee [hoy-te ah-bênt] êt-vâs fohr?) (Do you have anything planned [for this evening]?) Haben Sie (heute Abend) Zeit? (hah-ben zee [hoy-te ah-bênt] tsayt) (Do you have time this evening?) Hast du (morgen Vormittag) etwas vor? (hâst dooh [mor-gen fohrmi-tahk] êt-vâs fohr?) (Do you have anything planned [for tomorrow morning]?) Use the formal Sie (zee) (you) when you don’t know the person you’re speaking with very well; use the informal du (dooh) (you) only when you’re on mutually familiar terms. Notice that the form of the verb changes along with the Sie and du forms: Haben Sie. . . ? and Hast du. . . ?

Heading to the Movies Watching films in a language you want to learn is a terrific way of getting your ear accustomed to how the language sounds. At the same time, you can get used to understanding many different speakers. All around the world, in fact, people learn English by watching American movies. When you want to tell someone that you’re interested in going to the movies, you can use the following phrases: Ich möchte ins Kino gehen. (iH merH-te ins kee-noh gey-en.) (I would like to go to the movies.) Ich möchte einen Film sehen. (iH merH-te ayn-en film zey-en.) (I would like to see a film.)

Going to the show If you’re searching for a movie to go to, your best bet is to check out local websites, weekly guides of local events, or newspaper listings. The listings usually tell you everything you need to know about der Film (dêr film)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

190

Book II: Speaking German on the Go (movie) or die Vorstellung (dee fohr-stêl-oong) (the show): when and where the movie is playing, who the actors are, and whether the movie is in its original language. Here are some terms that may come in handy: ✓ im Original (im o-ri-gi-nahl) (original) ✓ OmU, which stands for Original mit Untertiteln (o-ri-gi-nahl mit oon-têrti-teln) (original with subtitles) ✓ synchronisiert (zyn-kro-nee-zeert) (dubbed) If you don’t have access to the Internet or other sources of information, the following phrases can help you ask for information about a movie: In welchem Kino läuft. . . ? (in vêlH-êm kee-noh loyft. . . ?) (In which movie theater is . . . showing?) Wo läuft. . . ? (voh loyft. . . ?) (Where is . . . playing?) Um wie viel Uhr beginnt der Film? (oom vee feel oohr be-gint dêr film?) (At what time does the movie start?) Läuft der Film im Original oder ist er synchronisiert? (loyft dêr film im o-ri-gi-nahl oh-der ist êr zyn-kro-nee-zeert?) (Is the film shown in the original [language] or is it dubbed?) Most foreign films shown in Germany are dubbed into German, although some movie theaters, especially the small independents, specialize in showing foreign films in the original language with German subtitles — Originalfassung mit deutschen Untertiteln (o-ri-gi-nahl-fâs-oong mit doy-chen oon-têr-ti-teln) (original version with German subtitles). So if you’re not into the mind-altering experience of listening to Hollywood actors assume strange voices and speak in tongues, keep an eye open for the undubbed version of the film or go see movies filmed in German exclusively. If you do go to the Originalfassung mit Untertiteln (o-ri-gi-nahl-fâs-oong mit oon-têr-ti-teln) (original version with subtitles) of an American movie, you have the advantage of reading the German as you listen to the English, and you may pick up some useful expressions. From the standpoint of language input, you may enjoy the ads and the trailers just as much as the actual movie, so be sure to get to the movie theater in time to catch these parts of the Vorstellung (fohr-shtêl-oong) (show).

Buying tickets You can use the following phrase whenever you want to buy tickets, whether they’re for the opera, the movies, or the museum: Ich möchte (zwei) Karten/Eintrittskarten für . . . (iH merH-te [tsvay] kâr-ten/ayn-trits-kâr-ten fuer . . .) (I would like [two] tickets/entrance tickets for . . .)

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town

191

After buying your tickets for a movie, you may get some information from the ticket seller, including the following: Der Film hat schon begonnen. (dêr film hât shon be-gon-en.) (The movie has already started.) Der . . . Uhr Film ist leider ausverkauft. (dêr . . . film ist lay-der ous-fêrkouft.) (The . . . o’clock movie is unfortunately sold out.) Wir haben noch Karten für den Film um . . . Uhr. (veer hah-ben noH kâr-ten fuer deyn film . . . oohr.) (There are tickets left for the movie at . . . o’clock.) Note: German has two words that mean ticket (for a show) — Karte and Eintrittskarte. The difference is simply the fact that Eintrittskarte is a compound word that translates roughly as entrance ticket. You come across many such compound words in German, and they’re frequently a combination of two words, in this case, Eintritt(s) and Karte.

Talkin’ the Talk Antje is talking to her friend Robert on the phone. Antje wants to go to the movies. After greeting her friend, Antje gets right to the point. (Go to www.dummies.com/go/germanaio to listen to this bonus track.) Der neue Zeichentrickfilm von Pixar Studios soll super witzig sein. dêr noy-e tsayH-en-trik-film fon pix-ahr shtooh-deeohs sol sooh-per vits-eeH zayn. The new animated film from Pixar Studios is supposed to be incredibly funny. Antje:

Robert:

Wann willst du gehen? vân vilst dooh gey-en? When do you want to go?

Antje:

Morgen Abend habe ich Zeit. mor-gen ah-bênt hah-be iH tsayt. I have time tomorrow evening.

Robert:

Morgen passt mir auch. In welchem Kino läuft der Film? mor-gen pâst meer ouH. in vêlH-êm kee-noh loyft dêr film? Tomorrow works for me as well. In which movie theater is the film showing?

Book II Speaking German on the Go

192

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Antje: Im Hansatheater. Der Film beginnt um 20 Uhr. im hân-sâ-tey-ah-ter. dêr film be-gint oom tsvân-tsiH oohr. In the Hansa Theater. The movie starts at 8 p.m. Gut, treffen wir uns um Viertel vor acht vor dem Kino. gooht, trêf-en veer oons oom fir-tel fohr âHt fohr deym kee-noh. Okay. Let’s meet at a quarter to eight in front of the movie theater. Robert:

Antje:

Prima. Bis morgen dann. pree-mâ. bis mor-gen dân. Great. Until tomorrow then.

Words to Know das Kino

dâs kee-no

movie theater

der Spielfilm

dêr shpeel-film

feature film

der Film

dêr film

film

die Vorstellung

dee fohr-shtêl-oong

show

die Karte

dee kâr-te

ticket

die Eintrittskarte

dee ayn-trits-kâr-te

entrance ticket

witzig

vits-eeH

funny

sehen

zey-en

to see

laufen

louf-en

to show

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town

193

Going to the Museum Germany has a long and rich museum tradition with many world-renowned museums sprinkled across the country. Most German museums receive state or federal funds and, as a result, often charge surprisingly low entrance fees.

Discovering different types of museums If you’re into art, keep an eye open for the Kunstmuseum (koonst-moo-seyoom) (art museum). If you want to find out more about the traditional lifestyle of a certain area, go to the Freilichtmuseum (fray-leeHt-moo-sey–oom) (openair museum). In Germany, you can find museums for virtually everything a human being might fancy, including a Biermuseum (beer-moo-sey-um) (beer museum) in Munich and several other locations! Museum mavens beware: German museums, like many European museums and other cultural centers, are closed on Mondays — montags geschlossen (mohntahks ge-shlos-en). Others are closed on dienstags (deens-tahks) (Tuesdays). Make sure to check die Öffnungszeiten (dee erf-noongs-tsayt-en) (the opening hours) before heading out. Many museums, performances, and other places offer discount tickets to students, so you may want to take advantage of these discounts by getting an international student ID before you leave home.

Talking about museums When you want to catch an exhibition — Ausstellung (ous-shtêl-oong) — the following phrases come in handy: Ich möchte ins Museum gehen. (iH merH-te ins moo-sey-oom gey-en.) (I would like to go to the museum.) Ich möchte die . . . Ausstellung sehen. (iH merH-te dee . . . ous-shtêl-oong zey-en.) (I would like to see the . . . exhibition.) In welchem Museum läuft die . . . Ausstellung? (in vêlH-em moo-sey-oom loyft dee . . . ous-shtêl-oong?) (At which museum is the . . . exhibit running?) Ist das Museum montags geöffnet? (ist dâs moo-sey-oom mohn-tahks ge-erf-net?) (Is the museum open on Mondays?) Um wie viel Uhr öffnet das Museum? (oom vee feel oohr erf-net dâs moo-sey-oom?) (At what time does the museum open?) Gibt es eine Sonderausstellung? (gipt ês ayn-e zon-der-ous-shtêl-oong?) (Is there a special exhibit?)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

194

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Talkin’ the Talk Jan and Mona are planning a trip to a museum. They invite their friend Ingo to join them. Jan:

Hallo, Ingo. Wir wollen morgen ins Städtische Museum. hâ-lo, in-go. veer vol-en mor-gen ins shtê-ti-she moo-sey-oom. Hi, Ingo. We want to go to the city museum tomorrow.

Wir wollen uns die Ausstellung über die Bronzezeit ansehen. Kommst du mit? veer vol-en oons dee ous-shtêl-oong ue-ber dee brontse-tsayt ân-zey-en. komst dooh mit? We want to see the exhibit about the Bronze Age. Do you want to come along? Mona:

Ingo:

Hmm, ich weiß nicht. Die Ausstellung habe ich schon letzte Woche gesehen. hmm, iH vays niHt. dee ous-shtêl-oong hah-be iH shohn lets-te voH-e ge-zey-en. Hmm, I don’t know. I already saw the exhibit last week.

Mona:

Hat sie dir gefallen? hât zee deer ge-fâl-en? Did you like it?

Ingo:

Ja. Vielleicht komme ich noch einmal mit. yah. fee-layHt kom-e iH noH ayn-mahl mit. Yes. Maybe I’ll come along for a second time.

Jan: Wir wollen morgen um 10.00 Uhr in die Ausstellung. veer vol-en mor-gen oom tseyn oohr in dee ous-shtêl-oong. We want to go to the exhibit tomorrow at ten o’clock. Ingo:

Gut. Ich treffe euch dort. gooht. iH trêf-e oyH dohrt. Good. I’ll meet you there.

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town

195

Attending Cultural Performances Wherever you may be staying in Europe, you’re probably just a short trip away from cultural centers that present such events as Oper (oh-per) (opera), Konzert (kon-tsêrt) (concert), Sinfonie (sin-foh-nee) (symphony), and Theater (tey-ah-ter) (theater). After all, performing arts centers abound in Europe. Summertime is when you find the greatest number of musical performances ranging from techno to opera and just about everything in between. When you’re thinking about taking in some musical entertainment, pick up a local newspaper, go to a ticket agency, or go online to the city website to find out what’s happening where.

Deciding where to go With all the entertainment options available in Germany (and elsewhere in Europe), you may want to consider doing something that you normally can’t do when you’re at home. For instance, if you aren’t familiar with opera, now would be a great opportunity to try it. If you’re up for going out on the town, say Ich möchte heute Abend ausgehen. (iH merH-te hoy-te ah-bênt ous-gey-en.) (I would like to go out this evening.) The following words and phrases may be helpful during a night out: Ich möchte ins Theater/Konzert gehen. (iH merH-te ins tey-ah-ter/ kon-tsert gey-en.) (I would like to go to the theater/a concert.) Ich möchte in die Oper gehen. (iH merH-te in dee oh-per gey-en.) (I would like to go to the opera.) Gehen wir ins Theater/Konzert. (gey-en veer ins tey-ah-ter/kon-tsert.) (Let’s go to the theater/a concert.) Gehen wir ins Ballet. (gey-en veer ins bâ-lêt.) (Let’s go to the ballet.) Wann ist die Premiere von. . . ? (vân ist dee prêm-yee-re fon. . . ?) (When is the opening night of. . . ?) In welchem Theater spielt. . . ? (in vêlH-em tey-ah-ter shpeelt. . . ?) (In which theater is . . . showing?)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

196

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Worried about the dress code? It’s relatively liberal, although Europeans do enjoy getting decked out for opera and symphony performances, especially for Premiere (prêm-yee-re) (opening night) or a Galavorstellung (gâ-lâ-fohrshtêl-oong) (gala performance). Other than that, as long as you stay away from the T-shirt, jeans, and sneakers look, you won’t stick out like a sore thumb.

Words to Know das Theater

dâs tey-ah-ter

theater

die Oper

dee oh-per

opera/opera house

die Sinfonie

dee sin-foh-nee

symphony

das Ballett

dâs bâ-lêt

ballet

die Pause

dee pou-ze

intermission

der Sänger/die Sängerin

dêr zên-ger/dee zên-ge-rin

singer

der Schauspieler/ die Schauspielerin

dêr shou-shpee-ler/ dee shou-shpee-le-rin

actor/actress

der Tänzer/die Tänzerin

dêr tên-tser/dee tên-tse-rin

dancer

singen

zing-en

to sing

tanzen

tân-tsen

to dance

klatschen

klâch-en

to clap

der Beifall

dêr bay-fâl

applause

die Zugabe

dee tsooh-gah-be

encore

die Kinokasse/ Theaterkasse

dee kee-noh-kâs-e/ tey-ah-ter-kâs-e

movie/theater box office

der Platz

dêr plâts

seat

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town

197

Going to a concert Getting a taste of the music scene while you’re in a foreign country is a terrific way to relax and get to know the culture of the people. After all, many of the greatest composers of classical music were Austrian or German. Think Mozart, Haydn, Beethoven, Bach. . . . Germany, Austria, and Switzerland enjoy an overwhelmingly rich classical music Kulturerbe (kool-toohr-êr-be) (cultural heritage), which is one reason why old music traditions are so alive there today. Some of the most famous summer music festivals in Europe take place in Germany, Austria, and Switzerland. They include ✓ Richard Wagner Festspiele (riH-ârd vahg-ner fêst-spee-le) (Richard Wagner Music Festival): An annual Wagnerian opera festival that takes place in Bayreuth ✓ Salzburger Festspiele (zâlts-boorg-er fêst-spee-le) (Salzburg Music Festival): A six-week-long music festival in Salzburg, Austria ✓ Bregenzer Festspiele (brêg-ênts-er fêst-spee-le) (Bregenz Music Festival): A music festival that takes place in Bregenz, Austria At such performances, a great number of prominent people, including political dignitaries and movie actors from Europe and beyond, can be spotted posing for photographers in front of lavish concert halls. You may have a hard time getting tickets to the top-notch performances, and prices can be astronomical. But don’t worry; Germany, Austria, and Switzerland offer plenty of other lesser-known events for Otto Normalverbraucher (ot-oh nor-mâl-fêr-brouH-er) (average Joe). The following are some general terms and types of musical events that may interest you: ✓ die BallettFestwoche (die bâl-êt-fêst-woH-e) (ballet festival week) ✓ die Jazzmusik (dee jazz-[as in English]-moo-zeek) (jazz music) ✓ die Kammermusik (dee kâm-er-moo-zeek) (chamber music) ✓ die Kirchenmusik (dee kirH-en moo-zeek) (church music) ✓ die klassische Musik (dee klâs-ish-e moo-zeek) (classical music) ✓ der Konzertsaal (dêr kon-tsêrt-zâl) (concert hall) ✓ das Musikfest (dâs moo-zeek-fêst) (music festival) ✓ das Musikfestival (dâs moo-zeek-fês-ti-vâl) (music festival)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

198

Book II: Speaking German on the Go ✓ die Opernfestspiele (dee oh-pern-fêst-spee-le) (opera festival) ✓ die Philharmonie (dee fil-hâr-mon-ee) (philharmonic orchestra) ✓ das Quartett (dâs kvâr-têt) (quartet) ✓ der Rap (dêr rap [as in English]) (rap) ✓ die Rockmusik (dee rok-moo-zeek) (rock music) ✓ die Sinfonie (dee sin-fon-ee) (symphony) ✓ der Techno (dêr têH-noh) (techno) When the audience wants the performers to play more music, they shout Zugabe! (tsoo-gâ-be) (encore). So if you like the music you hear on your next night out, feel free to join in the shouting. Oh, and of course, you can show your appreciation with klatschen (klatsh-en) (clapping).

How Was It? Talking about Entertainment One of the best parts about watching a movie, going to a concert, or attending some other kind of performance is that you’re part of a captive audience. Afterward, you may want to compare your impressions with others who shared the evening. When you want to talk about your experience, you need to know how to express yourself using the past tense. You get a complete look at the past tense in Chapters 4 and 5 of Book IV; here you get a quick sample of things to say when you want to talk about what you did or saw on your night out. You find out how to ask others how they liked the entertainment and how to give your opinions on the evening’s experience.

Asking about the entertainment When it comes to entertainment, everybody seems to have an opinion. So why miss out on the fun? Somebody may ask you one of the following questions — or you may pose one of them to someone else — to start a conversation about an exhibition, film, or performance: Hat Ihnen die Ausstellung/der Film/die Oper gefallen? (hât een-en dee ous-shtêl-oong/dêr film/dee oh-per ge-fâl-en?) (Did you [formal] like the exhibition/the movie/the opera?) Hat dir die Ausstellung/der Film/die Oper gefallen? (hât deer dee ous-shtêl-oong/dêr film/dee oh-per ge-fâl-en?) (Did you [informal] like the exhibition/the movie/the opera?)

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town

199

Hast du eine Theaterkarte bekommen? (hâst dooh ayn-e tey-ah-ter-kârte be-kom-en?) (Did you get a theater ticket?) Habt ihr Karten für die Matinee gekauft? (hâpt eer kâr-ten fuer dee mâ-tee-ney ge-kouft?) (Did you buy tickets for the matinee?)

Telling people what you think Now comes the fun part — telling people what you thought about a film or performance you’ve just seen. For starters, you can say whether you liked the entertainment. Try one of the following on for size: Die Ausstellung/der Film/die Oper hat mir (sehr) gut gefallen. (dee ousshtêl-oong/dêr film/dee oh-per hât meer [zeyr] gooht ge-fâl-en.) (I liked the exhibition/the movie/the opera [a lot].) Die Ausstellung/der Film/die Oper hat mir (gar) nicht gefallen. (dee ous-shtêl-oong/dêr film/dee oh-per hât meer [gâr] niHt ge-fâl-en.) (I didn’t like the exhibition/the movie/the opera [at all].) Wir haben das Kino nach 20 Minuten verlassen. (veer hah-ben dâs keenoh nâH tsvân-tsiH mi-nooh-ten vêr-lâs-en.) (We left the movie theater after 20 minutes.) Ich habe viel gelacht. (iH hah-be feel ge-lâHt.) (I laughed a lot.) You may want to follow up your statement with a reason. Start out by saying Die Ausstellung/der Film/die Oper war wirklich . . . (dee ous-shtêl-oong/ dêr film/dee oh-per vahr virk-liH . . .) (The exhibition/the movie/ the opera was really . . .) Finish the thought with any of the following adjectives that apply. You can always string a few of them together with the conjunction und (oont) (and) to add even more zest to your statement: ✓ aufregend (ouf-rey-gent) (exciting) ✓ ausgezeichnet (ous-ge-tsayH-net) (excellent) ✓ enttäuschend (ênt-toy-shênt) (disappointing) ✓ fantastisch (fân-tâs-tish) (fantastic) ✓ langweilig (lâng-vay-liH) (boring) ✓ sehenswert (zey-êns-veyrt) (worth seeing) ✓ spannend (shpân-ênt) (thrilling, suspenseful) ✓ unterhaltsam (oon-ter-hâlt-tsahm) (entertaining) ✓ wunderschön (voon-der-shern) (beautiful)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

200

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Talkin’ the Talk

Frau Peters went to the theater last night. Today at the office, she’s telling her colleague Herr Krüger about the show. (Track 23) Herr Krüger: Sind Sie nicht gestern im Theater gewesen? zint zee niHt gês-tern im teh-ah-ter ge-vey-zen? Weren’t you at the theater last night? Frau Peters: Doch. Ich habe das neue BalIet gesehen. doH. iH hah-be dâs noy-e bâ-lêt ge-zey-en. Indeed. I saw the new ballet. Herr Krüger: Wie hat es Ihnen gefallen? vee hât ês een-en ge-fâl-en? How did you like it? Frau Peters: Die Tänzer waren fantastisch. Die Vorstellung hat mir ausgezeichnet gefallen. dee tên-tser vahr-ren fân-tâs-tish. dee fohr-shtêl-oong hât meer ous-ge-tsayH-net ge-fâl-en. The dancers were fantastic. I liked the performance very much. Herr Krüger: War es einfach, Karten zu bekommen? vahr ês ayn-fâH, kâr-ten tsooh be-kom-en? Was it easy to get tickets? Frau Peters: Ja. Ich habe die Karte gestern Morgen an der Theaterkasse gekauft. yah. iH hah-be dee kâr-te gês-tern mor-gen ân dêr tey-ah-ter-kâs-e ge-kouft. Yes. I bought the ticket at the box office yesterday morning.

Going to a Party Just as Americans do, German speakers have different ideas about what makes a good party. They enjoy organizing all kinds of gatherings, ranging from formal sit-down dinners to Sunday afternoon barbecues. If you’re invited to a formal gathering at somebody’s home, take a small gift, such as a bottle of wine or a bouquet of flowers, with you.

Chapter 2: Going Out on the Town

201

If you’re invited to an informal get-together, your host or hostess may ask you to bring along something to eat or drink. You can also take the initiative and ask whether you should bring anything by saying Soll ich etwas mitbringen? (zol iH êt-vâs mit-bring-en?) (Do you want me to bring anything?) If you’re invited to Kaffee und Kuchen (kâ-fey oont koohH-en) (coffee and cake) in the afternoon, a German institution, make sure you arrive on time. In fact, some Germans like to arrive ten minutes early just to be on the safe side, and they wait out on the street until the exact hour to ring the doorbell. Don’t expect to stay for dinner. You may be asked, but don’t count on it.

Getting an invitation You may hear any of the following common phrases when receiving an ­invitation — die Einladung (dee ayn-lah-doong) — to a party: Ich würde Sie gern zu einer Party einladen. (iH vuer-de zee gêrn tsooh ayn-er pâr-tee ayn-lah-den.) (I would like to invite you to a party.) Wir wollen ein Fest feiern. Hast du Lust zu kommen? (veer vol-en ayn fêst fay-ern. hâst dooh loost tsooh kom-en?) (We want to have a party. Doyou feel like coming?) If you can’t make it (or don’t want to go for some reason), you can politely turn down the invitation by saying one of the following: Nein, tut mir leid, ich kann leider nicht kommen. (nayn, toot meer layt, iH kân lay-der niHt kom-en.) (No, sorry, unfortunately I won’t be able to make it.) Nein, da kann ich leider nicht. Ich habe schon etwas anderes vor. (nayn, dâ kân iH lay-der niHt. iH hah-be shohn êt-vâs ân-de-res fohr.) (No, unfortunately I won’t be able to make it. I have other plans.) If you’d like to go, you can accept the invitation with one of the following phrases: Vielen Dank. Ich nehme die Einladung gern an. (fee-len dânk. iH neh-me dee ayn-lah-doong gêrn ân.) (Thank you very much. I’ll gladly accept the invitation.) Gut, ich komme gern. (gooht, iH kom-e gêrn.) (Good, I’d like to come.)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

202

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Talking about the party When someone asks you something like Wie war die Party am Samstag? (vee vahr dee pâr-tee âm zâms-tahk?) (How was the party on Saturday?), you can reply with any of these responses: Toll, wir haben bis . . . Uhr gefeiert. (tol, veer hah-ben bis . . . oohr ge-fay-êrt.) (Great. We partied until . . . o’clock.) Wir haben uns ausgezeichnet unterhalten. (veer hah-ben oons ous-getsayH-net oon-ter-hâl-ten.) (We had a great time.) Das Essen war. . . . (dâs ês-en vahr. . . .) (The food was. . . .) Wir haben sogar getanzt. (veer hah-ben zoh-gahr ge-tântst.) (We even danced.) Die Musik war. . . . (dee mooh-zeek vahr. . . .) (The music was. . . .) Das Fest war. . . . (dâs fêst vahr. . . .) (The party was. . . .) Check out the list of adjectives in the earlier section “Telling people what you think” for some appropriate descriptions to use with the preceding phrases.

Chapter 3

Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise! In This Chapter ▶ Booking a trip and getting ready to travel ▶ Staying busy with different recreational activities ▶ Gathering passports, visas, and other travel necessities ▶ Dealing with money while traveling

W

ould you like to go hiking in the Alps or head to the sea? How about a one-day Ausflug (ous-floohk) (excursion), perhaps from Munich to the pristine Bavarian lake of Königsee (ker-nig-zee)? Or what about a weeklong vacation Pauschalreise (pou-shahl-ray-ze) (package tour) to the Nordseeinseln (nord-zee-in-zêln) (North Sea islands)? No matter what destination you decide on, every trip requires some preparation. You need to check your calendar and set the dates, make sure your passport is valid for six months past the length of your trip (especially if you’re traveling across borders), make reservations, and so on. This chapter gives you some helpful language input to make your trip go as smoothly as possible.

Getting Ready for Your Trip Exploring new places while traveling can be very exciting, but before you can start exploring, you need to make enough plans that you know what to expect without burdening yourself with a strict itinerary that leaves no room for spontaneity. Whether you prefer gathering information online or working directly with a travel agent when planning a trip, you’ll find the information in this section useful.

204

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Finding travel information online You may want to go online to find more information about the destinations you’re interested in. With so many sites out there, you may have a hard time finding what you’re looking for. Don’t give up! A great deal of tourist information is available in multiple languages, including English. Simply go to the site you’re interested in and choose the English option if you don’t want to try to translate the German. If you don’t have a specific site in mind, do some googeln (goo-geln) (googling); start with google.de for Germany, google. at for Austria, and google.ch for Switzerland. Or simply type the name of a location into your browser and add the country address, like Innsbruck.at for Innsbruck, Austria. If you’re feeling adventurous, try looking at websites in German. Although it may seem more complicated at first, it’s actually a great way to expand your knowledge of the language and do some armchair traveling to Deutschland (doych-lânt), Österreich (er-stê-rayH), and die Schweiz (dee shvayz) (Germany, Austria, and Switzerland) at the same time. The following general terms are helpful when you want to check out information on German language websites: ✓ Angebote finden (find offers) ✓ anmelden (sign in) ✓ Hilfe (help) ✓ Login (log in) ✓ mehr (more) ✓ Startseite (home) ✓ Suche (search) ✓ Tipps (tips) ✓ zum Seitenanfang (return to top) Europeans have more vacation time at their disposal than North Americans, so many of them enjoy taking several Kurzurlaubsreisen (koorts-oohrloups-ray-zen) (short vacation trips) interspersed throughout the year as well as a longer Urlaub (oohr-loup) (vacation) of two or three weeks. While you’re in Europe, you may want to book a short three-day trip to a city like Berlin (bêr-leen) (Berlin) or Salzburg (zâlts-boorg) (Salzburg) or a week-long Pauschalreise (pou-shâl-ray-ze) (all-inclusive trip) to a popular warm-weather destination like Gran Canaria (grân câ-nahr-ee-â) (Gran Canaria), a Spanish island off the coast of northern Africa, or Antalya (ân-tahl-yâ) (Antalya), a city on the Mediterranean coast of Turkey.

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

205

You may come across the following terms as you’re looking at travel websites or travel brochures: ✓ Ferienunterkünfte (fêr-ee-en-oon-têr-kuenf-te) (vacation rentals) ✓ Flug & Hotel (floohk) (flight & hotel) ✓ Flüge (flueg-e) (flights) ✓ Hotels (hotels [as in English]) (hotels) ✓ Last Minute Reisen (last minute [as in English] rayz-en) (last-minute trips) ✓ Reiseziele (ray-ze-tsee-le) (travel destinations)

Book II

✓ Restaurants (rêst-uh-rons) (restaurants)

Speaking German on the Go

✓ Spezialangebote (spêts-ee-ahl-ân-gê-boh-te) (special deals) ✓ Städtereisen (shtêt-e-ray-zen) (city trips) ✓ Urlaubsreisen (oor-loups-ray-zen) (vacation trips) ✓ Wellness Urlaub (wellness [as in English] oor-loup) (spa-type vacation) Hotels may quote room prices like this: Einzelzimmer 95€ (ayn-tsêl-tsi-mer 95 oy-roh) (single room 95 euros) Doppelzimmer ab 170€ (dop-el-tsi-mer âp 170 oy-roh) (double room starting at 170 euros) Trip organizers may quote prices on a p. P. (proh pêr-zohn) (per person) basis, as shown in these examples: Preise bereits ab 495€ p. P. (prayz-e be-rayts âp 495 oy-roh proh pêr-zohn) (prices starting at 495 euros per person) Flug & Hotel ab 650€ p. P. (floohk & hotel [as in English] âp 650 oy-roh proh pêr-zohn) (flight & hotel starting at 650 euros per person) The large number of Kurorte (koohr-ort-e) (spa towns) in Europe stems from a centuries-old culture that involved the “taking of the waters,” in which the elite spent time at a luxurious hotel going in and out of Thermen (têr-men) (thermal springs) and saunas. Nowadays, many spa venues are reasonably priced, especially when you go for just the day. One of the most well-known Kurorte in Germany is Baden-Baden (bah-den-bah-den) (Baden-Baden), located near the French border. Locations where you can find spas are frequently named Bad (baht) (bath) followed by the name of the town; for example, two spa towns are Bad Reichenhall (baht rayH-en-hâl) in Germany and Bad Gastein (baht gash-tayn) in Austria.

206

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Getting help from a travel agent Booking your trip online is fast and convenient, yet you may find that a travel agent can better serve your needs when you’re already in Europe and want to plan a short trip from there. After all, you don’t want to get stuck spending five nights at a hotel that blasts ear-splitting music 24/7 from its poolside disco! When you first contact a travel agency, das Reisebüro (dâs ray-ze-bue-roh), say to the travel agent Ich möchte gern . . . (iH merH-te gêrn . . .) (I would like to . . .) At the end of this phrase, say any of the following to specify what you want the agent to do for you: . . . einen Flug nach . . . buchen. (. . . ayn-en floohk nahH . . . boohH-en.) (. . . book a flight to. . . .) . . . am . . . abfliegen. (. . . âm . . . âp-fleeg-en.) (. . . depart [fly] on the. . . .) . . . am . . . zurückfliegen. (. . . âm . . . tsoo-ruek-fleeg-en.) (. . . return [fly back] on the. . . .) . . . eine (Pauschal)reise nach . . . buchen. (. . . ayn-e [pou-shahl]-ray-ze nahH . . . boohH-en.) (. . . book a vacation [package] to. . . .) . . . einen Ausflug nach . . . buchen. (. . . ayn-en ous-floohk nahH . . . boohH-en.) (. . . book an excursion to. . . .) . . . ein Hotelzimmer reservieren. (. . . ayn hoh-têl-tsi-mer rê-zêr-vee-ren.) (. . . reserve a hotel room.)

Talkin’ the Talk Frau Burger wants to book a vacation package to the Spanish island of Mallorca (may-yor-kâ), a very popular destination for Germans. She calls a travel agency to book her trip. (Go to www. dummies.com/go/germanaio to listen to this bonus track.) Angestellter: Reisebüro Kunze, guten Tag! ray-ze-bue-roh koon-tse, gooh-ten tahk! Travel agency Kunze, hello! Frau Burger: Guten Tag. Ich möchte eine Pauschalreise für eine Woche nach Mallorca buchen. gooh-ten tahk. iH merH-te ayn-e pou-shâl-ray-ze fuer ayn-e woH-e naH may-yor-kâ boohH-en. Hello, I’d like to book a one-week vacation package to Mallorca.

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

207

Angestellter: Gut. Wann möchten Sie hinfliegen? gooht. vân merH-ten zee hin-fleeg-en? Good. When do you want to fly there? Frau Burger: Im Oktober. Aber wie sind die Preise? im ok-toh-ber. ah-ber vee zint dee pray-ze? In October. But what are the prices like? Angestellter: Keine Sorge. Oktober ist Nebensaison. Möchten Sie am 5. Oktober abfliegen? kayn-e zohr-ge. ok-toh-ber ist ney-ben-zey-zon. merH-ten zee âm fuenf-ten ok-toh-ber âp-fleeg-en? Not to worry. October is the low season. Would you like to leave on the fifth of October? Frau Burger: Perfekt. Das passt ausgezeichnet. pêr-fêkt. dâs pâst ous-ge-tsayH-nêt. Perfect. That suits me perfectly. Angestellter: Sehr gut. Ich buche den Flug und die Übernachtung für Sie. Ich empfehle Ihnen das fûnf Stern Hotel Eden. zeyr gooht. iH boohH-e deyn floohk oont dee ue-bernâHt-oong fuer zee. iH em-pfey-le een-en dâs fuenf shtêrn hotel [as in English] ey-den. Very good. I’ll book the flight and accommodation for you. I recommend the five-star Hotel Eden. Frau Burger: Danke. dân-ke. Thank you.

Words to Know die Reise

dee ray-ze

trip

reisen

ray-zen

to travel

buchen

boohH-en

to book

das Reisebüro

dâs ray-ze-bue-roh

travel agency

die Übernachtung

dee ue-ber-nâHt-oong

accommodation

Book II Speaking German on the Go

208

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Packing your bags Preparing for a trip always includes packing your bags, though seasoned travelers manage to get around with a minimum of das Gepäck (dâs gê-pêk) (luggage). Particularly when you have to fly to your destination, the ideal Gepäck consists of one manageable checked bag and a small carry-on. The following are some types of luggage people use when traveling: ✓ das Handgepäck (dâs hânt-ge-pêk) (hand luggage) ✓ die Handtasche (dee hânt-tâsh-e) (handbag) ✓ der Koffer (dêr kof-er) (suitcase) ✓ der Rollkoffer (dêr rol-kof-er) (wheeled suitcase) ✓ der Rucksack (dêr rook-zâk) (backpack) ✓ die Tasche (dee tâsh-e) (bag) What separates the novice packer from the expert is a matter of planning what to take and, possibly even more important, what not to take. Wrinklefree clothing items with multiple uses are a good starting point. For example, women should take a couple of silk or pashmina scarves that double as a means of dressing up any basic black outfit and as a cover-up on chilly evenings. In the shoe department, a pair of sensible shoes are a must for walking around European cities with expansive pedestrian zones.

Are you planning to take any electronic devices? If so, remember to pack the right power converters and adapter plugs for Europe. Among the obvious items you have to remember to take are your up-to-date passport, some small euro bills, any medications you normally take, and reading materials. Here’s a list of some miscellaneous items besides clothes that you may want to take on your trip:

✓ der Fotoapparat/die Kamera (dêr foh-to-âp-â-rât/dee kâm-êr-ah) (camera) ✓ das Handy (dâs hên-dee) (cellphone) ✓ der iPad/iPod (dêr iPad/iPod [as in English]) (iPad/iPod) ✓ der Laptop (dêr laptop [as in English]) (laptop) ✓ der Rasierapparat (dêr râ-zeer-âp-â-rât) (razor) ✓ die Reiseapotheke (dee ray-ze-âp-oo-tey-ke) (travel first-aid kit) ✓ der Reisewecker (dêr ray-ze-vêk-er) (travel alarm clock) ✓ die Sonnenbrille (dee zon-en-bril-e) (sunglasses)

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

209

✓ die Sonnenschutzcreme (dee zon-en-shoots-kreym) (sunscreen) ✓ der Tablet-Computer (dêr tablet [as in English] computer [as in English] (tablet) ✓ die Taschentücher (dee tâsh-en-tueH-er) (tissues) ✓ die Toilettenartikel (dee toy-lêt-en-âr-ti-kel) (toilet articles) ✓ die Zahnbürste (dee tsahn-buers-te) (toothbrush) ✓ die Zahnpaste (dee tsahn-pâs-te) (toothpaste) In case you forget to bring toiletries and sundry items, not to worry. After you’re in German-speaking Europe, you just need to head to eine Drogerie (ayn-e drohg-êr-ee), which is like an American drugstore except that it doesn’t sell prescription drugs.

When you’re packing summer clothes, remember to include some items of clothing that cover your shoulders and legs so you blend in with the natives. Why? You don’t want to contradict local customs if you go into places of worship where tank tops and short skirts are frowned upon.

Exploring the Outdoors Within German-speaking Europe, you can enjoy a vast range of sports and recreation opportunities. All you have to do is decide which ones you want to try! You can sail on one of many lakes, ski in the mountains, go mountain biking, relax at the shore, or simply enjoy nature in a park. Or maybe you just want to get away from the busyness of life and experience the great outdoors alone or with your family and friends. In that case, lace up your hiking boots and grab your binoculars and guidebook. Just don’t forget to pack a lunch because you may not find a snack bar at the end of the trail!

Getting out and going If you’re interested in walking and hiking, the following phrases can help get you on your way: Wollen wir spazieren/wandern gehen? (vol-en veer shpâ-tsee-ren/ vân-dern gey-en?) (Should we take a walk/go hiking?) Ich möchte spazieren/wandern gehen. (iH merH-te shpâ-tsee-ren/ vân-dern gey-en.) (I would like to take a walk/go hiking.)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

210

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Things to see along the way When you return from your tour of the great outdoors, you can tell people about what you saw by saying Ich habe . . . gesehen. (iH hah-be . . . gê-zey-en.) (I saw. . . .) Ich habe . . . beobachtet. (iH hah-be . . . bê-oh-bâH-tet.) (I was watching. . . .) Just fill in the blanks. You may encounter any of the following along the way: ✓ der Baum (dêr boum) (tree) ✓ der Fluss (dêr floos) (river) ✓ die Kuh (dee kooh) (cow) ✓ das Meer (dâs meyr) (sea, ocean) ✓ das Pferd (dâs pfêrt) (horse) ✓ das Reh (dâs rey) (deer) ✓ das Schaf (dâs shahf) (sheep) ✓ der See (dêr zey) (lake) ✓ der Vogel (dêr foh-gel) (bird) Remember that you use the accusative case when completing these sentences. (See Book III, Chapter 2 for details on the accusative case.) For masculine nouns, phrase your sentences in this way: Ich habe einen Adler gesehen. (iH hah-be ayn-en âd-ler ge-zey-en.) (I saw an eagle.) For feminine nouns, use this phrasing: Ich habe eine lilafarbene Kuh gesehen! (iH hah-be ayn-e lee-lâ-fâr-bên-e kooh ge-zey-en!) (I saw a purple-colored cow!) Well, maybe not in the Alps, but you can see the purple cow on the wrapper of a well-known brand of chocolate. Express neuter nouns this way: Ich habe ein Reh gesehen. (iH hah-be ayn rey ge-zey-en.) (I saw a deer.)

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

211

Or you may want to use the plural form, which is generally easier: Ich habe viele Vögel gesehen. (iH hah-be fee-le fer-gel ge-zey-en.) (I saw a lot of birds.)

Talkin’ the Talk Mr. and Mrs. Paulsen are in a small town in the mountains. Today they want to go hiking. They are speaking with Frau Kreutzer atthe local tourist information office to find out about hiking trailsin the area. (Track 24) Frau Paulsen: Guten Morgen. Wir möchten eine Wanderung machen. gooh-ten mor-gen. veer merH-ten ayn-e vân-deroong mâH-en. Good morning. We would like to go hiking. Frau Kreutzer: Ich kann Ihnen eine Wanderkarte für diese Gegend geben. iH kân een-en ayn-e vân-dêr-kâr-te fuer deez-e geygend gey-ben. I can give you a hiking map of this area. Herr Paulsen: Das ist genau das, was wir brauchen. dâs ist ge-nou dâs, vâs veer brouH-en. That’s exactly what we need. Frau Kreutzer: Wie wäre es mit dem Hornberg? Wenn Sie Glück haben, können Sie sogar einige Murmeltiere sehen. vee vair-e ês mit deym hohrn-bêrg? vên zee gluek hah-ben, kern-en zee zoh-gâr ayn-ee-ge moor-melteer-e zey-en. How about Horn mountain? If you’re lucky, you can even see some marmots. Herr Paulsen: Das klingt gut. Können Sie uns den Weg auf der Karte markieren? dâs klinkt gooht. keer-en zee oons deyn vêg ouf dêr kâr-te mâr-keer-en? Sounds good. Can you mark the trail for us on the map?

Book II Speaking German on the Go

212

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Frau Kreutzer: Ja, natürlich. yah, nâ-tuer-liH. Yes, of course. Frau Paulsen: Vielen Dank für ihre Hilfe. fee-len dânk fuer eer-e hil-fe. Thank you very much for your help.

Going to the mountains Whether you plan to explore the ever-popular Alps or one of the other mountain ranges, you’re sure to meet the locals. In fact, you’re likely to see whole families out hiking if you venture out on a Sunday afternoon. Before you join them, fortify yourself with some sustaining vocabulary: ✓ der Berg (dêr bêrg) (mountain) ✓ das Gebirge (dâs ge-bir-ge) (mountain range) ✓ der Gipfel (dêr gip-fel) (peak) ✓ der Hügel (dêr hue-gel) (hill) ✓ das Naturschutzgebiet (dâs nâ-toohr-shoots-ge-beet) (nature preserve) ✓ das Tal (dâs tahl) (valley) Here are a few examples of sentences: Wir fahren in die Berge. (veer fahr-en in dee bêr-ge.) (We’re going to the mountains.) Wir wollen im Naturschutzgebiet wandern gehen. (veer vol-en im nâtoohr-shoots-ge-beet vân-dern gey-en.) (We want to go hiking in the nature preserve.) Ich will bis zum Gipfel bergsteigen. (iH vil bis tsoom gip-fel bêrg-shtaygen.) (I want to climb to the peak.) The Alps offer a variety of hiking opportunities for the casual hiker as well as for the expert climber. When you meet German-speaking people in the mountains and strike up a conversation, you’re bound to notice that complete strangers may address each other with du. Using the familiar form is a means of showing camaraderie with others interested in the experience of hiking.

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

213

Words to Know wandern

vân-dern

to go hiking

spazieren gehen

shpâ-tsee-ren gey-en

to take a walk

die Wanderung

dee vân-der-oong

hike

die Karte

dee kâr-te

map

der Weg

dêr veyk

trail, path, way

die Gegend

dee gey-gent

area

Talkin’ the Talk Herr Mahler meets Frau Pohl on his way home from work. They start talking about their travel plans. Frau Pohl:

Tag Herr Mahler. Na, haben Sie schon Urlaubspläne gemacht? tahk hêr mah-ler. nah, hah-ben zee shon oor-loupsplên-e ge-mâHt? Hello, Mr. Mahler. So, have you made plans for your vacation yet?

Herr Mahler: Aber ja, meine Frau und ich werden wieder in die Berge fahren. ah-ber yah, mayn-e frou oont iH vêr-den vee-der in dee bêr-ge fahr-en. Oh yes, my wife and I will go to the mountains again. Frau Pohl:

Wieder in die Alpen? vee-der in dee âlp-en? Back to the Alps?

Herr Mahler: Nein, diesmal gehen wir in den Pyrenäen wandern. Und Sie? nayn, dees-mâl gey-en veer in deyn per-re-nê-en vândern. oont zee? No, this time we’re going hiking in the Pyrenees. Andyou?

Book II Speaking German on the Go

214

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Wir wollen im Herbst in die Dolomiten zum Bergsteigen. veer vol-en im hêrpst in dee do-lo-meet-en tsoom bêrg-shtayg-en. We want to go mountain climbing in the Dolomite Alps in the fall. Frau Pohl:

Herr Mahler: Haben Sie schon ein Hotel gebucht? hah-ben zee shohn ayn hotel [as in English] ge-booHt? Did you book a hotel yet? Frau Pohl:

Nein, wir werden in Berghütten übernachten. nayn, veer vêr-den în bêrg-huet-en ue-ber-nâH-ten. No, we’re going to stay in mountain huts.

Going to the country Mountains aren’t your idea of fun? How about some fresh country air then? Despite a population of about 82 million people in Germany, you can still find quiet rural areas and out-of-the-way places, sometimes surprisingly close to bustling urban centers. And it goes without saying that you can find peace and quiet in the Austrian and Swiss countryside. All you need to get started on your relaxing country vacation is the right vocabulary:

✓ der Bauernhof (dêr bou-ern-hohf) (farm)

✓ das Dorf (dâs dorf) (village) ✓ das Feld (dâs fêlt) (field) ✓ das Land (dâs lânt) (countryside) ✓ der Wald (dêr vâlt) (forest) ✓ die Wiese (dee veez-e) (meadow) Here are a few sample sentences: Wir fahren aufs Land. (veer fahr-en oufs lânt.) (We’re going to the ­countryside.) Wir machen Urlaub auf dem Bauernhof. (veer mâH-en oor-loup ouf deym bou-ern-hohf.) (We’re vacationing on a farm.) Ich gehe im Wald spazieren. (iH gey-e im vâlt shpâ-tsee-ren.) (I’m going for a walk in the woods.)

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

215

Talkin’ the Talk Daniel runs into his friend Ellen. After they greet each other, Daniel tells Ellen about his upcoming vacation. Daniel: Ich fahre in der letzten Woche in Juli aufs Land. iH fahr-e in dêr lêts-ten voH-e in yooh-lee oufs lânt. I’m going to the countryside the last week in July. Ellen:

Fährst du allein? fairst dooh âl-ayn? Are you going alone?

Daniel:

Nein, ich verreise zusammen mit meiner Schwester und ihren Kindern. nayn, iH fêr-ray-ze tsoo-zâm-en mit mayn-er shvês-ter oont eer-en kin-dern. No, I’m traveling together with my sister and her children.

Ellen:

Habt ihr eine Ferienwohnung gemietet? hahpt eer ayn-e feyr-ee-ên-vohn-oong ge-meet-et? Did you rent a vacation apartment?

Nein. Wir übernachten auf einem Bauernhof in einem kleinen Dorf. nayn. veer ue-bêr-nâHt-en ouf ayn-em bou-ern-hohf in ayn-em klayn-en dorf. No. We’re staying on a farm in a small village. Daniel:

Ellen: Die Kindern freuen sich sicher. dee kin-dern froy-en ziH ziH-er. The kids are surely looking forward to that. Daniel:

Und wie! oont vee! Oh, yes!

Going to the sea If hiking through the mountains or countryside sounds somewhat dry and tame to you, maybe what you need is a stiff breeze and the cry of gulls overhead. Whether you decide to go to one of the windswept islands in the North

Book II Speaking German on the Go

216

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Sea or settle for the more serene Baltic Sea, you’ll be able to enjoy nature and meet the locals at the same time, using the following words: ✓ die Ebbe (dee êb-e) (low tide) ✓ die Flut (dee flooht) (high tide) ✓ die Gezeiten (dee gê-tsayt-en) (tides) ✓ die Küste (dee kues-te) (coast) ✓ das Meer (dâs meyr) (sea) ✓ die Nordsee (dee nort-zey) (North Sea) ✓ die Ostsee (dee ost-zey) (Baltic Sea) ✓ der Sturm (dêr shtoorm) (storm) ✓ die Wellen (dee vêl-en) (waves) ✓ der Wind (dêr vint) (wind)

Talkin’ the Talk Udo and Karin are talking about their holiday trips. They both like the seaside but have different ideas about what’s fun. Udo: Wir wollen dieses Jahr an die Ostsee. veer vol-en deez-es yahr ân dee ost-zey. We want to go to the Baltic Sea this year. Karin:

Toll! Und was macht ihr dort? Tol! oont vâs mâHt eer dort? Cool! And what are you going to do there?

Udo: Wir wollen windsurfen. Und ihr? veer vol-en vint-soorf-en. oont eer? We want to go windsurfing. And you? Wir werden auf eine Nordseeinsel fahren. Wir wollen im Watt wandern gehen. veer vêr-den ouf ayn-e nort-zey-in-zel fahr-en. veer vol-en im vât vân-dern gey-en. We’ll go to a North Sea island. We want to go walking in the tidal flats. Karin:

Udo:

Ist das nicht gefährlich? ist dâs niHt ge-fair-liH? Isn’t that dangerous?

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise! Karin:

217

Nein, man geht bei Ebbe los, und dann hat man einige Stunden Zeit, bevor die Flut kommt. nayn, mân geyt bay êb-e lohs, oont dân hât mân aynee-ge shtoon-den tsayt, bê-fohr dee flooht komt. No, you set out at low tide, and then you have several hours before high tide sets in.

Dealing with Passports and Visas Although the world seems to be shrinking faster and faster thanks to the Internet, you still need paperwork to travel out of the country. Specifically, you need a passport. (You know, that handy little booklet with the embarrassing picture that you always seem to misplace or let expire just before you’re about to leave on a trip?) And then there’s the issue of visas. The following sections cover both.

Keeping tabs on your passport Before you leave on a trip, make sure your passport is valid for the entire length of your stay and then some (many countries allow you to stay for between three and six months total). After all, you don’t want to spend your time away from home trying to find an American consulate to renew your passport. If you forget to take care of this very important task, you’ll hear the following when you show your passport at the airline ticket counter, or worse yet, at the border: Ihr Pass ist abgelaufen! (eer pâs ist âp-ge-louf-en!) (Your passport has expired!) At that point, you’ll be directed to the nearest American consulate — das amerikanische Konsulat (dâs â-mê-ree-kah-ni-she kon-zoo-laht) — where you can take care of the necessary paperwork. In the event that you notice your passport is missing, head straight to the American consulate to report it. If necessary, you can stop a policeman or file a report at a police station. Just say the following to get help: Ich habe meinen Pass verloren. (iH hah-be mayn-en pâs fêr-lohr-en.) (I lost my passport.)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

218

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Inquiring about visas Most countries in Europe don’t require you to have a visa if you’re traveling on vacation and are planning to stay a few weeks or a couple of months. But just in case you like your destination so much that you want to stay longer or you decide to continue on to a place where you’re required to have a visa, the following phrases can come in handy when you apply for one: Braucht man ein Visum für Reisen nach. . . ? (brouHt mân ayn vee-zoom fuer ray-zen nahH. . . ?) (Does one need a visa for trips to. . . ?) Ich möchte ein Visum beantragen. (iH merH-te ayn vee-zoom bê-ân-trahgen.) (I would like to apply for a visa.) Wie lange ist das Visum gültig? (vee lâng-e ist dâs vee-zoom guel-tiH?) (For how long is the visa valid?)

Talkin’ the Talk George Beck, an American living in Germany, wants to go on a trip to Phuket (fooh-ket), Thailand. As he’s making the necessary arrangements at the travel agency, he talks to the agent about entering the country. George:

Brauche ich ein Visum für Thailand? brouH-e iH ayn vee-zoom fuer tay-lânt? Do I need a visa for Thailand?

Angestellte: Nein, für Thailand nicht, aber Sie brauchen natürlich Ihren Reisepass. Ist er noch gültig? nayn, fuer tay-lânt niHt, aber zee brouH-en na-tuerliH eer-en ray-ze-pâs. ist êr noH guel-tiH? No, not for Thailand, but you need your passport, of course. Is it still valid? George:

Ja, doch. yah, doH. Yes, it is.

Angestellte: Prima! Noch irgendwelche Fragen, Herr Beck? pree-mâ! noH eer-gênt-velH-ê frah-gen hêr bêk? Great! Any other questions, Mr. Beck? George:

Nein, das war’s. Vielen Dank. nayn, dâs vahrs. fee-len dânk. No, that was it. Thank you very much.

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

219

Angestellte: Gern geschehen. Und, Gute Reise! gêrn ge-shey-en. oont, gooh-te ray-ze! You’re welcome. And have a nice trip!

Words to Know der Reisepass

dêr ray-ze-pâs

passport

das Visum

dâs vee-zoom

visa

beantragen

bê-ân-trah-gen

to apply for

gültig/ungültig

guel-tiH/ oon-guel-tiH

valid/invalid

verlängern

fêr-lêng-ern

to renew, to extend

ablaufen

âp-louf-en

to expire

das Konsulat

dâs kon-zooh-laht

consulate

die Botschaft

dee boht-shâft

embassy

Handling Money Money does indeed make the world go ’round. And Euroland is no different; it revolves around its multinational currency, the euro. When shopping and eating out, Germans use either paper (that is, hard currency) or plastic; however, many Germans prefer to use cash almost exclusively. Plastic, at least for Germans, refers to the electronic cash (EC) card, a debit card. Alternatively, Germans sometimes use credit cards, though many stores and restaurants don’t readily accept them. So what about the good old greenback? In this section, you get up to speed on exchanging your bucks for multicolored, multisized euros. Oh, and you getthe lowdown on money in those countries such as Switzerland that still have their own respective currencies. Whether you’re dealing with a personable teller or an impersonal ATM, a pocketful of the right expressions can get you, well, a pocketful of euros.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

220

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

As a non-European, your credit card will work in much the same way as it does at home, but before traveling, check with the institution that issued your card to find out whether any transaction fees apply. When you want to use your credit card to withdraw cash at an ATM, you need to use your fourdigit PIN.

Changing currency: Geldwechsel Obtaining local currency in Europe is generally a hassle-free experience. Practically every bank is willing to accept your dollars and provide you with the local cash. You can also easily withdraw cash in the local currency from an ATM (see the later section for details), provided you’re using a major credit card (preferably Visa or Mastercard) and you know your PIN. You usually find a notice posted in or outside the bank with the current exchange rates (Wechselkurse) (vêk-sel-koorz-e). Look for the column marked Ankauf (ân-kouf) (purchase/buy). Then saunter up to the teller window, der Schalter (dêr shâl-ter). The Bankangestellter (bânk-an-ge-stêlter) (bank teller) at the counter will either complete your transaction on the spot or send you on to the Kasse (kâs-e) (cashier). In airports and major train stations, you often find businesses that specialize in exchanging currencies, called Wechselstube (vêk-sel-stooh-be) in German. No matter where you decide to change your money, the whole process is simple. All you need are the following phrases: Ich möchte . . . Dollar in Euro wechseln/tauschen. (iH merH-te . . . dol-âr in oy-roh vêk-seln/toush-en.) (I would like to change . . . dollars into euros.) Note: Both wechseln and tauschen can mean change or exchange — in this case, money. Wie ist der Wechselkurs? (vee ist dêr vêk-sel-koors?) (What’s the exchange rate?) Wie hoch sind die Gebühren? (vee hohH zint dee ge-buer-en?) (How much are the transaction fees?) Nehmen Sie Reiseschecks? (ney-men zee ray-ze-shêks?) (Do you take traveler’s checks?) When you exchange money, you’ll probably have to show the teller your passport (Reisepass) (ray-ze-pâs). The teller will ask you Haben Sie ihren Reisepass? (hah-ben zee eer-en ray-ze-pâs?) (Do you have your passport?)

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

221

After you show your official mug shot — and assuming it appears to be you — the teller may ask you how you want the money: Welche Scheine hätten Sie gern? (vêlH-e shayn-e hêt-en zee gêrn?) (What size denominations would you like?) You can respond with In Zehnern/in Zwanzigern/in Fünfzigern/in Hundertern, bitte. (in tseyn-ern/in tsvân-zig-ern/in fuenf-tsig-ern/in hoon-dert-ern, bi-te.) (In bills of 10/20/50/100, please.)

Talkin’ the Talk

Anne, an American tourist, heads to a bank to exchange money. (Track 25) Bankangestellter: Guten Morgen. gooh-ten mor-gen. Good morning. Anne:

Guten Morgen. Ich möchte 300 US-Dollar wechseln. Wie ist der Wechselkurs, bitte? gooh-ten mor-gen. iH merH-te dray-hoon-dert ooh-ês dol-âr vêk-seln. vee ist dêr vêk-sel-koors, bi-te? Good morning. I’d like to change 300 U.S. dollars. What’s the exchange rate, please?

Bankangestellter: Einen Moment, bitte. Für einen Dollar bekommen Sie 0,78 Euro. ayn-en moh-ment, bi-te. fuer ayn-en dol-âr bekom-en zee nool kom-â zee-ben âHt oy-roh. One moment, please. One dollar is currently 0.78 euros. Anne:

Kônnen Sie mir bitte Reiseschecks über 300 Dollar in Euro wechseln? kern-en zee meer bi-te ray-ze-shêks ue-ber drayhoon-dêrt dol-âr in oy-roh vêk-seln? Could you exchange 300 dollars in traveler’s checks into euros, please?

Bankangestellter: Kein Problem. Haben Sie ihren Reisepass? kayn pro-bleym. hah-ben zee eer-en ray-ze-pâs? No problem. Do you have your passport?

Book II Speaking German on the Go

222

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Ja, hier ist er. yah, heer ist êr. Yes, here it is.

Anne:

Bankangestellter: Für 300 Dollar bekommen Sie 234 Euro. Abzüglich 3,30 Euro Wechselgebühr macht das 230,70 Euro. fuer dray-hoon-dert dol-âr bê-kom-en zee tsvayhoon-dert-feer-oont-dray-siH oy-roh. âb-tsuegliH dray oy-roh dray-siH vêk-sel-ge-buer mâHt dâs tsvay-hoon-dert-dray-siH oy-roh zeep-tsiH. For 300 dollars, you get 234 euros. Minus a 3.30 euro transaction fee, that’s 230.70 euros. Vielen Dank. fee-len dânk Thank you very much.

Anne:

Words to Know Geld tauschen

gêlt toush-en

to change/exchange money

Geld wechseln

gêlt vêk-seln

to change/exchange money

das Bargeld

dâs bâr-gêlt

cash

in bar

in bâr

in cash

einen Reisescheck einlösen

ayn-en ray-ze-shêk ayn-ler-zen

to cash a traveler’s check

eine Gebühr bezahlen

ayn-e ge-buer be-tsah-len

to pay a fee

der Wechselkurs

dêr vêk-sel-koors

exchange rate

der Ankauf

dêr ân-kouf

purchase, acquisition

der Verkauf

dêr fêr-kouf

sale

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

223

Understanding the euro and other currencies With the introduction of the European Monetary Union in 2002, the euro became the currency for 12 countries, including Germany and Austria. Euroland, the term coined (no pun intended) for countries that have adopted the euro, currently comprises 17 nations, and the numbers are still growing. Switzerland, the U.K., Denmark, and Poland are among those countries that still use their respective currencies. When referring to the plural of der Euro (dêr oy-roh) (euro), you have two choices, die Euro or die Euros, but whichever you choose, you pronounce them the same way (dee oy-roh) (euros). Each Euro has 100 Cent (sênt) (cents). The official abbreviation for the euro is EUR. When using the symbol for the euro, €, it appears after the number like this: 47€. The currencies of other countries are as follows: ✓ Czechoslovakia: die tschechische Krone (dee chêH-ish-e kroh-ne) (Czech crown) ✓ Denmark: die dänische Krone (dee deyn-ish-e kroh-ne) (Danish crown) ✓ Poland: der polnische Zloty (dêr poln-ish-e slo-tee) (Polish zloty) ✓ Switzerland: der schweizer Franken (dêr shvayts-er frân-ken) (Swiss franc) ✓ U.K.: das Pfund (dâs pfoont) (pound) ✓ United States: der Dollar (dêr dol-âr) (dollar)

Heading to the ATM Instead of changing money at the teller window of a bank, you can use a Bankautomat (bânk-ou-toh-maht) or Geldautomat (gêlt-ou-toh-maht) (ATM machine). Just look for your card symbol on the machine to make sure the machine takes your kind of card. Many ATMs give you a choice of languages to communicate in, but just in case German is your only option, you need to be prepared. ATMs use phrases that are direct and to the point. A typical run-through of prompts may look like this: Karte einführen (kâr-te ayn-fuer-en) (Insert card) Sprache wählen (shprahH-e vai-len) (Choose a language)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

224

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Geheimzahl eingeben (ge-haym-tsahl ayn-gey-ben) (Enter PIN) Betrag eingeben (be-trahk ayn-gey-ben) (Enter amount) Betrag bestätigen (be-trahk be-shtê-ti-gen) (Confirm amount) Karte entnehmen (kâr-te ênt-ney-men) (Remove card) Geld entnehmen (gêlt ênt-ney-men) (Take cash) Transaction completed. Your wallet should now be bulging with local ­currency — that is, unless something went wrong. The ATM may be out oforder, in which case, you see the following message: Geldautomat außer Betrieb. (gêlt-ou-toh-maht ous-er be-treep.) (ATM out of service.) Or the ATM may spit out your card without parting with any of its largesse. In that case, you may receive this message: Die Karte ist ungültig./Die Karte wird nicht akzeptiert. (dee kâr-te ist oon-guel-tiH./dee kâr-te virt niHt âk-tsep-teert.) (The card is not valid./ The card can’t be accepted.) The worst case scenario? The ATM may swallow your card whole, leaving you with only this message for consolation: Die Karte wurde eingezogen. Bitte gehen Sie zum Bankschalter. (dee kâr-te voor-de ayn-ge-tsoh-gen. bi-te gey-en zee tsoom bânk-shâl-ter.) (The card was confiscated. Please go to the counter in the bank.) ATMs and other machines often use terse-sounding phrases like Geheimzahl eingeben (Enter PIN). Although these phrases may not sound very polite, they’re used as a way to save space. For example, a more polite way to say Geheimzahl eingeben would be Bitte geben Sie Ihre Geheimzahl ein. (bi-te gey-ben zee eer-e ge-haymtsahl ayn.) (Please enter your PIN.) Grammatically speaking, such terse phrases are infinitives posing as imperatives (commands). You encounter these forms wherever language efficiency is of utmost importance to the writer or speaker or instructions are being given. (For more details about imperatives and commands, head to Book III, Chapter 7.)

Chapter 3: Planning a Pleasure Trip: Gute Reise!

225

Talkin’ the Talk Mike is about to meet his girlfriend for a cup of coffee when he realizes that he has only a 200-euro bill in his wallet. He goes to a bank to change his bill into smaller denominations. Mike:

Können Sie bitte diesen 200-Euro-Schein in kleinere Scheine wechseln? kern-en zee bi-te deez-en tsavy hoon-dert-oyroh-shayn in klayn-er-e shayn-e vêk-seln? Could you exchange this 200-euro bill for smaller bills, please?

Bankangestellte: Welche Scheine darf ich Ihnen geben? vêlH-e shayn-e dârf iH een-en gey-ben? What denominations would you like? Ich hätte gern einen 50-Euro-Schein, 5 Zwanziger und 5 Zehner. iH hêt-e gêrn ayn-en fuenf-tsiH-oy-roh-shayn, fuenf tsvân-tsee-ger oont fuenf tseyn-er. I’d like one 50-euro bill, five 20-euro bills, and five 10-euro bills. Mike:

Bankangestellte: Bitte. Haben Sie sonst noch einen Wunsch? bi-te. hah-ben zee sonst noH ayn-en voonsh? Here you are. Do you need anything else? Mike:

Danke. Das ist alles. dân-ke. dâs ist âl-es. Thanks. That’s all.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

226

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Chapter 4

Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht! In This Chapter ▶ Choosing where to stay and making reservations ▶ Getting the most out of your stay — no matter how long it is ▶ Checking in and out and paying the bill

R

egardless of whether you’re traveling on business or taking a vacation, having a clean and comfortable place to spend the night is an important part of your trip. In this chapter, we help you with the vocabulary and phrases you need to know to find accommodations, inquire about facilities, make reservations, and check in and out.

Finding Accommodations If you’re one of those people who likes the adventure of doing things on the spur of the moment or if you simply need help finding a hotel after you get to your town, you can get reliable information about all types of accommodations through the local tourist information center, which is called das Fremdenverkehrsbüro or Fremdenverkehrsamt (dâs frêm-den-fêr-keyrsbue-roh or frêm-den-fêr-keyrs-âmt). These tourist centers are often located conveniently in the center of town or next to the train station. Some information centers, called Touristen-Information (toor-ist-en-in-for-mâts-ee-ohn), are easily recognizable by a sign with a lowercase I on a red background. They may also help you get tickets to various events and attractions. Of course, you can also ask other people you know or meet whether they can recommend a hotel. In this case, ask Können Sie mir ein Hotel in . . . empfehlen? (kern-en zee meer ayn hotel [as in English] in . . . êm-pfey-len?) (Can you recommend a hotel in. . . ?)

228

Book II: Speaking German on the Go You can find a wide range of hotels and hotel-like accommodations in German-speaking countries. Outside urban areas, you’re especially likely to see different types of lodging, including the following: ✓ die Ferienwohnung (dee feyr-ree-ên-vohn-oong): A furnished vacation apartment located in a popular tourist destination. ✓ das Fremdenzimmer (dâs frêm-dên-tsi-mer): A bed-and-breakfast, often with shared bathroom facilities. ✓ das Gasthaus/der Gasthof (dâs gâst-hous/dêr gâst-hohf): An inn that provides food, drinks, and often lodging. ✓ das Hotel garni (dâs hotel gâr-nee): A hotel that serves only breakfast. ✓ die Jugendherberge (die yooh-gênt-hêr-bêr-ge): A youth hostel, but not only for the under-25 crowd. This is an inexpensive option, but you generally need a Youth Hostel ID, which you can get before you travel. ✓ die Pension (dee pên-zee-ohn): A bed-and-breakfast type of place. In addition to breakfast, it may also serve lunch and dinner. ✓ der Rasthof/das Motel (dêr râst-hohf/dâs motel [as in English]): A roadside lodge or motel located just off a highway.

Making a Reservation To avoid last-minute hassles, booking a hotel room in advance is best, especially during the peak season or when a special event in town may mean that hotels are booked solid for months in advance. If you’re having difficulty finding a room, try looking outside of towns and city centers. Ask for some assistance at the Fremdenverkehrsamt (frêm-den-fêr-keyrs-âmt). (See the preceding section for more information on that helpful office with the long name.) Of course, you can make reservations for hotel rooms online, but if you’re using the phone, you may want to read Book I, Chapter 5 beforehand. When you call, the following sentence can help you explain the purpose of your call: Ich möchte gern ein Zimmer reservieren. (iH merH-te gêrn ayn tsi-mer rê-zêr-vee-ren.) (I would like to reserve a room.) If you want to book more than one room, simply substitute the appropriate number — zwei (tsvay) (two), drei (dray) (three), and so on — in place of ein. Keep reading to find out what else you need to know when making reservations by phone.

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht!

229

Saying when and how long you want to stay The person taking your reservation is likely to ask you a handful of questions before setting up your reservation. One of the first of these questions may be something like this: Von wann bis wann möchten Sie das Zimmer reservieren? (fon vân bis vân merH-ten zee dâs tsi-mer rê-zêr-vee-ren?) (For what dates would you like to reserve the room?) To specify how many nights you want to stay or for what dates you want to reserve a room, you can say either of the following, depending on what suits your needs. (Book I, Chapter 2 gives more details on how to specify the date.) Ich möchte gern ein Zimmer für . . . Nächte reservieren. (iH merH-te gêrn ayn tsi-mer fuer . . . naiHt-e rê-zêr-vee-ren.) (I would like to reserve a room for . . . nights.) Ich möchte gern ein Zimmer vom 11. 3. bis zum 15. 3. reservieren. (iH merH-te gêrn ayn tsi-mer fom êlf-ten drit-en bis tsoom fuenf-tseyn-ten drit-en rê-zêr-vee-ren.) (I would like to reserve a room from the 11th to the 15th of March.)

Specifying the kind of room you want The person taking your reservation is certain to ask you something like the following to find out what kind of room you want: Was für ein Zimmer möchten Sie gern? (vâs fuer ayn tsi-mer merH-ten zee gêrn?) (What kind of room would you like?) Customer service people often ask Was für. . . ? (vâs fuer. . . ?) (What kind of. . . ?) when they want to know specifics about what you need. For example, someone at the Fremdenverkehrsbüro may want to find out exactly what you’re looking for by asking questions like the following: Was für eine Ferienwohnung möchten Sie gern? (vâs fuer ayn-e feyrree-ên-vohn-oong merH-ten zee gêrn?) (What kind of vacation apartment would you like?) Was für eine Unterkunft suchen Sie? (vâs fuer ayn-e oon-ter-koonft zoohH-en zee?) (What kind of accommodation are you looking for?)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

230

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

The question Was für. . . ? is always used with the indefinite article in the accusative case. (See Book III, Chapter 2 for the lowdown on indefinite articles and the accusative case.) Or you can take the initiative and state what kind of room you want with the phrase Ich hätte gern. . . . (iH hêt-e gêrn. . . .) (I would like. . . .) At the end of the phrase, add any of the following (or a combination of them) to specify exactly what kind of room you want to rest your weary bones in:

✓ ein Doppelzimmer (ayn dôp-el-tsi-mer) (a double room)

✓ ein Einzelzimmer (ayn ayn-tsêl-tsi-mer) (a single room)

✓ ein Zimmer mit . . . (ayn tsi-mer mit . . .) (a room with . . .) and then choose from the following features:

• Bad (baht) (bathroom)

• Dusche (dooh-she) (shower)

• einem Doppelbett (ayn-êm dôp-el-bêt) (one double bed)

• zwei Einzelbetten (tsvay ayn-tsêl-bêt-en) (two twin beds)

Asking about the price Even if your last name is Moneybags, you probably want to find out what the room costs. Look at the following variations of this question, depending on whether you want to know the basic price or the price with other features included: Was kostet das Zimmer pro Nacht? (vâs kos-tet dâs tsi-mer proh nâHt?) (What does the room cost per night?) Was kostet eine Übernachtung mit Frühstück? (vâs kos-tet ayn-e ueber-nâHt-oong mit frue-shtuek?) (What does accommodation including breakfast cost?) Was kostet ein Zimmer mit Halbpension/Vollpension? (vâs kos-tet ayn tsi-mer mit hâlp-pân-zee-ohn/fol-pân-zee-ohn?) (What does a room with half board/full board cost?) (Half board means two meals [breakfast and usually dinner], and full board means all three meals.)

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht!

231

Finalizing the reservation If the room is available and the price doesn’t cause you to faint, you can seal the deal by saying Können Sie das Zimmer bitte reservieren? (kern-en zee dâs tsi-mer bi-te rê-zêr-vee-ren?) (Could you reserve that room, please?)

Talkin’ the Talk Klaus and Ulrike Huber want to take a vacation in Österreich (erst-êr-ayH) (Austria), and they’ve found a hotel on Lake Mondsee where they’d like to stay. Klaus calls the Hotel Alpenhof and talks to the receptionist. (Go to www.dummies.com/go/germanaio to listen to this bonus track.) Rezeption:

Hotel Alpenhof, guten Tag. hotel [as in English] âlp-en-hohf, gooh-ten tahk. Hello, Hotel Alpenhof.

Klaus:

Guten Tag. Ich möchte ein Zimmer vom 15. bis zum 23. Juni reservieren. gooh-ten tahk. iH merH-te ayn tsi-mer fom fuenftseyn-ten bis tsoom dray-oont-tsvân-tsiH-sten yoohnee rê-zêr-vee-ren. Hello. I’d like to book a room from the 15th to the 23rd of June.

Rezeption:

Ja, das geht. Was für ein Zimmer möchten Sie? yah, dâs geyt. vâs fuer ayn tsi-mer merH-ten zee? Yes, that’s fine. What kind of room would you like?

Ein Doppelzimmer mit Bad, bitte. Was kostet das Zimmer pro Nacht? ayn dôp-el-tsi-mer mit baht, bi-te. vâs kôs-tet dâs tsimer proh nâHt? A double room with bathroom, please. What does the room cost per night? Klaus:

Book II Speaking German on the Go

232

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Rezeption: 129 Euro für die Übernachtung mit Frühstück. ayn-hoon-dert-noyn-oont-tsvân-tsiH oy-roh fuer dee ue-ber-nâHt-oong mit frue-shtuek. 129 euros for accommodation including breakfast. Klaus:

Sehr gut. Können Sie es bitte reservieren? Mein Name ist Huber. zeyr gooht. kern-en zee ês bi-te rê-zêr-vee-ren? mayn nah-me ist hooh-ber. That’s very good. Could you please reserve it? My name is Huber.

Rezeption:

Geht in Ordnung, Herr Huber. geyt in ort-noong, hêr hooh-ber. Okay, Mr. Huber.

Klaus:

Vielen Dank! fee-len dânk! Thank you very much!

Words to Know das Fremdenverkehrsbüro

dâs frêm-den-fêrkeyrsbue-roh

tourist information center

das Einzelzimmer

dâs ayn-tsêl-tsi-mer

single room

das Doppelzimmer

dâs dôp-el-tsi-mer

double room

das Bad

dâs baht

bathtub

die Dusche

dee dooh-she

shower

(Geht) in Ordnung!

(geyt) in ort-noong!

Okay!

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht!

233

Checking In After you arrive at your hotel, you have to check in at the Rezeption (rê-tsêptsee-ohn)/Empfang (êm-pfâng) (reception desk). To let the receptionist know that you have made reservations, say Ich habe ein Zimmer reserviert. (iH hah-be ayn tsi-mer rê-zêr-veert.) (I have reserved a room.) Of course, you also have to let the receptionist know what your name is: Mein Name ist. . . . (mayn nah-me ist. . . .) (My name is. . . .)

Stating how long you’re staying If you haven’t made a reservation or the receptionist wants to double-check the length of your stay, you may hear the question Wie lange bleiben Sie? (vee lâng-e blay-ben zee?) (How long are you going to stay?) You can reply with the phrase Ich bleibe/Wir bleiben. . . . (iH blay-be/veer blay-ben. . . .) (I’m going to stay/ We’re going to stay. . . .) Then end the phrase with any of the appropriate lengths of time: nur eine Nacht (noohr ayn-e nâHt) (only one night) bis zum elften (bis tsoom êlf-ten) (until the 11th) eine Woche (ayn-e vôH-e) (one week)

Filling out the registration form At most hotels, you have to fill out der Meldeschein (dêr mêl-de-shayn) (reservation form), commonly referred to as das Formular (dâs for-moohlahr) (the form), as part of the check-in process. The receptionist will hand you the form, saying something like the following: Bitte füllen Sie dieses Formular aus. (bi-te fuel-en zee deez-ês for-moohlahr ous.) (Please fill out this form.)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

234

Book II: Speaking German on the Go The registration form asks you for all or most of the following information: ✓ Tag der Ankunft (tahk dêr ân-koonft) (date of arrival) ✓ Name/Vorname (nah-me/fohr-nah-me) (surname/first name) ✓ Straße/Nummer (Nr.) (shtrah-se/noom-er) (street/number) ✓ Postleitzahl (PLZ)/Wohnort (post-layt-tsahl/vohn-ort) (zip code/town) ✓ Geburtsdatum/Geburtsort (gê-boorts-dah-toohm/gê-boorts-ort) (birth date/place of birth) ✓ Staatsangehörigkeit/Nationalität (stahts-ân-ge-herr-iH-kayt/nâ-tsee-ohnahl-i-tait) (nationality) ✓ Beruf (bê-roohf) (occupation) ✓ Passnummer (pâs-noom-er) (passport number) ✓ Ort/Datum (ort/dah-toohm) (place/date) ✓ Unterschrift (oon-ter-shrift) (signature)

Getting keyed in After you check in, the receptionist hands you your room key and says something like Sie haben Zimmer Nummer 203. (zee hah-ben tsi-mer noom-er tsvayhoon-dert-dray.) (You have room number 203.) In some hotels, usually the more traditional ones, your room key is on a massive, metal key holder. You may be asked to leave your heavy metal key at the reception desk when you go out. When you arrive back at the hotel and need the key to your room, you can use the following phrase: Können Sie mir bitte den Schlüssel für Zimmer Nummer . . . geben? (kern-nen zee meer bi-te deyn shlues-êl fuer tsi-mer noom-er . . . gey-ben?) (Could you give me the key for room number. . . ?) In all likelihood, you’ll travel with some kind of das Gepäck (dâs ge-pêk) (luggage). Your luggage could be der Koffer (dêr kof-er) (a suitcase) or maybe even die Koffer (dee kof-er) (suitcases). No, that’s not a mistake — the only difference between the singular and plural forms of suitcase is the article. (Book III, Chapter 2 gives you more details on plural endings for nouns.)

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht!

235

Although service charges are usually included in the price of your hotel room, you may want to give a das Trinkgeld (dâs trink-gêlt) (tip) to the porter who brings up your luggage. In this case, 1 or 2 euros per bag is a reasonable amount. On rare occasions, you also may see a little envelope in your room where you can leave money for the cleaning staff. Depending on the hotel and service, you can give a tip of 10 to 15 euros per week.

Asking about amenities and essentials You may want to find out what kind of services and facilities the hotel offers. Does your room have Wi-Fi or a minibar? Does the hotel have a laundry service? This section helps you find out.

Your room When you want to ask about specific features of your room, start with the phrase Hat das Zimmer. . . ? (hât dâs tsi-mer. . . ?) (Does the room have. . . ?) Then end the phrase with any of the following items: einen Balkon (ayn-en bâl-kohn) (a balcony) eine Minibar (ayn-e minibar [as in English]) (a minibar) Satellitenfernsehen/Kabelfernsehen (zâ-tê-lee-ten-fêrn-zey-en/kah-belfêrn-zey-en) (satellite TV/cable TV) ein Telefon (ayn tê-le-fohn) (a phone) Wi-Fi (wee-fee) (Wi-Fi)

The hotel The hotel may offer a number of services that are outlined in a brochure you find in your room. However, if you need to ask about the hotel’s amenities before you arrive or because you misplaced your reading glasses, just ask Hat das Hotel. . . ? (hât dâs hotel. . . ?) (Does the hotel have. . . ?) You can then ask about any of the following services by ending the preceding phrase with

Book II Speaking German on the Go

236

Book II: Speaking German on the Go einen Fitnessraum (ayn-en fit-nes-roum) (a fitness room) eine Hotelgarage (ayn-e hoh-têl-gâ-rah-ge [second g pronounced as g in genre]) (a hotel garage) eine Klimaanlage (ayn-e klee-mah-ân-lah-ge) (air conditioning) einen Parkplatz (ayn-en pârk-plâts) (a parking lot) eine Sauna (ayn-e zou-nâ) (a sauna) ein Schwimmbad (ayn shvim-baht) (a swimming pool) einen Wäschedienst (ayn-en vêsh-e-deenst) (laundry service) Here are the questions that allow you to inquire about breakfast and room service: Wann wird das Frühstück serviert? (vân virt dâs frue-shtuek zêr-veert?) (At what time is breakfast served?) Gibt es Zimmerservice? (gipt ês tsi-mer-ser-vis?) (Is there room service?)

Talkin’ the Talk Klaus and Ulrike Huber arrive at the Hotel Alpenhof. They park their car at the entrance and go to the reception desk to check in. (Track 26) Klaus:

Guten Abend! Mein Name ist Huber. Wir haben ein Zimmer reserviert. gooht-en ah-bent! mayn nah-me ist hooh-ber. veer hah-ben ayn tsi-mer rê-zêr-veert. Good evening! My name is Huber. We’ve reserved a room.

Ja richtig, ein Doppelzimmer mit Bad. Bitte füllen Sie dieses Formular aus. yah riH-tiH, ayn dôp-el-tsi-mer mit baht. bi-te fuel-en zee deez-es for-mooh-lahr ous. Yes right, a double room with bath. Please fill out this form.

Rezeption:

Klaus:

Haben Sie eine Garage oder einen Parkplatz? hah-ben zee ayn-e gâ-rah-ge oh-der ayn-en pârk-plâts? Do you have a garage or a parking lot?

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht!

237

Jawohl. Der Parkplatz ist hinter dem Hotel. Und hier ist Ihr Zimmerschlüssel, Nummer 203. yah-vohl. dêr pârk-plâts ist hin-ter deym hotel [as in English]. oont heer ist eer tsi-mer-shlues-êl, noom-er tsavy-hoon-dert-dray. Yes, indeed. The parking lot is behind the hotel. And here is your key, number 203. Rezeption:

Ulrike:

Wann servieren Sie Frühstück? vân zêr-vee-ren zee frue-shtuek? When do you serve breakfast? Book II

Rezeption: Von sieben bis zehn Uhr. fon zee-ben bis tseyn oohr. From 7 to 10 o’clock. Ulrike:

Speaking German on the Go

Vielen Dank. fee-len dânk Thank you very much.

Words to Know bleiben

blay-ben

to stay

das Formular

dâs for-mooh-lahr

form

ausfüllen

ous-fuel-en

to fill out

der Schlüssel

dêr shlues-êl

key

der Zimmerservice

dêr tsi-mer-ser-vis

room service

der Parkplatz

dêr pârk-plâts

parking lot

238

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Making the Most of Your Stay Whether you stay for just a few nights or several weeks, you’ll likely have some interactions with the hotel staff. You may need to ask for certain items or request help in resolving a problem. The following sections provide the phrases you need to enjoy your stay.

Making special requests After you’re settled in your hotel room, you may discover that you need an extra pillow or that you’d like someone to recommend a good restaurant nearby. The following questions and requests may come in handy: Können Sie mich bitte um 6 Uhr wecken? (kern-en zee miH bi-te oom zêks oohr vêk-en?) (Could you wake me up at 6 o’clock, please?) Können Sie mir bitte noch ein Kopfkissen bringen? (kern-en zee mir bi-te noH ayn kopf-kis-en bring-en?) (Could you bring me another pillow, please?) Könnte ich bitte noch ein (weiteres) Badetuch haben? (kern-te iH bi-te noH ayn [vayt-êr-ês] bah-de-tooH hah-ben?) (Could I have [another] bath towel, please?) Können Sie mir ein gutes Restaurant in der Nähe empfehlen? (kern-en zee mir ayn gooht-es rês-tuh-ron in dêr nai-he êm-pfey-len?) (Could you recommend a good restaurant nearby?) Gibt es hier in der Nähe eine U-Bahnstation? (gipt ês heer in dêr nai-he ayn-e ooh-bahn-shtât-see-ohn?) (Is there a subway station near here?) Wo ist die nächste Bank? (voh ist die naiH-ste bânk?) (Where is the nearest bank?) Wie funktioniert die Klimaanlage? (vee foonk-tsee-on-eert dee klee-mâân-lâ-ge?) (How does the air conditioning work?) Darf ich einen Fön ausleihen? (dârf iH ayn-en fern ous-lay-en?) (May I borrow a hair dryer?) Many of the larger hotels will arrange sightseeing tours and excursions for you, as well as buy tickets to the theater or other events. You make your request known at the Rezeption (rê-zep-tsee-ohn) (reception) or, in some of the fancier hotels, at a separate desk where you can get help specifically with planning your stay in town. Here are a few phrases that may be helpful: Ich möchte gern in die Berge fahren. (iH merH-te gêrn in dee bêrg-e f­ahr-hen.) (I’d like to go to the mountains.)

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht!

239

Könnten Sie mir bitte einen Tagesausflug buchen? (kern-ten zee mir bi-te ayn-en tah-ges-ous-floohk booH-en?) (Could you book a day trip for me?) Ich möchte gern ins Theater gehen. (iH merH-te gêrn ins tey-ah-ter gey-en.) (I’d like to go to the theater.) Könnten Sie mir bitte für heute Abend zwei Karten fürs Theater reservieren? (kern-ten zee mir bi-te fuer hoy-te ah-bênt tvsay kâr-ten fuers tey-ah-ter rêz-êr-veer-en?) (Could you reserve two tickets for this evening?)

Pointing out problems German, Austrian, and Swiss hotels enjoy a solid reputation for top-notch service and superb cleanliness, along with a continental breakfast or breakfast buffet included in the room price. Yet even at first-rate hotels, you may experience a glitch in the otherwise perfect accommodations. To point out something that needs attention, you want to be polite, but you also want results. Hopefully none of the following situations happen to you, but just in case onedoes, here’s a helpful list of how to address the problem. For each situation, you get a statement of what’s wrong, followed by a polite request for a solution: Das Zimmer ist zu kalt. (dâs tsi-mer ist tsooh kâlt.) (The room is too cold.) Können Sie mir bitte sagen, wie ich die Heizung aufdrehe? (kern-en zee mir bi-te zah-gen, vee iH dee hayts-oong ouf-drey-e?) (Could you tell me how to turn up the heat, please?) Der Straßenlärm ist mir sehr unangenehm. (dêr shtrah-sen-lêrm ist mir zeyr oon-ân-ge-neym.) (The street noise is very unpleasant.) Haben Sie vielleicht ein ruhigeres Zimmer zum Hinterhof? (hah-ben zee fee-layHt ayn rooh-ee-gêr-es tsi-mer tsoom hin-ter-hohf?) (Do you have a quieter room facing the courtyard?) In meinem Zimmer gibt es keine Fernbedienung. (in mayn-em tsi-mer gipt ês kayn-e fêrn-be-deen-oong.) (There is no remote control in my room.) Könnten Sie mir bitte eine bringen? (kernt-en zee mir bi-te ayn-e bring-en?) (Could you bring me one, please?) Die Gäste im Zimmer nebenan machen zu viel Lärm. (dee gês-te im tsi-mer ney-ben-ân mâH-en tsooh feel lêrm.) (The guests in the room next door are making too much noise.) Könnten Sie sie (darum) bitten, ruhiger zu sein? (kern-ten zee zee [dâroom] bi-ten, rooh-ee-ger tsoo zayn?) (Could you ask them to be quieter?)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

240

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Ich kann das Fenster nicht öffnen. (iH kân dâs fêns-ter niHt erf-nen.) (I can’t open the window.) Können sie mir bitte zeigen, wie ich das Fenster öffne? (kern-en zee mir bi-te tsay-gen, vee iH dâs fêns-ter erf-ne?) (Could you show me how I open the window, please?) Es gibt nur kaltes Wasser in der Dusche. (ês gipt noor kâl-tes vâs-er in dêr dooh-she.) (There’s only cold water in the shower.) Hätten Sie ein anderes Zimmer? (hêt-ten zee ayn ân-dêr-es tsi-mer?) (Would you have another room?) Ich bin allergisch gegen den Federn in der Bettdecke. (iH bin â-lêr-gish gey-gen dên fey-dêrn in dêr bêt-dêk-e.) (I’m allergic to the feathers in the quilt.) Können Sie mir bitte eine andere Bettdecke bringen? (kern-en zee mir bi-te ayn-e ân-dêr-e bêt-dêk-e bring-en?) (Could you bring me another quilt, please?)

Checking Out and Paying the Bill The German language has no exact equivalent for the convenient English phrase “to check out.” So you use das Zimmer räumen (dâs tsi-mêr roy-men), which literally translates into to clear out the room. If you want to ask what time you have to vacate your room, just say Bis wann müssen wir/muss ich das Zimmer räumen? (bis vân mues-en veer/moos iH dâs tsi-mêr roy-men?) (At what time do we/I have to check out of the room?)

Asking for the bill When you’re ready to check out of the hotel, you can use the word abreisen (âp-ray-zen) (to leave; literally: to travel on). So when you want to leave, tell the receptionist Ich reise ab. (iH ray-ze âp.) (I’m leaving.) Wir reisen ab. (veer ray-zen âp.) (We’re leaving.)

Chapter 4: Finding a Place to Stay: Gute Nacht!

241

The preceding phrases will probably be enough to get the receptionist busy preparing your bill. However, if you need to drive home the point that you’d like to have your bill, you can say Kann ich bitte die Rechnung haben? (kân iH bi-te dee rêH-noong hah-ben?) (Could I have the bill, please?) Book I, Chapters 6 and 7 tell you all about dealing with bills, paying with a credit card, and asking for a receipt.

Asking small favors If you have to check out of the hotel before you’re actually ready to continue on your trip, you may want to leave your luggage for a couple of hours. Fortunately, most hotels allow you to do this. Simply ask Können wir unser/Kann ich mein Gepäck bis . . . Uhr hier lassen? (kern-en veer oon-zer/kân iH mayn ge-pêk bis . . . oohr heer lâs-en?) (Could we leave our/Could I leave my luggage here until . . . o’clock?) When you return to pick up your luggage, you can say Können wir/Kann ich bitte unser/mein Gepäck haben? (kern-en veer/ kân iH bi-te oon-zer/mayn ge-pêk hah-ben?) (Could we/Could I get our/ my luggage, please?) Ready to go to the airport or train station? If you want the receptionist to call you a cab, ask Können Sie mir bitte ein Taxi bestellen? (kern-en zee meer bi-te ayn tâx-ee be-shtêl-en?) (Could you call a cab for me?) The receptionist will need to know where you intend to go before calling for your taxi. The receptionist may ask you Wo möchten Sie hin? (voh merH-ten zee hin?) (Where would you like to go?) Just make sure you know the name of the place you want to go before you approach the receptionist!

Book II Speaking German on the Go

242

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Talkin’ the Talk Klaus and Ulrike Huber are ready to move on and explore other parts of the country. They go to the reception desk to check out. Klaus: Rezeption:

Guten Morgen! Wir reisen heute ab. Kann ich bitte die Rechnung haben? gooh-ten môr-gen! veer ray-zen hoy-te âp. kân iH bi-te dee rêH-noong hah-ben? Good morning! We’re leaving today. May I have the bill, please? Sicher, einen Moment bitte. Haben Sie gestern Abend noch etwas aus der Minibar genommen? ziH-er, ayn-en moh-mênt bi-te. hah-ben zee gês-tern ah-bent nôH êt-vâs ous dêr minibar gê-nôm-en? Sure, one moment please. Did you take anything from the minibar last night?

Klaus:

Ja, zwei Bier. yah, tsvay beer. Yes, two beers.

Rezeption:

Danke. Also, hier ist ihre Rechnung. dân-ke. al-zoh, heer ist eer-e rêH-noong. Thank you. So, here is your bill.

Klaus:

Kann ich mit Kreditkarte bezahlen? kân iH mit krê-dit-kâr-te be-tsahl-en? Can I pay with a credit card?

Rezeption: Selbstverständlich. Unterschreiben Sie hier, bitte. zêlpst-fêr-shtênt-liH. oon-ter-shray-ben zee heer, bi-te. Of course. Please sign here. Klaus:

Vielen Dank und auf Wiedersehen. fee-len dânk oont ouf vee-der-zey-en. Thank you very much and goodbye.

Rezeption:

Gute Reise! gooh-te ray-ze! Have a good trip!

Chapter 5

Getting Around In This Chapter ▶ Getting familiar with airport lingo ▶ Seeing Germany (or wherever you are) by car ▶ Traveling by train ▶ Taking a bus, streetcar, subway, or taxi

P

lanes, trains, taxis, streetcars, buses, subways, and automobiles — you have lots of options for how to get around German-speaking countries. In this chapter, you find out what you need to know to deal with ticket agents, customs officials, car-rental staff, and public transportation personnel. You also discover how to ask the occasional bystander for help, all while keeping a cool head, smiling, and being polite.

Going through the Airport Most airline personnel speak several languages, so they can usually help you in English. But in case you need a little backup, this section provides you with enough vocabulary to navigate the airport with confidence and a smile.

Getting your ticket and checking in Before you head to the airport, you may want to memorize the following three terms related to airplane tickets — just in case: ✓ die Bordkarte (dee bord-kâr-te) (boarding pass) ✓ das Flugticket/der Flugschein (dâs floohk-ti-ket/dêr floohk-shayn) (airplane ticket) ✓ das Rückflugticket (dâs ruek-floohk-ti-ket) (round-trip ticket)

244

Book II: Speaking German on the Go If you can’t print out your ticket and boarding pass before you get to the airport, you’ll have to find the appropriate airline counter. Hopefully the signs at the airport are clear enough, but if you’re feeling like Alice in Wonderland and don’t know which way to go, stop an employee and ask for directions to your airline’s ticket counter: Wo ist der . . . Schalter? (voh ist dêr . . . shâl-ter?) (Where is the . . . counter?) When you arrive at the ticket counter, just say the following to inquire about your ticket: Ich möchte mein Ticket abholen. (iH merH-te mayn ticket [as in English] âp-hoh-len.) (I would like to pick up my ticket.) The attendant will ask you a few questions to prepare you for boarding the plane: Haben Sie Gepäck? (hah-ben zee ge-pêk?) (Do you have luggage?) Wo möchten Sie sitzen, am Fenster oder am Gang? (voh merH-ten zee zits-en, âm fêns-ter oh-der âm gâng?) (Where would you like to sit, by the window or on the aisle?) In response to the question about where you want to sit, you can respond simply am Fenster/am Gang (âm fêns-ter/âm gâng) (by a window/on the aisle), according to your preference. You may also want to ask the following questions to get some details about the flight: Wie lange dauert der Flug? (vee lâng-e dou-êrt dêr floohk?) (How long is the flight?) Wann fliegt die Maschine/das Flugzeug ab? (vân fleekt dee mâ-sheen-e/ dâs floohk-tsoyk âp?) (When does the plane leave?) If you’re at the airport to meet somebody who’s arriving on another plane, you can ask Wann kommt die Maschine aus . . . an? (vân komt dee mâ-sheen-e ous . . . ân?) (When does the plane from . . . arrive?)

Chapter 5: Getting Around

245

Words to Know der Anschlussflug

dêr ân-shloosfloohk

connecting flight

das Flugticket/der Flugschein

dâs floohk-ti-ket/ dêr floohk-shayn

airplane ticket

das Rückflugticket

dâs ruek-floohkti-ket

round-trip ticket

die Bordkarte

dee bord-kâr-te

boarding pass

das Gepäck/ Handgepäck

dâs ge-pêk/ hând-ge-pêk

luggage/hand luggage

das Flugzeug/die Maschine

das floohk-tsoyk/ dee mâ-shee-ne

airplane

der Flug

dêr floohk

flight

abholen

âp-hoh-len

to pick up

dauern

dou-ern

to last, to take (time)

Talkin’ the Talk

Frau Schöller is flying to Prague. At the airport she’s getting her boarding pass at the Lufthansa counter. (Track 27) Frau Schöller: Guten Morgen. Ich brauche eine Bordkarte. Hier ist mein Ticket. gooh-ten mor-gen. iH brauH-e ayn-e bord-kâr-te. Heer ist mayn ticket. Good morning. I need a boarding pass. Here is my ticket.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

246

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Angestellter: Ihren Pass, bitte. eer-en pâs, bi-te. Your passport, please. Frau Schöller hands the counter agent her passport. Frau Schöller: Bitte schön. bi-te shern. Here you are. Angestellter: Danke. Wo möchten Sie sitzen, am Fenster oder am Gang? dân-ke. voh merH-ten zee zits-en, âm fêns-ter oh-der âm gâng? Thank you. Where would you like to sit, by the window or by the aisle? Frau Schöller: Am Fenster, bitte. âm fêns-ter, bi-te. By the window, please. Angestellter: Sie haben Platz 15A, einen Fensterplatz. Hier ist Ihre Bordkarte. Haben Sie Gepäck? zee hah-ben plâts fuenf-tseyn ah, ayn-en fêns-terplâts. heer ist eer-e bord-kâr-te. hah-ben zee ge-pêk? You have seat 15A, a window seat. Here is your boarding pass. Do you have any luggage? Frau Schöller: Ich habe nur Handgepäck, diese Tasche. iH hah-be noohr hând-ge-pêk, deez-e tâsh-e. I only have a carry-on, this bag. Angestellter: Dann können Sie direkt zum Flugsteig gehen. dân kern-en zee di-rêkt tsoom floohk-shtayk gey-en. Then you can go straight to the gate. Frau Schöller: Danke. dân-ke. Thank you.

Chapter 5: Getting Around

247

Words to Know der Abflug

dêr âp-floohk

departure

die Ankunft

dee ân-koonft

arrival

der Flugsteig

dêr floohk-shtayk

gate

mitnehmen

mit-neym-en

to take along

einchecken

ayn-chêk-en

to check in

fliegen

fleeg-en

to fly

abfliegen

âp-fleeg-en

to leave (on a plane)

ankommen

ân-kom-en

to arrive

der Ausweis

dêr ous-vays

ID card

verspätet

fêr-shpey-tet

delayed

Going through passport control Jet-lagged after a long flight across the Atlantic (or wherever you’ve come from), all you want to do is leave the airport. But first you have two hurdles to overcome — passport control and customs. To help you in your foggy state of mind, here are the words you may need to be familiar with when you go through Passkontrolle (dee pâs-kon-trol-e) (passport control) (see the next section for details on customs): der Reisepass/der Pass (dêr ray-ze-pâs/dêr pâs) (passport) EU-Bürger (ey-ooh-buer-ger) (citizen of a country of the European Union) Nicht-EU-Bürger (niHt-ey-ooh-buer-ger) (citizen of a country outside the EU) Here are some sentences you may need to use on your way: Ich bin im Urlaub hier. (iH bin im oor-loup heer.) (I’m here on vacation.) Ich bin geschäftlich hier. (iH bin ge-shêft-liH heer.) (I’m here on business.) Ich bin auf der Durchreise nach. . . . (iH bin ouf dêr doorH-ray-ze nâhH. . . .) (I am on my way to. . . .)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

248

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Most of the time when you reach passport control, you get to choose between two lines: One is for EU-Bürger and the other is for Nicht-EU-Bürger. After passing through whichever line applies to you, you claim your baggage and go through der Zoll (dêr tsol) (customs), where you may have to open your luggage for inspection (see the next section). Matters are more laid back when you’re traveling from one member country of die europäische Union (dee oy-roh-pey-i-she oon-ee-yohn) (the European Union) to another by car or train. With the number of member states currently at 27 — and still counting — you may find yourself crossing many internal borders of the EU without being checked. So when you drive from Germany to France, for example, you may not even notice where the border is until you suddenly discover that the signs are all in French. You can also import virtually unlimited quantities of goods bought from one EU country to another country.

Going through customs You passed the first hurdle and are on your way to customs. Are you one of those people who feels guilty even when you have nothing to hide? Customs officers can make you feel that way. It pays to know how to answer their questions succinctly so you can get past them as quickly as possible. At der Zoll (dêr tsol) (customs), you usually get to choose between two options: the red exit for people who have to declare goods or the green exit for those people who are carrying only things they don’t need to declare. Customs officers may use the following phrase to ask you personally whether you have anything to declare, in which case you may need to pay duty: Haben Sie etwas zu verzollen? (hah-ben zee êt-vâs tsooh fêr-tsol-en?) (Do you have anything to declare?) To this question, you can respond with either of the following: Ich möchte . . . verzollen. (iH merH-te . . . fêr-tsol-en) (I would like to declare. . . .) Ich habe nichts zu verzollen. (iH hah-be niHts tsooh fêr-tsol-en.) (I have nothing to declare.) Despite your most engaging smile, the customs officer may ask to have a look at your not-so-suspicious-looking stuff by saying Bitte öffnen Sie diesen Koffer/diese Tasche. (bi-te erf-nen zee deez-en kof-er/deez-e tâsh-e.) (Please open this suitcase/bag.)

Chapter 5: Getting Around

249

When the customs officer asks what you’re planning to do with a particular item in your bag, you may answer Es ist für meinen persönlichen Gebrauch. (ês ist fuer mayn-en pêr-sernliH-en ge-brouH.) (It’s for my personal use.) Es ist ein Geschenk. (ês ist ayn ge-shênk.) (It’s a gift.)

Traveling by Car Before setting out on a European road trip in a rental car, consider acquiring an internationaler Führerschein (in-têr-nâ-tee-oh-nâ-ler fuer-er-shayn) (international driving permit). You can apply for one at the local AAA (American Automobile Association) website. (Find your local club at www.aaa.com.) Even with an internationaler Führerschein, however, you still need a valid driver’s license from your own country. The internationaler Füherschein is simply a document with translations of the license information into several major European languages. If you have both, you’re all set to discover new territory. To get from city to city in German-speaking countries, you’re most likely to travel the following types of roads: ✓ die Autobahn (dee ou-toh-bahn) (four- to six-lane freeway) ✓ die Bundesstraße (dee boon-des-shtrah-se) or, in Switzerland, Nationalstrasse (nâ-tee-oh-nahl-shtrah-se) (two- to four-lane highway) ✓ die Landstraße (dee lânt-shtrah-se) (two-lane highway)

Renting a car You’re likely to find that making car reservations is cheaper and more hasslefree if you do it before leaving for your European trip. However, if you decide to rent a car when you’re already in Europe, you need to make your way to the Autovermietung (ou-toh-fêr-meet-oong) (car rental agency). When you arrive, start out by saying Ich möchte ein Auto mieten. (iH merH-te ayn ou-toh meet-en.) (I would like to rent a car.)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

250

Book II: Speaking German on the Go The attendant will ask you what kind of car you want by saying something like Was für ein Auto möchten Sie? (vâs fuer ayn ou-toh merH-ten zee?) (What kind of car would you like?) You can respond with any of the following: ✓ ein zweitüriges/viertüriges Auto (ayn tsvay-tuer-ee-ges/feer-tuer-ee-ges ou-toh) (a two-door/four-door car) ✓ einen Kleinwagen (ayn-en klayn-wah-gen) (compact car) ✓ mit Klimanlage (mit klee-mâ-ân-lâ-ge) (with A/C) ✓ mit Automatik (mit ou-toh-mah-tik) (car with automatic transmission) ✓ mit Gangschaltung (mit gâng-shâlt-oong) (car with standard transmission) The attendant may also ask you one or more of the following questions about your rental plans: Ab wann möchten Sie den Wagen mieten? (âp vân merH-ten zee deyn vah-gen meet-en?) (When would you like to start renting the car?) Wann/Wo möchten Sie den Wagen zurückgeben? (vân/voh merH-ten zee deyn vah-gen tsoo-ruek-gey-ben?) (Where/When would you like to return the car?) Here are some possible answers: Ich möchte den Wagen ab dem . . . mieten. (iH merH-te deyn vah-gen âp deym . . . meet-en.) (I would like to rent the car starting. . . . ) Ich möchte den Wagen am . . . zurückgeben. (iH merH-te deyn vahgen âm . . . tsoo-ruek-gey-ben.) (I would like to return the car on the. . . .) Ich möchte den Wagen in (Frankfurt) zurückgeben. (iH merH-te deyn vah-gen in [frânk-foort] tsoo-ruek-gey-ben.) (I would like to return the car in [Frankfurt].) During the rental process, you’ll hear the following words as well: ✓ der Führerschein (dêr fuer-er-shayn) (driver’s license) ✓ die Vollkaskoversicherung (dee fol-kâs-koh-fêr-zeeH-er-oong) (comprehensive collision insurance) ✓ inbegriffen (in-be-grif-en) (included) ✓ ohne Kilometerbegrenzung (oh-ne ki-lo-mey-ter-be-grênts-oong) (unlimited mileage)

Chapter 5: Getting Around

251

Talkin’ the Talk Anke has just arrived in Frankfurt. After going through customs, she heads for a car rental agency where she talks to an employee. Anke:

Guten Morgen. Ich möchte ein Auto mieten. gooh-ten mor-gen. iH merH-te ayn ou-toh meet-en. Good morning. I would like to rent a car.

Angestellter: Was für ein Auto möchten Sie? vâs fuer ayn ou-toh merH-ten zee? What kind of car would you like? Anke:

Einen Kleinwagen mit Automatik. ayn-en klayn-vah-gen mit ou-toh-mah-tik. A compact car with automatic transmission.

Angestellter: Wie lange brauchen Sie den Wagen? vee lâng-e brouH-en zee deyn vah-gen? How long do you need the car? Anke:

Eine Woche. ayn-e voH-e. For one week.

Angestellter: Ein VW Polo kostet für eine Woche ohne Kilometerbregrenzung 299 Euro inklusive Versicherung. ayn vou-vey poh-loh kos-tet fuer ayn-e voH-e oh-ne ki-lo-mey-ter-be-grênts-oong tsvay-hoon-dêrt-noynoont–noyn-tsiH oy-roh in-kloo-zee-ve fêr-ziH-er-oong. A VW Polo costs 299 euros for one week, including unlimited mileage and insurance.

Making sense of road maps A good map tells you plenty more than how to get from Point A to Point B, and it allows you to mark your route as you travel. Another advantage of maps is that they’re primarily visual, so you don’t have to know too much of the language to read one. However, you may find that knowing the words for different kinds of maps is helpful, in case you need to ask for one: ✓ die Landkarte (dee lânt-kâr-te) (map) ✓ der Stadtplan (dêr shtât-plahn) (map of a city) ✓ die Straßenkarte (dee shtrah-sen-kâr-te) (road map)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

252

Book II: Speaking German on the Go On a German map (and also on road signs), you may see the following words: ✓ die Altstadt (dee âlt-shtât) (historic center) ✓ die Ausfahrt (dee ous-fahrt) (exit ramp) ✓ das Autobahndreieck (dâs ou-toh-bahn-dray-êk) (where one freeway splits off from another freeway) ✓ das Autobahnkreuz (dâs ou-toh-bahn-kroyts) (junction of two freeways) ✓ die Einfahrt (dee ayn-fahrt) (entrance ramp) ✓ die Fußgängerzone (dee foohs-gên-ger-tsohn-e) (pedestrian zone) ✓ die Kirche (dee kirH-e) (church) ✓ das Parkhaus (dâs pârk-hous) (parking garage) ✓ der Parkplatz (dêr pârk-plâts) (parking lot) ✓ das Theater (dâs tey-ah-ter) (theater)

Understanding and observing road signs No matter where you’re driving, you surely don’t want to get stopped for driving too fast in the wrong direction down a one-way street that’s been closed for construction. To prevent a scenario like this, here are some of the most common road signs that you encounter in German-speaking countries: ✓ Anlieger frei (ân-lee-ger fray) (access only; no exit) ✓ Baustelle (bou-shtêl-e) (construction site) ✓ Einbahnstraße (ayn-bahn-shtrah-se) (one-way street) ✓ Einordnen (ayn-ord-nen) (merge) ✓ 50 bei Nebel (fuenf-tsiH bay ney-bel) (50 kilometers per hour when foggy) ✓ Gebührenpflichtig (ge-buer-en-pfliHt-iH) (subject to charges — you have to pay toll; you see this sign at the beginning of bridges, tunnels, or turnpikes) ✓ Gesperrt (ge-shpêrt) (closed) ✓ Licht an/aus (liHt ân/ous) (lights on/off — you see these signs at tunnels) ✓ Maut (mout) (toll) ✓ Stau (shtou) (traffic jam — you see this message on electronic signage) ✓ Umleitung (oom-lay-toong) (detour) ✓ Vorsicht Glätte (fohr-ziHt glêt-e) (slippery when wet)

Chapter 5: Getting Around

253

Identifying parts of a car When you rent a car in Europe, you have the convenience of getting around to some of the most beautiful scenery imaginable, especially in the Alps. Driving up and down mountain passes is an exciting experience. In the unlikely event that something happens to your car and you need to go to an Automechaniker (ou-toh-mêH-ân-i-kêr) (car mechanic), you may want to be familiar with the parts of the car and some of the issues you could have with it: ✓ abschleppen (âp-shlêp-en) (to tow) ✓ der Abschleppwagen (âp-shlêp-vâ-gen) (tow truck) ✓ das Auto (dâs ou-toh) (car) ✓ die Batterie (dee bât-êr-ee) (battery) ✓ das Benzin (dâs bên-tseen) (gasoline) ✓ der Blinker (dêr blink-er) (turn signal) ✓ bremsen (brêm-zen) (to brake) ✓ das Bremspedal (dâs brêmz-pêd-âl) (brake pedal) ✓ einstellen (ayn-shtêl-en) (to adjust) ✓ fehlen (fey-len) (to be missing) ✓ der Gang (dêr gâng) (gear) ✓ das Gaspedal (dâs gâs-pêd-âl) (gas pedal) ✓ halten (hâlt-en) (to stop) ✓ klopfen (klopf-en) (to knock) ✓ der Kotflügel (dêr koht-flueg-el) (fender) ✓ kuppeln (koop-eln) (to engage the clutch) ✓ die Kupplung (dee koop-loong) (clutch) ✓ der Lärm (dêr lêrm) (noise) ✓ lecken (lêk-en) (to leak) ✓ leer (lêr) (empty) ✓ lenken (lênk-en) (to steer) ✓ das Lenkrad (dâs lênk-râd) (steering wheel) ✓ liegen bleiben (lee-gen blay-ben) (to stall) ✓ der Motor (dêr moh-tor) (motor) ✓ die Notbremse (dee noht-brêm-ze) (emergency brake)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

254

Book II: Speaking German on the Go ✓ die Panne (dee pân-e) (breakdown) ✓ einen Platten haben (ayn-en plât-en hah-ben) (to have a flat tire) ✓ der Reifen (dêr rayf-en) (tire) ✓ der Reifendruck (dêr rayf-en-drook) (tire pressure) ✓ die Reparatur (dee rêp-âr-â-toor) (repair) ✓ reparieren (rêp-âr-eer-en) (to repair) ✓ schalten (shâl-ten) (to shift gears) ✓ der Scheibenwischer (dêr shay-ben-wish-er) (windshield wiper) ✓ die Stoßstange (dee shtohs-shtâng-e) (bumper) ✓ die Tankstelle (dee tânk-shtêl-e) (gas station) ✓ der Unfall (dêr oon-fâl) (accident) ✓ der Wagen (dêr wah-gen) (car) ✓ die Zundkerze (dee tsoond-kêrts-e) (spark plug) ✓ die Zündung (dee tsuend-oong) (ignition) The following expressions may help you if you need to explain what’s wrong with your car or what you want the mechanic to do to it: Ich habe einen Platten. (iH hah-be ayn-en plât-en.) (I have a flat tire.) Können Sie bitte den Reifen wechseln? (kern-en zee bi-te den ray-fen vêk-seln?) (Can you change the tire, please?) Können Sie bitte den Reifendruck kontrollieren? (kern-en zee bi-te den rayf-en-drook kon-tro-leer-en?) (Can you check the tire pressure, please?) Der Motor klopft. (dêr moh-tor klopft.) (The motor knocks.) Der Wagen springt nicht an. (dêr vah-gen shprinkt niHt ân.) (The car doesn’t start.) Der Wagen bleibt liegen. (dêr vah-gen blaypt lee-gen.) (The car has stalled.) Der Motor macht einen komischen Lärm. (dêr moh-tor mâHt ayn-en koh-mish-en lêrm.) (The motor is making a strange noise.) Können Sie bitte das Auto sofort reparieren? (kern-en zee bi-te dâs ou-toh zoh-fort rêp-âr-eer-en?) (Can you repair the car right away, please?) Wie lange dauert die Reparatur? (vee lâng-e dou-êrt dee rêp-âr-â-toor?) (How long will the repair take?)

Chapter 5: Getting Around

255

Können Sie bitte einen Abschleppwagen schicken? (kern-en zee bi-te ayn-en âp-shlêp-vâg-en shik-en?) (Can you send a tow truck, please?) Nehmen Sie Kreditkarten? (ney-men zee krê-dit-kâr-ten?) (Do you accept credit cards?)

Taking the Train Traveling by rail is a very comfortable way of getting around Europe. Whether you want to whiz from Stuttgart to Paris on the Intercity Express (ICE) (in-têr-si-tee êks-prês [ee-tsey-ey]) or you want to head to the quaint towns along the Mosel River aboard the much slower Interregio (IR) (in-têr-rey-gee-oh [ee-êr]), you can get practically anywhere by train.

Rail travel is very popular among Europeans, so try to make a reservation if you plan to travel during peak traveling times. Europeans do a lot of traveling during July and August, at Christmastime, at Easter, and in Catholic regions, at Whitsuntide (the week after Pentecost). You may also be interested in a combination ticket that allows you to rent a bicycle or a car from a train station. Or if you’re covering a lot of ground in a short time, go online and check out the various types of rail passes before you leave home.

Interpreting train schedules Every train station displays schedules for all the trains that run through that particular station. However, with the flood of information displayed on these schedules, you may have a hard time figuring out what you need to know about the specific train you want to take. The following expressions provide some guidance for demystifying train schedules: ✓ die Abfahrt (dee âp-fahrt) (departure) ✓ die Ankunft (dee ân-koonft) (arrival) ✓ der Fahrplan (dêr fahr-plahn) (train schedule) ✓ sonn- und feiertags (zon oont fay-er-tâhks) (Sundays and holidays) ✓ über (ue-ber) (via) ✓ werktags (vêrk-tâhks) (workdays)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

256

Book II: Speaking German on the Go

Getting more information When you have questions about a train you want to take, head to die Auskunft (dee ous-koonft) (the information counter). There, you may ask any of the following questions: Von welchem Gleis fährt der Zug nach . . . ab? (fon vêlH-Hem glays fairt dêr tsoohk nahH . . . âp?) (Which track does the train to . . . leave from?) Auf welchem Gleis kommt der Zug aus . . . an? (ouf vêlH-em glays komt dêr tsoohk ous . . . ân?) (Which track does the train from . . . arrive on?) Hat der Zug Verspätung? (hât dêr tsoohk fêr-shpêt-oong?) (Is the train delayed?) Muss ich umsteigen? (moos iH oom-shtay-gen?) (Do I have to change trains?) Many German verbs, including many of the verbs used in this chapter, have prefixes that are detachable from the body (stem) of the verb. When using separable-prefix verbs, as these verbs are called, the main verb stem with the appropriate ending goes in its usual place, and the prefix becomes the last word in the sentence. This rule works for the present and simple past tenses. (Turn to Book III, Chapter 8 for more on separable- and inseparable-prefix verbs.) Take a look at this phenomenon in action, using the verb ankommen (ân-kom-en) (to arrive). Notice how the prefix always moves to the end of the sentence, no matter how many words come between it and the verb: Der Zug kommt um 18.15 Uhr an. (dêr tsoohk komt oom âHt-tseyn oohr fuenf-tseyn ân.) (The train arrives at 6:15 p.m.) Auf welchem Gleis kommt der Zug aus Dessau an? (ouf vêlH-em glays komt dêr tsoohk ous dês-ou ân?) (Which track does the train from Dessau arrive on?) Wann fährt der Zug ab? (vân fairt dêr tsoohk âp?) (When does the train depart?) Here are a few other travel-related verbs that follow this pattern. Notice how the first syllable is stressed: ✓ abfahren (âp-fahr-en) (to depart [on a train]) ✓ abfliegen (âp-fleeg-en) (to depart [on a plane]) ✓ anfangen (ân-fâng-en) (to start) ✓ ankommen (ân-kom-en) (to arrive) ✓ aussteigen (ous-shtayg-en) (to get off) ✓ einsteigen (ayn-shtayg-en) (to get on)

Chapter 5: Getting Around

257

Words to Know der Bahnsteig

dêr bahn-shtayk

platform

das Gleis

dâs glays

track

die Verspätung

dee fêr-shpêt-oong

delay

einsteigen

ayn-shtayg-en

to get on

aussteigen

ous-shtayg-en

to get off

umsteigen

oom-shtayg-en

to change (trains, buses, and so on)

abfahren

âp-fahr-en

to leave

fahren

fahr-en

to go by, to travel

Buying train tickets For train tickets, you need to go to der Fahrkartenautomat (dêr fahr-kâr-tenou-toh-mât) (ticket machine) or der Fahrkartenschalter (dêr fahr-kâr-tenshâl-ter) (ticket window/counter). With the help of the words in this section, you can buy a ticket to virtually anywhere you want to go.

The basics When it’s your turn to talk to the ticket agent, just say the following to buy a ticket: Eine Fahrkarte nach . . . , bitte. (ayn-e fahr-kâr-te nahH . . . , bi-te.) (A train ticket to . . . , please.) To find out whether you want a one-way or round-trip ticket, the ticket agent will ask Einfach oder hin und zurück? (ayn-fâH oh-der hin oont tsoo-ruek?) (One-way or round-trip?)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

258

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Then to find out whether you want a first-class or second-class ticket, the ticket agent will ask Erster oder zweiter Klasse? (eyrs-ter oh-der tsvay-ter klâs-e?) (In first or second class?)

Extras On all trains, you pay a set base price per kilometer for first and second class. In addition, you have to pay der Zuschlag (dêr tsooh-shlahk) (surcharge) for the very fast trains marked ICE (Intercity Express), IC (Intercity), or EC (Eurocity). For these trains, the word Zuschlag usually appears on the train schedule or the board displaying departures. On especially busy trains, you’re better off reserving a seat in advance. To do so, simply ask Ich möchte gern eine Platzkarte für den . . . von . . . nach. . . . (iH merHte gêrn ayn-e plâts-kâr-te fuer deyn . . . fon . . . nahH. . . .) (I would like to reserve a seat on the . . . from . . . to. . . .)

Words to Know die Fahrkarte

dee fahr-kâr-te

train ticket

die erste Klasse

dee êrs-te klâs-e

first class

die zweite Klasse

dee tsvay-te klâs-e

second class

der Zuschlag

dêr tsooh-shlahk

surcharge

die Rückfahrkarte

dee ruek-fahr-kâr-te

round-trip ticket

die Platzkarte

dee plâts-kâr-te

reserved seat

hin und zurück

hin oont tsoo-ruek

round-trip

einfach

ayn-fâH

one-way

Chapter 5: Getting Around

259

Navigating Buses, Subways, Streetcars, and Taxis German cities and towns usually have excellent public transportation systems. A combination of Bus (boos) (bus), U-Bahn (ooh-bahn) (subway), Straßenbahn (shtrah-sen-bahn) (streetcar), and S-Bahn (ês-bahn) (light rail train to the suburbs) can get you rapidly and safely where you want to go. Generally, your ticket allows you to ride on the various forms of transportation available. Of course, you can also take a taxi, if you prefer. Book II

Purchasing a ticket When you enter a subway station in a German-speaking country, you won’t see any turnstiles. So how do people pay for the ride? They buy tickets first and then validate them by inserting the ticket into a validating machine in the bus or streetcar, and in the case of a subway, before proceeding to the platform. To buy a ticket, go to der Fahrkartenautomat (dêr fahr-kâr-ten-ou-toh-mât) (ticket machine) at bus and streetcar stops and in subway stations. Here are three words you may see for ticket on the ticket machine or on the ticket itself:

✓ der Fahrschein (der fahr-shayn) (ticket for transportation)

✓ die Fahrkarte (dee fahr-kar-te) (ticket for transportation) ✓ das Ticket (dâs ti-ket) (general word for ticket) The following are various types of tickets you can buy: ✓ die Einzelfahrkarte (dee ayn-zel-fahr-kâr-te) (ticket): A single-ride ticket; generally valid for up to two hours of travel in a single direction ✓ die Streifenkarte (dee shtrayf-en-kâr-te) (strip ticket): A strip ticket for multiple trips; you fold over the number of strips that the trip costs, depending on the number of zones you’re traveling through ✓ die Tageskarte (dee tâg-es-kâr-te) (one-day ticket): A ticket valid for unlimited travel for one 24-hour period ✓ die Partnertageskarte (dee partner [as in English]-tâg-es-kâr-te) (partner day ticket): A ticket for two or more people — depending on the city — for unlimited travel within a 24-hour period

Speaking German on the Go

260

Book II: Speaking German on the Go ✓ die Gruppentageskarte (dee groop-en-tâg-es-kâr-te) (group day ticket): A ticket for a small group of people, for example, up to six — depending on the city — for unlimited travel within a 24-hour period ✓ die Wochenkarte (dee woH-en-kâr-te) (weekly ticket): A ticket for unlimited travel for one week ✓ die Monatskarte (dee moH-nâts-kâr-te) (monthly ticket): A ticket for unlimited travel for a month After you purchase a ticket, don’t forget to validate it before boarding the train, subway, streetcar, or bus. Plainclothes ticket inspectors make frequent checks, and anyone caught without a valid ticket can count on a hefty on-thespot fine.

You validate your ticket by inserting the end of the ticket marked by an arrow or the word entwerten (ênt-wêrt-en) (validate) into the Entwerter (ênt-wêrter) (validating machine). You find Entwerter on buses and streetcars and in subway stations before you enter the subway. After you’ve validated your ticket, you can use it interchangeably on the various forms of transportation available.

Boarding the bus, subway, or streetcar Getting on the right subway is easy when you know which direction to take. Take a look at the subway map to figure out where to go. If you’re still unsure, ask one or, better yet, two different people the following question: Ist das die richtige U-bahn zum (Stadion)? (ist dâs dee riH-tee-ge oohbahn tsoom [shtah-dee-on]?) (Is this the right subway to the [stadium]?) If you need help finding the right bus or streetcar to take, you can ask the agent at the Fahrkartenschalter (fahr-kâr-ten-shâl-ter) (ticket window/counter) or any bus driver (der Busfahrer) (dêr boos-fahr-er) or Straßenbahnfahrer (shtrah-sen-bahn-fahr-er) (streetcar driver) one of the following questions: Welcher Bus fährt ins Stadtzentrum? (vêlH-er boos fairt ins shtât-tsêntroom?) (Which bus goes to the city center?) Muss ich umsteigen? (moos iH oom-shtayg-en?) (Do I have to switch [buses]?) Hält dieser Bus am Hauptbahnhof? (hêlt deez-er boos âm houpt-bahnhohf?) (Does this bus stop at the main train station?)

Chapter 5: Getting Around

261

Words to Know der Bus

dêr boos

bus

die U-bahn

dee ooh-bahn

subway

die S-Bahn

dee ês-bahn

local train

die Straßenbahn

dee shtrahsen-bahn

streetcar

die Buslinie/ U-Bahnlinie

dee boos-leen-ye/ ooh-bahn-leen-ye

bus line/subway line

die Haltestelle

dee hâl-te-shtê-le

station, stop

halten

hâl-ten

to stop

die U-Bahnstation

dee ooh-bahnshtâts-ee-ohn

subway station

das Taxi

dâs tâx-ee

taxi

der Taxistand

dêr tâx-ee-shtânt

taxi stand

der Fahrscheinautomat

dêr fahr-shaynou-toh-maht

ticket vending machine

Book II

Talkin’ the Talk Ben wants to take the bus to city hall, but he’s not quite sure which bus he should take. So he approaches a teenager who is standing next to him at the bus stop. (Track 28) Ben: Entschuldigen Sie, bitte, hält hier der Bus Nummer 9? ênt-shool-dee-gen zee, bi-te, hêlt heer dêr boosnoom-er noyn? Excuse me please, does the bus number 9 stop here? Teenager:

Nein, hier hält nur die Linie 8. Wohin wollen Sie denn? nayn, heer hêlt noohr dee leen-ye âHt. vo-hin vol-en zee dên? No, only number 8 stops here. Where do you want to go?

Speaking German on the Go

262

Book II: Speaking German on the Go Ben: Zum Rathaus. tsoom raht-hous. To the town hall. Teenager:

Fahren Sie mit der Linie 8 bis zum Goetheplatz, und dort steigen Sie in die Linie 9 um. fahr-en zee mit dêr leen-ye âHt bis tsoom ger-te-plâts, oont dort shtayg-en zee in dee leen-ye noyn oom. Take this bus to Goetheplatz and switch there to number 9.

Ben: Wie viele Haltestellen sind es bis zum Goetheplatz? vee feel-e hâl-te-shtêl-en zint ês bis tsoom ger-te-plâts? How many stops are there to Goetheplatz? Teenager:

Von hier sind es vier Haltestellen. fon heer zint ês feer hâl-te-shtêl-en. It’s four stops from here.

Ben:

Vielen Dank für die Auskunft. feel-en dânk fuer dee ous-koonft. Thank you very much for the information.

Getting a taxi The secret to getting a taxi cab in Germany is making a phone call or walking to the nearest taxi stand. You may be used to the idea of hailing a cab on the street, but doing so isn’t common practice in Germany — even in the larger cities. Why? Well, with the astronomical cost of gas in Europe, consider how much cab drivers would spend if they drove around until being hailed. So if you want to take a taxi, you can ask someone on the street where the nearest taxi stand is located and walk to it, or you can find out the phone number of the taxi stand closest to you and call it. If you’re at a restaurant or some other business, you can ask an employee to call a cab for you. Of course, you also find taxi stands in front of airports, train stations, and major hotels. Getting a taxi at a Taxistand (tâx-ee-shtânt) (taxi stand) isn’t hard. Just go straight up to the first car in the line. When you get in, the Taxifahrer (tâx-ee-fahr-er) (taxi driver) will turn on the meter and ask you Wohin möchten Sie? (vo-hin merH-ten zee?) (Where would you like to go?) At the end of the trip, you pay the price indicated on the meter, along with a modest tip of around 5 percent. Many Germans taking a taxi alone sit in the passenger seat. You may enjoy doing the same. You have a far greater chance of seeing where you’re going, and you can take the opportunity to ask questions and practice your German.

Chapter 6

Handling Emergencies: Hilfe! In This Chapter ▶ Asking for assistance ▶ Getting help for a medical problem ▶ Communicating with the police

H

opefully, you’ll never need to use the vocabulary and information in this chapter, but you never know, so read on. Aside from dealing with accidents and talking to the police, you may need to handle other kinds of emergencies — like what to do if you wake up in the morning with a bout of nausea and stomach cramps. This chapter assists you in dealing with various emergency situations, from seeking medical attention to reporting a theft.

Requesting Help The hardest part of handling emergencies is keeping your cool so you can communicate the situation clearly and calmly to someone, be it a police officer, an emergency medical technician, or a doctor. So don’t panic if you have to express the following unpleasant facts in German. In case you get tonguetied, make sure you know how to ask for someone who speaks English.

Shouting for help The following expressions come in handy if you need to grab someone’s attention to get help in an emergency situation: Hilfe! (hilf-e!) (Help!) Rufen Sie die Polizei! (roohf-en zee dee po-li-tsay!) (Call the police!) Rufen Sie einen Krankenwagen! (roohf-en zee ayn-en krânk-en-vahg-en!) (Call an ambulance!)

264

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go Rufen Sie die Feuerwehr! (roohf-en zee dee foy-er-veyr!) (Call the fire department!) Holen Sie einen Arzt! (hohl-en zee ayn-en ârtst!) (Get a doctor!) Feuer! (foy-êr!) (Fire!)

Reporting a problem If you need to report an accident or let people know that you or other people are hurt, this basic vocabulary can help: Ich möchte einen Unfall melden. (iH merH-te ayn-en oon-fâl mêl-den.) (I want to report an accident.) Ich möchte einen Autounfall melden. (iH merH-te ayn-en ou-toh-oonfâl mêl-den.) (I want to report a car accident.) Ich bin verletzt. (iH bin fêr-lêtst.) (I am hurt.) Es gibt Verletzte. (ês gipt fêr-lêts-te.) (There are injured people.) In case of an emergency, you definitely want to have the right phone numbers handy. If you find yourself in an emergency situation while you’re in European Union (EU) countries, including Germany and Austria, the crucial number you need to memorize or keep in your wallet is 112. Switzerland and most other non-EU countries in western Europe have also adopted the 112 number for emergencies. When you dial 112, which should work even from a cellphone, your call is routed to the nearest emergency call center. The center is prepared to dispatch the Polizei (po-li-tsay) (police), call the Feuerwehr (foy-êr-veyr) (fire department), or contact a Rettungsdienst (rêtoongs-deenst) (emergency service). If you’re driving on the Autobahn (ou-toh-bahn) (highway) and you have to report an accident, the highway systems in Germany, Austria, Switzerland, and many other western European countries have motorist aid call boxes at regular intervals. On the Autobahn in German-speaking countries, such call boxes are labeled Notruf or S.O.S. (noht-roohf or s.o.s. [as in English]) (emergency call or S.O.S.). You’ll also see arrows on guard rails or posts that point in the direction of the nearest emergency phone. Accidents aside, you need to be prepared for other emergencies, such as a robbery or theft, as well: Ich möchte einen Diebstahl/Raubüberfall melden. (iH merH-te ayn-en deep-shtahl/roup-ue-ber-fâl mêl-den.) (I want to report a theft/robbery.) Halten Sie den Dieb! (hâl-ten zee deyn deep!) (Catch the thief!)

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe!

265

Asking for English-speaking help If you aren’t able to get the help you need by speaking German, ask this question: Spricht hier jemand Englisch? (shpriHt heer yey-mânt êng-lish?) (Does anybody here speak English?)

Words to Know

Book II

Hilfe!

hilf-e!

Help!

Rufen Sie die Polizei!

roohf-en zee dee po-li-tsay!

Call the police!

Feuer!

foy-êr!

Fire!

Handling Health Issues Open your mouth and say, “Ahhhhhh.” Good. Now breathe deeply. Relax. Breathe deeply again. Great! Now you, dear reader, should be relaxed enough to figure out how to explain what ails you. Hopefully, you won’t need to seek medical assistance in a foreign country, but if you do, this section is exactly what the doctor ordered. What kind of medical professional do you need? Where do you want to go? Here are a few words you need to know in case you’re feeling out of sorts and need medical attention: ✓ die Apotheke (dee ah-poh-tey-ke) (pharmacy) ✓ der Arzt/die Ärztin (dêr ârtst/dee êrts-tin) (male/female medical doctor) ✓ die Arztpraxis (dee ârtst-prâx-is) (doctor’s office) ✓ der Doktor (dêr dok-tohr) (doctor — profession and form of address)

✓ das Krankenhaus (dâs krânk-en-hous) (hospital)

✓ die Notaufnahme (dee noht-ouf-nah-me) (emergency room) ✓ der Zahnarzt/die Zahnärztin (dêr tsahn-ârtst/dee tsahn-êrts-tin) (male/ female dentist) ✓ die Zahnarztpraxis (dee tsahn-ârtst-prax-is) (dentist’s office)

Speaking German on the Go

266

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go If you need medical help, you can ask for a doctor or find out where the nearest doctor’s office, hospital, or pharmacy is located by saying one of the following: Ich brauche einen Arzt. (iH brouH-e ayn-en ârtst.) (I need a doctor.) Wo ist die Notaufnahme? (voh ist dee noht-ouf-nah-me?) (Where is the emergency room?) Wo ist die nächste Arztpraxis/das nächste Krankenhaus/die nächste Apotheke? (voh ist dee naiH-ste ârtst-prâx-is/dâs naiH-ste krânk-en-hous/ dee naiH-ste ah-poh-tey-ke?) (Where is the nearest doctor’s office/the nearest hospital/the nearest pharmacy?)

Describing what ails you Got a fever? Shooting pains down your leg? Nausea or worse? Then you’ve come to the right place. If you want to express that you aren’t feeling well and explain where it hurts, use the following sentences: Ich fühle mich nicht wohl. (iH fuel-e miH niHt vohl.) (I’m not feeling well.) Ich bin krank. (iH bin krânk.) (I am sick.) Mir geht es nicht gut. (meer geyt ês niHt gooht.) (I don’t feel well.) Mir ist schwindlig. (meer ist shvind-liH.) (I feel dizzy.) Mir ist übel. (meer ist ue-bel.) (I feel nauseous.) Ich glaube, ich bin erkältet. (iH glou-be, iH bin êr-kêlt-et.) (I think I have a cold.) Ich habe einen starken Husten. (iH hah-be ayn-en shtârk-en hooh-sten.) (I have a bad cough.) Ich habe geschwollene Drüsen. (iH hah-be gê-shvol-en-e druez-en.) (I have swollen glands.) Ich leide an Verstopfung. (iH lay-de ân fêr-shtopf-oong.) (I’m suffering from constipation.) Ich muss mich häufig übergeben. (iH moos miH hoy-fiH ue-ber-gey-ben.) (I have to vomit frequently.) Ich habe Fieber/Durchfall. (iH hah-be feeb-er/doorH-fâl.) (I have a fever/ diarrhea.) Mir tut der Fuß/Bauch/Rücken/Hals weh. (meer tooht dêr foohs/bouH/ ruek-en/hâls vey.) (My foot/stomach/back/throat hurts.) Ich habe Schmerzen im Arm/Bauch/Brust(korb). (iH hah-be shmêrts-en im ârm/bouH/broost[korp].) (I feel pain in my arm/stomach/chest.)

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe!

267

Ich habe (starke) Bauchschmerzen/Kopfschmerzen. (iH hah-be [shtârke] bouH-shmêrts-en/kopf-shmêrts-en.) (I have [a severe] stomachache/ headache.) Ich habe Ohrenschmerzen/Zahnschmerzen. (iH hah-be ohr-en-shmêrts-en/ tsahn-shmêrts-en.) (I have a headache/toothache.) Ich habe Halsschmerzen/Rückenschmerzen. (iH hah-be hâls-shmêrts-en/ ruek-en-shmêrts-en.) (I have a sore throat/back pain.)

Talking about any special conditions

Book II

An important part of getting treatment is letting the doctor know whether you’re allergic to something or have any other medical conditions. To do so, start out by saying

Speaking German on the Go

Ich bin . . . (ih bin . . .) (I am . . .) Then finish the sentence with any of the following: allergisch gegen . . . (â-lêr-gish gey-gen . . .) (allergic to . . .) behindert (bê-hin-dêrt) (handicapped) schwanger (shvâng-er) (pregnant) Diabetiker (dee-ah-bey-ti-ker) (a diabetic) Epileptiker (ey-pi-lêp-ti-ker) (an epileptic) A few specific conditions may require that you begin with the following: Ich habe . . . (iH hah-be . . .) (I have . . .) Then state the condition. Here are some examples: eine Intoleranz gegen (Penizillin) (ayn-e in-tol-er-ants gey-gen [pê-ni-tsileen]) (an intolerance to [penicillin]) ein Herzleiden (ayn hêrts-layd-en) (a heart condition) zu hohen/niedrigen Blutdruck (tsooh hoh-en/need-reeg-gen blooht-drook) (high/low blood pressure)

Getting an examination After you get into the examination room, you need to make sure you understand the doctor’s questions and the instructions you have to follow to get the proper diagnosis. The doctor may ask you questions like

268

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go Was haben Sie für Beschwerden? (vâs hah-ben zee fuer be-shveyr-den?) (What symptoms do you have?) Was fehlt Ihnen? (vâs feylt een-en?) (What is wrong with you?) Haben Sie Schmerzen? (hah-ben zee shmêrts-en?) (Are you in pain?) Wo tut es weh? (voh tooht ês vey?) (Where does it hurt?) Tut es hier weh? (tooht ês heer vey?) (Does it hurt here?) Wie lange fühlen Sie sich schon so? (vee lâng-e fuel-en zee ziH shon zoh?) (How long have you been feeling this way?) Sind Sie gegen irgendetwas allergisch? (zint zee gey-gen ir-gênt-êt-vâs â-lêr-gish?) (Are you allergic to anything?) Here are some (not-so-fun) instructions you may hear from the doctor: Bitte streifen Sie den Ärmel hoch. (bi-te shtrayf-en zee deyn êr-mel hoH.) (Please pull up your sleeve.) Bitte machen Sie den Oberkörper frei. (bi-te mâH-en zee deyn oh-bêrkerr-per fray.) (Please take off your shirt.) Bitte legen Sie sich hin. (bi-te ley-gen zee ziH hin.) (Please lie down.) Machen Sie bitte den Mund auf. (mâH-en zee bi-te deyn moont ouf.) (Please open your mouth.) Atmen Sie bitte tief durch./Einatmen./Ausatmen. (aht-men zee bi-te teef doorH/ayn-aht-men/ous-aht-men.) (Please take a deep breath./Breathe in./ Breathe out.) Husten Sie bitte. (hoohs-ten zee bi-te.) (Please cough.) Ich werde Ihren Puls messen. (iH wêr-de eer-en pools mês-en.) (I’m going to check your pulse.) Ich möchte Ihren Blutdruck messen. (iH merH-te eer-en blooht-drook mês-en.) (I would like to check your blood pressure.) Wir müssen eine Blutuntersuchung/Stuhlprobe machen. (veer mues-en ayn-e blooht-oon-ter-zooH-oong/shtoohl-proh-be maH-en.) (We need to take a blood sample/stool sample.) Ich gebe Ihnen eine Spritze. (iH gey-be een-en ayn-e shprit-se.) (I’m giving you a shot.) Wir müssen eine Röntgenaufnahme machen. (veer mues-en ayn-e rerntgên-ouf-nah-me mâH-en.) (We have to take an X-ray.) Sie müssen geröntgt werden. (zee mues-en ge-rerngt vêr-den.) (You have to get an X-ray.)

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe!

269

Specifying parts of the body To the question Wo tut es weh? (voh tooht ês vey?) (Where does it hurt?), you can answer any of the following: ✓ der Arm (dêr ârm) (arm) ✓ das Auge/die Augen (dâs oug-e/dee oug-en) (eye/eyes)

✓ der Bauch (dêr bouH) (stomach)

✓ das Bein (dâs bayn) (leg) ✓ die Brust (dee broost) (chest)

Book II

✓ der Daumen (dêr doum-en) (thumb)

Speaking German on the Go

✓ der Finger (dêr fing-er) (finger) ✓ der Fuß (dêr foohs) (foot) ✓ der Fußgelenk/Fußknöchel (dêr foohs-ge-lênk/foohs-knerH-el) (ankle) ✓ die Gelenke (dee ge-lênk-e) (joints) ✓ der Hals (dêr hâls) (throat, neck) ✓ die Hand (dee hânt) (hand) ✓ das Handgelenk (dâs hant-gê-lênk) (wrist) ✓ das Herz (dâs hêrts) (heart) ✓ die Hüfte (dee huef-te) (hip) ✓ der Kiefer (dêr keef-er) (jaw) ✓ das Knie (dâs knee) (knee) ✓ die Leber (dee ley-ber) (liver) ✓ die Lungen (dee loong-en) (lungs) ✓ der Magen (dêr mah-gen) (stomach) ✓ der Mund (dêr moont) (mouth) ✓ der Muskel (dêr moos-kel) (muscle) ✓ der Nacken (dêr nâk-en) (neck) ✓ die Nase (dee nah-ze) (nose) ✓ die Nieren (dee neer-en) (kidneys) ✓ der Oberschenkel (dêr oh-bêr-shênk-el) (thigh) ✓ das Ohr/die Ohren (dâs ohr/dee ohr-en) (ear/ears)

270

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go ✓ der Rücken (dêr ruek-en) (back) ✓ die Schulter (dee shool-ter) (shoulder) ✓ der Zahn (dêr tsahn) (tooth) ✓ der Zeh (dêr tsey) (toe) ✓ die Zunge (dee tsoong-e) (tongue) Here are a few other parts of the body you may need to identify: ✓ das Gesicht (dâs ge-ziHt) (face) ✓ das Haar (dâs hahr) (hair) ✓ der Kopf (dêr kopf) (head) ✓ die Lippe (dee lip-e) (lip)

Understanding the diagnosis After the doctor has gathered the information she needs, she’ll tell you what she thinks is wrong. Here are some very useful words and phrases that keep you from being left in the dark: die Diagnose (dee dee-âg-noh-ze) (diagnosis) Sie haben . . . (zee hah-ben . . .) (You have . . .) eine Erkältung (ayn-e êr-kêlt-oong) (a cold) eine Grippe (ayn-e grip-e) (the flu) eine Entzündung (ayn-e ênt-tsuend-oong) (an inflammation) Blinddarmentzündung (blint-dârm-ênt-tsuend-oong) (appendicitis) Lungenentzündung (lung-en-ênt-tsuend-oong) (pneumonia) Mandelentzündung (mân-del-ênt-tsuend-oong) (tonsillitis) Here are a few sample sentences you may hear: Sie haben 39 Grad Fieber. (zee hah-ben noyn-oont-dray-siH grâd feeb-er.) (You have a fever of 39 degrees.) Ihre Temperatur ist etwas erhöht. (eer-e têmp-êr-ah-toohr ist êt-vâs êr-hert.) (You have a slight temperature.) Ihr Fußknöchel ist gebrochen/verstaucht/verrenkt. (eer foohs-knerH-êl ist ge-broH-en/fêr-shtouHt/fêr-rênkt.) (Your ankle is broken/sprained/dislocated.) Sie müssen einen Spezialisten aufsuchen. (zee mues-en ayn-en shpêts-eeâ-list-en ouf-zooH-en.) (You need to see a specialist.)

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe!

271

If the doctor tells you that you need to see a specialist, you can ask about finding a specialist by saying Können Sie mir bitte einen Spezialisten empfehlen? (kern-en zee meer bi-te ayn-en shpêts-ee-â-list-en êm-pfey-len?) (Could you recommend a specialist to me, please?)

Talkin’ the Talk Ulrich Lempert hasn’t been feeling well for a couple of days and has made an appointment with his doctor, Dr. Grawen. (Track 29) Dr. Grawen: Guten Morgen, Herr Lempert. Was haben Sie für Beschwerden? gooht-en mor-gen, hêr lêm-pêrt. vâs hah-ben zee fuer be-shveyr-den? Good morning, Mr. Lempert. What symptoms do you have? Ulrich: Ich fühle mich seit ein paar Tagen nicht wohl. iH fuel-e miH zayt ayn pahr tah-gen niHt vohl. I haven’t been feeling well for a couple of days. Dr. Grawen: Haben Sie Schmerzen? hah-ben zee shmêrts-en? Are you in pain? Ulrich:

Ja, ich habe starke Kopf- und Magenschmerzen. yah, iH hah-be stâr-ke kopf- oont mah-gen-shmêrts-en. Yes, I have a severe headache and stomachache.

Dr. Grawen: Bitte setzen Sie sich hier hin und machen Sie den Oberkörper frei. bi-te zêts-en zee ziH heer hin oont mâH-en zee deyn oh-bêr-kerr-pêr fray. Please sit down here and take off your shirt. Dr. Grawen starts examining Ulrich. Dr. Grawen: Machen Sie bitte den Mund auf — danke. Atmen Sie bitte tief durch. Husten Sie bitte. mâH-en zee bi-te deyn moont ouf — dân-ke. aht-mên zee bi-te teef doorH. hoohs-ten zee bi-te. Please open your mouth — thank you. Take a deep breath, please. Please cough.

Book II Speaking German on the Go

272

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go Und, was stimmt nicht mit mir? oont, vâs shtimt niHt mit meer? And what’s wrong with me?

Ulrich:

Dr. Grawen: Sie haben eine Grippe. Ich gebe Ihnen ein Rezept. Und bleiben Sie die nächsten Tage im Bett. zee hah-ben ayn-e grip-e. iH gey-be een-en ayn rêtsêpt. oont blay-ben zee dee naiH-sten tah-ge im bêt. You have the flu. I’m giving you a prescription. And stay in bed for the next few days.

Words to Know Ich brauche einen Arzt.

iH brouH-e ayn-en ârtst.

I need a doctor.

Ich bin krank.

iH bin krânk.

I am sick.

Wo tut es weh?

voh tooht ês vey?

Where does it hurt?

Haben Sie Schmerzen?

hah-ben zee shmêrts-en?

Are you in pain?

Getting treatment After the doctor tells you what the problem is, he will tell you what to do about it. The doctor may ask you one final question before deciding what treatment would be best for you: Nehmen Sie noch andere Medikamente? (ney-men zee noH ân-de-re mey-dee-kâ-mên-te?) (Are you taking any other medicine?) The doctor may then begin with Ich gebe Ihnen . . . /Ich verschreibe Ihnen . . . (iH gey-be een-en . . ./ iH fêr-shray-be een-en . . .) (I’ll give you . . ./I’ll prescribe for you . . .)

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe!

273

He may end that statement with any of the following: ✓ Antibiotika (ân-tee-bee-oh-ti-kâ) (antibiotics) ✓ das Medikament/die Medikamente (dâs mey-dee-kâ-mênt/dee mey-deekâ-mên-te) (medicine [singular and plural]) ✓ ein Schmerzmittel (ayn shmêrts-mit-el) (a painkiller) ✓ Tabletten (tâ-blêt-en) (pills) Finally, the doctor may indicate that he wants to see you again by saying Kommen Sie in . . . Tagen/einer Woche wieder. (kom-en zee in . . . tah-gen/ ayn-er voH-e vee-der.) (Come back in . . . days/one week.) The doctor will give you a prescription, das Rezept (dâs rê-tsêpt), that you take to a pharmacy, called die Apotheke (dee âpo-tey-ke), to be filled. The following phrases can help you understand the instructions for taking your medicine: Bitte, nehmen Sie . . . Tabletten/Teelöffel . . . (bi-te, ney-men zee . . . tahblêt-en/tey-lerf-el . . .) (Please take . . . pills/teaspoons . . .) dreimal am Tag/täglich (dray-mahl âm tahk/taig-liH) (three times a day/ daily) alle . . . Stunden (âl-e . . . shtoon-den) (every . . . hours) vor/nach dem Essen (fohr/naH deym ês-en) (before/after meals)

Going to a pharmacy You may be used to getting your prescription medicine at a drugstore, but that isn’t the case in Germany. The German equivalent of the drugstore is the Drogerie (droh-ge-ree), where you get everything from toothpaste to sunblock, as well as nonprescription drugs, such as aspirin and cough syrup. For prescription drugs, however, you have to go to the Apotheke (âpoh-tey-ke) (pharmacy). When it comes to prescriptions, German laws are very strict, meaning that a lot of the medicine (such as allergy medication) you can buy over the counter in the U.S. requires a prescription in Germany (and thus, a trip to the doctor). While traveling, heading to the nearest pharmacy may be your best option if you don’t have time to make a doctor’s appointment or if you think what’s ailing you can be remedied with over-the-counter medicine. As in North America, the pharmacists in German-speaking Europe are well-trained and

Book II Speaking German on the Go

274

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go qualified to listen to their customers’ ailments and recommend nonprescription medicine to alleviate the symptoms of the common cold, sore throat, coughing, diarrhea, constipation, skin rash, sunburn, and so on. When you want to get help from the pharmacist, just ask one of these questions: Können Sie mir bitte etwas gegen . . . geben? (kern-en zee mir bi-te êt-vâs gey-gen . . . gey-ben?) (Could you give me something for . . . , please?) Haben Sie etwas gegen. . . ? (hah-ben zee êt-vâs gey-gen. . . ?) (Do you have something for. . . ?) You can complete these questions with any of the following: ✓ Durchfall (doorH-fâl) (diarrhea) ✓ eine Erkältung (ayn-e êr-kêlt-oong) (a cold) ✓ die Grippe (dee grip-e) (the flu) ✓ Husten (hoos-tên) (cough) ✓ Kopfweh (kopf-wey) (headache) ✓ Sonnenbrand (zon-en-brânt) (sunburn) ✓ Verstopfung (fêr-shtopf-oong) (constipation) The following questions may help you get more information about taking whatever medicine the pharmacist hands you: Haben diese Tabletten eine starke Wirkung? (hah-ben dee-ze tâ-blêt-en ayn-e shtârk-e virk-oong?) (Do these tablets have a strong effect?) Wieviele Tabletten soll ich nehmen? (vee fee-le tâ-blêt-en zol iH neymen?) (How many tablets should I take?) Wann soll ich dieses Medikament nehmen? (vân zol iH dee-zes mêd-i-kâmênt ney-men?) (When should I take this medicine?) Here are a few other items you may be looking for in the pharmacy: ✓ Aspirin (âs-pi-reen) (aspirin) ✓ der (Heft-/Wund-)pflaster (dêr [hêft-/voont-]pflâs-ter) (band-aid) ✓ Hustenbonbons (hoohs-ten-bon-bonz) (cough drops) ✓ Hustensaft (hoohs-ten-zâft) (cough syrup) ✓ der Verband (dêr fêr-bânt) (bandage)

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe!

275

Talkin’ the Talk After Ulrich gets his diagnosis, he takes the prescription to his neighborhood pharmacy and talks to the pharmacist. Ulrich:

Guten Morgen. Mein Ärzt hat mir dieses Rezept gegeben. gooht-en mor-gen. Mayn ârtst hât meer deez-es rê-tsêpt ge-gey-ben. Good morning. My doctor has given me this prescription.

Apothekerin: Einen Moment. ayn-en moh-ment. Just a moment. The pharmacist fills Ulrich’s prescription and returns.

So, Herr Lempert. Bitte nehmen Sie dreimal am Tag zwei von diesen Tabletten. zoh, hêr lêm-pêrt. bi-te ney-men zee dray-mahl âm tahk tsavy fon deez-en tâ-blêt-en. Okay, Mr. Lempert. Please take two of these pills three times a day.

Ulrich: Vor oder nach dem Essen? fohr oh-der nahH deym ês-en? Before or after meals? Apothekerin: Nach dem Essen. nahH deym ês-en. After meals. Ulrich:

Wird gemacht. virt ge-mâHt. I’ll do that.

Apothekerin: Gute Besserung, Herr Lempert! gooh-te bês-er-oong, hêr lêm-pêrt! Hope you feel better, Mr. Lempert!

Book II Speaking German on the Go

276

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go

Handling Police Matters You’ve just discovered that your hotel room has been robbed. The thieves made off with a lot, but fortunately, they left German All-in-One For Dummies behind. Their loss, your gain! Here are some helpful expressions for handling the situation: Wo ist das nächste Polizeirevier? (voh ist dâs naiH-ste po-li-tsay-reveer?) (Where is the closest police station?) Ich möchte einen Diebstahl melden. (iH merH-te ayn-en deep-shtahl mêlden.) (I would like to report a theft.)

Describing what was stolen To describe a theft, you start out by saying Man hat mir . . . gestohlen. (mân hât meer . . . ge-shtohl-en.) (Someone has stolen. . . .) You can then finish the sentence by inserting any of the following: ✓ mein Auto (mayn ou-toh) (my car) ✓ meine Brieftasche/mein Portemonnaie (mayn-e breef-tâsh-e/mayn port-mon-ey) (my wallet) ✓ mein Geld (mayn gêlt) (my money) ✓ meinen Pass (mayn-en pâs) (my passport) ✓ meine Tasche/Handtasche (mayn-e tâsh-e/hânt-tâsh-e) (my bag/ handbag) If you want to express that someone has broken into your room or office, you use the verb einbrechen (ayn-brêH-en) (to break into): Man hat bei mir eingebrochen. (mân hât bay meer ayn-ge-broH-en.) (Someone has broken into [my room].) If you’re talking about your car, however, you use a similar but slightly different verb, aufbrechen (ouf-brêH-en), which literally means to break open: Man hat mein Auto aufgebrochen. (mân hât mayn ou-toh ouf-ge-broH-en.) (Someone has broken into my car.)

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe!

277

The indefinite pronoun man (mân), which means one, someone, or you (in the sense of people in general), comes in handy. It’s easy to use because it always has the same form and spelling — man. Consider these examples: Man hat seine Tasche gestohlen. (mân hât zayn-e tâsh-e ge-shtohl-en.) (Someone has stolen his bag.) Was macht man jetzt? (vâs mâHt mân yêtst?) (What does one do now?)

Giving a description of the thief So you got a good look at the thug. Was he or she tall or short, thin or fat, hairy or bald? The police will want to know everything. (As a bonus, after you know how to describe people, you’ll also be ready to peruse personal ads.) The police will ask Können Sie die Person beschreiben? (kern-en zee dee pêr-zohn beshrayb-en?) (Can you describe that person?) Your answer to this question can begin Die Person/Er/Sie hatte . . . (dee per-zohn/êr/zee hât-e . . .) (The person/ he/she had . . .) Then finish the sentence with any of the following. You can combine traits by saying und between them: ✓ blonde/schwarze/rote/graue/lange/kurze Haare (blon-de/shvârts-e/ roh-te/grou-e/lâng-e/koorts-e hahr-e) (blond/black/red/gray/long/short hair) ✓ einen Bart/einen Schnurrbart/keinen Bart (ayn-en bahrt/ayn-en shnoohr-bahrt/kayn-en bahrt) (a beard/a mustache/no beard) ✓ eine Glatze (ayn-e glâts-e) (a bald head) ✓ eine Brille (ayn-e bril-e) (glasses) Alternatively, your answer may begin with Die Person/Er/Sie war . . . (dee pêr-zohn/êr/zee vahr . . .) (The person/ he/she was . . .) You can then end with any of the following: ✓ groß/klein (grohs/klayn) (tall/short) ✓ schlank/dick (shlânk/dik) (thin/fat)

Book II Speaking German on the Go

278

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go ✓ ungefähr . . . Meter groß (oon-ge-fair . . . mey-ter grohs) (approximately . . . meters tall) ✓ ungefähr . . . Jahre alt (oon-ge-fair . . . yahr-e âlt) (approximately . . . years old) The police may also ask you the following questions: Was ist passiert? (vâs ist pâs-eert?) (What happened?) Wann ist das passiert? (vân ist dâs pâs-eert?) (When did it happen?) Wo waren Sie in dem Moment? (voh vahr-en zee in deym moh-mênt?) (Where were you at that moment?)

Getting legal help Had enough for the day? If you’re really not up to conversing with the law on your own, here are two very important phrases that you should know: Ich brauche einen Anwalt. (iH brouH-e ayn-en ân-vâlt.) (I need a lawyer.) Ich möchte das Konsulat anrufen. (iH merH-te dâs kon-zoo-laht ân-roohfen.) (I would like to call the consulate.)

Talkin’ the Talk Erika Berger has to drop off some documents at her client’s office. When she returns to her car half an hour later, she sees that somebody has broken into it and stolen her bag. Luckily, the nearest police station is right around the corner. Erika:

Guten Tag. Ich möchte einen Diebstahl melden. Man hat mein Auto aufgebrochen und meine Tasche gestohlen. gooht-en tahk. iH merH-te ayn-en deep-shtahl mêlden. mân hât mayn ou-toh ouf-ge-broH-en oont mayn-e tâsh-e ge-shtohl-en. Hello. I would like to report a theft. Someone has broken into my car and stolen my bag.

Polizist: Moment mal. Wie ist ihr Name? moh-mênt mâl. vee ist eer nah-me? One moment. What is your name?

Chapter 6: Handling Emergencies: Hilfe! Erika:

Erika Berger. êr-i-kâ bêr-ger. Erika Berger.

Polizist:

Wann ist das passiert? vân ist dâs pâs-eert? When did it happen?

Erika:

Zwischen elf und halb zwölf. tsvish-en êlf oont hâlp tsverlf. Between 11:00 and 11:30.

Polizist:

Und wo? oont voh? And where?

Erika:

Gleich um die Ecke, in der Rothmundstraße. glayH um dee êk-e, în dêr roht-moont-shtrah-se. Right around the corner, on Rothmundstraße.

Polizist:

Was war in Ihrer Tasche? vâs vahr in eer-er tâsh-e? What was in your bag?

Erika:

Meine Brieftasche mit ungefähr fünfzig Euro, meine Kreditkarten und mein Führerschein! mayn-e breef-tâsh-e mit oon-ge-fair fuenf-tsiH oy-roh, mayn-e krê-deet-kârt-en oont mayn fuer-er-shayn! My wallet with approximately 50 euros in it, my credit cards, and my driver’s license!

Polizist:

Nun, ich habe noch einige Fragen. Wir erstatten dann Anzeige. noon, iH hah-be noH ayn-ee-ge frah-gen. veer êrshtât-en dân ân-tsayg-e. Now I have some more questions. Then we’ll file a report.

279

Book II Speaking German on the Go

280

Bool II: Speaking German on the Go

Book III

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication German Words That Mean The Case

Masculine

Feminine

Neuter

Plural

Nominative (subjects, predicate nouns)

der

die

das

die

Accusative (direct objects)

den

die

das

die

Dative (indirect objects)

dem

der

dem

den

Genitive (owned objects)

des

der

des

der

You’re bound to have questions or need to ask someone for help during your time in Germany. To ensure you phrase your inquiries politely, check out the free article about asking questions in different situations at www.dummies.com/extras/ germanaio.

Contents at a Glance Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences............................. 283 Identifying the Parts of Speech.....................284 Understanding Grammar Terms....................292 Understanding Word Order............................295 Checking Out the Tenses: Present, Past, and Future.................................................298 Finding Meaning through Context.................302 Using a Bilingual Dictionary...........................303

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case................................ 307 Classifying Nouns and Pronouns with Gender...................................................308 Pinning Down Plurals......................................311 Mastering the Art of Articles..........................315 Calling All Cases: The Roles Nouns and Pronouns Play.......................................317 Putting Pronouns in Place..............................322 Discovering Dative Verbs...............................327 Considering How Case Affects Adjectives......................................................328

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense........... 331 Grasping the Specifics of Subject Pronouns.......................................................332 Getting Your Verbs in Shape..........................336 Using the Very Versatile Present Tense......346 Stating Information with the Passive............348

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions ............................................ 353 Knowing How to Formulate Questions.........353 Answering with Yes.........................................361 Responding with No: The Difference between Kein and Nicht.............................364 Asking and Answering Questions with Wo- and Da- Compound Words................370 Sounding Diplomatic: Using Maybe, Suggesting, and Refusing Politely............376

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs........... 379 Organizing Adjectives: Opposites, Cognates, and Collocations.......................380 Helping Adjectives Meet a Satisfying End....385

Understanding Types of Adverbs..................391 Putting Adverbs and Adverbial Expressions in Their Proper Place............395 Comparing with Regular Adjectives and Adverbs: Fast, Faster, Fastest....................397 Using Irregular Comparison Forms...............403 Comparing Equals and Nonequals................404 Identifying Unique Adjective and AdverbGroups..............................................406

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries...... 411 Grasping the Basics of Modal Verbs............412 May I? Dürfen, the Permission Verb.............414 You Can Do It! Können, the Ability Verb.......416 I Like That: Mögen, the Likeable Verb..........419 What Would You Like? Möchten, the Preference Verb...........................................421 Do I Have To? Müssen, the Verb of Necessity..................................................423 Should I or Shouldn’t I? Sollen, the Duty Verb................................................425 I Want to Be Famous: Wollen, the Intention Verb........................................426

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood............................ 429 Getting into the Imperative Mood..................430 Grasping Formal Commands..........................434 Giving Informal Directives..............................440 Giving Directives Politely and Making Suggestions..................................................441

Chapter 8: Sorting Out SeparableandInseparable-Prefix Verbs.......... 445 Looking at the Prefix........................................445 Parting Ways: Simplifying Separable-Prefix Verbs..............................................................446 Together Forever: Investigating Inseparable-Prefix Verbs............................453 Double-Crossers: Dealing with Dual-Prefix Verbs.........................................458

Chapter 1

Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences In This Chapter ▶ Identifying the parts of speech ▶ Combining words to create sentences ▶ Talking in terms of the past, present, and future ▶ Understanding how to use context and a bilingual dictionary to find meaning

W

hen you think about grammar, imagine a big dresser with lots of drawers. Instead of being filled with all kinds of clothing, these drawers contain different types of words, called parts of speech — nouns, verbs, adjectives, adverbs, and so on. Each part of speech is in a separate drawer. Now imagine it’s early morning and you’re about to utter your first German sentence of the day. To begin, you reach into the noun drawer and pull out the word Socken (socks). Next, to describe your socks, you reach into the adjective drawer and pull out two words, neu (new) and schwarz (black). To indicate what you do with your new black socks, you fish through the verb drawer and pull out the verb anziehen (to put on). And because you’re running late, you dive straight into the adverb drawer and grab the word schnell (quickly). Now, to construct a whole sentence, you need another item, this one from the pronoun drawer: ich (I). Before you know it, you’ve pulled a complete sentence out of the dresser: Ich ziehe schnell meine neuen schwarzen Socken an. (I am quickly putting on my new black socks.) To construct a correct sentence, you need to know how to string all these words together, and that’s what grammar is all about. This chapter makes using grammar as easy as getting dressed in the morning. With a few basic rules in your back pocket, you’ll be using grammar with confidence in no time. So arrange your thoughts, grab the words you need, and before you know it, you’ll be out the door and speaking auf Deutsch (in German).

284

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Identifying the Parts of Speech To build a sentence, you need to figure out what you want to say, identify the parts of speech you need to express your ideas, and then decide which words to use and how to put them together. Table 1-1 lists the most essential parts of speech used in German sentences: nouns, pronouns, articles, verbs, adjectives, adverbs, conjunctions, and prepositions. The sections that follow the table give you the lowdown on each one.

Table 1-1

Parts of Speech

Name

Definition

Examples

Notes

Noun

A person, place, animal, thing, quality, concept, and so on

Dracula

In German, they’re always capitalized. (See Book III, Chapter 2.)

Hotel California Känguruh (kangaroo) Liebe (love)

Pronoun

Article

Verb

A word that replaces or stands for a noun

er (he)

A word that indicates the gender of a noun

der/die/das (the)

A word that shows action or a state of being

denken (to think)

sie (she) uns (us)

ein/eine/ein (a/an)

haben (to have) reisen (to travel)

German has far more pronoun variations than English; the four cases influence pronouns. (See Book III, Chapter 2.) German has three genders, so it uses three different articles for the. (See Book III, Chapter 2.) Verbs are conjugated according to person (I, you, he, and so on), tense (present, past, and future), and mood (for example, the difference between it is and it would be). (See Book III, Chapter 3 for details on present tense.)

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences Name

Definition

Examples

Notes

Adjective

A word that modifies or describes a noun or a pronoun

schön (beautiful)

Adjectives may or may not have case endings. (See Book III, Chapter 5.)

A word that modifies or describes a verb, an adjective, or another adverb

schnell (fast, quickly)

A word that connects other words or sentence parts together

und (and)

A word that shows a relationship between its object (a noun or pronoun) and another word in a sentence

mit (mir) (with [me])

Adverb

Conjunction

Preposition

praktisch (practical)

285

interessant (interesting)

sehr (very)

In German, adjectives and adverbs can be the same word. (See Book III, Chapter 5.)

schrecklich (terribly)

aber (but) weil (because)

ohne (mich) (without [me]) während (des Tages) (during [the day])

In German, some conjunctions affect the word order of the sentence. (See Book IV, Chapter 1.) In German, a preposition uses case (dative, accusative, or genitive) to show the relationship to its object. (See Book IV, Chapter 2.)

Nouns A rose is a rose is a rose, right? Well, a rose is also a noun, and nouns aren’t exactly the same in German and English. Although nouns in both languages name things (people, places, objects, concepts, and so on), the difference is that all German nouns are capitalized and have one of three genders: masculine, feminine, or neuter. The following sections go into more detail on gender and explain how to make singular German nouns plural.

Understanding a noun’s gender All German nouns have gender. That is, they are one of the following: ­masculine, feminine, or neuter. Unfortunately, the meaning of a noun isn’t

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

286

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication usually much help in predicting its grammatical gender. After all, in German, ­grammatical gender is an element of German grammar and isn’t related to the meaning of the noun. Instead, it’s a kind of marker that identifies how the noun fits into a sentence. So you simply have to memorize the gender that belongs with each noun. Fortunately, a few guidelines can get you started: ✓ Nouns for male persons, car makes, nationalities, occupations, seasons, days, and months are usually masculine. ✓ Nouns for most female persons, many flowers, and trees are feminine. ✓ Nouns beginning with Ge- are usually neuter. ✓ All verbs used as nouns, such as das Schwimmen (swimming) are neuter. ✓ Nouns ending in -ist, -ich, -ismus, and -ner are usually masculine. ✓ Nouns ending in -heit, -keit, -ik, -schaft, -ei, -ie, -tät, and -ung are feminine. ✓ Nouns ending in -chen, -lein, -ium, -um, and -tum are usually neuter. Knowing a noun’s gender becomes even more important when the noun is plopped into a sentence. How’s that? Well, depending on the role the noun plays in the sentence, the three definite articles der, die, and das, all of which translate to the English the, can go through all kinds of spelling gyrations, and sometimes even the noun’s spelling is altered. The same goes for the indefinite articles ein, eine, and ein, which correspond to the English a and an. The key to all this morphing is what’s known as case. Later in this chapter, we shed more light on how to put German nouns and articles into sentences. (For detailed information on gender, go to Book III, Chapter 2.)

Making singular nouns plural German has several ways to change a singular noun to its plural form. Fortunately, two groups of words are easy to deal with: ✓ Nouns that are the same in both the singular and plural forms, like the English noun sheep: Many of the nouns in this group are masculine- and neuter-gender words ending in -er, like das Fenster/die Fenster (window/windows) and der Amerikaner/die Amerikaner (American/ Americans). ✓ Nouns that are mostly of foreign origin: The plural form of these nouns has an -s ending, for example das Radio/die Radios (radio/radios) and das Café/die Cafés (café/cafés). Other plural form patterns include nouns that add -e, -er, or –en; nouns that add an umlaut (represented by two dots over a vowel, as in ä, ö, and ü); or nouns that do a combination of both. Following are three examples:

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

287

derVater/die Väter (father/fathers), die Lampe/die Lampen (lamp/lamps), and das Buch/die Bücher (book/books). Sound complicated? You’re right, so try to make a point of remembering the plural form of a noun (and its gender!) when you first incorporate it into your active vocabulary.

Pronouns Pronouns are the handy group of words that can stand in for nouns so you don’t have to sound redundant. They’re extremely versatile because they turn up in so many places, so you need to be able to recognize them and know how to use them. Figuring out which German pronoun to use takes some practice. To begin with, realize that both English and German pronouns have cases, which help show how a word functions in a sentence. (For more information on pronouns and their cases, go to Book III, Chapter 2.) The following list gives you a quick overview of the types of pronouns in both English and German: ✓ Personal pronouns include ich, mich, mir (I, me, me), and others. These pronouns replace the word for a person, animal, object, idea, and so on. Ich liebe dich (I love you) has two personal pronouns: ich and dich. (Go to Book III, Chapter 2 for details on using personal pronouns.) ✓ Demonstrative pronouns, such as der, das, and den (he/it, it, him/it; also this and that), point to and identify the noun or pronoun that they replace. For example, when you’re in an ice cream store, you point to the flavor you want as you say: Das möchte ich. (That’s the one I want.) (Find out more about demonstrative pronouns in Book III, Chapter 2.) ✓ Interrogative pronouns, also called question words in this book, include wer (who), was (what), and other words that you use for asking questions. For example, Was machen Sie? (What are you doing?) (For more information on forming questions, turn to Book III, Chapter 4.) ✓ Relative pronouns help you include more information about a noun or pronoun that has been expressed beforehand in a sentence. Examples of relative pronouns are who, that, and which. In the following sentence, the relative pronoun is den (whom): Das ist der Mann, den ich heiraten möchte. (That is the man [whom] I would like to marry.) In English, you don’t need to use the relative pronoun whom to connect the two parts of the sentence, but in German you do. (See Book IV, Chapter 1 for details on how to use the German relative pronouns.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

288

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication ✓ Possessive pronouns, such as mein, sein, and ihr (my, his, and her), describe who owns or is in possession of a particular person or object. These words are actually considered adjectives, and they change form just as adjectives do — according to the gender and case they have. For example, in the question Wo ist mein Handy? (Where is my cellphone?), mein is the possessive for the word Handy. (For information on how to use possessives and adjectives, check out Book III, Chapter 5.) ✓ Reflexive pronouns refer to the subject of a clause or sentence and include yourself and myself. The following sentence has the reflexive pronoun mir (myself): Ich kaufe mir ein neues Auto. (I’m buying [myself] a new car.) Some German verbs require a reflexive pronoun. (You find information on reflexive pronouns in Book IV, Chapter 3.)

Articles Nouns often appear in the company of a sidekick: a definite article (der, die, and das, which correspond to the English the) or an indefinite article (ein, eine, and ein, which correspond to a or an).

The definite articles (“der,” “die,” and “das”) While the definite article the has only one form in English, in German, it has three forms: der (masculine), die (feminine), and das (neuter). Which form you use depends on the gender of the German noun. Der is the definite article used with masculine nouns, die is used with feminine nouns, and das is used with neuter nouns.

When you meet a new noun, find out whether its definite article is der, die, or das — in other words, determine the gender of the noun. For example, memorize der Garten (the garden) rather than just Garten (garden), die Tür (the door) rather than Tür (door), and das Haus (the house) rather than Haus (house). For plural nouns, things are comparatively easy. The definite article for all plural nouns, regardless of gender, is die. As in English, the indefinite article a just vanishes in the plural: a garden becomes gardens. (The next section explains indefinite articles in more detail.)

The indefinite articles (“ein,” “eine,” and “ein”) In English, you use the indefinite article a or an when you want to specify one of a particular thing. Because German has three different genders, you have to use three different indefinite articles. Luckily, the indefinite article for masculine and neuter nouns is the same:

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

289

✓ For masculine nouns: Use ein — for example, ein Name (a name), ein Mann (a man), and ein Berg (a mountain). ✓ For neuter nouns: Use ein — for example, ein Problem (a problem), ein Museum (a museum), and ein Bier (a beer). ✓ For feminine nouns: Add an e to ein, making eine — for example, eine Nacht (a night), eine Adresse (an address), and eine Cousine (a female cousin). Not too difficult, right? Unfortunately, things can get a little more complicated. You know that the gender of a noun determines the articles you use with it. But the endings of the articles also change depending on whether the noun they’re attached to is in the nominative, genitive, dative, or accusative case. The endings specified in the preceding list are those of the nominative case. (For more information about case and the effect it has on both definite and indefinite articles, head to Book III, Chapter 2.)

Adjectives Adjectives describe nouns. In German, adjectives have different endings depending on the gender, case, and number (singular or plural) of the noun they accompany. Adjective endings also depend on whether the adjective is accompanied by a definite article, an indefinite article, or no article at all. The following list shows the endings for adjectives accompanied by a definite article in the nominative case. (For more on case, see Book III, Chapter 2.) This list includes the adjectives schön (beautiful), weiß (white), groß (large), and klein (small). The adjective endings appear in italics. ✓ der schöne Garten (the beautiful garden) ✓ die weiße Tür (the white door) ✓ das kleine Haus (the small house) ✓ die großen Häuser (the large houses) Following are the nominative case endings for adjectives used alone (that is, without an accompanying article) or adjectives accompanied by an indefinite article: ✓ (ein) schöner Garten ([a] beautiful garden) ✓ (eine) weiße Tür ([a] white door) ✓ (ein) kleines Haus ([a] small house) ✓ große Häuser (large houses)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

290

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication All the adjectives (and their corresponding endings) in the preceding examples are in the subject case (that is, the nominative case). (For more information on adjectives, go to Book III, Chapter 5.)

Verbs Verbs express actions or states of being. The person doing the action is the verb’s subject, and in both English and German, the verb always adjusts its ending for the subject. For example, you say I open the door and the cat opens the door. In the present tense in English, most verbs have two different forms, or spellings — for example, open and opens. Most German verbs, on the other hand, have four different forms. For example, the following table shows the endings (or forms) of the verb sagen (to say) in the present tense. You simply tack the appropriate ending onto the stem sag-, depending on how you’re expressing the verb. (For more on conjugating verbs and dealing with tenses, check out Chapters 3, 7, and 8 in Book III and Chapters 4 through 7 in Book IV. Also refer to the later section “Conjugating verbs and understanding tenses.”) sagen (to say) ich sage

wir sagen

du sagst

ihr sagt

er/sie/es sagt

sie sagen Sie sagen

Er sagt, dass er aus Deutschland kommt. (He says that he’s from Germany.) Seems easy enough, right? But — as usual — some exceptions to the rule exist. When the stem of the verb ends in -m, -n, -d, or -t, you need to insert an e before the ending in the du, er/sie/es, and ihr constructions, as shown in the following examples: du atm-e-st (you [singular, informal] breathe) er arbeit-e-t (he works) ihr bad-e-t (you [plural, informal] bathe) Why the added e? Try to pronounce “atmst” and you’ll know.

Adverbs Adverbs accompany verbs or adjectives in order to describe them. In English, most adverbs end with -ly (as in: I quickly put on my new black

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

291

socks). In German, adverbs are generally spelled the same as their adjective counterparts in their barebones form, without special endings. Take, for example, vorsichtig (careful/carefully), which has the same spelling for both its adjective and its adverb meaning. When you use vorsichtig in a sentence as an adverb, it keeps the same spelling — for example, Fahren Sie vorsichtig! (Drive carefully!) However, when you use vorsichtig in a sentence as an adjective, it changes its form (spelling) the way all German adjectives do; see the previous section about adjectives. The following sentence shows how vorsichtig, when used as an adjective, changes its spelling according to the noun it describes: Sie ist eine vorsichtige Fahrerin. (She’s a careful driver.) To find out more about using adverbs, go to Book III, Chapter 5.

Conjunctions Conjunctions serve the purpose of linking words and parts of sentences together. You can divide conjunctions into two groups: coordinating conjunctions and subordinating conjunctions. Three commonly used coordinating conjunctions are und (and), aber (but), and oder (or). Of the two types of conjunctions, the coordinating type are easier to use. The following example uses oder to link words: Möchten Sie Kaffee oder Tee? (Would you like coffee or tea?) Subordinating conjunctions include words like falls (in case), weil (because), dass (that), and wenn (if/when). With German subordinating conjunctions, you have to use a comma to separate the two parts of the sentence being connected by the conjunction, and you need to know what word order to use. (For details on word order with conjunctions, go to Book IV, Chapter 1.) Look at the following examples: Wir möchten, dass Sie am Samstag zu unserem Fest kommen. (We’d like you to come to our party on Saturday. Literally: We would like that you come to our party on Saturday.) Ich kann leider nicht, weil ich schon Pläne habe. (Unfortunately, I can’t because I already have plans.) For more information on using conjunctions, turn to Book IV, Chapter 1.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

292

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Prepositions Prepositions show the relationship of a noun or a pronoun to some other word or words in the sentence. Some examples of prepositions are mit (with), durch (through/by), and über (above/over). In most instances, you place the preposition right before the word or words that it modifies. The preposition determines the case — accusative, dative, or genitive — that the modified word or words following it will have. Some prepositions can use either the accusative case or the dative case depending on the meaning. Here are a couple of examples with the prepositions mit and durch: Ich fahre oft mit dem Zug. (I often take the train.) The more literal translation is I often travel with the train. Mit is a dative preposition, so dem Zug is in the dative case. Der Zug fährt durch den Tunnel. (The train is going through the tunnel.) Durch is an accusative preposition, so den Tunnel is in the accusative case. Head to Book IV, Chapter 2 for more information on how to use German prepositions and Book III, Chapter 2 for more details on case.

Understanding Grammar Terms Before you can start building sentences in German, you need to be able to keep track of the many grammatical terms you encounter. This section clears up any fuzzy ideas you may have about the names for tools of German grammar, such as conjugation, gender, case, and tense.

Conjugating verbs and understanding tenses The verb form in its basic, static state is called the infinitive. It’s the form you see in dictionary entries, as in wohnen (to live). In English, the to indicates that the word is in infinitive form; the German equivalent is the -en ending on the verb, although a small number of verbs, including tun (to do), have the infinitive ending -n. When you conjugate a verb, you change the verb form so it fits in your sentence to convey information such as which subject is doing the action and when something is happening. Conjugation involves breaking the verb

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

293

into its usable parts. Look at the conjugation of the verb to work: I work, you work, he/she/it works, we work, you work, they work. English has only two different spellings of work (with and without s). The same conjugation in German — ich arbeite, du arbeitest, er/sie/es arbeitet, wir arbeiten, ihr arbeitet, sie arbeiten, Sie arbeiten — reveals four different verb endings: -e, -est, -et, and -en. Verbs are conjugated in different tenses, which describe time. The three main descriptions of time are past, present, and future. Here’s a brief look at the most frequently used tenses, with the relevant verbs underlined: ✓ Present tense: This tense describes actions that are happening now, habitual actions, or general facts. Look at the following sentence, which uses the verb wohnen (to live) in the present tense: Ich wohne in den U.S.A. You can translate it as I live in the U.S.A. or I’m living in the U.S.A. (See Book III, Chapter 3 for details on the present tense.) ✓ Present perfect (conversational past): In German, the present perfect describes something that happened in the past, whether finished or unfinished. It’s used in conversational German. Ich habe in den U.S.A. gewohnt can mean I have lived in the U.S.A. or I lived in the U.S.A. (For more on the present perfect, go to Book IV, Chapter 4.) ✓ Simple past: The simple past is used in formal language to describe past actions. Ich wohnte in den U.S.A. means I lived in the U.S.A. (Find out more about the simple past in Book IV, Chapter 5.) ✓ Future: The future describes events that haven’t yet occurred. Ich werde in den U.S.A. wohnen means I will live in the U.S.A. or I’m going to live in the U.S.A. German makes much less use of the future tense than English, often opting for the simple present instead. (Check out Book IV, Chapter 6 for more info on the future.) English uses continuous (progressive) tenses — verbs with a form of to be and -ing, as in am living or have been living — to describe a temporary or ongoing action. But because German has no continuous forms, you can simply use the basic German tenses you see in the preceding list for the continuous form in English. German also uses other tenses slightly differently from English. (For more on these differences, go to Book IV, Chapters 4 and 6.) The subjunctive is not a tense but rather a mood, something that indicates how you describe an action — for example, as a fact, a possibility, or an uncertainty. But as with tenses, the subjunctive gets its own conjugation. (Go to Book IV, Chapter 7 for more on the subjunctive.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

294

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Familiarizing yourself with gender, number, and case The trio of gender, number, and case are closely linked to each other to help you make sense of single words and to connect them into sentences. You need to know how to use gender, number, and case to express your ideas in understandable language. Check out the following explanations (turn to Book III, Chapter 2 for more on any of these topics): ✓ Gender: People are one of two genders, masculine or feminine, right? Dogs and cats are, too. But do stones and water have a gender? In German, yes indeed! Every noun has a gender; der (masculine), die (feminine), and das (neuter) are the options. All three are the gender-specific versions of the English word the. (If this were a soccer game, the German team would’ve already won by a margin of two.) When looking at German words, don’t confuse grammatical gender with the word’s meaning. Gender has to do with the word itself, not the meaning of the word. ✓ Number: Number refers to singular and plural, like one potato, two potatoes, three potatoes. German plurals are more intricate than English plurals. In fact, German offers five major different types of plural endings. Some plurals compare with the irregular English plurals, like man and men (der Mann and die Männer).

✓ Case: German has four cases: nominative, accusative, dative, and genitive. But what does that actually mean? Cases help tell you what role the word plays in the sentence. They have to do with the difference between I and me or she and her, and they deal with the significance of the to in give it to me or the apostrophe s in dog’s Frisbee.

German case endings are numerous, and they show the relationship between the words having those cases. English uses case far less often.

Grammar terms that describe words, parts of words, and word groupings Grammatically speaking, you need to know several terms that describe words that you put together to convey meaning — sentence, clause, phrase, and so on. The following list shows the most important key words you see in this book: ✓ Phrase: A group of words without a subject or a verb; most often used to describe a prepositional phrase, such as ohne Zweifel (without a doubt).

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

295

✓ Clause: A group of related words that has a subject and a verb, such as wir arbeiten . . . (we’re working . . .). ✓ Sentence: A group of words that represents a complete thought and has a complete sentence structure — subject, verb, and punctuation — such as Gehen wir! (Let’s go!) ✓ Prefix: A “word beginning” attached to the front of a word that alters the word’s meaning, such as un (un-) + freundlich (friendly) = unfreundlich (unfriendly) or aus (out) + gehen (to go) = ausgehen (to go out).

✓ Suffix: A “word ending” attached to the back of a word that alters the word’s meaning, such as (der) Kapital + ismus = Kapitalismus (capital + ism = capitalism). Another example is the diminutive suffix -chen, which conveys the meaning of a smaller version of the original word, such as (das) Haus (house) + -chen = Häuschen (small house, cottage, booth). To form the diminutive -chen, you also need to add an umlaut over the letter a, as in ä.

✓ Cognates: Words that have the same meaning and the same (or nearly the same) spelling in two languages, such as der Hammer (the hammer) or die Melodie (the melody). Note: Technically, cognates are simply two words that come from a common ancestor.

Understanding Word Order Nouns, verbs, adjectives, and other parts of speech aren’t just thrown together helter-skelter to make a sentence. Instead, to create a logical sentence, you arrange words in a specific order. In some respects, German word order is more flexible than English word order because case plays a key role in clarifying the meaning of a sentence, something that’s not nearly as powerful of a tool in English. When positioning words in a German sentence, however, you need to keep in mind a few major points. The following sections give you the skinny on word order.

Arranging words in the right order Standard word order in German is much like English word order. The subject comes first, then the verb, followed by the rest of the sentence. Look at the following example sentence: Subject Meine Freundin My girlfriend

Verb hat has

Object einen Hund. a dog.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

296

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Putting the verb in second place One of the most important things to remember is the place of the verb in a German sentence. In freestanding, main clauses (known as independent clauses), like the one in the preceding section, a one-word verb is always in second place, no matter what. The term second place, however, doesn’t necessarily mean the second word in the sentence. Rather, it refers to the second placeholder, which may be comprised of more than one word. For example, meine Freundin, the subject of the earlier sentence, consists of two words, but it’s the first placeholder. In the following examples, the verb is fahren (to drive), and it follows the second place rule: Meine Freundin fährt nach Dänemark. (My girlfriend is driving to Denmark.) How about adding some more information? Meine Freundin fährt morgen nach Dänemark. (My girlfriend is driving to Denmark tomorrow.) Standard practice in German sentences is to place the reference to time, morgen (tomorrow), before the reference to place, nach Dänemark (to Denmark), as you can see in the previous sentence. What happens if you start the sentence with morgen? Morgen fährt meine Freundin nach Dänemark. (Tomorrow my girlfriend is driving to Denmark.) Morgen is in first place, and because the verb has to be in second place, the subject follows the verb. Technically, this arrangement is called inversion of the verb. All it means is that the verb and the subject switch places. Inversion of the verb occurs whenever anything other than the subject occupies first place in a sentence. Having said that, what about the statement Meine Freundin hat einen Hund? Can you give that one a twirl and change the word order? Absolutely, as long as the verb stays in second place, like this: Einen Hund hat meine Freundin. But why would you want to rearrange word order? Generally, you do so to shift emphasis in the meaning. For example, you may hear something along the lines of the following conversation: Hat deine Schwester einen Hund? (Does your sister have a dog?) Nein, sie hat eine Katze. Einen Hund hat meine Freundin Heike. (No, she has a cat. It’s my girlfriend Heike who has a dog.)

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

297

Don’t German speakers get all confused playing around with word order like that? That’s where the (in)famous German case system comes into play. Adjectives and articles that appear alongside nouns and, in some instances, the nouns themselves, assume different endings depending on their function in a sentence. So no matter where a noun appears in a German sentence, you can figure out its role by checking the ending of the article, the noun itself, and/or the adjective. (See Book III, Chapter 2 for more on case.)

Pushing the verb to the end The examples used so far in this section have all been independent, standalone sentences, but sometimes several thoughts combine to form a more complex structure: Wir gehen nicht einkaufen, weil wir kein Geld haben. (We’re not going shopping because we have no money.) The verb gehen (go) is in second place as you would expect, but the verb in the second part of the sentence, the part that begins with weil (because), gets kicked to the end. This arrangement of the verb happens in dependent clauses. Dependent clauses typically start with subordinating conjunctions (words that link sentences) like dass (that), weil (because), damit (so that), obwohl (although), bevor (before), and wenn (when), and they always end with the verb. (Turn to Book IV, Chapter 1 for the lowdown on conjunctions.)

Forming questions The German word order for asking yes or no questions is straightforward. You begin with a verb, and the subject follows, as in these examples: Tanzen Sie gern? (Do you like to dance?) Spricht er Spanisch? (Does he speak Spanish?) Note that you don’t have the verb do in German when forming questions. Another way to elicit information is to form a question by using a question word like wer (who), was (what), wo (where), wann (when), wie (how), or warum (why). You can also form a question with words and phrases like was für ein/e/en. . . ? (what kind of. . . ?) or welche/r/s. . . ? (which. . . ?).

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

298

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication When forming questions with these words, the verb goes in its usual place — second: Was für ein Fahrrad kauft Helmut? (What kind of bicycle is Helmut buying?) Wer kauft ein Rennrad? (Who’s buying a racing bicycle?) Wo kauft er das Rad? (Where’s he buying the bike?) Warum kauft er ein Rennrad? (Why’s he buying a racing bicycle?) (For more details on using question words and forming questions, go to Book III, Chapter 4.)

Checking Out the Tenses: Present, Past, and Future In grammar, the word tense is what the layperson calls “time.” You pick the appropriate tense to describe when the action you’re talking about takes place. The ways to look at the concept of time differ slightly from one culture and language to the next, so the way tenses are used sometimes differs, too.

Looking at the present The present tense is an incredibly useful tense in German. You can go a long way using just this one tense. The German present tense corresponds to three forms in English. For example, ich denke can mean the equivalent of I think, I do think, or I am thinking in English. And it gets even better: Depending on the context, the German present tense can correspond to the past or future tense in English. The present tense can describe what’s happening now: Was machst du gerade? (What are you doing right now?) Ich lese die Zeitung. (I’m reading the newspaper.) Additionally, the present tense can describe what sometimes, usually, always, or never happens: Freitags gehe ich oft ins Kino. (I often go to the movies on Fridays.)

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

299

The German present tense can also describe what’s going to happen: Wir fliegen im Dezember nach Portugal. (We’re flying to Portugal in December.) Nächste Woche fahre ich nach Bremen. (Next week I’m going to drive to Bremen.) Using the present tense is a very common way of talking about future events in German, particularly if the sentence includes a time expression that anchors the action clearly in the future — for example, im Dezember (in December) or nächste Woche (next week). Finally, Germans use the present tense to describe what’s been happening up until now: Ich lebe seit zehn Jahren in derselben Wohnung. (I’ve been living in the same apartment for ten years.) Wie lange lernst du schon Deutsch? (How long have you been learning German?) Note that English uses the present perfect tense to express the same thing. Book III

Talking about the past The perfect tense — as in wir haben gegessen (we have eaten) or Jan hat gearbeitet (Jan has worked) — is the main tense used to describe past events in spoken German. It’s very versatile: You can use it to talk about most actions and situations in the past. Contrast this with the use of the English perfect tense (I have gone, I have eaten, and so on), which you can use only in specific contexts. For example, Ich habe Anna letzte Woche gesehen (I have seen Anna last week) is grammatically correct in German, even though it doesn’t quite work in English. In the preceding sentence, the verb has two parts, habe and gesehen. These two parts are described in grammatical terms as the conjugated verb (habe in this example) and the past participle (here, gesehen). German word order for using verbs that have two or more parts follows specific rules. When forming a sentence with multiple verb parts, the conjugated verb takes second position in the sentence, and the other part(s) of the verb — in this instance, the past participle — goes all the way at the end of the sentence. This rule holds true for all verbs that have two or more parts.

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

300

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Most verbs form the perfect tense by combining the conjugated form of the verb haben (have) and the past participle form of the verb. The following examples follow the German word order rule, meaning that the conjugated form of the verb haben is in second position in the sentence, and the past participle of the verb that’s being expressed is kicked to the end of the sentence: Luka hat mir geholfen. (Luka [has] helped me.) Gestern haben wir ein neues Auto gekauft. (Yesterday we bought a new car.) Hast du die Zeitung schon gelesen? (Have you read the newspaper yet?) Ich habe den Film vor einer Woche gesehen. (I saw the film a week ago.) Certain verbs require sein (to be) in combination with the past participle instead of haben (to have) to form the perfect tense. These verbs often describe a change of location, state, or condition. Here are a few examples: Gestern bin ich ins Kino gegangen. (I went to the movies yesterday.) Ich bin in Hamburg gewesen. (I’ve been to Hamburg./I was in Hamburg.) Bist du mit dem Auto gekommen? (Did you come by car?) Sie ist nicht mit dem Zug gefahren. (She didn’t take the train.) German verbs fall into two categories: weak and strong verbs. Regular verbs, known as weak verbs, make up the largest group of German verbs. The next two sections discuss how to form past participles of weak and strong verbs in German.

Forming the past participle of a weak verb The past participle form of a weak verb begins with the past participle marker ge- like this: ge + verb stem (the infinitive minus -en) + (e)t = past participle For example, for the verb fragen (to ask), the formula looks like this: ge + frag + t = gefragt Some exceptions to this formula do exist. When the stem of the verb ends in -m, -n, -d, or -t, you need to insert an -e after the stem and before adding the -t, for example with the verbs arbeiten (to work) and atmen (to breathe) like this: ge + arbeit + e + t = gearbeitet ge + atm + e + t = geatmet

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

301

Forming the past participle of a strong verb Here’s the formula for constructing the past participle of a strong (irregular) verb: ge + verb stem (the infinitive minus -en) + en = past participle For the verb kommen (to come), the past participle is ge + komm + en = gekommen See Book IV, Chapter 4 for more information on the perfect tense.

Writing about the past The simple past verb tense is very frequently used in English. Imagine you’re sitting at the dinner table, telling about your day; you’re bound to use the simple past tense. For example, in the following story, the simple past tense verbs are underlined: There was a huge traffic jam, so I got to work late. My coworkers looked at me skeptically when I rolled out my usual excuse. Then I spilled coffee on my keyboard. The day seemed to get progressively worse after that. The simple past tense is used all the time in printed German, such as newspapers or books, but it’s much less common in spoken German, like the dinner table story in the previous paragraph. One exception is the simple past tense of sein (to be), which is often preferable to the perfect tense in both speech and writing. The following table shows you the various forms of the simple past tense of the verb sein. (For more information on the simple past tense, check out Book IV, Chapter 5.) sein (to be) ich war

wir waren

du warst

ihr wart

er/sie/es war

sie waren Sie waren

Ich war heute Nachmittag nicht zu Hause. (I wasn’t home this afternoon.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

302

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Talking about the future The future tense isn’t used as frequently in German as it is in English. In many situations, you can use the present tense instead. The way to form the future tense in German is pretty similar to English: You conjugate the verb werden (will/to become) and add an infinitive. The following table shows you the forms of the verb werden in the present tense. werden (will/to become) ich werde

wir werden

du wirst

ihr werdet

er/sie/es wird

sie werden Sie werden

Wir werden im Herbst einen langen Urlaub machen. (This fall we’re going to take a long vacation.) To incorporate the future tense of verbs into sentences, you follow the standard German word order for using verbs that have two parts: The conjugated verb, in this case, werden, takes second position in the sentence. The other verb part, which, for the future tense, is the infinitive of the verb, goes all the way at the end of the sentence, as the following examples show: Ich werde viel Geld verdienen. (I’m going to/I’ll earn a lot of money.) Wir werden morgen skifahren. (We’ll go/We’re going skiing tomorrow.) Es wird regnen. (It’s going to rain.) (Go to Book IV, Chapter 6 for more info on the future tense.)

Finding Meaning through Context One essential tool for making sense of a foreign language is to consciously look for meaning through the context of the words. You probably do the same thing in your own language. Imagine you’re reading a text that’s not in your field of expertise. You instinctively look at any headings, scan the text rapidly, and get clues from any illustrations, charts, or tables. When you’re looking at a text in German, you can figure out what it means by employing the same techniques you already use in your native language.

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

303

To understand what a whole sentence means, see how the words fit together. Identify the verb or verbs and a noun or pronoun, and you have the meat of your sentence. Then check out how the other words are related to the subject and verb — for example, look for a prepositional phrase or a conjunction. (See the earlier section for details on the parts of speech.) In short, use all the tools at your disposal to understand German sentences. Before you start memorizing new words, you want to make sure you know how to use them. So after you figure out the meaning of a new word or expression by looking at it in its context, you may want to write it down. Putting words together in a phrase or a sentence — that is, in the context where you first discovered the word(s) — is a great way to improve your brain’s ability to remember new words and their meanings.

Unfortunately, you don’t retain vocabulary, grammar, or what-have-you the first time you’re exposed to it — or the second or third time. So use a system of recording important information that works well for you: Try making flashcards (color code the nouns according to gender — blue cards for masculine, pink for feminine, green for neuter), creating an alphabetical word list, writing new expressions in meaningful sentences, and incorporating new grammar points into a short dialogue.

Using a Bilingual Dictionary Horses are only as good for riding as their training is. And dictionaries are only as useful for finding words as their owners’ knowledge of how to use them. Except for the terms breaking in a horse and breaking in a book, that’s about it for parallels (unless, of course, you want to speak German to your horse). A bilingual dictionary can be a challenge to use at first. Take on the challenge by reading the information at the front of the dictionary on how to use it. The symbols and abbreviations are your key to successfully scouting for the right word. This section helps you sort out this handy tool.

Making the right choice When choosing a bilingual dictionary, your first task is selecting the right dictionary. First and foremost is the size and quality. Don’t scrimp here. Check out a few dictionaries by comparing their features. Does the dictionary use only a core vocabulary of, say, 2,000 words to explain the entries? Does it contain word partnership info? Does it show usage of the word in complete

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

304

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication example sentences? Get the feel of the dictionary’s distinguishing features and layout. Then compare three different entries. Start with a frequently used verb like machen. The following shortened dictionary entry for the verb machen shows you how a good dictionary organizes the information on the first two lines: machen 1 vt (a) to do; (herstellen, zubereiten) to make. was ~ Sie (beruflich)? what do you do for a living?; gut, wird gemacht right, I’ll get that done or will be done (coll). You may notice two abbreviations and a symbol in this entry: ✓ The abbreviation vt stands for transitive verb; that’s a verb that can take a direct object. Other verbs have the abbreviation vi, which stands for intransitive verb; that’s a verb without a direct object. ✓ The second abbreviation coll stands for colloquial; expressions or words marked by this abbreviation are used in informal conversation. ✓ The ~ symbol represents the headword (the first word) machen. The complete expression is Was machen Sie (beruflich)? Start your dictionary comparison task by following these steps:

1. Look at how comprehensive the entries are.

Check for commonly used phrases, such as was machst du denn da? (what in the world are you doing here?), mach schneller! (hurry up!), or mach’s gut (take care), and compare their translations for detail and content. You should be able to find complete sentences and phrases using machen. Comprehensive dictionaries should offer alternative words in German (at least for frequently used verbs such as machen), along with possible translations. For example, after machen, you may find herstellen (to produce, manufacture) or zubereiten (to prepare), as in the example entry.

2. Ask yourself which dictionary is more user-friendly.

In other words, does the dictionary provide plenty of helpful abbreviations to help you understand the entries? Do you see clearly marked sections under the headword machen? They should be marked by numbers and letters in bold; in the example entry, you find 1 and (a). Some quality dictionaries indent the numbered sections to make them even easier to locate. You can compare whether there’s a phonetic pronunciation for tricky words. Also, check that the dictionary makes ample use of symbols like coll to indicate usage of the word. Apart from the abbreviations that show part of speech, gender, number, case, and so on, you find many more details in any large, quality

Chapter 1: Laying Out the Basics to Build Sentences

305

­ ictionary. A (very) short list of such abbreviated terms should include d fig (figurative), lit (literal), esp (especially), sl (slang), Tech (technology), Psych (psychology), Prov (proverb), Jur (law), spec (specialist term), Aus (Austrian usage), and Sw (Swiss usage). Make your choice wisely, and start enjoying your new Wörterbuch (dictionary). If you prefer an online dictionary and you’re not sure about how to make a good selection, follow the same criteria. Select a couple of reputable dictionary publishers, go to their online dictionaries, and find out how extensive and (hopefully accurate) they are. If you’re not familiar with dictionary publishers, check out the dictionaries listed under “deutsch-englisches wörterbuch.” Do a thorough online search to find what’s available and compare the sources you find. Online dictionaries are a good backup for finding out about words if you’re on a limited budget. They often have the add-on feature of an audio recording of each word. This can be a great help in figuring out the pronunciation of the word.

Performing a word search Whether you’re using a hard copy or an online dictionary, you still have to know how to find the right word.

Familiarize yourself with the symbols and abbreviations used by looking up a few nouns, verbs, adjectives, and so on. See whether you understand them in the context of the dictionary entry. Instead of trying to memorize the meaning of all the abbreviations, make a photocopy of the list that you find at the front of the dictionary and keep it as a bookmark in your dictionary. Better yet, laminate it. That way you can use it as a mouse pad, a table mat, or whatever. You can then cross-check definitions to get more information on words you’re looking up. When you look up a word that has several definitions, read beyond the first or second entry line and try to decide which one suits your needs. Think about context and decide which word fits best into the rest of the sentence. Besides meaning, here are some other factors that may affect your word choice:

✓ Nouns: Think of gender and number as the vital statistics of a noun.

• Gender is indicated by m, f, and nt (for masculine, feminine, and neuter) in some dictionaries.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

306

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

• Number is indicated with the plural ending form for that noun. There are five main groups of noun endings. A common ending is -en; other nouns add -s. With some nouns, you see the genitive case ending indicated for that noun in addition to the plural ending. ✓ Verbs: Verbs also have vital statistics you need to know.

• A verb is transitive or intransitive (symbols like vt and vi). A transitive verb takes a direct object; an intransitive verb doesn’t.

• A transitive verb may have a separable prefix (vt sep) or an inseparable prefix (vt insep). If the prefix is separable, it usually gets booted to the end of the sentence when the verb is conjugated.

• Some verbs are reflexive (vr), meaning they require a reflexive pronoun (myself, himself, and so on).

• The simple past form and the past participle are also indicated (in some dictionaries with pret and ptp, respectively).

✓ Prepositions: Prepositions in German dictionary entries show which case they have: accusative (prep + acc), dative (prep + dat), or genitive (prep + gen). Some prepositions have more than one case, and most prepositions have more than one meaning. ✓ Pronouns: Pronouns include personal pronouns (pers pron), such as ich (I); demonstrative pronouns (dem pron), such as denen (them); relative pronouns (rel pron), such as das (that); and reflexive pronouns (reflexive pron), such as mich (myself). See Book III, Chapter 2 for details on pronoun types.

Chapter 2

Sorting Out Word Gender and Case In This Chapter ▶ Getting to know word gender ▶ Surveying the five plural forms and the two types of articles ▶ Defining the four noun and pronoun cases ▶ Identifying the types of pronouns ▶ Understanding the effects of case and gender on verbs and adjectives

M

ost words in a German sentence take their cues from nouns (or their esteemed representatives — pronouns). When studying German, you really don’t know a new noun unless you know its characteristics, including gender. So for each new noun you come across, accept its gender as a part of the word and commit it to memory. To use nouns and pronouns (as well as adjectives and prepositions) in a German sentence, you have to know how they fit together; this is the role of case. In German, case endings on words show you how those words are being used in the sentence. Take, for example, nouns and their sidekicks, the articles. The case endings on these words indicate how the noun is working in the sentence — as the subject or object, for instance. In this chapter, you get the lowdown on how gender and case work hand in hand to form various endings on the members of two large families of words: the article family and the pronoun family. You also see how case and gender affect certain verbs (called dative verbs) and adjectives.

308

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Classifying Nouns and Pronouns with Gender Not everything with gender lives and breathes. Listen to people talk about inanimate objects and you may hear them refer to the faithful bicycle they cherish, the noncompliant computer they want to throttle, or the old jalopy they’re trying to coax up a hill as he or she. Like these other things you may have a love-hate relationship with, German words have gender. In German grammar, gender is the classification of a noun or a pronoun into one of three categories: masculine, feminine, or neuter. These genders often have nothing to do with the meaning of the word; they’re simply an identity bracelet. Note that gender refers to the word, not whatever the word represents. You need to know a word’s gender because it can dictate the spelling of other words in the sentence. The following sections explain how to identify a word’s gender.

Identifying German genders and figuring out which one to use In English, you mark a noun as one of three genders: male (masculine), female (feminine), or inanimate/neither (neuter). The descriptions male, female, and inanimate refer to living beings and things. The words in parentheses — masculine, feminine, and neuter — refer to grammatical gender distinction, which is how German describes noun gender. Gender distinction in English is natural, which means you need to know only whether the noun refers to a female being, a male being, or an inanimate object (neither male nor female). You can refer to the nouns as he, she, or it. The articles you use — such as the, a, and an — don’t tell you anything about gender at all. Look at these examples: ✓ Can you see the girl over there? She’s really tall. (You know the word girl refers to a female, so you use she when you refer back to her in the second sentence.) ✓ The new German teacher is Herr Mangold. I think he comes from Bremen. (The teacher is male, so you refer to him as he.) ✓ Have you seen the cool guitar in the shop window? It has 12 strings. (You refer to an inanimate object as it.) In German, you have three genders just as you do in English; however, much of the gender designation in German is unnatural, meaning you won’t find a silver bullet to help you remember the gender of a word. Instead of referring to a word’s meaning, gender in German refers to the word itself. Thus, you use different gender markers to point out the gender of nouns. The three gender

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

309

markers that mean the (singular) in German are der (masculine), die (feminine), and das (neuter). (These gender markers are also called definite articles; check out the later section “Mastering the Art of Articles” for details.) For example, look at the words for eating utensils, where you have all three bases covered: der Löffel (the spoon), die Gabel (the fork), and das Messer (the knife). Why should a spoon be masculine, a fork feminine, and a knife neuter? See any logical pattern here? Neither do we. So how do you know how to form/use genders correctly in German? First, remember that gender is an integral part of each noun; it’s like a piece of the noun’s identity. When you see a new noun, check a dictionary to find the gender; German dictionary entries identify nouns as der, die, or das. You can also use one of the noun gender categories listed in Tables 2-1 and 2-2 to help you make a good guess. Some categories of nouns are consistently masculine, feminine, or neuter. For instance, noun gender usually follows the gender of people: der Onkel (the uncle) and die Schwester (the sister). In many other cases, the noun categories have to do with the ending of the noun. Tables 2-1 and 2-2 provide some fairly reliable categories of nouns and their genders; however, there are exceptions (big surprise, huh?). Among the exceptions are der Kunde (customer) and das Messer (knife).

Table 2-1

Common Genders by Noun Ending (Or Beginning)

Usually Masculine (der)

Usually Feminine (die)

Usually Neuter (das)

-er (especially when referring to male people/jobs)

-ade, -age, -anz, -enz, -ette, -ine, -ion, -tur (if foreign/borrowed from another language)

-chen

-ich

-e

-ium

-ismus

-ei

-lein

-ist

-heit

-ment (if foreign/ borrowed from another language)

-ner

-ie

-o

-ik

-tum or -um

-in (when referring to female people/occupations)

Ge-

-keit -schaft -tät -ung

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

310

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 2-2

Common Genders by Noun Subject

Usually Masculine (der)

Usually Feminine (die)

Usually Neuter (das)

Days, months, and seasons: der Freitag (Friday)

Many flowers: die Rose (the rose)

Colors (adjectives) used as nouns: grün (green) → das Grün (the green)

Map locations: der Süd(en) (the south)

Many trees: die Buche (the beech)

Geographic place names: das Europa (Europe)

Names of cars and trains: der Audi (the Audi), der ICE (the Intercity Express)

Names of aircraft and ships: die Boeing 767 (the Boeing 767), die Titanic (the Titanic)

Infinitives used as nouns (gerunds): schwimmen (to swim) → das Schwimmen (swimming)

Nationalities and words showing citizenship: der Amerikaner (the American)

Cardinal numbers: eine Drei (a three)

Young people and animals: das Baby (the baby)

Occupations: der Arzt (the doctor)

Almost all the chemical elements and most metals: das Aluminium (aluminum), das Blei (lead)

Names of most mountains and lakes: der Großglockner (the highest mountain in Austria) Most rivers outside of Europe: der Amazonas (the Amazon)

Eyeing nouns with more than one gender and meaning Knowing the gender of a given German word is especially tricky (yet important) with groups of nouns that have more than one gender. Some of these nouns may have two different genders as a result of usage in different Germanspeaking regions. Other nouns have more than one gender and more than one meaning. Because there’s no logic to explain why a word has more than one gender, the only way to keep track of such words is through memory. Table2-3 shows some of the more frequently used nouns that have more thanone gender and meaning.

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

311

Table 2-3 German Nouns with More Than One Gender and Meaning

German Nouns

English Translations

German Nouns

English Translations

der Band

volume (book)

das Schild

die Band

band (music group)

sign, name/number plate

das Band

tape, ribbon, band, wavelength (radio)

der Schild

shield, shell (of a turtle)

das Golf

golf (game)

der See

lake

der Golf

gulf

die See

sea, ocean

der Kunde

customer

das Stift

foundation, seminary

die Kunde

tidings; the study of . . .

der Stift

pencil, pin, marker, pen (ballpoint)

der Leiter

director, leader, manager

das Tor

gate, gateway, goal

die Leiter

ladder

der Tor

fool (person)

das Messer

knife

der Messer

surveyor, gauge

Compound nouns (nouns with two or more nouns in one word) always have the gender of the last noun: die Polizei (the police) + der Hund (the dog) = der Polizeihund (the police dog).

Pinning Down Plurals When you want to make a noun plural in English, all you usually have to do is add -s or -es to the end of the noun. In German, on the other hand, you have five ways to choose from when forming plural nouns. Before you throw your hands up in dismay, think about how English varies from the one standard form of making plurals with -s or -es. Think of mouse/mice, tooth/teeth, child/ children, shelf/shelves, phenomenon/phenomena, man/men, and country/ countries. Better yet, think about words like hoof/hoofs/hooves that have two plural forms. With both languages, you have a variety of plural endings and/ or changes in the noun to remember. Here’s the good news: You don’t have to worry much about gender when you’re dealing with plural definite articles in German because die (the in plural form) is all you need (see the preceding section for more about

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

312

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication gender). The article die corresponds to all three singular definite article forms: der (the, masculine), die (the, feminine), and das (the, neuter). Although die has the double duty of being both a singular, feminine definite article and a plural definite article for all three genders, you can still distinguish between singular and plural. Just follow these tips: ✓ Find out the difference in noun endings for each feminine noun in its singular form and its plural form. ✓ Use the context in the sentence to figure out whether you’re dealing with a singular or plural form of the noun. You always have the chance to check subject/verb agreement. To see how this works, look at the difference in meaning between the following two phrases: die Schwester ist hier (the sister is here) and die Schwestern sind hier (the sisters are here). ✓ Refer to the case of the noun for clues; check out the section “Calling All Cases: The Roles Nouns and Pronouns Play” for details.

Knowing the five plural forms You can make nouns plural in five main ways in German. Table 2-4 shows you how. There’s no hard and fast method of knowing which plural ending you need, but you can recognize some patterns as you expand your vocabulary. At any rate, you need to place high priority on memorizing plural forms and genders when you first learn a word. To get started, consider the following patterns for forming plural nouns (and keep in mind that there may be exceptions): ✓ Feminine nouns with the (feminine) suffixes -heit, -keit, and -ung usually have an -en plural ending: die Möglichkeit (the possibility) → die Möglichkeiten (possibilities). ✓ Singular nouns ending in -er may not have any ending in the plural form: das Fenster (the window) → die Fenster (the windows). ✓ Many nouns, including many one-syllable words, have an umlaut and an extra -e in the plural form: der Kuss (the kiss) → die Küsse (the kisses); der Traum (the dream) → die Träume (the dreams). ✓ Some German nouns are used only in the plural or in the singular: die Ferien (the [often: school] vacation) is always plural; die Milch (the milk) is always singular.

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case Table 2-4

The Five German Plural Groups

Change Needed

English Singular and Plural

German Singular

German Plural

Add -s

the car(s)

das Auto

die Autos

the office(s)

das Büro

die Büros

the café(s)

das Café

die Cafés

the boss(es)

der Chef

die Chefs

the club(s)

der Club

die Clubs

the pen(s)

der Kuli

die Kulis

the computer(s)

der Computer

die Computer

the window(s)

das Fenster

die Fenster

the garden(s)

der Garten

die Gärten

the girl(s)

das Mädchen

die Mädchen

the mother(s)

die Mutter

die Mütter

the daughter(s)

die Tochter

die Töchter

the father(s)

der Vater

die Väter

the train station(s)

der Bahnhof

die Banhöfe

the friend(s) (singular is male)

der Freund

die Freunde

the problem(s)

das Problem

die Probleme

the son(s)

der Sohn

die Söhne

the city/cities

die Stadt

die Städte

the chair(s)

der Stuhl

die Stühle

the day(s)

der Tag

die Tage

the book(s)

das Buch

die Bücher

the bicycle(s)

das Fahrrad

die Fahrräder

the house(s)

das Haus

die Häuser

the child/children

das Kind

die Kinder

the man (men)

der Mann

die Männer

the castle(s)

das Schloss

die Schlösser

No change, or add umlaut (··)

Add -e or umlaut (··) + -e

Add -er or umlaut (··) + -er

313

(continued)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

314

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 2-4 (continued) Change Needed

English Singular and Plural

German Singular

German Plural

Add -n, -en, or -nen

the idea(s)

die Idee

die Ideen

the boy(s)

der Junge

die Jungen

the lamp(s)

die Lampe

die Lampen

the sister(s)

die Schwester

die Schwestern

the student(s) (female)

die Studentin

die Studentinnen

the university(-ies)

die Universität

die Universitäten

the newspaper(s)

die Zeitung

die Zeitungen

Taking note of nouns that are only singular or plural In both German and English, some nouns have only a plural form, and others have only a singular form. To keep things interesting, some nouns are plural in German and singular in English and vice versa. When you want to use a German noun that has no plural or one that has no singular form, you need to use the correct verb form in a sentence. For example, words like pants and (eye)glasses are singular in German and plural in English. Look at these two sentences: Deine Hose passt dir nicht. (Literally: Your pants doesn’t fit you.) Wo ist meine Brille? (Literally: Where is my glasses?) On the other hand, words such as vacation and the United States are plural in German and singular in English. The following sentences show how the German verb is plural to reflect the German use of the noun as a plural: Wann beginnen die Ferien? (Literally: When are the vacation beginning?) Die Vereinigten Staaten sind ein wunderbares Land. (Literally: The United States are a wonderful country.) Table 2-5 shows commonly used nouns that are singular in German and plural in English.

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

315

Table 2-5 Nouns That Are Singular in German but Plural in English German Noun

English Translation

German Noun

English Translation

die Brille

the (eye)glasses

das Mittelalter

the Middle Ages

die Dynamik

the dynamics

die Polizei

the police

das Feuerwerk

the fireworks

die Schere

the scissors

das Gemüse

the vegetables

die Statistik

the statistics

ein Gemüse (asingle type of vegetable)

a vegetable

die Hose

the pants

die Umgebung

the surroundings

der Inhalt

the contents

das Volk

the people (of a nation)

Table 2-6 shows frequently used nouns that are plural in German and singular in English.

Table 2-6 Nouns That Are Plural in German but Singular in English German Noun

English Translation

German Noun

English Translation

die Depressionen

the depression (illness)

die Kosten

the cost(s)

die Ferien

the vacation

die Möbel

the furniture

die Haare (a head of hair), usually plural

hair

die Vereinigten Staaten

the United States (of America)

die Informationen

the information

Mastering the Art of Articles Getting comfortable with using articles in German is a matter of determining whether you need the definite article der/die/das (the) or the indefinite article ein/eine (a/an) or the third option — no article at all.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

316

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Identifying singular nouns with indefinite articles Just as English has two indefinite articles — a and an — that you use with singular nouns, German also has two indefinite articles (in the nominative case): ein for masculine- and neuter-gender words and eine for femininegender words. (See the later section “Calling All Cases: The Roles Nouns and Pronouns Play” for more on the nominative and other cases.) An indefinite article has many of the same uses in both languages. For example, you use it before a singular noun that’s countable the first time it’s mentioned: Ein Mann geht um die Ecke. (A man is walking around the corner.) You also use it when a singular countable noun represents a class of things: Ein Elefant vergisst nie. (An elephant never forgets.) In addition, you can use ein/eine together with a predicate noun (a noun that complements the subject): Willy Brandt war ein geschickter Politiker. (Willy Brandt was a skillful politician.) (In case you’re wondering, in the preceding example, Politiker is the predicate noun.) Another similarity with English is that the German indefinite article ein/eine doesn’t have a plural form. Depending on how you’re describing something plural, you may or may not need to use the plural definite article. Consider the following generalized statement, which requires no article: In Zermatt sind Autos verboten. (Cars are forbidden in Zermatt [Switzerland].) The following list shows you the definite articles and the corresponding indefinite articles (nominative case): Gender/Number Masculine Feminine Neuter Plural

Definite (the) der die das die

Indefinite (a/an) ein eine ein (no plural form)

For tables with definite articles and indefinite articles, go to Appendix A.

Knowing when not to use articles The following three guidelines explain when not to use an article in the sentence:

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

317

✓ Don’t use the indefinite article when you mention someone’s profession, nationality, or religion, all of which are nouns in German. Look at these three examples: Mein Onkel war General bei der Bundeswehr. (My uncle was [a] general in the army.) Sind Sie Australier oder Neuseeländer? (Are you [an] Australian or [a] New Zealander?) Ich glaube, sie ist Lutheranerin. (I think she’s [a] Lutheran.) ✓ Just as in English, don’t use the definite article in generalized statements using plural nouns in German. But do use the plural definite article when you’re not making a generalization. Here are two examples:

Lügen haben kurze Beine. (You don’t get far by lying. Literally: Lies have short legs.) Both nouns, Lügen and Beine, are generalizations and need no article.

Die Bäume haben keine Blätter. (The trees have no leaves.) The second plural noun Blätter is generalized; it needs no article. ✓ Although names of countries have genders in German — most often das, or neuter — you generally don’t include the definite article. Of course, a few exceptions exist (see Chapter 3 of Book I for more on countries). Here are a few examples: Viele berühmte Komponisten sind aus Deutschland oder Österreich. (Many famous composers are from Germany or Austria.) Die Schweiz gehört nicht zur Europäischen Union. (Switzerland doesn’t belong to the European Union.) Note die, the feminine definite article. Die Vereinigten Staaten sind die größte Volkswirtschaft der Welt. (The United States has the largest economy in the world.) Note die, the plural definite article.

Calling All Cases: The Roles Nouns and Pronouns Play Cases indicate the role or function of nouns and pronouns in the sentence. English and German both have cases, as do most languages. This section identifies the four German cases and explains how they’re used, as well as how English and German cases compare.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

318

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Identifying the four cases When studying German, you have to get familiar with the four German cases because they’re the reason nouns, pronouns, articles, and adjectives go through so many spelling changes from sentence to sentence. Here are the four cases: ✓ Nominative case (nom.): This case is for the subject of the sentence. The subject is a person or thing acting like the quarterback and calling the shots. In a sentence, it’s who or what carries out the action. In the sentence Brady wirft den Ball (Brady throws the ball), Brady is the subject. Note: You also use the nominative case for predicate nouns, which are nouns (or noun phrases) that express more about the subject, such as a description or identification. For example, in the sentence Er ist ein hervorragender Tennisspieler (He’s an outstanding tennis player), both the subject Er and the predicate noun phrase ein hervorragender Tennisspieler are in the nominative case. ✓ Accusative case (acc.): This case is for the direct object of the sentence. The direct object is a bit similar to the quarterback’s ball — the subject is acting on it. In Ein Zuschauer fängt den Ball (A spectator catches the ball), Ball is the direct object. ✓ Dative case (dat.): This case is for the indirect object of the sentence. The indirect object receives the direct object — it’s like the person the spectator gives the ball to. In Der Zuschauer gibt seinem Sohn den Ball (The spectator gives his son the ball), seinem Sohn (his son) is the indirect object, so it’s in the dative case. In both German and English, you generally use the verb geben (to give) the same way; you give (the verb) something (den Ball, accusative case) to someone (seinem Sohn, dative case). ✓ Genitive case (gen.): This case shows possession. A person or thing can be the possessor, or owner. In Die Mutter des Sohnes jubelt (The mother of the son cheers), the son belongs to his cheering mother; des Sohnes is in the genitive case. Note: Prepositions also use the accusative, dative, and genitive cases for the words they link with. (See Chapter 2 of Book IV for more on prepositions.) The word endings of nouns, pronouns, articles, and adjectives alter slightly according to the case. These changes are necessary to identify what you want to express in a German sentence. (The case ending tables in Appendix A come in extremely handy when you want to find the correct word and its word ending.)

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

319

Eyeing the similarities and differences When dealing with case, English and German have their share of similarities and differences. Before you can tackle the differences, you need to understand that German and English share the following case-related characteristics: ✓ They share the same system of marking cases of personal pronouns. In other words, pronouns have different forms (spellings) according to the case they’re taking in a sentence. For example, in Er lebt dort (he lives there), the pronoun er (he) is the subject, so it’s in the nominative case. However, in Ich kenne ihn gut (I know him well), ihn (him) is the direct object, so it’s in the accusative case. Spelling changes indicate the role the pronoun is playing; for example, ich (I) changes to mich (me) and wir (we) changes to uns (us). The same is true for relative pronouns: Der (who) changes to dessen (whose). Skip to the later section “Putting Pronouns in Place” for more on this type of pronoun. ✓ They use the nominative case — the same case you use for subjects — when you have a predicate noun as the object of a sentence. A predicate noun states more about the subject. For English and German, the verb sein (to be) is the prime example of a verb that’s followed by the predicate noun. German also uses the predicate noun with the verbs bleiben (to stay, to remain), heißen (to be named, to be called), and werden (to become). (In English, people often call these verbs linking verbs.) Consider this example: Mein Zahnarzt ist auch der Zahnarzt meiner Eltern. (My dentist is also my parent’s dentist.) Mein Zahnarzt and der Zahnarzt are both in the nominative case. As for differences, English doesn’t have case endings for nouns (only for pronouns), so it relies on word order to indicate which grammatical hat the noun wears. The most common word order in an English sentence is subjectverb-object (or other information, such as a prepositional phrase). Hence, you can usually recognize the subject because you see it at the beginning of the sentence. Because German has different case spellings/endings for both articles and nouns, word order in German sentences can be more flexible. Look at the word order of these two sentences, for example: Der Junge liebt den Hund. (The boy loves the dog.) Den Hund liebt der Junge. (The boy loves the dog.) In both sentences, der Junge (the boy) is the subject and den Hund (the dog) is the object; as far as meaning goes, the two sentences are the same.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

320

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication However, you have a different case ending for the definite article (der in the first sentence and den in the second). In the nominative singular case, it’s der (Hund), but in the accusative case, it’s den (Hund). So why put den Hund (the direct object) at the beginning of the sentence? Because in German, you can use that word order to emphasize that den Hund (and not some other house pet) is the one the boy loves. To get that type of emphasis in English, you need to say something like It’s the dog that the boy loves. English speakers tend to create this kind of emphasis vocally, whereas in German, you can accomplish such a nuance in both writing and speech. Table 2-7 shows how the definite article the changes in both gender and case. You see the four cases and the three genders, plus the plural form of the definite article the. Appendix A shows the same type of table for indefinite articles.

Table 2-7

German Words That Mean The

Case

Masculine

Feminine

Neuter

Plural

Nominative (subjects, predicate nouns)

der

die

das

die

Accusative (direct objects)

den

die

das

die

Dative (indirect objects)

dem

der

dem

den

Genitive (owned objects)

des

der

des

der

You have a grand total of six different definite articles in German and one lonely word, the, in English. Practice makes perfect, so set your standards high for mastering the definite article in German. The following example sentences show you how definite articles appear in different cases. After each definite article and its noun, the information in parentheses tells you the gender and case of the definite article/noun duo and whether it’s in the plural form. The following abbreviations are in parentheses: m. = masculine; f. = feminine; n. = neuter; pl. = plural; nom. = nominative; acc. = accusative; dat. = dative; and gen. = genitive. These abbreviations refer to the noun that directly precedes them. ✓ Die Mannschaft (f., nom.) spielt sehr gut Fußball. (The team plays soccer very well.) ✓ Brauchst du den Kuli (m., acc.)? (Do you need the pen?) ✓ Das Radio (n., nom.) läuft nicht sehr gut. (The radio doesn’t work very well.)

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

321

✓ Ich schreibe der Zeitung (f., dat.) einen Brief. (I’m writing the newspaper a letter.) ✓ Die Mädchen (pl., nom.) sind sehr freundlich. (The girls are very friendly.) ✓ Mir gefällt die Farbe der Krawatte (f., gen.). (I like the color of the tie.) ✓ Kennen Sie die Leute (pl., acc.) da drüben? (Do you know the people over there?)

Understanding nouns with case endings Fortunately, most German nouns are spelled the same in all four cases. Of course, they have plural endings when necessary, but those endings don’t change from one case to another. Unfortunately, some small groups of commonly used nouns do change spelling, depending on their case in a sentence. This group of nouns includes der Fremde (the stranger) and der Junge (the boy). What distinguishes them from most German nouns is that they both have an -n ending in accusative, dative, and genitive cases. Here are the groups of nouns that have case endings: ✓ Masculine nouns ending in -e: In German, most nouns ending in -e are feminine, such as die Blume (the flower). The group of masculine nouns that end in -e generally has the case ending -n for all cases except the nominative case; in other words, these nouns add -n in the accusative, dative, and genitive cases. Some nouns of this type are der Franzose (the Frenchman), der Kunde (the customer), and der Verwandte (the relative). Consider this example sentence: Wir empfehlen dem Fremden ein Restaurant. (We recommend a restaurant to the stranger.) Dem Fremden (to the stranger) is the dative case for the noun der Fremde. You simply add the dative case ending -n to der Fremde. ✓ Masculine nouns ending in -e with the genitive case ending -(e)ns: This small subset of masculine nouns ending in -e has the case ending -(e)ns in the genitive case as well as the ending -n for the accusative and dative cases. Two examples of this type of noun are der Name (the name) and der Glaube (the belief). When used in the genitive case, these nouns are des Namens (of the name) and des Glaubens (of the belief). ✓ Certain groups of masculine nouns: The groups of nouns that refer to animals, people, professions, and titles of people add the ending -en in all cases except the nominative case. Some examples of these nouns are der Präsident (the president), der Mensch (human being, person), and der Bär (the bear). Here’s a sample sentence: Wir kennen den Präsidenten sehr gut. (We know the president very well.) Den Präsidenten is the accusative case with the ending -en for the noun der Präsident.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

322

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

When Germans use these masculine nouns in everyday, casual situations, they often replace the genitive endings -n and -en with -s or -es. And in some instances, they drop the accusative and dative endings altogether. For a list of nouns with case endings, go to Appendix A.

Putting Pronouns in Place What’s the big deal about pronouns like you, me, it, them, this, and that? First off, these plentiful, useful, and essential critters are lurking in various corners of many sentences. After all, they’re great for replacing or referring to nouns elsewhere in a sentence. The bad news is that, like articles, they also change spelling/endings according to the role they play in a sentence (case) and the nouns they replace. This section discusses three types of pronouns: personal, demonstrative, and relative. (See Book IV, Chapter 3 for details on a fourth type of pronoun — reflexive.) In German, pronouns are more affected by gender and case patterns than they are in English, so this section puts them into tables to help you see those patterns more easily. The case tables are arranged in order of frequency of use: nominative, accusative, dative, and genitive. You can also go to Appendix A for reference. Note: One more group of pronouns, called the possessive pronouns — such as mein (my), dein (your), unser (our), and so on — are technically classified as adjectives; they have endings that resemble those of descriptive adjectives like interesting, tiny, and pink. (See Book III, Chapter 5 for more details on possessive adjectives/pronouns.)

Getting personal with personal pronouns The personal pronoun family, shown in Table 2-8, comes in handy in all kinds of situations when you want to talk (or write) about people, including yourself, without repeating names all the time. You use the nominative case frequently because every sentence needs a subject. (See the earlier section “Identifying the four cases” for details on cases.) With German personal pronouns, the biggest difference is that you have to distinguish among three ways to say you: du, ihr, and Sie. Other personal pronouns, like ich and mich (I and me) or wir and uns (we and us), bear a closer resemblance to English. Note: The genitive case isn’t represented among the

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

323

personal pronouns because it indicates possession; the personal pronouns represent only people, not something those people possess. Check out Table 2-8 for a list of the personal pronouns. Notice that you and it don’t change in English and the accusative (for direct objects) and dative (for indirect objects) pronouns are identical. The table lists the distinguishing factors for the three forms of you — du, ihr, and Sie — in abbreviated form. Here’s what the abbreviations mean: s. = singular, pl. = plural, inf. = informal, form. = formal. (For detailed information on the difference between the formal and informal forms of you, go to Book III, Chapter 3.)

Table 2-8

German Personal Pronouns

Nominative (nom.)

Accusative (acc.)

Dative (dat.)

ich (I)

mich (me)

mir (me)

du (you) (s., inf.)

dich (you) (s., inf.)

dir (you) (s., inf.)

er (he)

ihn (him)

ihm (him)

sie (she)

sie (her)

ihr (her)

es (it)

es (it)

ihm (it)

wir (we)

uns (us)

uns (us)

ihr (you) (pl., inf.)

euch (you) (pl., inf.)

euch (you) (pl., inf.)

sie (they)

sie (them)

ihnen (them)

Sie (you) (s. or pl., form.)

Sie (you) (s. or pl., form.)

Ihnen (you) (s. or pl., form.)

The following example sentences show you how the personal pronouns look when you place them in a sentence. After each pronoun, the notes in parentheses show the English equivalent of the German pronoun, followed by the abbreviations that identify the case of the pronoun in the sentence. If the pronoun is one of the three forms of you — du, ihr, or Sie — you see the same distinguishing factors for you that you see in Table 2-8: Ich glaube, sie (she, nom.) arbeitet zu viel. (I think she works too hard.) Kennst du (you, nom., s., inf.) meine Schwester? (Do you know my sister?) Was kann ich (I, nom.) für Sie (you, acc., s. or pl., form.) tun? (What can I do for you?) Die Familie fährt ohne sie (her, acc.) nach Schweinfurt. (The family is traveling without her to Schweinfurt.) Thomas und Janina gehen mit Ihnen (you, dat., s. or pl., form.) ins Kino. (Thomas and Janina are going with you to the movies.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

324

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Wohnen Sie (you, nom., s. or pl., form.) in der Nähe? (Do you live nearby?) Wie gefällt euch (you, dat., pl., inf.) der neue Bürgermeister? (How do you like the new mayor?)

Relating to relative pronouns You use relative pronouns (who, whom, whose, that, and which) to include extra information about a noun or pronoun. A relative pronoun typically appears at the front of a relative clause, where it refers back to the noun in the main clause. In case you’re wondering, a main clause is a part of a sentence that can stand on its own and still make sense. A relative clause is a type of subordinate clause, which, as you can probably guess, is a part of a sentence that can’t stand alone (in other words, it’s a sentence fragment). (If you’re confused by all this talk of clauses, refer to Book III, Chapter 1 for clarification.) The following guidelines help you put relative pronouns to use in your sentences: ✓ In German, you must use a relative pronoun to connect a main clause and a relative clause. In English, you don’t always have to. For example, Ist das der Mann, den du liebst? (Is that the man [whom, that] you love?) In this sentence, the main clause is followed by the relative clause, den du liebst. The second den is the relative pronoun connecting the two parts of the sentence. ✓ You place a comma between the main clause and the relative clause. Remember that the relative clause begins with the relative pronoun. In English, people usually include this comma only before the relative pronoun which. For example: Bestellen wir die Pizza, die wir meistens essen. (Let’s order the pizza that we usually eat.) No comma needed in English, but you do have a comma in German to separate the main clause Bestellen wir die Pizza from the relative clause die wir meistens essen. ✓ Word order comes into play in relative clauses. You push the conjugated verb to the end of the clause. For example, Gestern habe ich eine gute Freundin getroffen, die ich seit Jahren nicht gesehen habe. (Yesterday I met a good [female] friend whom I haven’t seen for years.) In the relative clause die ich seit Jahren nicht gesehen habe, the verb has two parts, gesehen, the past participle, and habe, which is the conjugated part of the verb. Habe is the last word in the sentence. (For an indepth look at the present perfect verb tense, go to Book IV, Chapter 4.)

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

325

Table 2-9 breaks down the relative pronouns (who, whom, whose, and that) by gender and case.

Table 2-9

Relative Pronouns

Gender/Number of the Noun Being Replaced

Nominative Case

Accusative Case

Dative Case

Genitive Case

Masculine (m.)

der

den

dem

dessen

Feminine (f.)

die

die

der

deren

Neuter (n.)

das

das

dem

dessen

Plural (pl.)

die

die

denen

deren

The following sentences show relative pronouns that connect clauses. After each sentence, you see an explanation for the gender and case of the relative pronoun. ✓ Ich kenne den Supermarkt, den du meinst. (I know the supermarket [that] you mean/are talking about.) The pronoun den works as the masculine relative pronoun in the accusative case because it replaces the masculine noun der Supermarkt and is the direct object of the verb meinen (here: meinst). ✓ Ist das die Frau, die bei der Polizei arbeitet? (Is that the woman who works for the police?) The relative pronoun die is feminine and in the nominative case, reflecting the gender and case of die Frau, the noun it replaces in the relative clause. ✓ Wie gefällt dir das Hemd, das ich anhabe? (How do you like the shirt [that] I’m wearing?) Das replaces a neuter noun, das Hemd, and refers to the direct object (the accusative case) of anhaben in the relative clause. ✓ Das ist der Mann, dessen Hund ein Kind gebissen hat. (That’s the man whose dog bit a child.) Dessen is the relative pronoun for the masculine gender, genitive case. Dessen Hund (whose dog) refers to the masculine gender noun der Mann (the man) in the main clause.

Demonstrating demonstrative pronouns Demonstrative pronouns (listed in Table 2-10) allow you to emphasize or point out the pronoun that’s replacing a noun. Besides the pronouns he, it, they, and so on, which are the translations you see in Table 2-10, you can also

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

326

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication translate these pronouns with the demonstratives this, that, these, or those. Like in English, the demonstrative pronoun generally comes at the beginning of a phrase. You use demonstrative pronouns in the nominative case to emphasize the subject or in the accusative case to emphasize the object.

Table 2-10

Demonstrative Pronouns

Gender/Number of the Noun Being Replaced

Nominative Case (Subjects and Predicate Nouns)

Accusative Case (Direct Objects)

Masculine (m.)

der (he/it)

den (him/it)

Feminine (f.)

die (she/it)

die (her/it)

Neuter (n.)

das (it)

das (it)

Plural (pl.)

die (they)

die (them)

The only demonstrative pronoun that’s different in the nominative case and the accusative case is the masculine pronoun. Der is the nominative, and den is the accusative case. The following pairs of questions and answers show how demonstrative pronouns work in German. Each answer replaces a noun from the corresponding question with a relative pronoun. Question: Ist der Flug ausgebucht? (Is the flight completely booked?) Answer: Ja, der ist voll. (Yes, it’s full.) Der is the subject of the sentence, so it’s in the nominative case, and it replaces der Flug, which is masculine singular. Der is the masculine singular demonstrative pronoun in the nominative case. Question: Ist die Straße relativ ruhig? (Is the street relatively quiet?) Answer: Ja, die ist absolut ruhig. (Yes, it’s absolutely quiet.) Die is the subject (nominative case) that replaces die Straße, a feminine singular noun, which is why you use the feminine singular nominative demonstrative pronoun. Question: Wie findest du die Farbe? (What do you think of this color?) Answer: Die finde ich zu dunkel. (I think it’s too dark.) In this answer, die is the object in the accusative case. It replaces the feminine singular noun die Farbe, so you need the feminine singular accusative demonstrative pronoun. Question: Sind die Pferde aggressiv? (Are the horses aggressive?) Answer: Nein, die sind freundlich. (No, they’re friendly.) Die is the subject, so it’s in the nominative case. It stands in for die Pferde, which is plural, so you use the plural nominative demonstrative pronoun.

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case

327

Discovering Dative Verbs In German, a number of verbs are considered dative verbs. They distinguish themselves in two ways from the majority of German verbs: ✓ Generally speaking, dative verbs have only one object in a sentence. ✓ That object is in the dative case. This group of verbs doesn’t include such common verbs as geben (to give) and zeigen (to indicate, to show), which can have a dative object as well as an accusative object in the sentence. Table 2-11 shows a list of common German dative verbs with English equivalents and example sentences.

Table 2-11

Dative Verbs

German Verb

English Translation

Example Sentence

English Translation

antworten

to answer

Antworten Sie mir, bitte.

Please answer me.

danken

to thank

Ich danke Ihnen.

I thank you.

Book III

folgen

to follow

Folgen Sie mir, bitte.

Please follow me.

gefallen

to like

Diese Schuhe gefallen mir.

I like these shoes.

gehören

to belong to

Die Jacke gehört ihr.

The jacket belongs to her.

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

geschehen

to happen (to)

Ist ihr etwas geschehen?

Did something happen to her?

glauben

to believe

Wir glauben seiner Geschichte.

We believe his story.

helfen

to help

Helfen Sie uns, bitte.

Please help us.

passieren

to happen (to)

Das ist mir nie passiert.

That’s never happened to me.

raten

to advise

Ich rate dem Mann.

I advise the man.

wehtun

to hurt

Wo tut es Ihnen weh?

Where does it hurt you?

verzeihen

to forgive, to pardon

Verzeihen Sie mir.

Forgive me.

zuhören

to listen to

Hören Sie dem Piloten zu.

Listen to the pilot.

328

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Considering How Case Affects Adjectives When you think of adjectives, you may think of words like beautiful, interesting, or fast. But these are just the tip of the iceberg of adjectives. The plethora of words that makes up the adjective family (in both German and English) is incredibly diverse. For instance, the sentence My family is large has two different types of adjectives. The first is my, which is a possessive adjective that gives more information about the noun family. The second adjective is large. One important difference between German and English adjectives is that German adjectives change their spelling according to the case in which you use them. In English, you pay little or no attention to case because spelling changes in adjectives crop up only in the possessive adjectives.

How possessives change Possessive adjectives establish ownership. They mark the difference between what belongs to you (your book), what belongs to me (my book), and so on. Here are the possessive adjective forms for the different persons: ✓ mein (my) ✓ dein (your) (informal, singular) ✓ Ihr (your) (formal, singular) ✓ sein, ihr, sein (his, her, its) ✓ unser (our) ✓ euer (your) (informal, plural) ✓ Ihr (your) (formal, plural) ✓ ihr (their) Of course, each of these forms has different endings for the different cases. Table 2-12 presents all the forms of the possessive adjective mein (my). Fortunately, the other possessives take the same endings. These endings may look familiar because they’re the same as those for the indefinite article ein (a, an), as well as for the adjective that negates a noun, kein (no, not, not any).

Chapter 2: Sorting Out Word Gender and Case Table 2-12

329

Possessive Endings for Mein by Case

Gender

Nominative

Accusative

Dative

Genitive

Masculine

mein

meinen

meinem

meines

Feminine

meine

meine

meiner

meiner

Neuter

mein

mein

meinem

meines

Plural

meine

meine

meinen

meiner

How adjective endings change As you discover earlier in this chapter, adjectives and articles that accompany nouns change their endings according to the role the nouns play in the sentence. To illustrate the endings both adjectives and articles take based on the nouns they describe, check out Tables 2-13 and 2-14. Table 2-13 shows the endings with an indefinite article, and Table 2-14 shows them with the definite article. The so-called ein- words follow the same pattern as indefinite articles, so Table 2-13 includes them, too. In case you need a quick refresher, ein- words include kein (no, not, not any) and the possessive adjectives (see the preceding section for a list). This table includes the word kein for the plural forms because the indefinite article has no plural. For more information on using kein, see Book III, Chapter 4.

Table 2-13

Examples of Adjective Endings Preceded by Indefinite Articles or Ein- Words

Gender/ Number

Nominative

Accusative

Dative

Genitive

English Translation

Masculine

ein schöner Garten

einen schönen Garten

einem schönen Garten

eines schönen Gartens

a beautiful garden

Feminine

eine weiße Tür

eine weiße Tür

einer weißen Tür

einer weißen Tür

a white door

Neuter

ein kleines Haus

ein kleines Haus

einem kleinen Haus

eines kleinen Hauses

a small house

Plural

keine großen Häuser

keine großen Häuser

keinen großen Häusern

keiner großen Häuser

no large houses

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

330

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 2-14

Examples of Adjective Endings Preceded by Definite Articles

Gender/ Number

Nominative

Accusative

Dative

Genitive

English Translation

Masculine

der schöne Garten

den schönen Garten

dem schönen Garten

des schönen Gartens

the beautiful garden

Feminine

die weiße Tür

die weiße Tür

der weißen Tür

der weißen Tür

the white door

Neuter

das kleine Haus

das kleine Haus

dem kleinen Haus

des kleinen Hauses

the small house

Plural

die großen Häuser

die großen Häuser

den großen Häusern

der großen Häuser

the large houses

Chapter 3

Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense In This Chapter ▶ Using subject pronouns ▶ Conjugating present-tense verbs and putting them to use ▶ Getting to know passive voice (compared to active voice)

Y

ou’re driving down the road when you see a small herd of cows. Some are grazing, others are chewing their cud. Okay, so they might be drooling, too, but even so, it gets you on to thoughts about milk, and the idea hits you: You’re going to get some ice cream. You say to yourself, “I think I’ll go to Jan and Berry’s because I really do owe myself a treat. After all, I’ve been working hard, and —” you wake up and realize you’ve been dreaming for the past five minutes. Darn! Believe it or not, this isn’t a plug for ice cream. It is, however, a superb example of how streamlined German can be, because you can put all the verbs in the preceding paragraph (marked in italics) in the present tense in German. This multitalented player stands in for the plain old simple present tense (gets, wake up), the present continuous (are driving, are chewing), an emphatic form (do owe), some futures (are going to get, will go), and even references to actions that started in the past (have been working, have been dreaming). Das klingt gut, oder? (That sounds good, doesn’t it?) (For more information on the terminology of verb tenses, see Book III, Chapter 1.)

332

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication You probably thought we were going to start out with something along the lines of “First things first: The present tense is the verb form you use to talk about the present. Period.” Well, that’s true for sure, but there’s more to it. In this chapter, you see how to use subject pronouns with the present tense and how to conjugate regular and irregular verbs. You also see how versatile the present tense is and how you can use both active and passive voice with it.

Grasping the Specifics of Subject Pronouns Before you can understand the present tense (and all other verb tenses), you need a firm grasp of the subject pronouns and the way they work together with verbs to make logical sentences. You can’t just pick out a pronoun and a verb, stick them together, and hope they make sense. If you don’t observe certain conventions of how these two pieces go together, the sentence you create may sound more like mumbo-jumbo than a cohesive thought. The subject pronouns stand in for long-winded nouns and pop up everywhere in any language, and they play a key role in helping you get your verbs in shape. You always see them in tables that conjugate verbs, so get familiar with them before you start work on the verbs that accompany them.

Assigning person and number to subject pronouns You use subject pronouns — ich (I), du (you), er (he), sie (she), es (it), and so on — to express who or what is carrying out the action or idea of the verb. They refer to the noun without naming it, which means they can serve as placeholders so you don’t have to sound redundant by repeating the noun. (For more on pronouns, check out Book III, Chapters 1 and 2.) To use subject pronouns, you need to know which person (first, second, or third) and number (singular or plural) the pronoun represents; for example, ich (I) = first person, singular. To connect the correct subject pronoun to a presenttense verb, you need to know which conjugated verb form to use. I lay out this information in the later section “Getting Your Verbs in Shape.” Table 3-1 shows you the breakdown of subject pronouns in German and English. Notice the format with singular on the left, plural on the right, and the pronoun Sie (you) at the bottom. You see the same setup throughout the verb tables in this book.

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense Table 3-1

333

Subject Pronouns

Person

Singular

Plural

First

ich (I)

wir (we)

Second (familiar)

du (you)

ihr (you)

Third

er (he, it)

sie (they)

sie (she, it) es (it) Second (formal)

Sie (you, both singular and plural)

Think of the subject pronouns as persona because they impersonate the subject that they represent. You characterize them by their grammatical person (based on who’s speaking and listening), number (singular or plural), and sometimes formality (which we discuss in the next section). Here’s a closer look at the three persons: ✓ First person: The one(s) speaking: ich (I) or wir (we). ✓ Second person: The one(s) spoken to: du, ihr, Sie. All three mean you in English; du is the singular, familiar form, which you’d use with a friend; ihr is the plural, familiar form, which you’d use with a group of friends; and Sie is the formal form, whether singular or plural, which you’d use with the chancellor of Germany and the cabinet ministers (and everyone else you’re not on a first-name basis with). ✓ Third person: Who or what is spoken about: er (he, it), sie (she, it), or es (it) and sie (they). If you’re talking about an inanimate object (it), the choice among er, sie, and es depends on the gender of the noun — see Book III, Chapter 2 for details.

Distinguishing among the three forms of “you” If you’re hobnobbing with some business moguls, the mayor, and a throng of socialites at the charity benefit of the year, we hope you’re on your best behavior. On the other hand, most people do and say whatever they feel like while hanging out with their buddies at a backyard barbecue on a Saturday afternoon. That formality/informality factor is what you need to keep in mind when you address people in German because there are three ways to say you: du, ihr, and Sie.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

334

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Using Sie Use Sie, which is always capitalized, to speak to one or more people with whom you have a more distant, formal relationship. It’s appropriate ✓ When adults meet each other for the first time ✓ When you aren’t sure about whether du/ihr or Sie is correct ✓ When you’re not yet on a first-name basis with someone (for example, using Herr Kuhnagel or Frau Zitzelsberger, not Sigmund or Hildegard) ✓ When you’re talking to adults you don’t know well ✓ In business or at your place of work ✓ In public situations to service staff or a person in uniform (police officer, airport official, and other such individuals)

Using du and ihr Use du when you talk to one person (or animal) in an informal way; use ihr, the plural version of du, to address more than one person (or animal) informally. An informal pronoun is appropriate ✓ When a German speaker invites you to use du ✓ For talking to a close friend or relative ✓ For addressing children and teens younger than 16 or so ✓ Among people who share a common bond — for example, members of a club, a sports team, or comrades in the military ✓ When you talk to pets You may hear du among close work colleagues, students, members of a sports team, or people hiking in the mountains, but unless someone asks you, “Wollen wir uns dutzen?” (Shall we say du to each other?), try to stick with Sie. Using first names and addressing people with du (or ihr) when doing so isn’t appropriate can turn German speakers off — fast. Language and culture are bonded together with superglue, so avoid pasting your culture on the Germanspeaking world. Also, be careful with recent crossover scenarios at the workplace: people addressing each other with Sie, although they use first names: Heinz, haben Sie meine E-mail gelesen? (Heinz, have you read my e-mail?) If you use last names (Frau Dinkelhuber and Herr Sternhagel), using Sie is best.

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

335

The following three example questions asking for help show how this trio of du, ihr, and Sie play out. Notice that all three have the same English equivalent because English doesn’t have differences between the singular and plural of you or for showing formality and informality: Können Sie mir helfen? (Could you help me?) This situation may involve a person at work seeking help from a colleague. Kannst du mir helfen? (Could you help me?) The situation may be someone asking a friend to help out. Könnt ihr mir helfen? (Could you help me?) In this situation, a teenager may be asking a couple of friends for some help.

Distinguishing among “she,” “they,” and the formal “you” Look at Table 3-1, and you find the Three Musketeers, sie (she), sie (they), and Sie (you), lurking in their separate boxes. Seeing them in what look like random places may seem daunting, but a few clues can help you sort them out. First, you know the meanings by their context. The conjugated verb and capitalization also help reveal the meaning. Here’s what to watch for: ✓ Conjugation: When sie means she, its verb form is distinct; in the present tense, the conjugated verb usually ends in -t. When sie/Sie means they or you, the present-tense verb ends in -en. (For more on conjugation, see the next section.) ✓ Capitalization: The they and you forms of sie/Sie have identical conjugations, but only the you version, which is formal, is capitalized. The following examples show you how to figure out which one to use when: Wo wohnt sie? (Where does she live?) The verb is in third-person singular form. Wo wohnen sie? (Where do they live?) The verb is in third-person plural form, and sie isn’t capitalized. Wo wohnen Sie? (Where do you [formal] live?) The verb is in secondperson plural form (which is identical to the third-person plural form), and Sie is capitalized.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

336

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

When you’re speaking, listen carefully for cues in the context that help you distinguish between sentences like Wo wohnen sie? and Wo wohnen Sie? If you’re still not sure, just ask, “Meinen Sie mich?” (Do you mean me?). If you’re on a first-name basis with the speaker, then you’re all set; no confusion here because if someone asks you where you live, you hear the informal version: Wo wohnst du?

Getting Your Verbs in Shape Most of us love to talk — about ourselves, our family, our friends, our job, and what’s going on in our lives. Talking (and writing) about all these things and more in German is, for the most part, just a matter of knowing how to construct a verb in the present tense with the help of a noun (subject) and a few other elements. Most German verbs are regular, meaning they follow a standard pattern of conjugation. Think of conjugating as activating a verb from the sleepy infinitive form found in dusty dictionaries (leben, lachen, lieben) and its English equivalent with that pesky to (to live, to laugh, to love) into a form that’s compatible with the subject. This section shows you how to put verbs through their paces by conjugating them and combining them with nouns, pronouns, and other grammar goodies so you can start talking and writing with confidence in German.

Agreeing with the regulars Regular verbs don’t have any change in their basic form, or stem. You conjugate a verb by taking the stem — which is almost always the result of dropping -en from the infinitive form of the verb (the not-yet conjugated form) — and adding the right ending. In the present tense, English has only the ending -s or no ending at all (I live, you live, he lives), whereas German has four endings (-e, -st, -t, and -en). To conjugate a regular verb in the present tense, just drop the -en from the infinitive and add the appropriate ending to the stem. The endings are -e, -st, -t, -en, -t, -en, and -en. The following verb table shows how to conjugate the verb kommen (to come). The present-tense endings are marked in bold. Notice that three of the conjugated forms — first-person plural wir (we), third-person plural sie (they), and formal second-person plural Sie (you) — are identical to the infinitive itself.

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

337

(Make sure you know the meanings of the subject pronouns by checking Table 3-1 earlier in this chapter.) kommen (to come) ich komme

wir kommen

du kommst

ihr kommt

er/sie/es kommt

sie kommen Sie kommen

Er kommt aus Irland. (He comes from Ireland.) If the verb stem ends in -d or -t, place an e in front of the verb endings -st and -t. The following table shows you how to conjugate the regular verb arbeiten (to work) in the present tense. The stem arbeit- ends in -t, so you add an e before the verb endings for the second- and third-person singular (du arbeitest, er/ sie/es arbeitet) and the second-person plural familiar form (ihr arbeitet). arbeiten (to work) ich arbeite

wir arbeiten

du arbeitest

ihr arbeitet

Book III

er/sie/es arbeitet

sie arbeiten

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Sie arbeiten Du arbeitest sehr schnell. (You work very fast.) Note: Both English and German sometimes insert extra vowels to make a verb understandable. Just try saying she teachs as one syllable — it’s not easy. English adds an e before the -s so teaches expands to two syllables; the listener can then recognize that the speaker is using the third-person singular. German adds -est and -et to du arbeit- and er/sie/es arbeit- for the same reason: pronunciation. Adding the e lets speakers pronounce arbeitet with three syllables. With a few verbs that don’t have an -en infinitive ending, notably wandern (to hike) and tun (to do), drop -n from the infinitive and add only -n to ✓ The first-person plural form: wir wandern (we hike) and wir tun (we do) ✓ The third-person plural form: sie wandern (they hike) and sie tun (they do) ✓ The formal second-person singular and plural form: Sie wandern (you hike) and Sie tun (you do)

338

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Here are some other common regular German verbs; you use the regular conjugation on all of them: ✓ bringen (to bring)

✓ finden (to find, to have an opinion)

✓ reisen (to travel)

✓ gehen (to go, to walk) ✓ heißen (to be called, to be named) ✓ kaufen (to buy) ✓ kennen (to know [a person])

✓ lernen (to learn)

✓ sagen (to say) ✓ schreiben (to write)

✓ spielen (to play [a game, cards])

✓ wohnen (to live)

✓ kosten (to cost) The following examples show what a conjugated regular verb looks like in a sentence: Was spielt ihr? (What are you playing?) Sabina und Moritz reisen nach Australien. (Sabina and Moritz are traveling to Australia.) Der Computer kostet 599€. (The computer costs 599€.) Meine Großmutter und ich heißen beide Monika. (My grandmother and I are both called Monika.) Schreibst du oft Briefe? (Do you often write letters?) Ich wandere sehr gern in den Bergen. (I like to hike in the mountains.) Manfred kommt heute Abend spät nach Hause. (Manfred is coming home late this evening.) Kennt ihr den Mann da drüben? (Do you know the man over there?) Ja, mein Mann arbeitet mit ihm in derselben Firma. (Yes, my husband works with him in the same company.) Wohin gehen Sie? (Where are you going?) Heute kaufen Florian und Maria ein Auto. (Florian and Maria are buying a car today.)

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

339

Conjugating verbs with spelling changes The verbs in this section are more or less regular, but their stems undergo a few small changes in spelling. Luckily — or unluckily, depending on how you see it — many of the spelling-change verbs are frequently used, so perhaps you can acquire them by osmosis! You may notice that some of the verbs here are cognates, words that come from a common ancestor and are often similar in meaning and spelling. For instance, fallen and to fall are the same, taking into account the German infinitive ending –en. The same goes for helfen and to help. These verbs with spelling changes are technically classified as verbs with stem-vowel changes because — you guessed it — the vowel(s) in the stem changes when you conjugate the verb. The stem is the part of the infinitive left after you slice off the -en ending: Sprechen (to speak) is the infinitive, and sprech- is the stem. The stem-vowel changes take place in the du and er/sie/es forms (and in one verb type, the ich form). When dealing with these types of verbs, you encounter the following changes: ✓ a→ä and au→äu (laufen [to run])

Book III

✓ e→i (geben [to give]) ✓ e→ie (sehen [to see]) ✓ e→i (nehmen [to take]); also, consonant changes from hm to mm (see the nehmen verb table) ✓ i→ei (wissen [to know as a fact]); also, ich and er/sie/es forms have no endings (see the wissen verb table) The next five tables show each of these stem-vowel changes, along with the additional changes in nehmen (to take) and wissen (to know as a fact). In these tables, only the stem-vowel changing verb forms are in bold. fahren (to drive): a→ä ich fahre

wir fahren

du fährst

ihr fahrt

er/sie/es fährt

sie fahren Sie fahren

Du fährst sehr vorsichtig. (You drive very carefully.)

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

340

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Other a→ä verbs include the following: ✓ backen (to bake)

✓ laufen (to run)

✓ fallen (to fall)

✓ schlafen (to sleep)

✓ gefallen (to like, to enjoy)

✓ tragen (to carry, to wear)

✓ halten (to stop, to think about)

✓ waschen (to wash)

sprechen (to speak): e→i ich spreche

wir sprechen

du sprichst

ihr sprecht

er/sie/es spricht

sie sprechen Sie sprechen

Adrienne spricht fließend Englisch, Deutsch, und Französisch. (Adrienne speaks fluent English, German, and French.) Here are some other e→i verbs: ✓ essen (to eat) ✓ geben (to give) ✓ helfen (to help) ✓ vergessen (to forget) lesen (to read): e→ie ich lese

wir lesen

du liest

ihr lest

er/sie/es liest

sie lesen Sie lesen

Das Kind liest schon Romane. (The child already reads novels.) Sehen (to see) is also an e→ie verb.

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

341

nehmen (to take): e→i, hm→mm ich nehme

wir nehmen

du nimmst

ihr nehmt

er/sie/es nimmt

sie nehmen Sie nehmen

Du nimmst zu viele Kekse! (You’re taking too many cookies!)

wissen (to know as a fact): i→ei ich weiß

wir wissen

du weißt

ihr wisst

er/sie/es weiß

sie wissen Sie wissen

Weißt du, wer das ist? (Do you know who that is?) Note: When you use wissen to refer to information in the sentence, you use a comma to separate the two clauses. The following examples illustrate how stem-vowel-change verbs appear in a sentence. Notice in these examples that the stem-vowel changes take place in the du and er/sie/es (second-person singular familiar and third-person singular). Helena läuft am schnellsten. (Helena runs the fastest.) Sie sieht sehr schlecht ohne Brille. (She sees very poorly without glasses.) Mein Vater gibt mir viel Geld. (My father gives/is giving me a lot of money.) Was esst ihr zum Frühstück? (What do you eat/are you eating for breakfast?) Meistens schläft das Baby nur bis 5.00 Uhr. (The baby usually sleeps only until 5 a.m.) Wohin fährst du am Wochenende? (Where are you driving to/going on the weekend?) Ludwig spricht Deutsch mit einem schwäbischen Akzent. (Ludwig speaks German with a Swabian accent.) (Swabia is a region in the southwest of Germany.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

342

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Conjugating the irregulars haben and sein: To have and to be To have and to be: It sounds like a cross between a book title by an adventurous journalist turned author and a famous quote in English literature or a remake of a movie from the 1940s. Whatever comes to mind when you think of these two verbs, haben (to have) and sein (to be) are stars in their own right. These two common verbs are irregular. Just as in English, you come across them as full-fledged, free-standing, autonomous verbs and as auxiliary (helping) verbs. The auxiliary verb function of haben and sein is to work with other verbs in a frequently used verb tense: the present perfect. (For more on auxiliary verbs, see Book III, Chapter 6, and for more on the present perfect, go to Book IV, Chapter 4.) In this section, you see how haben and sein look in the present tense, and you discover how the English and German uses of these verbs compare.

Haben: Let me have it Look at the conjugation of haben in the present tense. Notice that the verb actually has only two irregular verb forms: du hast and er/sie/es hat. The rest of the forms follow the regular verb conjugation pattern of taking the stem (in this case hab-) and adding the usual ending. haben (to have) ich habe

wir haben

du hast

ihr habt

er/sie/es hat

sie haben Sie haben

Sie hat eine grosse Familie. (She has a large family.) German, like English, has many expressions that involve the verb to have. Many of them are the same in German and in English: Zeit haben (to have time). Others aren’t. For example, English has two ways to express that something is absolutely necessary, must and have to. German has only one, müssen (must): Ich muß anfangen. (I have to start.) In other cases, like those that follow, German uses the verb haben when English has a different construction: ✓ When expressing likes with haben and the adverb gern: Gern means gladly, with pleasure when you use it alone, but it means to like when you pair it with haben. When expressing likes, you usually place gern at the end of the sentence: Hast du klassische Musik gern? (Do you like classical music?)

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

343

✓ When talking about your birthday: For example, Ich habe am achten Oktober Geburtstag. (My birthday is on the eighth of October.) ✓ When using expressions that describe a physical condition, an emotional condition, or a state of being: Some common expressions are

• Angst haben (to be afraid)

• Dienst haben (to be on duty)

• Durst haben (to be thirsty)

• Glück haben (to be lucky, to be fortunate)

• Hunger haben (to be hungry)

• Lust haben (to feel like [doing something])

• Recht haben (to be right) Look at the following example sentences that use the verb haben: Hast du einen Hund? (Do you have a dog?) Nein, ich habe eine Katze. (No, I have a cat.) Wann habt ihr Zeit? (When do you have time?) Wir haben kein Wasser. (We don’t have any water.)

Book III

Ein Polizist hat immer Recht. (A policeman is always right.)

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Sie haben wenig Geld. (They have little money.)

Sein: To be or not to be Look at the conjugation of sein (to be) in the present tense. Notice that all the verb forms are irregular, although wir sind, sie sind, and Sie sind are identical. Remember that regular verb conjugations in the present tense also have the same endings for wir, sie, and Sie pronouns; consider the regular verb gehen (to go, to walk): wir gehen, sie gehen, and Sie gehen. sein (to be) ich bin

wir sind

du bist

ihr seid

er/sie/es ist

sie sind Sie sind

Sind Sie Herr Schumpich? (Are you Mr. Schumpich?)

344

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication The verb sein is a true workhorse in German. Not only does it tell you what is and what isn’t, but it can also help you form the present perfect — although haben is the main auxiliary verb for that task. (For more information on the present perfect tense, see Book IV, Chapter 4.) German and English use the verb sein (to be) in similar ways. For example, What’s your boss like? Is it time yet? Who’s that? Is it quiet? Are you ready? No, we’re not. Am I too old? How much is that? What’s up? Where are we? Isn’t she funny? Where are you? I’m lost. Here’s how you can use sein: ✓ With an adjective: Du bist sehr lustig. (You’re very funny.) Mein Sohn ist nicht musikalisch. (My son is not musical.) Some expressions in German use the verb sein with an adjective plus a noun or pronoun in the dative case. (For the lowdown on cases, refer to Book III, Chapter 2.) A couple of common expressions are Mir ist kalt/warm. (I’m cold/warm.) Mir is the dative case of the pronoun ich. Ihm ist schlecht/übel. (He’s feeling sick/sick to his stomach.) Ihm is the dative case of the pronoun er. ✓ With an adverb: Wir sind morgen nicht hier. (We’re not here tomorrow.) Sie ist dort. (She’s there.) ✓ With nouns: Sind Sie Kanadier? (Are you a Canadian?) Ich bin Bauingenieur. (I’m a civil engineer.) Note that German leaves out the article ein (a) for professions and nationalities. (See Book III, Chapter 2 for more information.) A few German expressions using sein are expressed slightly differently from their English equivalents: ✓ Wie ist ihre Telefonnummer/Adresse? (What’s your phone number/ address? Literally, wie means how.) (Book III, Chapter 4 deals with questions.) ✓ Hier ist Frau Becker. (I’m Mrs. Becker. You’d use this expression to identify yourself on the telephone.) ✓ Ihr seid hier richtig. (You’re in the right place.)

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

345

Expressing yourself using haben and sein You find all kinds of idioms that use the verbs haben and sein in German and English. German speakers use them in everyday situations when talking with people they know. So when you use such expressions, your German sounds more like a native’s. The idioms in the following lists are used in informal situations, so use them only with people you know fairly well. You can gauge the appropriateness of the expressions by looking at the English equivalent. The example sentences in these lists use a variety of personal pronouns so you can see the conjugations of the verbs haben and sein. Here are some common (and colorful) idioms with haben: ✓ Ich habe es satt. (I’m fed up with it.) ✓ Er hat die Nase voll. (He’s fed up.) ✓ Ich hab’s. (I get it!/I’ve got it!) ✓ Sie haben es eilig. (They’re in a hurry.) ✓ Du hast einen Vogel. (You’re crazy.) ✓ Sie hat nichts dagegen. (She has nothing against it.) ✓ Ich habe eine weiße Weste. (I have a clear conscience.) ✓ Er hat ein dickes Fell. (He’s got a thick skin.) (In other words, he doesn’t get upset easily.) ✓ Sie hat viel auf dem Gewissen. (She has a lot to answer for.) ✓ Ich habe zwei linke Hände. (I’m really clumsy. Literally: I have two left hands.) ✓ Wir haben alle Hände voll zu tun. (We’ve got our hands full.) ✓ Du hast eine lange Leitung. (You’re slow on the uptake.) ✓ Er hat eine spitze Zunge. (He has a sharp tongue.)

✓ Sie hat Köpfchen/Verstand. (She’s got brains/sense.) Here are a few common idioms with sein:

✓ Sie sind in guten Händen. (You’re in good hands.) ✓ Wir sind gut in Form. (We’re going strong.) ✓ Er ist auf Draht. (He knows his stuff.) ✓ Das ist für die Katze. (It’s for the birds.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

346

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication ✓ Ich bin mit meinem Latein am Ende. (I’m stumped.) ✓ Er ist pleite. (He’s broke.) ✓ Du bist gut! (You’re a fine one!) This is a sarcastic type of comment. ✓ Ich bin gespannt. (I’m curious.) ✓ Er ist ein Angsthase. (He’s a wimp.) ✓ Er ist ein Spielverderber. (He’s a spoilsport.) ✓ Du bist in guter Laune. (You’re in a good mood.) The following expressions begin with es ist (it is): ✓ Es ist nur eine Frage der Zeit. (It’s only a matter of time.) ✓ Es ist gang und gäbe. (It’s common practice.) ✓ Es ist höchste Zeit. (It’s high time.) ✓ Es ist mir egal. (It’s all the same to me./I don’t care.) ✓ Es ist der Mühe wert. (It’s worth the trouble.)

Using the Very Versatile Present Tense When you want to gain confidence speaking and writing in any language, you work on polishing your verb skills so you feel competent using the present, past, and future tenses. In German, grasping the present tense opens the door to several ways of expressing yourself. When you want to talk about something in German, first figure out whether you can use the present tense. In virtually all the situations where you use the present in English, you also use the present in German. In addition, you have a lot of opportunities to use the present tense in German when you have to use other verb tenses in English. The primary difference in usage is that English has a continuous verb form and German doesn’t. English uses the present continuous (our guests are staying until Sunday) to indicate that an action is happening now, and it uses the present tense for habitual actions or facts without expressing whether the action is going on at the time (my brother lives on a lake). Because German doesn’t verbally express such time distinctions, the listener can interpret sentences such as Was denkst du? in two ways: What are you thinking?/ What’s on your mind? or What do you think?/What’s your opinion?

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

347

Look at Table 3-2 for three ways to translate one German sentence into English.

Table 3-2 English Present Tense Translations for German Present German Present Tense

Possible English Translations

Intended Idea

Jörg spielt sehr gut Basketball.

Jörg plays basketball very well.

Stating a general fact, common knowledge (simple present)

Jörg spielt sehr gut Basketball.

Jörg is playing basketball very well.

Happening now, today, this week, and so on (present continuous)

Jörg spielt sehr gut Basketball.

Jörg does play basketball very well.

Showing emphasis or contradicting someone’s opinion (simple present with auxiliary do)

We aren’t kidding when we say the simple present tense in German is versatile! You even use it to talk about future plans, predictions, spontaneous decisions made at the time of speaking, and activities that started in the past and are still going on. Table 3-3 shows how German uses the present tense for talking about the future and the past.

Table 3-3

Future and Present Perfect Tense Translations for German Present

German Present Tense

English Translations with Other Tenses

Intended Idea

Wir treffen uns um acht Uhr, oder?

We’re meeting/going to meet at eight o’clock, aren’t we?

Stating a plan or intention

Vielleicht regnet es morgen.

Maybe it’ll rain tomorrow.

Predicting or speculating

Warte mal, ich helfe dir. (colloquial)

Wait a sec, I’ll help you.

Making a spontaneous decision at the time of speaking, such as offering help or promising

Sie arbeitet seit 20 Jahren bei der Firma.

She’s been working at the company for 20 years.

Expressing an action that started in the past and is still going

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

348

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Stating Information with the Passive When you hear the term passive in relation to German grammar, it’s not talking about a lion that lies on its back and lets you rub its tummy. What it is talking about is the passive voice. To really get a handle on passive voice, you first need to realize that it isn’t a tense. Then you need to distinguish between active voice and passive voice. When an action is in the active voice, the emphasis is on the subject of the sentence as the “agent” that carries out the action of the verb. In contrast, with the passive voice, the person or thing carrying out the action is deemphasized; the receiver of the action is the focus of attention. In sentences that are in the passive voice, the subject may or may not be mentioned. English makes more use of the passive than German. The following example sentences show how you can express the same basic information in the active voice and in the passive voice: ✓ Jedes Jahr erntet der Bauer das Getreide. (The farmer harvests the grain every year.) This is the active voice; the emphasis is on the agent, der Bauer (the farmer), who carries out the action of harvesting the grain. ✓ Jedes Jahr wird das Getreide vom Bauer geerntet. (The grain is harvested every year by the farmer.) This is the passive voice; the action of harvesting the grain is more important. The agent, der Bauer (the farmer), is less important. ✓ Jedes Jahr wird das Getreide geerntet. (The grain is harvested every year.) This is the passive voice; the important information is the action of harvesting the grain. The agent, der Bauer (the farmer), isn’t even mentioned. In cases like this, it’s often obvious or unnecessary to include the subject info.

Forming the passive To understand how to form the passive, you need to keep in mind that passive (and active) voice forms aren’t tenses. You can put the passive (and active) into the present, past, future, or any other tense. In this section, you see how to form the passive in the present tense. To form the passive, German uses the verb werden as a helping (or auxiliary) verb together with the past participle form of the verb being expressed in the passive. English uses the verb to be as the helping verb to form the passive. In a passive sentence, you translate werden by using the corresponding

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

349

conjugated form of the verb to be. Word order in passive sentences follows the basic rule for German sentences: The conjugated or auxiliary verb is in second position in the phrase or sentence, and the main verb (in this case, the past participle of the verb) goes at the end of the phrase or sentence. (For more information on word order, turn to Book III, Chapter 1.) Werden is a multitalented verb that has several uses and several meanings. As a main verb, it can mean to become or to get, but it also acts as an auxiliary verb to form the future tense. In the future tense, it means will. (For the lowdown on the future tense, flip to Book IV, Chapter 6.) The following table shows the present tense conjugation of werden, which is what you use to form passive sentences in the present tense. werden (to be in passive voice) ich werde

wir werden

du wirst

ihr werdet

er/sie/es wird

sie werden Sie werden

Die Benzinpreise werden ständig erhöht. (Gasoline prices are raised/are being raised constantly.) The following example illustrates how to form the German passive in the present tense: Der President wird vom Volk gewählt. (The president is elected by the people.) In this sentence, you use the present tense form of werden, which is wird, and the past participle of wählen, which is gewählt. To form other passive voice sentences in the past or the future, you use the corresponding verb tense of werden in combination with the past participle of the main verb. For example: Die unendliche Geschichte wurde von Michael Ende geschrieben. (The Never Ending Story was written by Michael Ende.) Wurde is the simple past conjugated form of werden. Wurde . . . geschrieben (was written) is the past passive form of the verb schreiben (to write).

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

350

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication In a passive sentence, you use von (by) to introduce the subject or agent when the agent is a person, as shown in the preceding example sentence. When the subject is a thing, you usually use durch (by, through, by means of). Look at the following example: In fast jedem Krieg werden viele Zivlisten durch Bomben getötet. (In nearly every war, many civilians are killed by bombs.) An active sentence with the same information looks like this: Bomben töten viele Zivilisten in fast jedem Krieg. (Bombs kill many civilians in nearly every war.)

Using the passive In German, you come across the passive far less often than in English. Where you do find it is in the written language, for example, in newspapers, instructions, and technical manuals. To illustrate how to use passive voice, Table 3-4 shows the same information in both active and passive voice.

Table 3-4

Contrasting Active and Passive Voice

Active Voice

Passive Voice

Die Werkstatt repariert heute mein Auto. (The garage is repairing my car today.)

Mein Auto wird heute repariert. (My car is being repaired today.)

Menschen verbreiten viele Gerüchte über das Internet. (People spread a lot of rumors on the Internet.)

Viele Gerüchte werden über das Internet verbreitet. (A lot of rumors are spread on the Internet.)

Lehrer unterrichten selten Deutsch an amerikanischen Gymnasien. (Teachers seldom teach German in American high schools.)

Deutsch wird selten an amerikanischen Gymnasien unterrichtet. (German is seldom taught in American high schools.)

Wir teilen uns die Hausarbeit. (We share the housework.)

Die Hausarbeit wird von uns geteilt. (The housework is shared by us.)

Man findet keine Pinguine in der Arktis. (You don’t find penguins in the Arctic.)

Pinguine werden in der Arktis nicht gefunden. (Penguins aren’t found in the Arctic.)

Chapter 3: Dealing with the Here and Now: The Present Tense

351

Recognizing the impersonal passive The impersonal passive expresses action in the passive without a direct object of the sentence. Constructions like this don’t exist in English, so the equivalent sentence in English may sound a bit unusual. The following list offers some important points about constructing impersonal passive sentences and provides examples: ✓ German impersonal sentences frequently use the placeholder es. For example, Es wird gefeiert. (Partying is going on./There is partying going on.) In this sentence, es (it) is a placeholder, not the subject of the sentence. The sentence doesn’t have a direct object. ✓ Sometimes the placeholder es is absent, as in Hier wird aufgeräumt. (Cleaning is going on here.) Another way to convey this thought in English is It’s here that cleaning is going on. Again, this sentence doesn’t have a direct object. ✓ With passive sentences that have conjunctions such as weil (because) or dass (that), the placeholder es (it) is left out of the sentence. Ich höre, dass heute nicht gearbeitet wird. (I hear that there’s no work going on today./I hear no work is being done today.) Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

352

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Chapter 4

Asking and Answering Questions In This Chapter ▶ Asking questions ▶ Responding with yes or no ▶ Using wo- and da- compounds to keep things interesting ▶ Being diplomatic when you agree and disagree

A

sking questions puts you in the conversational driver’s seat. You use questions to initiate dialogues, find out what you need to know, and clarify information you’re not sure about. When you’re studying a new language, you may find that your counterpart is speaking so fast that you can barely understand the first word, let alone the barrage that follows. You feel like asking where the stop button (or at least the rewind button) is, but instead, you ask, Können Sie das bitte wiederholen? (Could you repeat that, please?) But you’re still in the back seat, and your goal is to get behind the wheel. How you achieve that is simple: You implement effective question techniques. Answering questions is just as important as asking them. Knowing how to formulate your replies to questions either positively or negatively involves a bit of diplomacy. After all, you want to sound polite. This chapter gets you up to speed on formulating all kinds of questions and answers, including the means to soften a blunt “no” reply.

Knowing How to Formulate Questions Anytime you want to start a conversation with a stranger, you’re bound to ask questions. For example, when you go into a store and need some help from the salesperson, you need to know how to ask a few basic questions about the merchandise. The following section guides you through some very useful language to get you up and running as you go out and ask questions.

354

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Inverting word order for yes/no questions German word order is easy to follow when you form a question that merits a yes or no answer. You simply flip the subject and the conjugated (main) verb: The verb is in first place, and the subject is in second place (where the verb usually goes in statements). English is more complicated because you usually use the auxiliary (helping) verb to do or to be together with the main verb; in English, only the auxiliary verb goes in first place. Take a look at the following German questions and their translations: Leben Sie in einer Großstadt? (Do you live in a large city?) Bleibt sie hier? (Is she staying here?) Ist es kalt bei Ihnen im Winter? (Is it cold where you live in the winter?) The German present tense encompasses two English verb tenses (and more). The present continuous doesn’t exist in German, so in the second question here, you use the present. (See Book III, Chapter 3 for more on the present tense.) The inverted word order in German is the same for both the present tense and present continuous tense in English. The following examples are a few yes/no questions you may hear or want to ask at a Reiseauskunft (travel information) counter when you’re thinking of traveling to Berlin by train: Kann ich hier Tickets kaufen? (Can I buy tickets here?) Note: You may also use the word Fahrkarten for tickets. Reisen Sie nach Berlin hin und zurück? (Are you going round-trip to Berlin?) Wollen Sie ein Ticket 1. Klasse oder 2. Klasse nehmen? (Do you want a first- or second-class ticket?) Ist das Ticket 1. Klasse sehr teuer? (Is the first-class ticket very expensive?) Fährt ein Zug am Nachmittag? (Is there a train leaving in the afternoon?) Gibt es ein gutes Hotel am Bahnhof in Berlin? (Is there a good hotel at the train station in Berlin?) Haben Sie viel Gepäck dabei? (Do you have much luggage with you?)

Gathering information with question words: Who, what, why, and more When kids reach the age of asking why, it’s marvelous at first, but after weeks of nonstop questioning, you may wonder whether they’re practicing for a career in some government spy agency. Asking why is a kid’s way of engaging

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

355

an adult in conversation just as much as it’s a way of gathering information. As you progress in German, you need question words (interrogative pronouns) such as who, what, where, and when to gather specific information, but you can also use the kid’s tactic of asking wer (who), was (what), warum (why), and so on to engage people in conversation. This particular tactic is useful because it gives you more control over the direction of the discussion. The inverted word order for yes/no questions (see the preceding section) is the same for information-gathering questions, only the question word (or phrase) comes first. Thus, the word order for info-gathering questions is ­question word + verb + subject, as in Warum ist der Himmel blau? (Why is the sky blue?) and Wann fahren wir nach Hause? (When are we driving home?) Table 4-1 lists frequently used German question words and phrases, their English equivalents, and an example question for each.

Table 4-1

Question Words and Example Questions

Question Word

Example Question

English Translation

wie (how)

Wie heißen Sie?

What is your name?

wie viele (how many)

Wie viele Personen arbeiten in Ihrer Firma?

How many people work in your company?

wie viel (how much)

Wie viel kostet die Karte?

How much is the ticket?

wie lange (how long)

Wie lange dauert die Fahrt nach St. Anton?

How long does the trip take to St. Anton?

wie oft (how often)

Wie oft esst ihr Pizza?

How often do you eat pizza?

wie weit (how far)

Wie weit ist es bis Leipzig?

How far is it to Leipzig?

was (what)

Was machen wir nach der Pause?

What are we doing after the break?

was für (what kind of)

Was für ein Auto fahren Sie?

What kind of car do you drive?

wann (when)

Wann beginnt das Konzert?

When does the concert begin?

wo (where)

Wo wohnen Sie?

Where do you live?

woher (where . . . from)

Woher kommen Sie?

Where are you from?

wohin (where . . . [to])

Wohin fährt der Bus?

Where does the bus go (to)? (continued)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

356

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 4-1 (continued) Question Word

Example Question

English Translation

welcher/welche/ welches (which)

Welche Straßenbahn soll ich nehmen? (die Straßenbahn)

Which tram should I take?

wer (nominative) (who)

Wer ist Ihr Chef?

Who is your boss?

warum (why)

Warum hält der Zug jetzt (an)?

Why is the train stopping now?

weshalb (why)

Weshalb gibt es hier kein Wifi?

Why is there no WiFi here?

wieso (why)

Wieso lachst du?

Why are you laughing?

bis wann (until when)

Bis wann arbeitest du heute Abend?

Until what time are you working this evening?

für wen (who . . . for)

Für wen ist das Paket?

Who is the package for?

seit wann (since when)

Seit wann hast du ein Pferd?

Since when have you had a horse?

wen (accusative) (whom, who) wem (dative) (who) wessen (genitive) (whose)

Here are a couple of points to keep in mind regarding Table 4-1: ✓ Welcher/welche/welches (which) is an interrogative pronoun with three versions to correspond with the three noun genders der/die/ das: welcher Computer (which computer), welche Frau (which woman), welches Auto (which car). Remember that it has adjective endings — in other words, the case endings of the noun it’s describing. For example, consider Mit welchem Bus soll ich fahren? (Which bus should I take? Literally: With which bus should I drive/travel?). The preposition mit uses the dative case, and der Bus is masculine, so mit welchem Bus uses the masculine dative singular form of welch- in the prepositional phrase. Note: Welcher/welche/welches words follow the same pattern of case and gender endings that you see in der words. (For more information on der words, go to Book III, Chapter 2.) ✓ Wer (who) is an interrogative pronoun that has three other forms. Wer is the nominative case, wen (whom, who) is accusative, wem (who) is dative, and wessen (whose) is genitive.

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

357

The following example questions are the type you may want to ask when you’re inquiring about a language course at a Sprachenschule (language school): Wie viel kostet so ein Sprachkurs? (How much does such a language course cost?) Wie viele Stunden ist es? (How many hours is it?) Warum ist es so teuer? (Why is it so expensive?) Wer macht den Unterricht? (Who is teaching the class?) Wie heißt die Lehrerin? (What is the teacher’s name?) Woher kommt sie? (Where is she from?) Wann können wir anfangen? (When can we begin?)

Forming indirect questions Sometimes you want to find out something from someone, but you don’t want to ask a direct question. If you want to be sneaky about getting answers, you can use an indirect question. For instance, when you’re speculating about something and you want to pose a type of question that doesn’t sound as much like a question, you can start with one of the following expressions: Wissen Sie, . . . . (Do you know. . . ?) Können Sie mir sagen, . . . . (Can you tell me. . . ?) Ich frage mich, . . . . (I wonder. . . .) Wir möchten gern wissen, . . . . (We’d really like to know. . . .) Er hätte gern gewusst, . . . . (He was wondering. . . .) Jeder stellt sich die Frage, . . . . (Everyone is wondering. . . .) Mich würde interessieren, . . . . (I was wondering. . . .) To form the rest of the indirect question, you can use a couple of different types of words to connect the indirect expression (from the preceding list) with the thought that you’re formulating. These include question words such as wann (when) or wo (where). When you don’t want to use a question word, you use the conjunction ob (whether/if). Here are two other practices to keep in mind when forming indirect questions: ✓ You need a comma after the expression. In English, you don’t need a comma. ✓ In the phrase following the indirect question expression, the verb goes at the end of the sentence.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

358

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication The following examples combine indirect question expressions with other information to make complete sentences: Wissen Sie, wo die nächste U-Bahn Station ist? (Do you know where the nearest subway station is?) Können Sie mir sagen, ob morgen ein Feiertag ist? (Can you tell me if tomorrow is a holiday?) Ich frage mich, welche Familie hier lebt. (I wonder which family lives here.) Wir möchten gern wissen, wann sie endlich heiraten. (We’d really like to know when they’re finally getting married.) Er hätte gern gewusst, warum sein Chef nicht im Büro ist. (He was wondering why his boss isn’t in the office.) Jeder stellt sich die Frage, ob dieser Winter wieder so kalt wird. (Everyone is wondering whether this is going to be a cold winter again.) Mich würde interessieren, wie dieses Gerät funktioniert. (I was wondering how this device works.)

Checking information: Tag! You’re it, aren’t you? When you’re talking to someone and you want to check some information, you may say something like this, expecting the listener to agree with you: The mall opens at 10, doesn’t it? The same tactic is handy when you’re not sure whether the other person is actually listening to you or is more engrossed in the game on TV. As you delve into the depths of the German language, you may wonder at how much more complicated German grammar seems than English grammar. Then you stumble upon the realm of tag questions, and you giggle at how simple it is to play tag in German. A tag question is simply what you tack onto the end of a statement to make it into a question. In English, the tag depends on the subject and verb in the statement. The possibilities are practically endless in English: isn’t she?, do you?, can’t you?, wasn’t it?, were you?, wouldn’t it?, are you?, and so on. The German equivalent is far simpler. To form a tag question in German, just add nicht? (Literally: not?) or nicht wahr? (Literally: not true?) to the end of the sentence. Some more expressions that have the same function in German are Stimmt das? (Is that true?), Oder? (Literally: Or?), and Richtig? (Correct?). These expressions serve the

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

359

same function as the long list of tag question equivalents in English: to elicit a sign of agreement or disagreement or even just a grunt of acknowledgment from the listener. You can use the tag questions interchangeably regardless of whether you’re talking about something in the past, present, or future or something that’s negative or positive, because they aren’t grammatically linked to the first part of the sentence, as they are in English. Here are a couple of examples: Sie fahren morgen nach Düsseldorf, richtig? (You’re going/driving to Düsseldorf tomorrow, aren’t you?) Der Film war nicht besonders gut, nicht? (The movie wasn’t especially good, was it?) Sie wohnen in Graz, nicht wahr? (You live in Graz, don’t you?) Wir haben noch eine Stunde Zeit, oder? (We have another hour, don’t we?) Sie hat uns alle wichtigen Informationen gegeben, nicht? (She gave us all the important information, didn’t she?)

Making choices: Asking what kind of. . . ? You’re looking at a ticket machine for the public transportation system in a major German city. You know the system is really extensive because on the wall next to the machine is a huge subway/light rail map, the U-Bahn/S-Bahn Netzplan. (U-Bahn is short for Untergrundbahn [subway], and S-Bahn stands for Schnellbahn [commuter rail/light rail].) The shiny blue and silver ticket machine is a real gem from a technical standpoint, but it doesn’t look very user-friendly to Ausländer (foreigners) like you. The machine must provide lots of ticket choices because it has all kinds of buttons to push and various slots for inserting money and taking out tickets; still, no one seems to be having any trouble. You have two choices: Pretend you’re at a slot machine in Las Vegas, press a few buttons, and hope you get a ticket out of the deal, or use the phrase was für (ein) and ask a kind-looking passerby, “Was für ein Ticket brauche ich?” (“What kind of ticket do I need?”) — or, point to the ticket in her hand and ask, “Was für ein Ticket ist das?” (“What kind of a ticket is that?”) Obviously, we suggest you try the second option: To form this type of question, you use the phrase was für (ein) with a noun as the subject (nominative case) or the direct object (accusative case) of a question. To see how this works, consider these two questions: Was für ein Ticket ist das? (What kind of a ticket is that?) In this question, you start with was für. Next, you add the subject of the sentence, ein Ticket (a ticket), and then the verb ist (is) and das (that, indicating the ticket the passenger is holding).

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

360

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Was für ein Ticket brauche ich? (What kind of ticket do I need?) This question starts the same way with was für, followed by ein Ticket, which is the object of the sentence. The verb brauche (need) comes next, followed by the subject of the question, ich (I).

If you’re having trouble figuring out what a subject (nominative case) is and what a direct object (accusative case) is, turn the question into a normal, declarative sentence. To Was für ein Ticket ist das? you may hear the answer Das ist eine Streifenkarte. (That’s a strip ticket.) Eine Streifenkarte is nominative case; you use it with the verb sein (to be). In response to Was für ein Ticket brauche ich? you may hear Sie brauchen eine Streifenkarte. (You need a strip ticket.) The subject is Sie, in nominative case, and the object is eine Streifenkarte, in accusative case. Table 4-2 shows the breakdown of the grammatical structure for asking was für ein. . . ? (what kind of. . . ?) Notice the case and gender endings of the subject and object in each question. Remember that the preposition für in was für doesn’t determine the case; rather, the other information in the question does so.

Table 4-2

Was Für: Showing Case and Gender Endings

Gender/ Number

Nominative (Was Für. . . ?)

Translation

Accusative (Was Für. . . ?)

Translation

Masculine

Was für ein Fahrschein ist das?

What kind of ticket is that?

Was für einen Fahrschein brauche ich?

What kind of ticket do I need?

Feminine

Was für eine Fahrkarte ist das?

What kind of ticket is that?

Was für eine Fahrkarte brauche ich?

What kind of ticket do I need?

Neuter

Was für ein Bier ist das?

What kind of beer is that?

Was für ein Bier trinken Sie?

What kind of beer are you drinking?

Plural

Was für Geschäfte sind hier im Ort? (no article needed)

What kinds of shops are (there) in this town?

Was für Geschäfte verkaufen Bierkrüge?

What kinds of shops sell beer steins?

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

361

Answering with Yes You’re listening to your aunt as she talks on the phone in the room next toyou; you know the conversation isn’t very interesting because all you hear is yes, yes, yeah, yes, yeah, yes. Your aunt is probably employing most of those yeses for more than answering a question; she’s likely signaling that she’s still listening or is simply being polite. If she were in the same room as the person she’s talking to, she probably wouldn’t even need to talk — she could simply bob her head around, nodding in agreement or shaking it to express disagreement. Knowing how to say ja (yes) in German is essential whether you’re answering questions, responding to information, or agreeing with others, but in many situations, you need more than a one-word “yes” answer to clearly express yourself. Lucky for you, this section is here to help. In it, you discover various ways to clearly express yes.

Variations on yes When you want to show someone that you understand, that you’re listening, and so on, you use ja (yes) and its extended family: Ja, das ist richtig. (Yes, that’s right.) In these instances, all you have to do is add ja to what you want to say. You use ja the way you do in English — to answer a question in the affirmative or to say that you agree to something. It can stand alone, or if ja is in a sentence, it generally comes at the beginning of an affirmative sentence, just as it does in English. When you get bored with saying ja all the time, try a few variations that render the same meaning with slightly different emphasis. Table 4-3 lists nine alternatives for good old ja. The English explanations describe the implications behind these common substitutes, and the example sentences put them into context.

Table 4-3

Alternatives for Ja

Ja Equivalent

Translation — Explanation

Example Sentence

Translation

genau

exactly, precisely — sounds stilted in English, but not so to the German ear

Genau, mein Familienname ist Schranner.

Exactly, my family name is Schranner. (continued)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

362

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 4-3 (continued) Ja Equivalent

Translation — Explanation

Example Sentence

Translation

gewiss

of course, sure enough— somewhat formal-sounding inGerman

Gewiss. Sie werden um 7.00 Uhr geweckt.

Of course. You’ll be woken up at 7 a.m.

ja, ja

yes, yes — can express enthusiasm or skepticism

Ja, ja, das weiß ich schon.

Yes, yes, I already know that.

jawohl

exactly — has a somewhat formal ring

Jawohl, meine Frau kommt aus Sydney.

Exactly, my wife is from Sydney.

klar

of course (Literally: clear or clearly) — somewhat casual, colloquial tone

Klar kann ich segeln.

Of course I know how to sail.

natürlich

naturally — neutral, neither formal nor colloquial

Natürlich helfen wir Ihnen.

Naturally, we’ll help you.

richtig

right — neutral, neither formal nor colloquial

Richtig. Er mietet ein Auto.

Right. He’s renting a car.

selbstverständlich

certainly — good choice for business, formal situations

Selbstverständlich lade ich Sie zum Mittagessen ein.

Certainly, I’m inviting you to lunch.

sicher

certainly, sure

Sicher mache ich das Licht aus.

Sure, I’ll turn off the light.

Notice in the example sentences in Table 4-3, when the ja substitute is followed by a comma or a period, you start the next phrase in the usual German word order of subject followed by the verb in second position. (In the example sentences, the comma and period are interchangeable.) When the ja replacement word functions as the first element in the sentence (no comma or period), the verb follows in second position.

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

363

Emphasizing yes When you want to add more emphasis to show that you really understand or agree with someone, you can add ja or aber (but) to the expressions in Table4-3. Take a look at these examples: Ja, klar! (Yes, of course!) Aber natürlich! (Certainly!) Aber selbstverständlich! (Why, certainly!) Ja, sicher! (Yes, sure!) These examples place the ja words at the beginning of the sentence. However, when you want to express understanding or agreement within a sentence, you can construct sentences that use these words in more or less fixed expressions like genau richtig (exactly right) or es ist (mir) klar (it’s clear to me). In addition, genau, gewiss, klar, natürlich, richtig, selbstverständlich, and sicher can work as adjectives or in some cases as adverbs, and they have similar meanings. (See Book III, Chapter 5 for more on adjectives and adverbs.) The following list of example sentences shows you the context for how to use these yes expressions: Das wird selbstverständlich gemacht. (That will certainly be done.) Es ist mir klar, daß ich abnehmen soll. (I realize that I should lose weight. Literally: It’s clear to me that I should lose weight.) Die Straßen waren nach dem Sturm gewiss sehr gefährlich. (The streets were certainly very dangerous after the storm.) Natürlich können wir mit dem Zug nach Köln fahren. (Naturally, we can take the train to Cologne.) Richtig. Ich bin Herr Gravenstein. (Right. I’m Herr Gravenstein.) Klar geht die ganze Familie in Urlaub. (Of course the whole family is going on vacation.) Sicher, wir fliegen am Dienstag nach Genf. (Sure, we’re flying to Geneva on Tuesday.) Sie haben es genau richtig geraten. (You guessed it exactly right.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

364

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Responding with No: The Difference between Kein and Nicht Saying no in German is plain and simple: nein. However, when you want to negate an action, an object, or a person, you have two ways to express not (or not any): kein and nicht. Which one you use depends on what they negate in a sentence. The word order of these negations is important to know, as is how to form the endings of kein (nicht doesn’t change). In this section, we walk you through the steps of when and how to use nicht and kein. You also get the hang of how to avoid sounding too blunt when you’re saying no in German by using various words and expressions that soften your message.

Negating with nicht The nuts and bolts of nicht are straightforward as far as its form and use are concerned. In terms of form, nicht is all you need to know (unlike kein, which has case and gender endings — see the next section). As for use, nicht generally negates a verb — nicht einladen (not to invite), nicht fahren (not to drive, not to travel), nicht feiern (not to celebrate) — though it can also negate an adjective, as in nicht interessant (not interesting), or an adverb, as in nicht pünktlich (not on time). What you have to figure out is how to position nicht in a sentence. Because nicht is an adverb, it negates the action of the verb or modifies an adjective or an adverb, and it’s generally next to these parts of speech. For example: Sie fliegen nicht nach London. (They’re not flying to London.) Nicht directly follows the verb in this sentence, negating the idea that they’re flying. Martin spricht nicht gut Deutsch. (Martin doesn’t speak good German.) In this sentence, nicht tells you that Martin’s ability to speak German is not good, so nicht immediately follows the verb. Gestern kamen wir nicht pünktlich zum Termin. (Yesterday we didn’t get to our appointment on time.) Nicht links with the adverb pünktlich (on time) to mean not on time, so you place it before pünktlich. Das Buch ist nicht interessant. (The book isn’t interesting.) The negation connects the verb ist (is) and the adjective interessant (interesting); nicht modifies interessant, so you place it in front of the adjective.

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

365

Placement is the most complex part of nicht, but most of the time, even if you’re not perfect with word order, your listeners will be able to understand you. Table 4-4 explains some guidelines to follow when using nicht.

Table 4-4 Position of Nicht

Guidelines for Positioning Nicht Example Sentence

Translation

A conjugated verb

Maria fährt nicht nach Kiel.

Maria isn’t driving to Kiel.

A conjugated verb and precedes a separable prefix

Felix und Gretl sehen nicht fern. (Fernsehen is a separable prefix verb.)

Felix and Gretl aren’t watching TV.

Most specific adverbs of time

Ich war gestern nicht zu Hause. (Gestern is the specific adverb of time.)

I wasn’t at home yesterday.

Yes/no questions

Essen Sie den Apfel nicht?

Aren’t you going to eat the apple?

A sentence or question with a direct object

Ich kenne diesen Mann nicht. (Diesen Mann is the direct object.)

I don’t know that man.

Most adjectives

Das Hotel ist nicht gemütlich. (Gemütlich is the adjective.)

The hotel isn’t cozy.

Most adverbs, except for specific adverbs of time

Ihr lauft nicht schnell. (Schnell is the adverb.)

You don’t run fast.

Infinitives connected to a verb

Ich gehe nicht einkaufen. (Einkaufen is the infinitive.)

I’m not going shopping.

Most prepositional phrases

Dieser Käse kommt nicht aus Frankreich. (Aus Frankreich is the prepositional phrase.)

This cheese isn’t from France.

The combinations of parts in a sentence (usually)

Matthias geht nicht sehr oft in die Bibliothek. (Two parts are here — sehr oft and in die Bibliothek.)

Matthias doesn’t go to the library very often.

Follows

Comes at the end of

Precedes

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

366

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication The following pairs of questions and answers illustrate how to use nicht. After the answers, you see the reasons for the word order. Ist das dein Haus? (Is that your house?) Nein, das ist nicht mein Haus. (No, it isn’t my house.) Nicht follows the verb. Kommen Sie am Mittwoch zu uns? (Are you coming to see us on Wednesday?) Nein, am Mittwoch kommen wir nicht zu Ihnen. (No, we’re not coming on Wednesday to see you.) Nicht precedes the prepositional phrase zu Ihnen. Gehen Sie jetzt Golf spielen? (Are you going to play golf now?) Nein, ich gehe nicht Golf spielen. (No, I’m not going to play golf.) Nicht precedes the infinitive expression Golf spielen. Trinken Sie den Orangensaft nicht? (Aren’t you going to drink the orange juice?) Nein, ich trinke ihn nicht. (No, I’m not going to drink it.) Nicht follows the direct object ihn. Liegt Duisburg in einer schönen Gegend? (Is Duisburg in a pretty area?) Nein, Duisburg liegt nicht in einer schönen Gegend. (No, Duisburg isn’t in a pretty area.) Nicht precedes the prepositional phrase in einer schönen Gegend. Here are a few ready-made expressions with nicht that may help you add your two cents when you want to start with something fancier than just nein: Das ist nicht schlecht. (That’s not bad.) Just as in English, depending on how you say this, it can mean that something is actually pretty good. Das genügt nicht. (That’s not enough./That won’t do.) Das mache ich nicht mit. (I won’t have a part in that.) Ich auch nicht. (Neither am/do/can [and so on] I.) In English, you use a helping verb to say what you can’t do either; in German, you don’t need a verb to express the same thing.

Negating with kein Using kein (no, not, not any) is almost as easy as using nicht (see the preceding section). Kein functions as an adjective; it describes nouns by expressing negation such as keiner Polizist (no policeman), keine Jeans (no jeans), kein Brot (no bread), and so on. However, before you can jump in and start adding

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

367

kein to your sentences, you need to know the gender and case of the noun you’re negating. Look at the following sentence: Keiner Polizist hat einen leichten Job. (No policeman has an easy job.) Keiner Polizist is the subject of the sentence, so it’s in nominative case. Polizist is masculine (der), so you add -er to kein = keiner Polizist. Keiner is the singular masculine form of kein in nominative case. (See Book III, Chapter 2 for more on gender and case.) When you look at kein, you see the indefinite article ein (a, an). More good news on the grammar front: The indefinite article ein and other very commonly used words are often referred to as ein- words because they follow the same pattern in case and gender endings. In the nominative case, ein and kein are the masculine and neuter forms, and eine and keine are the feminine and plural forms. That means you need to remember only one set of endings for the following words: ✓ ein (a, an), the indefinite article ✓ kein (no, not, not any), the adjective that negates a noun ✓ mein (my), dein (your), sein (his), ihr (her), unser (our), eurer (your), ihr (their), Ihr (your), the possessive adjectives Table 4-5 shows how to remember the endings for kein, with the case and gender endings in bold. Masculine and neuter are grouped together, and feminine and plural are grouped together. This table is also valid for ein- words except for ein itself, which has no plural form.

Table 4-5

Endings of Kein

Case

Masculine/Neuter

Feminine/Plural

Nominative

kein

keine

Accusative

keinen (masc.), kein (n.)

keine

Dative

keinem

keiner (fem.), keinen (pl.)

Genitive

keines

keiner

Notice that the masculine and neuter endings are almost all the same for kein and ein- words; the accusative is the only one that differs. You can also remember feminine and plural together, keeping in mind that the dative is the only one that isn’t the same. Look at these example sentences with kein in the four cases, followed by the English equivalent and the grammar note explaining the gender:

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

368

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication ✓ Nominative case: Keine Menschen leben auf der Insel. (No people live on the island.) Menschen (plural) is the subject of the sentence, so keine Menschen is nominative plural. ✓ Accusative case: Nach dem grossen Abendessen hatte ich keinen Hunger. (I wasn’t hungry after the big dinner.) Literally, ich hatte keinen Hunger means I had no hunger. Der Hunger (masculine) changes to the accusative singular keinen Hunger because it’s the object of the sentence. ✓ Dative case: In keinem alten Auto gibt es Navi. (There’s no GPS in any old car[s]. Literally: In no old car is there GPS.) The prepositional phrase in keinem alten Auto is in dative case; therefore, das Auto becomes keinem (alten) Auto. ✓ Genitive case: Während keiner Nacht in der letzten Woche habe ich gut geschlafen. (I didn’t sleep well [during] any night last week. Literally: During no night in the past week did I sleep well.) Während (during) is a genitive preposition and die Nacht is feminine singular, so you need the genitive case ending -er for kein. (Book IV, Chapter 2 offers plenty more details on prepositions.)

When you’re reading German, use the examples you see to understand the grammar involved. Train yourself to take a step back and think carefully about which word endings you’re dealing with in a sentence. The pieces of the grammar puzzle begin to fit into place when you recognize which gender and case you’re looking at.

Avoiding blunt negative replies You don’t want to sound overly negative when answering yes/no questions with a straight nein. Instead, you can cushion the impact and make a positive impression on German speakers when giving positive and even negative replies by using idiomatic expressions — fixed phrases. Consider this exchange: Haben Sie Kleingeld für 2€? (Do you have change for 2€?) Nein, es tut mir leid. (No, I’m sorry. I don’t.) In the response, you soften the blow of nein by adding the apology es tut mir leid (I’m sorry). You can also give an excuse (hopefully a plausible one) such as Nein, da mein Portmonnaie zu Hause ist. (No, because my wallet is at home.) Table 4-6 provides a sampling of expressions that help you avoid sounding too negative.

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions Table 4-6

369

Avoiding Bluntness with Negative Answers

Phrase

English Equivalent

Comments

Es tut mir leid

I’m sorry

The apology Es tut mir leid prefaces the rest of the information.

fast keine (Zeit)

hardly any (time)

Fast keine Zeit (hardly any time) is the same as kaum Zeit.

Im Grunde genommen

basically

The signal of a refusal — Im Grunde genommen — comes at the beginning of the sentence, softening the negative.

nicht hundertprozentig/ nicht ganz

not 100%, not completely

You don’t need to admit that you understand only 70%. Chances are, the speaker will repeat him/herself. Stating nein flatly may not get you anywhere.

nicht nur (. . . sondern auch)

not only (. . . but also)

nicht nur (not only) can be linked like this: Nicht nur mein Vater, sondern auch mein Großvater kam aus Irland. (Not only my father but also my grandfather came from Ireland.)

Ich habe nicht die leiseste Ahnung

I haven’t the faintest idea

This is a fixed expression that can also be stated like this: Ich habe keine Ahnung. (Ihave no idea.)

auch nicht

[n]either

To add that something else is not easy/useful/ helpful, and so on, you can say Das ist auch nicht leicht. (That’s not easy, either.)

doch nicht

definitely not

For emphasis, use doch nicht like this: Ich fahre doch nicht mit. (I’m definitely not coming along.) It implies you’ve changed your mind.

eigentlich nicht

actually not

You can clarify with eigentlich nicht. Example: Das ist eigentlich nicht so einfach. (That’s actually not so easy.)

ja und nein

yes and no

When you’re on the fence about answering with yes or no, say ja und nein.

jein

yes-no

Yes and no are combined together into one word with jein — the informal expression for those who can’t make up their minds or who want to say that they partially agree with something.

nicht genau

not exactly

When you’re not clear about something, you can say, Ich weiß nicht genau. (I don’t know exactly.)

noch nicht

not yet

When you need to express that you’re not yet ready, for example, you can say, Ich bin noch nicht fertig. (I’m not ready yet.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

370

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication The following examples put the expressions from Table 4-6 to use in dialogue. For each example, a question is followed by an answer with a softener that avoids the bluntness of kein and nicht. The modifying words are set in bold: ✓ Können wir noch einen Kaffee trinken? (Can we have another cup of coffee?) Es tut mir leid, aber wir haben fast keine Zeit. (I’m sorry, but we have hardly any time.) ✓ Interessieren Sie sich für diese Musik? (Are you interested in this music?) Ich habe praktisch kein Interesse für solche Musik. (I have practically no interest in such music.) ✓ Können Sie in diesem Fall eine Ausnahme machen? (Can you make an exception in this case?) Im Grunde genommen, dürfen wir keine Ausnahmen machen. (Basically, we can’t make any exceptions.) Note: You can also use nicht with a verb: Im Grunde genommen, geht das nicht. (Basically, that won’t work.) ✓ Verstehen Sie, was ich meine? (Do you understand what I mean?) Nicht hundertprozentig/Nicht ganz. (Not one hundred percent./Not completely.) ✓ Sie Sind Engländer, nicht wahr? (You’re English, aren’t you?) Nicht nur Engländer, da mein Vater aus Irland kam. (Not only English, because my father came from Ireland.) ✓ Ändert sich das Klima heutzutage? (Is the climate changing nowadays?) Ich habe nicht die leiseste Ahnung. (I haven’t the faintest idea.)

Asking and Answering Questions with Wo- and Da- Compound Words If you don’t want to ask a question by beginning with a basic question word like wann (when) or wer (who), you can mix things up a bit by combining the word wo (where) with various prepositions, like mit (with), to make a whole new question word — in this case, womit (what . . . with). In a question, this combo looks like this: Womit schneidet er das Holz? (What’s he cutting the wood with?) Another type of word combination you may come across in connection with German questions consists of da- together with a preposition like zu (to, at) to form the word dazu (with it, in addition). These da- compound words come in handy in answers to questions when you want to refer back to some information that’s already been mentioned in a prepositional phrase without

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

371

having to repeat the same words again. Imagine you’re discussing your favorite dish, and someone asks you, Trinken Sie Weißwein oder Rotwein mit dem Eintopf? (Do you drink white wine or red wine with the stew?) Your answer: Dazu trinkt man am besten Rotwein. (It’s best to drink red wine with it.) You simply replace the prepositional phrase mit dem Eintopf with dazu. The following two sections take you through the ins and outs of using these two types of combination words.

Combining question words: Compounds with woYou’re listening to the German businessman sitting next to you on the plane tell you something like Ich bin gegen höhere Benzinpreise. (I’m against higher gas prices.) You hear the first part of the statement, ich bin gegen, but you don’t catch the rest — what’s he against? That one song about Benzin (gasoline) by Rammstein? You ask, Sie sind gegen was? (You’re against what?) The businessman can understand your question, but it sounds as though you’re challenging his opinion. It’s a bit like saying Just what is it that you claim you’re against?! and insinuating that you don’t agree at all. How do you communicate that you don’t want to challenge his judgment, but you do need a repeat of the statement? You ask, Wogegen sind Sie? (What are you against?) The question Wogegen sind Sie literally means What against are you? Wogegen asks for the object of the preposition gegen (against). In German, you stick wo- in front of the preposition to signal to the listener that a question about the object of the preposition is coming. The listener gets the most important information first in the question. The German word order in questions beginning with wo- compounds like worüber (what about, what over) may seem odd at first: Worüber spricht sie? (What’s she talking about? Literally: What over [about] is she talking?) However, compare it to a similar structure in formal English — To whom am I speaking? instead of the far more natural sounding Who am I speaking to? Remember: Such word order may seem odd in English, yet it’s standard fare in German. A second important function of the compound question words using wo- is to prompt the listener that the question you’re asking allows an open-ended answer: Wofür sind Sie? (What are you for?) The listener may answer like this: Ich bin für den Frieden (I’m for peace) or Ich bin für einen Spaziergang im Park (I’m [up] for a walk in the park). The meaning of the preposition in the compound with wo- may be different from the original meaning. Keep in mind that many German verbs require particular prepositions in particular contexts (check out Book IV, Chapter 2, for more on prepositions), which sometimes can determine which preposition you choose to combine with wo-, such as Worauf warten Sie? (What

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

372

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication are you waiting for?) and Ich warte auf den Bus. (I’m waiting for the bus.) The person posing the question uses the phrase warten auf . . . in question form. The reply contains the complete phrase (ich warte auf) with the object of the preposition (den Bus).

When you know the most common verb-preposition combinations, you’re on the road to success at forming wo- compounds. (Book IV, Chapters 2 and 3 help you with such combinations.) However, you also need to know which grammatical case to use with prepositions. Most important is being aware that prepositions can change meaning depending on the context of the sentence, so get to know how to use the wo- compounds in sentences. Table 4-7 shows the most common compounds formed by adding wo- to the prepositions. The English equivalents can help you get a feel for the preposition, but they change meaning according to the context of the sentence. Notice that when the preposition begins with a vowel, you insert the letter r between the two elements of the question word (for instance, wo + r + in = worin).

Table 4-7

Questioning Using Wo- Compounds

German Preposition

Translation

Wo- Compound

an

on, at, to

woran

auf

on top of, to

worauf

aus

out of, from

woraus

durch

through, by

wodurch

für

for

wofür

gegen

against

wogegen

hinter

behind, after

wohinter

in

in, inside of

worin

mit

with, by

womit

nach

after, to

wonach

über

over, above

worüber

um

around

worum

unter

under

worunter

von

from, by

wovon

vor

in front of, before

wovor

zu

to, at

wozu

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

373

The following examples show questions beginning with wo- compound words, followed by possible answers: Woran leidet er? Er leidet an Bronchitis. (What is he suffering from? He’s suffering from bronchitis.) Worüber spricht sie? Sie spricht über die Umwelt. (What is she talking about? She’s talking about the environment.) Wozu brauchen Sie einen Hammer? Um ein Bücherregal zu bauen. (What do you need a hammer for? To build a bookshelf.) Wodurch wurden Sie krank? Durch schlechten Fisch wurde ich krank. (What did you get sick from? I got sick from bad fish.) Worauf wartest du? Ich warte auf meine Freundin. (What are you waiting for? I’m waiting for my [girl]friend.)

Explaining yes and no answers by using da- compounds You’re probably aware of German’s propensity for combining words or word fragments into one humongous word that’s as long as its definition. Fortunately, da- compounds are far simpler because they combine only two parts: da- and a preposition. These compounds are handy for replacing the object of the preposition; da- translates as it or that and, in the case of plural nouns, them. You don’t need to repeat the prepositional phrase, making you sound intelligent as well as fluent in German. This section describes the ins and outs of da- compounds: how to form them and when and how to use them. (The preceding section “Combining question words: Compounds with wo-” deals with the kissing cousins of da- compounds, the wo- compounds, which you use in questions.)

Forming da- compounds To form compounds with da-, check out Table 4-8. The table shows the most common compounds formed by adding da- to the prepositions. The English equivalents help you get a feel for the preposition, but keep in mind that they can alter their meaning according to the context of the sentence. When the preposition begins with a vowel, you insert the letter r between the two elements of the word (as in da + r + über = darüber).

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

374

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 4-8

Forming Da- Compounds

German Preposition

Translation

Da- Compound (Preposition + it, that, them)

an

on, at, to

daran

auf

on top of, to

darauf

aus

out of, from

daraus

bei

at, with

dabei

durch

through, by

dadurch

für

for

dafür

gegen

against

dagegen

hinter

behind, after

dahinter

in

in, inside of

darin

mit

with, by

damit

nach

after, to

danach

neben

next to

daneben

über

over, above

darüber

um

around

darum

unter

under

darunter

von

from, by

davon

vor

in front of, before

davor

zu

to, at

dazu

zwischen

between

dazwischen

Putting da- compounds to work Use combinations of da- + preposition when you want to refer to a prepositional phrase that someone has already mentioned without repeating it — for example, in a reply to a question — just as you say something like I like to work with it (Ich arbeite gern damit) in English. For instance, you can replace the phrase mit meinem neuen Computer (with my new computer) with damit, a combination of da- + mit (literally it + with). Look at this example question with two different replies. Clearly, the second reply is much less redundant than the first one, and you sound much more like you know what you’re talking about — even though you say that you verstehe nichts davon (understand nothing about it)! Verstehen Sie etwas von dieser Grammatik? (Do you know/understand anything about this grammar?)

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

375

Nein, ich verstehe nichts von dieser Grammatik. (No, I don’t know/ understand anything about this grammar.) Nein, ich verstehe nichts davon. (No, I know/understand nothing about it.) Notice how davon translates in the second reply: about it. You can also translate davon as about that, even though in Table 4-8, von has only two translations, from and by. Why? Because the meaning of the preposition can change when you add it to a prepositional phrase or (especially) a verbal phrase (a verbal phrase is a more or less fixed expression that has a verb in it). The verbal phrase in the preceding example is von etwas verstehen, which is what you’d see in a dictionary entry under the headword verstehen, translated as to know sth about (sth is a standard abbreviation for something). The following pairs of questions and answers show how da- compound words play out in sentences: Denkst du oft an die Reise? (Do you often think about the trip?) Ja, ich denke oft daran. (Yes, I often think about it.) Warten Sie noch auf Ihre Bestellung? (Are you waiting for your order?) Ja, ich warte noch darauf. (Yes, I’m still waiting for it.) Schreibst du mit dem Laptop? (Are you writing with the laptop?) Nein, ich schreibe nicht damit. (No, I’m not writing with it.) Arbeitet er für 8€ in der Stunde? (Does he work for 8€ an hour?) Nein, dafür arbeitet er nicht. (No, he doesn’t/won’t work for that.) Steht der Stuhl vor dem Fenster oder hinter dem Tisch? (Is the chair in front of the window or behind the table?) Der Stuhl steht nicht davor und nicht dahinter; er steht in einem anderen Zimmer. (The chair isn’t in front of or behind it; it’s in another room.) Yet another frequently used da- compound is darum (that is why, so, therefore, for this/that reason, on that account), with its impressive number of meanings. When it’s used as part of a fixed expression, the chameleon darum changes meanings again and again. Here are some common expressions that use darum: Es geht darum, (dass) . . . (The point is . . .) Es handelt sich darum, (dass) . . . (The question is . . .) Sei’s drum! (So be it!) mit allem drum und dran (with the whole works, the whole shebang) In the last two examples, the words darum and daran are shortened to form drum and dran, respectively.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

376

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Sounding Diplomatic: Using Maybe, Suggesting, and Refusing Politely Ever felt like blurting out a resounding No! in the middle of a meeting when you totally disagreed with the proposal being discussed? Ever wanted to shake someone who’s always negative into saying an unequivocal Yes to something you suggested? If so, you likely used a bit more tact when you actually did speak up. Knowing how to couch your agreement or disagreement in diplomatic words is even more important when you speak another language. Although German may — acoustically speaking — sound direct and even harsh at times, you can sound more diplomatic and polite simply by adding a few measures of maybes and wells to replies that may otherwise sound too blunt. Add words such as vielleicht (maybe) or nun (well) where you would in English, namely at the beginning of the idea that you intend to disagree with or answer with a negative reply. Longer diplomatic expressions generally go at the beginning of the sentence you’re expressing doubts about; you just have to memorize them as fixed expressions. Here are a couple of examples: Es kann sein, dass der Bericht einige Fehler hat. (It could be that the report has some mistakes.) The expression es kann sein is a fixed expression connected to the rest of the sentence by the conjunction dass. (For details on conjunctions, see Book IV, Chapter 1.) Um ehrlich zu sein, das wäre schwierig. (To be honest, that would be difficult.) The expression um ehrlich zu sein is a fixed expression. Following it is the information that you’re being honest about. North Americans — and possibly even more so, the British — enjoy a great reputation for using a broad range of polite language when expressing indecision, agreement, and disagreement with others. The German language isn’t quite as famous for sounding reserved. Why? The language itself has a stronger ring to the ears than English because of the Tonfall (inflection or tone) and the fact that it bunches more consonants together. Speakers of German don’t deliberately try to be blunt; rather, the effect comes from the sound of the language. However, Germans do generally state their opinions more directly than North Americans do. Table 4-9 walks you through a number of ways you can respond diplomatically when you want to signal your reservations about something. Each German expression is followed by an example phrase and its English equivalent. Some of the expressions are one-word introductory signals that you use to preface your opinion; others are longer phrases that you use in German to sound diplomatic, to qualify your standpoint, or to negotiate acceptance of your suggestion.

Chapter 4: Asking and Answering Questions

377

Another bonus for using such expressions is that you gain time while you decide whether you really want to agree or disagree with the person you’re conversing with. That’s a thankful bonus when you’re speaking a language that isn’t your own and you want to sound intelligent — and intelligible — in what you say.

Table 4-9 German Expression

Diplomatic Answering Gambits Example Phrase

English Equivalent

Vielleicht . . .

Vielleicht kommt er . . .

Maybe he’ll come . . .

Eventuell . . .

Eventuell kann man . . .

You could possibly . . .

Expressing maybe/perhaps

Note: Eventuell means possibly or perhaps, not eventually. Möglicherweise . . .

Möglicherweise regnet es nicht . . .

Perhaps it won’t rain . . .

Nun . . .

Nun, wenn es so ist . . .

Well, if it’s like that . . .

Eigentlich . . .

Eigentlich dachte ich . . .

Actually, I thought . . .

. . . aber . . .

Ich verstehe, aber . . .

I understand, but . . .

Mit allem Respekt . . .

Mit allem Respekt muss ich dazu sagen . . .

With all due respect, Imust say . . .

Machen wir so, . . .

Machen wir so, wir schieben . . .

Let’s do it like this: We’ll delay . . .

Wir könnten . . .

Wir könnten morgen mit einander treffen . . .

We could meet ­tomorrow . . .

Wie wäre es . . .

Wie wäre es wenn wir versuchen würden . . .

How would it be if we tried . . .

Introducing doubt

Suggesting

(The introduction to the sentence wie wäre es implies that it will continue in the subjunctive because you’re imagining something.) Was halten Sie davon, wenn . . .

Was halten Sie davon, wenn wir abwarten . . .

What do you think about waiting . . . (continued)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

378

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 4-9 (continued) German Expression

Example Phrase

English Equivalent

. . . kaum . . .

Das ist kaum möglich . . .

That’s hardly possible . . .

. . . fast nicht . . .

Das ist fast nicht machbar . . .

That’s just about impossible to do . . .

Ich habe einige Bedenken . . .

Ich habe einige Bedenken dazu . . .

I have a few doubts about that . . .

. . . etwas zu . . .

Der Preis ist etwas zu hoch . . .

The price is somewhat too high . . .

. . . ein bißchen . . .

Wir brauchen ein bißchen mehr Zeit . . .

We need a bit more time . . .

Leider . . .

Leider kann ich nicht mitkommen . . .

Unfortunately, I can’t come along . . .

Es tut mir leid . . .

Es tut mir leid, aber das geht nicht . . .

I’m sorry, but that won’t work . . .

Entschuldigung, aber . . .

Entschuldigung, aber ich habe wenig Zeit . . .

Sorry, but I have little time . . .

Ist das nicht . . .

Ist das nicht etwas früh?

Isn’t that a bit early?

Modifying negation

Refusing diplomatically

Chapter 5

Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs In This Chapter ▶ Categorizing and forming adjectives ▶ Using adverbs to describe verbs, adjectives, and other adverbs ▶ Understanding regular and irregular adjective and adverb comparative forms ▶ Comparing equals and unequals

A

djectives and adverbs add spice, distinctive flavor, and creativity to a sentence. They dress it up for a vigorous winter workout in Arlberg. Why not leave out these extra words and stick with the basics? Cross out the adjective vigorous from vigorous winter workout in the previous sentence, and your listener still gets the picture. But she doesn’t perk up and become involved. Adjectives add depth and character to the power of a noun, and adverbs add oomph to verbs and other parts of a sentence. Besides, they’re interessant (interesting), lustig (funny), unglaublich (incredible), ruhig (quiet), and praktisch (practical).

Incorporating adjectives and adverbs into your sentences involves a bit of good news and a bit of not-so-good news. First the good news: Adverbs are no-nonsense words in that they don’t go through any contortions of German grammar. In addition, there are quite a few cognates among German adjectives and adverbs. In the first paragraph, you probably recognize interessant, and you may get the meaning of praktisch if you know that the ending -isch often stands in for English adjective endings like -ic and -ical. The not-sogood news has to do with adjectives. When handling adjectives, you have to address grammar — gender, number, and case. Depending on where you place the adjective in the sentence, you may or may not need to make the adjective agree with the noun it modifies. Keine Sorge. (Not to worry.) This chapter gives you the lowdown on adjectives and adverbs so you can start using them confidently in your descriptive German. Plus, you get up to speed on using them when making comparisons.

380

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Organizing Adjectives: Opposites, Cognates, and Collocations Adjectives are so numerous that you absolutely must find a system for categorizing them as a means of easy reference. When you encounter a new adjective, try to find a hook to hang it on or a group to put it in. You may be able to group them three different ways: ✓ Opposites: Some adjective types lend themselves to pairing up with an adjective of the opposite meaning. ✓ Cognates: Cognates, which are similar words in English and German, are instantly recognizable; after you check that the meaning is the same in both languages, you only need to know how to form their endings in sentences. ✓ Collocations: Collocations are semi-fixed, frequently used word combinations, so look for adjective + noun phrases. Get into the habit of recognizing collocations that include adjectives. Getting familiar with them takes a bit more work than figuring out what a solo adjective means, but in the end, it saves time. Add them to your range of expression, and you’re on the path to successful, idiomatic German. The following sections help you place adjectives in these three different groups. By doing so, you can more easily remember these descriptors, and then you can use them when you want to discuss appearance, personal traits, weather, and more.

Letting opposites attract You can master many groups of descriptive adjectives as opposite pairs. Two common groups are the adjectives that describe people’s appearance and personal traits and the adjectives that describe the weather.

Describing appearance and personal traits When you want to say what people are like, you use descriptive adjectives to describe them; for example, sie ist groß (she’s tall) or er ist freundlich (he’s friendly). In Table 5-1, you see such adjectives grouped as opposites; looking at them this way saves you time when remembering them.

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs Table 5-1

381

Adjectives of Personal Appearance and Traits

German Adjective

English Translation

German Opposite

English Opposite

attraktiv

attractive

unattraktiv

unattractive

freundlich

friendly

unfreundlich

unfriendly

glücklich

happy

traurig/unglücklich

sad/unhappy

heiter

cheerful

ernst

serious

interessant

interesting

uninteressant/ langweilig

uninteresting/ boring

jung

young

alt

old

klein

short

groß

tall

neu

new

alt

old

ruhig

quiet

laut

loud

schlank

thin, slim

mollig

plump, chubby

sportlich

athletic

unsportlich

unathletic

stark

strong

schwach

weak

sympathisch

likable, friendly

unsympathisch

unpleasant, disagreeable

tolerant

tolerant

intolerant

intolerant

zuverlässig

reliable

unzuverlässig

unreliable

The following example sentences contain adjectives that describe the appearance and personal traits of Paula and Philip, twins who couldn’t be more opposite from each other: Philip ist zuverlässig, aber Paula ist unzuverlässig. (Philip is reliable, but Paula is unreliable.) Paula ist klein, aber Philip ist groß. (Paula is short, but Philip is tall.) Paula ist attraktiv, aber Philip ist unattraktiv. (Paula is attractive, but Philip is unattractive.) Philip ist sympathisch, aber Paula ist unsympathisch. (Philip is likable, but Paula is disagreeable.) Philip ist stark, aber Paula ist schwach. (Philip is strong, but Paula is weak.) Paula ist unsportlich, aber Philip ist sportlich. (Paula is unathletic, but Philip is athletic.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

382

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Describing the weather No matter where you are, talking about das Wetter (the weather) is the perfect icebreaker. It also provides you with ammunition to make your friends jealous when you’re writing them Ansichtskarten (postcards) while you’re im Urlaub (on vacation). Look at the weather vocabulary in Table 5-2. Great news: Most of the adjectives have near opposites, so you can easily remember them in pairs.

Table 5-2

Adjectives of Weather

German Adjective

English Translation

German Opposite

English Opposite

gut, schön

good, nice

schlecht

bad

sonnig

sunny

wolkig/bewölkt

cloudy

wunderschön

delightful, lovely

furchtbar

awful

warm

warm

kühl

cool

heiß

hot

kalt

cold

trocken

dry

nass

wet

More weather-related adjectives that don’t have clear opposites include frostig (chilly), schön warm (nice and warm), neb(e)lig (foggy), regnerisch (rainy), schwül (humid), and stürmisch (gusty, blustery).

A family resemblance: Describing with cognates Although German does have some incredibly foreign-sounding words, the number of cognates is surprisingly large. You can put them in several categories for easy access. Some example categories are based on the adjective’s ending, as you can see in Table 5-3.

Table 5-3

Common Endings on German Adjectives

German Ending

Usual English Ending

German Examples

-al

same

diagonal, digital, emotional, formal, ideal, integral, interkontinental, international, irrational, kollegial, liberal, national, normal, optimal, original, sentimental, sozial, total, universal

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs German Ending

Usual English Ending

German Examples

-ant or -ent

same

elegant, exzellent, intelligent, interessant, intolerant, kompetent, tolerant, uninteressant

-ell

-al

generell, individuell, informell, konventionell, kriminell, offiziell, partiell, rationell, sensationell, visuell

-isch

-ic or -ical

allergisch, alphabetisch, analytisch, charakteristisch, chemisch, dynamisch, egoistisch, elastisch, elektrisch, elektronisch, ethisch, exotisch, exzentrisch, fanatisch, fantastisch, klassisch, harmonisch, hygienisch, identisch, idiomatisch, idyllisch, ironisch, logisch, lyrisch, melodisch, militärisch, musikalisch, mythisch, patriotisch, philosophisch, politisch, praktisch, romantisch, sarkastisch, sporadisch, symmetrisch, systematisch, tropisch

-iv

-ive

aktiv, alternativ, exklusiv, explosiv, intensiv, interaktiv, kreativ, massiv, passiv

-lich or -ig

-y, -ly, or -ally

freundlich, frostig, hungrig, persönlich, sportlich, sonnig, unfreundlich, unpersönlich, unsportlich, windig

Some cognates — such as bitter, blind, blond, fair, golden, human, illegal, legal, liberal, mild, modern, neutral, parallel, solid, uniform, warm, and wild — have the same meaning and the same spelling, but you pronounce them according to German pronunciation. Others have a few spelling changes from English to German, such as ✓ c → k: direkt, exakt, intakt, komplex, konstant, korrekt, nuklear ✓ c → k; ve → v: aktiv, effektiv, exklusiv, kreativ ✓ le → el: flexibel, kompatibel, miserabel, variabel ✓ d → t: hart, laut (loud) ✓ y → ig: frostig, hungrig, sonnig, windig

Get in the habit of remembering cognates in groups. Repeat them out loud, alphabetically, and rhythmically. They’ll stick with you and serve you well when you need them.

383

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

384

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Putting collocations and word partnerships into action Acquiring word chunks is far more economical than studying isolated words. Collocations are word combos that are very predictable, some so predictable that they nearly always stick together. By some definitions, collocations include idioms and other fixed expressions. Collocations are made up of all kinds of word combinations: adjective + noun, noun + noun, adverb + adjective, and so on. In this section, we deal with adjective combos. Some collocations translate well: Starke Nerven is the same as strong nerves. Other expressions aren’t as close: Das ist ein starkes Stück in literal English means that’s a strong piece. Yet in German, it’s like saying that’s a bit too much, as in that’s over the top. Take a look at some other example collocations: Unsere Produkte werden nur in umweltfreundlichen Verpackungen verkauft. (Our products are sold only in environmentally friendly packaging.) The collocation is the combination of umweltfreundlich(en) + Verpackung(en) (environmentally friendly + packaging). Notice that the fixed combination environmentally friendly is an adverb + adjective in English; in German, it’s a noun + adjective: die Umwelt (the environment) + freundlich (friendly). Ich ärgere mich grün und blau. (I’m hopping mad. Literally: I’m annoyed green and blue.) You can also describe this expression as an idiom (a group of words with a figurative meaning). Whatever the terminology, if you were to ask a German speaker to finish the sentence ich ärgere mich. . . und . . ., he wouldn’t hesitate to add the right colors. Use only German collocations or idioms you’re sure about. Although you know a collocation in English, it may very well translate into German as nonsense. Take the German adjective stark, for example. Put the English collocation stark raving mad into German word for word, and you get gibberish. Why? The equivalent for this particular three-word chunk is the German collocation total verrückt (totally crazy). When you know that stark means strong in German, not harsh as in English, you’re halfway on the road to using it correctly.

Read and listen actively to German. Make it your goal to recognize chunks of language, not just single words. Knowing a stack of collocations with adjectives offers you great opportunities for expressing yourself clearly and succinctly. Look at the following German expressions using colors. Memorizing them as word combos rather than individual words can help you understand (and be understood) when you’re conversing with a native German speaker.

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

385

Sie treffen ins Schwarze. (They hit the bull’s eye.) Sie sind blau. (They’re drunk.) Sie fahren schwarz. (They’re riding [the train] without a ticket.) Sie sind im Grünen. (They’re outdoors.) Sie werden rot. (They’re blushing.) Sie arbeiten schwarz. (They’re working illegally, not paying taxes.) Sie werden braun. (They’re getting tan.) Sie sind gelb vor Neid. (They’re green with envy. Literally: They’re yellow with envy.) Sie machen blau. (They’re skipping work/school.)

Helping Adjectives Meet a Satisfying End Expanding your adjective arsenal is the first step to spicing up your German (see the preceding section); knowing how to form and use adjectives correctly in a sentence is the second step. This section helps you figure out whether the adjectives need endings and, if so, how to form those endings. English uses adjectives as they come, straight up, no changes needed to plunk them into a combination with a noun. German is quite different. Before a German adjective can sidle up to a noun, it often needs an ending that reflects the gender and case of the noun it modifies. As in English, a German adjective usually comes right before the noun it describes: meine schwarze Handschuhe (my black gloves). However, not all adjectives need special attention as far as ending changes are concerned. Adjectives that precede nouns are changed, but post-position adjectives — ones that follow later in a clause — are not. An adjective has no ending when it follows the verbs sein (to be), werden (to become), or bleiben (to remain) and modifies the subject. Consider these two examples: Das Wetter bleibt warm. (The weather remains warm.) Die Berge in Bayern sind wunderschön. (The mountains in Bavaria are gorgeous.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

386

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Work at recognizing the case and gender of nouns in the sentence and then adding the correct endings to their corresponding adjectives. In this section, you find out the difference between endings when an adjective stands alone in front of the noun — for example, frisches Obst (fresh fruit) — and when an adjective has a word such as der, ein, or dieser at the beginning of the phrase — for example, das frische Obst (the fresh fruit).

Forming endings on adjectives not preceded by der- or ein- words When you describe something in general such as food prices, you simply say something like fresh pineapples are expensive. You don’t need to add the, those, or our. It’s the same in German, except you have to deal with the added factor of case endings for adjectives. In other words, when you say frische Ananas sind teuer (fresh pineapples are expensive), you need to know that the ending for frisch is -e. Note: In phrases that do have an article or modifier like the, those, or our (as in those fresh pineapples), the adjective endings are different. Check out the next section, “Adding endings for preceded adjectives,” for details. This section deals with endings for an adjective that modifies and precedes a noun but isn’t preceded by an article (such as der/die/das or ein/eine) or other modifiers (der- words, such as dieser and solcher, and ein- words, such as mein and kein). Here are the characteristics that define adjectives without der- or ein- words preceding them: ✓ Because no article or other modifier precedes the noun, the adjective must indicate gender and case of the noun; it has a double duty of adjective and article. ✓ These adjectives have mostly the same endings as der- words, with the exception of the masculine and neuter genitive, where the ending is -en. To form these adjective endings, you need to know the gender, case, and number of the noun that the adjective modifies. For example, take the adjective gut (good). To say guter Käse ist teuer (good cheese is expensive), you need to know that Käse is masculine singular (der Käse) and that, in this sentence, it’s in the nominative case (subject). Then you just add the nominative masculine ending -er onto gut, so you have gut + -er = guter Käse. The four adjectives in Table 5-4 deal with food: gut (good), schmackhaft (tasty), lecker (delicious, mouth-watering, scrumptious), and köstlich (delicious,

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

387

luscious, exquisite). The endings that agree in case, number, and gender with the noun they modify are in bold. For easy reference, the table also lists the adjective ending separately in bold with each example. Add these endings toadjectives that are not preceded by der- or ein- words.

Table 5-4 Adjective Endings Not Preceded by Der- or Ein- Words Case

Masculine

Feminine

Neuter

Plural

Nominative (subject)

-er guter Käse (good cheese)

-e schmackhafte Wurst (tasty sausage)

-es leckeres Brot (delicious bread)

-e köstliche Kuchen (delicious cakes)

Accusative (direct object)

-en guten Käse

-e schmackhafte Wurst

-es leckeres Brot

-e köstliche Kuchen

Dative (indirect object)

-em gutem Käse

-er schmackhafter Wurst

-em leckerem Brot

-en köstlichen Kuchen

Genitive (possessive)

-en guten Käses

-er schmackhafter Wurst

-en leckeren Brotes

-er köstlicher Kuchen

Check out some examples: Leckeres Brot findet man überall in deutschen Bäckereien. (You can find delicious bread everywhere in German bakeries.) The adjective lecker + -es (delicious) describes the noun (das) Brot (bread); leckeres Brot is in the accusative case because it’s the direct object. The singular, neuter accusative ending for unpreceded adjectives is -es. Es gibt köstliche Kuchen in österreichischen Cafés. (There are luscious cakes in Austrian cafés.) The adjective köstlich + -e describes the noun (der) Kuchen, in plural form. Köstliche Kuchen is in the accusative case because it’s the direct object. The plural accusative ending for unpreceded adjectives is -e. Im Winter trinken wir gern heißen Tee. (We like to drink hot tea in the winter.) Tee is masculine. Heißen Tee is in accusative case; it’s the direct object of the sentence. The masculine singular accusative ending for unpreceded adjectives is -en.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

388

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Adding endings for preceded adjectives When you want to be specific about something, you use articles and modifiers like the, those, or a to say something like the modern painting, those violent movies, or a fantastic restaurant. In English, you simply add the adjective of your choice, and you’re all set. Not so in German. Both the article/modifier and the adjective need to reflect the gender, number, and case of the noun they modify. This section deals with endings for an adjective that modifies and precedes a noun that’s preceded by an article (such as der/die/das or ein/eine) or other modifiers (der- words, such as dieser and solcher, and ein- words, such as mein and kein). (See Book III, Chapters 1 and 2 for information on articles and der- and ein- words.) Preceded adjectives, as they’re called, appear in phrases with an article or other modifier, an adjective, and a noun. Take the example ein lockeres Hemd ist bequem (a loose shirt is comfortable). Hemd is singular, neuter, and in the nominative case because it’s the subject of the sentence, so the article ein and the adjective lockeres reflect the neuter gender, number, and case of Hemd. Check out Table 5-5 for a few more examples that show how the adjective ending reflects the gender of the noun when both the article and the adjective appear together preceding the noun.

Table 5-5

Preceded Adjective Endings

Case

Masculine

Feminine

Neuter

Plural

Nominative (subject)

der lustige Manne (the funny man) ein lustiger Mann (a funny man)

die glückliche Frau (the happy woman) eine glückliche Frau (a happy woman)

das brave Kind (the well-behaved child) ein braves Kind (a wellbehaved child)

die braven Kinder (the well-behaved children) keine braven Kinder (no well-behaved children)

Accusative (direct object)

den lustigen Mann (the funny man) einen lustigen Mann (a funny man)

die glückliche Frau (the happy woman) eine glückliche Frau (a happy woman)

das brave Kind (the well-behaved child) ein braves Kind (a wellbehaved child)

die braven Kinder (the well-behaved children) keine braven Kinder (no well-behaved children)

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs Case

Masculine

Feminine

Neuter

Plural

Dative (indirect object)

dem lustigen Mann ([to] the funny man) einem lustigen Mann ([to] a funny man)

der glücklichen Frau ([to] the happy woman) einer glücklichen Frau ([to] a happy woman)

dem braven Kind ([to] the well-behaved child) einem braven Kind ([to] a well-behaved child)

den braven Kindern ([to] the wellbehaved children) keinen braven Kindern ([to] no wellbehaved children)

Genitive (possessive)

des lustigen Mannes ([of] the funny man) eines lustigen Mannes ([of] a funny man)

der glücklichen Frau ([of] the happy woman) einer glücklichen Frau ([of] a happy woman)

des braven Kindes ([of] the wellbehaved child) eines braven Kindes ([of] a well-behaved child)

der braven Kinder ([of] the wellbehaved children) keiner braven Kinder ([of] no wellbehaved children)

389

Book III

Look at the following example sentences: Letzte Woche habe ich ein neues Auto gekauft. (Last week I bought a new car.) Ein neues Auto is the object of the sentence; it’s in the accusative case. Auto is singular neuter, so the article ein and the adjective neu follow the gender, number, and case of the noun Auto. Ein needs no ending; the singular, neuter accusative ending for neu is -es. Die hohen Berge sind schon schneebedeckt. (The high mountains are already snow-covered.) Die hohen Berge is the subject of the sentence; it’s in the nominative case and plural. Die and hohen reflect the nominative plural case. The nominative plural of Berg is Berge. Salzburg hat eine herrliche Innenstadt. (Salzburg has a wonderful city center.) Eine herrliche Innenstadt is the object of the sentence. Innenstadt is feminine singular; eine and herrliche both indicate the agreement with Innenstadt by tacking on the ending -e.

Using the right endings with possessive adjectives Possessive adjectives are the words describing ownership, possession, or relationship, such as my, your, his, her, and so on. They’re also referred to

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

390

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication as possessive pronouns. (That’s because technically speaking, a possessive adjective is a pronoun that’s used as an adjective to show who “owns” the noun following it.) Identifying possessive adjectives is easy because they’re grouped together with the ein- words (they have the same endings, even if they don’t rhyme with ein). The ein- words include ein, kein, and all the possessive adjectives. The singular possessive adjectives are mein (my), dein (your), sein (his), ihr (her), and sein (its). The plural possessive adjectives are unser (our), euer (your), ihr (their), and Ihr (your — formal, singular and plural). Table 5-6 shows possessive adjective endings in all cases and genders; it follows the same pattern as ein- and kein- in Table 5-5. Note that the table shows mein and unser together; all other possessive adjectives use these same endings. The endings are shown separately in bold.

Table 5-6 Possessive Adjective Endings and First-Person Examples Case

Masculine

Feminine

Neuter

Plural

Nominative (subject)

mein, unser

-e meine, unsere

mein, unser

-e meine, unsere

Accusative (direct object)

-en meinen, unseren

-e meine, unsere

mein, unser

-e meine, unsere

Dative (indirect object)

-em meinem, unserem

-er meiner, unserer

-em meinem, unserem

-en meinen, unseren

Genitive (possessive)

-es meines, unseres

-er meiner, unserer

-es meines, unseres

-er meiner, unserer

The following example sentences show possessive adjectives with their endings: Ich kann meine Schlüssel nicht finden. (I can’t find my keys.) Meine is plural accusative. Deine Schlüssel liegen auf dem Tisch. (Your keys are on the table.) Deine Schlüssel is plural nominative. Und ist unser Gepäck schon fertig? (And is our luggage ready?) Unser Gepäck is singular, neuter nominative.

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

391

Uli hat seinen Koffer noch nicht gepackt. (No. Uli hasn’t packed his suitcase yet.) Seinen Koffer is singular, masculine accusative. Na ja, unser Urlaub fängt schon mit vielen Problemen an. (Oh well. Our vacation is already starting with a lot of problems.) Unser Urlaub is singular, masculine nominative.

Understanding Types of Adverbs Adverbs can modify verbs, adjectives, or other adverbs. (The verb sein [to be] is an exception: Adverbs can’t modify the verb sein.) Some adverbs are exactly the same word as their adjective cousins, while others may resemble their cousins, except that they, like all adverbs, don’t change form in a sentence. The fact that adverbs don’t require different endings based on the words they modify makes life easier for you when you want to insert an adverb into a sentence. In this section, you get the lowdown on four main groups of adverbs: adverbs of time, adverbs of place, adverbs of manner and degree, and adverbs that indicate cause.

Describing time with adverbs The adverbs that describe time (or express when an event or action takes place) include words like gestern (yesterday) and jetzt (now). Here are a few other frequently used adverbs of time: ✓ bald (soon)

✓ nachher (afterward)

✓ bisher (up until now)

✓ neuerdings (recently)

✓ damals (at that time)

✓ nie/niemals (never)

✓ früher (before, formerly)

✓ seitdem (since then)

✓ gerade (just, currently)

✓ später (later)

✓ heute (today)

✓ stets (always)

✓ heutzutage (nowadays)

✓ übermorgen (the day after tomorrow)

✓ immer (always)

✓ vorgestern (the day before yesterday)

✓ jemals (ever)

✓ vorher (before/beforehand)

✓ morgen (tomorrow) Here are a few example sentences using these adverbs: Heutzutage leben wenige Menschen auf dem Land. (Nowadays, few people live in the countryside.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

392

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Das Flugzeug landet gerade. (The plane is just landing.) Ich habe bisher keine neuen Informationen bekommen. (I haven’t received any new information up until now.) You can also express days of the week as well as a few other nouns that are related to time as adverbs. You simply add the letter s to the end of the noun. Here are some examples of such adverbs, which work as a reference to a habitual, recurring point in time: ✓ sonntags, montags, dienstags, and so on. (Sundays, Mondays, Tuesdays, and so on) ✓ morgens (in the mornings) ✓ mittags (at noontime) ✓ nachmittags (in the afternoons) ✓ abends (in the evenings) The following sentences show how these adverbs express time: Freitags kommt er meistens spät nach Hause. (He usually gets home late on Fridays.) Ich arbeite ungern abends. (I work reluctantly in the evenings.) Nachmittags spielen sie oft Golf. (They often play golf in the afternoon[s].)

Using adverbs to indicate place An adverb of place indicates where the action expressed takes place. It’s the type of adverb used to answer questions like wo (where), wohin (where to), and woher (from where). Some adverbs of this type, such as hierhin (over here) or dort drüben (over there), combine with other adverbs to form a oneor a two-word expression. The following is a list of commonly used adverbs of place. Some appear together with adverbs of the opposite meaning to help you more easily remember them. These are separated by a forward slash (/). Synonyms (words that mean nearly the same) are separated by commas. ✓ da/hier (there/here) ✓ dahin, dorthin/hierhin (over there/over here) ✓ draußen/drinnen (outside, outdoors/inside, indoors)

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

393

✓ drüben, da drüben, dort drüben (over there) ✓ geradeaus (straight ahead) ✓ links/rechts (left/right) ✓ nach links/nach rechts (to the left/to the right) ✓ nirgendwo/irgendwo (nowhere/somewhere) ✓ oben/unten (up/down) ✓ unterwegs (on the way/away [traveling]) ✓ vorn(e)/hinten (in front/behind) ✓ woanders (somewhere else) The following examples show how adverbs of place play out when they’re in a sentence: Der Geschäftsführer ist oft dienstlich unterwegs. (The director is often away on business.) Hier in diesem Raum befindet sich ein wunderschönes Gemälde. (There’s a beautiful painting here in this room.) Zum Museum müssen Sie nach links gehen. (To get to the museum, you have to go left.)

Looking at adverbs of manner and degree Adverbs that show how or why a situation or an action occurs belong to one group described as adverbs of manner and degree. They answer such questions as wie (how) and warum (why). The following list contains common adverbs of manner and degree. Notice how some of these adverbs intensify the meaning of the sentence, while others describe how much or to what degree an action takes place. ✓ allein (alone)

✓ nicht (not)

✓ bestimmt (certainly)

✓ sehr (very)

✓ etwa (approximately)

✓ unbedingt (absolutely)

✓ eventuell (possibly, maybe)

✓ umsonst (for nothing)

✓ fast (almost)

✓ vielleicht (perhaps, maybe)

✓ hoffentlich (hopefully)

✓ wahrscheinlich (probably)

✓ kaum (hardly)

✓ wirklich (really, absolutely)

✓ leider (unfortunately)

✓ zusammen (together)

✓ natürlich (of course)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

394

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication The following sentences show how these adverbs work in a sentence: Warten Sie, bitte. Ich bin fast fertig. (Please wait. I’m almost ready.) Er konnte die Musik kaum hören. (He could hardly hear the music.) Wir sind mit dem neun Bürgermeister sehr zufrieden. (We’re very pleased with the new mayor.) Der Film war wirklich lustig. (The film was really funny.) Hoffentlich schneit es heute Abend. (Hopefully it’ll snow this evening.) Ich muss meine Schwester unbedingt anrufen. (I absolutely have to call my sister.) In both English and German, you can use adverbs in this group alone in informal speech to add emphasis, as in this example dialogue: Können Sie mir bitte helfen? (Could you help me, please?) Aber, natürlich! (But, of course!) Another type of adverb that belongs to this group is a cross between an adjective and an adverb. To put such adverbs into perspective, look at the following two example sentences with information on how the adjective/ adverb in them differs: Sie ist eine schnelle Läuferin. (She’s a fast runner.) Schnell (fast) is an adjective here; it describes Läuferin (runner), which is a noun. The adjective precedes the noun, and it has to change spelling to fit with the noun in case and gender. Sie läuft schnell. (She runs fast.) Technically speaking, when words like schnell follow a verb and describe the verb, they’re adjectives that function as adverbs. They’re classified as adverbs in the sense that they don’t go through any of the changes to indicate agreement with case and gender that adjectives do. (For more information on the changes adjectives undergo, see the earlier section “Helping Adjectives Meet a Satisfying End.”)

Eyeing adverbs that describe cause Adverbs of cause indicate the purpose, reason, or consequence of a statement. They serve as a link between parts of a sentence. Here’s a list of commonly used adverbs of cause:

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

395

✓ also (so) ✓ darum (therefore, for that reason) ✓ deshalb (therefore) ✓ jedenfalls (anyway, in any case) ✓ nämlich (namely) ✓ somit (consequently, therefore) ✓ sonst (otherwise) ✓ trotzdem (nevertheless) Look at the following sentences to see how to use adverbs that describe cause: Das Konzert war sehr schlecht, deshalb sind wir nach der Pause nach Hause gegangen. (The concert was very bad; therefore, we went home after the break.) Ich spreche ziemlich gut Deutsch, trotzdem möchte ich noch viel mehr lernen. (I speak fairly good German; nevertheless, I’d like to learn a lot more.) Ziehen Sie eine Winterjacke an, sonst wird es Ihnen kalt. (Put on a winter jacket; otherwise, you’ll be cold.)

Putting Adverbs and Adverbial Expressions in Their Proper Place To put an adverb in a sentence, you have to keep in mind the following basic guidelines on word order, which are related to what type of adverb you’re using, what the adverb is modifying, and how the adverb is being used in the sentence: ✓ Adverbs that provide more information about the verb in a main clause generally come after the conjugated verb: Sie lachen oft über seine Witze. (They often laugh at his jokes.) The adverb oft follows the verb lachen. ✓ When an adverb modifies another adverb, the two appear together, generally after the conjugated verb in a main clause, like this: Sie schreibt sehr gut. (She writes very well.) The adverb sehr (very) modifies the adverb gut (well). Note that gut can also be an adjective when it modifies a

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

396

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication noun. However, when adjectives like gut follow a verb, they function as adverbs (For more on adjectives, check out the first half of this chapter.) ✓ When an adverb modifies an adjective, the adverb precedes the adjective, and they’re generally placed after the conjugated verb in a main clause: Es ist fast dunkel. (It’s almost dark.) The adverb fast precedes the adjective dunkel. ✓ Adverbs that refer to a noun follow the noun: Der Hund dort drüben heißt Waldi. (The name of that dog over there is Waldi.) Dort drüben is the adverb, and it follows the noun der Hund. ✓ Adverbs introduce subordinate clauses: Fahren wir jetzt, sonst wird es zu spät. (Let’s go now, otherwise it’ll be too late.) The adverb sonst begins the subordinate clause. ✓ The adverb can come before the verb when you want to stress the information it portrays: Leider haben wir wenig Zeit. (Unfortunately, we have little time.) The adverb leider (unfortunately) precedes the verb haben (have). Word order in German sentences varies from English when the sentences include information about time, cause, manner, and place. In German, you put adverbial expressions in the following order: 1. Expressions of time: Answer the question wann? (when?) 2. Expressions of cause: Answer the question warum? (why?) 3. Expressions of manner: Answer the question wie? (how?) 4. Expressions of place: Answer the question wo? (where?) Notice the word order in the following sentences, which contain two or more of these types of adverbial expressions: Wir fahren heute Abend wegen des Wetters mit dem Auto zum Theater. (We’re going by car to the theater this evening because of the rain.) The adverb of time, heute Abend (this evening), comes first, followed by the expressions of cause, manner, and place — wegen des Wetters (because of the weather), mit dem Auto (by car), and zum Theater (to the theater). As is the case with standard German word order, the subject is followed by the verb, which is in second position in the sentence. Tanya und ich fahren heute mit dem Fahrrad an den See. (Tanya and I are bicycling to the lake today.) The adverb of time, heute (today), comes first, followed by the expressions of manner and place — mit dem Fahrrad (by bicycle) and an den See (to the lake). As is the case with standard German word order, the subject is followed by the verb, which is in second position in the sentence.

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

397

To add a little variety, you can rearrange the information in the preceding example as long as you adhere to the German word order of time, cause, manner, and place: Heute fahren Tanya und ich mit dem Fahrrad an den See. (Tanya and I are bicycling to the lake today.) The adverb of time, heute, is at the front of the sentence, the verb is in the second position, followed by the subject. The other adverbial elements are in the same order: mit dem Fahrrad comes before an den See. The following sentences offer two more examples of how you can arrange information two different ways while still following the rules of word order: Sie fliegen morgen mit der ersten Maschine nach Berlin. (They are flying to Berlin with the first plane this morning.) The time expression morgen (tomorrow) comes before the expression of manner, mit der Maschine (with the plane), which answers the question how. Nach Berlin (to Berlin), the expression of place, is in last place in the sentence. As usual, the verb is in second position in the sentence. Morgen fliegen Sie mit der ersten Maschine nach Berlin. (They are flying to Berlin with the first plane this morning.) The first word, morgen, is the adverb of time. Next comes the verb, followed by the subject. The two elements of manner and place — mit der ersten Maschine and nach Berlin — are at the end of the sentence.

Comparing with Regular Adjectives and Adverbs: Fast, Faster, Fastest You may be wondering why we mix adjectives and adverbs in the same section. Actually, we have some very good reasons. For one thing, both have the power to make comparisons. What’s even better is that German adjectives and adverbs are one and the same word in many cases. Take, for instance, the adjective good and its adverbial counterpart well. The German equivalents are exactly the same for both adjective and adverb: gut. Best of all, using comparative and superlative forms of adjectives and adverbs offers great opportunities for making your language more precise, more useful, and more interesting. In this section, you make comparisons by using the comparative and superlative forms of adjectives and adverbs — for example, freundlich, freundlicher, am freundlichsten (friendly, friendlier, friendliest). Comparative means that you compare two objects, people, activities, ideas, and so on (for example, longer

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

398

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication is the comparative form of long); superlative means that you compare three or more objects, people, activities, ideas, and so on (longest is the superlative form). Fortunately, many adjectives and adverbs follow a regular pattern for making words of comparison, and that pattern isn’t too difficult to remember when you see the similarities to English. The endings that vary from the most frequent pattern mostly have to do with facilitating pronunciation. The guidelines that follow show how to add -er and -(e)st endings as well as the endings for adjectives that come before nouns. (See the earlier section “Helping Adjectives Meet a Satisfying End” for details on adjective agreement.)

Comparing two things For both adjectives and adverbs, when you want to compare two things, people, and so on, take the base form (the adjective or adverb as you see it in the dictionary) and form the comparative by adding -er to the base form; for instance, witzig → witziger (witty → wittier). To express than in a comparison, use the German equivalent als. Consider these examples: Mein Onkel Richard ist nett, aber meine Tante Christel ist netter als Onkel Richard. (My Uncle Richard is nice, but my Aunt Christel is nicer than Uncle Richard.) The adjective nett is the base form; netter als (nicer than) is the comparative form. Onkel Richard fährt schnell, aber Tante Christel fährt schneller er. (Uncle Richard drives fast, but Aunt Christel drives faster than he [does].) The adverb schnell is the base form; schneller als (faster than) is the comparative form. Note: Schnell is both an adjective and an adverb, just as fast is in English. Adjectives ending in -el and -er leave the last -e off the base form and then add -er to make the comparative: dunkel → dunkler (dark → darker) and teuer → teurer (expensive → more expensive). When using a comparative adjective that precedes the noun, you follow the same guidelines as with other adjectives that precede the noun (see the earlier section “Helping Adjectives Meet a Satisfying End” for details). Look at the following examples, which show three different scenarios for preceded adjective endings: Du hast ein neueres Auto als ich. (You have a newer car than I do.) The direct object, ein neueres Auto, is in accusative case, and it’s singular. The indefinite article ein (a) has no ending in accusative singular case: It’s neuter to reflect the neuter noun (das) Auto. The base form of the adjective neu (new) has the comparative ending -er + the neuter, singular ending -es to form neueres (neu + -er + -es).

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

399

Ich habe den kleineren Wagen. (I have the smaller car.) The direct object, den kleineren Wagen, is in accusative case, and it’s singular. The definite article den (the) has the accusative masculine ending: It’s masculine to reflect the masculine noun (der) Wagen. The base form of the adjective klein (small) has the comparative ending -er + the singular, masculine accusative ending -en to form kleineren (klein + -er + -en). Köstlicheres Brot ist kaum zu finden. (It’s hard to find more delicious bread.) The subject of the sentence, köstlicheres Brot, is in nominative case, and it’s singular. The base form of the adjective köstlich (delicious) has the comparative ending -er + the neuter singular ending -es to reflect the neuter noun (das) Brot. The comparative köstlicheres is formed like this: köstlich + -er + -es = köstlicheres. German doesn’t use mehr (more) together with the -er ending. In English, the comparative adjective form can look like this: more intelligent or more interesting. German uses only the -er ending: intelligenter or interessanter.

Absolutely the most! Discussing superlatives The superlative form for adverbs as well as for adjectives that follow a noun in a sentence is am + adjective/adverb + -sten: Dieser Supermarkt ist am billigsten. (This supermarket is the cheapest/ most inexpensive.) Billig is the base form of the adjective, and am billigsten is the superlative. Gisela läuft am schnellsten. (Gisela runs the fastest.) Schnell is the base form of the adverb; am schnellsten is the superlative form. A superlative adjective often precedes the noun it modifies, which means it needs to reflect the noun’s gender, number, and case. You get the superlative form of such adjectives by adding -st to the base form and then adding the appropriate adjective ending (see the previous section in this chapter on adjective endings): höflich → höflichst- + adjective ending (polite → most polite). Manuela ist die höflichste Kollegin im Büro. (Manuela is the most polite colleague in the office.) Höflich is the base form of the adjective; die höflichst- + -e (Kollegin) is feminine, singular, nominative case. Onkel Kalle hat das schönste Haus. (Uncle Kalle has the nicest house.) Schön is the base form of the adjective; das schönst- + -e (Haus) is the superlative form that reflects the neuter, singular accusative noun das Haus. Note: Here’s the alternative form, which uses an adjective that follows the noun: Sein Haus ist am schönsten. (His house is the nicest.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

400

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication You make the superlative form for adjectives ending in -t or -z (and a few others) by adding -e + -st = -est for ease of pronunciation, as in elegantest- (most elegant). For example, Du findest die elegantesten Schuhe bei Salamander. (You find the most elegant shoes at Salamander [a well-known shoe store].) Elegant is the base form of the adjective; die elegant- + est- + -en is the superlative form that reflects the accusative plural noun Schuhe.

Considering common comparisons Table 5-7 lists some adjectives and adverbs that are frequently used to compare people and things. The fourth column shows any differences in spelling, as in nett → netter → am nettesten, where you add the -e in front of -st. The superlative form for all words is shown at first as am + (e)sten. You use this form when the adjective follows the noun and for adverbs. The form shown in parentheses is the form that you use when a superlative adjective precedes the noun. You add the adjective endings to that form.

Table 5-7

Regular Comparison Forms

English

Base

Comparative

Superlative

Spelling Changes

modest

bescheiden

bescheidener

am bescheidensten (bescheidenst-)

cheap, inexpensive

billig

billiger

am billigsten (billigst-)

dark

dunkel

dunkler

am dunkelsten (dunkelst-)

drop the last -e in the comparative

elegant

elegant

eleganter

am elegantesten (elegantest-)

add -e + st in the superlative

fit, in shape

fit

fitter

am fittesten (fittest-)

double the t; add -e + st in the superlative

hard working, industrious

fleißig

fleißiger

am fleißigsten (fleißigst-)

flexible

flexibel

flexibler

am flexibelsten (flexibelst-)

drop the last -e in the comparative

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs English

Base

Comparative

Superlative

friendly

freundlich

freundlicher

am freundlichsten (freundlichst-)

generous

großzügig

großzügiger

am großzügigsten (großzügigst-)

ugly

hässlich

hässlicher

am hässlichsten (hässlichst-)

polite

höflich

höflicher

am höflichsten (höflichst-)

pretty

hübsch

hübscher

am hübschesten (hübschest-)

add -e + st in the superlative

intelligent

intelligent

intelligenter

am intelligentesten (intellegentest-)

add -e + st in the superlative

musical

musikalisch

musikalischer

am musikalischsten (musikalischst-)

brave

mutig

mutiger

am mutigsten (mutigst-)

nice

nett

netter

am nettesten (nettest-)

neat

ordentlich

ordentlicher

am ordentlichsten (ordentlichst-)

chic, stylish

schick

schicker

am schicksten (schickst-)

pretty, beautiful

schön

schöner

am schönsten (schönst-)

athletic

sportlich

sportlicher

am sportlichsten (sportlichst-)

expensive

teuer

teurer

am teuersten (teuerst-)

sensible

vernünftig

vernünftiger

am vernünftigsten (vernünftigst-)

witty

witzig

witziger

am witzigsten (witzigst-)

401

Spelling Changes

Book III

add -e + st in the superlative

drop the last -e in the comparative

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

402

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

When making a sentence, remember to add the appropriate endings to adjectives of comparison when needed. Adjectives following a noun don’t need to reflect the gender, number, and case of the noun, but adjectives that precede the noun do need agreement. The following example sentences use the comparative or superlative form of the adjective: Mein Bruder ist witziger als ich. (My brother is wittier than I.) Wir waren vorher mutiger als jetzt. (We were braver then than now.) Siegbert machte den nettesten Eindruck. (Siegbert made the nicest impression.) Ich bin fitter als du. (I’m in better shape than you.) Am glücklichsten bin ich mit meiner Familie. (I’m happiest [when I’m] with my family.) Wiebke hat jetzt dunkleres Haar als früher. (Wiebke now has darker hair than before.)

Adding the umlaut in regular comparisons German wouldn’t be the same without its three interesting-looking letters that have umlauts (not to mention that cool ess-tset, the letter ß). When forming the comparative and superlative forms of some adjectives and adverbs, be careful to add the umlaut when you need it. The general guideline for adding umlauts in comparisons is simple to remember: Many adjectives and adverbs with one syllable and with an -a, -o, or -u in the base form add an umlaut in the comparative and superlative forms: alt → älter → ältest- (old → older → oldest). Of course, there are some exceptions: Some common one-syllable words with an -a, -o, or -u in the base form don’t have an umlaut: blond (blond[e]), bunt (colorful), falsch (wrong), froh (glad), klar (clear), toll (amazing, great), wahr (true), and laut (loud, noisy). Note: Laut has -au in the base form, unlike the others in this list. We include it here because it doesn’t add an umlaut in the comparative and superlative forms.

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

403

Here are a couple of examples: Herr Diefenbacher ist alt, aber Frau Kolbe ist noch älter. (Herr Diefenbacher is old, but Frau Kolbe is even older.) The adjective alt (base form) changes to älter, with an umlaut in the comparative form. Die ärmsten Länder brauchen sehr viel Unterstützung. (The poorest countries need a lot of aid.) The adjective ärmsten is the superlative form; die ärmsten Länder is the subject (nominative case), and it’s plural. Ärmsten precedes the noun, so it needs the adjective ending to reflect Länder. You form it like this: arm- (base form) changes to ärm- (add the umlaut) + -est (superlative ending) + en (nominative plural ending). Table 5-8 shows some common adjectives and adverbs together with the German base and the comparative and superlative forms that use an umlaut.

Table 5-8

Comparison Forms with Umlauts

English Equivalent

Base

Comparative

Superlative

old

alt

älter

am ältesten

poor

arm

ärmer

am ärmsten

stupid

dumm

dümmer

am dümmsten

Book III

crude, coarse

grob

gröber

am gröbsten

large, big, tall

groß

größer

am größten

hard, tough

hart

härter

am härtesten

young

jung

jünger

am jüngsten

cold

kalt

kälter

am kältesten

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Using Irregular Comparison Forms German has some wayward characters among its adjectives and adverbs, but luckily, a few of these irregular types have parallels to English odd ducks. The classic example is gut → besser → am besten, which is easily recognizable in English as good → better → best. These irregular words are very common, and there are only a few of them, so getting them into your active vocabulary should be a snap. All you need to do is memorize the list of frequently used irregular comparison forms shown in Table 5-9.

404

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 5-9

Irregular Comparison Forms

English Equivalent

Base

Comparative

Superlative

soon, sooner, soonest

bald

eher

am ehesten

like/enjoy (doing something), prefer, like most of all

gern

lieber

am liebsten

good, better, best

gut

besser

am besten

high, higher, highest

hoch

höher

am höchsten

near, nearer, nearest

nah

näher

am nächsten

much, more, most

viel

mehr

am meisten

The use of gern (the base form of the word meaning to like, to enjoy [doing something]) is easiest to remember in the context of some common expressions: ✓ Ich spiele gern Klavier./Ich tanze gern./Ich esse gern Fisch. (I like to play the piano./I like to dance./I like to eat fish.) You use this construction to express that you like an activity, sport, game, food, and so on. Also: Ich spiele lieber Tennis./Ich trinke am liebsten Wasser. (I prefer playing tennis./I like drinking water most of all.) The base forms of these sentences are Ich spiele gern Tennis and Ich trinke gern Wasser (I like to play tennis and I like to drink water). ✓ Ich möchte gern wissen, ob . . . (I wonder if . . . ) ✓ Was möchtest du lieber . . . ? (Which would you rather . . . ?) ✓ Am liebsten möchte ich . . . (Most of all, I’d like to . . .) Use this expression to talk about an activity/food/place that you like or would like to do/eat/go to/and so on.

Comparing Equals and Nonequals When you were a kid, you probably boasted about yourself, saying you were better than the rest. Now that you’ve grown up, you have to consider a few more factors in your comparisons with others, and you may want to sound more diplomatic. Using the expressions in this section, you can sound smooth enough (and diplomatic enough) to impress almost anyone. Table 5-10 lists some commonly used expressions that describe equality or inequality between things, people, or ideas. The example sentences show how these expressions fit into sentences. Notice the word order of the information in each example sentence; with the exception of je . . . desto (the . . .

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

405

-er, the . . . -er), you use the same word order in German and English to make comparisons using these expressions. The adjective or adverb that you’re using as a comparison is in the middle of the two parts of the expression. For example, if you use the adverb schnell (fast) to say just as fast as . . . , you say genauso schnell wie . . . in German.

Table 5-10

Comparison Forms of Equals/Nonequals

Comparison of Equals/Nonequals

English Equivalent

Example Sentence

English Translation

genauso . . . wie . . .

just as . . . as . . .

Mein Auto fährt genauso schnell wie sein Motorrad.

My car goes just as fast as his motorcycle.

halb so . . . wie . . .

half as . . . as . . .

Das Ergebnis war nur halb so schlimm wie wir erwarteten.

The result was only half as bad as we expected.

nicht so . . . wie . . .

not as . . . as . . .

Ich bin nicht so stark wie ich dachte.

I’m not as strong as I thought.

so . . . wie . . .

as . . . as . . .

Unsere Produkte sind so zuverlässig wie importierte Produkte.

Our products are as reliable as imported products.

Je mehr Sie lesen, desto besser informiert werden Sie. (Note: The word order is different in English.)

The more you read, the better informed you’ll be.

je . . . , desto . . . (comparative words follow je . . . , desto . . .)

the . . . -er, the . . . -er (adjectives or adverbs in comparative form)

Look at these example sentences, along with a few notes on word order: Ein neuer BMW kostet so viel wie ein neuer Mercedes. (A new BMW costs as much as a new Mercedes.) Note that you can also say this in reverse order: Ein neuer Mercedes kostet so viel wie ein neuer BMW. (A new Mercedes costs as much as a new BMW.) Ein Baseballspieler läuft halb so viel wie ein Fußballspieler. (A baseball player runs half as much as a soccer player.) Je mehr er Poker spielt, desto reicher wird er. (The more he plays poker, the richer he becomes.) This one has a tricky word order.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

406

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Die neuen Autos benutzen nicht so viel Benzin wie die alten Modelle. (The new cars don’t use as much gas as the old models.) You can also say this one in reverse order. Schwarz-Weiß-Filme sind genauso spannend wie Farbfilme. (Black-andwhite movies are just as exciting as movies in Technicolor.) This one works in the reverse order, too. Je qualifizierter man ist, desto mehr verdient man. (The more qualified one is, the more one earns.) This statement has tricky word order and doesn’t make sense in reverse. Das Wetter in Deutschland ist so schön wie das Wetter in Neuengland. (The weather in Germany is as nice as the weather in New England.) This one also works in reverse.

Identifying Unique Adjective and Adverb Groups The structure and usage of some adjectives and adverbs is unique. These types include adjectives used as nouns, participles used as adjectives or adverbs, and adverbs that modify adjectives. Most are fairly easy to remember because they have parallel meanings and structures in English. You need to know these three groups because they’re high-frequency words and expressions that you come across in everyday language, and they help you express yourself more clearly. This section takes a closer look at the following three unique groups and explains how to use them in sentences: ✓ Adjectives used as nouns: Naturally, these adjectives stand in for the noun. In other words, they omit the noun — for example, das Richtige (the right thing/decision/choice). ✓ Participles that function as adjectives or adverbs: An example is am motiviertesten (the most motivated). The present participle of motivieren (to motivate) is motivierend (motivating), and the past participle is motiviert (motivated). ✓ Adverbs that modify adjectives: The combination of adverb + adjective here serves to make the adjective more descriptive; for example, in the expression wirklich interessant, you use the word wirklich (really, absolutely) to modify interessant (interesting).

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

407

Adjectives that act as nouns Sometimes adjectives replace a noun to represent an abstract idea, a person, an object, and so on. The noun that the adjective replaces may be singular or plural, and it may be the subject or the object of a sentence; in short, the adjective functions just as the noun does. The same structure exists in English and German for adjectives that take over as nouns; for example, the poor, the brave, the lonely one, the new ones. The only difference is that in German, nouns are capitalized and the spelling reflects gender, number, and case. In addition, German doesn’t have an equivalent for one/ones, so the German adjective stands alone to represent the noun. To understand how such adjectives work, imagine you’re discussing with your friend which cat you want to take home from the animal shelter. You talk about die Große, die Braune, and die Ruhige (the little one, the brown one, the quiet one). You’re replacing the word Katze (cat) by describing a characteristic of each cat and using that adjective to represent that cat. You use the feminine article die because Katze is a feminine noun. If you’re talking about taking home a dog, der Hund, instead, you refer to each one as der Große, der Braune, and der Ruhige. When you make your decision, you may say something like Ich nehme den Braunen. (I’ll take the brown one [dog].) The adjective has the accusative masculine singular case ending -en to reflect the noun it’s replacing. Look at these example sentences: Ich wünsche euch das Beste. (I wish you the best.) Das Beste is a noun. Kennst du die Kleine da drüben? (Do you know the small [woman] over there?) The article die combines with Kleine to stand in for the noun woman (die Frau). Note: Die Kleine doesn’t necessarily have to refer to a small woman. However, if it’s used to refer to a woman, it’s colloquial, a bit like saying that babe.

Participles that function as adjectives or adverbs In German, as in English, present and past participles can function as adjectives or adverbs. If the adjectives precede a noun, they agree in gender, number, and case with the noun they modify. In English, a present participle is the infinitive (for instance, fly, tumble, or seethe) with the ending -ing. When you use it as an adjective, you combine it with the noun you want to modify; for example, the flying squirrels, the tumbling acrobats, or the seething volcano.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

408

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication To create the present participle in German, start with a verb, such as laufen (to run). Then drop the infinitive ending -en and add -end to the infinitive form (lauf- + -end = laufend). The present participle of laufen is laufend (the closest thing to the English word running). Look at this example: Er erzählte Witze am laufenden Band. (He told an endless stream of jokes. Literally: He told jokes on a running band/belt.) A past participle of a regular verb in English is the infinitive of a verb with -ed or -d added. For an irregular verb, it’s the form such as eaten, hidden, or seen that you use to form the present perfect tense and other compound verb tenses. (An example of the present perfect tense is Scruffy has already eaten, where you combine the past participle eaten with the auxiliary verb have.) You can also use the past participle as a descriptive word; for example, the drenched cat, sunken treasure, or forbidden fruit. In German, verbs form past participles differently, depending on the verb type (see Book IV, Chapter 4); for instance, the past participle of pflegen is gepflegt (groomed, taken care of). The phrases gepflegtes Essen (first-rate food) and gepflegte Weine (quality wines) are typical descriptions that restaurants use to impress their clientele. Literally speaking, these expressions mean groomed food/wines in the sense that the restaurant has a carefully selected menu or wine list. Some German verbs, namely the verbs ending in -ieren, are cognates — in other words, they have the same meanings in English — making them easily recognizable. The past participle form of these verbs is formed with -iert at the end; the ending is the same, regardless of whether you’re using the past participle as an adjective or adverb. Many of these common adjectives have comparative and superlative forms: Some common adjectives with this structure are dekoriert (decorated), diszipliniert (disciplined), fasziniert (fascinated), frustriert (dissastisfied, frustrated), interessiert (interested), motiviert (motivated), organisiert (organized), and talentiert (talented). They can all form comparative and superlative adjectives (and possibly adverbs): Der Gefreite Schwarz war der disziplinierteste Soldat in seiner Kompanie. (Private Schwarz was the most disciplined soldier in his company.) Diszipliniertest- is a superlative adjective. In der Schule war ich motivierter als meine Schwester. (I was more motivated than my sister when I was in school.) Motivierter is a comparative adjective. Wir schauten die Olympische Spiele fasziniert zu. (We watched the Olympic Games with fascination.) Fasziniert is an adverb describing how we watched.

Chapter 5: Describing and Comparing with Adjectives and Adverbs

409

Some frequently used adjectives derived from past participles don’t have comparative forms. Among the more common are ausprobiert (tested), diskutiert (discussed), fotografiert (photographed), and probiert (tried/ tested). See the earlier section “Comparing with Regular Adjectives and Adverbs: Fast, Faster, Fastest” for more on comparatives.

Adverbs that modify adjectives Adverbs often modify verbs, but they can also modify adjectives. For instance, to express that something or someone is quite good, especially interesting, or really motivated, you use adverbs to modify the adjective. The adverbs frequently used with adjectives in German are besonders (especially), etwas (somewhat), relativ (relatively), sehr (very), viel (much, a lot), wirklich (absolutely, really), and ziemlich (quite). The good news here is that they don’t have any changes in the endings. To use an adverb to modify an adjective, just place the adverb in front of the adjective it’s modifying, and voilà! To see how this works, imagine you’re talking about the hotels you stayed at on your last trip to Europe. One hotel was especially luxurious. To express this in German, you place the adverb wirklich (really) in front of luxuriös (luxurious), and if the adjective precedes the noun that it modifies, add the appropriate adjective ending; for example, Wir haben zwei Nächte in einem wirklich luxuriösen Hotel übernachtet. (We spent two nights in a really luxurious hotel.) Here are two more examples: Der Sommer war etwas wärmer als in vergangenen Jahren. (The summer was somewhat warmer than in previous years.) The adverb etwas modifies the adjective wärmer, which is in the comparative form. The adjective wärmer needs no ending because it doesn’t precede the noun that it modifies, der Sommer. Letztes Jahr hatten wir einen ziemlich langen Winter. (Last year we had quite a long winter.) The adverb ziemlich modifies the adjective lang: einen ziemlich langen. Winter is the direct object of the sentence, so the other modifiers — einen and langen — have masculine, singular, accusative endings to reflect (der) Winter.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

410

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Chapter 6

Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries In This Chapter ▶ Modifying with modals: The what and the why ▶ Putting modals to work: Conjugating the present tense ▶ Clearing up confusion: English and German differences ▶ Choosing between similar helping verbs

I

hope you’re in a good mood as you start this chapter about modal auxiliary verbs. I’m talking about attitude with a capital A in the next few pages. In grammar mumbo jumbo, modals are auxiliary (helping) verbs that indicate an attitude about the main verb, even though they don’t directly alter the main verb’s action. This motley band of modal verbs helps set the mood of the sentence. They can, at times, be quite influential in their mood-altering abilities — and all without illegal substances. Mood is grammarspeak for how something is expressed in a sentence: The mood of a verb indicates a wide range of, yes, moods such as probability, impossibility, certainty, doubt, or even just plain old facts, without all the Schnickschnack (bells and whistles). If you’re asking yourself whether you can get by without using modals, the answer is plain and simple: No way, José — not unless you’re willing to put up with being misunderstood in daily situations in which the modals should make your intended thought clear to the listener. In this chapter, you find out what the seven modal verbs are, together with their equivalents in English, and you discover the importance of modal verbs in everyday situations. You get the present-tense conjugation of these verbs and the particulars on important characteristics of these verbs.

412

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Grasping the Basics of Modal Verbs Modal verbs modify the main verb in the sentence. Here’s how they work: You take a plain old verb or phrase like eat, sleep, walk, plant a garden, play tennis, learn how to play chess, or do nothing. Then you think about your attitude toward these activities, and you decide you want to say I like to eat, I must sleep more, I would like to walk every day, I should plant a garden, I can play tennis well, I want to learn how to play chess, or I may do nothing. The underlined modal verbs offer you a wide range of ways to express your attitude toward actions such as eat, sleep, play, and learn. You find modals working their magic in sentences in the indicative mood. This type of mood is for stating facts. Modal verbs also crop up in sentences expressed in the subjunctive mood. That’s what you use when you want to sound polite when requesting or suggesting something or when you want to make hypothetical statements. (Chapter 7 of Book IV is where you find out about the subjunctive.) This section gives you a quick overview of what modal verbs are and how they work. The rest of this chapter focuses on the seven specific modal verbs.

Identifying modals: Assistants with attitude Modals are your ticket to conveying your attitude or how you feel about an action. They usually accompany another verb and appear in the second position of a sentence. The main verb they assist generally appears at the end of the clause. Table 6-1 shows the German modal verbs in infinitive form and the English translation, followed by a statement using the modal verb. Look at the various ways of modifying the statement Ich lerne Deutsch (I learn German) with the modal verbs. Notice that the modal verb is in second position in the sentence, and the main verb gets booted to the end.

Table 6-1

German Modal Verbs

German Modal Verb

Translation

Example

English Equivalent

dürfen

may, to be allowed to

Ich darf Deutsch lernen.

l may/am allowed to learn German.

können

can, to be able to

Ich kann Deutsch lernen.

l can/am able to learn German.

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries German Modal Verb

Translation

Example

English Equivalent

mögen

to like to

Ich mag Deutsch lernen.

l like to learn German.

möchten

would like to

Ich möchte Deutsch lernen.

l would like to learn German.

müssen

must, to have to

Ich muss Deutsch lernen.

l must/have to learn German.

sollen

should, to be supposed to

Ich soll Deutsch lernen.

I am supposed to/should learn German.

wollen

to want to

Ich will Deutsch lernen.

I want to learn German.

413

These verbs all have regular verb endings in their plural forms (wir, ihr, sie, and Sie). Most of them also have irregular verb changes, some of which you can see in the examples in Table 6-1. As you go through Die Glorreichen Sieben (The Magnificent Seven — modal verbs, that is) in this chapter, you see the irregular verb endings of these verbs in the present tense. In English, you typically have two verbs in a sentence that has a modal verb; the second one is the main verb. In German, however, the modal verb may be the only verb. The one true rogue is the verb mögen, which frequently stands alone, and to a lesser extent, its cousin möchten. (Check out the sections “I Like That: Mögen, the Likeable Verb” and “What Would You Like? Möchten, the Preference Verb” for more information on these two.)

Understanding word order and modals In terms of word order for modals, German uses pretty much the same order as for other verbs that require an auxiliary verb to complete the meaning of the main verb. The present perfect and the future tenses also use a secondary, auxiliary verb to complete the main verb’s meaning. With these verb types (and tenses), you conjugate the auxiliary verb, put it in second position in the sentence, and generally put the main verb at the end of the clause or phrase. (See Chapter 4 of Book IV for present perfect verbs and Chapter 6 of Book IV for future tense verbs and their word order.) Look at the examples in Table 6-1. The conjugated, active verb is in second position in the sentence. It directly follows the subject or other elements, such as a reference to time or a prepositional phrase. When you need more than one verb, the others go to the very end of the sentence.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

414

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Questions follow a slightly different word order (inverted word order) if they’re the type of question that can be answered with yes, no, or maybe. See Chapter 4 of Book III for info on forming questions.

May I? Dürfen, the Permission Verb Some people feel rules and customs crimp their personal style, but such guidelines give people an idea of what they can expect from each other. The rules of the road allow you to do something (or not) — you may proceed with caution at a yield sign, but you’re not allowed to cross the double yellow line. And being polite by asking permission — May I use your bathroom? May I have another cookie? — is certainly not limited to young boys and girls. Adults in all parts of the world know that asking for and granting permission is part of the code of polite interaction.

Forming dürfen You use the modal verb dürfen to ask for and grant permission. Look at the conjugation of dürfen. It’s irregular in the singular forms: ich, du, and er/sie/ es. In the table, the irregular forms are bold, and the regular forms show the endings in bold. dürfen (may, to be allowed to, to be permitted to) ich darf

wir dürfen

du darfst

ihr dürft

er/sie/es darf

sie dürfen Sie dürfen

Sie dürfen dort nicht parken. (You’re not allowed to park there.)

Using dürfen German uses dürfen in a wide variety of everyday situations. Table 6-2 lists four common idiomatic expressions with dürfen, followed by an example sentence in German and the English equivalent. You frequently hear these expressions in polite exchanges between people who don’t know each other well.

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries Table 6-2

415

Uses of Dürfen in Polite Conversation

Situation

Example

English Equivalent

to ask whether a customer needs assistance

Was darf es sein?

May I help you?

to signal someone to do a favor such as opening the door

Darf ich Sie bitten?

May I trouble you?

to say that you’d like to introduce two people to each other

Darf ich Ihnen Frau Feuerstein vorstellen?

May I introduce you to Mrs. Feuerstein?

to explain that something is not allowed

Das Obst dürfen Sie nicht anfassen.

You may not/must not touch the fruit.

Generally speaking, German and English use dürfen (may, to be allowed to, to be permitted to) in very similar ways: to ask for permission, to grant permission, and to state that something is (or is not) permitted or allowed. German sometimes uses the impersonal form man (it, one, you) with dürfen, as in the following example sentence: Man darf hier nicht parken. For the equivalent in English, you use the passive construction (parking/passing/ stopping isn’t allowed here), or you simply say no parking/passing/stopping (allowed here). English uses may to express possibility, whereas dürfen doesn’t have this meaning. Instead, you’d use vielleicht (maybe/perhaps) to express possibility or chance. For instance, you can translate Vielleicht komme ich spät nach Hause as I may come home late. However, Perhaps I’ll come home late is closer to the word-for-word translation, even though German doesn’t use the future tense in the example sentence. (For information on the present tense, see Chapter 3 of Book III.) Watch out for false friends (which we discuss in Chapter 1 of Book I). The modal verb müssen looks somewhat similar to the English must, which is the correct meaning in English; however, you express must not in German with nicht dürfen: Sie dürfen hier nicht rauchen. (You must not/are not allowed to smoke here.) Look at the following example sentences with dürfen: Sie darf das nicht tun. (She is not allowed to do that.) Darf ich Sie daran erinnern? (May I remind you of that?)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

416

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Wir dürfen das nicht vergessen. (We must not forget that.) Das dürfen wir nicht vergessen. (We must never forget that.) The message is the same as with the previous sentence, but the word order is slightly different: Das (that) and wir (we) are switched. The modal auxiliary verb, dürfen, is in the second position in both sentences. Er hätte so etwas nicht machen dürfen. (He should never have been allowed to do that.) This sentence contains three verbs, and hätte (should have) is the conjugated verb. The other two verbs, machen (to make) and dürfen (to be allowed to), are at the end. Ich bin sehr dankbar, dich zu meinen Freunden zählen zu dürfen. (I am very grateful to be able to count you among my friends.) The verb zählen (to count) is followed by zu dürfen (to be allowed to). These phrases can combine with an idea that follows: Wenn ich fragen darf . . . (If you don’t mind my asking . . .) With the word order here, the verb dürfen needs to be at the end of the phrase; wenn (when) sends the verb to the end. The phrase that completes the thought is most likely in the form of a question. Ich darf wohl sagen, dass . . . (I dare say that . . .) The conjunction dass (that) needs to be followed by a phrase that has the verb at the end. (For information on conjunctions like dass, check out Chapter 1 of Book IV.) Wir dürfen sicher sein, dass . . . (We may be certain that . . .) Sie dürfen damit rechnen, dass . . . (You may rest assured that . . .)

You Can Do It! Können, the Ability Verb Can you run a marathon barefoot? Do you know how to play chess (and win) against a computer? Are you able to make a five-course dinner for 12 guests without batting an eye? No matter what your hidden talents may be, if you have a healthy ego, then chances are you enjoy talking about yourself. Knowhow, ability, and can-do attitude — all are expressed with the verb können. As one of the seven players in the modal verb dugout, können (can, to be able to, to know how to) is a true champ. In general, German and English use können in similar ways. The verb goes up to bat whenever you need to express that ✓ You can or can’t do something: Kannst du Tennis/Tischtennis/ Volleyball/Schach/Poker spielen? (Can you play tennis/table tennis/ volleyball/chess/poker?)

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries

417

✓ You know or don’t know how to do something: Er kann Geige/Klavier/ Keyboards/Gitarre/Klarinette/Saxophon spielen. (He knows how to play the violin/piano/keyboards/guitar/clarinet/saxophone.) In German, you don’t use the definite article der, die, das [the] to talk about playing an instrument. ✓ You are able to do something: Ich kann bis Mittag schlafen. (I’m able to/ can sleep until noon.) ✓ You want to request or offer help in a polite but direct way: Können Sie mir sagen, wo der Bahnhof/die Straßenbahnhaltestelle/das Hotel Blaue Gans/das Kunstmuseum ist? (Can you tell me where the train station/the streetcar stop/the Hotel Blaue Gans/the art museum is?) Note: Notice the comma after the first clause. In German, you need this comma to separate the subordinate clause (. . . wo der Bahnhof ist?) from the main clause (Können Sie mir sagen, . . .). Subordinate clauses often begin with words like wo (where), was (what), wie viel (how much), wer (who), and warum (why). The conjugated verb in the subordinate clause, ist (is), gets the boot and lands at the end of the sentence. (For information on subordinate clauses, see Chapter 1 of Book IV.)

Forming können

Book III

Look at the conjugation of können. It’s irregular in the singular forms: ich, du, and er/sie/es. The irregular forms are bold, and the regular forms show the endings in bold. können (can, to be able to, to know how to) ich kann

wir können

du kannst

ihr könnt

er/sie/es kann

sie können Sie können

Ich kann Ihnen mit ihrem Gepäck helfen. (I can help you with your luggage.)

Using können One striking difference between English and German is that German sometimes describes what can or can’t be done using können but no main verb. Typically, you hear the following expressions in spoken, casual conversation. Table 6-3 lists the situation, an example sentence in German, and its equivalent in English.

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

418

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 6-3

Uses of Können without a Main Verb

Situation

Example

English Equivalent

to say someone can speak a language

Meine Frau kann sehr gut Französisch.

My wife can speak French very well.

to say that you give up trying

Ich kann nicht weiter. Es ist zu schwer.

I can’t go on. It’s too difficult.

to explain that you can’t help doing (excusing yourself for taking a third piece of chocolate cake)

Ich kann nichts dafür. Es schmeckt so gut!

I can’t help it. It tastes so good!

to interject that you can do something

Das kann ich wohl!

Of course I can do that!

A number of common können expressions are reflexive (they use a reflexive pronoun [me, you, us, and so on] with the verb) in German but not in English. German uses the reflexive much more frequently than English. (For information on reflexive verbs, check out Chapter 3 of Book IV.) Table 6-4 lists these common expressions, an example sentence in German, and the English translation.

Table 6-4

Uses of Können with a Reflexive Verb

Situation

Example

English Equivalent

to say you can(‘t) decide

Ich kann mich nicht entscheiden.

I can’t decide.

to express that you can get away with something

Wie kannst du dir so etwas erlauben?

How can you get away with something like that?

to be able (or unable) to afford something

Wir können uns kein teueres Auto leisten.

We can’t afford an expensive car.

to give assurance that someone/something can be trusted

Sie können sich auf mich verlassen.

You can depend on me.

Notice the word order in the following expressions. When there are two verbs, the main verb (the one that’s in infinitive form) gets kicked to the end of the sentence. (Harsh treatment for some decent, upstanding verbs, but it’s true!)

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries

419

Sie kann Klarinette spielen. (She can play the clarinet.) The word order needs to have the conjugated verb kann in second position and the main verb spielen (in the infinitive form) at the end of the sentence. Können Sie mir helfen? (Can you help me?) Können is the conjugated verb, and in a yes/no question, it’s first; the verb helfen needs to be at the end. Könnt ihr gut Tennis spielen? (Can you play tennis well?) Könnt is the conjugated verb. This is a yes/no question, so it’s in first position. The verb spielen needs to be at the end. Ich kann Englisch, Deutsch, und Spanisch. (I can speak English, German, and Spanish.) Können needs no other verb here. However, you can add sprechen (to speak) at the end of the sentence, especially if you want to go on and say something different about another language: Ich kann Französisch verstehen, aber nicht sprechen. (I can understand French but not speak it.) Ich kann Fußball spielen. (I can play soccer.) In this word order, the conjugated modal verb kann is in second position, and the main verb spielen (in infinitive form) is at the end of the sentence.

I Like That: Mögen, the Likeable Verb Want to talk about likes and dislikes? Mögen is the verb for you. Consider these sentences: Magst du kaltes Wetter? (Do you like cold weather?) Nein, ich mag den Winter überhaupt nicht. (No, I don’t like the winter at all.) Want to express your feelings toward someone? Try ich mag dich (I like you). The main definition of mögen is that of liking or disliking someone or something. When talking about such preferences, you usually don’t need an additional verb: Magst du diese Sängerin? (Do you like this female singer?) Er mag kein Starkbier. (He doesn’t like strong beer.) The modal verb mögen comes as a double dipper. Why? Because mögen (to like, to care for) is so likeable that it has a cousin, möchten (would like, would like to do), which is similar in meaning to mögen. (Check out the later section for more on möchten.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

420

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Forming mögen This verb table shows you the conjugation of mögen. It follows the typical pattern of modal verbs: the singular verb forms are the irregular ones — ich mag, du magst, er/sie/es mag. The irregular forms are shown in bold, and the regular forms show the endings in bold. mögen (to like, to care for) ich mag

wir mögen

du magst

ihr mögt

er/sie/es mag

sie mögen Sie mögen

Ich mag klassische Musik. (I like classical music.) When you want to express dislike for someone or something, you put nicht at the end of the sentence when no other verb is along for the ride: Ihr mögt diese Farbe nicht. (You don’t like this color.) Mögen sie Schokoladeneis nicht? (Don’t they like chocolate ice cream?)

Using mögen To add some oomph to mögen, you can use a number of expressions with gern (gern is similar to a lot when you add it to other words). We’ve arranged the list in order of most positive to most negative: ✓ mögen . . . besonders gern (to especially like): Ich mag Bratkartoffeln besonders gern. (I especially like roasted potatoes.) They’re similar to home fries. ✓ mögen . . . (sehr) gern (to like [very much]): Ich mag Kartoffelklöße (sehr) gern. (I like potato dumplings very much.) In southern Germany and Austria, Klöße are referred to as Knödel, both of which are dumplings. ✓ mögen . . . nicht gern (not to like very much): Ich mag Pommes frites nicht gern. (I don’t like French fries very much.) ✓ mögen . . . überhaupt nicht gern (not to like at all): Ich mag Salzkartoffeln überhaupt nicht gern. (I don’t like boiled potatoes at all.)

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries

421

A few idiomatic expressions use mögen: ✓ Das mag sein. (That could be true.) ✓ Ich mag ihn leiden. (I care for him.) You can also leave off leiden without changing the meaning much, but leiden stresses the emotion of caring. ✓ Darin mögen Sie Recht haben. (You have a point there.)

What Would You Like? Möchten, the Preference Verb Life is full of choices, and you’re likely to have some opinions on what you like best. When the Kellner/Kellnerin (waiter/waitress) in a German restaurant asks you, “Was möchten Sie?” (What would you like?), make sure you order something to drink first — “Ich möchte eine Apfelsaftschorle.” (I’d like an apple juice/mineral water drink.) That way, you have time to peruse the eight-page menu and order the meal later. To say you’d like [to do] something in German, you use the modal verb möchten.

Forming möchten Although möchten (would like [to do]) is often lumped together with mögen (to like, to care for) (see the preceding section for more info), it’s definitely important enough to get top billing in the modal verb lineup. Technically speaking, möchten is the subjunctive form of mögen; it expresses a wish rather than reality. (Check out Book IV, Chapter 7 for more on the subjunctive.) Look at the conjugation of möchten. The verb endings are in bold. möchten (would like [to]) ich möchte

wir möchten

du möchtest

ihr möchtet

er/sie/es möchte

sie möchten Sie möchten

Ich möchte am Wochenende Rad fahren. (I’d like to go bicycling on the weekend.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

422

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Using möchten The important similarity that möchten and mögen share, aside from their meanings, is that neither modal verb needs a main verb to express something clearly. For instance, when ordering in a restaurant, the context can typically indicate what you’d like to have. Using möchten as the modal verb, you can omit the following main verbs: ✓ essen (to eat) ✓ trinken (to drink) ✓ haben (to have) ✓ fahren (to drive) ✓ gehen (to go, to walk) Look at the two example sentences, one with and one without a main verb. Assuming you know they’re spoken in a restaurant, the meaning of the first sentence, which has no main verb, is clear: Ich möchte ein Glas Rotwein, bitte. (I’d like a glass of red wine, please.) Ich möchte ein Glas Rotwein trinken, bitte. (I’d like to drink a glass of red wine, please.) Or you can use haben (to have) instead of trinken, and you’d still get a glass of red wine. German often expresses a preference by using möchten in combination with lieber (rather). The following example dialogue shows haben in parentheses to indicate that it’s not necessary in the context of the situation: Möchten Sie einen Fensterplatz (haben)? (Would you like a window seat?) Nein, ich möchte lieber einen Gangplatz (haben). (No, I’d rather have an aisle seat.) The following examples show more ways to use möchten: Ich möchte eine Tasse Kaffee. (I’d like a cup of coffee.) Ich möchte eine Pizza, bitte. (I’d like a pizza, please.) Wir möchten Deutsch lernen. (We’d like to learn German.) Ich möchte zu Hause bleiben. (I’d like to stay at home.)

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries

423

Sie möchte mit Andreas tanzen. (She’d like to dance with Andreas.) Möchtest du ein Glas Wasser? (Would you like a glass of water?)

Do I Have To? Müssen, the Verb of Necessity As a child, you may have heard something along the lines of “No, you don’t have to finish your broccoli au gratin, but you have to try at least three bites.” So now that you’ve grown up — or at least other people think you have — far more serious obligations haunt you, such as paying taxes, mowing the lawn, and having the first local strawberries of the season before anyone else. Müssen bears a vague resemblance to must, making it easier to get down to the nitty-gritty of how this modal works, when you need it, when you have to use it, when it’s a must, and when you don’t have to deal with it. What about must not? Oddly enough, must not is darf nicht in German, with the modal verb dürfen (to be allowed to). (Check out the earlier section on dürfen if you’re a bit foggy on the difference between the two verbs.)

Forming müssen Take a look at the conjugation of müssen. Like most of its fellow modal verbs, it’s irregular in the singular forms: ich, du, and er/sie/es. The irregular forms are in bold, and the regular forms show the endings in bold. müssen (must, to have to, to need to) ich muss

wir müssen

du musst

ihr müsst

er/sie/es muss

sie müssen Sie müssen

Er muss morgen früh aufstehen. (He has to get up early tomorrow.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

424

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Using müssen Necessity and obligation are the core meanings of müssen in both English and German, although in the English-speaking world and among North Americans in particular, there’s a tendency to downplay the use of must because it sounds so strong to the ear. Do I have to? works just fine at getting the obligation message across (especially when uttered by whining 10-yearolds after you’ve told them to turn off the TV and go to bed). Don’t get lulled into thinking that muss nicht is equivalent to must not. When you turn müssen into a negative expression, the similarities between German and English go down the drain. German has two expressions for indicating whether something is forbidden or simply not necessary: ✓ nicht dürfen (not allowed, must not, not permitted): A no-no; strong prohibition, such as Du darfst das nicht trinken. (You mustn’t drink that.) ✓ nicht müssen (not necessary, don’t need to): An absence of necessity or obligation, such as Du musst das nicht trinken. (You don’t need to drink that.) The following sentences show how to use the modal auxiliary verb müssen: Ich muss jetzt gehen. (I have to leave now.) Sie muss das sehr genau machen. (She has to do that very precisely.) Wir müssen eine Entscheidung treffen. (We have to come to a decision.) Er muss im Bett bleiben. (He has to stay in bed.) Sie muss das Haus hüten. (She has to stay at home.) Ich muss damit rechnen. (I have to face that.) Wir müssen sparen. (We have to save [money].) Following are some commonly used fixed expressions using müssen: Sie müssen Farben bekennen. (You have to show your true colors.) Wir müssen zusammenhalten. (We have to stick together.) Sie müssen die Folgen tragen. (She has to bear the consequences.) Er muss sich entscheiden. (He has to reach a decision.) Muss das sein? (Is that really necessary?) This expression in the form of a question is typically used to indicate that you call into question or disapprove of someone else’s actions.

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries

425

These beginning phrases can combine with an idea that follows. The second phrase in the sentence uses the conjunction dass (that), which needs to be followed by a phrase that has the verb at the end. (For information on conjunctions like dass, check out Chapter 1 of Book IV.) Ich muss zugeben, dass . . . (I have to admit that . . .) Wir müssen bedenken, dass . . . (We have to consider that . . .) Sie müssen wissen, dass . . . (You have to know that . . .)

Should I or Shouldn’t I? Sollen, the Duty Verb There are things in life that you have to do and things you’re supposed to do. We prefer the latter because they’re easier to put off. But wasting valuable vacation time to accomplish everything on your checklist is something you really shouldn’t do. So the to-do list just gets longer and longer until the day it fortuitously gets lost in the trash. When you want to describe an action you should or shouldn’t do or that you’re supposed to or not supposed to do, sollen is the verb to use.

Forming sollen Look at the conjugation of this modal verb in the table that follows. Sollen is irregular only in two places — the ich and er/sie/es forms. The irregular forms are in bold, and the regular forms show the endings in bold. sollen (should, to be supposed to) ich soll

wir sollen

du sollst

ihr sollt

er/sie/es soll

sie sollen Sie sollen

Du sollst die Katze füttern. (You should feed the cat.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

426

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Using sollen Nonnative speakers of German should be careful not to sound too forceful when it isn’t necessary. Sollen, the modal duty verb, is the verb you use for giving advice or expressing a duty that’s an expected, right-kind-of-thing-to-do action. The negative version, nicht sollen, expresses what you shouldn’t do. The cousin müssen is the modal verb of necessity and strong directives — see the earlier section on müssen. Check out the examples with sollen and nicht sollen: Ich soll etwas trinken. Ich habe Durst. (I should drink something. I’m thirsty.) Wir sollen unsere Schuhe putzen. Sie sind schmutzig. (We should clean our shoes. They’re dirty.) Du sollst nicht spät ins Bett gehen. Du siehst sehr müde aus. (You shouldn’t go to bed late. You look very tired.) Ich soll den neuen Film sehen. Er ist super. (I should see the new movie. It’s super.) Maria soll ein kleineres Auto kaufen. Das Benzin ist sehr teuer. (Maria should buy a smaller car. Gas is very expensive.) Du sollst nicht zum Konzert gehen. Die Gruppe ist wirklich schlecht. (You shouldn’t go to the concert. The group is really bad.) Was soll das bedeuten? (What’s that supposed to mean?) (This is an idiomatic expression.)

I Want to Be Famous: Wollen, the Intention Verb When you were little, did you want to travel around the world in a hot air balloon? Chances are, by now you’ve scaled back such grand intentions: You wish you could just remember the names of three famous movie stars. However, you do intend to travel more — to your son’s soccer games. No matter how grandiose or mundane your wants and desires may be, you can express them all with wollen, the intention verb. Expressing your wants (as well as intentions, desires, and a secret wish or two) in German is simple when you know how to use wollen.

Chapter 6: Modifying Verbs with Helpers: The Modal Auxiliaries

427

Forming wollen Like some others in the band of modal verbs, wollen is irregular in the following forms: ich, du, and er/sie/es — the singular forms. The irregular forms are in bold, and the regular forms show the endings in bold. Look at the verb conjugation. wollen (to want to, to intend to, to wish) ich will

wir wollen

du willst

ihr wollt

er/sie/es will

sie wollen Sie wollen

Ich will jetzt nach Hause fahren. (I want to drive home now.) Note: Although (ich) will can easily be mistaken as meaning (I ) will, it’s the verb werden that means will. You use werden as a helping verb to speak about the future. (Go to Book IV, Chapter 6 for more on using werden to form the future.)

Using wollen When you’re expressing something you want to do or intend to do, you can substitute möchten for wollen and come up with virtually the same results (see the earlier section “What Would You Like? Möchten, the Preference Verb”). Look at the following examples. The difference between them is minimal in both languages. The speaker could be talking to someone or doing some wishful thinking: Ich will ein neues Auto kaufen. (I want to buy a new car.) Ich möchte ein neues Auto kaufen. (I would like to buy a new car.)

When you want something from someone else, the two verbs are not interchangeable. Wollen is direct: You want something. Möchten does express a want in the form of would like to, but it carries the ring of politeness. Compare the two example sentences that follow. The speaker is a dinner guest in someone’s living room. Ich will fernsehen. (I want to watch TV.) The guest is simply stating what he or she wants or intends to do. There’s no hint, direct or indirect, of a request. Ich möchte fernsehen. (I would like to watch TV.) The guest sounds polite by using möchte. A request is likely to follow the stated intention with a question, such as Haben Sie etwas dagegen? (Do you mind?)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

428

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication The expressions using wollen in the following sentences show how its meaning can bend slightly in conjunction with another word or words: ✓ wollen . . . gern + infinitive: Stresses desire. (Note: Look at the earlier section in this chapter on mögen for more ways to use gern.) For example, Er will gern Musik hören (He feels like listening to music). ✓ wollen . . . unbedingt: Underscores that you absolutely want something, without fail, such as Ich will unbedingt nach Australien reisen (I’m dying to travel to Australia). ✓ wie + subject + wollen: Notes that a decision is up to somebody else, such as Wie Sie wollen (It’s up to you). The German title of Shakespeare’s As You Like It is Wie Ihr Wollt. ✓ wollen . . . nicht + past participle + haben/sein: Expresses that someone doesn’t want to admit having done something, as in Sie wollen den Unfall nicht gesehen haben (They claim not to have seen the accident). In other words, they don’t want to admit to having seen the accident. (See Chapter 4 of Book IV for info on past participles.) ✓ wollen nichts damit zu tun haben: Notes that the subject doesn’t want to be involved with something, as in Ich will nichts damit zu tun haben (I want no part of that or I don’t want anything to do with it). Look at the examples of sentences with wollen: Du willst einen Salat machen. (You want to make a salad.) Ich will morgen um 17.00 Uhr Tennis spielen. (I want to play tennis tomorrow at 5 p.m.) Wir wollen Orangensaft (trinken). (We want to drink [some] orange juice.) Ihr wollt in die Stadt gehen. (You want to go into the city.) Heidi und Thomas wollen heute Abend ins Restaurant gehen. (Heidi and Thomas want to go to a/the restaurant this evening.) Sophie will ein Stück Apfelkuchen essen. (Sophie wants to eat a piece of apple cake.)

Chapter 7

Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood In This Chapter ▶ Forming commands ▶ Understanding orders and instructions ▶ Instructing politely

W

hen you need help, you can ask for it in several ways. You could simply state something like I need some help. But if you’re surfing and a shark is after you, you’re more likely to be shouting at the top of your lungs, Help! Shark! In that panic-stricken moment, you’re commanding the attention of the others on the beach to help you. And although most of them will run the other way, the lifeguard will hopefully rush out to rescue you before the shark has you for dinner. In the unlikely event that you need to shout out a warning in German, you want to know how to use the imperative form, also called the command form. You can also use the imperative form in other situations, such as giving instructions, offering encouragement, making suggestions, and persuading people. Unexpected situations may happen when you’re among Germanspeaking people, and understanding what’s going on is useful. Someone may be commanding a group of people you’re among to get out of the way, or a helpful pedestrian may be telling you that you need to get out of the street because a bus is approaching behind you. This chapter gives the lowdown on the imperative in its varied forms. You find out how to use the command form, understand warning signs, read instructions, and direct people’s attention to lend you a hand.

430

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Getting into the Imperative Mood When telling someone to do something, you use the imperative. Note that the imperative is not a verb tense; it’s actually what’s known as a mood. So what’s that? Mood is the means by which the speaker perceives the action of the sentence — in other words, the verb. (A verb tense, on the other hand, is the way in which the speaker expresses the past, present, or future.) When issuing commands, you need to use the correct verb form and punctuation so the person you’re talking to understands. (However, that still doesn’t mean he’ll do what you say.) Keep reading to see how to use the imperative correctly.

Grasping the three imperative forms English has one verb form for the imperative — stop here please, get me a pen please, go home, watch out! You may be talking to one person, several people, a bus driver, a friend, or your neighbor’s dog. On the other hand, German has three forms, depending on whom you’re addressing. They correspond to the three German pronouns that represent you — Sie, ihr, and du. An imperative sentence begins with the verb, followed by the pronoun. However, only imperatives in the Sie form use the pronoun. Table 7-1 shows examples of the three imperative forms and explains how to form the verbs.

Table 7-1

The Three German Imperative Forms of You

German Pronoun

Translation

German Example Sentence

Translation

How to Form the Verb

Sie

you (formal, singular or plural)

Zeigen Sie mir, bitte! (zeigen)

Please show me.

Same as presenttense Sie form

ihr

you (informal, plural = y’all)

Öffnet bitte die Fenster! (öffnen)

Please open the windows.

Same as presenttense ihr form

du

you (informal, singular)

Fahr vorsichtig! (fahren)

Drive carefully.

Stem of a verb (+e)

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood

431

We explain when to use each form of the imperative later in this chapter. But first, we explain how to punctuate imperatives and form them from regular and irregular verbs.

Punctuating commands When you write a command in German, you generally put an exclamation mark at the end of the phrase. It isn’t intended to make the command sound like a do-or-die situation, and when you read the written words out loud, you don’t need to sound like a drill sergeant (unless the situation merits that emphasis). The exclamation mark is simply a grammatical element of the imperative form, just as a question mark belongs at the end of a question. By contrast, in written English, you reserve the use of the exclamation mark for situations when you’re trying to add a sense of real urgency, threat, or anger to the meaning of a sentence. The liberal use of exclamation marks on German signage as a means of signaling warning can be a bit overwhelming at first. Rasen nicht betreten! (Don’t walk on the grass) may seem threatening, but don’t let it give you the impression that you’ll go straight to jail if you dare to place even one toe on the grass. The exclamation mark is meant to draw your attention to the sign so you recognize it as a directive that you need to adhere to.

Book III

Grammatically speaking, the format of Rasen nicht betreten! is an imperative, but you more often see the infinitive form on signs, and it often takes the form of a prohibition with nicht preceding the infinitive. Nicht hinauslehnen! (Don’t lean out!) is an example of a sign posted on a train window. The exclamation mark adds strength to the message.

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Not all commands need an exclamation mark. There are several ways to grab someone’s attention or get your message across, and whether you use an exclamation mark depends on how you want to emphasize the message. For example, when giving instructions in German, you may use a form of the imperative, yet you don’t need to drive home the information with an exclamation mark. When you’re telling someone what to do, your tone of voice is every bit as important as the actual words you utter. You can turn your message into something that sounds more like a question than a command by raising your voice at the end of your statement, just as you would when you’re asking a question.

432

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Commanding with regular verbs Most German verbs are regular in the sense that they follow a standard pattern of conjugation, so that’s good news. For the imperative, you need only three forms, as Table 7-1 indicates — Sie, ihr, and du — in the present tense. (For information on present-tense conjugation, go to Chapter 3 of Book III.) Within this large group of regular verbs, German verbs are classified into other groups, two of which are the separable-prefix verbs (Chapter 8 of Book III) and reflexive verbs (Chapter 3 of Book IV). For all verbs, you start the imperative/command phrase with the verb. When you want to form the imperative of separable-prefix verbs and reflexive verbs, you need to know some details about word order and how the verbs work in a sentence. The verbs in the following commands are separable-prefix verbs. When you use separable-prefix verbs in a command, the prefix needs to go to the end of the sentence. For reference, the infinitive form of the German verb follows the English translation of the sentence. Stehen Sie jetzt auf! (Get up now.) aufstehen (to get up). Kommt her! (Come here.) herkommen (to come here). Passen Sie auf! (Look out./Watch out.) aufpassen (to look out/to watch out). Ruf doch mal an. (Give a call.) anrufen (to call). Gentle reminders like this don’t need an exclamation mark — unless you’re agitated! It’s a message used by the Deutsche Telekom (German Telecommunications Company) to promote business. Bringen Sie eine Flasche Wein mit. (Bring a bottle of wine along.) mitbringen (to bring along). Using an exclamation mark here isn’t likely to get you far with a request like this. Zieh dich warm an! (Dress warmly.) anziehen (to dress, to get dressed). The separable-prefix verb anziehen is used reflexively here. In the following list of commands, the verb is a reflexive verb. Word order for sentences with reflexive verbs is simple: You begin the sentence as usual, with the imperative form of the verb, followed by the corresponding reflexive pronoun, for example, sich (you). When using the formal imperative form, you do, however, place the formal pronoun Sie in second place directly after the verb. Look at these example sentences: Putz dir die Zähne. (Brush your teeth.) Schauen Sie sich im Spiegel an. (Look at yourself in the mirror.) In addition to being used reflexively here, the verb anschauen (to look at) is a separable-prefix verb.

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood

433

Beeilt euch! (Hurry up!) Wasch dir gründlich die Hände. (Wash your hands thoroughly.)

Commanding with irregular verbs As is the situation with many verbs in both German and English, a few wayward souls don’t particularly care to adhere to the standard pattern of conjugation. The good news is that for German imperative verbs, the irregular forms are mostly limited to the du form. Normally, the du imperative form is straightforward: verb stem + -e (for example, geh + -e = gehe [go]). Here are the three du imperative exceptions: ✓ In informal German, the -e is often dropped: pass auf (watch out). ✓ In verbs with a stem ending in -d or -t, you often don’t drop the -e: arbeite (work). ✓ If the verb has a stem-vowel change, the imperative has this vowel change and does not have -e at the end of the verb: essen = iss (eat). (See Chapter 3 of Book III for verbs with stem-vowel changes.) The verb sein (to be) is irregular (of course!) in the imperative: ✓ Sie form: seien Sie ✓ ihr form: seid

✓ du form: sei The following examples show command forms with verbs that have a stem ending in -d or -t, verbs with stem-vowel changes, and the verb sein: Arbeite schneller! (Work faster!) Wirf mir den Ball! (Throw me the ball!) Seien Sie ruhig! (Be quiet!) Seid still! (Be quiet!) Nimm noch ein Stuck Kuchen. (Have another piece of cake.) Sprich nicht so laut. (Don’t speak so loud.) Lies weiter. (Continue reading.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

434

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Grasping Formal Commands Many situations in daily life involve understanding both written and spoken commands. When someone is giving you directions on how to get to that cozy restaurant you’ve been hunting for, you may hear something like, Gehen Sie geradeaus, und an der Kreuzung, gehen Sie nach links. (Go straight ahead, and at the intersection, go to the left.) (For details on following directions on the street, go to Chapter 1 of Book II.) You may be on a plane or a ferry, and a crew member is giving instructions about what to do in case of an emergency. In German, you use the formal Sie command form when dealing with public officials, service personnel, and people you don’t know well. You also see formal commands on street signs and signs in public buildings; being familiar with them enables you to navigate smoothly and confidently. The next sections delve into the world of formal commands and give you the language essentials you need in order to deal with such situations in Germanspeaking regions.

Using the formal “you” form: Sie

When you want to use a formal command when speaking German, you need to be certain about the effect of your words. Expressing yourself in forcefulsounding language may be tricky. You generally have the alternative of softening your message by throwing a bitte into the mix. Other alternatives include the question-command hybrids. (For info on this type of language, go to the later section “Giving Directives Politely and Making Suggestions.”) Look at the examples of formal commands you may find useful in times of need: Helfen Sie mir, bitte. (Please help me.) Zeigen Sie mir, bitte. (Show me, please.) Lassen Sie mich in Ruhe! (Leave me alone!) The formal Sie command form sounds more respectful than the du form, so if you really want someone to leave you alone in no uncertain terms, use one of these commands in the du form: Lass mich in Ruhe! (Leave me alone!) Hau ab! (Get lost!) Hör auf damit! (Stop doing that!)

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood

435

The following commands are fixed expressions you may hear in conversation. They may have a strong effect on the listener just as they would in English, so be careful about using them until you’re sure they’re appropriate in a given situation: Schießen Sie los! (Fire away!) Reißen Sie sich zusammen! (Pull yourself together!) Schieben Sie die Schuld nicht auf mich! (Don’t lay the blame on me!) Schämen Sie sich! ([You should] be ashamed of yourself!) The following formal expressions all use the verb sein: Seien wir ehrlich. (Let’s be honest.) Seien Sie mir nicht böse. (Don’t be angry with me.) Seien Sie offen zu mir! (Be frank with me!) Seien Sie auf der Hut! (Watch out!/Be on your guard!)

Obeying orders You’ve just boarded Lufthansa 235 to Frankfurt and the crew is about to go through the safety precautions. You have several options: Dig into some music on your iPod, glance at the card with safety precaution pictograms in the seat pocket in front of you, wait for the English instructions, or focus on the crew’s instructions in German. Obviously, the most useful means of boosting your German is the latter, so why not give it a try? To better understand all those long-winded instructions, grab that card and follow along as you listen to the verbiage. Anticipate hearing verbs like möchten (would like) or können (can/to be able to), commonly referred to as modal auxiliary verbs mixed in with the instructions. (Chapter 6 of Book III has information on modal auxiliaries.) Check out these annotated examples: Wir möchten Ihnen zeigen, wie Sie ihren Sitzgurt richtig öffnen und schließen können. (We would like to show you how to fasten and unfasten your seat belts correctly.) Although you may not understand all the words that follow möchten (would like), when you grasp that möchten is a polite means of inviting you to do something, then you know that the rest is more or less optional.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

436

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Sie können ihr persönliches elektronisches Gerät nach dem Erreichen der Flughöhe und nach Erlöschen der Anschnallzeichen über Ihren Sitzen gerne wieder benutzen. (You can use your own electronic equipment after takeoff when the plane has reached cruising altitude and the fasten seat belt signs have been switched off.) This sentence may sound incredibly long and convoluted, but when you hear können (can/to be able to), you understand that the rest of the information is not obligatory. Also recognize that in the case of commands or instructions, the verb is likely to come first in the sentence or phrase. The following onboard safety instructions use this word order: Stellen Sie bitte die Rückenlehne senkrecht und klappen Sie bitte die Tische zurück. (Please make sure that your seat back is in the upright position and your tray table is closed.) Ziehen sie bitte eine der Masken zu sich heran. (Pull one of the masks toward you.) Drücken Sie die Maske fest auf Mund und Nase. (Press the mask firmly over your mouth and nose.) Ziehen Sie die Schwimmweste über den Kopf. (Slip the life vest over your head.) Ziehen Sie die Gurte straff. (Pull the straps tight.) Ziehen Sie an den roten Griffen, um die Weste aufzublasen. (Inflate the vest by pulling down on [one of] the red tabs.) When instructions begin with bitte (please), you have a chance to focus your attention on some key information that immediately follows — namely, the verb telling you what to do or not to do. The following instructions begin with bitte and follow with the verb: Bitte prägen Sie sich die Lage der Notausgänge ein. (Please remember the location of the emergency exits.) Wir bitten Sie sich wieder zu Ihren Plätzen zu begeben und sich anzuschnallen. (Please return to your seat and fasten your seat belt.) Bitte bleiben Sie noch so lange angeschnallt auf Ihren Plätzen sitzen bis wir unsere entgultige Parkposition erreicht haben. (Please remain seated with your seat belt fastened until the aircraft has come to a complete stop.) Bitte vergessen Sie keine Gepäckstücke in den Ablagen über Ihnen oder in den Sitztaschen vor Ihnen. (Please do not forget any baggage in the compartment over you or the seat pockets in front of you.)

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood

437

Understanding signs When you’re traveling in German-speaking regions, you’re likely to see a great number of warning signs. Although you may think that the sheer number of these signs far surpasses the number you see in a comparable English-speaking country, the main difference may be in the content of the message, not in the quantity. For one, that exclamation mark does grab your attention. No less striking are the words of warning that seem to pop up everywhere. When you’re aware of the most frequently seen words, you’re well on your way to understanding how to react when you see such signs. Here are some familiar words you may see on signs: Achtung! (Attention/Caution) Kein (No, not) Nicht (No, not) Verboten! (Forbidden) Freihalten (Keep clear) Vorsicht (Careful) You may find signs like these in public places: Kein Eingang! (No entry) Kein Zutritt! (No entry) Kein Ausgang! (No exit) Kein Zugang! (No access) Kein Trinkwasser (Water not potable) Nicht rauchen! (No smoking) You may see the following signs in museums or other public venues: Berühren verboten! (Do not touch) Anfassen verboten! (Do not handle) Fotografieren verboten! (No photos)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

438

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Zutritt für Unbefugte verboten! (Unauthorized persons not allowed/ No trespassing) Mobilfunk verboten (No cellphones) Mobiltelefone benutzen verboten (No cellphone use) Achtung! Tür schließt automatisch (Attention! Door closes automatically) Tür bitte freihalten! (Please keep door clear) Bitte Tür schließen (Please close door) Bitte Tür geschlossen halten! (Please keep door closed at all times) Für Garderobe keine Haftung (Not responsible for items in cloakroom) Vorsicht Stufe! (Caution: Step) Eltern haften für ihre Kinder! (Parents responsible for children) When you see any of the following signs on the street, make sure you follow their instructions: Zufahrt/Einfahrt freihalten (Keep entrance clear) Ausfahrt freihalten (Keep exit clear) Feuerwehrzufahrt freihalten (Fire department entrance — keep clear) Parken verboten (No parking) Durchfahrt verboten (Not a thruway) Schritt fahren (Drive slowly) Achtung! Schranke schließt nach jedem Fahrzeug (Attention! Gate closes after each vehicle) Hunde müssen draußen bleiben (Dogs have to stay outdoors) Plakate ankleben verboten! (Do not put up posters here) These signs warn against trespassing: Betreten auf eigene Gefahr! (Enter at your own risk) Betreten der Baustelle verboten! (No trespassing on construction site) Betreten des Grundstückes verboten! (No trespassing on property) Betreten verboten! Lebensgefahr! (No entry! Highly dangerous!) Das Betreten der Anlage ist streng verboten! (Trespassing strictly forbidden)

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood

439

You may find warning signs like these in public places such as hospitals or factories: Kein Zutritt Röntgen (No entry: X-ray lab) Nur für Mitarbeiter! (Employees only) Dieser Bereich wird durch Video überwacht! (Area under surveillance cameras) Hochspannung! Lebensgefahr! (High voltage! Danger to life!) Achtung! Nicht unter Spannung ausstecken (Attention! Do not unplug [before switching off the machine])

Reading instructions You find the command, or imperative, form in written instructions such as the type you find for assembling a bookshelf, setting up a tent, or following a recipe. These step-by-step instructions typically use a variation of the word order for the imperative form: the verb comes at the very end of each step in the sequence of instructions. The verb is generally written in the infinitive form — for example, aufstellen (to assemble) or kochen (to cook). The following instructions from a recipe for making Kartoffelsalat (potato salad) are arranged with each step on a separate line so you can easily identify the verb at the end of each step. In English, the word order for the equivalent information puts the verb at the beginning. Look at the line-by-line instructions: Kartoffeln ca. 20 Min. in Salzwasser gar kochen, (Boil potatoes approximately 20 minutes in salt water until cooked,) etwas abkühlen lassen, (let [them] cool,) dann pellen ([and] then peel) und in Scheiben schneiden. (and cut into slices.) Die heiße Gemüsebrühe darüber gießen (Pour hot vegetable broth over [the potatoes]) und etwas durchziehen lassen. (and let stand awhile.) Anschließend die übrigen Zutaten dazugeben (Afterward, add the remaining ingredients) und unterheben. (and mix gently.) Mit Salz und Pfeffer abschmecken. (Add salt and pepper to taste.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

440

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Giving Informal Directives When you know someone well enough to speak informally together, use the casual du form. You generally use the du form with people you know well, people who have communicated to you that they want to be on informal du terms, and with animals and children under the age of around 16. (For more information on using the informal du, go to Chapter 3 of Book I.) In any situation where you don’t really know whether to use the Sie or du form, stick to the Sie form. When you’re sure you’re on du (or its plural form, ihr) speaking terms, however, you can go ahead and use the informal means of addressing someone. Imagine you’re driving on the Autobahn (highway) with your long-lost German uncle, with whom you’re on du speaking terms, and he’s trying to impress you with his Mercedes XXLQRS7000 by taking it up to 180 — kilometers per hour, that is — or even faster. You’re more likely to get a helpful reaction from him if you say Fahr bitte nicht so schnell (Please don’t drive so fast) in a neutral tone of voice than if you raise your voice and blurt out the Sie version: Fahren Sie nicht so schnell! (Don’t drive so fast!) After all, the last thing you want to do is get him rattled while he’s behind the wheel. The following sections give you some pointers about issuing commands when using the informal you in either the singular or plural form.

Using the singular “you” form: du Here are some imperative du forms with verbs that have no spelling change: Fahr vorsichtig. (Drive carefully.) Bleib bis neun Uhr im Bett. (Stay in bed until 9 a.m.) Trink mehr Wasser. (Drink more water.) Mach es so. (Do it like this.) Mach, was du willst. (Do what you like.) The following examples of du imperatives have spelling changes. For reference, you see the infinitive form of the verb following the command and its English equivalent. Nimm eine Aspirin. (Take an aspirin.) nehmen (to take) Lies meine E-mails. (Read my e-mails.) lesen (to read)

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood

441

Vergiss es. (Forget it.) vergessen (to forget) Hilf mir. (Help me.) helfen (to help) Gib Gas! (Step on it!) geben (to give); Gas geben is a colloquial expression

Using the plural informal “you” form: ihr When you want to make a command using the ihr form, you use the present tense ihr form of the verb. The following examples show how the ihr form of a command looks in a sentence: Kommt schnell! (Come quickly!) Helft mir! (Help me!) Macht die Tür auf! (Open the door!) Trinkt nicht so viel. (Don’t drink so much.) Beeilt euch! (Hurry up!) Stellt die Flaschen im Kühlschrank. (Put the bottles in the fridge.) Macht nicht so viel Lärm! (Don’t make so much noise!)

Giving Directives Politely and Making Suggestions In some cases, the imperative walks the fine line between asking and telling someone to do something. Both have inverted word order with the verb first, followed by the subject. Look at the following examples of questions and imperative sentences: Können Sie das bitte machen? (Could you do that, please?) You’re asking someone to do something, so you formulate your request more politely by using a helping verb such as können (could). In addition, you end the request in a rising voice and use a question mark. Machen Sie das, bitte. (Please do that.) By contrast, when you want to tell someone to do something in more direct but polite language, you make a request with the imperative form. Your voice falls at the end, and you use a period.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

442

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Können Sie mir bitte helfen? (Could you help me, please?) The question form, können, and bitte indicate a request that you’re asking someone (politely) to do something. When you say it, your voice rises at the end. Helfen Sie mir, bitte. (Please help me./Give me a hand, please.) The imperative form is a request in more direct language, but bitte makes it sound polite. This is probably something you’d say, not write. Another use of the imperative is to make suggestions. When referring to wir (we) as the people who may follow the suggestion, the German looks like this: Fahren wir Fahrrad. (Let’s go bicycling.) It’s the wir verb form with inverted word order. The following suggestions use wir: Gehen wir! (Let’s go!) Gehen indicates going on foot. Fahren wir jetzt! (Let’s go now!) Fahren refers to driving a car, riding a bicycle, or taking some sort of transportation. Fahren wir mit dem Taxi zum Flughafen. (Let’s take a taxi to the airport.) Schauen wir uns das Fußballspiel an. (Let’s watch the soccer game.) Bleiben wir noch eine Stunde. (Let’s stay another hour.) Gehen wir zur Party. (Let’s go to the party.) The German verb lassen (to let, to leave, to allow) is another way to make a suggestion. When you translate the following examples of suggestions into English, the equivalent often involves let’s, yet the German sentence structure looks different from the English. How so? The German word order comes into play. The second verb gets kicked to the end of the sentence. (For information on word order, go to Chapter 1 of Book III.) Look at the following examples: Lassen wir das Thema fallen. (Let’s drop the subject.) Lassen wir uns bald wiedersehen. (Let’s meet again soon.) Lassen Sie von sich hören. (Let us hear from you.) Lassen Sie mich an der Kreuzung aussteigen. (Let me [get] out at the intersection.) Lassen Sie den Toast nicht anbrennen. (Don’t let the toast burn.) Lassen Sie mich nicht im Stich! (Don’t leave me in the lurch!/Don’t leave me high and dry!) Leben und leben lassen. (Live and let live.)

Chapter 7: Instructing and Commanding: The Imperative Mood

443

Check out the following polite directives that use Sie: Helfen Sie mir bitte mit dem Gepäck. (Please help me with the luggage.) Bitte wecken Sie mich morgen um sechs Uhr. (Please wake me tomorrow at 6 a.m.) Vergessen Sie bitte nicht, uns anzurufen. (Please don’t forget to call us.) Schauen Sie sich das an. (Take a look at that.) Probierien Sie eine dieser Pralinen. (Try one of these chocolates.)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

444

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Chapter 8

Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs In This Chapter ▶ Juggling separable-prefix verbs ▶ Keeping it together with inseparable-prefix verbs ▶ Rounding up dual-prefix verbs

A

ll you couch potatoes: Use it or lose it! Get up off the couch, put your shoes on, breathe some air in, and get ready to work out! Why the exercise hype in a chapter on separable- and inseparable-prefix verbs? Wouldn’t it be more appropriate as a pep talk in a health magazine? Actually, the verbs we deal with in this chapter are the types you see in italics here. In English, they’re called two-part or phrasal verbs, and their German counterparts are called separable- or inseparable-prefix verbs. Separable prefixes can separate from the verb itself, depending on the verb tense you use, while inseparable prefixes never separate from the verb. These verb types are equally common in German and English. This chapter deals with three categories of verbs: separable-prefix verbs, inseparable-prefix verbs, and dual-prefix verbs, which we dub the doublecrossers because the prefixes can be separable or inseparable.

Looking at the Prefix Two-part verbs in English are generally exactly that — in two parts: get + up = get up. They’re a dime a dozen: turn away, put on, take off . . . you get the picture. The German equivalent of a two-part verb has a prefix attached directly to an infinitive (the base verb form). The prefix, which corresponds to the second part of a two-part verb in English, may stand for a preposition like up or

446

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication an adverb like away. (Refer to Book IV, Chapter 2 for info on prepositions.) For example, aufstehen (to get up) has the prefix auf-; literally, auf- + stehen is up + stand. Such German verbs are extremely common. The prefix alters the meaning of the original verb, sometimes only slightly, sometimes radically.

To remember whether verbs are separable- or inseparable-prefix verbs, practice pronouncing them aloud. The separable-prefix verbs stress the prefix in spoken German, but the inseparable-prefix verbs don’t stress the prefix. For instance, umsteigen (to change [trains, planes, and so on]) is separable, so when you say it, stress the prefix um- like this: um-steig-en. Unterbrechen (to interrupt) is inseparable, so you don’t stress the prefix, but you do stress the first syllable of the verb brechen like this: un-ter-brech-en. You can remember verbs with prefixes using two approaches. First, find out the meanings of the prefixes, and second, know what the prefix and verb mean together. Prefixes can alter the verb’s meaning logically, for example, when you add the prefixes an (at, to, on) or aus (from, out) to machen (to make), you get anmachen (to turn on) and ausmachen (to turn off). Idiomatically speaking, the meanings change and you get anmachen (to make a pass at someone, as well as to mix/dress [a salad]), and ausmachen (to arrange, to plan). With the prefix/verb lists in this chapter, you can try both methods at the same time. Although this may sound complicated, a great deal of these verbs (sans prefix) are garden-variety types you encounter often in German.

Parting Ways: Simplifying Separable-Prefix Verbs With separable-prefix verbs, the verb and the prefix can — drum roll please — split up (surprise, surprise). For example, aufstehen (to get up) is a separableprefix verb. Its prefix, auf-, means up in this context, and the verb stehen means to stand or to stay. Notice that the prefix auf- appears at the end of the sentence: Ich stehe meistens um sechs Uhr auf. (I usually get up at 6 a.m.) Of the three groups of verbs that we discuss in this chapter, this group is the largest because it has the largest number of prefixes as well as the largest number of verbs that connect with these prefixes. The following sections introduce you to separable prefixes and show you how to use separable-prefix verbs in the present tense. (For information on forming separable-prefix verbs in the simple past, go to Book IV, Chapter 5, and for the present perfect, go to Book IV, Chapter 4.)

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs

447

Getting the hang of separable prefixes You get your money’s worth with the prefixes in this section. They’re a great help when you’re expanding your vocabulary. Why? Not only do they combine with verbs, but some also combine with nouns and adjectives. Most verb prefixes have more than one specific meaning, and as you become familiar with them, you start seeing a pattern in the way a prefix alters the meaning of the verbs it combines with. When you come across a new German verb with the same prefix, you can make an educated guess about its meaning. These itty bitty sound bites are very influential, so start your own collection right away. Table 8-1 shows separable prefixes, their English meanings, and some verbs that use each prefix. Knowing the meaning of the verb without the prefix can help, but make sure you also know the separable-prefix verb and its English meaning. Although this prefix list is fairly extensive, the number of separableprefix verbs is huge. This sample list contains high-frequency verbs.

Table 8-1

Separable Prefixes and Verb Combinations

Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

ab-

from

abblenden

to shade, to dim (lights)

abbrechen

to break away, to stop

abnehmen

to lose weight, to reduce, to diminish

abschaffen

to do away with

abziehen

to deduct, to print (photos)

anbauen

to grow, to plant

anbringen

to install, to fasten

anfangen

to begin, to start

anhaben

to have on, to wear

ankommen

to arrive, to catch on

anrufen

to phone

anschauen

to look at, to examine

an-

at, to, on

(continued)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

448

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 8-1 (continued) Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

auf-

on, out, up

aufbauen

to put up, to build up

aufdrehen

to turn on, to wind up

auffallen

to be noticeable, to stand out

aufgeben

to give up, to check (bags)

aufschließen

to unlock, to open up

aufstehen

to get up, to stand up

ausatmen

to exhale

ausbilden

to train, to educate

ausfallen

to cancel, to fall out (hair)

ausgehen

to go out

ausmachen

to put out (fire), to turn off (lights), to discern, to make plans, to amount to

aussehen

to look (like), to appear

auswechseln

to replace (parts)

beibringen

to teach, to inflict

beilegen

to insert (in a document)

beisetzen

to bury

beitragen

to contribute (to)

beitreten

to join, to enter into (a pact)

dableiben

to stay behind

dalassen

to leave there

aus-

bei-

da-

from, out

with, along

there

dabei-

there

dabeibleiben

to stay with, to stick with (it)

daran-

on

daranmachen

to get down to (it)

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

ein-

in, into, down

einatmen

to inhale

einbrechen

to break in, to cave in

einkaufen

to go shopping, to buy

einladen

to invite

einschlafen

to go to sleep

einsteigen

to board (plane)

entgegenarbeiten

to oppose, to work against

entgegenkommen

to approach, to accommodate

entgegen-

against, toward

fehl-

wrong

fehlschlagen

to go wrong

fest-

fixed

festhalten

to hold on, to keep hold of

festlegen

to establish

festsitzen

to be stuck, to be stranded

fortbilden

to continue education

fortführen

to carry on, to continue

fortpflanzen

to reproduce, to propagate

fortsetzen

to continue

forttreiben

to drive away

gegenüberliegen

to face, to be opposite

gegenüberstehen

to confront, to face

fort-

gegenüber-

onward, away

across from

gleich-

equal

gleichstellen

to treat as equal

her-

from, here

herfahren

to pull up, to get here

herstellen

to manufacture, to establish

herausfinden

to find out

herausreden

to talk one’s way out of

herausfordern

to challenge

heraus-

from, out of

(continued)

449

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

450

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 8-1 (continued) Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

hin-

to, toward, there

hinfahren

to drive there, to go there

hinzu-

in addition

hinzufügen

to add (details), to enclose

kennen-

know

kennenlernen

to get to know, to meet

los-

start, away

losbrechen

to break off

losfahren

to drive off

loslassen

to let go of

mitarbeiten

to collaborate

mitbringen

to bring along

mitfahren

to go with, to get a ride

mitmachen

to go along with, to join in

mitteilen

to inform (someone)

nachahmen

to imitate

nachfragen

to ask, to inquire

nachfüllen

to refill, to top off

nachgeben

to give way, to give in

nachlassen

to loosen, to decrease (price)

stattfinden

to take place (event)

stattgeben

to grant

vorbereiten

to prepare

vorführen

to present, to perform

vorgehen

to proceed, to go first

vorlegen

to submit, to present

vorlesen

to read aloud

vormachen

to show someone how to do something, to fool someone

mit-

nach-

stattvor-

along, with (similar to English prefix co-)

after, copy (similar to English prefix re-)

no equivalent before (similar to English prefixes pre- and pro-)

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs

451

Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

weg-

away, off

wegbleiben

to stay away

wegfahren

to drive off, to leave

wegfallen

to be discontinued

wegnehmen

to take away

wegwerfen

to throw away

zudecken

to cover up

zulassen

to authorize, to license

zumachen

to close

zusichern

to assure someone

zusteigen

to get on, to board

zurückgehen

to go back

zurückkommen

to return, to come back

zurückschlagen

to strike back

zurücksetzen

to put back, to reverse

Book III

zurücktreten

to step back, to resign

zurückzahlen

to pay back

zusammenarbeiten

to work together

zusammenfassen

to summarize

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

zusammenreißen

to pull oneself together

zusammenstoßen

to crash, to clash

zusammenwachsen

to grow together

zwischenlanden

to stop over (flight)

zu-

zurück-

zusammen-

zwischen-

shut, to, upon

back

together

between

Using separable-prefix verbs in the present tense When you write an e-mail to your friend in Berlin or speak to your German boss, you’ll probably end up using separable-prefix verbs in the present tense. When doing so, word order is a really big deal. Why? If you mix up word order, the reader or listener may not get your intended message. Also,

452

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication keep in mind that the prefix alters the basic verb’s meaning, so if you leave it out, you’re likely to cause confusion. (For more on word order in present tense, see Book III, Chapter 3.) With separable-prefix verbs in the present tense, keep the following points in mind: ✓ The prefix — such as fest- in festhalten (to hold on) — goes to the end of the sentence. In spoken German, you stress the prefix. ✓ The verb itself, which is the part you conjugate, is generally in second position in the sentence, as in Ich halte mich fest. (I’m holding on tight.) Halte, the conjugated part of the verb, is in second position. Here are some guidelines for word order, depending on the type of sentence: ✓ Statements, both positive and negative: The verb is generally in second position, such as in Wir haben viel vor. (We’re planning to do a lot [of activities].) The verb is vorhaben (to plan). The verb haben is in second position, and the prefix vor- is at the end of the sentence. The same sentence expressed negatively would look like this: Wir haben nicht viel vor. (We’re not planning to do much.) ✓ Yes/no questions and commands: The verb and subject are inverted, meaning that the verb is first, followed by the subject, such as with Kommst du am Sonntag vom Urlaub zurück? (Are you coming back from vacation on Sunday?) The verb is zurückkommen (to come back). Kommst, the conjugated part of the verb zurückkommen, is in first position in a yes/no question, and the prefix zurück is at the end of the question. ✓ Sentences or questions with a modal verb (such as dürfen or möchten) in addition to the separable-prefix verb: Modal verbs are helping verbs that modify an attitude about the main verb. Conjugate the modal verb, put it in second position (usually), and place the separable-prefix verb in the infinitive form at the end of the phrase, such as in Alle Gäste dürfen mitmachen. (All the guests may join in.) The verb is mitmachen (to join in). The modal verb dürfen (may, to be allowed to) is in second position, and mitmachen, the infinitive form of the separable-prefix verb, goes to the end of the sentence. (See Book III, Chapter 6 for info on modal verbs.) ✓ Sentences with multiple clauses: For sentences that have more than one clause, the guidelines follow those for two-part sentences. See Book IV, Chapter 1 for details. The following pairs of sentences show how the separable-prefix verbs work with and without a modal auxiliary verb. When you have a modal in the sentence, the separable-prefix verb goes to the end of the sentence or clause.

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs

453

It’s in the infinitive form, meaning the verb is in one piece, with the prefix attached. When the sentence has only one verb (the separable-prefix verb), the prefix goes to the end of the sentence or clause. Die Regierung soll das Gesetz abschaffen. (The government should do away with [repeal] the law.) Die Regierung schafft das Gesetz ab. (The government is doing away with [repealing] the law.) Um wie viel Uhr möchten Sie aufstehen? (What time would you like to get up?) Um wie viel Uhr stehen Sie auf? (What time are you getting up?) Das Konzert kann nur bei schönem Wetter stattfinden. (The concert can only take place with good weather.) Das Konzert findet nur bei schönem Wetter statt. (The concert only takes place with good weather.) Muss der Präsident zurücktreten? (Does the president have to resign?) Tritt der Präsident zurück? (Is the president resigning?) Ich darf nicht einschlafen. (I must not fall asleep.) Ich schlafe nicht ein. (I’m not falling asleep.) Können Sie mir bitte die Details mitteilen? (Could you send me the details, please?) Teilen Sie mir bitte die Details mit. (Please send me the details.)

Together Forever: Investigating Inseparable-Prefix Verbs Although the number of inseparable-prefix verbs isn’t as large as that of separable-prefix verbs, you still need to be aware of these verbs so you can include them in your writing and speech. The good news is that many of these inseparable-prefix verbs are common German verbs. More good news: As you may rightly assume from their name, the prefix doesn’t separate from the verb, no matter how the verb is used. In addition, some equivalent verbs in English have the same prefix. For these reasons, recognizing many of these inseparable-prefix verbs is fairly simple.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

454

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication In the following sections, we introduce the inseparable prefixes and then show you how to use inseparable verbs in the present tense. (For information on forming inseparable-prefix verbs in the simple past, go to Book IV, Chapter 5, and for the present perfect, go to Book IV, Chapter 4.)

Understanding inseparableprefix combinations Inseparable-prefix verbs are easier to spot in a sentence than separableprefix verbs because the verb appears together with its prefix. What you still need to keep in mind is that the prefix alters the original meaning of the verb. Table 8-2 lists inseparable prefixes, their English meanings, and some verbs that use the prefix. A number of the prefixes have direct comparable uses in English, and many of the verbs are frequently used. Erkennen Sie einige Verben? (Do you recognize some verbs?) But as with separable prefixes, each prefix may have several meanings, and a few inseparable prefixes, such as emp- and ge-, have no English equivalent.

Table 8-2

Inseparable Prefixes and Verb Combinations

Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

be-

similar to English prefix be-

sich befinden (reflexive)

to be located

befreunden

to befriend

begegnen

to meet

bekommen

to get

bemerken

to notice

empfangen

to receive (signal, visitor), to welcome someone

empfehlen

to recommend

empfinden

to feel

emp-

no equivalent

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

ent-

similar to English prefixes de- and dis-

entbehren

to do without

entdecken

to discover

entfernen

to remove

entkommen

to escape

entlassen

to discharge (someone)

entstehen

to originate

entwerten

to cancel (ticket)

erhängen

to hang (execute)

erholen

to recover

sich erinnern (reflexive)

to remember

erkennen

to recognize

erklären

to explain, to declare

erschiessen

to shoot dead

ertrinken

to drown

erzählen

to tell

gebrauchen

to use, to make use of

gefallen

to like

gehören

to belong to

gelangen

to arrive at, to attain

genesen

to recover

gestalten

to form, to shape

gestehen

to confess

er-

ge-

sometimes no equivalent, sometimes similar to the English prefix re- or the meaning of fatal

no equivalent

455

Book III

(continued)

Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

456

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 8-2 (continued) Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

miss-

similar to English prefix mis-

missachten

to disregard

missbrauchen

to misuse, to abuse

misstrauen

to mistrust

missverstehen

to misunderstand

verbieten

to forbid

vergeben

to forgive

vergessen

to forget

verachten

to despise

sich verfahren (reflexive)

to get lost

verkommen

to go to ruin

verschlafen

to oversleep

verdrängen

to block out, to push aside

verlassen

to leave, to abandon

verlieren

to lose

verbinden

to link, to join, to bandage

vergrößern

to enlarge

verfhaften

to arrest

versprechen

to promise

vollenden

to complete, to come to an end

vollführen

to execute, to perform

zerbrechen

to shatter

zerstören

to destroy

ver-

ver-

ver-

ver-

voll-

zer-

similar to English prefix for-

(go) awry

away, lose

no equivalent

complete

completely (ruin)

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs

457

Putting inseparable-prefix verbs into the present tense After you grasp the meaning of an inseparable-prefix verb (or any other word, for that matter), you can try your hand at plugging it into a meaningful sentence. The following points define the use of inseparable-prefix verbs: ✓ You don’t stress the prefix in spoken German. ✓ Unlike the separable-prefix verbs, these verbs remain as one word. Word order follows the usual German rule of thumb for verbs: In a simple sentence with only one verb, that verb is in second position. Look at the example sentences with the inseparable-prefix verb in its usual second position: Ich verspreche dir einen Rosengarten. (I promise you a rose garden.) The verb is versprechen (to promise). Viele Fluggäste vergessen ihre Geräte während der Landung auszuschalten. (Many air passengers forget to turn off their devices while landing.) Ich empfehle Ihnen diesen österreichischen Weißwein. (I recommend this Austrian white wine.) Wie gefällt Ihnen dieses Restaurant? (How do you like this restaurant?) With this type of information question, the inseparable-prefix verb gefallen (to like) is in second position following the question word wie (how). Sentences with modal auxiliary verbs, commands, and yes/no questions put the inseparable-prefix verb in a position other than the second position. Here are some example sentences: Erklären Sie das bitte noch einmal. (Please explain that again.) Erklären (to explain) is an inseparable-prefix verb used as a command. With the command (imperative) form, the verb is at the beginning of the sentence. Sie will ihren Mann verlassen. (She wants to leave her husband.) The conjugated verb is the modal auxiliary verb wollen (to want to), and it’s in second position. The inseparable-prefix verb verlassen (to leave) is in the infinitive form at the end of the sentence. Verfahren viele Touristen sich in der Stadt? (Do many tourists get lost in the city?) The verb verfahren means to get lost. In yes/no questions, the verb is at the beginning of the question.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

458

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Double-Crossers: Dealing with Dual-Prefix Verbs The dual-prefix verbs, the ones we call the double-crossers, are characterized by having a prefix that can combine to make both separable-prefix verbs and inseparable-prefix verbs. This means that with some main verbs, the prefix is separable, and with other main verbs, the same prefix is inseparable. For example, you can use the prefix unter- (down) to form the verb unterzeichnen (to sign [a document]), which is an inseparable-prefix verb. You can also combine unter- with bringen (to bring) to form unterbringen (to accommodate), a separable-prefix verb. The list of these prefixes is short. Without the prefix, many of the verbs are high-frequency types that you may already be familiar with.

Grasping dual-prefix verb distinctions Follow these guidelines to help you remember dual-prefix verbs: ✓ Memorize whether the prefix is usually separable or inseparable. Some dual prefixes are mainly separable, and others are mainly inseparable:

• Um- is a prefix that is mainly separable. Umziehen (to move), with the prefix um- (around), is an example of a separable-prefix verb: Wann ziehst du um? (When are you moving?)

• Über- is a prefix that is mainly inseparable. Übernachten (to sleep), with the prefix über- (over, across), is an inseparable-prefix verb: Im Sommer übernachten wir oft im Zelt. (We often sleep in a tent in the summer.)

✓ Think about whether the meaning is literal or figurative. Some dualprefix verbs are both separable and inseparable. Generally speaking, the verb in its literal meaning has a separable prefix, such as with Die Fähre setzt uns ans andere Ufer über. (The ferry is taking us across to the other bank [side].) Übersetzen (to ferry across) is a separable-prefix verb. The prefix über- (over, across) is at the end of the sentence. The literal meaning involves physical movement from one place to another: to cross over, travel across, go across. The verb in its figurative meaning has an inseparable prefix, such as with Sie übersetzt sehr schnell. (She translates very quickly.) Übersetzen (to translate), with the prefix über- (over, across), is an inseparable-prefix verb. The figurative meaning involves changing over: to translate from one language to another.

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs

459

Table 8-3 provides a list of dual prefixes and their English definitions, a sampling of dual-prefix verbs, indicating whether they’re separable- or inseparable-prefix verbs, and the English verb equivalents. Five verb pairs have both separable (sep.) and inseparable (insep.) prefixes. Notice that the last two prefixes, wider(against) and wieder- (again), have two separate meanings and spellings.

Table 8-3

Dual Prefixes and Verb Combinations

Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

durch(usually sep.)

through

durchbringen (sep.)

to get through

durchfahren (sep.)

to drive through

durchkommen (sep.)

to come through

hinter-

behind

hinterlassen (sep.)

to let someone go behind

hinterlassen (insep.)

to leave, to bequeath

überfahren (sep.)

to ferry across, to cross (over)

überfahren (insep.)

to run over

überfallen (insep.)

to attack, to hold up (a bank and so on)

übernachten (insep.)

to sleep (in a hotel and such)

übersetzen (insep.)

to translate

übersetzen (sep.)

to ferry across

umbauen (sep.)

to renovate

umbauen (insep.)

to enclose, to build around

umsteigen (sep.)

to change (trains)

umziehen (sep.)

to move (to a new home), to change (clothes)

unterbrechen (insep.)

to interrupt, to disconnect

untergehen (sep.)

to sink, to go down

unterkommen (sep.)

to find accommodation

unternehmen (insep.)

to do, to undertake

über(usually insep.)

um(usually sep.)

unter-

over, across

around

down, under

(continued)

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

460

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication Table 8-3 (continued) Prefix

English Definition

Example Verb

English Equivalent

wider(usually insep.)

against (similar to English prefix re-)

widerrufen (insep.)

to recall (product), to withdraw

widersprechen (insep.)

to contradict

widerstehen (insep.)

to resist, to withstand

wiedergeben (sep.)

to give back, to play back, to restore

wiederholen (insep.)

to repeat

wiederholen (sep.)

to get back

wiedersehen (sep.)

to see again, to meet again

wieder-

again

Looking at dual-prefix verbs in the present tense Dual-prefix verbs follow the guidelines for formation, usage, and word order according to whether the prefix is separable or inseparable. As is the case with the separable-prefix verbs, the dual-prefix verbs that are separable follow the same guidelines for pronunciation: when speaking, the separable prefix is stressed. (For more information on usage, look at the guidelines in the earlier two sections for separable- and inseparable-prefix verbs.) The following examples show how the dual-prefix verbs play out when you use them in a present-tense sentence: Ich steige im nächsten Bahnhof um. (I’m changing [trains] at the next station.) The dual-prefix verb umsteigen (to change [train, plane]) is separable. Wiederholen Sie bitte ihre Telefonnummer. (Please repeat your phone number.) The verb wiederholen (to repeat) has an inseparable prefix when it means to repeat. This meaning of the verb is very frequently used.

Chapter 8: Sorting Out Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs

461

Hilfe! Das Schiff geht unter! (Help! The ship is sinking!) The dual-prefix verb untergehen (to sink) is separable. Die Firma widerruft alle defekten Produkte. (The company is recalling all of the defective products.) Widerrufen (to recall) is the dual-prefix verb and it’s inseparable. Mein Freund baut sein altes Haus um. (My friend is renovating his old house.) The dual-prefix verb umbauen can be either separable or inseparable depending on the meaning. Here, umbauen (to renovate) is separable.

Book III Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

462

Book III: Assembling the Grammatical Foundations for Communication

Book IV

Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Two-Way Prepositions That Work in Both the Accusative and Dative Cases

Preposition

English Equivalent(s)

an

at, on, to

auf

on, onto, to

hinter

behind, to the back of

in

in, into, to

neben

beside, next to

über

above, over

unter

under, underneath

vor

in front of

zwischen

between

To improve your chances of being understood when communicating in German, you have to speak or write your words in a particular order. Head to www.dummies. com/extras/germanaio for a free article about the basic guidelines for German word order.

Contents at a Glance Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions andRelative Pronouns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 465 Conjunctions and Clauses: Reviewing the Terminology.............................................466 Connecting with Coordinating Conjunctions.................................................................468 Getting Support from Subordinating Conjunctions......................................................471 Joining with Relative Pronouns.......................................................................................476

Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions . . . . . . . . . . 479 Prepping for Prepositions with a Few Basic Guidelines.............................................480 Accusative, Dative, and Genitive Cases: How the Rest of the Phrase Shapes Up..............................................................................................482 Tackling Two-Way Prepositions: Accusative/Dative..................................................488 Understanding Quirky Combinations..............................................................................491

Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations . . . . . . . 493 Identifying Types of Idiomatic Verb Expressions.........................................................494 In the Looking Glass: Reflecting on Reflexive Verbs...................................................495 Combining Verbs with Prepositions................................................................................501

Chapter 4: Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 507 Forming the Present Perfect with Haben......................................................................508 Forming the Present Perfect with Sein..........................................................................513 Eyeing the Present Perfect: German versus English...................................................515 Using Modal Auxiliary Verbs in Present Perfect..........................................................516 Using Separable- and Inseparable-Prefix Verbs in Present Perfect........................519 Describing with Past Perfect...........................................................................................522

Chapter 5: Narrating the (Simple) Past: Fact and Fiction . . . . . . . . . . 525 Conjugating the Simple Past............................................................................................525 Contrasting Tenses............................................................................................................534

Chapter 6: Looking to the Future (And Avoiding It) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537 The Future Is Now: Using the Present Tense Instead.................................................538 Peering into the Future with Werden.............................................................................541 Talking about What Will Have Happened: The Future Perfect..................................545

Chapter 7: Describing Your Mood: Summing Up the Subjunctive . . . 549 Terms and Conditions: Unraveling Subjunctive Terminology....................................549 The Present Subjunctive II: Knowing How and When to Use It................................551 Forming and Using the Past Subjunctive II...................................................................557 Subjunctive I: Using It in Indirect Discourse.................................................................560

Chapter 1

Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns In This Chapter ▶ Getting to know different sentence parts and the conjunctions that hold them together ▶ Connecting phrases and clauses with coordinating conjunctions ▶ Forming sentences with subordinating conjunctions ▶ Joining sentences with relative pronouns

C

onjunctions are the glue that connects parts of a sentence, such as clauses, phrases, or words, together to reach beyond basic sentence structure to form more sophisticated sentences. German uses two types of conjunctions: coordinating conjunctions, such as oder (or), and subordinating conjunctions, such as weil (because). Which type you use depends on the structure of the clauses, phrases, and words that you’re joining together. In the first part of this chapter, you find out the difference between these two types of conjunctions, and then you discover how to use the most common German conjunctions to express your ideas clearly and intelligently. Relative pronouns are another type of glue used to connect sentence parts. These words — who, whose, whom, which, and that — generally appear at the beginning of a relative clause, and they refer back to the noun or pronoun in the main clause. At the end of this chapter, you find out how to identify German relative pronouns and how to use them to link parts of a sentence together.

466

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

Conjunctions and Clauses: Reviewing the Terminology Before you can master the art of using conjunctions , you need to get a handle on some basic grammatical vocab. You may already be familiar with many of the following terms, but here’s a quick recap of the differences among phrases, clauses, and sentences — just in case you’ve forgotten: ✓ Phrase: A group of connected words that has neither a subject nor a verb, such as nach Zürich (to Zürich). ✓ Clause: A group of related words that has a subject and a verb, such as Ich fliege (I’m flying). Clauses come in several varieties:

• Main clause (independent clause): This clause can stand on its own; it has a sentence structure, as in der Nachrichtensprecher war enttäuscht (the newscaster was disappointed). This is just about the same as a sentence, except it doesn’t have a proper beginning (a capitalized D in der) or a punctuation mark at the end (a period in this example).

• Subordinate clause (dependent clause): This clause has a sentence structure with a subject and a verb, but it can’t stand on its own. It needs some help from its friends, the independent clause and the conjunction. If you see such a clause alone without a main clause — for example, weil er seine Stimme verloren hat (because he lost his voice) — you’re left waiting to find out more information.

• Relative clause (dependent clause): This type of clause can’t stand on its own even though it has a sentence structure with a subject and a verb. Relative clauses modify nouns or pronouns, as well as whole phrases. The modifying clause begins with a relative pronoun, such as who, which, or that. In English, the relative pronoun may be left out; that’s not the case in German. For example, Wo ist das Hotel, das er uns empfohlen hat? (Where’s the hotel [that] he recommended us?) The second das in the sentence is the relative pronoun das (that).

✓ Sentence: A group of words that has it all: a subject, a verb, a capital letter at the beginning, and an ending like a period, exclamation point, or question mark. In other words, a sentence is the whole shebang. For example, Ich fliege nächste Woche nach Zürich. (I’m flying to Zürich next week.)

Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns

467

Conjunctions are the connectors, the cement, the super glue that you use to combine sentence parts. Here are the two types of conjunctions: ✓ Coordinating: A coordinating conjunction joins main clauses, phrases, or words. For example: Der Nachrichtensprecher hat seine Stimme verloren, und er musste zu Hause bleiben. (The newscaster lost his voice, and he had to stay home.) The coordinating conjunction und (and) combines the two main clauses; a comma placed before und separates the two clauses. Martin ging nach Hause und machte sich ein Käsebrot zum Abendessen. (Martin went home and made [himself] a cheese sandwich for supper.) Und (and) is a coordinating conjunction; it combines two actions (verbs) that Martin did. ✓ Subordinating: This type of conjunction introduces a subordinate clause and relates it to another clause in the sentence. For example: Der Nachrichtensprecher war enttäuscht, weil er seine Stimme verloren hat. (The newscaster was disappointed because he lost his voice.) Weil (because) is the subordinating conjunction. The subordinate clause weil er seine Stimme verloren hat (because he lost his voice) has complete meaning when it’s connected to der Nachrichtensprecher war enttäuscht (the newscaster was ­disappointed). Martin ging nach Hause, obwohl er sehr einsam war. (Martin went home, although he was very lonely.) The subordinating conjunction obwohl (although) introduces the subordinate clause that follows it and connects the two parts of the sentence — Martin ging nach Hause and er sehr einsam war. In English, conjunctions such as and, because, but, or, and when are simple to use in a sentence; the word order comes naturally for fluent speakers. Using German conjunctions correctly, however, requires a conscious effort on your part to keep in mind which type of conjunction you’re dealing with and how to get the word order straight. You also need to remember the comma. Keep reading to find out how to correctly use these two types of conjunctions.

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

468

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

Connecting with Coordinating Conjunctions The coordinating conjunctions, the ones that join main clauses, phrases, or words, are the easier of the two types to master. The number of German coordinating conjunctions is small, and they correspond well to their English counterparts in meaning and usage — except for a few easy-to-understand differences. Table 1-1 shows the common coordinating conjunctions, along with their English equivalents and comments related to how you use them in a sentence. Note: In German, you don’t use a comma in front of und in a series (or list of words), although this practice is common in English. Example: Wir haben Kartoffelbrei, Spinat und Kabeljau gegessen. (We ate mashed potatoes, ­spinach, and cod.)

Table 1-1

Common Coordinating Conjunctions

German

English Equivalent

Does a Comma Separate Joined Sentence Parts?

Comment

aber

but

yes

Used the same way in English.

denn

for, because

yes

Denn is also used as a flavoring particle, often to interest the listener; weil, a subordinating conjunction, also means because, but it has a different word order.

oder

or

no (unless the writer chooses a comma for clarity)

Used the same way in English.

sondern

but (rather)

yes

Used to express on the contrary, rather, or instead; it’s preceded by a clause that makes a negative statement.

und

and

no (unless the writer chooses a comma for clarity)

Used the same way in English.

Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns

469

Using coordinating conjunctions Incorporating coordinating conjunctions into your writing and speech isn’t too difficult. You just combine two sentence parts by using the coordinating conjunction that fits what you intend to say about the relationship between them. Keep in mind that in German, oder and und don’t need a comma preceding them, although you can use a comma to improve clarity. On the other hand, aber, sondern, and denn do require a preceding comma to connect clauses, phrases, and words. Here are some examples: Ich gehe zur Bank, denn ich brauche Geld. (I’m going to the bank because I need some money.) Esssen wir heute Abend bei dir oder bei mir? (Are we having dinner at your place or my place tonight?) Heute esse ich ein saftiges Steak im Restaurant oder ich mache Spaghetti zu Hause. (Today I’ll have a juicy steak in a restaurant, or I’ll make spaghetti at home.) Sondern and aber both mean but; however, their uses differ. You use sondern to express but rather in cases where the first clause has a negative expression and where the two ideas cancel each other. For example: Ich wohne nicht in der Stadmitte, sondern am Stadtrand. (I live not downtown but [rather] on the outskirts of the city.) The main clause in the beginning (Ich wohne nicht in der Stadmitte) contains a negative, nicht, and the two ideas are mutually exclusive. Sondern links the prepositional phrase am Stadtrand to the rest of the sentence. You use aber in the same manner as in English — to connect two ideas that aren’t mutually exclusive. The following sentences show you how to use the coordinating conjunctions sondern and aber: Ich möchte gern ins Theater gehen, aber ich habe kein Geld. (I’d really like to go to the theater, but I don’t have any money.) Ich fliege nicht am Samstag, sondern am Sonntag. (I’m flying not on Saturday but rather on Sunday.) Der Film hatte nicht nur gute Schauspieler, sondern auch hervorragende Musik. (The movie had not only good actors but also excellent music.)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

470

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

Working on word order When you form German sentences with coordinating conjunctions, the separate sentence parts maintain their word order. For both English and German, the standard word order looks like this: Take the subject + the verb + additional information, like an object or a prepositional phrase, and then add the conjunction to combine the other sentence part. (Keep in mind that in German, the active, conjugated verb always goes in the second position.) Now you have two parts combined into one sentence: Luca geht ins Kaufhaus, aber sein Hund bleibt zu Hause. (Luca goes to the department store, but his dog stays home.) Aber (but) is the coordinating conjunction. Although the preceding word order is exactly the same in English and German, that’s not always the case. Other German sentences using a coordinating conjunction have a different word order from the standard subject + verb + other information structure. (Go to Book III, Chapter 1 for more on word order.) For example, in sentences where time expressions (descriptions of time, such as this morning, in the eighteenth century, at five o’clock, and so on) take the place of the subject, the verb is still in second position, but the subject goes behind the verb. Here’s what this word order change looks like: Wir fahren heute mit dem Zug nach Hamburg, denn morgen früh möchten wir zum Fischmarkt gehen. (We’re taking the train to Hamburg today because tomorrow morning we’d like to go to the fish market.) The time expression morgen früh immediately follows the coordinating conjunction denn. This change in word order is important because it distinguishes coordinating conjunctions from their cousins, the subordinating conjunctions. (See the later section “Using subordinating conjunctions” for details on the differences between these two types of conjunctions.) When you want to add more detail to a German sentence (as part of the “additional information” that comes after the subject and verb), remember the mantra time, cause, manner, place. This mantra reminds you how to position information that describes when, why, how, and where. The standard word order is

Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns

1. Time (tells when)

2. Cause (tells why)

3. Manner (tells how)

4. Place (tells where)

471

Take a look at the enhancement to the example sentence from earlier in this section: Wir fahren heute wegen des Fischmarkts mit dem Zug nach Hamburg, denn schon um 5 Uhr in der Früh beginnt der Fischmarkt. (We’re taking the train to Hamburg today because of the fish market, for the market opens already at 5 a.m.) In the first clause, heute = time, wegen des Fischmarkts = cause, mit dem Zug = manner, and nach Hamburg = place. In the second clause, schon um 5 Uhr in der Früh describes time and is in first place in front of the verb. The following sentences demonstrate German word order with the coordinating conjunctions und, aber, and denn: Ich möchte schwimmen, aber das Wasser ist zu kalt. (I’d like to go swimming, but the water is too cold.) Kai hat zwei Brüder und Stefanie hat drei Schwestern. (Kai has two brothers, and Stefanie has three sisters.) Sven ist sehr intelligent, aber er ist nicht amüsant. (Sven is very intelligent, but he is not amusing.) Heike und Georg wohnen in einem sehr kleinen Haus, aber sie sind glücklich darin. (Heike and Georg live in a very small house, but they’re happy in it.) Heute arbeite ich nicht, denn ich habe eine Erkältung. (I’m not working today because I have a cold.)

Getting Support from Subordinating Conjunctions Subordinating conjunctions are a little trickier to use than their coordinating cousins, but that’s partly because there are more of them to keep straight. As long as you follow the guidelines covered in this section, you’ll be able to use subordinating conjunctions in German as well as (or maybe even better than) you do in English.

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

472

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Table 1-2 presents a list of commonly used German subordinating conjunctions with their English equivalents and comments on their usage.

Table 1-2

Common Subordinating Conjunctions

German

English Equivalent

Comment

als

as, when

Describes an event in the past. Example: Als ich elf Jahre alt war . . . (When I was eleven . . .)

bevor

before

Used the same way in English

da

since (inasmuch as)

Not to be confused with the preposition seit (since + a point in time) or da (there)

damit

so that

Used to express in order that . . .; not to be confused with damit, a compound of da + mit to express with that/it/them

dass

that

Rarely begins a sentence; in English, you can leave out the conjunction that, but you can’t in German. Example: Ich wusste, dass er krank war . . . (I knew [that] he was sick . . .)

falls

in case

Used to describe in the situation/event that . . .

ob

if, whether

Not interchangeable with wenn; ob can be used to begin an indirect yes/no question

obwohl

although

Used the same way in English

weil

because

Same meaning as denn (coordinating conjunction) but with a different word order in the subordinate clause

wenn

if, when, whenever

Not interchangeable with ob; wenn starts a clause that stipulates the condition of something possibly happening or not, such as if A, then B

Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns

473

Using subordinating conjunctions Subordinating conjunctions have some similarities to coordinating conjunctions: Both types of conjunctions link ideas together, both introduce one ofthe ideas, and both generally use commas to separate the two ideas. The distinguishing characteristics of subordinating conjunctions are as follows: ✓ A subordinating conjunction begins a subordinate clause. Ich hoffe, dass du kommst. (I hope that you come.) Dass is the subordinating conjunction, and the subordinate clause is dass du kommst. ✓ A comma always separates the main clause from the subordinate clause. Ich hoffe (main clause) + , (comma) + dass . . . (subordinate clause). ✓ Subordinating conjunctions affect word order of verbs. They push the conjugated (main) verb to the end of the subordinate clause. Als and wenn have similar meanings; they can both mean when. However, als describes a single event in the past, and wenn functions the way it does in English — to describe an action that’s repeated in any verb tense. Here are two examples to help you keep these two conjunctions straight: Als ich in der Stadt lebte, hatte ich kein Auto. (When I lived in the city, I didn’t have a car.) You don’t live in the city anymore; that event is over. Wenn ich nicht mehr arbeite, möchte ich noch fit bleiben. (When I’m no longer working, I’d like to stay in shape.) This sentence is in present tense; it describes an imagined scenario in the future. Ob and wenn are similar because they can both mean if. However, ob can begin an indirect yes/no question, and wenn starts a clause that stipulates the condition of something possibly happening or not. Falls and wenn are also similar. Falls can be used in such situations when you want to express in case or in the case that. Consider these examples: Ich weiß nicht, ob das richtig ist. (I don’t know if that’s right.) You’re posing a question to yourself that would have a yes/no answer. Wenn/Falls es morgen regnet, bleiben wir zu Hause. (If/In case it rains tomorrow, we’ll stay home.)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

474

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Look at the following examples of how you use da, bevor, and damit in German sentences. You find example sentences with dass, obwohl, and weil in the next section. Da ich wenig Geld habe, hoffe ich einen reichen Partner zu finden. (Since I have little money, I hope to find a rich partner.) You can also use weil in place of da in this sentence when you want to express because. Bevor ich den richtigen Mann finde, werde ich meine Freiheit genießen. (Before I find the right man, I’ll enjoy my freedom.) Ich brauche viel Geld, damit ich Luxusartikeln kaufen kann. (I need a lot of money so I can buy luxury goods.)

Putting words in the proper order Clarity is the name of the game when you’re using subordinating conjunctions. To achieve that clarity, you need to make sure you put everything in its proper order: ✓ Throw the conjugated verb to the end of the subordinate clause, as in Ich hoffe, dass sie das Basketballspiel gewinnen. (I hope [that] they win the basketball game.) The verb gewinnen (win) is at the end of the subordinate clause, which begins with the word dass. Dass very rarely begins a sentence. ✓ When a subordinate clause begins a sentence, place the conjugated verb of the main clause directly following the subordinate clause. Why? Because the whole subordinate clause counts as one sentence element (one unit), the verb in the main clause is in its usual second position: Wenn ich zu spät aufstehe, verpasse ich den Zug. (When I get up too late, I miss the train.) The verb verpasse (miss, as in to miss an opportunity) directly follows the subordinate clause. Look at the annotated examples of three sentences that use subordinating conjunctions: Ich hoffe, dass sie das Basketballspiel gewinnen. (I hope [that] they win the basketball game.) The main clause comes first, followed by the subordinate clause. 1. Ich hoffe (I hope) = main clause 2. dass (that) = subordinating conjunction introducing the subordinate clause 3. sie (they) = subject

Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns

475

4. das Basketballspiel (the basketball game) = direct object, in ­accusative case 5. gewinnen (win) = verb at the end of the subordinate clause Obwohl ich oft zu spät aufstehe, erreiche ich den Zug. (Although I often get up too late, I catch the train.) The subordinate clause comes first, followed by the main clause. 1. Obwohl (although) = subordinating conjunction introducing the sentence 2. ich oft zu spät (I often too late) = subject and other information 3. aufstehe (get up) = verb at the end of the subordinate clause 4. erreiche (catch) = verb at the beginning of the independent clause (counts as second position in the sentence) 5. ich den Zug (I the train) = subject and direct object, in accusative case Weil ich viel zu spät aufgestanden bin, habe ich den Zug verpasst. (Because I [have gotten] got up much too late, I [have] missed the train.) The subordinate clause comes first, with the main clause in second position; both clauses use the present perfect verb tense (see Book IV, Chapter 4 for more on the present perfect). In the subordinate clause, the two verb parts are at the end of the clause, with the past participle (aufgestanden) preceding the conjugated verb (bin). In the main clause (habe ich den Zug verpasst), the word order of the verbs follows that of present perfect in a sentence with only one clause: The conjugated verb is in second position (habe), and the past participle is at the end of the clause/sentence. Remember that the whole subordinate clause functions as a subject, or as one unit of information, with a comma separating the two clauses. The conjugated verb is, grammatically speaking, in second position. 1. Weil (because) = subordinating conjunction introducing the ­sentence 2. ich zu spät (I too late) = subject and other information 3. aufgestanden (got up) = past participle of aufstehen (to get up) 4. bin (have; Literally: am) = conjugated verb thrown to the end ofthe subordinate clause so it follows the past participle ­aufgestanden (got up) 5. habe (have) = conjugated verb at the beginning of the main clause 6. ich den Zug (I the train) = subject and direct object, in accusative case 7. verpasst (missed) = past participle of verpassen (to miss)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

476

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication The following sentences show how word order plays out with the subordinating conjunction dass: Ich weiss, dass Sie gut Deutsch sprechen. (I know that you speak good German.) Ich möchte, dass du morgen mit mir kommst. (I’d like you to come with me tomorrow. Literally: I would like that you come with me tomorrow.) Es ist gut, dass er am Freitag Zeit hat. (It’s good that he has time on Friday.) Wir möchten, dass sie den Vertrag unterschreiben. (We want them to sign the contract. Literally: We would like that they sign the contract.) Es ist nicht gut, dass Norbert heute Abend allein ist. (It’s not good that Norbert’s alone tonight.)

Joining with Relative Pronouns When you want to include more information in a sentence than just a subject, verb, and possibly an object, you may need the help of a relative clause, which uses a relative pronoun (like who, whom, which, or that) to link two sentence parts. (For more information on relative pronouns, refer to BookIII, Chapter 2.) This section explains what the German relative pronouns look like, how they differ from their English counterparts, and how to use them in sentences.

Knowing how to make the connection with relative pronouns The most important factors that determine which form of the German relative pronoun to use are gender and case. For your reference, Table 1-3 shows the breakdown of the relative pronouns by gender and case. Remember that these relative pronouns can mean who, whom, whose, which, or that in English.

Chapter 1: Tying Ideas Together with Conjunctions and Relative Pronouns Table 1-3

477

Relative Pronouns

Gender/Number of Noun Being Replaced

Nominative Case

Accusative Case

Dative Case

Genitive Case

Masculine (m.)

der

den

dem

dessen

Feminine (f.)

die

die

der

deren

Neuter (n.)

das

das

dem

dessen

Plural (pl.)

die

die

denen

deren

As Table 1-3 shows, the German relative pronouns take a number of different forms, depending on their function in the relative clause. To form a relative clause, keep in mind the following points: ✓ Relative clauses need a relative pronoun; English doesn’t always use a relative pronoun. ✓ Relative clauses are set off by commas; English doesn’t always need commas. ✓ Selecting the correct form of the relative pronoun depends on gender, number, and case. In English, you only have case with who, whom, and whose. ✓ The information preceding the relative clause determines the gender and number of the relative pronoun. In English, you aren’t concerned with either gender or number. ✓ The relative pronoun’s case is determined by its function in the relative clause. The same thing goes for English with who, whom, and whose.

Forming sentences with relative clauses When you know the details of how relative pronouns work, you’re ready to form your own sentences with relative clauses. Look at the following two short sentences that both have to do with der Mann (the man): Das ist der Mann. Ich habe gestern mit ihm gesprochen. (That is the man. I spoke with him yesterday.)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

478

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication To put these two bits of information together into a single sentence, you use the corresponding relative pronoun that links the two sentences. The resulting single sentence with a relative clause sounds more natural than the two short sentences: Das ist der Mann, mit dem ich gestern gesprochen habe. (That is the man [that] I spoke to yesterday.) The relative clause begins with mit dem (with whom). Dem refers to der Mann, so it’s singular, and it’s dative because it’s connected to the dative preposition mit (with). The more formal-sounding English equivalent of the sentence looks like this: That is the man with whom I spoke yesterday. The following example sentences each have a relative clause. After the English translation, you see an explanation for the relative pronoun used in the sentence. As you look at the sentences, notice that the relative clause directly follows the noun to which it refers. Das ist die Frau, in deren Frühstückspension wir übernachten. (That’s the woman whose bed and breakfast we’re staying at.) The relative pronoun deren is in the genitive case, and it’s feminine singular. Ich habe einen Freund, dessen Sohn in Kiev lebt. (I have a friend whose son lives in Kiev.) The relative pronoun dessen is in the genitive case, and it’s masculine singular. Das Auto, das ich kaufen möchte, kostet mehr als $50,000. (The car [that] I want to buy costs more than $50,000.) Das is a singular, neuter relative pronoun, and it’s in the accusative case. The relative clause interrupts the main clause to modify Das Auto. Das Holz, aus dem dieser Schreibtisch gemacht wurde, stammt aus Indonesien. (The wood that this desk was made of comes from Indonesia.) Dem is a singular, neuter pronoun, and it’s in the dative case. The relative clause interrupts the main clause to modify Das Holz. Kennst du Männer, die Frauennamen haben? (Do you know [any] men who have women’s names?) The relative pronoun die is in the nominative case, and it’s plural. Wie finden Sie die Musik, die diese Gruppe spielt? (What do you think of the music [that] this band is playing?) The relative pronoun is the second die, the one that follows the comma. Die is feminine singular, and it’s in the accusative case. Der grosse Hund, der gerade bellt, hat mich letzte Woche gebissen. (The big dog that is barking right now bit me last week.) The relative pronoun der is masculine, singular, and it’s in the nominative case. Es gibt viele Länder, denen wir mehr Entwicklungshilfe geben sollten. (There are many countries to whom we should give more economic aid.) The relative pronoun denen is in the dative case, and it’s plural.

Chapter 2

Specifying Relationships with Prepositions In This Chapter ▶ Looking at some basic preposition guidelines ▶ Getting to know the accusative, dative, and genitive cases ▶ Knowing which prepositions can use both the accusative and dative cases ▶ Identifying preposition combinations

W

hat’s in a preposition? Zwischen (between) by any other name would sound as strange. A preposition is a small word that shows the relationship between its object (a noun) and another word or words in the sentence. It’s part of a prepositional phrase, which starts with a preposition and includes a noun and maybe an article and other words. In this chapter, you find out just how important these little guys are in expressing such things as

✓ Place/where something is located, as with in (in): Es gibt eine Fliege in meiner Suppe. (There’s a fly in my soup.) ✓ Movement/the direction where something is going, as with unter (under): Eine Maus läuft unter meinen Stuhl. (A mouse is running under my chair.) ✓ Information showing relationships, as with trotz (in spite of): Trotz dieser Überraschungen, schmeckt mir das Essen. (In spite of these surprises, the food tastes good.) Here, we break down German prepositions into four groups: accusative, dative, genitive, and accusative/dative. The prepositions in the latter group are what we call the two-timers because they can be either accusative or dative. You find an easy and logical explanation for these wise guys in the section pertaining to them. Plus, you get a rundown on the preposition combinations or fixed expressions like zu Hause (at home) and nach Hause (to home [going home]).

480

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

Prepping for Prepositions with a Few Basic Guidelines Prepositions, such as around, before, and with, combine with other words to form prepositional phrases that provide information on where (around the corner), when (before noon), who (with you), and much more. Prepositions perform incredible tasks when they combine with other words — notably nouns and verbs — to create a diverse range of expressions. But all those possibilities come at a price. Prepositions are finicky little critters, much more so in German than in English. So how in the world do you get to feel even remotely comfortable with understanding, let alone using, German prepositions with the right case? For starters, look at these basic grammar guidelines.

Grasping the importance of case In German, case is one key to perfecting the fine art of prepositioning. Both English and German have many prepositions, and both languages use prepositions in similar ways. However, English doesn’t have much to do with cases and case endings. In fact, if you bring up the subject of case in English grammar, some people may tell you to go home, lie down for a while, and forget all about it. But case is hugely important to using German prepositions correctly in a prepositional phrase. As with other German words like nouns, adjectives, and verbs, you have to understand prepositions in conjunction with the other trappings of language. After all, a lowly two-letter preposition like in (in, into, to) has so much power that it forces the rest of the prepositional phrase — the noun and other words following the preposition — to take the same case endings. The preposition doesn’t change; it “tells” the words that follow it to use the same case that it uses. The result is that the case endings in the prepositional phrase help you to ✓ Recognize the links between the preposition and the words in the phrase. ✓ Understand the prepositional phrase in context of the whole sentence. The three cases that prepositions identify with are accusative, dative, and genitive, though some prepositions may use accusative or dative case, depending on meaning. The following examples show all four groups of prepositions. (Book III, Chapter 2 deals with the basics of case.) ✓ Accusative: Mein Hund Bello läuft gern durch den Wald. (My dog Bello likes to run through the woods.) The prepositional phrase is durch den Wald (through the woods). Because durch is in the accusative case, der Wald changes to the accusative form den Wald.

Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions

481

✓ Dative: Ich laufe gern mit ihm (Bello). (I like to run with him.) The phrase is mit ihm (with him). The preposition mit is in the dative case, so the personal pronoun er changes to the dative form ihm. ✓ Genitive: Während des Winters bleiben Bello und ich oft zu Hause. (During the winter, Bello and I often stay at home.) The phrase is während des Winters (during the winter). Because während is a genitive preposition, der Winter in nominative case changes to des Winters in genitive case. ✓ Accusative/dative: Meistens liege ich allein auf der Couch, aber manchmal springt Bello auf die Couch. (I usually lie on the couch alone, but sometimes he jumps onto the couch.) Auf der Couch (on the couch) is dative case; auf die Couch (onto the couch) is accusative case. The first denotes place, and the second describes movement. Check out the section “Accusative, Dative, and Genitive Cases: How the Rest of the Phrase Shapes Up” for a complete discussion of case and a look at why case is important when using prepositions.

Understanding where meaning fits in Meaning is another key to using German prepositions successfully. Know that the rules of mathematics don’t apply here — the prepositions and their English counterparts aren’t always equal. The preposition in looks like the English preposition in. Indeed, you can use it the same way in both languages: Wie viele Fernseher haben Sie in Ihrem Haus? (How many TVs do you have in your house?) However, in in German can also mean into or to. Another preposition, bei, sounds like by but has a variety of meanings, including at, near, and with: Bei mir gibt es keine Flimmerkisten. (There aren’t any boob tubes at my place.) Prepositions crop up in places you’d never suspect, and they take on new meanings in combinations with other words that can be surprising. Don’t assume there’s a parallel in meaning between German prepositions that resemble English prepositions, either in spelling, pronunciation, or both, because one preposition may have several different meanings. Often, these meanings don’t parallel the way the preposition is used in English.

The trick to taming these preposition beasties is remembering them in commonly used phrases, fixed idioms, or standard prepositional phrases — not all alone and naked. So memorize one or two common phrases or words that combine with each preposition to get a feeling for the various meanings a preposition may have.

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

482

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication When you come across an unfamiliar expression that includes a preposition, look at (or listen to) the context of the phrase. You can often make an accurate guess of the meaning by checking whether the literal meaning or the figurative meaning makes more sense. Your experience in your own language can help you make the leap of faith to understanding figurative meaning.

Accusative, Dative, and Genitive Cases: How the Rest of the Phrase Shapes Up When you use prepositions in your German writing and speech, you want to use them correctly, right? If so (hopefully you said yes!), this section is key because it explains the role that cases play in using prepositions. So what exactly is case? Case is like a marker, a tag, or an ID for a word; it shows the word’s role in relationship to other words in the sentence. The three groups of prepositions are organized by the case that they require to form phrases. These three cases are accusative, dative, and genitive. Having said that, by far the most frequently used group of prepositions is yet another group, namely those that use both accusative and dative cases (fondly called the two-way prepositions); we deal with these two-timers in the later section “Tackling Two-Way Prepositions: Accusative/Dative.” As you go through this section, keep in mind that prepositions pop up everywhere in German (and English, for that matter), so be patient and take your time to master the cases one by one. In addition, remember that the context of the phrase influences the meaning of the preposition. For example, nach can mean three different things in English — after, past, or to — yet nach dem Weg fragen (to ask for directions) doesn’t even translate using one of those three prepositions.

No finger pointing: Accusative prepositions Accusative prepositions express movement, opposition to something, and acts of excluding or receiving. The small band of accusative prepositions, which are strictly linked to the accusative case, includes bis, durch, für, gegen, ohne, and um. Look in Table 2-1 for a list of these prepositions, their English equivalents, and a few sample phrases.

Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions Table 2-1

Accusative Prepositions

Preposition

English Equivalent(s)

Sample Phrases

English Equivalent

bis

till, until (also: conjunction until)

bis nächsten Sonntag

until next Sunday

durch

through, by

durch die Stadt

through the city

(jemanden) durch einen Freund kennenlernen

meet (someone) through a friend

für Sie

for you

für meine Freunde

for my friends

gegen die Regeln

against the rules

etwas gegen Kopfschmerzen nehmen

take something for a headache

ohne mich

without me

ohne Herrn Adler

without Herr Adler

um das Haus

around the house

Ich bewerbe mich um die Stelle.

I’m applying for the job.

für

gegen

ohne

um

483

for

against, for

without

around, for, at

To form phrases with accusative prepositions, start with the preposition and add the information that the preposition links to the rest of the sentence — the preposition’s object (noun) and any modifiers. If necessary, change the endings of any articles, pronouns, adjectives, and nouns following the preposition to the accusative case. Here’s what needs to change: ✓ Some definite articles change. The definite articles are easy because the only change is der → den. Die (feminine and plural) and das don’t change. (See Book III, Chapters 1 and 2 for details on definite articles.)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

484

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication ✓ Some accusative prepositions may be expressed as contractions with das:

• durch + das = durchs

• für + das = fürs

• um + das = ums

These contractions are very common in spoken, colloquial German but not so common in written German. ✓ Most of the pronouns change. The personal pronouns in accusative (direct object) case are mich (me), dich (you), ihn/sie/es (him/her/it), uns (us), euch (you), sie (them), and Sie (you). (See Book III, Chapter 2 for details on pronouns.) ✓ Adjectives may or may not undergo an ending change. (See Book III, Chapter 5 for the skinny on adjectives.) ✓ A few nouns undergo an ending change. (See Book III, Chapters 1 and 2 for more on nouns.) Here are some examples of these changes in action: Sammy das Stinktier sitzt ganz allein, ohne seine Freunde. (Sammy the skunk is sitting all alone without his friends.) The preposition ohne is followed by seine Freunde; both words have accusative plural endings. Dann läuft er durch den Garten der Familie Finkenhuber. (Then he runs through the Finkenhuber’s garden.) The preposition durch (through in this context) indicates movement. Den Garten is the masculine singular form of der Garten in the accusative case. Sammy läuft um den Hund Bello und . . . psst! (Sammy runs around Bello the dog and . . . psst!) The preposition um (around) indicates movement. Den Hund is the masculine singular form of der Hund in the accusative case.

Dative prepositions Dative prepositions include some heavy hitters. Most dative prepositions express relationships of time (when), motion (where to), and location (where). Some have surprising variations in meaning. Nine prepositions are on the dative hit list: aus, außer, bei, gegenüber, mit, nach, seit, von, and zu. These particular prepositions have an exclusivity clause with the dative case. Table 2-2 shows the nine dative prepositions, their English equivalents, and some sample phrases for each.

Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions Table 2-2

Dative Prepositions

Preposition

English Equivalent(s)

Sample Phrases

English Equivalent

aus

from, out of

aus den USA

from the U.S.A.

aus der Arbeit

from/out of work

außer uns

besides/except for us

außer den Kindern

except for the children

bei Katharina

at Katharina’s (place)

bei der Straße

near the street

Es ist anders bei mir.

It’s different with me.

bei schlechtem Wetter

in bad weather

with, by (means of transportation)

mit dem Hund

with the dog

mit dem Zug

by train

after, past, to

nach einer Stunde

after an hour

Es ist fünf nach vier.

It’s five past four.

nach Moskau (no article for cities and countries in German)

to Moscow

seit zwanzig Jahren

for 20 years

seit dem Krieg

since the war

von einem deutschen Maler

by a German artist (created by someone)

ein Geschenk von dir

a present from you

am Ende vom Film

at the end of the movie

zur Universität

to the university

Was gibt’s zum Abendessen?

What’s for dinner?

außer

bei

mit

nach

seit

von

zu

485

besides, except for

at (a home of, a place of business), near, with

for, since

by, from, of

to (with people and certain places)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

486

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication To form phrases with dative prepositions, start with the preposition and add the information that the preposition connects to the rest of the sentence (the object of the preposition and any articles or adjectives that modify it). Change the endings of any articles, pronouns, adjectives, and nouns following the preposition — if necessary — to the dative case. Here’s a list of what needs to change: ✓ The definite articles change like this (see Book III, Chapters 1 and 2 for more on definite articles):

• der → dem

• die → der (feminine)

• das → dem

• die → den (plural)

Note: Not all prepositional phrases need an article (dem, einen, and so on) with the noun, although those that don’t are generally fixed expressions such as clock times like es ist Viertel nach acht (it’s quarter past eight) or other types like zu Hause (at home). ✓ The contractions that dative prepositions build are

• bei + dem = beim

• von + dem = vom

• zu + dem = zum

• zu + der = zur

These contractions are very common in spoken, colloquial German, but they’re not as common in written German. ✓ All the pronouns change. The personal pronouns in the dative case are mir (me), dir (you), ihm/ihr/ihm (him/her/it), uns (us), euch (you), ihnen (them), and Ihnen (you). (See Book III, Chapter 2 for details on pronouns.) ✓ Adjectives may or may not undergo an ending change. (See Book III, Chapter 5 for more on adjectives.) ✓ A few nouns undergo an ending change. (See Book III, Chapters 1 and 2 for the lowdown on nouns.) Take a look at these examples: Essen wir heute Abend bei dir? (Shall we have dinner at your place tonight?) Bei is a true chameleon as far as variations in meanings go. In this example, take bei, add the dative pronoun dir, and presto! You end up with bei dir = at your place. Nein, ich möchte lieber zum Restaurant um die Ecke gehen. (No, I’d rather go to the restaurant around the corner.) This example uses the contraction of zu + dem = zum.

Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions

487

Luigis? Es ist seit einem Monat geschlossen. (Luigi’s? It’s been closed for a month.) Einem Monat is the masculine dative case of the indefinite article ein combined with the masculine noun Monat. Wichtig ist nur, ich esse mit dir. (It’s only important that I eat with you.) Dir is the dative form of the pronoun you that combines with the dative preposition mit.

Genitive prepositions The list of genitive prepositions may be small, but these prepositions are used almost as frequently as the others in this chapter. The genitive prepositions describe duration of time, reasons for something, or opposition to something. Most expressions with genitive prepositions are equivalent to English expressions that include of: instead of, because of, and inside or outside of. The genitive prepositions include anstatt/statt, außerhalb, innerhalb, trotz, während, and wegen. A few other genitive prepositions exist, but they’re used less frequently. Table 2-3 shows the six most common genitive prepositions, along with their English equivalents and sample phrases.

Table 2-3

Genitive Prepositions

Preposition

English Equivalent(s)

Sample Phrases

English Equivalent

(an)statt (no difference between anstatt and statt)

instead of

(an)statt meines Autos

instead of my car

außerhalb

outside of

außerhalb des Hauses

outside of the house

innerhalb

inside of

innerhalb der Firma

within the company

trotz

in spite of, despite

trotz des Wetters

despite the weather

trotz des Lärms

in spite of the noise

während

during

während des Tages

during the day

wegen

because of, on account of

wegen der Kosten

on account of the costs

wegen mir

because of me

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

488

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication To form genitive prepositional phrases, begin with the preposition and then add the information that the preposition links to the rest of the sentence. Change the endings of any articles, pronouns, adjectives, and nouns following the preposition — if necessary — so they’re also in the genitive case. (See Book III, Chapter 2 for more on cases.) Here are a few examples of what needs to change: ✓ Definite articles: Masculine and neuter articles change from der/das to des. Feminine and plural articles change from die/die to des. ✓ Indefinite articles: Masculine and neuter articles change from ein/ein to eines. Feminine and plural articles change from eine/eine to einer. ✓ Adjectives: Almost all adjectives, singular and plural, add the -en ending to the adjective. Take a look at a couple of example sentences: Wegen der Hitze gehen wir nicht spazieren. (We’re not going for a walk because of the heat.) Die Hitze in nominative case becomes der Hitze in genitive case. Während des Winters bleiben wir meistens zu Hause. (We usually stay at home during the winter.) Der Winter in nominative case becomes des Winters in genitive case. Note: Especially in spoken German, but also in casual written German, some genitive prepositions — anstatt/statt, trotz, wegen, and während — are typically used with the dative case. This is generally true in central Germany and in the south and southwest German-speaking regions — Bayern, Österreich, und die Schweiz (Bavaria, Austria, and Switzerland). Während uses dative case less frequently in colloquial German than the other three. The meaning of these prepositions doesn’t change when you use dative case.

Tackling Two-Way Prepositions: Accusative/Dative The nine two-way prepositions in this section can use either accusative or dative case, depending on meaning. Here are the main differences: ✓ The preposition in the accusative case describes movement, shows a change of location, is used for dynamic, change-of-place verbs, and answers the question wohin? (where to?) ✓ The preposition in the dative case describes position, refers to a static location, and answers the question wo? (where?)

Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions

489

English sometimes has two different prepositions that do the work of one German two-way preposition. Take in and into, for example: In expresses where something is (dative), and into refers to the movement from one place into the other (accusative). The German preposition in can therefore use either accusative or dative case, depending on whether it expresses position (location) or movement (from one location to another). For example, Ich sitze im Kino (I’m sitting in the cinema) expresses location, so the preposition uses the dative case, and Ich gehe ins Kino (I’m going to the cinema) expresses movement, so the preposition uses the accusative case. To determine whether you need to use a preposition in accusative or dative case, visualize what you want to say. These prepositions indicate concrete spatial relationships, not intangible concepts, which makes it simple to imagine the difference between a cat lying on the table — eine Katze liegt auf dem Tisch (location = dative case) — and a cat jumping onto the table — eine Katz springt auf den Tisch (movement = accusative case). Table 2-4 shows the two-way prepositions, their English equivalents, and a sample phrase for each one with the English translation. Remember: German doesn’t have a present continuous, so the present tense (the mouse runs), present continuous (the mouse is running), or both may be logical translations.

Table 2-4

Two-Way Prepositions

Preposition

English Equivalent(s)

Accusative Example

Dative Example

an

at, on, to

Die Katze geht ans (an + das) Fenster. (The cat walks to the window.)

Die Katze sitzt am Fenster. (The cat is sitting at the window.)

auf

on, onto, to

Die Katze springt auf den Tisch. (The cat jumps onto the table.)

Die Katze steht auf dem Tisch. (The cat is standing on the table.)

hinter

behind, to the back of

Die Katze geht hinter die Couch. (The cat is going behind the couch.)

Die Katze sitzt hinter der Couch. (The cat is sitting behind the couch.)

in

in, into, to

Die Katze läuft in die Küche. (The cat is running into the kitchen.)

Die Katze ist in der Küche. (The cat is in the kitchen.) (continued)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

490

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Table 2-4 (continued) Preposition

English Equivalent(s)

Accusative Example

Dative Example

neben

beside, next to

Der Hund legt sich neben die Katze hin. (The dog lays itself down next to the cat.)

Die Katze liegt neben dem Hund. (The cat is lying next to the dog.)

über

above, over

Eine Maus läuft über den Teppich. (A mouse is running over the carpet.)

Eine Lampe hängt über dem Tisch. (A lamp is hanging over the table.)

unter

under, u­ nderneath

Die Maus läuft unter den Teppich. (The mouse runs under the carpet.)

Der Teppich liegt unter dem Tisch. (The carpet is lying under the table.)

vor

in front of

Die Maus läuft vor die Katze. (The mouse is running in front of the cat.)

Der Hund sitzt vor dem Fernseher. (The dog is sitting in front of the TV.)

zwischen

between

Die Katze legt sich zwischen die Pfoten des Hundes. (The cat lies down between the dog’s paws.)

Der Hund steht zwischen der Maus und der Katze. (The dog is standing between the mouse and the cat.)

To form phrases with accusative/dative prepositions, follow the guidelines I describe in the previous two sections for accusative prepositions and dative prepositions. The following two-way prepositions combine with articles to make contractions, though they’re mostly used in spoken, colloquial German: ✓ an + das = ans ✓ an + dem = am ✓ auf + das = aufs ✓ in + das = ins ✓ in + dem = im Other contractions that aren’t as frequently used with das and dem include hinters, hinterm, übers, überm, unters, unterm, vors, and vorm.

Chapter 2: Specifying Relationships with Prepositions

491

The following examples clarify how to form and use these prepositions correctly: Die Kinder sind im Bett. (The children are in bed.) The preposition in (here it means in) uses dative case here to express location. Where are the children? In bed. Die Kinder gehen ins Bett. (The children are going to bed.) The preposition in (here it means into) uses accusative case to express movement. Where are the children going? To bed. Ich wohne über einer Buchhandlung. (I live above a bookstore.) The preposition über (over) describes where it is. Where describes location, so it takes the dative case. Der Zeppelin fliegt über die Stadt. (The zeppelin [blimp] is flying over the city.) The preposition über (over) describes movement, so it’s in the accusative case.

Understanding Quirky Combinations German has several quirky yet important prepositional phrases that you encounter on a regular basis. These phrases are easiest to remember in verb/ preposition combinations. Verb/preposition combinations are high-frequency expressions that combine verbs with prepositions. (Refer to Book IV, Chapter 3 for details on verb/preposition combinations.) To understand what sets these prepositional phrases apart from the others in this chapter, consider the following descriptions and sample sentences: ✓ Zu Hause and nach Hause are two prepositional phrases that are often confused. Zu Hause means at home. It indicates location. Nach Hause means going home. It implies movement — motion in the direction of home. Wo ist Birgit? Sie ist zu Hause. (Where’s Birgit? She’s at home.) Wohin geht Lars? Er geht nach Hause. (Where is Lars going? He’s going home.) ✓ Bis (till, until) is an accusative preposition. What makes it different is the fact that it’s used most often in combination with other prepositions, not as a standalone. Look at the following expressions: von 8.30 Uhr bis 19.00 Uhr (from 8:30 a.m. till 7 p.m.): The preposition combo here is von (from) together with bis (till/to). This expression represents a sign on a store posting opening hours; clock time expressions don’t need an article. bis zum bitteren Ende (until the bitter end): This idiom has the preposition combination bis zu (until). Zu takes dative case: zu + dem = zum.

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

492

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication bis ins kleinste Detail (in[to] the smallest detail): This is an idiom, and the preposition combo consists of bis in (in[to]). Ins = in + das, the accusative case. bis in (den Abend) hinein (on into the [evening]): When you tack hinein (into) at the end of bis in + den Abend, or a similar time frame, you’re emphasizing the length of time. The phrase is in accusative case. ✓ Entlang (along, down) is the preposition that works the case crowd. It actually has three case combinations: accusative, dative, and genitive. In addition, entlang often follows the information it modifies. (And it also functions as an adverb!) Look at these three examples of entlang, each of which uses a different case: Gehen Sie den Weg entlang. (Walk along the path.) Den Weg is accusative case. You use the accusative case here because you’re describing the motion of walking along. Die Grenze verläuft entlang dem Fluß. (The border follows the river.) Dem Fluß is dative case because you’re describing the place, the location where the border is. Entlang des Ufers gibt es viele Schwäne. (There are a lot of swans along the shore.) The use of the genitive case, Des Ufers, is a regional variation on the dative case usage. Using entlang in genitive case is typical in southern Germany and Austria. ✓ Gegenüber (across from, opposite) is another oddity among prepositions. A true multitasker, gegenüber works as a dative preposition and combines with verbs as a separable-prefix verb in gegenüberstehen — Er steht mir gegenüber. (He’s standing opposite me.) As a preposition, it can be in front of or after its object; it makes no difference in meaning: Wir wohnen gegenüber dem Park. (We live across from the park.) The object, dem Park, follows gegenüber. Der Präsident stand mir gegenüber. (The president was standing opposite me.) The object, mir, precedes gegenüber. Technically speaking, prepositions that combine with verbs belong in a separate group called prefix verbs. (See Book III, Chapter 8 for the lowdown on separable- and inseparable-prefix verbs.)

Chapter 3

Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations In This Chapter ▶ Pointing out the different types of idiomatic expressions in German ▶ Referring back to the subject with reflexive verbs ▶ Mastering verb/preposition combos as one unit

W

hat, exactly, marks the difference between the dabbler in German who’s struggling to order a cup of coffee at a local café and the customer in a three-star restaurant who has the wait staff surrounding the table, offering yet another sample from the chef’s newest concoction? The customer’s sway over the servers may have to do with his command of native German expressions. You can notice how well a person has mastered German — or any language — by observing the timely use of idiomatic expressions, or fixed expressions whose meanings you can’t necessarily figure out based on the meanings of the words that make them up. To correctly insert idiomatic expressions into spoken and written German with ease, you have to know the meaning of the whole expression (not just the words in it). This chapter takes a closer look at the expressions that involve verbs, including those that use reflexive verbs. By using these expressions in your writing and speech, you can take your German to the next level and come across sounding like a native speaker.

494

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

Identifying Types of Idiomatic Verb Expressions Idiomatic German flows easily from the mouths of native speakers, who know when and how much to season their language with verb expressions. You can add some flair to your own German speech and writing by using one of the following major types of idiomatic verb expressions: ✓ Reflexive verbs: Verbs are reflexive when you use them with reflexive pronouns, which include words such as myself, themselves, and himself in English. Look at the following example: Ich erinnere mich an unserem ersten Tanz. (I remember our first dance. Literally: I recall to myself at our first dance.) German expresses a great deal of actions by linking reflexive pronouns to the verb, a practice that English uses much less often. ✓ Verbs associated with certain prepositions: In this chapter, you find out about idiomatic expressions that pair the verb with a particular preposition in either the dative or accusative case. For instance, the preposition vor usually means in front of, but in the example Ich habe Angst vor Schlangen (I’m afraid of snakes), the fixed expression combines the verb haben (to have) with Angst (fear) and the dative preposition vor. ✓ Verbs with separable or inseparable prefixes: A separable-prefix verb is a verb with a prefix that detaches from the verb when it’s conjugated. These verb combinations can be confusing because more often than not, the prefixes are nothing more than prepositions in disguise. Some reflexive verbs have separable or inseparable prefixes. (For more on verbs with separable and inseparable prefixes, see Book III, Chapter 8.) To make things even more confusing, you find combos of combos; some verb/preposition combos are actually separable or inseparable verb combos at the same time. In the following verb/preposition expression, the verb ankommen (to arrive) is a case in point because it has a separable verb prefix an-. When you add the preposition auf (on) to the expression, the meaning changes. Look at the example: Es kommt darauf an. (It depends.) The prefix an- is separated from -kommen, the word darauf (literally: on it) accompanies the verb, and the sum of its parts is no longer arrive but rather depend on. The preposition auf (on) in the word darauf is a combination of da- + (r) + auf. (See Book III, Chapter 4 for more on expressions using da-.)

Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations

495

In the rest of this chapter, you discover various ways of using verb combinations to talk about yourself, others, and things. These groups of idiomatic expressions combine a verb with another word (or words), such as a reflexive pronoun or a preposition, to form expressions.

In the Looking Glass: Reflecting on Reflexive Verbs Look at yourself in the mirror and smile. What do you see (besides a stunningly beautiful or handsome person)? You are, grammatically speaking, reflecting on yourself. Reflexive verbs have a subject that carries out an action directed at itself. Typically, the verb combines with a reflexive pronoun to describe that action. The reflexive pronoun refers back to the subject of the sentence, which is carrying out the action indicated by the verb. German and English both have reflexive verbs, but German uses them much more liberally. To make a long story short, your German can benefit from flexing (yourself) at the reflexive verb gym. This section introduces you to reflexive verbs and shows you how to use them correctly in your writing and speech.

Self-ish concerns: Meeting the reflexive pronouns A reflexive verb has two elements: the verb and the reflexive pronoun. In English, a reflexive pronoun has the ending -self (myself, yourself) for singular forms and -selves for plural forms (ourselves, yourselves). Both English and German have two cases of reflexive pronouns: the accusative and the dative case. The two cases are identical in English. German has only two variations between the two cases, namely in the first- and second-person singular forms. Table 3-1 lists the reflexive pronouns together with their translations. (Notice how frequently sich appears in the right two columns.) As a guide, you see the corresponding nominative pronouns in the left-hand column. Here’s the key to the abbreviations: s. = singular, pl. = plural, inf. = informal, and form. = formal.

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

496

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Table 3-1

Reflexive Pronouns: Accusative and Dative Case

Nominative (nom.) Pronouns for Reference

Accusative (acc.)

Dative (dat.)

ich (I)

mich (myself)

mir (myself)

du (you) (s., inf.)

dich (yourself)

dir (yourself)

er/sie/es (he/she/it)

sich (himself/herself/itself)

sich (himself/herself/ itself)

wir (we)

uns (ourselves)

uns (ourselves)

ihr (you) (pl., inf.)

euch (yourselves)

euch (yourselves)

sie (they)

sich (themselves)

sich (themselves)

Sie (you) (s. or pl., form.)

sich (yourself or yourselves)

sich (yourself or yourselves)

On the case! Choosing the right form of reflexive pronoun Reflexive pronouns are in either the accusative case or the dative case. Which case you use depends on how the pronoun functions in the sentence. It may be the direct object (accusative case) or the indirect object (dative case). Case shows the relationship of words to each other in a sentence — for instance, who’s doing what (where the reflexive pronoun is in the accusative case) or who’s doing what to what/whom (where the reflexive pronoun is in the dative case). Consider this example: Ich putze mir die Zähne. (I brush my teeth.) It explains who’s doing what to what, so German expresses this activity with a reflexive pronoun in dative case — mir. Die Zähne is the direct object, the receiver of the action, and it’s in the accusative case. (See Book III, Chapter 2 for more on cases.) Here are two more examples: Ich fühle mich viel besser. (I feel/I’m feeling much better.) Mich (myself) is the accusative form of the reflexive pronoun; it’s the direct object that refers back to the subject performing the action of the verb fühlen. (The information answers the question who’s doing what? Therefore, the reflexive pronoun is in the accusative case.) Ich ziehe mir eine Jeans an. (I put on/I’m putting on a pair of jeans.) Mir is the dative form of the reflexive pronoun; eine Jeans is the direct object (accusative case) in the sentence. (The information answers the question who’s doing what to what/whom? Therefore, the reflexive pronoun is in the dative case.)

Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations

497

The verbs using the dative reflexive pronoun are those in sentences that have a separate direct object; the verbs using an accusative reflexive pronoun have no separate direct object in the sentence. The reflexive pronoun can also be part of a verb + preposition expression, and certain prepositions can require either the accusative or the dative case, as with Wir freuen uns auf den Feiertag nächste Woche. (We’re happy about the holiday next week.) The preposition auf (about) requires the accusative case, as do time expressions. (Find out more about verb/preposition idioms in the section “Combining Verbs with Prepositions.”)

Putting the pronoun in the proper place Word order plays an important role when you’re constructing sentences with reflexive pronouns. Keep in mind the following important points related to word order and reflexive pronouns: ✓ In a statement, the reflexive pronoun immediately follows the conjugated verb. Sich comes right after haben in this example: Die Touristen haben sich die schöne Umgebung angesehen. (The tourists looked at the beautiful surroundings.) ✓ In a question, if the subject is a pronoun (ihr [you]), then you place the reflexive pronoun (euch [you]) directly after it. For example, Habt ihr euch beide schon wieder erkältet? (Have you both caught a cold again?) ✓ In the present tense, you push the prefix of a separable-prefix verb to the end of the sentence. In the following example, the verb anziehen (to get dressed) is a separable-prefix verb; the reflexive pronoun mich comes after the conjugated verb ziehe and before the prefix an-: Ich ziehe mich an. (I get/I’m getting dressed.) (Refer to Book III, Chapter 8 for more on separable-prefix verbs.)

Identifying which verbs need to be reflexive A surprisingly large number of German verbs require a reflexive pronoun such as mich (myself), dich (yourself), or uns (ourselves) in situations when you don’t use a reflexive pronoun in English, as in the sentence Beeilen Sie sich! (Hurry up!) In German, you frequently find the reflexive in describing personal care routines. These reflexive verbs often describe what you do to yourself when you’re in the bathroom. For example, shaving (sich rasieren [to shave oneself]) is a reflexive verb. In English, you can say that the man shaved himself or that he shaved, period. The first version is expressed reflexively using himself. The second statement, he shaved, is just as understandable, and it isn’t reflexive in structure. But German has only one, reflexive way of expressing this action: Er rasiert sich. (He shaves himself.)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

498

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication To further add to the mix, some German verbs can go either way: with or without the reflexive pronoun. With such verbs, the reflexive format is different from the verb without the reflexive pronoun. The next three examples show you waschen (to wash) expressed first with a reflexive pronoun in the accusative case, then in the dative case, and finally without a reflexive pronoun; notice the difference in meaning: Ich wasche mich am Abend. (I wash myself in the evening.) Mich, the reflexive pronoun in accusative case, refers back to the subject of the sentence, ich. And ich (I) is carrying out the action on mich (myself). Waschbären waschen sich oft die Hände. (Raccoons often wash their hands.) Notice that German speakers express their hands with die Hände (the hands), so if you want to say I wash my hands in German, it looks like this: Ich wasche mir die Hände. Mir is the dative case reflexive pronoun myself, and die Hände is the accusative case (direct object) the hands. Christian wäscht sein Auto jeden Samstag. (Christian washes his car every Saturday.) In both the English and the German sentences, the verb wäscht (washes) is followed by a direct object that refers to another living being or thing. Table 3-2 lists some of the more common reflexive verbs that have to do with personal hygiene. In German, you express the verbs in this list with a reflexive pronoun. The helpful grammar details give you clues about case and whether you have a separable-prefix verb.

Table 3-2

Reflexive Verbs: Personal Hygiene

German Expression

English Equivalent

Helpful Grammar Details

sich abschminken (acc.)

to take off one’s makeup

Separable-prefix verb; accusative reflexive pronoun

sich abtrocknen (acc.)

to dry oneself off

sich (die Hände) abtrocknen (dat.)

to dry (one’s hands)

Separable-prefix verb; accusative or dative reflexive pronoun

sich anziehen (acc.)

to get dressed

sich (das Hemd) anziehen (dat.)

to put on (one’s shirt)

Separable-prefix verb; accusative or dative reflexive pronoun

Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations

German Expression

English Equivalent

Helpful Grammar Details

sich ausziehen (acc.)

to get undressed

sich (die Stiefel) ­ausziehen (dat.)

to take off (one’s boots)

Separable-prefix verb; accusative or dative reflexive pronoun

sich duschen (acc.)

to take a shower

Accusative reflexive pronoun

sich kämmen (acc.)

to comb oneself

sich (die Haare) kämmen (dat.)

to comb (one’s hair)

Accusative or dative reflexive pronoun

sich die Zähne putzen (dat.)

to brush one’s teeth

Dative reflexive pronoun

sich rasieren (acc.)

to shave oneself

sich (das Gesicht) ­rasieren (dat.)

to shave (one’s face)

Accusative or dative reflexive pronoun

sich schminken (acc.)

to put on one’s makeup

Accusative reflexive pronoun

sich waschen (acc.)

to wash oneself

sich das Gesicht waschen (dat.)

to wash (one’s face)

Accusative or dative reflexive pronoun

sich die Haare waschen (dat.)

to wash (one’s hair)

sich die Hände waschen (dat.)

to wash (one’s hands)

Many German reflexive verbs have to do with actions other than personal hygiene. They include verbs such as sich entscheiden (to make up one’s mind, to decide) or sich befinden (to be located, to find oneself [somewhere]). These verbs are common in everyday German, so you can really boost your language ability by familiarizing yourself with such verbal expressions. For the most part, these reflexive verbs have the reflexive pronoun in the accusative case, meaning the reflexive pronoun refers back to the subject of the sentence. Table 3-3 shows some of the commonly used reflexive verbs that revolve around activities in daily life. Note that all the verbs in this list use the accusative reflexive pronoun, and any prepositions used with these verbs take the accusative case.

499

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

500

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Table 3-3

Reflexive Verbs: Daily Life

German Expression

English Equivalent

sich ärgern (acc.) (über)

to be angry, upset (about)

sich bedienen (acc.)

to serve oneself

sich beeilen (acc.)

to hurry (up)

sich befinden (acc.)

to be located

sich bewegen (acc.)

to move

sich eignen (acc.)

to be suited (for)

sich entscheiden (acc.)

to decide

sich erholen (acc.)

to get better, to recover

sich erinnern (acc.) (an)

to remember, to recollect

sich freuen auf (acc.)

to look forward to something

sich freuen über (acc.)

to be happy about something

sich gewöhnen an (acc.)

to get used to something

sich handeln um (acc.)

to be about

sich interessieren für (acc.)

to be interested in

sich konzentrieren auf (acc.)

to focus on

sich setzen (acc.)

to sit down

sich vergewissern (acc.)

to make sure (of)

sich verlassen auf (acc.)

to rely on

sich verlieben in (acc.)

to fall in love with

sich vorbereiten auf (acc.)

to get ready for

sich vorstellen (acc.)

to introduce oneself

sich wundern über (acc.)

to be amazed at

Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations

501

Combining Verbs with Prepositions Prepositions are short, cute words that can have a great influence on otherparts of the sentence. Some German prepositions and their English counterparts look similar at times: in (in), an (on), and für (for). However, they can also be sly little creatures that change their tune when they hook up with different verbs, changing the verb’s meaning. Certain prepositions that work together with certain verbs make for powerful, effective means of expression in German and English. You may refer to them as idioms, idiomatic expressions, or the bare bones term — verb/preposition combos. When you want to sound like your mother tongue is German, you need to acquire as many of these combos as you can fit into your repertoire.

Seeing how prepositions transform verbs Verb/preposition combinations are more than the sum of their parts. Why? These prepositions are slick: When combined with a verb to form a fixed expression, they can alter the meaning of the verb they appear with. That’s why memorizing the verb/preposition combos as a unit is important. You can’t predict which preposition partners with which verb, and you can’t determine the meaning of the whole phrase, even if you know the meaning of the verb alone (without the preposition). Table 3-4 lists some of the most frequently used German prepositions that change their meaning in combination with a verb. Notice that the English equivalent of the preposition itself isn’t always the same as the translation of the verbal expression. The third column gives an example of a verb/ preposition combo, and the fourth column shows an example sentence with its English translation. As you look through the example sentences and their English equivalents, notice that the preposition generally changes its original meaning. Here’s what the abbreviations in the table mean: acc. = accusative, dat. = dative.

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

502

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Table 3-4

Prepositions Used in Idiomatic Verb Expressions

Preposition

Usual English Equivalent

Example Verbal Expression/English Translation

Example Sentence

an (acc./dat.)

on, at, to

denken an (acc.) (to think of/about)

Er denkt oft an seinen Eltern. (acc.) (He often thinks of his parents.)

auf (acc./dat.)

on top of, to

warten auf (acc.) (to wait for)

Sie warten auf den Zug. (acc.) (They’re waiting for the train.)

aus (dat.)

out of, from

bestehen aus (dat.) (to consist of)

Die Uhr besteht aus vielen kleinen Teilen. (The clock consists of many small parts.)

für (acc.)

for

halten für (acc.) (to take someone for, to consider)

Ich halte ihn für einen engen Freund. (I consider him a close friend.)

in (acc./dat.)

in, inside of

sich verlieben in (acc.) (to fall in love with)

Sie hat sich in ihn verliebt. (acc.) (She fell in love with him.)

mit (dat.)

with

fahren mit (dat.) (to go with)

Ich fahre gern mit der U-Bahn. (I like to take the subway.)

über (acc.)

over, above

reden über (acc.) (to talk about)

Wir reden über dich. (We’re talking about you.)

um (acc.)

around

bitten um (acc.) (to ask for)

Er bittet um Hilfe. (He’s asking for help.)

von (dat.)

from, of

sprechen von (dat.) (to speak about/of)

Wir sprechen von dem/vom Präsidenten. (von + dem = vom) (We’re talking about the president.)

vor (dat.)

in front of

Angst haben vor (dat.) (to be afraid of)

Hast du Angst vor Spinnen? (Are you afraid of spiders?)

Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations

503

All German prepositions dictate the case of and control the relationship they have with other parts of the sentence, namely as objects of the preposition. Some of the prepositions that pair with verbs use the accusative case, while others use the dative case. Another group, the two-way prepositions, can work in the accusative or dative case. (This is true of some other prepositions as well, including those that don’t partner with verbs to form idiomatic expressions.) The following sections group some common verbal expressions according to what case their preposition takes to help you remember them. (Check out Book IV, Chapter 2 for more information on prepositions.)

Knowing common combos in the accusative case Verbs that combine with prepositions using the accusative case add real German sparkle to your written and spoken language. These common verb/ preposition combos are fixed expressions, so you have to remember which preposition partners with which verb, which case the preposition takes (accusative for this list), and what the expression means. Table 3-5 lists the commonly used verb/preposition combos with prepositions in the accusative case. Used alone, these prepositions may be able to use either accusative or dative, but in combination with these verbs, they work as accusatives. The expressions are listed alphabetically by verb.

Table 3-5 Idiomatic Verb Expressions with Accusative Prepositions Verbal Expression

Example Sentence

English Equivalent

ankommen auf (to depend on) (Note: Ankommen has a separable prefix an-.)

Es kommt auf das Wetter an.

It depends on the weather.

bitten um (to ask for)

Wir bitten um Ihre Unterstützung.

We’re asking for your support.

denken an (to think of/about)

Denkst du oft an deine Kindheit?

Do you often think about your childhood?

gespannt sein auf (to be excited about)

Ich bin gespannt auf die Reise.

I’m excited about the trip.

glauben an (to believe in)

Sie glauben nicht an Gott.

They don’t believe in God. (continued)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

504

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Table 3-5 (continued) Verbal Expression

Example Sentence

English Equivalent

halten für (to take someone for, to consider)

Hältst du ihn für einen Dieb?

Do you take him for a thief?

reden über (to talk about)

Sie redet über diverse Themen.

She talks about different topics.

schreiben an (to write to)

Ich schreibe an die Zeitung.

I’m writing to the newspaper.

schreiben über (to write about)

Schreibst du über mich?

Are you writing about me?

sorgen für (to take care of)

Wir sorgen für unsere Oma.

We’re taking care of our grandma.

sich verlieben in (to fall in love with)

Ich habe mich in ihn verliebt.

I fell in love with him.

verzichten auf (to do without)

Ich kann auf meinen Urlaub verzichten.

I can do without my vacation.

warten auf (to wait for)

Wartest du auf uns?

Are you waiting for us?

Eyeing common combos in the dative case When you know how to incorporate verbs that combine with prepositions in the dative case into your written and spoken German, you’re well on your way to sounding like you’re originally from a German-speaking country. The frequently used verb/preposition combos covered in this section are fixed expressions, so get ready to memorize which preposition combines with which verb, which case the preposition takes (dative for this list), and what the expression means. Table 3-6 lists some commonly used verb expressions with prepositions in the dative case. Used alone, these prepositions may be accusative or dative, but in these expressions, they require the dative. The table lists the expressions alphabetically by verb.

Chapter 3: Using Reflexives and Other Verb Combinations

505

Table 3-6 Idiomatic Verb Expressions with Dative Prepositions Verbal Expression

Example Sentence

English Equivalent

abhängen von (to depend on) (Note: Abhängen has a separable prefix ab-.)

Es hängt von dem Wetter ab.

It depends on the weather.

Angst haben vor (to be afraid of)

Hast du Angst vor Grizzlybären?

Are you afraid of grizzly bears?

arbeiten an (to work on)

Ich arbeite sehr fleißig an dem Projekt.

I’m working very diligently on the project.

bestehen aus (to consist of)

Die Schweiz besteht aus vier Sprachregionen.

Switzerland consists of four language regions.

erzählen von (to talk about)

Er erzählt oft von seinen Reisen.

He often talks about his trips.

fahren mit (to go, to ride with)

Ich fahre mit dir.

I’ll go (or ride) with you.

gehören zu (to belong to)

Sie gehören zu unserer Mannschaft.

They belong to our team.

halten von (to think of, to have an opinion about)

Sie hält nicht viel von der neuen Regierung.

She doesn’t think much of the new government.

rechnen mit (to count on)

Sie rechnen mit einer langen Nacht.

They’re counting on a long night.

sprechen von (to talk about)

Ich spreche nicht von dir.

I’m not talking about you.

studieren an (to study at)

Viele Studenten studieren an technischen Universitäten.

Many students study at technical universities (usually: engineering schools).

Verstehst du etwas von Motorrädern?

Do you know something about motorcycles?

verstehen von (to understand about)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

506

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

Chapter 4

Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect In This Chapter ▶ Forming the present perfect ▶ Contrasting English and German usage of the present perfect ▶ Using the present perfect with modals and separable- and inseparable-prefix verbs ▶ Talking about actions that began and ended in the past with the past perfect

P

resent perfect in German is commonly described as the conversational past because — naturally — you use it in conversation. You also typically see present perfect in informal writing such as personal letters and e-mails. German uses the present perfect to talk about all actions or states in the past, finished or unfinished. English, on the other hand, tends to use the present perfect for actions that began in the past but have a link to the present. The present perfect in German has two elements: ✓ An auxiliary verb, also known as a helping verb. (English present perfect uses have.) ✓ A past participle. (English examples are gone, been, and known.) German uses the two auxiliary verbs haben (to have) and sein (to be) to form the present perfect. First, you conjugate the auxiliary in the present tense, and then you add the past participle of the verb (gelebt [lived]; gewesen [been]; geschwommen [swum]). This chapter shows you how to form and use the present perfect in German and explains how the present perfect differs between German and English. You also get a quick look at the German past perfect, a verb tense that isn’t used nearly as frequently as the present perfect.

508

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

Forming the Present Perfect with Haben The majority of verbs form the present perfect with the auxiliary verb haben (to have) plus the past participle of the action verb you want to use. The two main categories of verbs are classified by the way you form the past participle. They’re called weak and strong verbs. (Don’t worry — you don’t have to go to the gym to find the strong verbs!) Check out the next sections for more information on weak and strong verbs. To conjugate a verb in the present perfect with haben, you choose the simple present-tense form of haben — ich habe, du hast, er/sie/es hat, wir haben, ihr habt, sie haben, or Sie haben — and then add the past participle of the verb. Check out the following example of wohnen (to live, to reside) in the present perfect. wohnen (to live) ich habe gewohnt

wir haben gewohnt

du hast gewohnt

ihr habt gewohnt

er/sie/es hat gewohnt

sie haben gewohnt Sie haben gewohnt

Ich habe ein Jahr in Paris gewohnt. (I lived in Paris for a year.) German word order follows specific rules. When you form a sentence with two verbs, the conjugated verb (haben [to have], sein [to be], werden [will], möchten [would like], and so on) takes second position in the sentence, and you push the past participle to the end of the sentence. (See Book III, Chapter 1 for more info on word order.)

Forming the present perfect with regular weak verbs Regular weak verbs are the largest group of verbs. To form the past participle, take the unchanged present-tense stem and add the ge- prefix and the ending -t or -et. You need the -et ending in the following cases: ✓ For verbs whose stem ends in -d or -t: For example, heiraten (to marry) becomes geheiratet (married). ✓ For some verbs whose stem ends in -m or -n: For example, regnen (torain) becomes geregnet (rained). ✓ For verbs recently taken over from English: For example, flirten (to flirt) changes to geflirtet (flirted).

Chapter 4: Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect

509

Note: The verbs ending in -ieren — such as, interpretieren (to interpret), which changes to interpretiert (interpreted) — don’t add the prefix ge-. (Get the lowdown on these verbs that have no ge- prefix in the later section “Forming the present perfect with verbs ending in -ieren.”) So with the verb arbeiten (to work), you conjugate haben in the appropriate person and then add the past participle. To create the past participle, you chop off the ending -en, take the stem arbeit, and add ge- and -et like this: ge- + arbeit + -et = gearbeitet. arbeiten (to work) ich habe gearbeitet

wir haben gearbeitet

du hast gearbeitet

ihr habt gearbeitet

er/sie/es hat gearbeitet

sie haben gearbeitet

Sie haben gearbeitet Sie hat im Herbst bei der Filmgesellschaft gearbeitet. (She worked at the film ­company in the fall.) Table 4-1 shows some regular weak verbs with the German and English infinitives, followed by the German and English past participles.

Table 4-1

Past Participles of Regular Weak Verbs

Infinitive

Past Participle

Infinitive

Past Participle

arbeiten (to work)

gearbeitet (worked)

lieben (to love)

geliebt (loved)

brauchen (to need)

gebraucht (needed)

lernen (to learn)

gelernt (learned)

chatten (to chat)

gechattet (chatted)

machen (to make)

gemacht (made)

Book IV

drucken (to print)

gedruckt (printed)

passen (to fit)

gepasst (fit)

feiern (to celebrate)

gefeiert (celebrated)

regnen (to rain)

geregnet (rained)

Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

fragen (to ask)

gefragt (asked)

sagen (to say)

gesagt (said)

führen (to lead)

geführt (led)

schenken (to give [a present])

geschenkt (given)

glauben (to believe)

geglaubt (believed)

schmecken (to taste)

geschmeckt (tasted) (continued)

510

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Table 4-1 (continued) Infinitive

Past Participle

Infinitive

Past Participle

hören (to hear)

gehört (heard)

schneien (to snow)

geschneit (snowed)

hoffen (to hope)

gehofft (hoped)

spielen (to play)

gespielt (played)

jobben (to do odd jobs)

gejobbt (did odd jobs)

suchen (to look for, to search)

gesucht (looked for, searched)

kaufen (to buy)

gekauft (bought)

surfen (to surf)

gesurft (surfed)

kochen (to cook)

gekocht (cooked)

tanzen (to dance)

getanzt (danced)

kosten (to cost)

gekostet (cost)

töten (to kill)

getötet (killed)

kriegen (to get)

gekriegt (gotten/ got)

wohnen (to live)

gewohnt (lived)

lächeln (to smile)

gelächelt (smiled)

zahlen (to pay)

gezahlt (paid)

leben (to live)

gelebt (lived)

Forming the present perfect with irregular weak verbs A few weak verbs are irregular, because although they have the prefix ge- and the ending -t, they don’t follow the same pattern as the regular weak verbs. The present-tense stem changes when you put it in the past participle. The good news is there aren’t many of these rebels. The bad news: The only way to really identify them is to memorize their past participles because they don’t follow any recognizable pattern. To form these irregular weak verbs in the present perfect, conjugate haben in the present tense and then add the past participle. Check out the following example with the verb denken (to think). denken (to think) ich habe gedacht

wir haben gedacht

du hast gedacht

ihr habt gedacht

er/sie/es hat gedacht

sie haben gedacht Sie haben gedacht

Luka hat oft an seine Frau gedacht. (Luka often thought about his wife.)

Chapter 4: Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect

511

Table 4-2 shows irregular weak verbs with the German and English infinitives, followed by the German and English past participles.

Table 4-2

Past Participles of Irregular Weak Verbs

Infinitive

Past Participle

brennen (to burn)

gebrannt (burned)

bringen (to bring)

gebracht (brought)

denken (to think)

gedacht (thought)

kennen (to know a person)

gekannt (known a person)

nennen (to name, to call)

genannt (named, called)

wissen (to know information)

gewusst (known information)

Forming the present perfect with strong verbs Identifying a strong verb is fairly easy. Its past participle ends in -en. (The one exception is the verb tun [to do], whose past participle is getan [done].) In most strong verbs, the past participle begins with ge-. Many of these past participles can seem pesky at first. Why? They often have vowels and consonants that differ from those in the infinitive. Here’s some good news, though: A lot of the verbs whose past participles go through these spelling contortions are high-frequency verbs. To form the present perfect with strong verbs, you conjugate haben in the appropriate person and then add the past participle. Take a look at the following table to see an example. trinken (to drink) ich habe getrunken

wir haben getrunken

du hast getrunken

ihr habt getrunken

er/sie/es hat getrunken

sie haben getrunken

Sie haben getrunken Wir haben gestern viel Mineralwasser getrunken. (We drank a lot of mineral water yesterday.) Table 4-3 lists some other strong verbs with their infinitives, past participles, and English translations.

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

512

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Table 4-3

Past Participles of Strong Verbs

Infinitive

Past Participle

Infinitive

Past Participle

backen (to bake)

gebacken (baked)

schreiben (to write)

geschrieben (written)

beginnen (to begin)

begonnen (begun)

singen (to sing)

gesungen (sung)

essen (to eat)

gegessen (eaten)

sitzen (to sit)

gesessen (sat)

finden (to find)

gefunden (found)

sprechen (to speak, to talk)

gesprochen (spoken, talked)

geben (to give)

gegeben (given)

stehen (to stand)

gestanden (stood)

halten (to hold)

gehalten (held)

tragen (to wear)

getragen (worn)

heißen (to be called)

geheißen (been called)

treffen (to meet)

getroffen (met)

helfen (to help)

geholfen (helped)

trinken (to drink)

getrunken (drunk)

lassen (to leave, to let)

gelassen (left, let)

tun (to do)

getan (done)

lesen (to read)

gelesen (read)

verlassen (to leave)

verlassen (leave)

liegen (to lie, tobe located)

gelegen (lain, been located)

verlieren (to lose)

verloren (lost)

nehmen (to take)

genommen (taken)

verstehen (to understand)

verstanden (understood)

rufen (to call)

gerufen (called)

waschen (to wash)

gewaschen (washed)

schlafen (to sleep)

geschlafen (slept)

ziehen (to pull)

gezogen (pulled)

You can easily remember the meanings of many strong verbs because they’re reasonably similar to the English verbs. Another plus is that you can even find similar patterns to the English past participle forms. Take a look at these examples: beginnen, begonnen (begin, begun); singen, gesungen (sing, sung); and trinken, getrunken (drink, drunk).

Forming the present perfect with verbs ending in -ieren The -ieren verbs are easy to spot because when you take away the -ieren, they generally look like verbs you may be familiar with in English. These verbs are different from other German verbs for several reasons. First, they

Chapter 4: Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect

513

end in -ieren, unlike mainstream verbs, which end in -en. In addition, they form the past participle without the prefix ge- but with -t at the end. You can usually recognize the meanings of these verbs, and the English equivalent of the infinitive often ends in -ify (identifizieren = to identify; verifizieren = to verify), -ize (idealisieren = to idealize; sozialisieren = to socialize), or -ate (aktivieren = to activate; vibrieren = to vibrate). When forming the present perfect with -ieren verbs, all you need to know is this: ✓ You form the past participle without ge-. ✓ You form the past participle with -t. Look at how easily you can use these verbs: ✓ fotografieren (to photograph): Der Journalist hat die Demonstration fotografiert. (The journalist photographed the demonstration.) ✓ dekorieren (to decorate): Vor dem Neujahrsfest haben wir das Wohnzimmer dekoriert. (Before the New Year’s Eve party, we decorated the living room.) ✓ probieren (to try, to sample): Hast du die Torte schon probiert? Sie ist lecker! (Have you tried the torte [cake] yet? It’s delicious!)

Forming the Present Perfect with Sein Some verbs form the present perfect with the auxiliary verb sein (to be) plus the past participle of the verb you want to use. All the verbs that use sein have two similarities: ✓ They don’t have a direct object, which means they’re intransitive. For example, the verb laufen (to run) is intransitive: Wir sind schnell gelaufen. (We ran fast.) An example of a transitive verb (with a direct object) is trinken (to drink), and it looks like this: Ich habe eine Tasse Tee getrunken. (I drank a cup of tea.) ✓ They show a change in some condition, as with werden (to become), or some motion to or from a place, as with kommen (to come). Generally, you form the past participle with ge- + the stem from the infinitive + the ending –en. For example, kommen (to come) becomes gekommen (come). However, some verbs in this group have past participles with spelling changes from the original infinitive form. For instance, gehen (to go, to walk) changes to gegangen (gone, walked). Of course, this verb group includes a few rogues, as well. For instance, the verbs bleiben (to stay) and sein (to be) don’t meet the second criterion, but they still need sein to form the present perfect. Adding to the group of wayward verbs are the ones that use sein but have a -t ending in the past participle.

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

514

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication These include joggen (to jog), which changes to gejoggt (jogged), reisen (to travel), which changes to gereist (traveled), and rennen (to run, to race), which changes to gerannt (run, raced). To form the present perfect with sein, you first conjugate the present tense of the verb sein and then add the right past participle, as you can see in the following conjugation of fahren (to drive). fahren (to drive) ich bin gefahren

wir sind gefahren

du bist gefahren

ihr seid gefahren

er/sie/es ist gefahren

sie sind gefahren Sie sind gefahren

Bist du die ganze Nacht gefahren? (Did you drive all night?) Even in conversation, it’s a lot more common to use the simple past of sein than the present perfect; for example, Wie war der Flug von Zürich nach San Francisco? (How was the flight from Zürich to San Francisco?) (For more information on how to form and use the simple past, check out Book IV, Chapter 5.) Look at Table 4-4 for a list of verbs that use sein in the present perfect. Some past participles have no stem change; others go through contortions to form the past participle, so you need to memorize them.

Table 4-4

Verbs Conjugated with Sein in the Present Perfect

Infinitive

Sein + Past Participle

Infinitive

Sein + Past Participle

bleiben (to stay, to remain)

ist geblieben (stayed, remained)

reiten (to ride [horseback])

ist geritten (ridden)

fahren (to drive)

ist gefahren (driven)

schwimmen (to swim)

ist geschwommen (swum)

fallen (to fall)

ist gefallen (fallen)

sein (to be)

ist gewesen (been)

fliegen (to fly)

ist geflogen (flown)

steigen (to climb)

ist gestiegen (climbed)

fließen (to flow, to run)

ist geflossen (flowed, run)

sterben (to die)

ist gestorben (died)

Chapter 4: Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect Infinitive

Sein + Past Participle

Infinitive

Sein + Past Participle

gehen (to go, to walk)

ist gegangen (gone, walked)

wachsen (to grow)

ist gewachsen (grown)

kommen (to come)

ist gekommen (come)

werden (to become)

ist geworden (become)

laufen (to run, to walk)

ist gelaufen (run, walked)

515

Eyeing the Present Perfect: German versus English In the present perfect, German and English have some similarities and some differences. In both languages, you use the present perfect to talk about past activities, and you use them both in conversation. Also, the construction looks similar, at least when you use the auxiliary verb haben; for example, Ich habe einen Kojoten gesehen. (I have seen a coyote.) The differences in the present perfect come about when you want to add a time element, such as gestern (yesterday): Gestern habe ich einen Kojoten gesehen. (Yesterday I saw a coyote.) You use the present perfect in German, but in English, you use saw (the simple past). On the other hand, when you want to describe a past action that’s still going on, you say something like Seit einigen Jahren sehe ich Kojoten. (I’ve been seeing coyotes for a few years.) Here, German uses the simple present, yet English uses the present perfect continuous. In this section, you get familiar with these differences in verb tense usage.

One for all: Representing three English tenses Both English and German use the present perfect in conversation. The distinction is that in German, you use it a lot more frequently in conversation and informal written language. Look at this example, which uses present perfect in German but simple past in English because last night is finished: Was hast du gestern Abend im Fernsehen gesehen? (What did you see on TV last night?)

Book IV Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

516

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication German has only the one verb tense, the present perfect, to represent three tenses in English. For example, here are three acceptable translations of Sie haben in Wien gelebt: ✓ Present perfect: They have lived in Vienna. (This one expresses that they may still live there.) ✓ Simple past: They lived in Vienna. (This version says they no longer live there.) ✓ Past continuous: They were living in Vienna. (This tense talks about a relationship between two completed past actions. Usually one is longer than the other; the other past action may be described in a previous or subsequent sentence or in the same sentence.) Look at the sentence They were living in Vienna. Because you don’t even have past continuous in German (or any other continuous forms, for that matter), you use the present perfect as the pinch hitter, like so: Während des kalten Krieges haben sie in Wien gelebt. (During the Cold War, they were living in Vienna.) As soon as you understand how to form the present perfect, you’ll find yourself using it frequently to describe a great deal of situations in the past. In fact, unless you intend to pursue a career in German journalism, you won’t have much use for the simple past or other past-tense verb forms.

Opting for the German present Look at the following two German sentences with their literal and real English translations. You may be surprised (and relieved) that in German, you can get by with the simple present in some situations where you have to use the present perfect in English. To make things even simpler, you express both since and for with seit in German. Seit wie lange warten Sie auf die U-Bahn? (How long have you been waiting for the subway? Literally: Since how long wait you for the subway?) Wir stehen hier seit zehn Minuten. (We’ve been standing here for ten minutes. Literally: We stand here for ten minutes.)

Using Modal Auxiliary Verbs in Present Perfect When you’re dealing with modal verbs — such as sollen (should, to be supposed to) or wollen (to want) — in the present perfect, you need to be aware of

Chapter 4: Conversing about the Past: The Present Perfect and Past Perfect

517

word order. Some sentences with a modal verb in the present perfect may have three verb components; others may have only two parts. This section gives you the lowdown on forming modal verbs and using them in the present perfect tense.

Forming modal verbs in present perfect When modal verbs stand alone without modifying an infinitive verb in present perfect, they look and act like other strong verbs in present perfect. Mögen (to like) is the modal verb that most often appears alone without another verb. To form the present perfect of a modal verb, you first conjugate the auxiliary verb haben (to have) in the present tense — for example, ich habe (I have). Then you add the past participle form of the modal verb — for example, the past participle form of mögen is gemocht (liked). Consider this example sentence: Ich habe ihn gemocht. (I liked him.) Table 4-5 lists the infinitives and past participles of the modal verbs.

Table 4-5

Past Participles of Modal Verbs

Infinitive

Past Participle

dürfen (may, to be allowed to)

gedurft (was allowed to)

können (can, to be able to)

gekonnt (could, was able to)

mögen (to like to)

gemocht (liked)

müssen (must, to have to)

gemusst (had to)

sollen (should, to be supposed to)

gesollt (was supposed to)

wollen (to want to)

gewollt (wanted to) Book IV

Understanding word order with modal verbs For situations in which modal verbs don’t modify an infinitive verb in the present perfect, the conjugated auxiliary verb goes in second position in the sentence, and the past participle goes at the end of the sentence. The following sentences show you what this word order looks like. Notice that each of the sentences has two verb parts (the auxiliary verb and the past participle of the modal verb). Am Anfang habe ich diese Kollegin nicht gemocht. (In the beginning, Ididn’t like that colleague.) In früheren Zeiten haben die Bauer viele Kinder gewollt. (In former times, farmers wanted [to have] a lot of children.)

Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication

518

Book IV: Building Detail and Precision in Your Communication Wir haben vor Mitternacht nach Hause gemusst. (We had to be home before midnight.) Er hat Pasta nie gemocht. (He never liked pasta.) When the modal verb combines with another verb (in addition to the auxiliary haben) in present perfect tense, they form a double infinitive. In such sentences, the main verb and the modal verb appear together at the end of the clause or sentence in their infinitive forms, with the main verb preceding the modal verb. As is the case with other verbs in the present perfect, you conjugate the auxiliary verb haben in the present tense and place it in second position in the sentence. The following examples illustrate the correct word order for modals that